<?xml version="1.0"?><Statute bill-origin="commons" bill-type="govt-public" xml:lang="en" in-force="yes" startdate="20120329"><Identification Code="id=&quot;&quot;" hasPreviousVersion="true"><LongTitle Code="id=&quot;&quot;,lt=&quot;&quot;">An Act respecting insurance companies and fraternal benefit societies</LongTitle><ShortTitle status="official" Code="id=&quot;&quot;,st=&quot;&quot;">Insurance Companies Act</ShortTitle><RunningHead>Insurance Companies</RunningHead><BillHistory><Stages stage="assented-to"><Date><YYYY>1991</YYYY><MM>December</MM><DD>13</DD></Date></Stages><Stages stage="consolidation"><Date><YYYY>2012</YYYY><MM>04</MM><DD>03</DD></Date></Stages></BillHistory><Chapter Code="id=&quot;&quot;,ch=&quot;&quot;"><ConsolidatedNumber official="no" Code="id=&quot;&quot;,ch=&quot;&quot;,cn=&quot;&quot;">I-11.8</ConsolidatedNumber><AnnualStatuteId revised-statute="no"><AnnualStatuteNumber>47</AnnualStatuteNumber><YYYY>1991</YYYY></AnnualStatuteId></Chapter></Identification><Introduction Code="in=&quot;&quot;"><?Pub Dtl?><Enacts Code="in=&quot;&quot;,en=&quot;&quot;"><Provision format-ref="indent-1-0" language-align="no" Code="in=&quot;&quot;,en=&quot;&quot;,pv=&quot;&quot;,nb=&quot;1&quot;"><Text>Her Majesty, by and with the advice and consent of the Senate and House of Commons of Canada, enacts as follows:</Text></Provision></Enacts></Introduction><Body><Heading Code="ga=&quot;s_1&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="1"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;s_1&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">SHORT TITLE</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Short title</MarginalNote><Label>1.</Label><Text>This Act may be cited as the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="I-11.8">Insurance Companies Act</XRefExternal>.</Text></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_I&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="1"><Label>PART I</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_I&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">INTERPRETATION AND APPLICATION</TitleText></Heading><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_I&quot;,gb=&quot;s_2&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_I&quot;,gb=&quot;s_2&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Definitions</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Definitions</MarginalNote><Label>2.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>In this Act,</Text><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{actuary}{actuaire}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{actuary}{actuaire}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>actuary</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{actuary}{actuaire}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>actuaire</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>actuary</DefinedTermEn> means a Fellow of the Canadian Institute of Actuaries;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{adjustable policy}{police ajustable}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{adjustable policy}{police ajustable}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>adjustable policy</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{adjustable policy}{police ajustable}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr><Emphasis style="italic">police ajustable</Emphasis></DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>adjustable policy</DefinedTermEn> means an adjustable policy as defined in the regulations;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{affairs}{affaires internes}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{affairs}{affaires internes}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>affairs</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{affairs}{affaires internes}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>affaires internes</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>affairs</DefinedTermEn>, with respect to a company, means the relationships among the company and its affiliates and the shareholders, policyholders, directors and officers of the company and its affiliates, but does not include the business of the company or any of its affiliates;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{affiliate}{groupe}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{affiliate}{groupe}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>affiliate</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{affiliate}{groupe}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>groupe</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>affiliate</DefinedTermEn> means an entity that is affiliated with another entity within the meaning of section 6;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{Agency}{Agence}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{Agency}{Agence}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>Agency</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{Agency}{Agence}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>Agence</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>Agency</DefinedTermEn> means the Financial Consumer Agency of Canada established under section 3 of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="F-11.1">Financial Consumer Agency of Canada Act</XRefExternal>;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{annual return}{état annuel}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{annual return}{état annuel}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>annual return</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{annual return}{état annuel}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>état annuel</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>annual return</DefinedTermEn> means a return prepared in accordance with subsection 665(1) or (2);</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{annual statement}{rapport annuel}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{annual statement}{rapport annuel}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>annual statement</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{annual statement}{rapport annuel}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>rapport annuel</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>annual statement</DefinedTermEn>, in relation to a company, means the annual financial statement of the company within the meaning of paragraph 331(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) and, in relation to an insurance holding company, means the annual financial statement of the insurance holding company within the meaning of paragraph 887(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>);</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{assets in Canada}{actif au Canada}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{assets in Canada}{actif au Canada}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>assets in Canada</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{assets in Canada}{actif au Canada}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>actif au Canada</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>assets in Canada</DefinedTermEn> means the assets that have been vested in trust for a foreign company under Part XIII;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{auditor}{vérificateur}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{auditor}{vérificateur}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>auditor</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{auditor}{vérificateur}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>vérificateur</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>auditor</DefinedTermEn> includes a firm of accountants;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{bank holding company}{société de portefeuille bancaire}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{bank holding company}{société de portefeuille bancaire}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>bank holding company</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{bank holding company}{société de portefeuille bancaire}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>société de portefeuille bancaire</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>bank holding company</DefinedTermEn> means a body corporate that is incorporated or formed under Part XV of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="B-1.01">Bank Act</XRefExternal>;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{bearer}{porteur}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{bearer}{porteur}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>bearer</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{bearer}{porteur}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>porteur</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>bearer</DefinedTermEn>, in relation to a security, means the person in possession of a security payable to bearer or endorsed in blank;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{bearer form}{titre au porteur}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{bearer form}{titre au porteur}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>bearer form</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{bearer form}{titre au porteur}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>titre au porteur</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>bearer form</DefinedTermEn>, in respect of a security, means a security in bearer form as determined in accordance with subsection 87(2);</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{beneficial ownership}{véritable propriétaire}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{beneficial ownership}{véritable propriétaire}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>beneficial ownership</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{beneficial ownership}{véritable propriétaire}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>véritable propriétaire</DefinedTermFr> et <DefinedTermFr>propriété effective</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>beneficial ownership</DefinedTermEn> includes ownership through one or more trustees, legal representatives, agents or other intermediaries;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{body corporate}{personne morale}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{body corporate}{personne morale}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>body corporate</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{body corporate}{personne morale}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>personne morale</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>body corporate</DefinedTermEn> means an incorporated body wherever or however incorporated;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{Canadian financial institution}{institution financière canadienne}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{Canadian financial institution}{institution financière canadienne}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>Canadian financial institution</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{Canadian financial institution}{institution financière canadienne}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>institution financière canadienne</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>Canadian financial institution</DefinedTermEn> means a financial institution that is incorporated or formed by or under an Act of Parliament or of the legislature of a province;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{central securities register}{registre central des valeurs mobilières}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{central securities register}{registre central des valeurs mobilières}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>central securities register</DefinedTermEn> or <DefinedTermEn>securities register</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{central securities register}{registre central des valeurs mobilières}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>registre central des valeurs mobilières</DefinedTermFr> ou <DefinedTermFr>registre des valeurs mobilières</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>central securities register</DefinedTermEn> or <DefinedTermEn>securities register</DefinedTermEn>, in relation to a company or an insurance holding company, means the register referred to in section 271;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{class}{branche}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{class}{branche}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>class</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{class}{branche}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>branche</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>class</DefinedTermEn>, in respect of insurance or an insurance policy, means a class determined in accordance with section 12;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{Commissioner}{commissaire}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{Commissioner}{commissaire}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>Commissioner</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{Commissioner}{commissaire}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>commissaire</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>Commissioner</DefinedTermEn> means the Commissioner of the Financial Consumer Agency of Canada appointed under section 4 of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="F-11.1">Financial Consumer Agency of Canada Act</XRefExternal>;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{common-law partner}{conjoint de fait}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{common-law partner}{conjoint de fait}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>common-law partner</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{common-law partner}{conjoint de fait}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>conjoint de fait</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>common-law partner</DefinedTermEn>, in relation to an individual, means a person who is cohabiting with the individual in a conjugal relationship, having so cohabited for a period of at least one year;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{company}{société}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{company}{société}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>company</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{company}{société}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>société</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>company</DefinedTermEn> means a body corporate referred to in subsection 13(1);</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{complainant}{plaignant}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{complainant}{plaignant}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>complainant</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{complainant}{plaignant}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>plaignant</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>complainant</DefinedTermEn>, in relation to a company or any matter concerning a company, means</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{complainant}{plaignant}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a registered holder or beneficial owner, and a former registered holder or beneficial owner, of a security of the company or any of its affiliates,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{complainant}{plaignant}&quot;,p1=&quot;a.1&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a.1</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a policyholder entitled to vote at a meeting of policyholders or shareholders and policyholders of the company,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{complainant}{plaignant}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a director or an officer, or a former director or officer, of the company or any of its affiliates, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{complainant}{plaignant}&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any other person who, in the discretion of a court, is a proper person to make an application under section 371, 375 or 1031;</Text></Paragraph></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{consumer provision}{disposition visant les consommateurs}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{consumer provision}{disposition visant les consommateurs}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>consumer provision</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{consumer provision}{disposition visant les consommateurs}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>disposition visant les consommateurs</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>consumer provision</DefinedTermEn> means a provision referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>) of the definition “consumer provision” in section 2 of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="F-11.1">Financial Consumer Agency of Canada Act</XRefExternal>;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{converted company}{société transformée}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{converted company}{société transformée}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>converted company</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{converted company}{société transformée}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>société transformée</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>converted company</DefinedTermEn> means a mutual company that has been converted under this Act into a company with common shares;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{court}{tribunal}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{court}{tribunal}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>court</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{court}{tribunal}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>tribunal</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>court</DefinedTermEn> means</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{court}{tribunal}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the Province of Ontario, the Superior Court of Justice,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{court}{tribunal}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the Province of Quebec, the Superior Court of the Province,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{court}{tribunal}&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the Provinces of Nova Scotia and British Columbia, the Supreme Court of the Province,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{court}{tribunal}&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the Provinces of New Brunswick, Manitoba, Saskatchewan and Alberta, the Court of Queen’s Bench for the Province,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{court}{tribunal}&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the Provinces of Prince Edward Island and Newfoundland, the trial division of the Supreme Court of the Province, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{court}{tribunal}&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in Yukon and the Northwest Territories, the Supreme Court, and in Nunavut, the Nunavut Court of Justice;</Text></Paragraph></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{court of appeal}{cour d’appel}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{court of appeal}{cour d’appel}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>court of appeal</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{court of appeal}{cour d’appel}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>cour d’appel</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>court of appeal</DefinedTermEn> means the court to which an appeal lies from a decision or order of a court;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{debt obligation}{titre de créance}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{debt obligation}{titre de créance}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>debt obligation</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{debt obligation}{titre de créance}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>titre de créance</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>debt obligation</DefinedTermEn> means a bond, debenture, note or other evidence of indebtedness of an entity, whether secured or unsecured;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{director}{administrateur}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{director}{administrateur}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>director</DefinedTermEn>, <DefinedTermEn>board of directors</DefinedTermEn> or <DefinedTermEn>directors</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{director}{administrateur}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>administrateur</DefinedTermFr>, <DefinedTermFr>conseil d’administration</DefinedTermFr> ou <DefinedTermFr>conseil</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>director</DefinedTermEn> means a natural person occupying the position of director, by whatever name called, of a body corporate, and <DefinedTermEn>board of directors</DefinedTermEn> or <DefinedTermEn>directors</DefinedTermEn> refers to the directors of a body corporate as a body and, in the case of a society, refers to the supreme governing body of the society;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{equity}{capitaux propres}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{equity}{capitaux propres}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>equity</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{equity}{capitaux propres}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>capitaux propres</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>equity</DefinedTermEn>, in respect of a company or an insurance holding company, means its equity as determined in accordance with the regulations;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{entity}{entité}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{entity}{entité}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>entity</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{entity}{entité}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>entité</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>entity</DefinedTermEn> means a body corporate, trust, partnership, fund, an unincorporated association or organization, Her Majesty in right of Canada or of a province, an agency of Her Majesty in either of such rights and the government of a foreign country or any political subdivision thereof and any agency thereof;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{federal financial institution}{institution financière fédérale}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{federal financial institution}{institution financière fédérale}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>federal financial institution</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{federal financial institution}{institution financière fédérale}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>institution financière fédérale</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>federal financial institution</DefinedTermEn> means</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{federal financial institution}{institution financière fédérale}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a company or a society,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{federal financial institution}{institution financière fédérale}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a bank,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{federal financial institution}{institution financière fédérale}&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a body corporate to which the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="T-19.8">Trust and Loan Companies Act</XRefExternal> applies, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{federal financial institution}{institution financière fédérale}&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an association to which the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="C-41.01">Cooperative Credit Associations Act</XRefExternal> applies or a central cooperative credit society for which an order has been made under subsection 473(1) of that Act;</Text></Paragraph></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{fiduciary}{représentant}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{fiduciary}{représentant}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>fiduciary</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{fiduciary}{représentant}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>représentant</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>fiduciary</DefinedTermEn> means any person acting in a fiduciary capacity and includes a personal representative of a deceased person;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{financial institution}{institution financière}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{financial institution}{institution financière}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>financial institution</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{financial institution}{institution financière}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>institution financière</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>financial institution</DefinedTermEn> means</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{financial institution}{institution financière}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a company or a society,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{financial institution}{institution financière}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a bank or an authorized foreign bank within the meaning of section 2 of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="B-1.01">Bank Act</XRefExternal>,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{financial institution}{institution financière}&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a body corporate to which the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="T-19.8">Trust and Loan Companies Act</XRefExternal> applies,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{financial institution}{institution financière}&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an association to which the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="C-41.01">Cooperative Credit Associations Act</XRefExternal> applies or a central cooperative credit society for which an order has been made under subsection 473(1) of that Act,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{financial institution}{institution financière}&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a trust, loan or insurance corporation incorporated by or under an Act of the legislature of a province,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{financial institution}{institution financière}&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a cooperative credit society incorporated and regulated by or under an Act of the legislature of a province,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{financial institution}{institution financière}&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an entity that is incorporated or formed by or under an Act of Parliament or of the legislature of a province and that is primarily engaged in dealing in securities, including portfolio management and investment counselling, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{financial institution}{institution financière}&quot;,p1=&quot;h&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">h</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a foreign institution;</Text></Paragraph></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{financial year}{exercice}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{financial year}{exercice}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>financial year</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{financial year}{exercice}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>exercice</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>financial year</DefinedTermEn>, in respect of a foreign company, means a calendar year;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{foreign company}{société étrangère}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{foreign company}{société étrangère}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>foreign company</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{foreign company}{société étrangère}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>société étrangère</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>foreign company</DefinedTermEn> means an entity that is the subject of an order made under subsection 574(1);</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{foreign institution}{institution étrangère}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{foreign institution}{institution étrangère}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>foreign institution</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{foreign institution}{institution étrangère}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>institution étrangère</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>foreign institution</DefinedTermEn> means an entity that is</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{foreign institution}{institution étrangère}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>engaged in the business of banking, the trust, loan or insurance business, the business of a cooperative credit society or the business of dealing in securities or is otherwise engaged primarily in the business of providing financial services, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{foreign institution}{institution étrangère}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>incorporated or formed otherwise than by or under an Act of Parliament or of the legislature of a province;</Text></Paragraph></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{former-Act company}{société antérieure}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{former-Act company}{société antérieure}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>former-Act company</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{former-Act company}{société antérieure}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>société antérieure</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>former-Act company</DefinedTermEn> means a body corporate referred to in paragraph 13(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>);</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{former-Act society}{société de secours antérieure}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{former-Act society}{société de secours antérieure}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>former-Act society</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{former-Act society}{société de secours antérieure}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>société de secours antérieure</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>former-Act society</DefinedTermEn> means a body corporate referred to in paragraph 13(2)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>);</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{form of proxy}{formulaire de procuration}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{form of proxy}{formulaire de procuration}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>form of proxy</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{form of proxy}{formulaire de procuration}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>formulaire de procuration</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>form of proxy</DefinedTermEn> means a written or printed form that, when completed and executed by or on behalf of a shareholder or a policyholder, or, in the case of a fraternal benefit society, a member, constitutes a proxy;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{fraternal benefit society}{société de secours mutuel}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{fraternal benefit society}{société de secours mutuel}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>fraternal benefit society</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{fraternal benefit society}{société de secours mutuel}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>société de secours mutuel</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>fraternal benefit society</DefinedTermEn> means a body corporate</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{fraternal benefit society}{société de secours mutuel}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>that is without share capital,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{fraternal benefit society}{société de secours mutuel}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>that has a representative form of government, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{fraternal benefit society}{société de secours mutuel}&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>that was incorporated for fraternal, benevolent or religious purposes, including the provision of insurance benefits solely to its members or the spouses, common-law partners or children of its members;</Text></Paragraph></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{going-private transaction}{transaction de fermeture}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{going-private transaction}{transaction de fermeture}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>going-private transaction</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{going-private transaction}{transaction de fermeture}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>transaction de fermeture</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>going-private transaction</DefinedTermEn> means a going-private transaction as defined in the regulations;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{guarantee}{garantie}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{guarantee}{garantie}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>guarantee</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{guarantee}{garantie}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>garantie</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>guarantee</DefinedTermEn> includes a letter of credit;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{head office}{siège}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{head office}{siège}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>head office</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{head office}{siège}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>siège</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>head office</DefinedTermEn> means</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{head office}{siège}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in relation to a company, the office required to be maintained by the company under section 260,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{head office}{siège}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in relation to a society, the office required to be maintained by the society under section 544, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{head office}{siège}&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in relation to an insurance holding company, the office required to be maintained by the insurance holding company under section 868;</Text></Paragraph></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{holder}{détenteur}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{holder}{détenteur}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>holder</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{holder}{détenteur}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>détenteur</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>holder</DefinedTermEn> means</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{holder}{détenteur}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in respect of a security certificate, the person in possession of the certificate issued or endorsed to that person or to bearer or in blank, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{holder}{détenteur}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in respect of the ownership of a share, the shareholder of the share within the meaning of section 7;</Text></Paragraph></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{holding body corporate}{société mère}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{holding body corporate}{société mère}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>holding body corporate</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{holding body corporate}{société mère}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>société mère</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>holding body corporate</DefinedTermEn> means a holding body corporate within the meaning of section 4;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{incorporated}{constitué en personne morale}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{incorporated}{constitué en personne morale}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>incorporated</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{incorporated}{constitué en personne morale}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>constitué en personne morale</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>incorporated</DefinedTermEn>, when used with reference to a body corporate that is incorporated by or under an Act of Parliament or of the legislature of a province, also refers to a body corporate that is continued by or under any such Act;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{incorporating instrument}{acte constitutif}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{incorporating instrument}{acte constitutif}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>incorporating instrument</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{incorporating instrument}{acte constitutif}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>acte constitutif</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>incorporating instrument</DefinedTermEn> means the special Act, letters patent, instrument of continuance or other constating instrument by which a body corporate was incorporated or continued and includes any amendment to or restatement of the constating instrument;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{incorporator}{fondateur}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{incorporator}{fondateur}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>incorporator</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{incorporator}{fondateur}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>fondateur</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>incorporator</DefinedTermEn>, in relation to a company or an insurance holding company, means a person who applied for letters patent to incorporate the company or insurance holding company, as the case may be;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{insurance holding company}{société de portefeuille d’assurances}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{insurance holding company}{société de portefeuille d’assurances}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>insurance holding company</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{insurance holding company}{société de portefeuille d’assurances}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>société de portefeuille d’assurances</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>insurance holding company</DefinedTermEn> means a body corporate that is incorporated or formed under Part XVII;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{issuer}{émetteur}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{issuer}{émetteur}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>issuer</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{issuer}{émetteur}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>émetteur</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>issuer</DefinedTermEn>, in respect of a security, means the entity that issues or issued the security;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{letters patent}{lettres patentes}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{letters patent}{lettres patentes}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>letters patent</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{letters patent}{lettres patentes}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>lettres patentes</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>letters patent</DefinedTermEn>, in respect of an instrument authorized to be issued under this Act, means letters patent in a form approved by the Superintendent;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{life company}{société d’assurance-vie}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{life company}{société d’assurance-vie}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>life company</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{life company}{société d’assurance-vie}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>société d’assurance-vie</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>life company</DefinedTermEn> means a company or a provincial company that is permitted to insure risks falling within the class of life insurance, other than a company or a provincial company that is also permitted to insure risks falling within any other class of insurance other than accident and sickness insurance, credit protection insurance and other approved products insurance;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{marine company}{société d’assurance maritime}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{marine company}{société d’assurance maritime}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>marine company</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{marine company}{société d’assurance maritime}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>société d’assurance maritime</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>marine company</DefinedTermEn> means a company that is incorporated for the sole purpose of insuring risks within the class of marine insurance;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{Minister}{ministre}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{Minister}{ministre}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>Minister</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{Minister}{ministre}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>ministre</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>Minister</DefinedTermEn> means the Minister of Finance;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{minor}{mineur}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{minor}{mineur}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>minor</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{minor}{mineur}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>mineur</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>minor</DefinedTermEn> has the same meaning as in the applicable provincial law and in the absence of any such law has the same meaning as the word “child” in the United Nations Convention on the Rights of the Child adopted in the United Nations General Assembly on November 20, 1989;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{mutual company}{société mutuelle}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{mutual company}{société mutuelle}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>mutual company</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{mutual company}{société mutuelle}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>société mutuelle</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>mutual company</DefinedTermEn> means</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{mutual company}{société mutuelle}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a company that is incorporated or continued as a mutual company under this Act,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{mutual company}{société mutuelle}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a former-Act company that, on the coming into force of this paragraph, has no issued and outstanding shares, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{mutual company}{société mutuelle}&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a company that is converted into a mutual company under sections 226 to 236,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedDefinition><Text>and that is not converted into a company with common shares under this Act;</Text></ContinuedDefinition></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{non-WTO Member foreign institution}{institution étrangère d’un non-membre de l’OMC}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{non-WTO Member foreign institution}{institution étrangère d’un non-membre de l’OMC}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>non-WTO Member foreign institution</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{non-WTO Member foreign institution}{institution étrangère d’un non-membre de l’OMC}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>institution étrangère d’un non-membre de l’OMC</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>non-WTO Member foreign institution</DefinedTermEn> means a foreign institution that is not controlled by a WTO Member resident;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{officer}{dirigeant}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{officer}{dirigeant}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>officer</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{officer}{dirigeant}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>dirigeant</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>officer</DefinedTermEn> means</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{officer}{dirigeant}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in relation to a body corporate, a chief executive officer, president, vice-president, secretary, controller, treasurer and any other natural person designated as an officer of the body corporate by by-law or by resolution of the directors of the body corporate, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{officer}{dirigeant}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in relation to any other entity, any natural person designated as an officer of the entity by by-law, by resolution of the members thereof or otherwise;</Text></Paragraph></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{order form}{titre à ordre}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{order form}{titre à ordre}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>order form</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{order form}{titre à ordre}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>titre à ordre</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>order form</DefinedTermEn>, in respect of a security, means a security in order form as determined in accordance with subsection 87(3);</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{ordinary resolution}{résolution ordinaire}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{ordinary resolution}{résolution ordinaire}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>ordinary resolution</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{ordinary resolution}{résolution ordinaire}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>résolution ordinaire</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>ordinary resolution</DefinedTermEn> means a resolution passed by a majority of the votes cast by or on behalf of the shareholders or policyholders who voted in respect of that resolution;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{participating policy}{police à participation}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{participating policy}{police à participation}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>participating policy</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{participating policy}{police à participation}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>police à participation</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>participating policy</DefinedTermEn> means a policy issued by a company that entitles its holder to participate in the profits of the company;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{participating policyholder}{souscripteur avec participation}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{participating policyholder}{souscripteur avec participation}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>participating policyholder</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{participating policyholder}{souscripteur avec participation}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>souscripteur avec participation</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>participating policyholder</DefinedTermEn> means the holder of a participating policy;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{person}{personne}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{person}{personne}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>person</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{person}{personne}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>personne</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>person</DefinedTermEn> means a natural person, an entity or a personal representative;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{personal representative}{représentant personnel}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{personal representative}{représentant personnel}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>personal representative</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{personal representative}{représentant personnel}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>représentant personnel</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>personal representative</DefinedTermEn> means a person who stands in place of and represents another person and, without limiting the generality of the foregoing, includes, as the circumstances require, a trustee, an executor, an administrator, a committee, a guardian, a tutor, a curator, an assignee, a receiver, an agent or an attorney of any person;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{policy}{police}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{policy}{police}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>policy</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{policy}{police}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>police</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>policy</DefinedTermEn> means any written contract of insurance or reinsurance whether contained in one or more documents and, in the case of insurance in a fraternal benefit society, any contract of insurance whether evidenced by a written document or not and any certificate of membership relating in any way to insurance, and includes any annuity contract and any endowment insurance contract;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{}{}&quot;"><Text><DefinedTermEn>policy in Canada</DefinedTermEn><Repealed>[Repealed, 2007, c. 6, s. 186]</Repealed></Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{}{}&quot;"><Text><DefinedTermEn>policyholder in Canada</DefinedTermEn><Repealed>[Repealed, 2007, c. 6, s. 186]</Repealed></Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{prescribed}{}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{prescribed}{}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>prescribed</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{prescribed}{}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinitionEnOnly>Version anglaise seulement</DefinitionEnOnly></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>prescribed</DefinedTermEn> means prescribed by regulation;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{property and casualty company}{société d’assurances multirisques}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{property and casualty company}{société d’assurances multirisques}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>property and casualty company</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{property and casualty company}{société d’assurances multirisques}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>société d’assurances multirisques</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>property and casualty company</DefinedTermEn> means a company or a provincial company that is not a life company or a marine company;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{provincial company}{société provinciale}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{provincial company}{société provinciale}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>provincial company</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{provincial company}{société provinciale}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>société provinciale</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>provincial company</DefinedTermEn> means, subject to subsection (1.1),</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{provincial company}{société provinciale}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 2001, c. 9, s. 345]</Repealed></Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{provincial company}{société provinciale}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>Antigonish Farmers’ Mutual Fire Insurance Company,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{provincial company}{société provinciale}&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>Clare Mutual Insurance Company,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{provincial company}{société provinciale}&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>The Halifax Insurance Company, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{provincial company}{société provinciale}&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>Pictou County Farmers’ Mutual Fire Insurance Company,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedDefinition><Text>or, if the name of such company is changed, includes the successor company by its new name;</Text></ContinuedDefinition></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{proxy}{procuration}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{proxy}{procuration}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>proxy</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{proxy}{procuration}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>procuration</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>proxy</DefinedTermEn> means a completed and executed form of proxy by means of which a shareholder or policyholder or, in the case of a society, a member, appoints a proxyholder to attend and act on behalf of the shareholder, policyholder or member at a meeting of shareholders, policyholders or members;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{proxyholder}{fondé de pouvoir}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{proxyholder}{fondé de pouvoir}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>proxyholder</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{proxyholder}{fondé de pouvoir}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>fondé de pouvoir</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>proxyholder</DefinedTermEn> means the person appointed by proxy to attend and act on behalf of a shareholder or a policyholder or, in the case of a society, a member at a meeting of shareholders, policyholders or members;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{real property}{biens immeubles}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{real property}{biens immeubles}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>real property</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{real property}{biens immeubles}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>biens immeubles</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>real property</DefinedTermEn> includes a leasehold interest in real property;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{recorded address}{adresse enregistrée}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{recorded address}{adresse enregistrée}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>recorded address</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{recorded address}{adresse enregistrée}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>adresse enregistrée</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>recorded address</DefinedTermEn> means</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{recorded address}{adresse enregistrée}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in relation to a person who is a shareholder of a company or an insurance holding company, the latest postal address of the person according to the central securities register of the company or the insurance holding company, as the case may be, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{recorded address}{adresse enregistrée}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in relation to a person in any other respect, the latest postal address of the person according to the records of the company or insurance holding company;</Text></Paragraph></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{registered form}{titre nominatif}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{registered form}{titre nominatif}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>registered form</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{registered form}{titre nominatif}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>titre nominatif</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>registered form</DefinedTermEn>, in respect of a security, means a security in registered form as determined in accordance with subsection 87(4);</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{regulatory capital}{capital réglementaire}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{regulatory capital}{capital réglementaire}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>regulatory capital</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{regulatory capital}{capital réglementaire}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>capital réglementaire</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>regulatory capital</DefinedTermEn>, in respect of a company, a society, a provincial company or an insurance holding company, has the meaning given that expression by the regulations;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{resident Canadian}{résident canadien}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{resident Canadian}{résident canadien}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>resident Canadian</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{resident Canadian}{résident canadien}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>résident canadien</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>resident Canadian</DefinedTermEn> means a natural person who is</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{resident Canadian}{résident canadien}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a Canadian citizen ordinarily resident in Canada,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{resident Canadian}{résident canadien}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a Canadian citizen not ordinarily resident in Canada who is a member of a prescribed class of persons, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{resident Canadian}{résident canadien}&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a permanent resident within the meaning of subsection 2(1) of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="I-2.5">Immigration and Refugee Protection Act</XRefExternal> and ordinarily resident in Canada, except a permanent resident who has been ordinarily resident in Canada for more than one year after the time at which the individual first became eligible to apply for Canadian citizenship;</Text></Paragraph></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{residential property}{immeuble résidentiel}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{residential property}{immeuble résidentiel}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>residential property</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{residential property}{immeuble résidentiel}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>immeuble résidentiel</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>residential property</DefinedTermEn> means real property consisting of buildings that are used, or are to be used, to the extent of at least one half of the floor space thereof, as one or more private dwellings;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{securities underwriter}{souscripteur à forfait}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{securities underwriter}{souscripteur à forfait}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>securities underwriter</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{securities underwriter}{souscripteur à forfait}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>souscripteur à forfait</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>securities underwriter</DefinedTermEn> means a person who, as principal, agrees to purchase securities with a view to the distribution of the securities or who, as agent for a body corporate or other person, offers for sale or sells securities in connection with a distribution of the securities, and includes a person who participates, directly or indirectly, in a distribution of securities, other than a person whose interest in the distribution of securities is limited to receiving a distributor’s or seller’s commission payable by a securities underwriter;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{security}{titre}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{security}{titre}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>security</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{security}{titre}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>titre</DefinedTermFr> ou <DefinedTermFr>valeur mobilière</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>security</DefinedTermEn> means</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{security}{titre}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in relation to a body corporate, a share of any class of shares of the body corporate or a debt obligation of the body corporate, and includes a warrant of the body corporate, but does not include a deposit with a financial institution or any instrument evidencing such a deposit, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{security}{titre}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in relation to any other entity, any ownership interest in or debt obligation of the entity,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedDefinition><Text>but does not include a policy;</Text></ContinuedDefinition></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{security interest}{sûreté}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{security interest}{sûreté}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>security interest</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{security interest}{sûreté}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>sûreté</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>security interest</DefinedTermEn> means an interest in or charge on property by way of mortgage, lien, pledge or otherwise taken by a creditor or guarantor to secure the payment or performance of an obligation;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{send}{envoyer}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{send}{envoyer}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>send</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{send}{envoyer}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>envoyer</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>send</DefinedTermEn> includes deliver;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{series}{série}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{series}{série}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>series</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{series}{série}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>série</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>series</DefinedTermEn>, in respect of shares, means a division of a class of shares;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{significant interest}{intérêt substantiel}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{significant interest}{intérêt substantiel}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>significant interest</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{significant interest}{intérêt substantiel}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>intérêt substantiel</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>significant interest</DefinedTermEn> means a significant interest determined in accordance with section 8;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{society}{société de secours}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{society}{société de secours}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>society</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{society}{société de secours}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>société de secours</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>society</DefinedTermEn> means a body corporate referred to in subsection 13(2) that is a fraternal benefit society;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{special resolution}{résolution extraordinaire}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{special resolution}{résolution extraordinaire}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>special resolution</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{special resolution}{résolution extraordinaire}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>résolution extraordinaire</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>special resolution</DefinedTermEn> means a resolution passed by a majority of not less than two thirds of the votes cast by or on behalf of the shareholders and policyholders and, in the case of a fraternal benefit society, the members, who voted in respect of that resolution or signed by all the shareholders, policyholders and members entitled to vote on that resolution;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{squeeze-out transaction}{transaction d’éviction}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{squeeze-out transaction}{transaction d’éviction}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>squeeze-out transaction</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{squeeze-out transaction}{transaction d’éviction}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>transaction d’éviction</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>squeeze-out transaction</DefinedTermEn> means a transaction by a company that is not a distributing company, or an insurance holding company that is not a distributing insurance holding company, that requires an amendment to a by-law referred to in subsection 238(1) or 851(1), as the case may be, and that would directly or indirectly result in the interest of a holder of shares of a class of shares being terminated without their consent and without substituting an interest of equivalent value in shares that are issued by the following persons and have rights and privileges equal to or greater than those of the shares of the affected class:</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{squeeze-out transaction}{transaction d’éviction}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of a company, the company, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{squeeze-out transaction}{transaction d’éviction}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of an insurance holding company, the insurance holding company;</Text></Paragraph></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{subordinated indebtedness}{titre secondaire}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{subordinated indebtedness}{titre secondaire}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>subordinated indebtedness</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{subordinated indebtedness}{titre secondaire}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>titre secondaire</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>subordinated indebtedness</DefinedTermEn> means an instrument evidencing an indebtedness of a company that by its terms provides that the indebtedness will, in the event of the insolvency or winding-up of the company, be subordinate in right of payment to all policy liabilities of the company and all other liabilities of the company except those other liabilities that, by their terms, rank equally with or are subordinate to such indebtedness;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{subsidiary}{filiale}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{subsidiary}{filiale}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>subsidiary</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{subsidiary}{filiale}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>filiale</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>subsidiary</DefinedTermEn> means an entity that is a subsidiary of another entity within the meaning of section 5;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{substantial investment}{intérêt de groupe financier}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{substantial investment}{intérêt de groupe financier}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>substantial investment</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{substantial investment}{intérêt de groupe financier}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>intérêt de groupe financier</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>substantial investment</DefinedTermEn> means a substantial investment determined in accordance with section 10;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{Superintendent}{surintendant}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{Superintendent}{surintendant}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>Superintendent</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{Superintendent}{surintendant}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>surintendant</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>Superintendent</DefinedTermEn> means the Superintendent of Financial Institutions appointed pursuant to the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="O-2.7">Office of the Superintendent of Financial Institutions Act</XRefExternal>;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{total assets}{actif total}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{total assets}{actif total}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>total assets</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{total assets}{actif total}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>actif total</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>total assets</DefinedTermEn>, in respect of a company, society, provincial company or insurance holding company, has the meaning given that expression by the regulations;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{trade}{opération}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{trade}{opération}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>trade</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{trade}{opération}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>opération</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>trade</DefinedTermEn>, in respect of securities, means any sale or disposition of securities for valuable consideration;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{transfer}{transfert}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{transfer}{transfert}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>transfer</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{transfer}{transfert}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>transfert</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>transfer</DefinedTermEn>, in respect of securities, includes a transmission by operation of law;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{voting share}{action avec droit de vote}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{voting share}{action avec droit de vote}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>voting share</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{voting share}{action avec droit de vote}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>action avec droit de vote</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>voting share</DefinedTermEn> means a share of any class of shares of a body corporate carrying voting rights under all circumstances or by reason of an event that has occurred and is continuing or by reason of a condition that has been fulfilled;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{WTO Member resident}{résident d’un membre de l’OMC}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{WTO Member resident}{résident d’un membre de l’OMC}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>WTO Member resident</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{WTO Member resident}{résident d’un membre de l’OMC}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>résident d’un membre de l’OMC</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>WTO Member resident</DefinedTermEn> means a WTO Member resident within the meaning of section 11.1.</Text></Definition></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Provincial company status</MarginalNote><Label>(1.1)</Label><Text>A company referred to in the definition “provincial company” in subsection (1) ceases to be a provincial company for the purposes of this Act if the order made by the Superintendent under subsection 657(1) approving the commencement and carrying on of business by the company is revoked.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Policy loans</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>For greater certainty, any reference in this Act to a loan does not include, unless otherwise provided, a reference to an advance on the security or against the cash surrender value of a policy.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Major shareholder</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>For the purposes of this Act, a person is a major shareholder of a body corporate if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the aggregate of the shares of any class of voting shares of the body corporate that are beneficially owned by the person and that are beneficially owned by any entities controlled by the person is more than 20 per cent of the outstanding shares of that class of voting shares of the body corporate; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the aggregate of the shares of any class of non-voting shares of the body corporate that are beneficially owned by the person and that are beneficially owned by any entities controlled by the person is more than 30 per cent of the outstanding shares of that class of non-voting shares of the body corporate.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Widely held</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>For the purposes of this Act, a body corporate is widely held if it has no major shareholder.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, ss. 2, 758, c. 48, s. 495;</li><li> 1992, c. 51, s. 55;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 66;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 165;</li><li> 1998, c. 30, ss. 13(F), 15(E);</li><li> 1999, c. 3, s. 70, c. 28, s. 118;</li><li> 2000, c. 12, s. 153;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 345, c. 27, s. 255;</li><li> 2002, c. 7, s. 187(E);</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 214;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 186.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20100101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_I&quot;,gb=&quot;s_2.1&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_I&quot;,gb=&quot;s_2.1&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Interpretation</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;2.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations — distributing company or insurance holding company</MarginalNote><Label>2.1</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;2.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations respecting the determination of what constitutes a distributing company or distributing insurance holding company for the purposes of this Act.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;2.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exemption — company or insurance holding company</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>On the application of a company or insurance holding company, the Superintendent may determine that it is not or was not a distributing company or distributing insurance holding company, as the case may be, if the Superintendent is satisfied that the determination would not prejudice any security holder of that company or insurance holding company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;2.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;2.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exemption — class of companies or insurance holding companies</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The Superintendent may determine that members of a class of companies or insurance holding companies are not or were not distributing companies or distributing insurance holding companies, as the case may be, if the Superintendent is satisfied that the determination would not prejudice any security holder of a member of the class.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2005, c. 54, s. 215.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Control</MarginalNote><Label>3.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;3&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>For the purposes of this Act,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;3&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a person controls a body corporate if securities of the body corporate to which are attached more than 50 per cent of the votes that may be cast to elect directors of the body corporate are beneficially owned by the person and the votes attached to those securities are sufficient, if exercised, to elect a majority of the directors of the body corporate;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;3&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a person controls an unincorporated entity, other than a limited partnership, if more than 50 per cent of the ownership interests, however designated, into which the entity is divided are beneficially owned by that person and the person is able to direct the business and affairs of the entity;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;3&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the general partner of a limited partnership controls the limited partnership; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;3&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a person controls an entity if the person has any direct or indirect influence that, if exercised, would result in control in fact of the entity.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;3&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;3&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Deemed control</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A person who controls an entity is deemed to control any entity that is controlled, or deemed to be controlled, by the entity.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;3&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;3&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Deemed control</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A person is deemed to control, within the meaning of paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>), an entity if the aggregate of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;3&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any securities of the entity that are beneficially owned by that person, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;3&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any securities of the entity that are beneficially owned by any entity controlled by that person</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>is such that, if that person and all of the entities referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) that beneficially own securities of the entity were one person, that person would control the entity.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;3&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;3&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Guidelines</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>The Minister may, for any purpose of any provision of this Act that refers to control within the meaning of paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), make guidelines respecting what constitutes such control, including guidelines describing the policy objectives that the guidelines and the relevant provisions of the Act are intended to achieve and, if any such guidelines are made, the reference to paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>) in that provision shall be interpreted in accordance with the guidelines.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 3;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 346.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Holding body corporate</MarginalNote><Label>4.</Label><Text>A body corporate is the holding body corporate of any entity that is its subsidiary.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 4;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 347.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Subsidiary</MarginalNote><Label>5.</Label><Text>An entity is a subsidiary of another entity if it is controlled by the other entity.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 5;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 347.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Affiliated entities</MarginalNote><Label>6.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;6&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>One entity is affiliated with another entity if one of them is controlled by the other or both are controlled by the same person.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;6&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;6&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Affiliated entities</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Despite subsection (1), for the purposes of Divisions VIII and X of Part VI and Subdivisions 8 and 10 of Division 6 of Part XVII, one entity is affiliated with another entity if one of them is controlled, determined without regard to paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), by the other or both are controlled, determined without regard to paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), by the same person.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 6;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 348.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;7&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;7&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shareholder</MarginalNote><Label>7.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;7&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>For the purposes of this Act, a person is a shareholder of a body corporate when, according to the securities register of the body corporate, the person is the owner of one or more shares of the body corporate or is entitled to be entered in the securities register or like record of the body corporate as the owner of the share or shares.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;7&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;7&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Holder of a share</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A reference in this Act to the holding of a share by or in the name of any person is a reference to the fact that the person is registered or is entitled to be registered in the securities register or like record of the body corporate as the holder of that share.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;8&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;8&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Significant interest</MarginalNote><Label>8.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;8&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A person has a significant interest in a class of shares of a company or an insurance holding company if the aggregate of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;8&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any shares of that class beneficially owned by the person, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;8&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any shares of that class beneficially owned by entities controlled by the person</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>exceeds 10 per cent of all of the outstanding shares of that class of shares of the company or insurance holding company, as the case may be.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;8&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;8&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Increasing significant interest</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A person who has a significant interest in a class of shares of a company or insurance holding company increases that significant interest in the class of shares if the person or any entity controlled by the person</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;8&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>acquires beneficial ownership of additional shares of that class, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;8&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>acquires control of any entity that beneficially owns shares of that class,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>in such number as to increase the percentage of shares of that class that are beneficially owned by the person and by any entities controlled by the person.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 8;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 349.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;9&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;9&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Acting in concert</MarginalNote><Label>9.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;9&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>For the purposes of Part VII and Division 7 of Part XVII, if two or more persons have agreed, under any agreement, commitment or understanding, whether formal or informal, verbal or written, to act jointly or in concert in respect of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;9&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>shares of a company or of an insurance holding company that they beneficially own,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;9&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>shares or ownership interests that they beneficially own of any entity that beneficially owns shares of a company or of an insurance holding company, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;9&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>shares or ownership interests that they beneficially own of any entity that controls any entity that beneficially owns shares of a company or insurance holding company,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>those persons are deemed to be a single person who is acquiring beneficial ownership of the aggregate number of shares of the company or insurance holding company or shares or ownership interests of the entity that are beneficially owned by them.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;9&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;9&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Acting in concert</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Without limiting the generality of subsection (1), any agreement, commitment or understanding by or between two or more persons who beneficially own shares of a company or insurance holding company or shares or ownership interests of any entity referred to in paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>),</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;9&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>whereby any of them or their nominees may veto any proposal put before the board of directors of the company or insurance holding company, as the case may be, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;9&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>under which no proposal put before the board of directors of the company or insurance holding company, as the case may be, may be approved except with the consent of any of them or their nominees,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>is deemed to be an agreement, commitment or understanding referred to in subsection (1).</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;9&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;9&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exceptions</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>For the purposes of this section, persons shall be presumed not to have agreed to act jointly or in concert solely by reason of the fact that</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;9&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>one is the proxyholder of one or more of the others in respect of shares or ownership interests referred to in subsection (1); or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;9&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>they vote the voting rights attached to shares or ownership interests referred to in subsection (1) in the same manner.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;9&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;9&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Designation</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Where in the opinion of the Superintendent it is reasonable to conclude that an agreement, commitment or understanding referred to in subsections (1) and (2) exists by or among two or more persons, the Superintendent may designate those persons as persons who have agreed to act jointly or in concert.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;9&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;9&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Contravention</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>A person contravenes a provision of Part VII or Division 7 of Part XVII if the person agrees to act jointly or in concert with one or more other persons in such a manner that a deemed single person contravenes the provision.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 9;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 350;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 187.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;10&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;10&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Substantial investment in body corporate</MarginalNote><Label>10.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;10&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A person has a substantial investment in a body corporate where</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;10&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the voting rights attached to the aggregate of any voting shares of the body corporate beneficially owned by the person and by any entities controlled by the person exceed 10 per cent of the voting rights attached to all of the outstanding voting shares of the body corporate; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;10&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the aggregate of any shares of the body corporate beneficially owned by the person and by any entities controlled by the person represents ownership of greater than 25 per cent of the shareholders’ equity of the body corporate.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;10&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;10&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Increasing substantial investment in body corporate</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A person who has a substantial investment in a body corporate pursuant to paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) increases that substantial investment when the person or any entity controlled by the person</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;10&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>acquires beneficial ownership of additional voting shares of the body corporate in such number as to increase the percentage of voting rights attached to the aggregate of the voting shares of the body corporate beneficially owned by the person and by any entities controlled by the person; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;10&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>acquires control of any entity that beneficially owns any voting shares of the body corporate in such number as to increase the percentage of voting rights attached to the aggregate of the voting shares of the body corporate beneficially owned by the person and by any entities controlled by the person.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;10&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;10&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Idem</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A person who has a substantial investment in a body corporate pursuant to paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) increases that substantial investment when the person or any entity controlled by the person</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;10&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>acquires beneficial ownership of additional shares of the body corporate in such number as to increase the percentage of the shareholders’ equity of the body corporate represented by the aggregate of the shares of the body corporate beneficially owned by the person and by any entities controlled by the person; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;10&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>acquires control of any entity that beneficially owns any shares of the body corporate in such number as to increase the percentage of the shareholders’ equity of the body corporate represented by the aggregate of the shares of the body corporate beneficially owned by the person and by any entities controlled by the person.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;10&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;10&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">New substantial investment</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>For greater certainty,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;10&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>where a person has a substantial investment in a body corporate pursuant to paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) and the person, or any entity controlled by the person,</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;10&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>purchases or otherwise acquires beneficial ownership of shares of the body corporate, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;10&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>acquires control of any entity that beneficially owns shares of the body corporate,</Text></Subparagraph><ContinuedParagraph><Text>in such number as to cause the shareholders’ equity of the body corporate represented by the aggregate of the shares of the body corporate beneficially owned by the person and by any entities controlled by the person to exceed 25 per cent of the shareholders’ equity of the body corporate, or</Text></ContinuedParagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;10&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>where a person has a substantial investment in a body corporate pursuant to paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) and the person or any entity controlled by the person</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;10&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>purchases or otherwise acquires beneficial ownership of voting shares of the body corporate, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;10&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>acquires control of any entity that beneficially owns voting shares of the body corporate,</Text></Subparagraph><ContinuedParagraph><Text>in such number as to cause the voting rights attached to the aggregate of the voting shares beneficially owned by the person and by any entities controlled by the person to exceed 10 per cent of the voting rights attached to all of the outstanding voting shares of the company,</Text></ContinuedParagraph></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>the acquisition is deemed to cause the person to increase a substantial investment in the body corporate.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;10&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;10&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Substantial investment in unincorporated entity</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>A person has a substantial investment in an unincorporated entity where the aggregate of any ownership interests, however designated, into which the entity is divided, beneficially owned by the person and by any entities controlled by the person exceeds 25 per cent of all of the ownership interests into which the entity is divided.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;10&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;10&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Increasing substantial investment in unincorporated entities</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>A person who has a substantial investment in an unincorporated entity increases that substantial investment when the person or any entity controlled by the person</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;10&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>acquires beneficial ownership of additional ownership interests in the unincorporated entity in such number as to increase the percentage of ownership interests in the unincorporated entity beneficially owned by the person and by any entities controlled by the person; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;10&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>acquires control of any entity that beneficially owns ownership interests in the unincorporated entity in such number as to increase the percentage of ownership interests beneficially owned by the person and by any entities controlled by the person.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;11&quot;"><Label>11.</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 2005, c. 54, s. 216]</Repealed></Text><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;11.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;11.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">WTO Member resident</MarginalNote><Label>11.1</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;11.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>For the purposes of this Act, a WTO Member resident is</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;11.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a natural person who is ordinarily resident in a country or territory that is a WTO Member as defined in subsection 2(1) of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="W-11.8">World Trade Organization Agreement Implementation Act</XRefExternal>, other than Canada;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;11.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a body corporate, association, partnership or other organization that is incorporated, formed or otherwise organized in a country or territory that is a WTO Member, as defined in subsection 2(1) of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="W-11.8">World Trade Organization Agreement Implementation Act</XRefExternal>, other than Canada, and that is controlled,</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;11.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>directly or indirectly, by one or more persons referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>), or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;11.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>by a government of a WTO Member, whether federal, state or local, or an agency of one of those governments;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;11.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a trust established by one or more persons referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) or a trust in which one or more of those persons have more than 50 per cent of the beneficial interest; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;11.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a body corporate, association, partnership or other organization that is controlled, directly or indirectly, by a trust referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>).</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;11.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;11.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Interpretation</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>For the purposes of subsection (1),</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;11.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a body corporate is controlled by one or more persons if</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;11.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>securities of the body corporate to which are attached more than 50 per cent of the votes that may be cast to elect directors of the body corporate are beneficially owned by the person or persons, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;11.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>the votes attached to those securities are sufficient to elect a majority of the directors of the body corporate;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;11.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an association, partnership or other organization is controlled by one or more persons if</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;11.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>more than 50 per cent of the ownership interests, however designated, into which the association, partnership or other organization is divided are beneficially owned by the person or persons, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;11.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>the person or persons are able to direct the business and affairs of the association, partnership or other organization;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;11.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a body corporate, association, partnership or other organization is controlled by one or more persons if the person or persons have, directly or indirectly, control in fact of the body corporate, association, partnership or other organization; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;11.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a body corporate, association, partnership or other organization that controls another body corporate, association, partnership or other organization is deemed to control any body corporate, association, partnership or other organization that is controlled or deemed to be controlled by the other body corporate, association, partnership or other organization.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1999, c. 28, s. 119.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;12&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;12&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Class of insurance</MarginalNote><Label>12.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;12&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A class of insurance is a class set out in the schedule.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;12&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;12&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Reference to particular class</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A reference in this Act to a particular class of insurance is a reference to the insurance of risks falling within that particular class determined in accordance with subsections (3) to (6) and the schedule.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;12&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;12&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Property</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A class of insurance that includes insurance against the loss of, or damage to, property includes insurance against loss of use, occupancy, rents and profits resulting from that loss or damage.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;12&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;12&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Personal injuries and death</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Unless specifically mentioned in the schedule, no class of insurance includes insurance against liability arising out of bodily injury to, or the death of, a natural person or the loss of, or damage to, property.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;12&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;12&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Idem</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>A class of insurance that includes insurance against liability arising out of bodily injury to, or the death of, a natural person or the loss of, or damage to, property includes insurance against loss, damage or expenses incident to a claim giving rise to that liability.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;12&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;12&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Endowments</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>The class of life insurance includes the issuance of endowment insurance the funds of which are to be paid at a fixed or determinable future time if the person whose life is insured is then alive or at the person’s death if the person dies before that time.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;12&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;12&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Amendment</MarginalNote><Label>(7)</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may, by order, amend subsections (3) to (5) and the schedule.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 12;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 188.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_I&quot;,gb=&quot;s_13&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_I&quot;,gb=&quot;s_13&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Application</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;13&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;13&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application of Act</MarginalNote><Label>13.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;13&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>This Act applies to every body corporate</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;13&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>that is incorporated or continued as a company under this Act, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;13&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>to which any of the provisions of Parts I, II, III and VII and either or both of Parts IV and VI of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act">Canadian and British Insurance Companies Act</XRefExternal> applied immediately before the coming into force of this section</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>and that is not discontinued under this Act.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;13&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;13&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application of certain provisions</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>This Part, Parts II to IV, sections 224, 225, 245 to 258 and 489 and Parts X, XII, XV, XVI and XVIII to XX apply to every body corporate that is not discontinued under this Act and</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;13&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>that is incorporated or continued as a society under this Act; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;13&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>to which any of the provisions of Parts I and II, Part III, except section 77, Part IV, except sections 123 to 130 and 153 to 158, and Parts V and VII of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act">Canadian and British Insurance Companies Act</XRefExternal> applied before June 1, 1992.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 13;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 167;</li><li> 1999, c. 31, s. 138;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 352;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 217.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;14&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;14&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Conflicting provisions</MarginalNote><Label>14.</Label><Text>Where there is a conflict or inconsistency between a provision of this Act and a provision of the incorporating instrument of a former-Act company or former-Act society, the provision of this Act prevails.</Text></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_II&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="1"><Label>PART II</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_II&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">STATUS AND POWERS</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;15&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;15&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Corporate powers</MarginalNote><Label>15.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;15&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company or society has the capacity of a natural person and, subject to this Act, the rights, powers and privileges of a natural person.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;15&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;15&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Powers restricted</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Neither a company nor a society shall carry on any business or exercise any power that it is restricted by this Act from carrying on or exercising, or exercise any of its powers in a manner contrary to this Act.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;15&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;15&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Business in Canada</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A company or society may carry on business throughout Canada.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;15&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;15&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Powers outside Canada</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Subject to this Act, a company or society has the capacity to carry on its business, conduct its affairs and exercise its powers in any jurisdiction outside Canada to the extent and in the manner that the laws of that jurisdiction permit.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;16&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;16&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">No invalidity</MarginalNote><Label>16.</Label><Text>No act of a company or society, including any transfer of property to or by a company or society, is invalid by reason only that the act or transfer is contrary to the company’s or society’s incorporating instrument or this Act.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;17&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;17&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">By-law not necessary</MarginalNote><Label>17.</Label><Text>It is not necessary for a company to pass a by-law in order to confer any particular power on the company or its directors.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;18&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;18&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">No personal liability</MarginalNote><Label>18.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;18&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The shareholders and participating policyholders of a company are not, as shareholders or policyholders, liable for any liability, act or default of the company except as otherwise provided by this Act.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;18&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;18&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Idem</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The members of a society are not, as members, liable for any liability, act or default of the society except as otherwise provided by this Act.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;19&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;19&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">No constructive notice</MarginalNote><Label>19.</Label><Text>No person is affected by or is deemed to have notice or knowledge of the contents of a document concerning a company or society by reason only that the document has been filed with the Superintendent or the Minister or is available for inspection at an office of the company or society.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;20&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;20&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Authority of directors and officers</MarginalNote><Label>20.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;20&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>No company or society and no guarantor of an obligation of a company or society may assert against a person dealing with the company or society or against a person who has acquired rights from the company or society that</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;20&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the company’s or society’s incorporating instrument or any by-laws of the company or society have not been complied with;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;20&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the persons named as directors of the company or society in the most recent return sent to the Superintendent under section 549 or 668 are not the directors of the company or society;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;20&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the place named in the incorporating instrument or by-laws of the company or society is not the place where the head office of the company or society is situated;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;20&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a person held out by the company or society as a director, officer or representative of the company or society has not been duly appointed or has no authority to exercise the powers and perform the duties that are customary in the business of the company or society or usual for a director, officer or representative; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;20&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a document issued by any director, officer or representative of the company or society with actual or usual authority to issue the document is not valid or not genuine.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;20&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;20&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception — knowledge</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Subsection (1) does not apply in respect of a person who has or ought to have knowledge of a situation described in that subsection by virtue of their relationship to the company or society.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 20;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 218.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;21&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;21&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Sunset provision</MarginalNote><Label>21.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;21&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to subsections (2) and (4), companies and societies shall not carry on business, and foreign companies shall not carry on business in Canada, after the day that is the fifth anniversary of the day on which this section comes into force.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;21&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;21&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Extension</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may, by order, extend by up to six months the time during which companies and societies may continue to carry on business and foreign companies may continue to carry on business in Canada. No more than one order may be made under this subsection.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;21&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;21&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Order not a regulation</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The order is not a regulation for the purposes of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="S-22">Statutory Instruments Act</XRefExternal>. However, it shall be published in Part II of the <XRefExternal reference-type="other" link="gazette">Canada Gazette</XRefExternal>.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;21&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;21&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>If Parliament dissolves on the fifth anniversary of the day on which this section comes into force, on any day within the six-month period before that anniversary or on any day within an extension under subsection (2), companies and societies may continue to carry on business, and foreign companies may continue to carry on business in Canada, until the end of 180 days after the first day of the first session of the next Parliament.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 21;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 168;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 353;</li><li> 2006, c. 4, s. 201;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 189;</li><li> 2012, c. 5, s. 123.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20070420">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_III&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="1"><Label>PART III</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_III&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">INCORPORATION, CONTINUANCE AND DISCONTINUANCE</TitleText></Heading><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_III&quot;,gb=&quot;s_22&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_III&quot;,gb=&quot;s_22&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Formalities of Incorporation</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;22&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;22&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Incorporation of company or society</MarginalNote><Label>22.</Label><Text>On the application of one or more persons made in accordance with this Act, the Minister may, subject to this Part, issue letters patent incorporating a company or society.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;23&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;23&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restrictions on incorporation</MarginalNote><Label>23.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;23&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Letters patent incorporating a company or society may not be issued if the application therefor is made by or on behalf of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;23&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>Her Majesty in right of Canada or in right of a province, an agency of Her Majesty in either of those rights, or an entity controlled by Her Majesty in either of those rights;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;23&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the government of a foreign country or any political subdivision thereof;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;23&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an agency of the government of a foreign country or any political subdivision thereof; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;23&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an entity, other than a foreign institution or any subsidiary of a foreign institution, that is controlled by the government of a foreign country or any political subdivision thereof.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;23&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;23&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Societies</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Letters patent incorporating a society may not be issued if the society is to operate for profit or as a commercial enterprise or its property is not to be under the control of persons periodically elected by members of the society.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 23;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 169.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;24&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;24&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">National treatment</MarginalNote><Label>24.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;24&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If a proposed company would be a subsidiary of a foreign institution that is engaged in the insurance business, letters patent to incorporate the company may not be issued unless the Minister is satisfied that, if the application is made by a non-WTO Member foreign institution, treatment as favourable for companies to which this Act applies exists or will be provided in the jurisdiction in which the foreign institution principally carries on business, either directly or through a subsidiary.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;24&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;24&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Part XII of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="B-1.01">Bank Act</XRefExternal></MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Nothing in subsection (1) affects the operation of Part XII of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="B-1.01">Bank Act</XRefExternal>.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 24;</li><li> 1999, c. 28, s. 120;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 354.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;25&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;25&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application for incorporation</MarginalNote><Label>25.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;25&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>An application for letters patent to incorporate a company or society setting out the names of the first directors of the company or society shall be filed with the Superintendent, together with such other information, material and evidence as the Superintendent may require.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;25&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;25&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Publishing notice of intent</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Before filing an application referred to in subsection (1), the applicant or one of the applicants, as the case may be, shall, at least once a week for a period of four consecutive weeks, publish, in a form satisfactory to the Superintendent, a notice of intention to make the application in the <XRefExternal reference-type="other" link="gazette">Canada Gazette</XRefExternal> and in a newspaper in general circulation at or near the place where the head office of the company or society is to be situated.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;26&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;26&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Objections to incorporation</MarginalNote><Label>26.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;26&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Any person who objects to the proposed incorporation of a company or society may, within thirty days after the date of the last publication under subsection 25(2) in respect of the proposed company or society, submit the objection in writing to the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;26&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;26&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Minister to be informed</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>On receipt of an objection under subsection (1), the Superintendent shall inform the Minister of the objection.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;26&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;26&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Inquiry into objection and report</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>On receipt of an objection under subsection (1), and if the application for the issuance of the letters patent to which the objection relates has been received, the Superintendent shall, if satisfied that it is necessary and in the public interest to do so, hold or cause to be held a public inquiry into the objection as it relates to the application and, on completion of the inquiry, the Superintendent shall report the findings of the inquiry to the Minister.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;26&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;26&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Report to be made available</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Within thirty days after receiving a report under subsection (3), the Minister shall make the report available to the public.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;26&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;26&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Rules governing proceedings</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>Subject to the approval of the Governor in Council, the Superintendent may make rules governing the proceedings at public inquiries held under this section.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;27&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;27&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Matters for consideration</MarginalNote><Label>27.</Label><Text>Before issuing letters patent to incorporate a company or society, the Minister shall take into account all matters that the Minister considers relevant to the application, including</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;27&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the nature and sufficiency of the financial resources of the applicant or applicants as a source of continuing financial support for the company or society;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;27&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the soundness and feasibility of the plans of the applicant or applicants for the future conduct and development of the business of the company or society;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;27&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the business record and experience of the applicant or applicants;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;27&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the character and integrity of the applicant or applicants or, if the applicant or any of the applicants is a body corporate, its reputation for being operated in a manner that is consistent with the standards of good character and integrity;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;27&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>whether the company or society will be operated responsibly by persons with the competence and experience suitable for involvement in the operation of a financial institution;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;27&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the impact of any integration of the operations and businesses of the applicant or applicants with those of the company or society on the conduct of those operations and businesses; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;27&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the best interests of the financial system in Canada.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 27;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 355.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;28&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;28&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Contents of letters patent</MarginalNote><Label>28.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;28&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>There shall be set out in the letters patent incorporating a company or society</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;28&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the name of the company or society;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;28&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the province in which the head office of the company or society is to be situated;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;28&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the date that the company or society came, or is to come, into existence; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;28&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of letters patent incorporating a company, whether the company is to be a mutual company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;28&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;28&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Fraternal benefit societies</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>In addition to the information required to be included under subsection (1), there shall be set out in the letters patent of a society</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;28&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the criteria for membership in the society;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;28&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the manner in which the capital of the society is to be acquired; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;28&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the disposition to be made of the property of the society on liquidation.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;28&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;28&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Provisions in letters patent</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The Minister may set out in the letters patent incorporating a company or society any provision not contrary to this Act that the Minister considers advisable in order to take into account the particular circumstances of the proposed company or society.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;28&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;28&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Terms and conditions</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>The Minister may impose such terms and conditions in respect of the issuance of letters patent incorporating a company or society as the Minister considers necessary or appropriate.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 28;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 219.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;28.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;28.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Letters patent of incorporation on application of converted companies</MarginalNote><Label>28.1</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;28.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If the Minister, under section 22, issues letters patent incorporating a company on the application of a converted company in respect of which subsection 407(4) or (11) applies or applied at any time, the Minister may include in the letters patent of incorporation of the company a provision deeming shares of the company to be issued, on a share for share basis, to all shareholders of the converted company in exchange for all the issued and outstanding shares of the converted company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;28.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;28.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effect of provision</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Shares of a company deemed to be issued under subsection (1) are subject to the same designation, rights, privileges and restrictions or conditions and, subject to any agreement to the contrary, to the same charges, encumbrances and other restrictions as the shares of the converted company for which they are exchanged and the shares of the converted company, on the issuance of the letters patent, become the property of the company free and clear of any charge, encumbrance or other restriction.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;28.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;28.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effect of provision</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>An exchange of shares of a converted company referred to in subsection (1) under a provision included in the letters patent incorporating a company does not deprive a person who was a holder of shares of the converted company immediately before the exchange of any right or privilege with respect to the shares or relieve the person of any liability in respect of the shares, but that right or privilege must be exercised in accordance with this Act.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;28.1&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;28.1&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Transfer and voting of company shares</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Despite subsection (3), no share of a company that is deemed to be issued under a provision included in the letters patent incorporating a company may subsequently be transferred or voted contrary to this Act.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;28.1&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;28.1&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shareholder and policyholder approval</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>No provision described in subsection (1) may be included in letters patent issued under section 22 unless the application for the letters patent is accompanied by evidence that the request for the provision was approved by a special resolution of the shareholders and policyholders of the converted company who are entitled to vote at a meeting of shareholders and policyholders called to consider the application.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;28.1&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;28.1&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exchange of share certificates</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>If, under a provision included in the letters patent incorporating a company, a share exchange is deemed to have taken place, the company shall, within ninety days after the issuance of the letters patent, make provision for the issue of share certificates representing shares of the company and for the exchange of those certificates for share certificates representing the shares of the converted company that were outstanding on the day the letters patent were issued.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 356.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;28.2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;28.2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Proposal involving fundamental change</MarginalNote><Label>28.2</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;28.2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>On application, made in accordance with the regulations, by a converted company in respect of which subsection 407(4) or (11) applies or applied at any time to give effect to a proposal to incorporate a company as the holding body corporate of the converted company, to continue a body corporate as a company that is the holding body corporate of the converted company or to amalgamate two or more bodies corporate and continue those bodies corporate as a company that is the holding body corporate of the converted company — and to make any other fundamental change to the converted company, including an exchange of any or all of the shares of the converted company for shares of the company —, the Minister may, to give effect to the proposal,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;28.2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>include in the letters patent of the company issued under section 22, 34 or 251 any provision the Minister considers necessary; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;28.2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>despite any provision of the Act specified in regulations made under paragraph (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>), give any approval that the Minister considers necessary.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;28.2&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;28.2&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;28.2&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting applications referred to in subsection (1), including their form and the information to be contained in them, and authorizing the Superintendent to require additional information in respect of such applications;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;28.2&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting proposals to which subsection (1) applies, including the information to be contained in the proposals and the times within which the transactions involved in them must occur;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;28.2&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the procedures to be followed by a converted company that makes an application under subsection (1);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;28.2&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the approval, confirmation or authorization, if any, of all or any portion of proposals to which subsection (1) applies, including the approval of shareholders and policyholders and including the terms and conditions of those approvals, confirmations or authorizations and their effect; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;28.2&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>specifying provisions of the Act for the purpose of paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>).</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 356.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;29&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;29&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of issue of letters patent</MarginalNote><Label>29.</Label><Text>The Superintendent shall cause to be published in the <XRefExternal reference-type="other" link="gazette">Canada Gazette</XRefExternal> a notice of the issuance of letters patent incorporating a company or society.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;30&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;30&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">First directors</MarginalNote><Label>30.</Label><Text>The first directors of a company or society are the directors named in the application for letters patent to incorporate the company or society.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;31&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;31&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effect of letters patent</MarginalNote><Label>31.</Label><Text>A company or society comes into existence on the date provided therefor in its letters patent.</Text></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_III&quot;,gb=&quot;s_32&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_III&quot;,gb=&quot;s_32&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Continuance</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;32&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;32&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Federal corporations</MarginalNote><Label>32.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;32&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A body corporate incorporated under the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="C-44">Canada Business Corporations Act</XRefExternal> or any other Act of Parliament, including an insurance holding company, may apply to the Minister for letters patent continuing the body corporate as a company under this Act.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;32&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;32&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Other corporations</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A body corporate incorporated otherwise than by or under an Act of Parliament may, if so authorized by the laws of the jurisdiction where it is incorporated, apply to the Minister for letters patent continuing the body corporate as a company under this Act.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;32&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;32&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Fraternal benefit societies</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A fraternal benefit society incorporated otherwise than by or under an Act of Parliament may, if so authorized by the laws of the jurisdiction where it is incorporated, apply to the Minister for letters patent continuing the fraternal benefit society as a society.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 32;</li><li> 1994, c. 24, s. 34(F);</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 170;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 357.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;33&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;33&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application for continuance</MarginalNote><Label>33.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;33&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where a body corporate applies for letters patent under subsection 32(1), (2) or (3), sections 23 to 27 apply in respect of the application, with such modifications as the circumstances require.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;33&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;33&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Special resolution approval</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where a body corporate applies for letters patent under subsection 32(1), (2) or (3), the application must be duly authorized by a special resolution.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;33&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;33&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Copy of special resolution</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A copy of the special resolution referred to in subsection (2) shall be filed with the application.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 33;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 171.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;34&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;34&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Power to issue letters patent</MarginalNote><Label>34.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;34&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>On the application of a body corporate under subsection 32(1) or (2), the Minister may, subject to this Part, issue letters patent continuing the body corporate as a company under this Act.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;34&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;34&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Power to issue letters patent to fraternal benefit society</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>On the application of a fraternal benefit society under subsection 32(3), the Minister may, subject to this Part, issue letters patent continuing the fraternal benefit society as a society.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;34&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;34&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Issue of letters patent</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Section 28 applies in respect of the issue of letters patent under subsection (1) or (2), with such modifications as the circumstances require.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 34;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 172.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;35&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;35&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effect of letters patent</MarginalNote><Label>35.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;35&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>On the day set out in the letters patent continuing a body corporate as a company under subsection 34(1),</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;35&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the body corporate becomes a company as if it had been incorporated under this Act; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;35&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the letters patent are deemed to be the incorporating instrument of the continued company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;35&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;35&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effect of letters patent — society</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>On the day set out in the letters patent continuing a fraternal benefit society as a society under subsection 34(2),</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;35&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the fraternal benefit society becomes a society as if it had been incorporated under this Act; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;35&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the letters patent are deemed to be the incorporating instrument of the continued society.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 35;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 173.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;36&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;36&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Copy of letters patent</MarginalNote><Label>36.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;36&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where a body corporate is continued as a company or society under this Part, the Superintendent shall without delay send a copy of the letters patent to the appropriate official or public body in the jurisdiction in which the body corporate was authorized to apply to be continued under this Act.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;36&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;36&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of issuance of letters patent</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The Superintendent shall publish in the <XRefExternal reference-type="other" link="gazette">Canada Gazette</XRefExternal> a notice of the issuance of letters patent continuing a body corporate as a company or society under this Act.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 36;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 174(E).</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;37&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;37&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effects of continuance</MarginalNote><Label>37.</Label><Text>Where a body corporate is continued as a company or society under this Part,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;37&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the property of the body corporate continues to be the property of the company or society;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;37&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the company or society continues to be liable for the obligations of the body corporate;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;37&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an existing cause of action or claim by or against the body corporate or any liability of the body corporate to prosecution is unaffected;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;37&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a civil, criminal or administrative action or proceeding pending by or against the body corporate may continue to be prosecuted by or against the company or society;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;37&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a conviction against, or any ruling, order or judgment in favour of or against the body corporate may be enforced by or against the company or society;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;37&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a person who, on the day the body corporate becomes a company or society, is the holder of a security issued by the body corporate is not deprived of any right or privilege available to the person at that time in respect of the security or relieved of any liability in respect of it, but any such right or privilege may be exercised only in accordance with this Act; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;37&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the by-laws of the body corporate, except those that are in conflict with this Act, continue as the by-laws of the company or society.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 37;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 175.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;38&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;38&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Transitional</MarginalNote><Label>38.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;38&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Notwithstanding any other provision of this Act or the regulations, the Minister may, on the recommendation of the Superintendent, by order, grant to a company or society in respect of which letters patent were issued under subsection 34(1) or (2) permission to</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;38&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>engage in a business activity specified in the order that the company or society would not otherwise be permitted by this Act to engage in and that the body corporate continued as the company or society was engaging in at the time the application for the letters patent was made;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;38&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>continue to have issued and outstanding debt obligations the issue of which is not authorized by this Act if the debt obligations were outstanding at the time the application for the letters patent was made;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;38&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 1994, c. 47, s. 119]</Repealed></Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;38&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>hold assets that the company or society would not otherwise be permitted by this Act to hold, if the assets were held by the body corporate continued as the company or society at the time the application for the letters patent was made;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;38&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>acquire and hold assets that the company or society would not otherwise be permitted by this Act to acquire or hold, if the body corporate continued as the company or society was obliged, at the time the application for the letters patent was made, to acquire those assets; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;38&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>maintain outside Canada any records or registers required by this Act to be maintained in Canada.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;38&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;38&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Duration</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The permission granted under subsection (1) shall be expressed to be granted for a period specified in the order not exceeding</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;38&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>with respect to any activity described in paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>), thirty days after the date of issue of the letters patent or, where the activity is conducted pursuant to an agreement existing on the date of issue of the letters patent, the expiration of the agreement;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;38&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>with respect to any matter described in paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>), ten years; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;38&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>with respect to any matter described in any of paragraphs (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>), two years.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;38&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;38&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Renewal</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection (4), the Minister may, on the recommendation of the Superintendent, by order, renew a permission granted by order under subsection (1) with respect to any matter described in paragraphs (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>) for such further period or periods as the Minister considers necessary.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;38&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;38&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limitation</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>The Minister shall not grant to a company or society any permission</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;38&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>with respect to matters described in paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>), that purports to be effective more than ten years after the date of the approval for the company or society to commence and carry on business, unless the Minister is satisfied on the basis of evidence on oath provided by an officer of the company or society that the company or society will not be able at law to redeem at the end of the ten years the outstanding debt obligations to which the permission relates; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;38&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>with respect to matters described in paragraphs (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>) and (<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>), that purports to be effective more than ten years after the date of the approval for the company or society to commence and carry on business.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 38;</li><li> 1994, c. 47, s. 119;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 176;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 190.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_III&quot;,gb=&quot;s_39&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_III&quot;,gb=&quot;s_39&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Discontinuance</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;39&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;39&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Transferring to other federal Acts</MarginalNote><Label>39.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;39&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company or society may</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;39&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>apply, under the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="B-1.01">Bank Act</XRefExternal>, for letters patent continuing the company or society as a bank or a bank holding company under that Act, or amalgamating and continuing the company or society as a bank or a bank holding company under that Act;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;39&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>apply, with the approval in writing of the Minister, under the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="C-44">Canada Business Corporations Act</XRefExternal> for a certificate of continuance as a corporation under that Act;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;39&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>apply, with the approval in writing of the Minister, under the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="C-1.7">Canada Cooperatives Act</XRefExternal> for a certificate of continuance, or a certificate of continuance and a certificate of amalgamation, as a cooperative under that Act;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;39&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>apply, under the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="C-41.01">Cooperative Credit Associations Act</XRefExternal>, for letters patent continuing the company or society as an association under that Act, or amalgamating and continuing the company or society as an association under that Act; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;39&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>apply, under the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="T-19.8">Trust and Loan Companies Act</XRefExternal>, for letters patent continuing the company or society as a company under that Act, or amalgamating and continuing the company or society as a company under of that Act.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;39&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;39&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Continuance under the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="C-7.75">Canada Not-for-profit Corporations Act</XRefExternal></MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A society may also, with the approval in writing of the Minister, apply under the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="C-7.75">Canada Not-for-profit Corporations Act</XRefExternal>, for a certificate of continuance under that Act.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;39&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;39&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Conditions for approval</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The approval referred to in paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>) or subsection (2) may be given only if the Minister is satisfied that</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;39&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the company or society has published, once a week for four consecutive weeks in the <XRefExternal reference-type="other" link="gazette">Canada Gazette</XRefExternal> and in a newspaper in general circulation at or near the place where the head office of the company or society is situated, a notice of its intention to apply for the approval;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;39&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the company or society has discharged, or provided for the discharge of, all its policy liabilities;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;39&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the company or society will not, unless it is an entity referred to in paragraph 47(2)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>), use the word “<Language xml:lang="fr">assurance</Language>”, “<Language xml:lang="fr">assurances</Language>” or “insurance” in its name after the certificate or letters patent are issued in respect of the company or society; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;39&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the application has been authorized by a special resolution.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;39&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;39&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Withdrawing application</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>If a special resolution authorizing the application for the certificate or letters patent so states, the directors of a company or society may, without further approval of the shareholders, policyholders entitled to vote or members, withdraw the application before it is acted on.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;39&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;39&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction on other transfers</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>A company or society may not apply to be continued, or to be amalgamated and continued, as the case may be, as a body corporate other than one referred to in subsection (1) or (2).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, ss. 39, 759;</li><li> 1994, c. 24, s. 34(F);</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 358;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 191;</li><li> 2009, c. 23, s. 331.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20070420">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;40&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;40&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Act ceases to apply</MarginalNote><Label>40.</Label><Text>If a company or society applies for a certificate or letters patent referred to in section 39 in accordance with that section and the certificate is given or the letters patent are issued, this Act ceases to apply to the company or society as of the day the certificate or the letters patent take effect.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 40;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 358;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 191.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;41&quot;"><Label>41.</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 2001, c. 9, s. 358]</Repealed></Text></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_III&quot;,gb=&quot;s_42&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_III&quot;,gb=&quot;s_42&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Corporate Name</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;42&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;42&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Prohibited names</MarginalNote><Label>42.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;42&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company or society may not be incorporated under this Act with a name</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;42&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>that is prohibited by an Act of Parliament;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;42&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>that is, in the opinion of the Superintendent, deceptively misdescriptive;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;42&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>that is the same as or, in the opinion of the Superintendent, substantially the same as or confusingly similar to, any existing</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;42&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>trade-mark or trade name, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;42&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>corporate name of a body corporate,</Text></Subparagraph><ContinuedParagraph><Text>except where the trade-mark or trade name is being changed or the body corporate is being dissolved or is changing its corporate name and consent to the use of the trade-mark, trade name or corporate name is signified to the Superintendent in such manner as the Superintendent may require;</Text></ContinuedParagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;42&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>that is the same as or, in the opinion of the Superintendent, substantially the same as or confusingly similar to, the known name under or by which any entity carries on business or is identified; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;42&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>that is reserved under section 45 for another company or society or a proposed company or society or under section 734 for an insurance holding company or a proposed insurance holding company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;42&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;42&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) does not apply with respect to any former-Act company or former-Act society incorporated by or under an Act of Parliament that expressly authorizes the use of any name that would otherwise be prohibited.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 42;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 67;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 177;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 359.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;43&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;43&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Affiliated company or society</MarginalNote><Label>43.</Label><Text>Despite section 42, a company or society that is affiliated with another entity may, with the consent of that entity, be incorporated with, or change its name to, substantially the same name as that of the affiliated entity.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 43;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 68;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 360;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 192.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;44&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;44&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">French or English form of name</MarginalNote><Label>44.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;44&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The name of a company or society may be set out in its letters patent in an English form, a French form, an English form and a French form or in a combined English and French form, and the company or society may use and be legally designated by any such form.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;44&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;44&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Alternate name</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A company or society may identify itself outside Canada by its name in any language and the company or society may use and be legally designated by any such form of its name outside Canada.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;44&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;44&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Other name</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection (4) and section 278, a company or society may carry on business under or identify itself by a name other than its corporate name.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;44&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;44&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Directions</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Where a company or society is carrying on business under or identifying itself by a name other than its corporate name, the Superintendent may, by order, direct the company or society not to use that other name if the Superintendent is of the opinion that that other name is a name referred to in any of paragraphs 42(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 44;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 69.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;45&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;45&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Reserved name</MarginalNote><Label>45.</Label><Text>The Superintendent may, on request, reserve for ninety days a name for a proposed company or society or for a company or society that intends to change its name.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;46&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;46&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Directing change of name</MarginalNote><Label>46.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;46&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If through inadvertence or otherwise a company or society</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;46&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>comes into existence or is continued with a name, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;46&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>on an application to change its name, is granted a name</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>that is prohibited by section 42, the Superintendent may, by order, direct the company or society to change its name and the company or society shall comply with that direction.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;46&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;46&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Revoking name</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If a company or society has been directed under subsection (1) to change its name and has not, within sixty days after the service of the direction, changed its name to a name that is not prohibited by this Act, the Superintendent may revoke the name of the company or society and assign to it a name and, until changed in accordance with section 224, 238 or 544.1, the name of the company or society is thereafter the name so assigned.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 46;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 70;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 361.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;47&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;47&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction on use of name</MarginalNote><Label>47.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;47&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>No entity incorporated or formed by or under an Act of Parliament shall use the word “assurance”, “assurances”, “insurance” or “lifeco” or any word or words of import equivalent to any of those words in its name.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;47&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;47&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exceptions</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Subsection (1) does not apply to</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;47&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a company or society;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;47&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a.1&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a.1</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an insurance holding company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;47&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an entity the business of which is not financial activities;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;47&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an entity that is primarily engaged in insurance brokerage or insurance agency services; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;47&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an entity that was, on the day immediately preceding the day on which that subsection comes into force, using the word “assurance”, “assurances”, “insurance” or “lifeco” or any word or words of import equivalent to any of those words in its name.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 47;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 70;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 362.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;48&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;48&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Subsidiaries</MarginalNote><Label>48.</Label><Text>Despite subsection 47(1), a subsidiary of a company or society may use the company’s or society’s name in its name.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 48;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 70;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 363.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;48.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;48.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Definition of <DefinedTermEn>reserved name</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><Label>48.1</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;48.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>In this section, <DefinedTermEn>reserved name</DefinedTermEn> means a name that includes as part thereof the word “assurance”, “assurances”, “insurance”, “lifeco”, “fiduciaire”, “fiduciary”, “fiducie”, “trust”, “trustco”, “loan”, “loanco” or “prêt” or any word or words of import equivalent to any of those words.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;48.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;48.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Termination of control required in certain cases</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>No person, other than a financial institution, who</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;48.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>is carrying on business in Canada under a reserved name, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;48.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>has control or acquires control of a company,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>shall control the company on the later of</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;48.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>one year after this section comes into force, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;48.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>one year after the date of acquisition of the control.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;48.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;48.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Prohibition</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>No person, other than a financial institution, who</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;48.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>controls an entity that is not a financial institution that carries on business in Canada under a reserved name, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;48.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>has control or acquires control of a company,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>shall control the company on the later of</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;48.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>one year after this section comes into force, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;48.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>one year after the date of the acquisition of the control.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;48.1&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;48.1&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Continuing control prohibited</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Notwithstanding subsection (3), where a financial institution controls an entity that</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;48.1&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>is not a financial institution,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;48.1&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>carries on business in Canada under a reserved name, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;48.1&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>has control or acquires control of a company,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>the entity shall not control the company on the later of</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;48.1&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>one year after this section comes into force, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;48.1&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>one year after the date on which the entity acquires control of the company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;48.1&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;48.1&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exceptions</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>Subsections (2) to (4) do not apply with respect to a person or entity that was carrying on business in Canada under a reserved name on the day immediately preceding the day on which those subsections come into force.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1996, c. 6, s. 70.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_IV&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="1"><Label>PART IV</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_IV&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">ORGANIZATION AND COMMENCEMENT</TitleText></Heading><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_IV&quot;,gb=&quot;s_49&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_IV&quot;,gb=&quot;s_49&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Organization Meetings</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;49&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;49&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">First directors’ meeting</MarginalNote><Label>49.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;49&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>After letters patent incorporating a company or society are issued, a meeting of the directors of the company or society shall be held at which the directors shall appoint an actuary to be the actuary of the company or society and may, subject to this Part,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;49&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>make by-laws;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;49&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>adopt forms of share certificates and corporate records;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;49&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>authorize the issue of shares of the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;49&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>appoint officers;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;49&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>appoint an auditor to hold office until the meeting called pursuant to subsection 50(1), (2) or (3);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;49&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>make banking arrangements; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;49&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>deal with any other matters necessary to organize the company or society.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;49&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;49&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Calling directors’ meeting</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>An incorporator or a director named in the application for letters patent may call the meeting referred to in subsection (1) by giving, subject to subsection 190(2), no fewer than five days notice of the purpose, time and place of the meeting to each director of the company or society.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;50&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;50&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Calling shareholders’ meeting</MarginalNote><Label>50.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;50&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If at least five million dollars, or any greater amount that the Minister may specify, has been received by a company, other than a mutual company, in respect of which letters patent were issued under section 22 from the issue of its shares, the directors of the company shall without delay call a meeting of the shareholders of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;50&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;50&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Calling incorporators’ meeting</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where such amount as the Minister may specify has been received by a mutual company in respect of which letters patent were issued pursuant to section 22 from its incorporators, the directors of the mutual company shall forthwith call a meeting of the incorporators of the mutual company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;50&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;50&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Calling meeting of supreme governing body</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Where such amount as the Minister may specify has been received by a society in respect of which letters patent were issued pursuant to section 22 from its incorporators, the directors of the society shall forthwith call a meeting of the supreme governing body of the society.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;50&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;50&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Meeting of shareholders or incorporators</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>The shareholders or incorporators of a company or the supreme governing body of a society shall, by resolution at the meeting of shareholders or incorporators called pursuant to subsection (1), (2) or (3),</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;50&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>approve, amend or reject any by-law made by the directors of the company or society;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;50&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>subject to section 176, elect directors to hold office for a term expiring not later than the close of the third annual meeting of shareholders and policyholders or members following the election; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;50&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>appoint an auditor to hold office until the close of the first annual meeting of shareholders and policyholders or, in the case of a society, until the close of the first general meeting of members.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 50;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 364.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;51&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;51&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Term of first directors</MarginalNote><Label>51.</Label><Text>A director named in the application for letters patent to incorporate a company or society holds office until the election of directors at the meeting of shareholders or incorporators or of the supreme governing body called pursuant to subsection 50(1), (2) or (3).</Text></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_IV&quot;,gb=&quot;s_52&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_IV&quot;,gb=&quot;s_52&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Commencement and Carrying on of Business</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;52&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;52&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Order to commence and carry on business</MarginalNote><Label>52.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;52&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection (6), a company or society shall not carry on any business until the Superintendent has, by order, approved the commencement and carrying on of business by the company or society.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;52&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;52&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Former-Act companies and societies</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A certificate of registry issued to a company or society under Part III of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act">Canadian and British Insurance Companies Act</XRefExternal>, or any other authorization, that is in effect immediately before the coming into force of this Part is deemed to be an order of the Superintendent of indeterminate duration under subsection 53(1) and the company or society remains subject to any and all other restrictions and conditions in the certificate.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;52&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;52&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Continued company or society</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Except in respect of a body corporate that is continued as a company or society under this Act for the purposes of amalgamating without delay with one or more bodies corporate and continuing as a company or society under this Act, where letters patent continuing a body corporate as a company or society under this Act are issued, the Superintendent shall make an order approving the commencement and carrying on of business by the company or society.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;52&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;52&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Amalgamated company or society</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Where letters patent amalgamating and continuing two or more bodies corporate as a company or society under this Act are issued, the Superintendent shall make an order approving the commencement and carrying on of business by the company or society.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;52&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;52&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Subsection 53(2) and section 57 do not apply</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>For greater certainty, subsection 53(2) and section 57 do not apply in respect of a company or society referred to in subsections (3) and (4).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;52&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;52&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Marine insurance</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>A company that is not a marine company may insure risks in the class of marine insurance without an order under subsection (1).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;52&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;52&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Transitional</MarginalNote><Label>(7)</Label><Text>Every former-Act company and former-Act society that deposited securities with the Receiver General pursuant to section 76 or 82 of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act">Canadian and British Insurance Companies Act</XRefExternal> shall apply for the return of those securities within such period following the coming into force of this section as may be fixed by order of the Governor in Council.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 52;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 178;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 193.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;53&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;53&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Authority to make order</MarginalNote><Label>53.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;53&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>On application by a company or society, the Superintendent may make an order approving the commencement and carrying on of business by the company or society.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;53&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;53&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Statement of payments</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>An application by a company or society for an order under subsection (1) must contain a statement setting out the amounts paid or to be paid by the company or society in connection with its incorporation and organization.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;54&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;54&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">No payments before order</MarginalNote><Label>54.</Label><Text>Until an order approving the commencement and carrying on of business is made in respect of a company or society, the company or society shall not make any payment on account of incorporation or organization expenses out of moneys received from the paid-in capital of the company or society and interest on those moneys, except reasonable sums</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;54&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>for the remuneration of not more than two officers;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;54&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>for the payment of costs related to the issue of shares; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;54&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>for the payment of clerical assistance, legal services, accounting services, office accommodation at one location, office expenses, advertising, stationery, postage and travel expenses.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 54;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 194.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;55&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;55&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Expenses charged to paid-in capital</MarginalNote><Label>55.</Label><Text>All incorporation and organization expenses of a company or society shall be charged to the paid-in capital of the company or society and shall not in any way be charged directly or indirectly to policyholders.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;56&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;56&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Deposits and investments before order</MarginalNote><Label>56.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;56&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection (2), where a company or society comes into existence but no order approving the commencement and carrying on of business is made for the company or society, the company or society may only</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;56&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>deposit, in Canada, paid-in capital of the company or society in a deposit-taking Canadian financial institution; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;56&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>invest paid-in capital of the company or society in unencumbered securities of the Government of Canada or the government of any province.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;56&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;56&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Subsection (1) does not apply in respect of any company incorporated for the sole purpose of insuring risks in the class of marine insurance.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;57&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;57&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Conditions for order</MarginalNote><Label>57.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;57&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The Superintendent shall not make an order approving the commencement and carrying on of business by a company or society until</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;57&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>it has been shown to the satisfaction of the Superintendent that</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;57&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>the meeting of shareholders, incorporators or supreme governing body of the company or society referred to in subsection 50(1), (2) or (3) has been duly held,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;57&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>the company or society has paid-in capital of</Text><Clause Code="se=&quot;57&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;,c1=&quot;A&quot;"><Label>(A)</Label><Text>such amount as is specified by the Minister under subsection 50(2) or (3), in the case of a mutual company or a society, or</Text></Clause><Clause Code="se=&quot;57&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;,c1=&quot;B&quot;"><Label>(B)</Label><Text>at least five million dollars or any greater amount that is specified by the Minister under subsection 50(1), in the case of a company other than a mutual company,</Text></Clause></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;57&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>the expenses of incorporation and organization to be borne by the company or society are reasonable, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;57&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;iv&quot;"><Label>(iv)</Label><Text>all other relevant requirements of this Act have been complied with; and</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;57&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of a society, the society has filed with the Superintendent</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;57&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>a report of an actuary appointed by the society, in such form as the Superintendent may require, on the results of an actuarial valuation of each of the benefit funds maintained by the society, having regard to the prospective liabilities of and contributions to each fund,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;57&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>the opinion of the actuary that the assets of the society applicable to each fund, together with the contributions to be received thereafter from the members, are sufficient to provide for the payment at maturity of all of the obligations of the fund without deduction or abatement, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;57&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>a statement of its condition and affairs in such detail as the Superintendent may require, as at the date of the valuation referred to in subparagraph (i).</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;57&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;57&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restrictions re societies</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>No order approving the commencement and carrying on of business of a society shall be made if the society operates for profit or as a commercial or business enterprise or the property or funds of the society are under the control of persons not periodically elected by members of the society.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;57&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;57&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Time limit</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The Superintendent shall not make an order approving the commencement and carrying on of business by a company or society more than one year after the day on which the company or society comes into existence.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 57;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 179;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 365.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;58&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;58&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Order to specify classes of insurance</MarginalNote><Label>58.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;58&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>An order approving the commencement and carrying on of business by a company shall specify the classes of insurance risks that the company is permitted to insure pursuant to section 443.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;58&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;58&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Conditions of order</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>An order approving the commencement and carrying on of business by a company or society may contain such conditions or limitations that are consistent with this Act and relate to the business of the company or society as the Superintendent deems expedient and necessary.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;59&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;59&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Variations</MarginalNote><Label>59.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;59&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>In respect of the order approving the commencement and carrying on of business by a company or society, the Superintendent may at any time, by further order,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;59&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>specify additional classes of insurance risks that the company is permitted to insure pursuant to section 443,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;59&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>make the order subject to such conditions or limitations that are consistent with this Act and that relate to the business of the company or society as the Superintendent deems expedient and necessary, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;59&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>amend or revoke any authorization contained in the order or any condition or limitation to which the order is subject,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>but before making any such further order the Superintendent shall provide the company or society with an opportunity to make representations regarding that further order.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;59&quot;,ss=&quot;2)&quot;"><Label>(2) to (6)</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 1996, c. 6, s. 71]</Repealed></Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 59;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 71.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;59.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;59.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limit on assets</MarginalNote><Label>59.1</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;59.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The Minister may, by order, require a company that is a converted company in respect of which the Minister has issued an order under subsection 407(8) or a converted company in respect of which subsection 407(11) applied at any time not to have average total assets in any three month period ending on the last day of a month subsequent to the month specified in the order exceeding the company’s average total assets in the three month period ending on the last day of the month immediately before the month specified in the order if the Minister is of the opinion that it is in the best interests of the financial system in Canada to do so, after having considered the Superintendent’s opinion on</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;59.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the nature and extent of the financial services activities carried out by entities affiliated with the company; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;59.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the impact that the nature and degree of supervision and regulation of those financial services activities have on the supervision and regulation of the company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;59.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;59.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Revocation of order</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If the Minister is of the opinion that the circumstances giving rise to the order have ceased to exist or have changed substantially, the Minister may, by further order, revoke the order.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;59.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;59.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Average total assets</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>For the purposes of subsection (1), the average total assets of a company in a three month period shall be computed by adding the total assets of the company as calculated for the month end of each of the three months in the period and by dividing the sum by three.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 366.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;60&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;60&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Public notice</MarginalNote><Label>60.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;60&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>On the making of an order approving the commencement and carrying on of business by a company or society, the company or society shall publish a notice of the making of the order in a newspaper in general circulation at or near the place where the head office of the company or society is located.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;60&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;60&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice in <XRefExternal reference-type="other" link="gazette">Canada Gazette</XRefExternal></MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The Superintendent shall cause to be published in the <XRefExternal reference-type="other" link="gazette">Canada Gazette</XRefExternal> a notice of the making of an order approving the commencement and carrying on of business by a company or society.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;60&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;60&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Non-application to former-Act company or society</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>For greater certainty, this section does not apply to a company or society referred to in subsection 52(2).</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;61&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;61&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Cessation of existence</MarginalNote><Label>61.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;61&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection (2), except for the sole purpose of winding up the company’s or society’s affairs, a company or society ceases to exist one year after the day on which its incorporating instrument became effective if it does not obtain an order approving the commencement and carrying on of business within that year.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;61&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;61&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Marine insurance</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A company that was incorporated for the sole purpose of insuring risks in the class of marine insurance ceases to exist one year after the day on which its incorporating instrument became effective if, in the opinion of the Superintendent, the company is not, by that date, actively engaged in insuring those risks.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;62&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;62&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Allowed disbursements</MarginalNote><Label>62.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;62&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;62&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order approving the commencement and carrying on of business is not made for a company or society, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;62&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the Superintendent is of the opinion that a company referred to in subsection 61(2) is not actively engaged in insuring risks in the class of marine insurance,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>no part of the moneys of the company or society shall be used for the payment of incorporation and organization expenses, other than remuneration and costs referred to in section 54, unless the payment has been approved by a special resolution.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;62&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;62&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application to court to settle disbursements</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If the amount allowed by a special resolution for the payment of any incorporation and organization expenses referred to in subsection (1) is considered insufficient by the directors or if no special resolution for the payment of such expenses is passed, the directors may apply to any court having jurisdiction in the place where the head office of the company or society is situated to settle and determine the amounts to be paid out of any moneys of the company or society before distribution of the balance to the shareholders or, where there are no shareholders, to the incorporators.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;62&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;62&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of application to court</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The directors shall, at least twenty-one days prior to the date fixed for the hearing of the application referred to in subsection (2), send to the shareholders or incorporators, as the case may be, a notice of the application, which notice shall contain a statement of the amounts that are proposed to be settled and determined by the court.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;62&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;62&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Ratio payable</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>In order that the amounts paid and payable under this section may be equitably borne by the shareholders or incorporators, as the case may be, the directors shall, after the amounts of the payments have been approved by special resolution or settled and determined by a court, fix the proportionate part thereof chargeable to each shareholder or incorporator as the ratio of the amount paid in by the shareholder or incorporator to the aggregate of all the amounts paid in by the shareholders or incorporators.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;62&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;62&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Return of excess</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>After the amounts referred to in this section have been paid, the directors shall pay, with any interest earned thereon, to the shareholders or incorporators, the respective balances of the moneys paid in by them, less the amount chargeable to each shareholder or incorporator under subsection (4).</Text></Subsection></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_V&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="1"><Label>PART V</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_V&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">CAPITAL STRUCTURE</TitleText></Heading><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_V&quot;,gb=&quot;s_63&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_V&quot;,gb=&quot;s_63&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Share Capital</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;63&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;63&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Power to issue shares</MarginalNote><Label>63.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;63&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to this Act and the by-laws of the company, shares of a company may be issued at such times and to such persons and for such consideration as the directors of the company may determine.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;63&quot;,ss=&quot;2)&quot;"><Label>(2) and (3)</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 1997, c. 15, s. 180]</Repealed></Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;63&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;63&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shares</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Shares of a company shall be in registered form and shall be without nominal or par value.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;63&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;63&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shares of former-Act company</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>Shares with nominal or par value of a former-Act company are deemed to be shares without nominal or par value.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;63&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;63&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shares of continued company</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>Where a body corporate is continued as a company under this Act, shares with nominal or par value issued by the body corporate before it was so continued are deemed to be shares without nominal or par value.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;63&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;63&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Deemed share conditions</MarginalNote><Label>(7)</Label><Text>Where any right of a holder of a share with nominal or par value of a former-Act company or a body corporate continued as a company under this Act, other than a voting right, was stated or expressed in terms of the nominal or par value of the share immediately before the coming into force of this Part or the continuance under this Act, as the case may be, that right is thereafter deemed to be the same right stated or expressed without reference to the nominal or par value of the share.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 63;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 180.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;64&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;64&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Common shares</MarginalNote><Label>64.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;64&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company, other than a mutual company, shall have one class of shares, to be designated as “common shares”, which are non-redeemable and in which the rights of the holders thereof are equal in all respects, and those rights include</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;64&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the right to vote at all meetings of shareholders except where only holders of a specified class of shares, or policyholders, are entitled to vote;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;64&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the right to receive dividends declared on those shares; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;64&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the right to receive the remaining property of the company on dissolution that pertains to shareholders.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;64&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;64&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Designations of shares</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>No company shall designate more than one class of its shares as “common shares” or any variation of that term.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;64&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;64&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Former-Act company</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A former-Act company that is not in compliance with subsection (2) on the coming into force of this Part shall, within twelve months after the coming into force of this Part, redesignate its shares to comply with that subsection.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;64&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;64&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Continued company</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>A body corporate continued as a company under this Act that is not in compliance with subsection (2) on the date letters patent continuing it as a company are issued shall, within twelve months after that date, redesignate its shares to comply with that subsection.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;65&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;65&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Classes of shares</MarginalNote><Label>65.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;65&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The by-laws of a company may provide for one or more classes of shares and, if they so provide, shall set out</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;65&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the rights, privileges, restrictions and conditions attaching to the shares of each class; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;65&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the maximum number, if any, of shares of any class that the company is authorized to issue.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;65&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;65&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shareholder approval</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where a by-law referred to in subsection (1) is made, the directors of the company shall submit the by-law to the shareholders and policyholders at the next meeting of shareholders and policyholders.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;65&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;65&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effective date</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A by-law referred to in subsection (1) is not effective until it is confirmed or confirmed with amendments by special resolution of the shareholders and policyholders at the meeting referred to in subsection (2).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 65;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 181;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 367.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;66&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;66&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shares issued in series</MarginalNote><Label>66.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;66&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The by-laws of a company may, subject to any limitations set out in them, authorize the issue of any class of shares in one or more series and may</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;66&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>fix the maximum number of shares in each series and determine the designation, rights, privileges, restrictions and conditions attaching to them; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;66&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>authorize the directors to do anything referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>).</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;66&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;66&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Series participation</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If any cumulative dividend or amounts payable on return of capital in respect of a series of shares are not paid in full, the shares of all series of the same class participate rateably in respect of accumulated dividends and return of capital.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;66&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;66&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Voting rights</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Where voting rights are attached to any series of a class of shares, the shares of every other series of that class shall have the same voting rights.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;66&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;66&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction on series</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>No rights, privileges, restrictions or conditions attached to a series of shares authorized under this section confer on the series a priority in respect of dividends or return of capital over any other series of shares of the same class that are then outstanding.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;66&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;66&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Material to Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>If the directors exercise their authority under paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>), the directors shall, before the issue of shares of the series, send to the Superintendent particulars of the series of shares and a copy of the by-law that granted the authority to the directors.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 66;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 220;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 195(E).</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20060427">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;67&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;67&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">One share, one vote</MarginalNote><Label>67.</Label><Text>Where voting rights are attached to a share of a company, the voting rights may confer only one vote in respect of that share.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;68&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;68&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shares non-assessable</MarginalNote><Label>68.</Label><Text>Shares issued by a company after the coming into force of this section are non-assessable and the shareholders are not liable to the company or to its creditors in respect thereof.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;69&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;69&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Consideration for share</MarginalNote><Label>69.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;69&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>No share of any class of shares of a company shall be issued until it is fully paid for in money or, with the approval of the Superintendent, in property.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;69&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;69&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Transitional</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where any share of a company is not fully paid for on the day this Part comes into force, the provisions of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act">Canadian and British Insurance Companies Act</XRefExternal> that applied to the company immediately prior to that day and that relate to</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;69&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the liability of holders of shares of a company that are not fully paid for and the enforcement of that liability,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;69&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the forfeiture of the share, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;69&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the forfeiture of the right to vote the share</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>continue to apply in respect of that share.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;69&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;69&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Other currencies</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>When issuing shares, a company may provide that any aspect of the shares relating to money or involving the payment of or the liability to pay money be in a currency other than the currency of Canada.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;70&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;70&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Stated capital account</MarginalNote><Label>70.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;70&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company shall maintain a separate stated capital account for each class and series of shares it issues.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;70&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;70&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Addition to stated capital account</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A company shall record in the appropriate stated capital account the full amount of any consideration it receives for any shares it issues.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;70&quot;,ss=&quot;2.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;70&quot;,ss=&quot;2.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(2.1)</Label><Text>Despite subsection (2), a company may, subject to subsection (2.2), record in the stated capital account maintained for the shares of a class or series any part of the consideration it receives in an exchange if it issues shares</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;70&quot;,ss=&quot;2.1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in exchange for</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;70&quot;,ss=&quot;2.1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>property of a person who immediately before the exchange did not deal with the company at arm’s length within the meaning of that expression in the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="I-3.3">Income Tax Act</XRefExternal>,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;70&quot;,ss=&quot;2.1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>shares of or another interest in a body corporate that immediately before the exchange or because of it did not deal with the company at arm’s length within the meaning of that expression in the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="I-3.3">Income Tax Act</XRefExternal>, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;70&quot;,ss=&quot;2.1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>property of a person who immediately before the exchange dealt with the company at arm’s length within the meaning of that expression in the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="I-3.3">Income Tax Act</XRefExternal> if the person, the company and all of the holders of shares in the class or series of shares so issued consent to the exchange;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;70&quot;,ss=&quot;2.1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>under an agreement referred to in subsection 246(1); or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;70&quot;,ss=&quot;2.1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>to shareholders of an amalgamating body corporate who receive the shares in addition to or instead of securities of the amalgamated company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;70&quot;,ss=&quot;2.2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;70&quot;,ss=&quot;2.2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limit on addition to a stated capital account</MarginalNote><Label>(2.2)</Label><Text>On the issuance of a share, a company shall not add to the stated capital account in respect of the share an amount greater than the amount of the consideration it receives for the share.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;70&quot;,ss=&quot;2.3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;70&quot;,ss=&quot;2.3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Constraint on addition to a stated capital account</MarginalNote><Label>(2.3)</Label><Text>Where a company that has issued any outstanding shares of more than one class or series proposes to add to a stated capital account that it maintains in respect of a class or series of shares an amount that was not received by the company as consideration for the issue of shares, the addition must be approved by special resolution unless all the issued and outstanding shares are of not more than two classes of convertible shares referred to in subsection 81(4).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;70&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;70&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Stated capital of former-Act company</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>On the coming into force of this Part, a former-Act company shall record in the stated capital account maintained for each class and series of shares then outstanding an amount that is equal to the aggregate of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;70&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the aggregate amount paid up on the shares of each class and series of shares immediately before the coming into force of this Part, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;70&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the amount of the contributed surplus of the company that is attributable to those shares.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;70&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;70&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Contributed surplus entry</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>The amount of any contributed surplus recorded in the stated capital account pursuant to paragraph (3)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) shall be deducted from the contributed surplus account of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;70&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;70&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Share issued before coming into force</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>Any amount unpaid in respect of a share issued by a former-Act company before the coming into force of this Part and paid after the coming into force of this Part shall be recorded in the stated capital account maintained by the company for the shares of that class or series.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 70;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 182;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 221.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;71&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;71&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Stated capital of continued company</MarginalNote><Label>71.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;71&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where a body corporate is continued as a company under this Act, the company shall record in the stated capital account maintained for each class and series of shares then outstanding an amount that is equal to the aggregate of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;71&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the aggregate amount paid up on the shares of each class and series of shares immediately before the body corporate was so continued, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;71&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the amount of the contributed surplus of the company that is attributable to those shares.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;71&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;71&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Contributed surplus entry</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The amount of any contributed surplus recorded in the stated capital account pursuant to paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) shall be deducted from the contributed surplus account of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;71&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;71&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shares issued before continuance</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Any amount unpaid in respect of a share issued by a body corporate before it was continued as a company under this Act and paid after it was so continued shall be recorded in the stated capital account maintained by the company for the shares of that class or series.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;72&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;72&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Pre-emptive right</MarginalNote><Label>72.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;72&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where the by-laws of a company so provide, no shares of any class shall be issued unless the shares have first been offered to the shareholders holding shares of that class, and those shareholders have a pre-emptive right to acquire the offered shares in proportion to their holdings of the shares of that class, at such price and on such terms as those shares are to be offered to others.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;72&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;72&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Notwithstanding the existence of a pre-emptive right, a shareholder of a company has no pre-emptive right in respect of shares of a class to be issued</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;72&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>for a consideration other than money;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;72&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>as a share dividend; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;72&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>pursuant to the exercise of conversion privileges, options or rights previously granted by the company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;72&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;72&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Idem</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Notwithstanding the existence of a pre-emptive right, a shareholder of a company has no pre-emptive right in respect of shares to be issued</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;72&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>where the issue of shares to the shareholder is prohibited by this Act; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;72&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>where, to the knowledge of the directors of the company, the offer of shares to a shareholder whose recorded address is in a country other than Canada ought not to be made unless the appropriate authority in that country is provided with information in addition to that submitted to the shareholders at the last annual meeting.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;73&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;73&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Conversion privileges</MarginalNote><Label>73.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;73&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company may issue conversion privileges, options or rights to acquire securities of the company, and shall set out the conditions thereof</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;73&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the documents that evidence the conversion privileges, options or rights; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;73&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the securities to which the conversion privileges, options or rights are attached.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;73&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;73&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Transferable rights</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Conversion privileges, options and rights to acquire securities of a company may be made transferable or non-transferable, and options and rights to acquire such securities may be made separable or inseparable from any securities to which they are attached.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;73&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;73&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Reserved shares</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Where a company has granted privileges to convert any securities issued by the company into shares, or into shares of another class or series, or has issued or granted options or rights to acquire shares, if the by-laws limit the number of authorized shares, the company shall reserve and continue to reserve sufficient authorized shares to meet the exercise of such conversion privileges, options and rights.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;74&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;74&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Holding of own shares</MarginalNote><Label>74.</Label><Text>Except as provided in sections 75 to 78, or unless permitted by the regulations, a company shall not</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;74&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>hold shares of the company or of any body corporate that controls the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;74&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>hold any ownership interests of any unincorporated entity that controls the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;74&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>permit any of its subsidiaries to hold any shares of the company or of any body corporate that controls the company; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;74&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>permit any of its subsidiaries to hold any ownership interests of any unincorporated entity that controls the company.</Text></Paragraph></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;75&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;75&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Purchase and redemption of shares</MarginalNote><Label>75.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;75&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection (2) and to its by-laws, a company may, with the consent of the Superintendent, purchase, for the purpose of cancellation, any shares issued by it, or redeem any redeemable shares issued by it at prices not exceeding the redemption price thereof calculated according to a formula stated in its by-laws or the conditions attaching to the shares.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;75&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;75&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restrictions on purchase and redemption</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A company shall not make any payment to purchase or redeem any shares issued by it if there are reasonable grounds for believing that the company is, or the payment would cause the company to be, in contravention of subsection 515(1), any regulation made under subsection 515(2) or any order made under subsection 515(3).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;75&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;75&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Donated shares</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A company may accept from any shareholder a share of the company surrendered to it as a gift, but may not extinguish or reduce a liability in respect of an amount unpaid on any such share except in accordance with section 79.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 75;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 196.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;76&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;76&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Holding as personal representative</MarginalNote><Label>76.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;76&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company may, and may permit its subsidiaries to, hold, in the capacity of a personal representative, shares of the company or of any body corporate that controls the company or ownership interests in any unincorporated entity that controls the company, but only where the company or the subsidiary does not have a beneficial interest in the shares or ownership interests.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;76&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;76&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Security interest</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A company may, and may permit its subsidiaries to, by way of a security interest</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;76&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>hold shares of the company or of any body corporate that controls the company, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;76&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>hold any ownership interests of any entity that controls the company,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>where the security interest is nominal or immaterial when measured by criteria established by the company that have been approved in writing by the Superintendent.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;76&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;76&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Saving</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Nothing in subsection (2) precludes a former-Act company or any of its subsidiaries from holding any security interest held immediately prior to the coming into force of this Part.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 76;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 222(F).</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;76.01&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;76.01&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception — conditions before acquisition</MarginalNote><Label>76.01</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;76.01&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company may permit any of its subsidiaries to acquire shares of the company through the issuance of those shares by the company to the subsidiary if the conditions prescribed for the purposes of this subsection are met before the subsidiary acquires the shares.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;76.01&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;76.01&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Conditions after acquisition</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>After a subsidiary has acquired shares under the purported authority of subsection (1), the conditions prescribed for the purposes of this subsection must be met.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;76.01&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;76.01&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Non-compliance with conditions</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>If a company permits any of its subsidiaries to acquire shares of the company under the purported authority of subsection (1) and one or more of the conditions prescribed for the purposes of subsections (1) and (2) were not met, are not met or cease to be met, as the case may be, then, despite section 16 and subsection 70(2), the company must comply with the prescribed requirements.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2007, c. 6, s. 197.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;76.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;76.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Holding in market-indexed segregated fund</MarginalNote><Label>76.1</Label><Text>A company may hold shares of the company or shares or ownership interests of an entity that controls the company, if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;76.1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the shares or ownership interests are assets of a fund maintained by the company as required by paragraph 451(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>); and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;76.1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the assets of the fund reflect the securities upon which a generally recognized market index is based and the weighting of those securities in that index.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 183;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 368.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;77&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;77&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Cancellation of shares</MarginalNote><Label>77.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;77&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection (2), where a company purchases shares of the company or fractions thereof or redeems or otherwise acquires shares of the company, the company shall cancel those shares.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;77&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;77&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Requirement to sell</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where a company or any of its subsidiaries, through the realization of security, acquires any shares of the company or of any body corporate that controls the company or any ownership interests in an unincorporated entity that controls the company, the company shall, or shall cause its subsidiaries to, as the case may be, within six months after the day of the realization, sell or otherwise dispose of the shares or ownership interests.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;78&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;78&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Subsidiary holding shares</MarginalNote><Label>78.</Label><Text>Subject to the regulations, a former-Act company shall cause any subsidiary of the company that holds shares of the company, or of any body corporate that controls the company, or any ownership interests of any unincorporated entity that controls the company to sell or otherwise dispose of those shares or ownership interests within six months after the day this section comes into force.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;79&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;79&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Reduction of capital</MarginalNote><Label>79.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;79&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The stated capital of a company may be reduced by special resolution.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;79&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;79&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limitation</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A company shall not reduce its stated capital by special resolution if there are reasonable grounds for believing that the company is, or the reduction would cause the company to be, in contravention of subsection 515(1), any regulation made under subsection 515(2) or any order made under subsection 515(3).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;79&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;79&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Contents of special resolution</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A special resolution to reduce the stated capital of a company shall specify the stated capital account or accounts from which the reduction of stated capital effected by the special resolution will be deducted.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;79&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;79&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Approval by Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>A special resolution to reduce the stated capital of a company has no effect until it is approved in writing by the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;79&quot;,ss=&quot;4.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;79&quot;,ss=&quot;4.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(4.1)</Label><Text>Subsection (4) does not apply if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;79&quot;,ss=&quot;4.1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the reduction in the stated capital is made solely as a result of changes made to the accounting principles referred to in subsection 331(4); and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;79&quot;,ss=&quot;4.1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>there is to be no return of capital to shareholders or policyholders as a result of the reduction.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;79&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;79&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Conditions for approval</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>No approval to reduce the stated capital of a company may be given by the Superintendent unless application therefor is made within three months after the time of the passing of the special resolution and a copy of the special resolution, together with a notice of intention to apply for approval, has been published in the <XRefExternal reference-type="other" link="gazette">Canada Gazette</XRefExternal>.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;79&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;79&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Statements to be submitted</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>In addition to evidence of the passing of a special resolution to reduce the stated capital of a company and of the publication thereof, statements showing</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;79&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the number of the company’s shares issued and outstanding,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;79&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the results of the voting by policyholders and by class of shares of the company,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;79&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the company’s assets and liabilities, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;79&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the reason why the company seeks the reduction of capital</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>shall be submitted to the Superintendent at the time of the application for approval of the special resolution.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 79;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 198.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;80&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;80&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Recovery by action</MarginalNote><Label>80.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;80&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where any money or property was paid or distributed to a shareholder or other person as a consequence of a reduction of capital made contrary to section 79, a creditor of the company may apply to a court for an order compelling the shareholder or other person to pay the money or deliver the property to the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;80&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;80&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shares held by personal representative</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>No person holding shares in the capacity of a personal representative and registered on the records of the company as a shareholder and therein described as the personal representative of a named person is personally liable under subsection (1), but the named person is subject to all the liabilities imposed by that subsection.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;80&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;80&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limitation</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>An action to enforce a liability imposed by subsection (1) may not be commenced more than two years after the date of the act complained of.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;80&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;80&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Remedy preserved</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>This section does not affect any liability that arises under section 216.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;81&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;81&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Adjustment of stated capital account</MarginalNote><Label>81.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;81&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>On a purchase, redemption or other acquisition by a company of shares or fractions thereof issued by it, other than shares acquired pursuant to section 76 or acquired through the realization of security and sold pursuant to subsection 77(2), the company shall deduct from the stated capital account maintained for the class or series of shares so purchased, redeemed or otherwise acquired an amount equal to the result obtained by multiplying the stated capital in respect of the shares of that class or series by the number of shares of that class or series so purchased, redeemed or otherwise acquired and dividing by the number of shares of that class or series outstanding immediately before the purchase, redemption or other acquisition.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;81&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;81&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Idem</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A company shall adjust its stated capital account or accounts in accordance with any special resolution referred to in section 79.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;81&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;81&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shares converted to another class</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>On a conversion of outstanding shares of a company into shares of another class or series, or on a change of outstanding shares of the company into shares of another class or series, the company shall</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;81&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>deduct from the stated capital account maintained for the class or series of shares converted or changed an amount equal to the result obtained by multiplying the stated capital of the shares of that class or series by the number of shares of that class or series converted or changed, and dividing by the number of outstanding shares of that class or series immediately before the conversion or change; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;81&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>record the result obtained under paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) and any additional consideration received pursuant to the conversion or change in the stated capital account maintained or to be maintained for the class or series of shares into which the shares have been converted or changed.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;81&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;81&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Stated capital of convertible shares</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>For the purposes of subsection (3) and subject to the company’s by-laws, where a company issues two classes of shares and there is attached to each class a right to convert a share of one class into a share of the other class and a share is so converted, the amount of stated capital attributable to a share in either class is the aggregate of the stated capital of both classes divided by the number of outstanding shares of both classes immediately before the conversion.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;81&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;81&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Conversion or change of shares</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>Shares issued by a company and converted into shares of another class or series, or changed under subsection 238(1) into shares of another class or series, become issued shares of the class or series of shares into which the shares have been converted or changed.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;82&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;82&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Addition to stated capital account</MarginalNote><Label>82.</Label><Text>On a conversion of any debt obligation of a company into shares of a class or series of shares, the company shall</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;82&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>deduct from the liabilities of the company the nominal value of the debt obligation being converted; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;82&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>record the result obtained under paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) and any additional consideration received for the conversion in the stated capital account maintained or to be maintained for the class or series of shares into which the debt obligation has been converted.</Text></Paragraph></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;83&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;83&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Declaration of dividend</MarginalNote><Label>83.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;83&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The directors of a company may declare and a company may pay a dividend by issuing fully paid shares of the company or options or rights to acquire fully paid shares of the company and, subject to subsection (4), the directors of a company may declare and a company may pay a dividend in money or property, and, if a dividend is to be paid in money, the dividend may be paid in a currency other than the currency of Canada.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;83&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;83&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice to Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The directors of a company shall notify the Superintendent of the declaration of a dividend at least 15 days before the day fixed for its payment.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;83&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;83&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Share dividend</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>If shares of a company are issued in payment of a dividend, the company shall record in the stated capital account maintained or to be maintained for the shares of the class or series issued in payment of the dividend the declared amount of the dividend stated as an amount of money.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;83&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;83&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">When dividend not to be declared</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>The directors of a company shall not declare and a company shall not pay a dividend if there are reasonable grounds for believing that the company is, or the payment would cause the company to be, in contravention of subsection 515(1), any regulation made under subsection 515(2) or any order made under subsection 515(3).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;83&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><Label>(5)</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 2007, c. 6, s. 199]</Repealed></Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;83&quot;,ss=&quot;6)&quot;"><Label>(6) to (8)</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 1997, c. 15, s. 184]</Repealed></Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 83;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 184;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 369;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 199.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_V&quot;,gb=&quot;s_83.01&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_V&quot;,gb=&quot;s_83.01&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Restrictions Specific to Shares of Mutual Companies</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;83.01&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;83.01&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Definitions</MarginalNote><Label>83.01</Label><Text>The definitions in this section apply in this section and in sections 83.02 to 83.11.</Text><Definition Code="se=&quot;83.01&quot;,df=&quot;{participating share}{action participante}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;83.01&quot;,df=&quot;{participating share}{action participante}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>participating share</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;83.01&quot;,df=&quot;{participating share}{action participante}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>action participante</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>participating share</DefinedTermEn> means a share issued by a mutual company that confers on the holder of the share the right to receive remaining property of the company on the dissolution of the company.</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;83.01&quot;,df=&quot;{participating shareholder}{actionnaire participant}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;83.01&quot;,df=&quot;{participating shareholder}{actionnaire participant}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>participating shareholder</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;83.01&quot;,df=&quot;{participating shareholder}{actionnaire participant}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>actionnaire participant</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>participating shareholder</DefinedTermEn> means the holder of a participating share.</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;83.01&quot;,df=&quot;{participating shareholder account}{compte des actionnaires participants}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;83.01&quot;,df=&quot;{participating shareholder account}{compte des actionnaires participants}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>participating shareholder account</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;83.01&quot;,df=&quot;{participating shareholder account}{compte des actionnaires participants}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>compte des actionnaires participants</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>participating shareholder account</DefinedTermEn> means an account that a mutual company is required by section 83.04 to maintain.</Text></Definition><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 185.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;83.02&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;83.02&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Voting rights</MarginalNote><Label>83.02</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;83.02&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Except as provided in subsections (2) and (3), a mutual company shall not issue any share that confers on its holder the right to vote at meetings of the shareholders and policyholders of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;83.02&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;83.02&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception — specified events or conditions</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A share may confer on its holder the right to vote where an event has occurred and is continuing or a condition is fulfilled.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;83.02&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;83.02&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception — election of directors</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection 173(4.1), participating shares may confer on their holders the right to elect the number of directors indicated in the company’s by-laws.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 185.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;83.03&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;83.03&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Participating shares</MarginalNote><Label>83.03</Label><Text>A mutual company shall not issue participating shares unless the by-laws of the company authorize it to issue participating shares.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 185.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;83.04&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;83.04&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Participating shareholder accounts</MarginalNote><Label>83.04</Label><Text>A mutual company that issues participating shares shall maintain separate accounts, in the form and manner determined by the Superintendent, in respect of those shares.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 185.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;83.05&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;83.05&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Allocation of income</MarginalNote><Label>83.05</Label><Text>There shall be credited to, or debited from, a participating shareholder account that portion of the income or losses of the company for a financial year, including accrued capital gains or losses, whether or not realized, that is determined in accordance with a method that is</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;83.05&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the written opinion of the actuary of the company, fair and equitable to the participating policyholders of the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;83.05&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>approved by resolution of the directors, after considering the written opinion of the actuary; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;83.05&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>not disallowed by the Superintendent, on the ground that it is not fair and equitable to the participating policyholders, within sixty days after receiving the resolution.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 185.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;83.06&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;83.06&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Allocation of expenses</MarginalNote><Label>83.06</Label><Text>There shall be debited from a participating shareholder account that portion of the expenses, including taxes, of the company for a financial year that is determined in accordance with a method that is</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;83.06&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the written opinion of the actuary of the company, fair and equitable to the participating policyholders of the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;83.06&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>approved by resolution of the directors, after considering the written opinion of the actuary; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;83.06&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>not disallowed by the Superintendent, on the ground that it is not fair and equitable to the participating policyholders, within sixty days after receiving the resolution.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 185.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;83.07&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;83.07&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Filing of allocation method</MarginalNote><Label>83.07</Label><Text>A mutual company the directors of which by resolution approve a method of allocating its income and losses and expenses to a participating shareholder account shall, within thirty days after the making of the resolution, file a copy of it with the Superintendent, together with a copy of the written opinion of the actuary of the company and any other information relevant to the allocation method that the Superintendent requests.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 185.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;83.08&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;83.08&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Review of allocation method</MarginalNote><Label>83.08</Label><Text>The actuary of a company shall annually report in writing to the directors on the fairness and equitableness of the method used by the company for allocating its income and losses and expenses to a participating shareholder account.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 185.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;83.09&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;83.09&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Payment of dividends</MarginalNote><Label>83.09</Label><Text>A mutual company that pays a dividend under section 83 on participating shares shall debit from the participating shareholder account in respect of those shares</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;83.09&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of a dividend paid by issuing fully paid shares, the amount recorded as stated capital in respect of the dividend as required by subsection 83(3); and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;83.09&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in any other case, the amount or value of the dividend.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 185.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;83.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;83.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Participating share redemptions, etc.</MarginalNote><Label>83.1</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;83.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>On a purchase, redemption or other acquisition by a company of participating shares issued by it or fractions of participating shares issued by it, other than participating shares held under section 76 or acquired through the realization of security and sold as required by subsection 77(2), there shall be debited from the participating shareholder account for the class or series of shares so purchased, redeemed or otherwise acquired the amount determined by the formula</Text><FormulaGroup><Formula><FormulaText>A × B/C</FormulaText></Formula><FormulaConnector>where</FormulaConnector><FormulaDefinition><FormulaTerm>A</FormulaTerm><Text>is the balance of the participating shareholder account for the shares of that class or series immediately before the purchase, redemption or other acquisition;</Text></FormulaDefinition><FormulaDefinition><FormulaTerm>B</FormulaTerm><Text>is the number of shares of that class or series so purchased, redeemed or otherwise acquired; and</Text></FormulaDefinition><FormulaDefinition><FormulaTerm>C</FormulaTerm><Text>is the number of shares of that class or series outstanding immediately before the purchase, redemption or other acquisition.</Text></FormulaDefinition></FormulaGroup></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;83.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;83.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shares converted to another class</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>On a conversion of outstanding participating shares of a company into shares of another class or series, or on a change of outstanding participating shares of the company into shares of another class or series</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;83.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>there shall be deducted from the participating shareholder account maintained for the class or series of participating shares converted or changed the amount determined by the formula</Text><FormulaGroup><Formula><FormulaText>A × B/C</FormulaText></Formula><FormulaConnector>where</FormulaConnector><FormulaDefinition><FormulaTerm>A</FormulaTerm><Text>is the balance of the participating shareholder account for the shares of that class or series immediately before the conversion or change,</Text></FormulaDefinition><FormulaDefinition><FormulaTerm>B</FormulaTerm><Text>is the number of shares of that class or series converted or changed, and</Text></FormulaDefinition><FormulaDefinition><FormulaTerm>C</FormulaTerm><Text>is the number of shares of that class or series outstanding immediately before the conversion or change; and</Text></FormulaDefinition></FormulaGroup></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;83.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if the shares of that other class or series are participating shares, the amount determined under the formula in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) shall be credited to the participating shareholder account for those participating shares.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;83.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;83.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Participating shareholder account for convertible participating shares</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>For the purposes of subsection (2) and subject to the company’s by-laws, where a company issues two classes of participating shares and there is attached to each class a right to convert a share of one class into a share of the other class and a share is so converted, the amount in a participating shareholder account attributable to a share in either class is the amount determined by the formula</Text><FormulaGroup><Formula><FormulaText>A/B</FormulaText></Formula><FormulaConnector>where</FormulaConnector><FormulaDefinition><FormulaTerm>A</FormulaTerm><Text>is the total of the balances of the participating shareholder accounts of both classes; and</Text></FormulaDefinition><FormulaDefinition><FormulaTerm>B</FormulaTerm><Text>is the number of outstanding shares of both classes immediately before the conversion.</Text></FormulaDefinition></FormulaGroup></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 185.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;83.11&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;83.11&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Remaining property on dissolution</MarginalNote><Label>83.11</Label><Text>The remaining property of a company that a participating shareholder of the company is entitled to receive on the dissolution of the company shall not exceed the sum of all amounts each of which is the amount in respect of a class or series of participating shares of the company determined by the formula</Text><FormulaGroup><Formula><FormulaText>A × B/C</FormulaText></Formula><FormulaConnector>where</FormulaConnector><FormulaDefinition><FormulaTerm>A</FormulaTerm><Text>is the balance in the participating shareholder account for the shares of that class or series immediately before the dissolution;</Text></FormulaDefinition><FormulaDefinition><FormulaTerm>B</FormulaTerm><Text>is the number of shares of that class or series held by the participating shareholder immediately before the dissolution; and</Text></FormulaDefinition><FormulaDefinition><FormulaTerm>C</FormulaTerm><Text>is the number of shares of that class or series immediately before the dissolution.</Text></FormulaDefinition></FormulaGroup><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 185.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_V&quot;,gb=&quot;s_84&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_V&quot;,gb=&quot;s_84&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Subordinated Indebtedness</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;84&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;84&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction on subordinated indebtedness</MarginalNote><Label>84.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;84&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company shall not issue subordinated indebtedness unless the subordinated indebtedness is fully paid for in money or, with the approval of the Superintendent, in property.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;84&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;84&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">References to subordinated indebtedness</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A person shall not in any prospectus, advertisement, correspondence or literature relating to any subordinated indebtedness issued or to be issued by a company refer to the subordinated indebtedness otherwise than as subordinated indebtedness.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;84&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;84&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Other currencies</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>When issuing subordinated indebtedness, a company may provide that any aspect of the subordinated indebtedness relating to money or involving the payment of or the liability to pay money in relation thereto be in a currency other than that of Canada including, without restricting the generality of the foregoing, the payment of any interest thereon.</Text></Subsection></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_V&quot;,gb=&quot;s_85&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_V&quot;,gb=&quot;s_85&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Security Certificates and Transfers</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;85&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Definitions</MarginalNote><Label>85.</Label><Text>In this section and sections 86 to 139,</Text><Definition Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{adverse claim}{opposition}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{adverse claim}{opposition}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>adverse claim</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{adverse claim}{opposition}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>opposition</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>adverse claim</DefinedTermEn> includes a claim that a transfer was or would be wrongful or that a particular adverse person is the owner of or has an interest in a security;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{bona fide purchaser}{acheteur de bonne foi}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{bona fide purchaser}{acheteur de bonne foi}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn><Language xml:lang="la">bona fide</Language> purchaser</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{bona fide purchaser}{acheteur de bonne foi}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>acheteur de bonne foi</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn><Language xml:lang="la">bona fide</Language> purchaser</DefinedTermEn> means a purchaser for value in good faith and without notice of any adverse claim who takes delivery of a security in bearer form or order form or of a security in registered form issued to the purchaser or endorsed to the purchaser or endorsed in blank;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{clearing agency}{agence de compensation et de dépôt}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{clearing agency}{agence de compensation et de dépôt}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>clearing agency</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{clearing agency}{agence de compensation et de dépôt}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>agence de compensation et de dépôt</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>clearing agency</DefinedTermEn> means a person designated as a recognized clearing agency by the Superintendent;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{delivery}{livraison}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{delivery}{livraison}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>delivery</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{delivery}{livraison}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>livraison</DefinedTermFr> ou <DefinedTermFr>remise</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>delivery</DefinedTermEn> means voluntary transfer of possession;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{fungible}{fongibles}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{fungible}{fongibles}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>fungible</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{fungible}{fongibles}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>fongibles</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>fungible</DefinedTermEn>, in respect of securities, means securities of which any unit is, by nature or usage of trade, the equivalent of any other like unit;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{genuine}{authentique}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{genuine}{authentique}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>genuine</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{genuine}{authentique}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>authentique</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>genuine</DefinedTermEn> means free of forgery or counterfeit;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{good faith}{bonne foi}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{good faith}{bonne foi}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>good faith</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{good faith}{bonne foi}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>bonne foi</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>good faith</DefinedTermEn> means honesty in fact in the conduct of the transaction concerned;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{over-issue}{émission excédentaire}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{over-issue}{émission excédentaire}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>over-issue</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{over-issue}{émission excédentaire}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>émission excédentaire</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>over-issue</DefinedTermEn> means the issue of securities in excess of any maximum number of securities that the issuer is authorized to issue;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{purchaser}{acquéreur}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{purchaser}{acquéreur}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>purchaser</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{purchaser}{acquéreur}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>acquéreur</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>purchaser</DefinedTermEn> means a person who takes an interest in a security by sale, mortgage, pledge, issue, reissue, gift or any other voluntary transaction;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{securities broker}{courtier}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{securities broker}{courtier}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>securities broker</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{securities broker}{courtier}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>courtier</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>securities broker</DefinedTermEn> means a person who is engaged for all or part of the person’s time in the business of buying and selling securities and who, in the transaction concerned, acts for, or buys a security from, or sells a security to, a customer;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{security}{valeur mobilière}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{security}{valeur mobilière}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>security</DefinedTermEn> or <DefinedTermEn>security certificate</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{security}{valeur mobilière}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>valeur mobilière</DefinedTermFr> ou <DefinedTermFr>certificat de valeur mobilière</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>security</DefinedTermEn> or <DefinedTermEn>security certificate</DefinedTermEn> means an instrument issued by a company that is</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{security}{valeur mobilière}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in bearer, order or registered form,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{security}{valeur mobilière}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>of a type commonly dealt in on securities exchanges or markets or commonly recognized in any area in which it is issued or dealt in as a medium for investment,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{security}{valeur mobilière}&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>one of a class or series or by its terms divisible into a class or series of instruments, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{security}{valeur mobilière}&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>evidence of a share, participation or other interest in or obligation of a company,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedDefinition><Text>but does not include a policy;</Text></ContinuedDefinition></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{trust indenture}{acte de fiducie}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{trust indenture}{acte de fiducie}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>trust indenture</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{trust indenture}{acte de fiducie}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>acte de fiducie</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>trust indenture</DefinedTermEn> has the meaning given that expression by section 317;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{unauthorized}{non autorisé}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{unauthorized}{non autorisé}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>unauthorized</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{unauthorized}{non autorisé}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>non autorisé</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>unauthorized</DefinedTermEn>, in relation to a signature or an endorsement, means a signature or an endorsement made without actual, implied or apparent authority, and includes a forgery;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{uncertificated security}{valeur mobilière sans certificat}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{uncertificated security}{valeur mobilière sans certificat}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>uncertificated security</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{uncertificated security}{valeur mobilière sans certificat}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>valeur mobilière sans certificat</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>uncertificated security</DefinedTermEn> means a security, not evidenced by a security certificate, the issue and any transfer of which is registered and recorded in records maintained for that purpose by or on behalf of a company;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{valid}{valide}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{valid}{valide}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>valid</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;85&quot;,df=&quot;{valid}{valide}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>valide</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>valid</DefinedTermEn> means issued in accordance with the applicable law or validated under section 101.</Text></Definition></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;86&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;86&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Provisions governing transfers of securities</MarginalNote><Label>86.</Label><Text>The transfer of a security is governed by sections 87 to 139.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;87&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;87&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Security a negotiable instrument</MarginalNote><Label>87.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;87&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A security is a negotiable instrument but, in the case of any inconsistency between the provisions of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="B-4">Bills of Exchange Act</XRefExternal> and this Act, this Act prevails to the extent of the inconsistency.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;87&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;87&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Bearer form</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A security is in bearer form if it is payable to bearer according to its terms and not by reason of any endorsement.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;87&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;87&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Order form</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A security is in order form where the security is not a share and, by its terms, it is payable to the order or assigns of any person therein specified with reasonable certainty or to the person or the person’s order.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;87&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;87&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Registered form</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>A security is in registered form if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;87&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>it specifies a person entitled to the security or to the rights it evidences, and its transfer is capable of being recorded in a securities register; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;87&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>it bears a statement that it is in registered form.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;88&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;88&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Status of guarantor</MarginalNote><Label>88.</Label><Text>A guarantor for an issuer of a security is deemed to be an issuer to the extent of the guarantee, whether or not the guarantor’s obligation is noted on the security.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;89&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;89&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Rights of holder</MarginalNote><Label>89.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;89&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to Part VII, every security holder is entitled at the holder’s option to a security certificate that complies with this Act or to a non-transferable written acknowledgement of the holder’s right to obtain a security certificate that complies with this Act from a company in respect of the securities of that company held by the security holder.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;89&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;89&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Fee for security certificate</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A company may charge a fee, not exceeding a prescribed amount, for a security certificate issued in respect of a transfer.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;89&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;89&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Joint holders</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A company is not required to issue more than one security certificate in respect of securities held jointly by several persons, and delivery of a security certificate to one of several joint holders is sufficient delivery to all joint holders of the security.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 89;</li><li> 1999, c. 31, s. 139.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;90&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;90&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Signatures</MarginalNote><Label>90.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;90&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A security certificate shall be signed by or bear the printed or otherwise mechanically reproduced signature of at least one of the following:</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;90&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a director or officer of the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;90&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a registrar or transfer agent of the company or a branch transfer agent or a natural person on their behalf; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;90&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a trustee who certifies it in accordance with a trust indenture.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;90&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;90&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Continuation of validity of signature</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If a security certificate contains a person’s printed or mechanically reproduced signature, the company may issue the security certificate even if the person has ceased to be a director or officer of the company. The security certificate is as valid as if the person were a director or officer at the date of its issue.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 90;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 224.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;91&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;91&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Contents of share certificate</MarginalNote><Label>91.</Label><Text>There shall be stated on the face of each share certificate issued by a company after the coming into force of this section</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;91&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the name of the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;91&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a statement that the company is subject to the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="I-11.8">Insurance Companies Act</XRefExternal>;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;91&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the name of the person to whom the share certificate is issued; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;91&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the number and class of shares and the designation of any series that the certificate represents.</Text></Paragraph></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;92&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;92&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restrictions and charges</MarginalNote><Label>92.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;92&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>No charge in favour of a company and no restriction on transfer, other than a constraint under Part VII other than section 427, is effective against a transferee of a security issued by the company if the transferee has no actual knowledge of the charge or restriction unless it or a reference to it is noted conspicuously on the security certificate.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;92&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;92&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">No restriction</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If any of the issued shares of a distributing company remain outstanding and are held by more than one person, the company may not restrict the transfer or ownership of its shares except by way of a constraint under Part VII.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;92&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;92&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Continuance</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>If a body corporate that is continued as a company under this Act has outstanding security certificates and the words “private company” or “private corporation” appear on the certificates, those words are deemed to be a notice of a charge or restriction for the purposes of subsection (1).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 92;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 71.1;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 225.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;93&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;93&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Particulars of class</MarginalNote><Label>93.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;93&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>There shall be stated legibly on a share certificate issued after the coming into force of this section by a company that is authorized to issue shares of more than one class or series</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;93&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the rights, privileges, restrictions and conditions attached to the shares of each class and series existing when the share certificate is issued; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;93&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>that the class or series of shares that the certificate represents has rights, privileges, restrictions or conditions attached thereto and that the company will furnish a shareholder, on demand and without charge, with a full copy of</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;93&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>the text of the rights, privileges, restrictions and conditions attached to each class authorized to be issued and to each series in so far as those rights, privileges, restrictions and conditions have been fixed by the directors, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;93&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>the text of the authority of the directors, if the directors are so authorized, to fix the rights, privileges, restrictions and conditions of subsequent series of shares.</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;93&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;93&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Duty</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where a share certificate issued by a company contains the statement mentioned in paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>), the company shall provide a shareholder, on demand and without charge, with a full copy of the texts referred to in subparagraphs (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)(i) and (ii).</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;94&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;94&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Fractional share</MarginalNote><Label>94.</Label><Text>A company may issue a certificate for a fractional share or may issue in place thereof a scrip certificate in bearer form that entitles the holder to receive a certificate for a full share by exchanging scrip certificates aggregating a full share.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;95&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;95&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Scrip certificates</MarginalNote><Label>95.</Label><Text>The directors of a company may attach conditions to any scrip certificate issued by the company, including conditions that</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;95&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the scrip certificate becomes void if not exchanged for a share certificate representing a full share before a specified date; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;95&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any shares for which the scrip certificate is exchangeable may, notwithstanding any pre-emptive right, be issued by the company to any person and the proceeds thereof may be distributed rateably to the holders of all the scrip certificates.</Text></Paragraph></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;96&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;96&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Holders of fractional shares</MarginalNote><Label>96.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;96&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A holder of a fractional share issued by a company is not entitled to exercise voting rights or to receive a dividend in respect of the fractional share.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;96&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;96&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Holders of scrip certificates</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A holder of a scrip certificate is not entitled to exercise voting rights or to receive a dividend in respect of the scrip certificate.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;97&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;97&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Dealings with registered holder</MarginalNote><Label>97.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;97&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company or a trustee within the meaning of section 317 may, subject to sections 142 to 145 and 149, treat the registered owner of a security as the person exclusively entitled to vote, to receive notices, to receive any interest, dividend or other payment in respect of the security and to exercise all of the rights and powers of an owner of the security.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;97&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;97&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Constructive registered holder</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Notwithstanding subsection (1), a company may treat a person as a registered security holder entitled to exercise all of the rights of the security holder that the person represents, if that person provides the company with evidence as described in subsection 131(4) that the person is</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;97&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the heir or personal representative of a deceased security holder or the personal representative of the heirs of the deceased security holder;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;97&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the personal representative of a registered security holder who is a minor, an incompetent person or a missing person; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;97&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a liquidator of, or a trustee in bankruptcy for, a registered security holder.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;97&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;97&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Permissible registered holder</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>If a person on whom the ownership of a security of a company devolves by operation of law, other than a person described in subsection (2), provides proof of that person’s authority to exercise rights or privileges in respect of a security of the company that is not registered in the person’s name, the company shall, subject to this Act, treat that person as entitled to exercise those rights or privileges.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;97&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;97&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Immunity of company</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>A company is not required to inquire into the existence of, or see to the performance or observance of, any duty owed to a third person by a registered holder of any of its securities or by anyone whom it treats, as permitted or required by this Part, as the owner or registered holder thereof.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 97;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 226(E).</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;98&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;98&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Minors</MarginalNote><Label>98.</Label><Text>If a minor exercises any rights of ownership in the securities of a company, no subsequent repudiation or avoidance is effective against the company.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 98;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 227(E).</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;99&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;99&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Joint shareholders</MarginalNote><Label>99.</Label><Text>A company may treat as owners of a security the survivors of persons to whom the security was issued as joint holders, if the company receives proof satisfactory to it of the death of any of the joint holders.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;100&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;100&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Transmission of securities</MarginalNote><Label>100.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;100&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to the provisions of Part VII and any applicable law relating to the collection of taxes, a person referred to in paragraph 97(2)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) is entitled to become registered as the owner of a security, or to designate another person to be registered as the owner of a security, if the person referred to in paragraph 97(2)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) delivers to the company or its transfer agent</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;100&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the original grant of probate or of letters of administration, or a copy thereof certified to be a true copy by</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;100&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>the court that granted the probate or letters of administration,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;100&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>a trust company incorporated under the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="T-19.8">Trust and Loan Companies Act</XRefExternal> or under the laws of a province, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;100&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>a lawyer or notary acting on behalf of the person referred to in paragraph 97(2)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>), or</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;100&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of transmission by notarial will in the Province of Quebec, a copy thereof authenticated pursuant to the laws of that Province,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>together with</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;100&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an affidavit or declaration of transmission made by the person referred to in paragraph 97(2)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) that states the particulars of the transmission, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;100&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the security certificate that was owned by the deceased holder</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;100&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>in the case of a transfer to the person referred to in paragraph 97(2)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>), with or without the endorsement of that person, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;100&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>in the case of a transfer to any other person, endorsed in accordance with section 115,</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>and accompanied by any assurance the company may require under section 131.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;100&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;100&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Excepted transmissions</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Notwithstanding subsection (1), if the laws of the jurisdiction governing the transmission of a security of a deceased holder do not require a grant of probate or of letters of administration in respect of the transmission, a personal representative of the deceased holder is entitled, subject to Part VII and any applicable law relating to the collection of taxes, to become registered as the owner or to designate a person to be registered as the owner, if the personal representative delivers to the company or its transfer agent the following documents, namely,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;100&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the security certificate that was owned by the deceased holder; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;100&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>reasonable proof of the governing laws, of the deceased holder’s interest in the security and of the right of the personal representative or the designated person to become the registered shareholder.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;100&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;100&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Right of company to treat as owner</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Subject to Part VII, delivery of the documents referred to in this section empowers a company or its transfer agent to record in a securities register the transmission of a security from the deceased holder to a person referred to in paragraph 97(2)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) or to such person as the person referred to in that paragraph may designate and, thereafter, to treat the person who becomes so registered as the owner of that security.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, ss. 100, 758.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;101&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;101&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Over-issue</MarginalNote><Label>101.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;101&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The provisions of this Part that validate a security or compel its issue or reissue do not apply to the extent that a validation, issue or reissue would result in over-issue, but</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;101&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if a valid security similar in all respects to the security involved in the over-issue is reasonably available for purchase, the person entitled to the validation or issue may compel the issuer to purchase and deliver such a security to that person against surrender of the security that the person holds; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;101&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if a valid security similar in all respects to the security involved in the over-issue is not reasonably available for purchase, the person entitled to the validation or issue may recover from the issuer an amount equal to the price the last purchaser for value paid for the invalid security.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;101&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;101&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Retroactive validation</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where an issuer is subsequently authorized to issue securities of a number equal to or exceeding the number of securities previously authorized plus the amount of the securities over-issued, the securities so over-issued are valid from the date of their issue.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;101&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;101&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Payment not a purchase or redemption</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A purchase or payment by an issuer under subsection (1) is not a purchase or payment in respect of which section 75 or 81 applies.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;102&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;102&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Burden of proof</MarginalNote><Label>102.</Label><Text>In any action on a security,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;102&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>unless specifically denied in the pleadings, each signature on the security or in a necessary endorsement is admitted;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;102&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a signature on the security is presumed to be genuine and authorized but, if the effectiveness of the signature is put in issue, the burden of establishing that it is genuine and authorized is on the party claiming under the signature;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;102&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if a signature is admitted or established, production of the instrument entitles a holder to recover on it unless the defendant establishes a defence or a defect going to the validity of the security; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;102&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if the defendant establishes that a defence or defect exists, the plaintiff has the burden of establishing that the defence or defect is ineffective against the plaintiff or any person under whom the plaintiff claims.</Text></Paragraph></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;103&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;103&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Securities fungible</MarginalNote><Label>103.</Label><Text>Unless otherwise agreed, and subject to any applicable law, regulation or stock exchange rule, a person required to deliver securities may deliver any security of the specified issue in bearer form or registered in the name of the transferee or endorsed to the transferee or in blank.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;104&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;104&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of defect</MarginalNote><Label>104.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;104&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Even against a purchaser for value and without notice of a defect going to the validity of a security, the terms of the security include those stated on the security and those incorporated therein by reference to another instrument, statute, rule, regulation or order to the extent that the terms so referred to do not conflict with the stated terms, but such a reference is not of itself notice to a purchaser for value of a defect going to the validity of the security, notwithstanding that the security expressly states that a person accepting it admits the notice.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;104&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;104&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Purchaser for value</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A security is valid in the hands of a purchaser for value without notice of any defect going to its validity.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;104&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;104&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Lack of genuineness</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Except as provided in section 105, the fact that a security is not genuine is a complete defence even against a purchaser for value and without notice.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;104&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;104&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Ineffective defences</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>All defences of an issuer, including non-delivery and conditional delivery of a security but not including lack of genuineness, are ineffective against a purchaser for value without notice of the particular defence.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;104&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;104&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Staleness as defect notice</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>After an event that creates a right to immediate performance of the principal obligation evidenced by a security, or that sets a date on or after which a security is to be presented or surrendered for redemption or exchange, a purchaser is deemed to have notice of any defect in its issue or of any defence of the issuer</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;104&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if the event requires the payment of money or the delivery of securities, or both, on presentation or surrender of the security, and the funds or securities are available on the date set for payment or exchange, and the purchaser takes the security more than one year after that date; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;104&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if the purchaser takes the security more than two years after the date set for presentation or surrender or the date on which the performance became due.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;105&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;105&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Unauthorized signature</MarginalNote><Label>105.</Label><Text>An unauthorized signature on a security before or in the course of issue is ineffective, except that the signature is effective in favour of a purchaser for value and without notice of the lack of authority, if the signing has been done by</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;105&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an authenticating trustee, registrar, transfer agent or other person entrusted by the issuer with the signing of the security, or of similar securities, or their immediate preparation for signing; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;105&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an employee of the issuer or of a person referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) who, in the ordinary course of the employee’s duties, handles the security.</Text></Paragraph></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;106&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;106&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Completion or alteration</MarginalNote><Label>106.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;106&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where a security contains the signatures necessary to its issue or transfer but is incomplete in any other respect,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;106&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any person may complete it by filling in the blanks in accordance with the person’s authority; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;106&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>notwithstanding that the blanks are incorrectly filled in, the security as completed is enforceable by a purchaser who took it for value and without notice of the incorrectness.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;106&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;106&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Enforceability</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A completed security that has been improperly altered, even if fraudulently altered, remains enforceable, but only according to its original terms.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;107&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;107&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Warranties of agents</MarginalNote><Label>107.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;107&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A person signing a security, as authenticating trustee, registrar, transfer agent or other person entrusted by the issuer with the signing of the security, warrants to a purchaser for value without notice that</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;107&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the security is genuine;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;107&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the person’s acts in connection with the issue of the security are within the person’s authority; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;107&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the person has reasonable grounds for believing that the security is in the form and within the amount the issuer is authorized to issue.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;107&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;107&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limitation of liability</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Unless otherwise agreed, a person referred to in subsection (1) does not assume any further liability for the validity of a security.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;108&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;108&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Title of purchaser</MarginalNote><Label>108.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;108&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to Part VII, on delivery of a security the purchaser acquires the rights in the security that the purchaser’s transferor had or had authority to convey, except that the position of a purchaser who has been a party to any fraud or illegality affecting the security or who as a prior holder had notice of an adverse claim is not improved by taking from a later <Language xml:lang="la">bona fide</Language> purchaser.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;108&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;108&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Title of <Language xml:lang="la">bona fide</Language> purchaser</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A <Language xml:lang="la">bona fide</Language> purchaser, in addition to acquiring the rights of a purchaser, also acquires the security free from any adverse claim.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;108&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;108&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limited interest purchaser</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A purchaser of a limited interest acquires rights only to the extent of the interest purchased.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;109&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;109&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Deemed notice of adverse claim</MarginalNote><Label>109.</Label><Text>A purchaser of a security, or any securities broker for a seller or purchaser, is deemed to have notice of an adverse claim if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;109&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the security, whether in bearer form or registered form, has been endorsed “for collection” or “for surrender” or for some other purpose not involving transfer; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;109&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the security is in bearer form and has on it a statement that it is the property of a person other than the transferor, except that the mere writing of a name on a security is not such a statement.</Text></Paragraph></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;110&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;110&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of fiduciary duty</MarginalNote><Label>110.</Label><Text>Notwithstanding that a purchaser, or any securities broker for a seller or purchaser, has notice that a security is held for a third person by, or is registered in the name of or endorsed by, a fiduciary, neither the purchaser nor the securities broker has any duty to inquire into the rightfulness of the transfer or any notice of an adverse claim, except that if the purchaser or securities broker for the seller or purchaser knows that the consideration is to be used for, or that the transaction is for, the personal benefit of the fiduciary or is otherwise in breach of the fiduciary’s duty, the purchaser or securities broker is deemed to have notice of an adverse claim.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;111&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;111&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Staleness as notice</MarginalNote><Label>111.</Label><Text>An event that creates a right to immediate performance of the principal obligation evidenced by a security or that sets a date on or after which the security is to be presented or surrendered for redemption or exchange is not of itself notice of an adverse claim, except in the case of a purchase</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;111&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>made more than one year after any date set for such a presentation or surrender; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;111&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>made more than six months after any date set for payment of money against such a presentation or surrender if funds are available for payment on that date.</Text></Paragraph></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;112&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;112&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Warranties to issuer</MarginalNote><Label>112.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;112&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A person who presents a security for registration of transfer or for payment or exchange warrants to the issuer that the person is entitled to the registration, payment or exchange, except that a purchaser for value without notice of an adverse claim who receives a new, reissued or re-registered security on registration of transfer warrants only that the purchaser has no knowledge of any unauthorized signature in a necessary endorsement.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;112&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;112&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Warranties to purchaser</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A person by transferring a security to a purchaser for value warrants only that</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;112&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the transfer is effective and rightful;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;112&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the security is genuine and has not been materially altered; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;112&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the person knows of nothing that might impair the validity of the security.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;112&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;112&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Warranties of intermediary</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Where a security is delivered by an intermediary known by the purchaser to be entrusted with delivery of the security on behalf of another or with collection of a draft or other claim to be collected against that delivery, the intermediary by that delivery warrants only the intermediary’s own good faith and authority even if the intermediary has purchased or made advances against the draft or other claim to be collected against the delivery.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;112&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;112&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Warranties of pledgee</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>A pledgee or other holder for purposes of security who redelivers a security received, or after payment and on order of the debtor delivers that security to a third person, gives only the warranties of an intermediary under subsection (3).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;112&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;112&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Warranties of securities broker</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>A securities broker gives to the broker’s customer, to the issuer and to a purchaser, as the case may be, the warranties provided in subsections (1) to (4) and has the rights and privileges of a purchaser under those subsections, and those warranties of and in favour of the broker acting as an agent are in addition to warranties given by the broker’s customer and warranties given in favour of the broker’s customer.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;113&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;113&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Right to compel endorsement</MarginalNote><Label>113.</Label><Text>Where a security in registered form is delivered to a purchaser without a necessary endorsement, the purchaser may become a <Language xml:lang="la">bona fide</Language> purchaser only as of the time the endorsement is supplied, but against the transferor the transfer is complete on delivery and the purchaser has a specifically enforceable right to have any necessary endorsement supplied.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;114&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;114&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Definition of <DefinedTermEn>appropriate person</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><Label>114.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;114&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>In this section, section 115, subsections 122(1), 125(4) and 130(1) and section 134, <DefinedTermEn>appropriate person</DefinedTermEn> means</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;114&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the person specified by the security or by special endorsement to be entitled to the security;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;114&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if a person described in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) is described as a fiduciary but is no longer serving in the described capacity, either that person or that person’s successor;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;114&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if the security or endorsement mentioned in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) specifies more than one person as fiduciaries and one or more of those persons are no longer serving in the described capacity, the remaining fiduciary or fiduciaries, whether or not a successor has been appointed;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;114&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if a person described in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) is a natural person and is without capacity to act by reason of death, incompetence, minority or other reason, the person’s fiduciary;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;114&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if the security or endorsement mentioned in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) specifies more than one person with right of survivorship and by reason of death not all of the persons can sign, the survivor or survivors;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;114&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a person having power to sign under any applicable law or a power of attorney; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;114&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>to the extent that a person described in any of paragraphs (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>) may act through an agent, the person’s authorized agent.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;114&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;114&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Determining an <DefinedTermEn>appropriate person</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Whether the person signing is an appropriate person is determined as of the time of signing, and an endorsement by such a person does not become unauthorized for the purposes of this Part by reason of any subsequent change of circumstances.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;115&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;115&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Endorsement</MarginalNote><Label>115.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;115&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>An endorsement of a security in registered form is made when an appropriate person signs, either on the security or on a separate document, an assignment or transfer of the security or a power to assign or transfer it, or when the signature of an appropriate person is written without more on the back of the security.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;115&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;115&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Special or blank</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>An endorsement may be special or in blank.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;115&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;115&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Blank endorsement</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>An endorsement in blank includes an endorsement to bearer.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;115&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;115&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Special endorsement</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>A special endorsement specifies the person to whom the security is to be transferred, or who has power to transfer it.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;115&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;115&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Right of holder</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>A holder may convert an endorsement in blank into a special endorsement.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;116&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;116&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Immunity of endorser</MarginalNote><Label>116.</Label><Text>Unless otherwise agreed, the endorser by the endorsement assumes no obligation that the security will be honoured by the issuer.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;117&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;117&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Partial endorsement</MarginalNote><Label>117.</Label><Text>An endorsement purporting to be an endorsement of only part of a security representing units intended by the issuer to be separately transferable is effective to the extent of the endorsement.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;118&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;118&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effect of failure by fiduciary to comply</MarginalNote><Label>118.</Label><Text>Failure of a fiduciary to comply with a controlling instrument or with the law of the jurisdiction governing the fiduciary relationship, including any law requiring the fiduciary to obtain court approval of a transfer, does not render the fiduciary’s endorsement unauthorized for the purposes of this Part.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;119&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;119&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effect of endorsement without delivery</MarginalNote><Label>119.</Label><Text>An endorsement of a security, whether special or in blank, does not constitute a transfer until delivery of the security on which it appears or, if the endorsement is on a separate document, until delivery of both the security and that document.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;120&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;120&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Endorsement in bearer form</MarginalNote><Label>120.</Label><Text>An endorsement of a security in bearer form may give notice of an adverse claim under section 109 but does not otherwise affect any of the holder’s rights.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;121&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;121&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effect of unauthorized endorsement</MarginalNote><Label>121.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;121&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The owner of a security may assert the ineffectiveness of an endorsement against the issuer or any purchaser, other than a purchaser for value and without notice of an adverse claim, who has in good faith received a new, reissued or re-registered security on registration of transfer, unless the owner</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;121&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>has ratified an unauthorized endorsement of the security; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;121&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>is otherwise precluded from impugning the effectiveness of an unauthorized endorsement.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;121&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;121&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Liability of issuer</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>An issuer who registers the transfer of a security on an unauthorized endorsement is liable for improper registration.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;122&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;122&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Warranties of guarantor of signature</MarginalNote><Label>122.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;122&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A person who guarantees the signature of an endorser of a security warrants that, at the time of signing,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;122&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the signature was genuine;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;122&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the signer was an appropriate person to endorse; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;122&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the signer had legal capacity to sign.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;122&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;122&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limitation of liability</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A person who guarantees the signature of an endorser does not otherwise warrant the rightfulness of the transfer to which the signature relates.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;122&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;122&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Warranties of guarantor of endorsement</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A person who guarantees the endorsement of a security warrants both the signature and the rightfulness, in all respects, of the transfer to which the signature relates, but an issuer may not require a guarantee of endorsement as a condition to registration of transfer.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;122&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;122&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Extent of warrantor’s liability</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>The warranties referred to in subsections (1) to (3) are made to any person who, relying on the guarantee, takes or deals with the security, and the guarantor is liable to such a person for any loss resulting from breach of warranty.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;123&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;123&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Constructive delivery of a security</MarginalNote><Label>123.</Label><Text>Delivery to a purchaser occurs when</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;123&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the purchaser or a person designated by the purchaser acquires possession of a security;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;123&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the purchaser’s securities broker acquires possession of a security specially endorsed to or issued in the name of the purchaser;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;123&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the purchaser’s securities broker sends the purchaser confirmation of the purchase and the broker in the broker’s records identifies a specific security as belonging to the purchaser; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;123&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in respect of an identified security to be delivered while still in the possession of a third person, that person acknowledges that it is held for the purchaser.</Text></Paragraph></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;124&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;124&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Constructive ownership of security</MarginalNote><Label>124.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;124&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A purchaser is the owner of a security held for the purchaser by a securities broker, but a purchaser is not a holder except in the cases referred to in paragraphs 123(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) and (<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;124&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;124&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Ownership of part of fungible bulk</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If a security is part of a fungible bulk, a purchaser of the security is the owner of the proportionate interest in the fungible bulk.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;124&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;124&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice to securities broker of adverse claim</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Notice of an adverse claim received by a securities broker or by a purchaser after the broker takes delivery as a holder for value is not effective against the broker or the purchaser, except that, as between the broker and the purchaser, the purchaser may demand delivery of an equivalent security in respect of which no notice of an adverse claim has been received.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;125&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;125&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Delivery of security</MarginalNote><Label>125.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;125&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Unless otherwise agreed, if a sale of a security is made on a stock exchange or otherwise through securities brokers,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;125&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the selling customer fulfils the customer’s duty to deliver when the customer delivers the security to the selling securities broker or to a person designated by the selling securities broker or causes an acknowledgement to be made to the selling securities broker that it is held for the selling securities broker; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;125&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the selling securities broker, including a correspondent broker, acting for a selling customer fulfils the securities broker’s duty to deliver by delivering the security or a like security to the buying securities broker or to a person designated by the buying securities broker or by effecting clearance of the sale in accordance with the rules of the exchange on which the transaction took place.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;125&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;125&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Duty to deliver</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Except as otherwise provided in this section and unless otherwise agreed, a transferor’s duty to deliver a security under a contract of purchase is not fulfilled until the transferor delivers the security in negotiable form to the purchaser or to a person designated by the purchaser, or causes an acknowledgement to be made to the purchaser that the security is held for the purchaser.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;125&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;125&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Delivery to securities broker</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A sale to a securities broker purchasing for the securities broker’s own account is subject to subsection (2) and not subsection (1), unless the sale is made on a stock exchange.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;125&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;125&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Transfer through clearing agency</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>If a security shown in the records of a clearing agency is evidenced by</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;125&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a security certificate in the custody of the clearing agency or a custodian, or a nominee of either, subject to the instructions of the clearing agency, and is in bearer form or endorsed in blank by an appropriate person or registered in the name of the clearing agency or a custodian, or of a nominee of either, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;125&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an uncertificated security registered or recorded in records maintained by or on behalf of the company in the name of the clearing agency or a custodian, or of a nominee of either, subject to the instructions of the clearing agency,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>then, in addition to other methods, a transfer or pledge of the security or any interest therein may be effected by the making of an appropriate entry in the records of the clearing agency.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;125&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;125&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Interest in fungible bulk</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>Under subsections (4) to (10), entries may be in respect of like securities or interests therein as part of a fungible bulk and may refer merely to a quantity of a particular security without reference to the name of the registered owner, certificate or bond number or the like and, in appropriate cases, may be on a net basis taking into account other transfers or pledges of the same security.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;125&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;125&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Constructive endorsement and delivery</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>A transfer or pledge under subsections (4) to (10) has the effect of a delivery of a security in bearer form or duly endorsed in blank representing the amount of the obligation or the number of shares or rights transferred or pledged.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;125&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;125&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Idem</MarginalNote><Label>(7)</Label><Text>If a pledge or the creation of a security interest is intended, the making of entries has the effect of a taking of delivery by the pledgee or a secured party and the pledgee or secured party shall be deemed to have taken possession for all purposes.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;125&quot;,ss=&quot;8&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;125&quot;,ss=&quot;8&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Holder</MarginalNote><Label>(8)</Label><Text>A person depositing a security certificate or an uncertificated security with a clearing agency, or a transferee or pledgee of a security under subsections (4) to (10), is a holder of the security and shall be deemed to have possession of the security so deposited, transferred or pledged, as the case may be, for all purposes.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;125&quot;,ss=&quot;9&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;125&quot;,ss=&quot;9&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Not registration</MarginalNote><Label>(9)</Label><Text>A transfer or pledge under subsections (4) to (10) does not constitute a registration of transfer under sections 130 to 137.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;125&quot;,ss=&quot;10&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;125&quot;,ss=&quot;10&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Error in records</MarginalNote><Label>(10)</Label><Text>That entries made in the records of the clearing agency as provided in subsection (4) are not appropriate does not affect the validity or effect of the entries nor the liabilities or obligations of the clearing agency to any person adversely affected thereby.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;126&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;126&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Right to reclaim possession</MarginalNote><Label>126.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;126&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A person against whom the transfer of a security is wrongful for any reason, including the person’s incapacity, may, against anyone except a <Language xml:lang="la">bona fide</Language> purchaser,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;126&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>reclaim possession of the security or obtain possession of any new security evidencing all or part of the same rights; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;126&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>claim damages.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;126&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;126&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Recovery where unauthorized endorsement</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If the transfer of a security is wrongful by reason of an unauthorized endorsement, the owner may reclaim possession of the security or a new security even from a <Language xml:lang="la">bona fide</Language> purchaser if the ineffectiveness of the purported endorsement is asserted against the purchaser under section 121.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;126&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;126&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Remedies</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The right to reclaim possession of a security may be specially enforced, its transfer may be restrained and the security may be impounded pending litigation.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;127&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;127&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Right to requisites for registration</MarginalNote><Label>127.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;127&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Unless otherwise agreed, a transferor shall, on demand, supply a purchaser with proof of the transferor’s authority to transfer a security or with any other requisite that is necessary to obtain registration of the transfer of a security, but if the transfer is not for value, it is not necessary for a transferor to prove authority to transfer unless the purchaser pays the reasonable and necessary costs of the proof and transfer.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;127&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;127&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Rescission of transfer</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If a transferor fails to comply with a demand under subsection (1) within a reasonable time, the purchaser may reject or rescind the transfer.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;128&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;128&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Seizure of security</MarginalNote><Label>128.</Label><Text>No seizure of a security or other interest evidenced thereby is effective until the person making the seizure obtains possession of the security.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;129&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;129&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">No conversion if good faith delivery</MarginalNote><Label>129.</Label><Text>An agent or bailee who in good faith, including observance of reasonable commercial standards if the agent or bailee is in the business of buying, selling or otherwise dealing with securities of a company, has received securities and sold, pledged or delivered them according to the instructions of the agent’s or bailee’s principal is not liable for conversion or for participation in breach of fiduciary duty even though the principal has no right to dispose of the securities.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;130&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;130&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Duty to register transfer</MarginalNote><Label>130.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;130&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to Part VII, where a security in registered form is presented for transfer, the issuer shall register the transfer if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;130&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the security is endorsed by an appropriate person;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;130&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>reasonable assurance is given that the endorsement is genuine and effective;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;130&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the issuer has no duty to inquire into adverse claims or has discharged any such duty;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;130&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>all applicable laws relating to the collection of taxes have been complied with;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;130&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the transfer is rightful or is to a <Language xml:lang="la">bona fide</Language> purchaser; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;130&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the fee, if any, referred to in subsection 89(2) has been paid.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;130&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;130&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Liability for delay</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where an issuer has a duty to register a transfer of a security, the issuer is liable to the person presenting it for registration for any loss resulting from any unreasonable delay in registration or from the failure or refusal to register the transfer.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;131&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;131&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Assurance of endorsements</MarginalNote><Label>131.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;131&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>An issuer may require an assurance that each necessary endorsement on a security is genuine and effective by requiring a guarantee of the signature of the person endorsing the security and by requiring</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;131&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if the endorsement is by an agent, reasonable assurance of authority to sign;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;131&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if the endorsement is by a fiduciary, evidence of appointment or incumbency;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;131&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if there is more than one fiduciary, reasonable assurance that all who are required to sign have done so; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;131&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in any other case, assurance that corresponds as closely as practicable to the foregoing.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;131&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;131&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Definition of <DefinedTermEn>guarantee of the signature</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>For the purposes of subsection (1), <DefinedTermEn>guarantee of the signature</DefinedTermEn> means a guarantee signed by or on behalf of a person whom the issuer believes, on reasonable grounds, to be a responsible person.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;131&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;131&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Standards</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>An issuer may adopt reasonable standards to determine responsible persons for the purposes of subsection (2).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;131&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;131&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Definition of <DefinedTermEn>evidence of appointment or incumbency</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>For the purposes of paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>), <DefinedTermEn>evidence of appointment or incumbency</DefinedTermEn> means</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;131&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of a fiduciary appointed by a court and referred to in subsection 100(1), a copy of the certified court order referred to in subsection 100(1) and dated not earlier than sixty days before the day a security is presented for transfer; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;131&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of any other fiduciary, a copy of a document showing the appointment or other evidence believed by the issuer to be appropriate.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;131&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;131&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Standards</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>An issuer may adopt reasonable standards with respect to evidence referred to in paragraph (4)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;131&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;131&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">No notice to issuer</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>An issuer is deemed not to have notice of the contents of any document referred to in subsection (4) that is obtained by the issuer except to the extent that the contents relate directly to appointment or incumbency.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;132&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;132&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice from additional documentation</MarginalNote><Label>132.</Label><Text>If an issuer, in relation to a transfer, demands assurance other than an assurance specified in subsection 131(1) and obtains a copy of a will, trust or partnership agreement or a by-law or similar document, the issuer is deemed to have notice of all matters contained therein affecting the transfer.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;133&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;133&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limited duty of inquiry</MarginalNote><Label>133.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;133&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>An issuer to whom a security is presented for registration has a duty to inquire into adverse claims if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;133&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the issuer receives written notice of an adverse claim at a time and in a manner that provides the issuer with a reasonable opportunity to act on it before the issue of a new, reissued or re-registered security and the notice discloses the name and address of the claimant, the registered owner and the issue of which the security is a part; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;133&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the issuer is deemed to have notice of an adverse claim from a document that it obtained under section 132.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;133&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;133&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Discharge of duty</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>An issuer may discharge a duty of inquiry by any reasonable means, including notifying an adverse claimant by registered mail sent to the address provided by the adverse claimant or, if no such address has been provided, to the adverse claimant’s residence or regular place of business, that a security has been presented for registration of transfer by a named person and that the transfer will be registered unless, within thirty days after the date of mailing of the notice, either</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;133&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the issuer is served with a restraining order or other order of a court, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;133&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the issuer is provided with an indemnity bond sufficient in the issuer’s judgment to protect the issuer and any registrar, transfer agent or other agent of the issuer from any loss that may be incurred by any of them as a result of complying with the adverse claim.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;134&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;134&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Inquiry into adverse claims</MarginalNote><Label>134.</Label><Text>Unless an issuer is deemed to have notice of an adverse claim from a document that it obtained under section 132 or has received notice of an adverse claim under subsection 133(1), if a security presented for registration is endorsed by the appropriate person, the issuer has no duty to inquire into adverse claims and, in particular,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;134&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an issuer registering a security in the name of a person who is a fiduciary or who is described as a fiduciary is not bound to inquire into the existence, extent or correct description of the fiduciary relationship and thereafter the issuer may assume without inquiry that the newly registered owner continues to be the fiduciary until the issuer receives written notice that the fiduciary is no longer acting as such with respect to the particular security;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;134&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an issuer registering a transfer on an endorsement by a fiduciary has no duty to inquire into whether the transfer is made in compliance with the document or with the law of the jurisdiction governing the fiduciary relationship; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;134&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an issuer is deemed not to have notice of the contents of any court record or any registered document even if the record or document is in the issuer’s possession and even if the transfer is made on the endorsement of a fiduciary to the fiduciary specifically or to the fiduciary’s nominee.</Text></Paragraph></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;135&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;135&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Duration of notice of adverse claim</MarginalNote><Label>135.</Label><Text>A written notice of adverse claim received by an issuer is effective for twelve months after the day it was received unless the notice is renewed in writing.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;136&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;136&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limitation on issuer’s liability</MarginalNote><Label>136.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;136&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Except as otherwise provided in any applicable law relating to the collection of taxes, an issuer is not liable to the owner or any other person who incurs a loss as a result of the registration of a transfer of a security if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;136&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the necessary endorsements were on or with the security; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;136&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the issuer had no duty to inquire into adverse claims or had discharged any such duty.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;136&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;136&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Duty of issuer on default</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If an issuer has registered a transfer of a security to a person not entitled to it, the issuer shall on demand deliver a like security to the owner unless</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;136&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the issuer is not liable by virtue of subsection (1);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;136&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the owner is precluded by subsection 137(1) from asserting any claim; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;136&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the delivery would result in over-issue in respect of which section 101 applies.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;137&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;137&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Lost or stolen security</MarginalNote><Label>137.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;137&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where a security has been lost, apparently destroyed or wrongfully taken, and the owner fails to notify the issuer of that fact by giving the issuer written notice of the owner’s adverse claim within a reasonable time after the owner knows of the loss, destruction or taking, then, if the issuer has registered a transfer of the security before receiving the notice, the owner is precluded from asserting against the issuer any claim to a new security.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;137&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;137&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Duty to issue new security</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where the owner of a security claims that the security has been lost, destroyed or wrongfully taken, the issuer shall issue a new security in place of the original security if the owner</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;137&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>so requests before the issuer has notice that the security has been acquired by a <Language xml:lang="la">bona fide</Language> purchaser;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;137&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>provides the issuer with a sufficient indemnity bond; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;137&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>satisfies any other reasonable requirements imposed by the issuer.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;137&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;137&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Duty to register transfer</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>If, after the issue of a new security under subsection (2), a <Language xml:lang="la">bona fide</Language> purchaser of the original security presents the original security for registration of transfer, the issuer shall register the transfer unless registration would result in over-issue in respect of which section 101 applies.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;137&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;137&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Right of issuer to recover</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>In addition to the rights that an issuer has by reason of an indemnity bond, the issuer may recover the new security issued under subsection (2) from the person to whom it was issued or any person taking under that person other than a <Language xml:lang="la">bona fide</Language> purchaser.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;138&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;138&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Authenticating agent’s duty</MarginalNote><Label>138.</Label><Text>An authenticating trustee, registrar, transfer agent or other agent of an issuer has, in respect of the issue, registration of transfer and cancellation of a security of the issuer,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;138&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a duty to the issuer to exercise good faith and reasonable diligence; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;138&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the same obligations to the holder or owner of a security and the same rights, privileges and immunities as the issuer.</Text></Paragraph></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;139&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;139&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice to agent</MarginalNote><Label>139.</Label><Text>Notice to an authenticating trustee, registrar, transfer agent or other agent of an issuer is notice to the issuer in respect of the functions performed by the agent.</Text></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="1"><Label>PART VI</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">CORPORATE GOVERNANCE</TitleText></Heading><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_I&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><Label>Division I</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_I&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Shareholders and Policyholders</TitleText></Heading><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_I&quot;,gc=&quot;s_140&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_I&quot;,gc=&quot;s_140&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Place of Meetings</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;140&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;140&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Place of meetings</MarginalNote><Label>140.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;140&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Meetings of shareholders or policyholders of a company shall be held at the place within Canada provided for in the by-laws of the company or, in the absence of any such provision, at the place within Canada that the directors determine.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;140&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;140&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Participation by electronic means</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Unless the by-laws provide otherwise, any person who is entitled to attend a meeting of shareholders or policyholders may participate in the meeting by means of a telephonic, electronic or other communication facility that permits all participants to communicate adequately with each other during the meeting if the company makes one available. A person who is participating in a meeting by one of those means is deemed for the purposes of this Act to be present at the meeting.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;140&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;140&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations respecting the manner of and conditions for participating in a meeting by means of a telephonic, electronic or other communication facility that permits all participants to communicate adequately with each other during the meeting.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 140;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 228.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_I&quot;,gc=&quot;s_141&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_I&quot;,gc=&quot;s_141&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Calling Meetings</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;141&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;141&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Calling meetings</MarginalNote><Label>141.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;141&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The directors of a company</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;141&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>shall, after the meeting called pursuant to subsection 50(1) or (2), call the first annual meeting of shareholders and policyholders of the company, which meeting must be held not later than six months after the end of the first financial year of the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;141&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>shall subsequently call an annual meeting of shareholders and policyholders, which meeting must be held not later than six months after the end of each financial year; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;141&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>may at any time call a special meeting of shareholders or policyholders.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;141&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;141&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Order to delay calling annual meeting</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Despite subsection (1), the company may apply to the court for an order extending the time for calling an annual meeting.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;141&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;141&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Obligation to notify Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The company shall give notice of the application to the Superintendent before any hearing concerning the application and shall provide the Superintendent with a copy of any order that is issued.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;141&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;141&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Superintendent’s right to appear</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>The Superintendent is entitled to appear and be heard in person or by counsel at any hearing concerning the application.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 141;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 229.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_I&quot;,gc=&quot;s_142&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_I&quot;,gc=&quot;s_142&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Record Dates</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;142&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;142&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Authority to fix record date</MarginalNote><Label>142.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;142&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The directors may in advance fix a record date, that is within the prescribed period, for the determination of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;142&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>shareholders who are entitled to receive payment of a dividend;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;142&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>shareholders or policyholders who are entitled to participate in a liquidation distribution;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;142&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>shareholders</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;142&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>who are entitled to receive notice of a meeting of shareholders or a meeting of shareholders and policyholders,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;142&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>who are entitled to vote at a meeting of shareholders or at a meeting of shareholders and policyholders, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;142&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>for any other purpose;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;142&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>policyholders who are entitled to</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;142&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>receive notice of a meeting of policyholders or a meeting of shareholders and policyholders, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;142&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>vote at a meeting of policyholders or at a meeting of shareholders and policyholders; or</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;142&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>policyholders for any other purpose except</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;142&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>the right to receive payment of a policy dividend or bonus,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;142&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>any purpose where the determination of policyholders is governed by contract, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;142&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>the right to receive benefits in respect of the conversion of a mutual company into a company with common shares.</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;142&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;142&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Determination of record date — shareholders</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If no record date is fixed,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;142&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the record date for the determination of shareholders who are entitled to receive notice of a meeting of shareholders or a meeting of shareholders and policyholders is</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;142&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>at the close of business on the day immediately preceding the day on which the notice is given, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;142&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>if no notice is given, the day on which the meeting is held; and</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;142&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the record date for the determination of shareholders for any other purpose, other than to establish a shareholder’s right to vote, is at the close of business on the day on which the directors pass a resolution in respect of that purpose.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;142&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;142&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Determination of record date — policyholders</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>If no record date is fixed,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;142&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the record date for the determination of policyholders who are entitled to receive notice of a meeting of policyholders or a meeting of shareholders and policyholders is</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;142&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>at the close of business on the day immediately preceding the day on which the notice is given, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;142&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>if no notice is given, the day on which the meeting is held;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;142&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the record date for the determination of policyholders entitled to vote at a meeting is the day on which the meeting is held; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;142&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the record date for the determination of policyholders for any other purpose is at the close of business on the day on which the directors pass a resolution in respect of that purpose.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;142&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;142&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of record date — shareholders</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>If a record date is fixed and unless notice of the record date is waived in writing by every holder of a share of the class or series affected whose name is set out in the securities register at the close of business on the day on which the directors fix the record date, notice of the record date shall be given within the prescribed period by</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;142&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>advertisement in a newspaper in general circulation in the place where the company’s head office is situated and in each place in Canada where the company has a transfer agent or where a transfer of its shares may be recorded; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;142&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>written notice to each stock exchange in Canada on which the company’s shares are listed for trading.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 142;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 186;</li><li> 1999, c. 1, s. 1;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 230.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_I&quot;,gc=&quot;s_143&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_I&quot;,gc=&quot;s_143&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Notices of Meetings</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;143&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of meeting</MarginalNote><Label>143.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Notice of the time and place of a meeting of a company’s shareholders or policyholders shall be sent within the prescribed period to</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>each shareholder entitled to vote at the meeting;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>each policyholder who is determined under subsection (1.4) or (1.6) to be entitled to notice if no business referred to in subparagraphs (<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)(i) to (iii) is to be dealt with;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>each policyholder entitled to vote at the meeting if any of the following business is to be dealt with:</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>authorizing the company to apply to the Minister for approval of a mutualization proposal or amalgamation agreement,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>confirming a by-law changing the rights of policyholders to vote at meetings or the province in which the head office of the company is situated, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>approving an agreement setting out the terms and means of effecting the transfer of all or substantially all of the company’s policies or the reinsurance of all or substantially all of the company’s policies;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>each director;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the auditor of the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the actuary of the company; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the Superintendent.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;1.001&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;1.001&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(1.001)</Label><Text>In the case of a company that is not a distributing company and does not have any policyholders entitled to vote, notice may be sent within any shorter period specified in its by-laws.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;1.01&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;1.01&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Number of eligible votes</MarginalNote><Label>(1.01)</Label><Text>A converted company in respect of which subsection 407(4) applies or a company to which subsection 407(5) applies shall set out in the notice of a meeting the number of eligible votes, as defined under subsection 164.08(1), that may be cast at the meeting as of the record date for determining the shareholders or policyholders entitled to receive the notice of meeting or, if there are to be separate votes of shareholders or policyholders at the meeting, the number of eligible votes, as defined in that subsection, in respect of each separate vote to be held at the meeting.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Waiver of notice</MarginalNote><Label>(1.1)</Label><Text>A company is not required under subsection (1) to send to a person notice of a meeting if the person waives notice of the meeting. That waiver may be in any manner.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;1.2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;1.2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Attendance constitutes waiver</MarginalNote><Label>(1.2)</Label><Text>A person who attends a meeting of shareholders or policyholders is deemed to have waived notice of the meeting, except where the person attends the meeting for the express purpose of objecting to the transaction of any business on the grounds that the meeting is not lawfully called.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;1.3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;1.3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Practices of policyholder notification</MarginalNote><Label>(1.3)</Label><Text>A company shall adopt and follow either of the two practices set out in subsections (1.4) and (1.5) for the notification of policyholders under paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;1.4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;1.4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">First practice</MarginalNote><Label>(1.4)</Label><Text>One practice requires the company to send the notice to each policyholder entitled to vote at the meeting. If that practice is adopted, each of those policyholders is entitled to notice under paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;1.5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;1.5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Second practice</MarginalNote><Label>(1.5)</Label><Text>The other practice requires the company, at the time of the application for or issuance of a policy that gives the policyholder the right to vote at meetings of the shareholders and policyholders of the company, and after that time at least once every three years,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;1.5&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>to advise the policyholder of the policyholder’s right to attend and to vote in person or by proxy at those meetings; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;1.5&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>to provide the policyholder with a form on which the policyholder may indicate whether the policyholder wants to receive notices of those meetings.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;1.6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;1.6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice under second practice</MarginalNote><Label>(1.6)</Label><Text>If a company chooses the practice under subsection (1.5), each policyholder entitled to vote at a meeting is entitled to notice under paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) if, within three years before the record date fixed under subparagraph 142(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)(i) or determined under paragraph 142(3)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>), they complete and return to the company the form referred to in paragraph (1.5)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) indicating that they want to receive notice or they indicate to the satisfaction of the company that they want to receive notice.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exemption</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The Minister may exempt a company from the application of paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>) with respect to business consisting of the approval of an amalgamation agreement, having regard to the size of the company and of the companies or bodies corporate with which it proposes to amalgamate.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Publication in newspaper</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>In addition to the notice required under subsection (1),</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>where any class of shares of a company is publicly traded on a recognized stock exchange in Canada, notice of the time and place of the meeting of shareholders shall be published once a week for at least four consecutive weeks before the date of the meeting in a newspaper in the place where the head office of the company is situated and in each place in Canada where the company has a transfer agent or where a transfer of the company’s shares may be recorded; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>notice of the time and place of the meeting of policyholders of the company and, where a company follows the practice under subsection (1.5), information on the means by which any policyholder can receive the notice required under subsection (1), shall be published once a week for at least four consecutive weeks before the date of the meeting in a newspaper in the place where the head office of the company is situated and in each region of Canada in which more than one per cent of the total number of policyholders entitled to vote at the meeting reside.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice not required — shareholders</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Notice of a meeting is not required to be sent to shareholders who are not registered on the records of the company or the company’s transfer agent on the record date fixed under subparagraph 142(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)(i) or determined under paragraph 142(2)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice not required — policyholders</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>Notice of a meeting at which business referred to in paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>) is to be dealt with is not required to be sent to policyholders who become policyholders after the record date fixed under subparagraph 142(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)(i) or determined under paragraph 142(3)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;143&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effect of default</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>Failure to receive a notice of a meeting of shareholders or policyholders does not deprive a shareholder or policyholder of the right to vote at the meeting.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 143;</li><li> 1993, c. 34, s. 78;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 187;</li><li> 1999, c. 1, s. 2;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 370;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 231.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;144&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;144&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of adjourned meeting</MarginalNote><Label>144.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;144&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If a meeting of shareholders or policyholders is adjourned for less than thirty days, it is not necessary, unless the by-laws otherwise provide, to give notice of the adjourned meeting, other than by announcement at the earliest meeting that is adjourned.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;144&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;144&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice after longer adjournment</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If a meeting of shareholders or policyholders is adjourned by one or more adjournments for a total of thirty days or more, notice of the continuation of the meeting shall be given as for an original meeting but, unless the meeting is adjourned by one or more adjournments for a total of more than ninety days, subsection 164.03(1) does not apply.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 144;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 188.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;145&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;145&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Special business</MarginalNote><Label>145.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;145&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>All matters dealt with at a special meeting of shareholders or policyholders or at an annual meeting of shareholders and policyholders are deemed to be special business, except that special business does not include consideration of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;145&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the financial statements;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;145&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the auditor’s report;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;145&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the actuary’s report;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;145&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the election of directors;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;145&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the remuneration of directors and reappointment of the incumbent auditor; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;145&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the description of the roles of the actuary and the auditor in the preparation and audit of the financial statements.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;145&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;145&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of special business</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Notice of a meeting of shareholders or policyholders at which special business is to be transacted must</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;145&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>state the nature of the special business in sufficient detail to permit a shareholder or policyholder to form a reasoned judgment thereon;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;145&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>contain the text of any special resolution to be submitted to the meeting; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;145&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>state, where a management proxy circular is sent to shareholders concurrently with the notice, that a policyholder is entitled on request to receive a copy of the management proxy circular.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;145&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;145&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exemption</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The Superintendent may exempt a company from the application of paragraph (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) in relation to policyholders, on condition that, instead of sending the policyholders the text of a special resolution to be submitted to a meeting, the company send the policyholders a summary of the text.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 145;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 189.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;146&quot;"><Label>146.</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 1997, c. 15, s. 190]</Repealed></Text></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_I&quot;,gc=&quot;s_147&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_I&quot;,gc=&quot;s_147&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Shareholder and Policyholder Proposals</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;147&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Proposal</MarginalNote><Label>147.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to subsections (1.1) and (1.2), a registered holder or beneficial owner of shares that may be voted — or a policyholder entitled to vote — at an annual meeting of shareholders and policyholders may</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>submit to the company notice of any matter that they propose to raise at the meeting (in this section and section 148 referred to as a “proposal”); and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>discuss at the meeting any matter in respect of which they would have been entitled to submit a proposal.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Eligibility to submit proposal</MarginalNote><Label>(1.1)</Label><Text>To be eligible to submit a proposal a person shall</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>for at least the prescribed period be the registered holder or beneficial owner of at least the prescribed number of the company’s outstanding shares;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>have the support of persons who, in the aggregate and including or not including the person who submits the proposal, have for at least the prescribed period been the registered holders or beneficial owners of at least the prescribed number of the company’s outstanding shares; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>be a policyholder entitled to vote at an annual meeting of the company’s shareholders and policyholders.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;1.2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;1.2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Information to be provided</MarginalNote><Label>(1.2)</Label><Text>A proposal submitted by a registered holder or beneficial owner is to be accompanied by the following information:</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;1.2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the name and address of the person submitting the proposal and the names and addresses of their supporters, if any; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;1.2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the number of shares held or owned by the person and their supporters, if any, and the date that the shares were acquired.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;1.3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;1.3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Information not part of proposal</MarginalNote><Label>(1.3)</Label><Text>The information provided under subsection (1.2) does not form part of a proposal or of the supporting statement referred to in subsection (3) and is not to be included for the purpose of the prescribed maximum number of words referred to in subsection (3).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;1.4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;1.4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Proof may be required</MarginalNote><Label>(1.4)</Label><Text>If the company requests within the prescribed period that a person provide proof that they are eligible to submit a proposal, the person shall within the prescribed period provide proof that they meet the requirements of subsection (1.1).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Circulation of proposal</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A company shall attach any proposal of a shareholder or policyholder submitted for consideration at a meeting of shareholders and policyholders to the notice of the meeting.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Supporting statement</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>At the request of the person who submits a proposal, the company shall attach to the notice of the meeting the person’s statement in support of the proposal and their name and address. The statement and proposal together are not to exceed the prescribed maximum number of words.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Nomination of directors</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>A proposal may include nominations for the election of directors if it is signed by</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of nominations for the directors to be elected by shareholders, one or more registered holders or beneficial owners of shares representing in the aggregate not less than 5% of the shares of the company or 5% of the shares of a class of its shares entitled to vote at the meeting at which the proposal is to be presented; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of nominations for the directors to be elected by policyholders, the lesser of 250 policyholders and 1% of the policyholders who are entitled to vote at the meeting.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Conditions precedent for proposals</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>A company is not required to comply with subsections (2) and (3) if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the proposal is not submitted to the company at least the prescribed number of days before the anniversary date of the notice of meeting that was sent to shareholders and policyholders in respect of the previous annual meeting of shareholders and policyholders;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>it clearly appears that the primary purpose of the proposal is to enforce a personal claim or redress a personal griev­ance against the company or its directors, officers or security holders;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;b.1&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b.1</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>it clearly appears that the proposal does not relate in a significant way to the business or affairs of the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the person submitting the proposal failed within the prescribed period before the company receives their proposal to present, in person or by proxy, at a meeting of shareholders or policyholders a proposal that at their request had been attached to a notice of meeting;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>substantially the same proposal was set out in or attached to a dissident’s proxy circular or attached to a notice of meeting relating to, and was presented to shareholders or policyholders at, a meeting of shareholders or policyholders held within the prescribed period before the receipt of the proposal and did not receive the prescribed minimum amount of support at the meeting;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the rights conferred by subsections (1) to (4) are being abused to secure publicity;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of a proposal submitted by a policyholder that relates to business that is referred to in paragraph 143(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>), the proposal is not signed by at least five hundred policyholders entitled to vote at the meeting to which the proposal is to be presented, or one per cent of the total number of those policyholders, whichever is lesser;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of any other proposal submitted by a policyholder, the proposal is not signed by at least one hundred policyholders entitled to vote at the meeting to which the proposal is to be presented;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;h&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">h</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of a proposal submitted by a policyholder, the proposal</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;h&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>relates to the management of the ordinary business and affairs of the company, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;h&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>would, if implemented, result in a change in the character or direction of the company that would have a material adverse effect on the ability of the company to meet the reasonable expectations of the company’s participating policyholders as to the net cost of their insurance; or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;h&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 1996, c. 6, s. 72]</Repealed></Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">i</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of a proposal submitted by a policyholder or a shareholder of a mutual company, the proposal would result in the mutual company being converted into a company with common shares.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;5.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;5.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Company may refuse to include proposal</MarginalNote><Label>(5.1)</Label><Text>If a person who submits a proposal fails to continue to hold or own shares in accordance with paragraph (1.1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) or, as the case may be, does not continue to have the support of persons who are in the aggregate the registered holders or beneficial owners of the prescribed number of shares in accordance with paragraph (1.1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) until the end of the meeting, the company is not required to attach any proposal submitted by that person to a notice of meeting for any meeting held within the prescribed period after the day of the meeting.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;147&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Immunity for proposal and statement</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>No company or person acting on behalf of a company incurs any liability by reason only of circulating a proposal or statement in compliance with subsections (2) and (3).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 147;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 72;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 191;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 371(F);</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 232.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;148&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;148&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of refusal</MarginalNote><Label>148.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;148&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If a company refuses to attach a proposal to a notice of a meeting, it shall in writing notify the person submitting the proposal of its intention not to attach the proposal to the notice of the meeting and of the reasons for the refusal. It shall notify the person within the prescribed period after either the day on which it receives the proposal or, if it has requested proof under subsection 147(1.4), the day on which it receives the proof.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;148&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;148&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application to court</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>On the application of a person submitting a proposal who claims to be aggrieved by a company’s refusal under subsection (1), a court may restrain the holding of the meeting at which the proposal is sought to be presented and make any further order that it thinks fit.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;148&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;148&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Idem</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A company or any person claiming to be aggrieved by a proposal may apply to a court for an order permitting the company not to attach the proposal to the notice of the meeting, and the court, if it is satisfied that subsection 147(5) applies, may make such order as it thinks fit.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;148&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;148&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice to Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>An applicant under subsection (2) or (3) shall give the Superintendent written notice of the application and the Superintendent may appear and be heard at the hearing of the application in person or by counsel.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 148;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 233.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_I&quot;,gc=&quot;s_149&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_I&quot;,gc=&quot;s_149&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Shareholder and Policyholder Lists</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;149&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;149&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Lists of shareholders and policyholders</MarginalNote><Label>149.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;149&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company shall prepare an alphabetical list</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;149&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>of shareholders entitled to receive notice of a meeting showing the number of shares held by each shareholder</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;149&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>if a record date is fixed under subparagraph 142(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)(i), no later than 10 days after that date, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;149&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>if no record date is fixed, on the record date determined under paragraph 142(2)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>); and</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;149&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>of policyholders entitled to vote at a meeting</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;149&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>if a record date is fixed under subparagraph 142(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)(ii), no later than the day on which the meeting is held, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;149&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>if no record date is fixed, on the record date determined under paragraph 142(3)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>).</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;149&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;149&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shareholder voting list</MarginalNote><Label>(1.1)</Label><Text>The company shall prepare an alphabetical list of shareholders entitled to vote as of the record date showing the number of shares held by each shareholder</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;149&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if a record date is fixed under subparagraph 142(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)(ii), no later than 10 days after that date; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;149&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if no record date is fixed under subparagraph 142(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)(ii), no later than 10 days after a record date is fixed under subparagraph 142(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)(i) or no later than the record date determined under paragraph 142(2)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>), as the case may be.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;149&quot;,ss=&quot;1.2&quot;"><Label>(1.2)</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 2005, c. 54, s. 234]</Repealed></Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;149&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;149&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Entitlement to vote — shareholders</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Subject to section 164.08, a shareholder whose name appears on a list prepared under subsection (1.1) is entitled to vote the shares shown opposite their name.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;149&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;149&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Entitlement to vote — policyholders</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A policyholder whose name appears on a list prepared under paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) is entitled to vote at the meeting to which the list relates.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;149&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;149&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Examination of shareholder list</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>A shareholder or policyholder may examine the list of shareholders</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;149&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>during usual business hours at the head office of the company or at the place where its central securities register is maintained; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;149&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>at the meeting of shareholders for which the list was prepared.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;149&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;149&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Verification of right of policyholder to vote</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>A shareholder or policyholder of a company may, at the meeting of policyholders for which the list referred to in subsection (1) was prepared, require the company to verify from that list whether a person identified both by name and by some other distinguishing feature is entitled to vote at that meeting.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 149;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 192;</li><li> 1999, c. 1, s. 3;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 234.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_I&quot;,gc=&quot;s_150&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_I&quot;,gc=&quot;s_150&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Quorum</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;150&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;150&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shareholders</MarginalNote><Label>150.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;150&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Unless the by-laws otherwise provide, a quorum of shareholders is present at a meeting of shareholders if the holders of a majority of the shares who are entitled to vote at the meeting are present in person or represented by proxyholders.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;150&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;150&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Policyholders</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Unless the by-laws otherwise provide, a quorum of policyholders is present at a meeting of policyholders if at least five hundred policyholders who are entitled to vote at the meeting, or one per cent of the total number of those policyholders, whichever is lesser, are present in person or represented by proxyholders.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;150&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;150&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shareholders and policyholders</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Unless the by-laws otherwise provide, a quorum of shareholders and policyholders is present at a meeting of shareholders and policyholders if the holders of a majority of the shares and at least five hundred policyholders, or one per cent of the total number of policyholders, whichever is lesser, who are entitled to vote at the meeting are present in person or represented by proxyholders.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;150&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;150&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Quorum at opening</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>If a quorum is present at the opening of a meeting of shareholders or policyholders, the shareholders or policyholders present may, unless the by-laws otherwise provide, proceed with the business of the meeting, notwithstanding that a quorum is not present throughout the meeting.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;150&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;150&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">No quorum at opening</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>If a quorum is not present at the opening of a meeting of shareholders or policyholders, the shareholders or policyholders present may adjourn the meeting to a fixed time and place but may not transact any other business.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 150;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 372.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;151&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;151&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">One shareholder meeting</MarginalNote><Label>151.</Label><Text>If a company has only one shareholder, or only one holder of any class or series of shares, the shareholder present in person or represented by a proxyholder constitutes a meeting of shareholders or a meeting of shareholders of that class or series.</Text></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_I&quot;,gc=&quot;s_152&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_I&quot;,gc=&quot;s_152&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Voting</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;152&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;152&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">One share — one vote</MarginalNote><Label>152.</Label><Text>Subject to section 164.08, if a share of a company entitles the holder of the share to vote at a meeting of shareholders or shareholders and policyholders, that share entitles the shareholder to one vote at the meeting.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 152;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 373.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;153&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;153&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">One vote for each participating policyholder</MarginalNote><Label>153.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;153&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection 149(3), the holder of one or more participating policies issued by a company is entitled to attend a meeting of policyholders or shareholders and policyholders of the company and is entitled to one vote at that meeting.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;153&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;153&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Notwithstanding subsection (1) but subject to subsection 149(3), the holder of a participating policy that was issued by a former-Act company before June 1, 1992 is entitled to more than one vote, or to a fraction of a vote, at a meeting of policyholders or shareholders and policyholders of the company in accordance with the terms of the policy or the provisions of the incorporating instrument or the by-laws of the company that had not been repealed and had not otherwise ceased to have effect before that date.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 153;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 193.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;154&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;154&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Other policyholders entitled to vote</MarginalNote><Label>154.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;154&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection 149(3), the holder of one or more policies, other than participating policies, issued by a company is entitled to attend a meeting of policyholders or shareholders and policyholders of the company, and is entitled to one vote at that meeting, where</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;154&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the terms of one or more of those policies entitle the policyholder to vote at the meeting; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;154&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the by-laws of the company entitle the policyholder to vote at the meeting.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;154&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;154&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Notwithstanding subsection (1) but subject to subsection 149(3), the holder of a policy, other than a participating policy, that was issued by a former-Act company before June 1, 1992 is entitled to more than one vote, or to a fraction of a vote, at a meeting of policyholders or shareholders and policyholders of the company in accordance with the terms of the policy or the provisions of the incorporating instrument or the by-laws of the company that had not been repealed and had not otherwise ceased to have effect before that date.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;154&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;154&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">One policyholder — one vote</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection 149(3), the holder of one or more participating policies issued by a company and one or more policies, other than participating policies, referred to in subsection (1)</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;154&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>is entitled to one vote as the holder of one or more participating policies and to another vote as the holder of one or more policies, other than participating policies, referred to in that subsection where this Act provides for participating policyholders to vote separately from other policyholders who are entitled to vote, or for those other policyholders to vote separately from participating policyholders;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;154&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>is not otherwise entitled to more than one vote at a meeting of policyholders; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;154&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>is not otherwise entitled to more than one vote at a meeting of shareholders and policyholders, unless the holder is also a shareholder, in which case the holder is entitled to one vote as a policyholder and is also entitled to vote his or her shares.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 154;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 194.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;155&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;155&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Representative shareholder or policyholder</MarginalNote><Label>155.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;155&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If an entity is a shareholder or policyholder of a company, the company shall recognize any natural person authorized by a resolution of the directors or governing body or similar authority of the entity to represent it at meetings of shareholders or policyholders of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;155&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;155&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Idem</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A natural person authorized under subsection (1) to represent an entity may exercise on behalf of the entity all the powers the entity could exercise if the entity were a natural person who was a shareholder or policyholder.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;156&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;156&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Joint shareholders or policyholders</MarginalNote><Label>156.</Label><Text>Unless the by-laws otherwise provide, if two or more persons hold shares or policies jointly, one of those holders present at a meeting of shareholders or policyholders may in the absence of the others vote the shares or policies, but if two or more of those persons who are present in person or represented by proxyholder vote, they shall vote as one on the shares or policies jointly held by them.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;157&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;157&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Voting by hands or ballot</MarginalNote><Label>157.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;157&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Unless the by-laws otherwise provide, voting at a meeting of shareholders or policyholders shall take place by show of hands except when a ballot is demanded by a shareholder, policyholder or proxyholder entitled to vote at the meeting.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;157&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;157&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Ballot</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A shareholder, policyholder or proxyholder may demand a ballot either before or after any vote by show of hands.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;157&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;157&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Electronic voting</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Despite subsection (1) and unless the by-laws provide otherwise, any vote referred to in that subsection may be held entirely by means of a telephonic, electronic or other communication facility if the company makes one available.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;157&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;157&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Voting while participating electronically</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Unless the by-laws provide otherwise, any person who is participating in a meeting of shareholders or policyholders under subsection 140(2) and entitled to vote at that meeting may vote by means of the telephonic, electronic or other communication facility that the company has made available for that purpose.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;157&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;157&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations respecting the manner of and conditions for voting at a meeting of shareholders or policyholders by means of a telephonic, electronic or other communication facility.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 157;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 235.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_I&quot;,gc=&quot;s_158&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_I&quot;,gc=&quot;s_158&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Resolution in lieu of Meeting</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;158&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;158&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Resolution in lieu of meeting</MarginalNote><Label>158.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;158&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Except where a written statement is submitted by a director under section 182 or by an auditor under subsection 344(1),</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;158&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a resolution in writing signed by all the shareholders and policyholders entitled to vote on that resolution at a meeting of shareholders or policyholders is as valid as if it had been passed at a meeting of the shareholders or policyholders; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;158&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a resolution in writing dealing with all matters required by this Act to be dealt with at a meeting of shareholders or policyholders, and signed by all the shareholders and policyholders entitled to vote at that meeting, satisfies all the requirements of this Act relating to meetings of shareholders or policyholders.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;158&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;158&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Filing resolution</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A copy of every resolution referred to in subsection (1) shall be kept with the minutes of the meetings of shareholders or policyholders.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;158&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;158&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Evidence</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Unless a ballot is demanded, an entry in the minutes of a meeting that the chairperson declared a resolution to be carried or defeated is in the absence of evidence to the contrary proof of that fact without proof of the number or proportion of votes recorded in favour of or against the resolution.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 158;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 236.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_I&quot;,gc=&quot;s_159&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_I&quot;,gc=&quot;s_159&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Requisitioned Meetings</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;159&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;159&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Requisitioned meeting</MarginalNote><Label>159.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;159&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Shareholders who together hold not less than 5 per cent of the issued and outstanding shares of a company that carry the right to vote at a meeting sought to be held may requisition the directors to call a meeting of shareholders or shareholders and policyholders for the purposes stated in the requisition.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;159&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;159&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Idem</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>At least five hundred policyholders entitled to vote at a meeting sought to be held, or one per cent of the total number of those policyholders, whichever is greater, may requisition the directors to call a meeting of policyholders or shareholders and policyholders for the purposes stated in the requisition.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;159&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;159&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Form</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A requisition referred to in subsection (1) or (2)</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;159&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>must state the business to be transacted at the meeting and must be sent to each director and to the head office of the company; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;159&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>may consist of several documents of like form, each signed by one or more shareholders or policyholders.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;159&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;159&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Directors calling meeting</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>On receipt of a requisition referred to in subsection (1) or (2), the directors shall call a meeting of shareholders or policyholders to transact the business stated in the requisition, unless</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;159&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a record date has been fixed under subparagraph 142(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)(i) or (<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)(i) and notice of it has been given under subsection 142(4);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;159&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the directors have called a meeting of shareholders or policyholders and have given notice thereof under section 143; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;159&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the business of the meeting as stated in the requisition includes matters described in paragraphs 147(5)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>), (<Emphasis style="italic">h</Emphasis>) and (<Emphasis style="italic">i</Emphasis>).</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;159&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;159&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shareholders’ and policyholders’ power</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>If the directors do not call a meeting within twenty-one days after receiving a requisition referred to in subsection (1) or (2), any shareholder or policyholder who signed the requisition may call the meeting.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;159&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;159&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Procedure</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>A meeting called under this section shall be called as nearly as possible in the manner in which meetings are to be called pursuant to the by-laws and this Act.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;159&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;159&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Reimbursement</MarginalNote><Label>(7)</Label><Text>Unless the shareholders or policyholders otherwise resolve at a meeting called under subsection (5), the company shall reimburse the shareholders or policyholders for any expenses reasonably incurred by them in requisitioning, calling and holding the meeting.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 159;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 195;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 237.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_I&quot;,gc=&quot;s_160&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_I&quot;,gc=&quot;s_160&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Powers of the Court</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;160&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;160&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Court may order meeting to be called</MarginalNote><Label>160.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;160&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A court may, on the application of a director, a shareholder or policyholder who is entitled to vote or the Superintendent, order a meeting to be called, held or conducted in the manner that the court directs if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;160&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>it is impracticable to call the meeting within the time or in the manner in which it is to be called;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;160&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>it is impracticable to conduct the meeting in the manner required by this Act or the by-laws; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;160&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the court thinks that the meeting ought to be called, held or conducted within the time or in the manner that it directs for any other reason.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;160&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;"><Label>(1.1)</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 2005, c. 54, s. 238]</Repealed></Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;160&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;160&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Varying quorum</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Without restricting the generality of subsection (1), a court may order that the quorum required by the by-laws or this Act be varied or dispensed with at a meeting called, held and conducted pursuant to this section.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;160&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;160&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Valid meeting</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A meeting called, held and conducted pursuant to this section is for all purposes a meeting of shareholders or policyholders of the company duly called, held and conducted.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 160;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 196;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 238.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;161&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;161&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Court review of election</MarginalNote><Label>161.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;161&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company or a shareholder, policyholder or director of a company may apply to a court to resolve any dispute in respect of the election or appointment of a director or an auditor of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;161&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;161&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Powers of court</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>On an application under subsection (1), a court may make any order it thinks fit including, without limiting the generality of the foregoing,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;161&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order restraining a director or auditor whose election or appointment is challenged from acting pending determination of the dispute;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;161&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order declaring the result of the disputed election or appointment;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;161&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order requiring a new election or appointment, and including in the order directions for the management of the business and affairs of the company until a new election is held or the new appointment is made; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;161&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order determining the voting rights of shareholders, persons claiming to own shares, policyholders and persons claiming to be policyholders.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;162&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;162&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice to Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>162.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;162&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A person who makes an application under subsection 160(1) or 161(1) shall give notice of the application to the Superintendent before the hearing and shall deliver a copy of the order of the court, if any, to the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;162&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;162&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Superintendent representation</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The Superintendent may appear and be heard in person or by counsel at the hearing of an application referred to in subsection (1).</Text></Subsection></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_I&quot;,gc=&quot;s_163&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_I&quot;,gc=&quot;s_163&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Pooling Agreements</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;163&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;163&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Pooling agreement</MarginalNote><Label>163.</Label><Text>A written agreement between two or more shareholders or policyholders may provide that in exercising voting rights the shares or policies held by them will be voted as provided in the agreement.</Text></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_I.1&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><Label>Division I.1</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_I.1&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Proxies</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;164&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Definitions</MarginalNote><Label>164.</Label><Text>The definitions in this section apply in this Division.</Text><Definition Code="se=&quot;164&quot;,df=&quot;{intermediary}{intermédiaire}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164&quot;,df=&quot;{intermediary}{intermédiaire}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>intermediary</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164&quot;,df=&quot;{intermediary}{intermédiaire}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>intermédiaire</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>intermediary</DefinedTermEn> means a person who holds a security on behalf of another person who is not the registered holder of the security, and includes</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;164&quot;,df=&quot;{intermediary}{intermédiaire}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a securities broker or dealer required to be registered to trade or deal in securities under the laws of any jurisdiction;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;164&quot;,df=&quot;{intermediary}{intermédiaire}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a securities depositary;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;164&quot;,df=&quot;{intermediary}{intermédiaire}&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a financial institution;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;164&quot;,df=&quot;{intermediary}{intermédiaire}&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in relation to a clearing agency, a securities dealer, trust company, association within the meaning of section 2 of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="C-41.01">Cooperative Credit Associations Act</XRefExternal>, bank or other person, including another clearing agency, on whose behalf the clearing agency or its nominee holds securities of an issuer;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;164&quot;,df=&quot;{intermediary}{intermédiaire}&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a trustee or administrator of a self-administered retirement savings plan, retirement income fund or education savings plan or another similar self-administered savings or investment plan registered under the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="I-3.3">Income Tax Act</XRefExternal>;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;164&quot;,df=&quot;{intermediary}{intermédiaire}&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a nominee of a person referred to in any of paragraphs (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>); and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;164&quot;,df=&quot;{intermediary}{intermédiaire}&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a person who performs functions similar to those performed by a person referred to in any of paragraphs (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>) and holds a security registered in their name, or in the name of their nominee, on behalf of another person who is not the registered holder of the security.</Text></Paragraph></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;164&quot;,df=&quot;{}{}&quot;"><Text><DefinedTermEn>registrant</DefinedTermEn><Repealed>[Repealed, 2005, c. 54, s. 239]</Repealed></Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;164&quot;,df=&quot;{solicit}{sollicitation}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164&quot;,df=&quot;{solicit}{sollicitation}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>solicit</DefinedTermEn> or <DefinedTermEn>solicitation</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164&quot;,df=&quot;{solicit}{sollicitation}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>sollicitation</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>solicit</DefinedTermEn> or <DefinedTermEn>solicitation</DefinedTermEn> includes</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;164&quot;,df=&quot;{solicit}{sollicitation}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a request for a proxy, whether or not accompanied by or included in a form of proxy,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;164&quot;,df=&quot;{solicit}{sollicitation}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a request to execute or not to execute a form of proxy or to revoke a proxy,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;164&quot;,df=&quot;{solicit}{sollicitation}&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the sending of a form of proxy or other communication to a shareholder or policyholder under circumstances reasonably calculated to result in the procurement, withholding or revocation of a proxy, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;164&quot;,df=&quot;{solicit}{sollicitation}&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the sending of a form of proxy to a shareholder or a policyholder under section 164.03,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedDefinition><Text>but does not include</Text></ContinuedDefinition><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;164&quot;,df=&quot;{solicit}{sollicitation}&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the sending of a form of proxy in response to an unsolicited request made by or on behalf of a shareholder or policyholder,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;164&quot;,df=&quot;{solicit}{sollicitation}&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the performance of administrative acts or professional services on behalf of a person soliciting a proxy,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;164&quot;,df=&quot;{solicit}{sollicitation}&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the sending by a registrant of the documents referred to in section 164.06, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;164&quot;,df=&quot;{solicit}{sollicitation}&quot;,p1=&quot;h&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">h</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a solicitation by a person in respect of shares of which that person is the beneficial owner.</Text></Paragraph></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;164&quot;,df=&quot;{solicitation by or on behalf of the management of a company}{sollicitation effectuée par la direction d’une société ou pour son compte}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164&quot;,df=&quot;{solicitation by or on behalf of the management of a company}{sollicitation effectuée par la direction d’une société ou pour son compte}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>solicitation by or on behalf of the management of a company</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164&quot;,df=&quot;{solicitation by or on behalf of the management of a company}{sollicitation effectuée par la direction d’une société ou pour son compte}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>sollicitation effectuée par la direction d’une société ou pour son compte</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>solicitation by or on behalf of the management of a company</DefinedTermEn> means a solicitation by any person pursuant to a resolution or instruction of, or with the acquiescence of, the directors or a committee of the directors of the company.</Text></Definition><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 164;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 197;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 239.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;164.01&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.01&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Appointing proxyholder</MarginalNote><Label>164.01</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.01&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A shareholder or policyholder who is entitled to vote at a meeting of shareholders or policyholders may, by executing a form of proxy, appoint a proxyholder or one or more alternate proxyholders, who are not required to be shareholders or policyholders, to attend and act at the meeting in the manner and to the extent authorized by the proxy and with the authority conferred by the proxy.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.01&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.01&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Execution of proxy</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A form of proxy shall be executed by a shareholder or policyholder or by a shareholder’s or policyholder’s attorney authorized in writing to do so.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.01&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.01&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limit on authority</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>No appointment of a proxyholder provides authority for the proxyholder to act in respect of the appointment of an auditor or the election of a director unless a nominee proposed in good faith for the appointment or election is named in the form of proxy, a management proxy circular, a dissident’s proxy circular or a proposal under subsection 147(1).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.01&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.01&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Required information</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>A form of proxy must indicate, in bold-face type, that the shareholder or policyholder by whom or on whose behalf it is executed may appoint a proxyholder, other than a person designated in the form of proxy, to attend and act on the shareholder’s or policyholder’s behalf at a meeting to which the proxy relates, and must contain instructions as to the manner in which the shareholder or policyholder may do so.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.01&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.01&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Validity of proxy</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>A proxy is valid only at the meeting in respect of which it is given or at a continuation of the meeting after an adjournment.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.01&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.01&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Revocation of proxy</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>A shareholder or policyholder may revoke a proxy</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;164.01&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>by depositing an instrument in writing executed by the shareholder or policyholder or by the shareholder’s or policyholder’s attorney authorized in writing to do so</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;164.01&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>at the head office of the company at any time up to and including the last business day before the day of a meeting, or a continuation of a meeting after an adjournment, at which the proxy is to be used, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;164.01&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>with the chairperson of the meeting on the day of the meeting or a continuation of the meeting after an adjournment; or</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;164.01&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in any other manner permitted by law.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 197.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;164.02&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.02&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Deposit of proxies</MarginalNote><Label>164.02</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.02&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The directors may specify, in a notice calling a meeting of shareholders or policyholders or a continuation of a meeting of shareholders or policyholders after an adjournment, a time before which executed forms of proxy to be used at the meeting or the continued meeting must be deposited with the company or its transfer agent.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.02&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.02&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Time for deposit of proxies</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The time specified for the deposit of forms of proxy may not precede the meeting or the continued meeting by more than</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;164.02&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>forty-eight hours, excluding Saturdays and holidays, in the case of forms of proxy executed by shareholders; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;164.02&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>ten days, in the case of forms of proxy executed by policyholders.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 197.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;164.03&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.03&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Mandatory solicitation</MarginalNote><Label>164.03</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.03&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection 144(2) and subsection (2), the management of a company shall, at the same time as they send notice of a meeting of shareholders and policyholders, send a form of proxy in prescribed form to each shareholder entitled to receive notice of the meeting and to each policyholder entitled to receive notice of the meeting under section 143.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.03&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.03&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The management of a company is not required to send a form of proxy to shareholders under subsection (1) if the company</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;164.03&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>is not a distributing company; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;164.03&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>has 50 or fewer shareholders who are entitled to vote at a meeting, two or more joint holders of a share being counted as one shareholder.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.03&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.03&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Optional solicitation</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The management of a company may send forms of proxy referred to in subsection (1) to policyholders who are entitled to vote at the meeting but not entitled to receive notice of the meeting under section 143, if the management</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;164.03&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>sends forms of proxy referred to in that subsection to all policyholders who are entitled to vote at the meeting but not entitled to receive notice of the meeting under that section; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;164.03&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>at the same time sends to each of the policyholders referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) a notice of the meeting as if those policyholders were persons entitled under that subsection to notice of the meeting.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.03&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.03&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Deeming rule for other provisions</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>For the purposes of this Act other than this section, if notices of a meeting are sent to policyholders under paragraph (3)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>), those policyholders are deemed to have been entitled under paragraph 143(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) to receive notice of the meeting.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 197;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 240.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;164.04&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.04&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Soliciting proxies</MarginalNote><Label>164.04</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.04&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A person shall not solicit proxies unless</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;164.04&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of solicitation by or on behalf of the management of a company, a management proxy circular in prescribed form, either as an appendix to or as a separate document accompanying the notice of the meeting, is sent to the auditor of the company and to each shareholder or policyholder whose proxy is solicited; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;164.04&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of any other solicitation, a dissident’s proxy circular in prescribed form stating the purposes of the solicitation is sent to the auditor of the company, to each shareholder or policyholder whose proxy is solicited and to the company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.04&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.04&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Copy to Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A person who sends a management proxy circular or dissident’s proxy circular shall at the same time file with the Superintendent</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;164.04&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of a management proxy circular, a copy of it together with a copy of the notice of meeting, form of proxy and any other documents for use in connection with the meeting; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;164.04&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of a dissident’s proxy circular, a copy of it together with a copy of the form of proxy and any other documents for use in connection with the meeting.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.04&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.04&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exemption by Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>On the application of an interested person, the Superintendent may, on any terms that the Superintendent thinks fit, exempt the person from any of the requirements of subsection (1) and section 164.03, and the exemption may be given retroactive effect.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.04&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.04&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Reporting exemptions</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>The Superintendent shall set out in a periodical available to the public the particulars of each exemption granted under subsection (3) together with the reasons for the exemption.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 197.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;164.05&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.05&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Attendance at meeting</MarginalNote><Label>164.05</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.05&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A person who solicits a proxy and is appointed proxyholder shall attend in person or cause an alternate proxyholder to attend every meeting in respect of which the proxy is valid, and the proxyholder or alternate proxyholder shall comply with the directions of the shareholder or policyholder who executed the form of proxy.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.05&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.05&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Rights of proxyholder</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A proxyholder or an alternate proxyholder has the same rights as the appointing shareholder or policyholder to speak at a meeting of shareholders or policyholders in respect of any matter, to vote by way of ballot at the meeting and, except where a proxyholder or an alternate proxyholder has conflicting instructions from more than one shareholder or policyholder, to vote at the meeting in respect of any matter by way of a show of hands.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.05&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.05&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Vote by show of hands</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Despite subsections (1) and (2) and unless a shareholder, policyholder or proxyholder demands a ballot, if the chairperson of a meeting of shareholders or policyholders declares to the meeting that, if a ballot were conducted, the total number of votes represented at the meeting by proxy required to be voted against what, to the knowledge of the chairperson, would be the decision of the meeting on a matter or group of matters is less than 5% of all the votes that might be cast by shareholders or policyholders, in person or by proxy,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;164.05&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the chairperson may conduct the vote in respect of that matter or group of matters by way of a show of hands; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;164.05&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a proxyholder or alternate proxyholder may vote in respect of that matter or group of matters by way of a show of hands.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 197;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 242.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;164.06&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.06&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Duty of intermediary</MarginalNote><Label>164.06</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.06&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Shares of a company that are registered in the name of an intermediary or an intermediary’s nominee and not beneficially owned by the intermediary may not be voted unless the intermediary sends to the beneficial owner</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;164.06&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a copy of the notice of the meeting, annual statement, management proxy circular and dissident’s proxy circular and any other documents, other than the form of proxy, that were sent to shareholders by or on behalf of any person for use in connection with the meeting; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;164.06&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a written request for voting instructions except if the intermediary has already received written voting instructions from the beneficial owner.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.06&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.06&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">When documents to be sent</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The intermediary shall send the documents referred to in subsection (1) without delay after they receive the documents referred to in paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.06&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.06&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction on voting</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>An intermediary or a proxyholder appointed by them may not vote shares that the intermediary does not beneficially own and that are registered in the name of the intermediary or their nominee unless the intermediary or proxyholder, as the case may be, receives written voting instructions from the beneficial owner.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.06&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.06&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Copies</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>A person by or on behalf of whom a solicitation is made shall on request and without delay provide the intermediary, at the person’s expense, with the necessary number of copies of the documents referred to in paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.06&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.06&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Instructions to intermediary</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>The intermediary shall vote or appoint a proxyholder to vote in accordance with any written voting instructions received from the beneficial owner.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.06&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.06&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Beneficial owner as proxyholder</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>If a beneficial owner so requests and provides an intermediary with appropriate documentation, the intermediary shall appoint the beneficial owner or a nominee of the beneficial owner as proxyholder.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.06&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.06&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effect of intermediary’s failure to comply</MarginalNote><Label>(7)</Label><Text>The failure of an intermediary to comply with any of subsections (1) to (6) does not render void any meeting of shareholders or policyholders or any action taken at the meeting.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.06&quot;,ss=&quot;8&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.06&quot;,ss=&quot;8&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Intermediary may not vote</MarginalNote><Label>(8)</Label><Text>Nothing in this Division gives an intermediary the right to vote shares that they are otherwise prohibited from voting.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 197;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 243.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;164.061&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.061&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exemption</MarginalNote><Label>164.061</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations respecting the conditions under which a company is exempt from any of the requirements of sections 164.01 to 164.06.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2005, c. 54, s. 243.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;164.07&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.07&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restraining order</MarginalNote><Label>164.07</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.07&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If a form of proxy, management proxy circular or dissident’s proxy circular contains an untrue statement of a material fact or omits to state a material fact that is required to be contained in it or that is necessary to make a statement contained in it not misleading in light of the circumstances in which the statement is made, an interested person or the Superintendent may apply to a court and the court may make any order it thinks fit including</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;164.07&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order restraining the solicitation or the holding of the meeting, or restraining any person from implementing or acting on a resolution passed at the meeting, to which the form of proxy, management proxy circular or dissident’s proxy circular relates;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;164.07&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order requiring correction of any form of proxy or proxy circular and a further solicitation; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;164.07&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order adjourning the meeting.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.07&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.07&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of application</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where a person other than the Superintendent is an applicant under subsection (1), the applicant shall give to the Superintendent notice of the application and the Superintendent is entitled to appear and to be heard in person or by counsel.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 197.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_I.2&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><Label>Division I.2</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_I.2&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Restrictions on Voting</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;164.08&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.08&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Meaning of <DefinedTermEn>eligible votes</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><Label>164.08</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.08&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>In this section, <DefinedTermEn>eligible votes</DefinedTermEn> means the total number of votes that may be cast by or on behalf of shareholders and policyholders on a vote of shareholders or shareholders and policyholders or a vote of holders of a class or series of shares, as the case may be, in respect of any particular matter, calculated without regard to subsection (2).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.08&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.08&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>At a meeting of shareholders and policyholders of a company in respect of which subsection 407(4) applies or of a company to which subsection 407(5) applies, no person and no entity controlled by any person may, in respect of any vote of shareholders or shareholders and policyholders or holders of any class or series of shares of the company, cast votes in respect of any shares beneficially owned by the person or the entity that are, in aggregate, more than 20 per cent of the eligible votes that may be cast in respect of that vote.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.08&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.08&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Proxyholders</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>No person who is a proxyholder for a person or for an entity controlled by a person may cast votes to which the proxy relates that the person or entity may not cast by reason of subsection (2).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.08&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.08&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Subsections (2) and (3) do not apply in respect of votes cast by or on behalf of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;164.08&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a company to which subsection 407(5) applies, or an insurance holding company to which subsection 407(6) applies, that controls the company; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;164.08&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any entity that is controlled by a company or an insurance holding company referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>).</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.08&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.08&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>Subsections (2) and (3) do not apply in respect of a vote held under section 239.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.08&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.08&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Validity of vote</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>A vote in respect of a particular matter is not invalid merely because a person voted contrary to subsection (2) or (3).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.08&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.08&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Disposition of shareholdings</MarginalNote><Label>(7)</Label><Text>If, with respect to any company, a person contravenes subsection (2) or (3), the Minister may, by order, direct the shareholder of the shares to which the contravention relates or any person controlled by that shareholder to dispose of any number of shares of the company beneficially owned by any of those persons that the Minister specifies in the order, within the time specified in the order and in the proportion, if any, as between the shareholder and the persons controlled by that shareholder that is specified in the order.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.08&quot;,ss=&quot;8&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.08&quot;,ss=&quot;8&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction on voting rights</MarginalNote><Label>(8)</Label><Text>If the Minister makes an order under subsection (7), the person to whom the order relates may not, in person or by proxy, exercise any voting rights that are attached to shares of the company beneficially owned by the person.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.08&quot;,ss=&quot;9&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.08&quot;,ss=&quot;9&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Subsection (8) ceases to apply</MarginalNote><Label>(9)</Label><Text>Subsection (8) ceases to apply in respect of a person when the shares to which the order relates have been disposed of.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.08&quot;,ss=&quot;10&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.08&quot;,ss=&quot;10&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Reliance on number in notice</MarginalNote><Label>(10)</Label><Text>For the purpose of this section, a person is entitled to rely on the number of eligible votes set out in a notice of a meeting under subsection 143(1.01).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;164.08&quot;,ss=&quot;11&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;164.08&quot;,ss=&quot;11&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Designation of persons</MarginalNote><Label>(11)</Label><Text>For the purpose of this section, the Minister may, with respect to a particular company, designate two or more persons who are parties to an agreement, commitment or understanding referred to in section 9 to be a single person.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 374.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_II&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><Label>Division II</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_II&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Directors and Officers</TitleText></Heading><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_II&quot;,gc=&quot;s_165&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_II&quot;,gc=&quot;s_165&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Duties</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;165&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Duty to manage</MarginalNote><Label>165.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to this Act, the directors of a company shall manage or supervise the management of the business and affairs of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Specific duties</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Without limiting the generality of subsection (1), the directors of a company shall</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>establish an audit committee to perform the duties referred to in subsections 203(3) and (4);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>establish a conduct review committee to perform the duties referred to in subsection 204(3);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>establish procedures to resolve conflicts of interest, including techniques for the identification of potential conflict situations and for restricting the use of confidential information;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>designate a committee of the board of directors to monitor the procedures referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of a company that issues participating policies, establish, before issuing any participating policies or, in the case of a former-Act company, within six months after the coming into force of this Part, a policy for determining the dividends and bonuses to be paid to the participating policyholders;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;e.1&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e.1</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>establish a policy respecting the management of each of the participating accounts maintained under section 456,</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;e.1&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>if the company has participating policyholders on the day on which this paragraph comes into force, within six months after that day, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;e.1&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>in any other case, before issuing a participating policy;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;e.2&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e.2</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>establish criteria for changes made by the company to the premium or charge for insurance, amount of insurance or surrender value in respect of its adjustable policies,</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;e.2&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>if the company has adjustable policyholders on the day on which this paragraph comes into force, within six months after that day, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;e.2&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>in any other case, before issuing an adjustable policy;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>establish procedures to provide disclosure of information to customers of the company that is required to be disclosed by this Act and for dealing with complaints as required by section 486;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>designate a committee of the board of directors to monitor the procedures referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>) and satisfy itself that they are being adhered to by the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;h&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">h</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>establish investment and lending policies, standards and procedures in accordance with section 492; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">i</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of a former-Act company, appoint the actuary of the company forthwith after the coming into force of this Part.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Paragraphs (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) and (<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) do not apply to the directors of a company where</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>all the voting shares of the company, other than directors’ qualifying shares, if any, are beneficially owned by a Canadian financial institution described by any of paragraphs (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>) of the definition “financial institution” in subsection 2(1);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>there are no policyholders who are entitled to vote; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the audit committee or the conduct review committee of the Canadian financial institution referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) performs for and on behalf of the company all the functions that would otherwise be required to be performed by the audit committee or conduct review committee of the company under this Act.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;3.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;3.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Report of actuary — par. (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</MarginalNote><Label>(3.1)</Label><Text>The company’s actuary shall report to the directors in writing on the fairness to participating policyholders of any policy to be established or amended under paragraph (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>) and report at least once during each financial year on its continuing fairness. In the case of a policy established before the day on which this subsection comes into force, the actuary shall within six months after that day report on its fairness to participating policyholders and report at least once during each financial year on its continuing fairness.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;3.2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;3.2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Report of actuary — par. (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">e.1</Emphasis>)</MarginalNote><Label>(3.2)</Label><Text>The company’s actuary shall report to the directors in writing on the fairness to participating policyholders of any policy to be established or amended under paragraph (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">e.1</Emphasis>) and report at least once during each financial year on its continuing fairness.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;3.3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;3.3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Report of actuary — par. (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">e.2</Emphasis>)</MarginalNote><Label>(3.3)</Label><Text>The company’s actuary shall report to the directors in writing on the fairness to adjustable policyholders of the criteria to be established or amended under paragraph (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">e.2</Emphasis>) and report at least once during each financial year on their continuing fairness.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;3.4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;3.4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Consideration of reports</MarginalNote><Label>(3.4)</Label><Text>The directors shall consider the report prepared under subsection (3.1), (3.2) or (3.3) before establishing or amending a policy under paragraph (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">e.1</Emphasis>) or the criteria under paragraph (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">e.2</Emphasis>), as the case may be.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;3.5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;3.5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Generally accepted actuarial practice</MarginalNote><Label>(3.5)</Label><Text>The report of the actuary referred to in subsections (3.1) to (3.3) shall be prepared in accordance with generally accepted actuarial practice with such changes as may be determined by the Superintendent and any additional directions that may be made by the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Copy to Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>The company shall, within 30 days after a policy is established or amended under paragraph (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">e.1</Emphasis>) or criteria are established or amended under paragraph (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">e.2</Emphasis>), send a copy to the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;4.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;4.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Access to policies</MarginalNote><Label>(4.1)</Label><Text>The company shall on request and free of charge send a copy of a policy established or amended under paragraph (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">e.1</Emphasis>) to a shareholder or participating policyholder and on payment of a reasonable fee to any other person.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;4.2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;4.2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Access to criteria</MarginalNote><Label>(4.2)</Label><Text>The company shall on request and free of charge send a copy of the criteria referred to in paragraph (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">e.2</Emphasis>) to an adjustable policyholder and on payment of a reasonable fee to any other person.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;165&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations respecting the content of the policies established under paragraphs (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>) and (<Emphasis style="italic">e.1</Emphasis>) and of the criteria established under paragraph (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">e.2</Emphasis>).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 165;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 199;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 375(F);</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 244.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;166&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;166&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Duty of care</MarginalNote><Label>166.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;166&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Every director and officer of a company in exercising any of the powers of a director or an officer and discharging any of the duties of a director or an officer shall</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;166&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>act honestly and in good faith with a view to the best interests of the company; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;166&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>exercise the care, diligence and skill that a reasonably prudent person would exercise in comparable circumstances.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;166&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;166&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Duty to comply</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Every director, officer and employee of a company shall comply with this Act, the regulations, the company’s incorporating instrument and the by-laws of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;166&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;166&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">No exculpation</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>No provision in any contract, in any resolution or in the by-laws of a company relieves any director, officer or employee of the company from the duty to act in accordance with this Act and the regulations or relieves a director, officer or employee from liability for a breach thereof.</Text></Subsection></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_II&quot;,gc=&quot;s_167&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_II&quot;,gc=&quot;s_167&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Qualification and Number — Directors</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;167&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;167&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Minimum number of directors</MarginalNote><Label>167.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;167&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company shall have at least seven directors.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;167&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;167&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Residency requirement</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>At least one half of the directors of a company that is a subsidiary of a foreign institution or of a prescribed holding body corporate of a foreign institution and a majority of the directors of any other company must be, at the time of each director’s election or appointment, resident Canadians.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 167;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 376;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 201.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;168&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;168&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Disqualified persons</MarginalNote><Label>168.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;168&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The following persons are disqualified from being directors of a company:</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;168&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a person who is less than eighteen years of age;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;168&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a person who is of unsound mind and has been so found by a court in Canada or elsewhere;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;168&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a person who has the status of a bankrupt;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;168&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a person who is not a natural person;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;168&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a person who is prohibited by subsection 164.08(8) or section 418 or 430 from exercising voting rights attached to shares of the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;168&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a person who is an officer, director or full time employee of an entity that is prohibited by subsection 164.08(8) or section 418 or 430 from exercising voting rights attached to shares of the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;168&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a person who is an agent or employee of Her Majesty in right of Canada or in right of a province;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;168&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;h&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">h</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a minister of Her Majesty in right of Canada or in right of a province;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;168&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">i</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a person who is an agent or employee of the government of a foreign country or any political subdivision thereof; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;168&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;j&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">j</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a person who is an insurance agent or broker of the company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;168&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;168&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shareholders disqualified</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A shareholder of a company is disqualified from being a policyholders’ director of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;168&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;168&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>) does not apply in respect of a company that is controlled by a body corporate organized in a mutual form the members of which are primarily employees of Her Majesty in right of Canada or in right of a province.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 168;</li><li> 1994, c. 47, s. 120;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 200;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 377.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;169&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;169&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">No requirement to hold shares or policies</MarginalNote><Label>169.</Label><Text>A director of a company is not required to hold shares of or a policy issued by the company.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;170&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;170&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Affiliated person</MarginalNote><Label>170.</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations specifying the circumstances under which a natural person is affiliated with a company for the purposes of this Act.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;170.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;170.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Affiliated director determination</MarginalNote><Label>170.1</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;170.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Notwithstanding section 170, the Superintendent may determine that a particular director is affiliated with a company for the purposes of this Act if, in the opinion of the Superintendent, the director has a significant or sufficient commercial, business or financial relationship with the company or with an affiliate of the company to the extent that the relationship can be construed as being material to the director and can reasonably be expected to affect the exercise of the director’s best judgment.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;170.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;170.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notification by Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A determination by the Superintendent under subsection (1)</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;170.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>becomes effective on the day of the next annual meeting of the shareholders and policyholders unless a notice in writing by the Superintendent revoking the determination is received by the company prior to that day; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;170.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>ceases to be in effect on the day of the next annual meeting of the shareholders and policyholders after a notice in writing by the Superintendent revoking the determination is received by the company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1996, c. 6, s. 73.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;171&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;171&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Unaffiliated directors</MarginalNote><Label>171.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;171&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>At the election of directors at each annual meeting of the shareholders and policyholders of a company and at all times until the day of the next annual meeting no more than two thirds of the directors may be persons affiliated with the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;171&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;171&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Subsection (1) does not apply where</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;171&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>all the voting shares of a company, other than directors’ qualifying shares, if any, are beneficially owned by a Canadian financial institution incorporated by or under an Act of Parliament; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;171&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>there are no policyholders who are entitled to vote.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;171&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;171&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Determination of affiliation</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>For the purposes of subsection (1), whether or not a person is affiliated with a company shall be determined as of the day the notice of the annual meeting is sent to shareholders and policyholders pursuant to section 143 and that determination becomes effective on the day of that meeting, and a person shall be deemed to continue to be affiliated or unaffiliated, as the case may be, until the next annual meeting of shareholders and policyholders.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;172&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;172&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limit on directors</MarginalNote><Label>172.</Label><Text>No more than 15 per cent of the directors of a company may, at each director’s election or appointment, be employees of the company or a subsidiary of the company, except that up to four persons who are employees of the company or a subsidiary of the company may be directors of the company if those directors constitute not more than one half of the directors of the company.</Text></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_II&quot;,gc=&quot;s_173&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_II&quot;,gc=&quot;s_173&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Election and Tenure — Directors</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;173&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;173&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Number of directors</MarginalNote><Label>173.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;173&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection 167(1) and sections 176 and 238, the directors of a company shall, by by-law, determine the number of directors or the minimum and maximum number of directors, but no by-law that decreases the number of directors shortens the term of an incumbent director.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;173&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;173&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shareholders’ and policyholders’ directors</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection 167(1) and sections 176 and 238, the directors of a company that has common shares and policyholders who are entitled to vote at an annual meeting of shareholders and policyholders shall by by-law determine the number of directors, or the minimum and maximum number of directors, who are to be elected by the shareholders and the number, or the minimum and maximum number, who are to be elected by the policyholders.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;173&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;173&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Election at annual meeting</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A by-law made pursuant to subsection (1) that provides for a minimum and maximum number of directors may provide that the number of directors, shareholders’ directors or policyholders’ directors to be elected at any annual meeting of the shareholders and policyholders be such number as is fixed by the directors prior to the annual meeting.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;173&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;173&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Minimum</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>If a company has common shares and policyholders who are entitled to vote at an annual meeting of shareholders and policyholders, the number of shareholders’ directors and the number of policyholders’ directors, whether determined by by-law or fixed by the directors, must each be at least one third of the total number of directors.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;173&quot;,ss=&quot;4.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;173&quot;,ss=&quot;4.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Mutual company</MarginalNote><Label>(4.1)</Label><Text>Where the shareholders of a mutual company are entitled to elect one or more directors of the company, not more than one third of the directors may be elected by the shareholders.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;173&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;173&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shareholders’ and policyholders’ directors</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>In making by-laws for the purposes of subsection (2), the directors shall designate every member of the board as being either a shareholders’ director or a policyholders’ director.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 173;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 74;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 202.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;173.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;173.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Election or appointment as director</MarginalNote><Label>173.1</Label><Text>The election or appointment of a person as a director is subject to the following conditions:</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;173.1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the person was present at the meeting when the election or appointment took place and did not refuse to hold office as a director; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;173.1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the person was not present at the meeting when the election or appointment took place but</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;173.1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>consented in writing to hold office as a director before the election or appointment or within 10 days after it, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;173.1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>acted as a director after the election or appointment.</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2005, c. 54, s. 245.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;174&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;174&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Term of directors</MarginalNote><Label>174.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;174&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Except where this Act or the by-laws of a company provide for cumulative voting, the company may, by by-law, provide that the directors be elected for terms of one, two or three years.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;174&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;174&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Idem</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where this Act or the by-laws of a company provide for cumulative voting to elect the shareholders’ directors, the company may, by by-law, provide that the policyholders’ directors be elected for terms of one, two or three years.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;174&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;174&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Term of one, two or three years</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A director elected for a term of one, two or three years holds office until the close of the first, second or third annual meeting of shareholders and policyholders, as the case may be, following the election of the director.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;174&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;174&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">No stated term</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>A director who is not elected for an expressly stated term of office ceases to hold office at the close of the next annual meeting of shareholders and policyholders following the election of the director.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;174&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;174&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Tenure of office</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>It is not necessary that all directors elected at a meeting of shareholders or policyholders hold office for the same term.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;174&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;174&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Idem</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>If a by-law of a company provides that the directors be elected for a term of two or three years, it may also provide that the term of office of each director be for the whole of that term, or that, as nearly as may be, one half of the directors retire each year if the term is two years, and that one third of the directors retire each year if the term is three years.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;174&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;174&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Composition requirements</MarginalNote><Label>(7)</Label><Text>Where a director of a company is elected or appointed for a term of more than one year, the company shall comply with subsections 167(2) and 171(1), section 172 and subsection 173(4) at each annual meeting of shareholders and policyholders during the director’s term of office as if that director were elected or appointed on that date.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;174&quot;,ss=&quot;8&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;174&quot;,ss=&quot;8&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Transitional</MarginalNote><Label>(8)</Label><Text>Subsection (7) does not apply in respect of a former-Act company until the day of the third annual meeting of shareholders and policyholders after the coming into force of this section.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;175&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;175&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Determining election of directors</MarginalNote><Label>175.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;175&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Except where this Act or the by-laws of a company provide for cumulative voting, the persons, to the number authorized to be elected, who receive the greatest number of votes at an election of directors of a company shall be the directors thereof.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;175&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;175&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">No right to vote</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A shareholder of a company that has common shares and policyholders who are entitled to vote at an annual meeting of shareholders and policyholders</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;175&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>is not entitled to vote for the policyholders’ directors if the shareholder is not a policyholder; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;175&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>is not entitled to vote any shares for the policyholders’ directors.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;175&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;175&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Idem</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The holder of a policy issued by a company that has common shares and policyholders who are entitled to vote at an annual meeting of shareholders and policyholders</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;175&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>is not entitled to vote for the shareholders’ directors if the policyholder is not a shareholder; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;175&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>is not entitled to vote as a policyholder for the shareholders’ directors.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;175&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;175&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Equal number of votes</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>If, at any election of directors referred to in subsection (1), two or more persons receive an equal number of votes and there are not sufficient vacancies remaining to enable all the persons receiving an equal number of votes to be elected, the directors who receive a greater number of votes or the majority of them shall, in order to complete the full number of directors, determine which of the persons so receiving an equal number of votes are to be elected.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;176&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;176&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Cumulative voting</MarginalNote><Label>176.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;176&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where this Act or the by-laws provide for cumulative voting,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;176&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>there shall be a stated number determined by by-law, and not a minimum and maximum number, of directors, in the case of a company that has no policyholders who are entitled to vote at an annual meeting of shareholders and policyholders, or of shareholders’ directors, in the case of a company that has such policyholders;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;176&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>each shareholder entitled to vote at an election of directors to be elected by cumulative voting has the right to cast a number of votes equal to the number of votes attached to the shares held by the shareholder multiplied by the number of directors to be elected by cumulative voting, and the shareholder may cast all such votes in favour of one candidate or distribute them among the candidates in any manner;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;176&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a separate vote shall be taken with respect to each candidate nominated for a position that is to be filled by cumulative voting unless a resolution is passed unanimously permitting two or more persons to be elected by a single vote;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;176&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if a shareholder has voted for more than one candidate without specifying the distribution of the votes among the candidates, the shareholder is deemed to have distributed the votes equally among the candidates for whom the shareholder voted;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;176&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if the number of candidates nominated exceeds the number of positions to be filled, the candidates who receive the least number of votes shall be eliminated until the number of candidates remaining equals the number of positions to be filled;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;176&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>each director elected by cumulative voting ceases to hold office at the close of the next annual meeting of shareholders and policyholders following the director’s election;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;176&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a director elected by cumulative voting may be removed from office only if the number of votes cast in favour of a motion to remove the director is greater than the product of the number of directors required by the by-laws to be elected by cumulative voting and the number of votes cast against the motion; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;176&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;h&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">h</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the number of directors required by the by-laws to be elected by cumulative voting may be decreased only if the number of votes cast in favour of a motion to decrease the number of directors is greater than the product of the number of directors required by the by-laws to be elected by cumulative voting and the number of votes cast against the motion.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;176&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;176&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Mandatory cumulative voting</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where the aggregate of the voting shares beneficially owned by a person and any entities controlled by the person carries more than 10 per cent of the voting rights attached to all the outstanding voting shares of a company, the directors to be elected by shareholders shall be elected by cumulative voting.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;176&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;176&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Subsection (2) does not apply where all the voting shares of the company that are outstanding, other than directors’ qualifying shares, if any, are beneficially owned by</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;176&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>one person;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;176&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>one person and one or more entities controlled by that person; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;176&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>one or more entities controlled by the same person.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;176&quot;,ss=&quot;3.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;176&quot;,ss=&quot;3.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(3.1)</Label><Text>Subsection (2) does not apply to a converted company in respect of which subsection 407(4) applies or a company to which subsection 407(5) applies.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;176&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;176&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Transitional election</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Where this Act or the by-laws of a company provide for cumulative voting, the shareholders of the company shall,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;176&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>at the first annual meeting of shareholders and policyholders held not earlier than ninety days following the date that cumulative voting is required under subsection (2) or provided for in the by-laws, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;176&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>at each succeeding annual meeting,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>elect the stated number of directors to hold office until the close of the next annual meeting of shareholders and policyholders following their election.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;176&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;176&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Class or series of shares</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>Nothing in this Act precludes the holders of any class or series of shares of a company from having an exclusive right to elect one or more directors.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 176;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 74.1;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 203;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 379;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 246.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;177&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;177&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Re-election of directors</MarginalNote><Label>177.</Label><Text>A director who has completed a term of office is, if otherwise qualified, eligible for re-election.</Text></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_II&quot;,gc=&quot;s_178&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_II&quot;,gc=&quot;s_178&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Incomplete Elections and Director Vacancies</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;178&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;178&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Void election or appointment</MarginalNote><Label>178.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;178&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If, immediately after the time of any purported election or appointment of directors, the board of directors would fail to comply with subsection 167(2) or 171(1), section 172 or subsection 173(4) or (4.1), the purported election or appointment of all persons purported to be elected or appointed at that time is void unless the directors, within forty-five days after the discovery of the non-compliance, develop a plan, approved by the Superintendent, to rectify the non-compliance.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;178&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;178&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Failure to elect minimum</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where, at the close of a meeting of shareholders or policyholders of a company, the shareholders or policyholders have failed to elect the number or minimum number of directors required by this Act or the by-laws of a company, the purported election of directors at the meeting</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;178&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>is valid if the directors purported to be elected and those incumbent directors, if any, whose terms did not expire at the close of the meeting, together constitute a quorum; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;178&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>is void if the directors purported to be elected and those incumbent directors, if any, whose terms did not expire at the close of the meeting, together do not constitute a quorum.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;178&quot;,ss=&quot;3)&quot;"><Label>(3) and (4)</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 1997, c. 15, s. 204]</Repealed></Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 178;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 204.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;179&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;179&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Directors where elections incomplete or void</MarginalNote><Label>179.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;179&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Notwithstanding subsections 174(3) and (4) and paragraphs 176(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>) and 180(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>), where subsection 178(1) or (2) applies at the close of any meeting of shareholders or policyholders of a company, the board of directors shall, until their successors are elected or appointed, consist solely of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;179&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>where paragraph 178(2)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) applies, the directors referred to in that paragraph; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;179&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>where subsection 178(1) or paragraph 178(2)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) applies, those persons who were the incumbent directors immediately before the meeting.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;179&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;179&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Where there is no approved rectification plan</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Notwithstanding subsections 174(3) and (4) and paragraphs 176(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>) and 180(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>), where a plan to rectify the non-compliance referred to in subsection 178(1) has not been approved by the Superintendent by the end of the forty-five day period referred to in that subsection, the board of directors shall, until their successors are elected or appointed, consist solely of the persons who were the incumbent directors immediately before the meeting at which the purported election or appointment referred to in that subsection occurred.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;179&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;179&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Directors to call meeting</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Where subsection (1) or (2) applies, the board of directors referred to in that subsection shall without delay call a special meeting of shareholders or policyholders to fill the vacancies, where paragraph 178(2)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) applies, or elect a new board of directors, where subsection 178(1) or paragraph 178(2)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) applies.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;179&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;179&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shareholder or policyholder may call meeting</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Where the directors fail to call a special meeting required by subsection (3), the meeting may be called by any shareholder or policyholder entitled to vote.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 179;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 205.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;180&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;180&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Ceasing to hold office</MarginalNote><Label>180.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;180&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A director ceases to hold office</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;180&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>at the close of the annual meeting at which the director’s term of office expires;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;180&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>when the director dies or resigns;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;180&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>when the director becomes disqualified under section 168 or ineligible to hold office pursuant to subsection 212(2);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;180&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>when the director is removed under section 181; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;180&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>when the director is removed from office under section 678.1 or 678.2.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;180&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;180&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Date of resignation</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The resignation of a director of a company becomes effective at the time a written resignation is sent to the company by the director or at the time specified in the resignation, whichever is later.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 180;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 380.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;181&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;181&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Removal of director</MarginalNote><Label>181.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;181&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to paragraph 176(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>) and this section, the shareholders or policyholders of a company may by resolution at a special meeting remove any director or all the directors from office.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;181&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;181&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A shareholders’ director may be removed only by a resolution of the shareholders at a meeting of shareholders or shareholders and policyholders.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;181&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;181&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Idem</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A policyholders’ director may be removed only by a resolution of the policyholders at a meeting of policyholders or shareholders and policyholders.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;181&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;181&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Idem</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Where the holders of any class or series of shares of a company have the exclusive right to elect one or more directors, a director so elected may be removed only by a resolution at a meeting of the shareholders of that class or series.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;181&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;181&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Vacancy by removal</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>Subject to paragraphs 176(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>), a vacancy created by the removal of a director may be filled at the meeting of the shareholders or policyholders at which the director is removed or, if not so filled, may be filled under section 185 or 187.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;182&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;182&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Statement of director</MarginalNote><Label>182.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;182&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A director who</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;182&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>resigns,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;182&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>receives a notice or otherwise learns of a meeting of shareholders or policyholders called for the purpose of removing the director from office, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;182&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>receives a notice or otherwise learns of a meeting of directors or shareholders or policyholders at which another person is to be appointed or elected to fill the office of director, whether because of the director’s resignation or removal or because the director’s term of office has expired or is about to expire,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>is entitled to submit to the company a written statement giving the reasons for the resignation or the reasons why the director opposes any proposed action or resolution.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;182&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;182&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Statement to Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where a director resigns as a result of a disagreement with the other directors or the officers of a company, the director shall submit to the company and the Superintendent a written statement setting out the nature of the disagreement.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;183&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;183&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Circulation of statement</MarginalNote><Label>183.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;183&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company shall forthwith on receipt of a director’s statement referred to in subsection 182(1) relating to a matter referred to in paragraph 182(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>), or a director’s statement referred to in subsection 182(2), send a copy thereof to each shareholder and policyholder entitled to receive a notice of meetings under paragraph 143(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) and to the Superintendent, unless the statement is attached to a notice of a meeting.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;183&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;183&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Immunity for statement</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>No company or person acting on its behalf incurs any liability by reason only of circulating a director’s statement in compliance with subsection (1).</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;184&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;184&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shareholders or policyholders filling vacancy</MarginalNote><Label>184.</Label><Text>The by-laws of a company may provide that a vacancy among the directors is to be filled only by vote of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;184&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the shareholders or policyholders;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;184&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the shareholders, if the vacancy occurs among the shareholders’ directors;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;184&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the policyholders, if the vacancy occurs among the policyholders’ directors; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;184&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the holders of any class or series of shares having an exclusive right to elect one or more directors if the vacancy occurs among the directors elected by the holders of that class or series.</Text></Paragraph></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;185&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;185&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Directors filling vacancy</MarginalNote><Label>185.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;185&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Despite section 192 but subject to subsection (2) and sections 184, 186 and 187, a quorum of directors may fill a vacancy among the directors except a vacancy resulting from a change in the by-laws by which the number or the minimum or maximum number of directors is increased or from a failure to elect the number or minimum number of directors provided for in the by-laws.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;185&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;185&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Where composition fails</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Notwithstanding sections 184 and 192, where by reason of a vacancy the number of directors or the composition of the board of directors fails to meet any of the requirements of section 167, subsection 171(1), section 172 and subsection 173(4), the directors who, in the absence of any by-law, would be empowered to fill that vacancy shall do so forthwith.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 185;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 247.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;186&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;186&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Vacancy among shareholders’ or policyholders’ directors</MarginalNote><Label>186.</Label><Text>Notwithstanding section 192 but subject to sections 184 and 187, where a company has shareholders’ directors and policyholders’ directors and a vacancy occurs among those directors,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;186&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the remaining shareholders’ directors or policyholders’ directors, as the case may be, may fill the vacancy except one resulting from an increase in the number or the minimum or maximum number — or from a failure to elect the number or minimum number — of shareholders’ directors or policyholders’ directors provided for in the by-laws;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;186&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if there are no such remaining directors and, by reason of the vacancy, the number of directors or the composition of the board of directors fails to meet any of the requirements of section 167, subsection 171(1), section 172 and subsection 173(4), the other directors may fill that vacancy; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;186&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if there are no such remaining directors and paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) does not apply, any shareholder or policyholder entitled to vote may call a meeting of shareholders or policyholders for the purpose of filling the vacancy.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 186;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 248.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;187&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;187&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Class vacancy</MarginalNote><Label>187.</Label><Text>Notwithstanding section 192 but subject to section 184, where the holders of any class or series of shares of a company have an exclusive right to elect one or more directors and a vacancy occurs among those directors,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;187&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the remaining directors elected by the holders of that class or series of shares may fill the vacancy except one resulting from an increase in the number or the minimum or maximum number of directors for that class or series or from a failure to elect the number or minimum number of directors provided for in the by-laws for that class or series;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;187&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if there are no such remaining directors and, by reason of the vacancy, the number of directors or the composition of the board of directors fails to meet any of the requirements of section 167, subsection 171(1), section 172 and subsection 173(4), the other directors may fill that vacancy; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;187&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if there are no such remaining directors and paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) does not apply, any holder of shares of that class or series may call a meeting of the holders thereof for the purpose of filling the vacancy.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 187;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 249.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;188&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;188&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Unexpired term</MarginalNote><Label>188.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;188&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Unless the by-laws otherwise provide, a director elected or appointed to fill a vacancy holds office for the unexpired term of the director’s predecessor in office.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;188&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;188&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Affiliation</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Notwithstanding subsection 171(3), the affiliation of a person to be elected or appointed to fill a vacancy shall be determined as at the date of the person’s election or appointment and that person shall be deemed to continue to be affiliated or unaffiliated, as the case may be, until the next annual meeting of the shareholders and policyholders.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;188.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;188.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Additional directors</MarginalNote><Label>188.1</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;188.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Shareholders’ directors may appoint one or more additional directors as shareholders’ directors, and policyholders’ directors may appoint one or more additional directors as policyholders’ directors, where the by-laws of the company allow them to do so and the by-laws determine the minimum and maximum numbers of shareholders’ directors and policyholders’ directors.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;188.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;188.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Term of office</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A director appointed under subsection (1) holds office for a term expiring not later than the close of the next annual meeting of shareholders or policyholders of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;188.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;188.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limit on number appointed</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The total number of directors appointed under subsection (1) may not exceed one third of the number of directors elected at the previous annual meeting of shareholders or policyholders of the company.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 206.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_II&quot;,gc=&quot;s_189&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_II&quot;,gc=&quot;s_189&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Meetings of the Board</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;189&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;189&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Meetings required</MarginalNote><Label>189.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;189&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The directors shall meet at least four times during each financial year.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;189&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;189&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Place for meetings</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The directors may meet at any place unless the by-laws provide otherwise.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;189&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;189&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice for meetings</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The notice for the meetings must be given as required by the by-laws.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 189;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 207.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;190&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;190&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of meeting</MarginalNote><Label>190.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;190&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A notice of a meeting of directors shall specify each matter referred to in section 207 that is to be dealt with at the meeting but, unless the by-laws otherwise provide, need not otherwise specify the purpose of or the business to be transacted at the meeting.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;190&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;190&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Waiver of notice</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A director may in any manner waive notice of a meeting of directors and the attendance of a director at a meeting of directors is a waiver of notice of that meeting except where the director attends the meeting for the express purpose of objecting to the transaction of any business on the grounds that the meeting is not lawfully called.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;190&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;190&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Adjourned meeting</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Notice of an adjourned meeting of directors is not required to be given if the time and place of the adjourned meeting was announced at the original meeting.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;191&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;191&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Quorum</MarginalNote><Label>191.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;191&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to section 192, the number of directors referred to in subsection (2) constitutes a quorum at any meeting of directors or a committee of directors and, notwithstanding any vacancy among the directors, a quorum of directors may exercise all the powers of the directors.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;191&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;191&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Idem</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The number of directors constituting a quorum at any meeting of directors or a committee of directors shall be</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;191&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a majority of the minimum number of directors required by this Act for the board of directors or a committee of directors; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;191&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>such greater number of directors than the number calculated pursuant to paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) as may be established by the by-laws of the company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;191&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;191&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Director continues to be present</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A director who is present at a meeting of directors or of a committee of directors but is not, in accordance with subsection 212(1), present at any particular time during the meeting is considered to be present for the purposes of this section.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 191;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 250.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;192&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;192&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Resident Canadian majority</MarginalNote><Label>192.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;192&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The directors of a company shall not transact business at a meeting of directors or of a committee of directors unless</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;192&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of a company that is the subsidiary of a foreign institution, at least one half, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;192&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of any other company, a majority</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>of the directors present are resident Canadians.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;192&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;192&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Notwithstanding subsection (1), the directors of a company may transact business at a meeting of directors or of a committee of directors without the required proportion of directors who are resident Canadians if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;192&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a director who is a resident Canadian unable to be present approves, in writing or by telephonic, electronic or other communications facilities, the business transacted at the meeting; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;192&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>there would have been present the required proportion of directors who are resident Canadians had that director been present at the meeting.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;192.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;192.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Presence of unaffiliated director</MarginalNote><Label>192.1</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;192.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The directors of a company shall not transact business at a meeting of directors unless at least one of the directors who is not affiliated with the company is present.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;192.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;192.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Despite subsection (1), the directors of a company may transact business at a meeting of directors if a director who is not affiliated with the company and who is not able to be present approves, in writing or by telephonic, electronic or other communications facilities, the business transacted at the meeting.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;192.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;192.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Subsection (1) does not apply if all the voting shares of the company, other than directors’ qualifying shares, if any, are beneficially owned by a Canadian financial institution incorporated by or under an Act of Parliament.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 381.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;193&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;193&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Electronic meeting</MarginalNote><Label>193.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;193&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to the by-laws of a company, a meeting of directors or of a committee of directors may be held by means of such telephonic, electronic or other communications facilities as permit all persons participating in the meeting to communicate adequately with each other during the meeting.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;193&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;193&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Deemed present</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A director participating in a meeting by any means referred to in subsection (1) is deemed for the purposes of this Act to be present at that meeting.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;193.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;193.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Resolution outside board meeting</MarginalNote><Label>193.1</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;193.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A resolution in writing signed by all the directors entitled to vote on that resolution at a meeting of directors is as valid as if it had been passed at a meeting of directors.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;193.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;193.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Filing directors’ resolution</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A copy of the resolution referred to in subsection (1) shall be kept with the minutes of the proceedings of the directors.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;193.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;193.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Resolution outside committee meeting</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A resolution in writing signed by all the directors entitled to vote on that resolution at a meeting of a committee of directors, other than a resolution of the audit committee in carrying out its duties under subsection 203(3) or a resolution of the conduct review committee in carrying out its duties under subsection 204(3), is as valid as if it had been passed at a meeting of that committee.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;193.1&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;193.1&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Filing committee resolution</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>A copy of the resolution referred to in subsection (3) shall be kept with the minutes of the proceedings of that committee.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;193.1&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;193.1&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Evidence</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>Unless a ballot is demanded, an entry in the minutes of a meeting that the chairperson declared a resolution to be carried or defeated is in the absence of evidence to the contrary proof of that fact without proof of the number or proportion of votes recorded in favour of or against the resolution.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 208;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 251.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;194&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;194&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Dissent of director</MarginalNote><Label>194.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;194&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A director of a company who is present at a meeting of directors or a committee of directors is deemed to have consented to any resolution passed or action taken at that meeting unless</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;194&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the director requests that the director’s dissent be entered or the director’s dissent is entered in the minutes of the meeting;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;194&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the director sends a written dissent to the secretary of the meeting before the meeting is adjourned; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;194&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the director sends the director’s dissent by registered mail or delivers it to the head office of the company immediately after the meeting is adjourned.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;194&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;194&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Loss of right to dissent</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A director of a company who votes for or consents to a resolution is not entitled to dissent under subsection (1).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;194&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;194&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Dissent of absent director</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A director of a company who is not present at a meeting at which a resolution is passed or action taken is deemed to have consented thereto unless, within seven days after the director becomes aware of the resolution, the director</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;194&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>causes the director’s dissent to be placed with the minutes of the meeting; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;194&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>sends the director’s dissent by registered mail or delivers it to the head office of the company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;195&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;195&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Record of attendance</MarginalNote><Label>195.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;195&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company shall keep a record of the attendance at each meeting of directors and each committee meeting of directors.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;195&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;195&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Statement to shareholders and policyholders</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A company shall attach to the notice of each annual meeting it sends to its shareholders and policyholders a statement showing, in respect of the financial year immediately preceding the meeting, the total number of directors’ meetings and directors’ committee meetings held during the financial year and the number of those meetings attended by each director.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 195;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 209.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;196&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;196&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Meeting required by Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>196.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;196&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where in the opinion of the Superintendent it is necessary, the Superintendent may, by notice in writing, require a company to hold a meeting of directors of the company to consider the matters set out in the notice.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;196&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;196&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Attendance of Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The Superintendent may attend and be heard at a meeting referred to in subsection (1).</Text></Subsection></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_II&quot;,gc=&quot;s_197&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_II&quot;,gc=&quot;s_197&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">By-laws</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;197&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;197&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">By-laws</MarginalNote><Label>197.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;197&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Unless this Act otherwise provides, the directors of a company may by resolution make, amend or repeal any by-law that regulates the business or affairs of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;197&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;197&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shareholder and policyholder approval</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The directors shall submit a by-law, or an amendment to or a repeal of a by-law, that is made under subsection (1) to the shareholders and policyholders at the next meeting of shareholders and policyholders, and the shareholders and policyholders may, by resolution, confirm or amend the by-law, amendment or repeal.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;197&quot;,ss=&quot;2.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;197&quot;,ss=&quot;2.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Separate vote</MarginalNote><Label>(2.1)</Label><Text>If a by-law made, amended or repealed under subsection (1) deals with the quorum of policyholders at a meeting of shareholders and policyholders, the policyholders who are entitled to vote on a resolution to confirm or amend the by-law, amendment or repeal are entitled to vote on it separately from the shareholders.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;197&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;197&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effective date of by-law</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Unless this Act otherwise provides, a by-law, or an amendment to or a repeal of a by-law, is effective from the date of the resolution of the directors under subsection (1) until it is confirmed, confirmed as amended or rejected by the shareholders and policyholders under subsection (2) or (2.1) or until it ceases to be effective under subsection (4) and, where the by-law is confirmed, or confirmed as amended, it continues in effect in the form in which it was so confirmed.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;197&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;197&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effect where no shareholder or policyholder approval</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>If a by-law, or an amendment to or a repeal of a by-law, is rejected by the shareholders and policyholders, or is not submitted to the shareholders and policyholders by the directors as required under subsection (2), the by-law, amendment or repeal ceases to be effective from the date of its rejection or the date of the next meeting of shareholders and policyholders, as the case may be, and no subsequent resolution of the directors to make, amend or repeal a by-law having substantially the same purpose or effect is effective until it is confirmed, or confirmed as amended, by the shareholders and policyholders.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 197;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 382.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;198&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;198&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shareholder or policyholder proposal of by-law</MarginalNote><Label>198.</Label><Text>A shareholder or policyholder entitled to vote at an annual meeting of shareholders and policyholders may, in accordance with sections 147 and 148, make a proposal to make, amend or repeal a by-law.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;199&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;199&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">By-laws of former-Act company</MarginalNote><Label>199.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;199&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to section 200, where a by-law of a former-Act company is in effect on the coming into force of this section, the by-law continues in effect until amended or repealed, unless it is contrary to a provision of this Act.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;199&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;199&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Unconfirmed by-laws</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A by-law made by the directors of a company under section 23 of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act">Canadian and British Insurance Companies Act</XRefExternal>, as that section read immediately before the coming into force of this section, and not confirmed at a general or annual meeting of the company in accordance with section 24 of that Act on or before the coming into force of this section, continues to have effect, unless it is contrary to the provisions of this Act, until the first meeting of the shareholders and policyholders following the coming into force of this section.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;199&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;199&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shareholder and policyholder approval</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A by-law referred to in subsection (2) shall be submitted to the shareholders and policyholders at the first meeting of the shareholders and policyholders following the coming into force of this section.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;199&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;199&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application of ss. 197(3) and (4) and 198</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Subsections 197(3) and (4) and section 198 apply in respect of a by-law referred to in this section as if it were a by-law made under section 197.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;200&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;200&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Resolutions re remuneration</MarginalNote><Label>200.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;200&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where the remuneration of directors of a former-Act company was, immediately prior to the coming into force of this section, fixed by a resolution of the shareholders or policyholders of the company that was passed pursuant to subsection 135(1) of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act">Canadian and British Insurance Companies Act</XRefExternal>, that resolution continues to have effect, unless it is contrary to the provisions of this Act, until the first meeting of the shareholders and policyholders following the coming into force of this section.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;200&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;200&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Existing resolutions</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where the remuneration of directors of a former-Act company was, immediately prior to the coming into force of this section, fixed by a resolution of the directors, that resolution continues to have effect, unless it is contrary to the provisions of this Act, until the first meeting of the shareholders and policyholders following the coming into force of this section.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;201&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;201&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Deemed by-laws</MarginalNote><Label>201.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;201&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Any matter provided for in the incorporating instrument of a former-Act company on the coming into force of this section, or of a body corporate continued as a company under this Act at the time of continuance that, under this Act, would be provided for in the by-laws of a company is deemed to be provided for in the by-laws of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;201&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;201&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">By-law prevails</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where a by-law of the company made in accordance with sections 197 and 198 amends or repeals any matter referred to in subsection (1), the by-law prevails.</Text></Subsection></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_II&quot;,gc=&quot;s_202&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_II&quot;,gc=&quot;s_202&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Committees of the Board</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;202&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;202&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Committees</MarginalNote><Label>202.</Label><Text>The directors of a company may appoint from their number, in addition to the committees referred to in subsection 165(2), such other committees as they deem necessary and, subject to section 207, delegate to those committees such powers of the directors, and assign to those committees such duties, as the directors consider appropriate.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;203&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;203&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Audit committee</MarginalNote><Label>203.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;203&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The audit committee of a company shall consist of at least three directors.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;203&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;203&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Membership</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A majority of the members of the audit committee must consist of directors who are not persons affiliated with the company and none of the members of the audit committee may be officers or employees of the company or a subsidiary of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;203&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;203&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Duties of audit committee</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The audit committee of a company shall</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;203&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>review the annual statement of the company before the annual statement is approved by the directors;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;203&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>review such returns of the company as the Superintendent may specify;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;203&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>require the management of the company to implement and maintain appropriate internal control procedures;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;203&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;c.1&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c.1</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>review, evaluate and approve those procedures;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;203&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>review such investments and transactions that could adversely affect the well-being of the company as the auditor or any officer of the company may bring to the attention of the committee;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;203&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>meet with the auditor to discuss the annual statement and the returns and transactions referred to in this subsection;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;203&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>meet with the actuary of the company to discuss the parts of the annual statement and the annual return filed under section 665 prepared by the actuary; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;203&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>meet with the chief internal auditor of the company, or the officer or employee of the company acting in a similar capacity, and with management of the company, to discuss the effectiveness of the internal control procedures established for the company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;203&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;203&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Report</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>In the case of the annual statement and returns of a company that under this Act must be approved by the directors of the company, the audit committee of the company shall report thereon to the directors before the approval is given.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;203&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;203&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Required meeting of directors</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>The audit committee of a company may call a meeting of the directors of the company to consider any matter of concern to the committee.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 203;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 210.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;204&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;204&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Conduct review committee</MarginalNote><Label>204.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;204&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The conduct review committee of a company shall consist of at least three directors.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;204&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;204&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Membership</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A majority of the members of the conduct review committee of a company must consist of directors who are not persons affiliated with the company and none of the members of the conduct review committee may be officers or employees of the company or a subsidiary of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;204&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;204&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Duties of conduct review committee</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The conduct review committee of a company shall</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;204&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>require the management of the company to establish procedures for complying with Part XI;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;204&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>review those procedures and their effectiveness in ensuring that the company is complying with Part XI;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;204&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b.1&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b.1</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if an insurance holding company or a bank holding company that is widely held has a significant interest in any class of shares of the company,</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;204&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b.1&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>establish policies for entering into transactions referred to in subsection 528.1(1), and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;204&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b.1&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>review transactions referred to in subsection 528.3(1); and</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;204&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>review the practices of the company to ensure that any transactions with related parties of the company that may have a material effect on the stability or solvency of the company are identified.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;204&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;204&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Company report to Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>A company shall report to the Superintendent on the mandate and responsibilities of the conduct review committee and the procedures referred to in paragraph (3)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;204&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;204&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Committee report to directors</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>After each meeting of the conduct review committee of a company, the committee shall report to the directors of the company on matters reviewed by the committee.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;204&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;204&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Directors’ report to Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>Within ninety days after the end of each financial year, the directors of a company shall report to the Superintendent on what the conduct review committee did during the year in carrying out its responsibilities under subsection (3).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 204;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 211;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 383.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_II&quot;,gc=&quot;s_205&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_II&quot;,gc=&quot;s_205&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Directors and Officers — Authority</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;205&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;205&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Chief executive officer</MarginalNote><Label>205.</Label><Text>The directors of a company shall appoint from their number a chief executive officer who must be ordinarily resident in Canada and, subject to section 207, may delegate to that officer any of the powers of the directors.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;206&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;206&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Appointment of officers</MarginalNote><Label>206.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;206&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The directors of a company may, subject to the by-laws, designate the offices of the company, appoint officers thereto, specify the duties of those officers and delegate to them powers, subject to section 207, to manage the business and affairs of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;206&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;206&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Directors as officers</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Subject to section 172, a director of a company may be appointed to any office of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;206&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;206&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Two or more offices</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Two or more offices of a company may be held by the same person.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;207&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;207&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limits on power to delegate</MarginalNote><Label>207.</Label><Text>The directors of a company may not delegate any of the following powers, namely, the power to</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;207&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>submit to the shareholders or policyholders a question or matter requiring the approval of the shareholders or policyholders;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;207&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>fill a vacancy among the directors, on a committee of directors or in the office of auditor or actuary, or appoint additional directors;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;207&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>issue or cause to be issued securities, including an issue of shares of a series that is authorized in accordance with section 66, except in accordance with any authorization made by the directors;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;207&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>declare a dividend on shares or a policy dividend, bonus or other benefit payable to policyholders, other than a dividend on a group policy that is a participating policy;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;207&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>authorize the redemption or other acquisition by the company pursuant to section 75 of shares issued by the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;207&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>authorize the payment of a commission on a share issue;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;207&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>approve a management proxy circular;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;207&quot;,p1=&quot;h&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">h</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>except as provided in this Act, approve the annual statement of the company and any other financial statements issued by the company; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;207&quot;,p1=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">i</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>adopt, amend or repeal by-laws.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 207;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 212;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 252.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;208&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;208&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Remuneration of directors, officers and employees</MarginalNote><Label>208.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;208&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to this section and the by-laws, the directors of a company may fix the remuneration of the directors, officers and employees of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;208&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;208&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">By-law required</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>No remuneration shall be paid to a director as director until a by-law fixing the aggregate of all amounts that may be paid to all directors in respect of directors’ remuneration during a fixed period of time has been confirmed by special resolution.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 208;</li><li> 1994, c. 26, s. 37.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;209&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;209&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Validity of acts</MarginalNote><Label>209.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;209&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>An act of a director or an officer of a company is valid notwithstanding a defect in the director’s qualification or an irregularity in the director’s election or in the appointment of the director or officer.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;209&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;209&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Idem</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>An act of the board of directors of a company is valid notwithstanding a defect in the composition of the board or an irregularity in the election of the board or in the appointment of a member of the board.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;210&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;210&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Right to attend meetings</MarginalNote><Label>210.</Label><Text>A director of a company is entitled to attend and to be heard at every meeting of shareholders or policyholders.</Text></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_II&quot;,gc=&quot;s_211&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_II&quot;,gc=&quot;s_211&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Conflicts of Interest</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;211&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;211&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Disclosure of interest</MarginalNote><Label>211.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;211&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A director or officer of a company shall disclose to the company, in writing or by requesting to have it entered in the minutes of a meeting of directors or a meeting of a committee of directors, the nature and extent of any interest they have in a material contract or material transaction with the company, whether entered into or proposed, if they</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;211&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>are a party to the contract or transaction;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;211&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>are a director or officer of a party to the contract or transaction or a person acting in a similar capacity; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;211&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>have a material interest in a party to the contract or transaction.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;211&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;211&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Time of disclosure — director</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The disclosure shall be made in the case of a director</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;211&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>at the meeting of directors, or of a committee of directors, at which the proposed contract or transaction is first considered;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;211&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if at the time of the meeting referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) the director was not interested in the proposed contract or transaction, at the first one after they become interested in it;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;211&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if the director becomes interested after a contract or transaction is entered into, at the first one after they become interested; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;211&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if a person who is interested in a contract or transaction becomes a director, at the first one after they become a director.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;211&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;211&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Time of disclosure — officer</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The disclosure shall be made in the case of an officer who is not a director</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;211&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>immediately after they become aware that the contract, transaction, proposed contract or proposed transaction is to be considered or has been considered at a meeting of directors or of a committee of directors;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;211&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if they become interested after the contract or transaction is entered into, immediately after they become interested; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;211&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if a person who is interested in a contract or transaction becomes an officer, immediately after they become an officer.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;211&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;211&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Time of disclosure — contract not requiring approval</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>If the material contract or material transaction, whether entered into or proposed, is one that in the ordinary course of the company’s business would not require approval by the directors, shareholders or policyholders, the director or officer shall disclose to the company, in writing or by requesting to have it entered in the minutes of a meeting of directors or of a committee of directors, the nature and extent of their interest immediately after they become aware of the contract or transaction.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 211;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 253.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;212&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;212&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Director to abstain</MarginalNote><Label>212.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;212&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A director who is required to make a disclosure under subsection 211(1) shall not be present at any meeting of directors, or of a committee of directors, while the contract or transaction is being considered or vote on any resolution to approve it unless the contract or transaction</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;212&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>relates primarily to their remuneration as a director, officer, employee or agent of the company, an entity controlled by the company or an entity in which the company has a substantial investment;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;212&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>is for indemnity under section 221 or insurance under section 222; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;212&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>is with an affiliate of the company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;212&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;212&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Ineligibility</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Any director who knowingly contravenes subsection (1) ceases to hold office as director and is not eligible, for a period of five years after the date on which the contravention occurred, for election or appointment as a director of any financial institution that is incorporated or formed by or under an Act of Parliament.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;212&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;212&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Validity of acts</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>An act of the board of directors of a company or of a committee of the board of directors is not invalid because a person acting as a director had ceased under subsection (2) to hold office as a director.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 212;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 213;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 254.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;213&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;213&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">General notice</MarginalNote><Label>213.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;213&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>For the purposes of subsection 211(1), a general notice to the directors declaring that a director or officer is to be regarded as interested for any of the following reasons in a contract or transaction entered into with a party is a sufficient declaration of interest in relation to any contract or transaction with that party:</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;213&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the director or officer is a director or officer of a party referred to in paragraph 211(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>) or a person acting in a similar capacity;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;213&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the director or officer has a material interest in the party; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;213&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>there has been a material change in the nature of the director’s or officer’s interest in the party.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;213&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;213&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Access to disclosures</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A policyholder who is entitled to vote or a shareholder may examine the portions of any minutes of meetings of directors or committees of directors that contain disclosures under subsection 211(1), or the portions of any other documents that contain those disclosures, during the usual business hours of the company.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 213;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 255.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;214&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;214&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Avoidance standards</MarginalNote><Label>214.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;214&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A contract or transaction for which disclosure is required under subsection 211(1) is not invalid and a director or officer is not accountable to the company or its shareholders or policyholders for any profit realized from it by reason only of the director’s or officer’s interest in the contract or transaction or the fact that the director was present or was counted to determine whether a quorum existed at the meeting of directors, or of a committee of directors, that considered it if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;214&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the director or officer disclosed their interest in accordance with section 211 and subsection 213(1);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;214&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the directors approved the contract or transaction; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;214&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the contract or transaction was reasonable and fair to the company at the time that it was approved.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;214&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;214&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Confirmation by shareholders and policyholders</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Even if the conditions set out in subsection (1) are not met, a director or officer acting honestly and in good faith is not accountable to the company or its shareholders or policyholders for any profit realized from a contract or transaction for which disclosure was required and the contract or transaction is not invalid by reason only of the director’s or officer’s interest in it if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;214&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the contract or transaction is approved or confirmed by special resolution at a meeting of shareholders and policyholders;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;214&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>disclosure of the interest was made to the shareholders and to the policyholders entitled to vote in a manner sufficient to indicate its nature before the contract or transaction was approved or confirmed; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;214&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the contract or transaction was reasonable and fair to the company at the time that it was approved or confirmed.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 214;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 255.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;215&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;215&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Court may set aside or require accounting</MarginalNote><Label>215.</Label><Text>If a director or officer of a company fails to comply with any of sections 211 to 214, a court, on application of the company or any of its policyholders entitled to vote or its shareholders, may set aside the contract or transaction on any terms that the court thinks fit and may require the director or officer to account to the company for any profit or gain realized on it.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 215;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 255.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_II&quot;,gc=&quot;s_216&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_II&quot;,gc=&quot;s_216&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Liability, Exculpation and Indemnification</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;216&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;216&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Director liability</MarginalNote><Label>216.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;216&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Directors of a company who vote for or consent to a resolution of the directors authorizing the issue of a share contrary to subsection 69(1) or the issue of subordinated indebtedness contrary to section 84 for a consideration other than money are jointly and severally, or solidarily, liable to the company to make good any amount by which the consideration received is less than the fair equivalent of the money that the company would have received if the share or subordinated indebtedness had been issued for money on the date of the resolution.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;216&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;216&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Further liability</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Directors of a company who vote for or consent to a resolution of the directors authorizing any of the following are jointly and severally, or solidarily, liable to restore to the company any amounts so distributed or paid and not otherwise recovered by the company and any amounts in relation to any loss suffered by the company:</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;216&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a redemption or purchase of shares contrary to section 75;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;216&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a reduction of capital contrary to section 79;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;216&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a payment of a dividend contrary to section 83;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;216&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a payment of an indemnity contrary to section 221; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;216&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any transaction contrary to Part XI.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 216;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 256(E).</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;217&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;217&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Contribution</MarginalNote><Label>217.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;217&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A director who has satisfied a judgment in relation to the director’s liability under section 216 is entitled to contribution from the other directors who voted for or consented to the unlawful act on which the judgment was founded.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;217&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;217&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Recovery</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A director who is liable under section 216 is entitled to apply to a court for an order compelling a shareholder or other person to pay or deliver to the director</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;217&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any money or property that was paid or distributed to the shareholder or other person contrary to section 75, 79, 83 or 221; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;217&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an amount equal to the value of the loss suffered by the company as a result of any transaction contrary to Part XI.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;217&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;217&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Court order</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Where an application is made to a court under subsection (2), the court may, where it is satisfied that it is equitable to do so,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;217&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>order a shareholder or other person to pay or deliver to a director any money or property that was paid or distributed to the shareholder or other person contrary to section 75, 79, 83 or 221 or any amount referred to in paragraph (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;217&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>order a company to return or issue shares to a person from whom the company has purchased, redeemed or otherwise acquired shares; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;217&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>make any further order it thinks fit.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;218&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;218&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limitation</MarginalNote><Label>218.</Label><Text>An action to enforce a liability imposed by section 216 may not be commenced after two years from the date of the resolution authorizing the action complained of.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;219&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;219&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Directors liable for wages</MarginalNote><Label>219.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;219&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to subsections (2) and (3), the directors of a company are jointly and severally, or solidarily, liable to each employee of the company for all debts not exceeding six months wages payable to the employee for services performed for the company while they are directors.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;219&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;219&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Conditions precedent</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A director is not liable under subsection (1) unless</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;219&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the company has been sued for the debt within six months after it has become due and execution has been returned unsatisfied in whole or in part;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;219&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the company has commenced liquidation and dissolution proceedings or has been dissolved and a claim for the debt has been proven within six months after the earlier of the date of commencement of the liquidation and dissolution proceedings and the date of dissolution; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;219&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a winding-up order has been issued in respect of the company under the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="W-11">Winding-up and Restructuring Act</XRefExternal> and a claim for the debt has been allowed or proven within six months after the issue of the winding-up order.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;219&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;219&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limitations</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A director is not liable under subsection (1) unless the director is sued for a debt referred to in that subsection while a director or within two years after the director has ceased to be a director.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;219&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;219&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Amount due after execution</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Where execution referred to in paragraph (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) has issued, the amount recoverable from a director is the amount remaining unsatisfied after execution.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;219&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;219&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Subrogation of director</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>Where a director of a company pays a debt referred to in subsection (1) that is proven in liquidation and dissolution or winding-up proceedings, the director is entitled to any preference that the employee would have been entitled to and, where a judgment has been obtained, the director is entitled to an assignment of the judgment.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;219&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;219&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Contribution entitlement</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>A director of a company who has satisfied a claim under this section is entitled to a contribution from the other directors of the company who are liable for the claim.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 219;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 167;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 257(E).</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;220&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;220&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Defence — due diligence</MarginalNote><Label>220.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;220&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A director, officer or employee of a company is not liable under section 216 or 219 or subsection 539(1) and has fulfilled their duty under subsection 166(2) if they exercised the care, diligence and skill that a reasonably prudent person would have exercised in comparable circumstances, including reliance in good faith on</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;220&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>financial statements of the company that were represented to them by an officer of the company or in a written report of the auditor of the company fairly to reflect the financial condition of the company; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;220&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a report of a person whose profession lends credibility to a statement made by them.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;220&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;220&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Defence — good faith</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A director or officer of a company has fulfilled their duty under subsection 166(1) if they relied in good faith on</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;220&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>financial statements of the company that were represented to them by an officer of the company or in a written report of the auditor of the company fairly to reflect the financial condition of the company; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;220&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a report of a person whose profession lends credibility to a statement made by them.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 220;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 384;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 258.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;221&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;221&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Indemnification</MarginalNote><Label>221.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;221&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company may indemnify a director or officer of the company, a former director or officer of the company or another person who acts or acted, at the company’s request, as a director or officer of or in a similar capacity for another entity against all costs, charges and expenses, including an amount paid to settle an action or satisfy a judgment, reasonably incurred by them in respect of any civil, criminal, administrative, investigative or other proceeding in which they are involved because of that association with the company or other entity.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;221&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;221&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Advances</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A company may advance amounts to the director, officer or other person for the costs, charges and expenses of a proceeding referred to in subsection (1). They shall repay the amounts if they do not fulfil the conditions set out in subsection (3).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;221&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;221&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">No indemnification</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A company may not indemnify a person under subsection (1) unless</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;221&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the person acted honestly and in good faith with a view to the best interests of, as the case may be, the company or the other entity for which they acted at the company’s request as a director or officer or in a similar capacity; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;221&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of a criminal or administrative action or proceeding that is enforced by a monetary penalty, the person had reasonable grounds for believing that their conduct was lawful.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;221&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;221&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Indemnification — derivative actions</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>A company may with the approval of a court indemnify a person referred to in subsection (1) or advance amounts to them under subsection (2) — in respect of an action by or on behalf of the company or other entity to procure a judgment in its favour to which the person is made a party because of the association referred to in subsection (1) with the company or other entity — against all costs, charges and expenses reasonably incurred by them in connection with that action if they fulfil the conditions set out in subsection (3).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;221&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;221&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Right to indemnity</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>Despite subsection (1), a person referred to in that subsection is entitled to be indemnified by the company in respect of all costs, charges and expenses reasonably incurred by them in connection with the defence of any civil, criminal, administrative, investigative or other proceeding to which the person is subject because of the association referred to in subsection (1) with the company or other entity described in that subsection if the person</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;221&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>was not judged by the court or other competent authority to have committed any fault or omitted to do anything that they ought to have done; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;221&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>fulfils the conditions set out in subsection (3).</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;221&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;221&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Heirs and personal representatives</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>A company may, to the extent referred to in subsections (1) to (5) in respect of the person, indemnify the heirs or personal representatives of any person whom the company may indemnify under those subsections.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 221;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 385(F);</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 258.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;222&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;222&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Directors’ and officers’ insurance</MarginalNote><Label>222.</Label><Text>A company may purchase and maintain insurance for the benefit of any person referred to in section 221 against any liability incurred by the person</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;222&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the capacity of a director or an officer of the company, except where the liability relates to a failure to act honestly and in good faith with a view to the best interests of the company; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;222&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the capacity of a director or officer of another entity or while acting in a similar capacity for another entity, if they act or acted in that capacity at the company’s request, except if the liability relates to a failure to act honestly and in good faith with a view to the best interests of the entity.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 222;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 259.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;223&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;223&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application to court for indemnification</MarginalNote><Label>223.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;223&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company or a person referred to in section 221 may apply to a court for an order approving an indemnity under that section and the court may so order and make any further order it thinks fit.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;223&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;223&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice to Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>An applicant under subsection (1) shall give the Superintendent written notice of the application and the Superintendent is entitled to appear and to be heard at the hearing of the application in person or by counsel.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;223&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;223&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Other notice</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>On an application under subsection (1), the court may order notice to be given to any interested person and that person is entitled to appear and to be heard in person or by counsel at the hearing of the application.</Text></Subsection></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_III&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><Label>Division III</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_III&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Fundamental Changes</TitleText></Heading><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_III&quot;,gc=&quot;s_224&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_III&quot;,gc=&quot;s_224&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Amendments — Letters Patent</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;224&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;224&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Incorporating instrument</MarginalNote><Label>224.</Label><Text>On the application of a company or society duly authorized by special resolution, the Minister may approve a proposal to add, change or remove any provision that is permitted by this Act to be set out in the incorporating instrument of the company or society.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 224;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 214;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 386.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;225&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;225&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Letters patent to amend</MarginalNote><Label>225.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;225&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>On receipt of an application referred to in section 224, the Minister may issue letters patent to effect the proposal.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;225&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;225&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effect of letters patent</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Letters patent issued pursuant to subsection (1) become effective on the day stated in the letters patent.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 225;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 387.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_III&quot;,gc=&quot;s_226&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_III&quot;,gc=&quot;s_226&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Mutualization</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;226&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;226&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Mutualization</MarginalNote><Label>226.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;226&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>On the application of a company that has common shares but does not have securities that are not convertible into common shares until after, or options or rights to acquire those shares that are not exercisable until after, the time of the application, the Minister may approve a proposal to convert the company into a mutual company by the purchase, or other acquisition, for the purpose of cancellation of those shares, securities, options and rights.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;226&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;226&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Definitions</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>In sections 227 to 236,</Text><Definition Code="se=&quot;226&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,df=&quot;{common share}{action ordinaire}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;226&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,df=&quot;{common share}{action ordinaire}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>common share</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;226&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,df=&quot;{common share}{action ordinaire}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>action ordinaire</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>common share</DefinedTermEn> includes</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;226&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,df=&quot;{common share}{action ordinaire}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a security currently convertible into a common share, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;226&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,df=&quot;{common share}{action ordinaire}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a currently exercisable option or a right to acquire a common share or a security referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>);</Text></Paragraph></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;226&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,df=&quot;{mutualization proposal}{proposition de mutualisation}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;226&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,df=&quot;{mutualization proposal}{proposition de mutualisation}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>mutualization proposal</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;226&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,df=&quot;{mutualization proposal}{proposition de mutualisation}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>proposition de mutualisation</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>mutualization proposal</DefinedTermEn> means a proposal referred to in subsection (1).</Text></Definition></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;226&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;226&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Saving</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Nothing in this section or sections 227 to 236 limits the powers of companies under subsection 75(1).</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;227&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;227&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Contents of mutualization proposal</MarginalNote><Label>227.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;227&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Every mutualization proposal shall set out the terms and means of effecting the conversion, and, in particular,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;227&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the manner in which all issued and outstanding shares of the company, other than shares that may be issued by a mutual company, are to be purchased or otherwise acquired for the purpose of cancellation;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;227&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the price to be paid for those shares;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;227&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the nature of the consideration to be paid for those shares;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;227&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the amount of any dividends to be paid to the holders of those shares after their purchase or other acquisition;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;227&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the period within which the company intends to purchase or otherwise acquire those shares;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;227&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the anticipated date when the company will become a mutual company; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;227&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the proposed by-laws of the converted company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;227&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;227&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Idem</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The mutualization proposal shall also contain such other information and evidence as the Minister may require.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;228&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;228&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shareholder and policyholder approval</MarginalNote><Label>228.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;228&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The directors of a company that makes a mutualization proposal shall, before applying to the Minister for approval of the proposal, submit it for approval to a meeting of the shareholders and policyholders entitled to vote and, subject to subsection (3), to the holders of each class or series of shares.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;228&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;228&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Right to vote</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Each share of a company that makes a mutualization proposal carries the right to vote in respect of the proposal whether or not it otherwise carries the right to vote.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;228&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;228&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Class vote</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The holders of shares of a class or series of shares of a company that makes a mutualization proposal are entitled to vote separately as a class or series in respect of the proposal.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;228&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;228&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Policyholder vote</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Policyholders who are entitled to vote are entitled to vote separately from shareholders in respect of a mutualization proposal.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;228&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;228&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Special resolution</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>Subject to subsections (3) and (4), a mutualization proposal is approved when the shareholders and the policyholders who are entitled to vote have approved the proposal by special resolution.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;229&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;229&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application to Minister</MarginalNote><Label>229.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;229&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company shall, within three months after the approval of a mutualization proposal in accordance with section 228, apply to the Minister for approval of the proposal.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;229&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;229&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Criteria for approval</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>In determining whether to approve a mutualization proposal, the Minister shall consider all matters that the Minister considers relevant and may not approve the proposal unless satisfied that</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;229&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the proposal was approved by the shareholders and policyholders pursuant to section 228;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;229&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the conversion of the company into a mutual company may reasonably be expected to be achieved under the terms of the proposal and in accordance with this section and sections 230 to 236;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;229&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>there are no reasonable grounds for believing that the conversion would cause the company to be in contravention of subsection 515(1), any regulation made under subsection 515(2) or any order made under subsection 515(3);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;229&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the stated capital of the company has ceased to be an important factor in safeguarding the interests of the policyholders of the company, having regard to the quality and amount of the assets of the company, the surplus of the company relative to its liabilities, the nature of the business carried on by the company and any other considerations deemed by the Minister to be relevant;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;229&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the price fixed by the directors for the purchase or other acquisition of the common shares of the company under the proposal is fair and reasonable in the circumstances; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;229&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the proposal is in the best interests of the financial system in Canada.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 229;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 202.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;230&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;230&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effect of Minister’s approval</MarginalNote><Label>230.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;230&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where the Minister approves a mutualization proposal made by a company,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;230&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the company may not issue any shares other than a share that may be issued by a mutual company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;230&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the company may solicit offers from the holders of the shares of the company that are to be purchased or otherwise acquired to effect the conversion of the company but shall not purchase or otherwise acquire those shares until the approval of the Superintendent under section 234 is obtained; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;230&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any change in the proposal must be approved by the shareholders and policyholders and by the Minister.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;230&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;230&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application of ss. 228 to 230</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Sections 228 to 230 apply with such modifications as the circumstances require in respect of changes in mutualization proposals.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;231&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;231&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Register to be kept</MarginalNote><Label>231.</Label><Text>A company shall prepare and maintain a register recording the offers for sale of shares under the terms of a mutualization proposal in the order in which those offers are received by the company, showing, in respect of each offer,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;231&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the date of receipt by the company of the offer;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;231&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the name and address of the shareholder making the offer;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;231&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the number of shares so offered by the shareholder making the offer;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;231&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the price at which each of the shares so offered may be purchased or otherwise acquired;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;231&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the date of purchase, if any, of each of the shares so offered and the number of shares purchased; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;231&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the date of withdrawal, if any, of the offer and the number of shares affected by the withdrawal.</Text></Paragraph></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;232&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;232&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application to Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>232.</Label><Text>A company that holds binding offers from the holders of at least ninety per cent of each class of shares for the purchase or other acquisition of those shares pursuant to a mutualization proposal shall apply to the Superintendent for approval of the purchase or other acquisition of the shares.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;233&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;233&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Criteria for approval</MarginalNote><Label>233.</Label><Text>The Superintendent shall approve the purchase or other acquisition of shares pursuant to a mutualization proposal if the Superintendent is satisfied that</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;233&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the purchase or other acquisition of shares would not cause the company to be in contravention of subsection 515(1), any regulation made under subsection 515(2) or any order made under subsection 515(3); and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;233&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the stated capital of the shares has, in the opinion of the Superintendent, ceased to be an important factor in safeguarding the interests of the policyholders of the company, having regard to the quality and amount of the assets of the company, the surplus of the company relative to its liabilities, the nature of the business carried on by the company and any other considerations deemed by the Superintendent to be relevant.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 233;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 203.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;234&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;234&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effect of Superintendent’s approval</MarginalNote><Label>234.</Label><Text>Where the Superintendent approves the purchase or other acquisition of shares of a company pursuant to a mutualization proposal, the company</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;234&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>shall, within the period set out in the mutualization proposal, purchase or otherwise acquire the shares for the purchase or other acquisition of which pursuant to the proposal the company holds binding offers; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;234&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>may acquire the remaining shares in accordance with Division X, which applies in respect of that acquisition with such modifications as the circumstances require, as if each reference in that Division to</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;234&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>the “offeree company” or the “offeror” were a reference to the “company”,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;234&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>a “dissenting offeree” were a reference to a holder of a share of the company who has not offered to sell his or her share under the terms of the mutualization proposal,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;234&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>an “offeree who accepted the take-over bid” were a reference to a holder of a share of the company who has offered to sell his or her share under the terms of the mutualization proposal, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;234&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;iv&quot;"><Label>(iv)</Label><Text>the “date of the take-over bid” or the “date of termination of the take-over bid” were a reference to the date on which the Superintendent approves the purchase or other acquisition of the shares of the company pursuant to a mutualization proposal.</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;235&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;235&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Payment</MarginalNote><Label>235.</Label><Text>Notwithstanding anything in this Act, a company may, with the approval of the Superintendent, pay for shares purchased or otherwise acquired pursuant to a mutualization proposal by</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;235&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>making a promissory note that is, or issuing debt securities that are, payable at a fixed or determinable future time not later than ten years after the date of its making or their issue; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;235&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>issuing shares that a mutual company may issue.</Text></Paragraph></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;236&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;236&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Conversion into mutual company</MarginalNote><Label>236.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;236&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where a company purchases or otherwise acquires all of its common shares pursuant to a mutualization proposal,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;236&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the company shall cancel those shares; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;236&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the directors of the company shall apply to the Minister for the issue of letters patent to effect the conversion of the company into a mutual company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;236&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;236&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Issue of letters patent</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>On receipt of an application referred to in subsection (1), the Minister shall issue letters patent to effect the conversion of the company into a mutual company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;236&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;236&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effect of letters patent</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Letters patent issued pursuant to subsection (2) become effective on the day stated in the letters patent.</Text></Subsection></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_III&quot;,gc=&quot;s_236.1&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_III&quot;,gc=&quot;s_236.1&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Conversion into Company with Common Shares</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;236.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;236.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Definitions</MarginalNote><Label>236.1</Label><Text>The following definitions apply in sections 237 to 237.2.</Text><Definition Code="se=&quot;236.1&quot;,df=&quot;{conversion proposal}{proposition de transformation}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;236.1&quot;,df=&quot;{conversion proposal}{proposition de transformation}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>conversion proposal</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;236.1&quot;,df=&quot;{conversion proposal}{proposition de transformation}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>proposition de transformation</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>conversion proposal</DefinedTermEn> means a proposal to convert a mutual company into a company with common shares.</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;236.1&quot;,df=&quot;{converting company}{société en transformation}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;236.1&quot;,df=&quot;{converting company}{société en transformation}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>converting company</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;236.1&quot;,df=&quot;{converting company}{société en transformation}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>société en transformation</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>converting company</DefinedTermEn> has the meaning given to that expression by the regulations.</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;236.1&quot;,df=&quot;{eligible policyholder}{souscripteur admissible}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;236.1&quot;,df=&quot;{eligible policyholder}{souscripteur admissible}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>eligible policyholder</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;236.1&quot;,df=&quot;{eligible policyholder}{souscripteur admissible}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>souscripteur admissible</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>eligible policyholder</DefinedTermEn> has the meaning given to that expression by the regulations.</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;236.1&quot;,df=&quot;{letters patent of conversion}{lettres patentes de transformation}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;236.1&quot;,df=&quot;{letters patent of conversion}{lettres patentes de transformation}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>letters patent of conversion</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;236.1&quot;,df=&quot;{letters patent of conversion}{lettres patentes de transformation}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>lettres patentes de transformation</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>letters patent of conversion</DefinedTermEn> means letters patent issued under paragraph 237(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>).</Text></Definition><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1999, c. 1, s. 4;</li><li> 2011, c. 15, s. 30.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;237&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Conversion into company with common shares</MarginalNote><Label>237.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>On the application of a mutual company made in accordance with the regulations, the Minister may, on the recommendation of the Superintendent,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>approve a conversion proposal; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>issue letters patent of conversion to effect the conversion proposal.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Special meeting of eligible policyholders</MarginalNote><Label>(1.1)</Label><Text>Before an application is made under subsection (1), the directors of the company must call a special meeting of eligible policyholders to obtain</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>approval of the conversion proposal;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>confirmation of any by-law or of any amendment to or repeal of a by-law that is necessary to implement the conversion proposal; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>authorization to make the application.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;1.2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;1.2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of meeting and policyholder list</MarginalNote><Label>(1.2)</Label><Text>A company shall, in respect of a special meeting,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;1.2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>send, not less than 45 days and not more than 75 days before the meeting, to each eligible policyholder a notice of the time and place of the meeting, describing the conversion proposal in sufficient detail to permit a policyholder to form a reasoned judgment about the terms of the proposal and its impact on both policyholders and the company, together with the prescribed information in respect of the conversion proposal; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;1.2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>prepare, not less than 45 days before the meeting, a list, which may be in electronic form, of all eligible policyholders.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;1.3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;1.3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application of subsection 149(5)</MarginalNote><Label>(1.3)</Label><Text>Subsection 149(5) applies, with any modifications that the circumstances require, in respect of the list of eligible policyholders.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;1.4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;1.4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Entitlement to notice and right to vote</MarginalNote><Label>(1.4)</Label><Text>Only eligible policyholders are entitled to notice of and to vote at a special meeting.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;1.5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;1.5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Special resolution</MarginalNote><Label>(1.5)</Label><Text>Any approval, confirmation or authorization referred to in subsection (1.1) must be given by special resolution of the eligible policyholders.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the application referred to in subsection (1), including the form of the application and the information to be contained in the application, and authorizing the Superintendent to require additional information in order to make a recommendation;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a.1&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a.1</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the conversion proposal, including the information to be contained in the conversion proposal, and authorizing the Superintendent to approve the measures to be taken by the converting company in respect of any proposed amendment to the conversion proposal;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a.2&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a.2</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the value of a converting company for the purposes of the regulations and authorizing the Superintendent to specify a day at which the value shall be estimated by the converting company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>concerning the fair and equitable treatment of policyholders under a conversion proposal;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>governing the ownership of shares issued by a mutual company that has been converted into a company with common shares;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c.1&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c.1</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the authorization by the Superintendent of the sending of a notice of a special meeting referred to in subsection (1.1), including</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c.1&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>prescribing the information to be submitted by the converting company in support of an authorization,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c.1&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>authorizing the Superintendent to consider information in addition to that referred to in subparagraph (i), and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c.1&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>authorizing the Superintendent to require that information, in addition to the prescribed information referred to in paragraph (1.2)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>), be sent with a notice;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c.2&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c.2</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>authorizing the Superintendent to</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c.2&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>require the converting company to hold one or more information sessions for eligible policyholders and to take other measures to assist eligible policyholders in forming a reasoned judgment on the conversion proposal, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c.2&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>set the rules under which the information sessions must be held;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c.3&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c.3</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting restrictions on any fee, compensation or other consideration that may be paid, in respect of the conversion of a mutual company into a company with common shares, to any director, officer or employee of the company or to any entity with which a director, officer or employee of the company is associated;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c.4&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c.4</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>prohibiting, during the period set out in the regulations, the issuance or provision of shares, share options or rights to acquire shares, of a company that has been converted from a mutual company into a company with common shares to</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c.4&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>any director, officer or employee of the company, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c.4&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>any person who was a director, officer or employee of the company during the year preceding the effective date of conversion of the company; and</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>generally, respecting the conversion of a mutual company into a company with common shares.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exemption by Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A regulation made under subsection (2) may provide that the Superintendent may, on such terms and conditions as the Superintendent considers appropriate, exempt a company from prescribed requirements of that regulation.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exemption by Minister</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>The Minister may, on such terms and conditions as the Minister considers appropriate, exempt a company from any requirement of this Act or the regulations if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the company is a mutual company applying for the approval of a proposal to convert the company into a company with common shares; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;237&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the Minister is of the opinion that the company is, or is about to be, in financial difficulty and that the exemption would help to facilitate an improvement in the financial condition of the company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 237;</li><li> 1994, c. 26, s. 38(E);</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 215;</li><li> 1999, c. 1, s. 5.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;237.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;237.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effect of letters patent of conversion</MarginalNote><Label>237.1</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;237.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Letters patent of conversion become effective on the day stated in the letters patent of conversion, and on that day</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;237.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the company ceases to be a mutual company; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;237.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the policyholders of the company cease to have any rights with respect to or any interest in the company as a mutual company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;237.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;237.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Consideration for shares</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>For the purposes of subsection 69(1) and section 70, shares issued by a company under a conversion proposal are deemed to be fully paid for in money and the amount of consideration received by the company for those shares is deemed to be equal to the book value of the company immediately after the effective date of its conversion, determined in accordance with the accounting principles referred to in subsection 331(4) and calculated without taking into account any amounts remaining at that time in the participating accounts that the company maintains under section 456.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 216;</li><li> 1999, c. 1, s. 6.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;237.2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;237.2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Distribution prohibited</MarginalNote><Label>237.2</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;237.2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A mutual company shall not take any action or series of actions directed toward the distribution of all or part of its property to its policyholders or shareholders or the provision of any other benefit to its policyholders or shareholders, other than as provided in subsections 237(1) to (1.2), until a conversion proposal has been approved by the Minister under subsection 237(1).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;237.2&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;237.2&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Nothing in subsection (1) prevents</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;237.2&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the directors of the company from declaring a dividend on shares or a policy dividend, bonus or other benefit payable to policyholders in the ordinary course of business; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;237.2&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the company from paying or otherwise satisfying a dividend, bonus or other benefit referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>).</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;237.2&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;237.2&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Non-application</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>This section does not apply to a company that is insolvent within the meaning of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="W-11">Winding-up and Restructuring Act</XRefExternal>.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2011, c. 15, s. 31.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_III&quot;,gc=&quot;s_238&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_III&quot;,gc=&quot;s_238&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Amendments — By-laws</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;238&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;238&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">By-laws</MarginalNote><Label>238.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;238&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The directors of a company may make, amend or repeal any by-laws, in the manner set out in subsections (2) and (3) and sections 239 to 244, to</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;238&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>change the maximum number, if any, of shares of any class that the company is authorized to issue;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;238&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>create new classes of shares;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;238&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>change the designation of any or all of the company’s shares, and add, change or remove any rights, privileges, restrictions and conditions, including rights to accrued dividends, in respect of any or all of the company’s shares, whether issued or unissued;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;238&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>change the shares of any class or series, whether issued or unissued, into a different number of shares of the same class or series or into the same or a different number of shares of other classes or series;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;238&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>divide a class of shares, whether issued or unissued, into series and fix the maximum number of shares, if any, in each series and the rights, privileges, restrictions and conditions attached thereto;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;238&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>authorize the directors to divide any class of unissued shares into series and fix the maximum number of shares, if any, in each series and the rights, privileges, restrictions and conditions attached thereto;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;238&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>authorize the directors to change the rights, privileges, restrictions and conditions attached to unissued shares of any series;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;238&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;h&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">h</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>revoke, diminish or enlarge any authority conferred under paragraphs (<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>) and (<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;238&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">i</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>change the rights of policyholders to vote at meetings of shareholders or policyholders, subject to subsection 153(1);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;238&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;i.1&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">i.1</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>change the name of the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;238&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;j&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">j</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>increase or decrease the number of directors, the minimum or maximum number of directors, the number of directors who are to be elected by the shareholders or the number of directors who are to be elected by the policyholders, subject to subsections 167(1) and 173(4) and (4.1) and section 176; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;238&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;k&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">k</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>change the province in which the head office of the company is situated.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;238&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;238&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shareholder or policyholder approval</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The directors shall submit a by-law, or an amendment to or a repeal of a by-law, that is made under subsection (1) to the shareholders and policyholders entitled to vote, and the shareholders and policyholders may, by special resolution, confirm, amend or reject the by-law, amendment or repeal.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;238&quot;,ss=&quot;2.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;238&quot;,ss=&quot;2.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Right to vote</MarginalNote><Label>(2.1)</Label><Text>The by-laws of a company may provide that each participating share, as defined in section 83.01, of a mutual company carries the right to vote on a proposed addition or amendment to the by-laws to do anything referred to in any of paragraphs (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">h</Emphasis>), (<Emphasis style="italic">j</Emphasis>) and (<Emphasis style="italic">k</Emphasis>). Where that right is provided for in the by-laws, each of those shares carries that right even if they do not otherwise carry the right to vote.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;238&quot;,ss=&quot;2.2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;238&quot;,ss=&quot;2.2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Separate vote</MarginalNote><Label>(2.2)</Label><Text>The holders of shares who are entitled under subsection (2.1) to vote on a proposed addition or amendment referred to in that subsection are entitled to vote on it separately from policyholders.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;238&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;238&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effective date of by-law</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A by-law, or an amendment to or a repeal of a by-law, made under subsection (1) is not effective until it is confirmed or confirmed as amended by the shareholders and policyholders under subsection (2) and, in the case of a by-law respecting a change to the name of the company, approved by the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;238&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;238&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Letters patent</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>If the name of a company or the province in Canada in which the head office of the company is situated is changed under this section, the Superintendent may issue letters patent to amend the company’s incorporating instrument accordingly.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;238&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;238&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effect of letters patent</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>Letters patent issued under subsection (4) become effective on the day stated in the letters patent.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 238;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 217;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 388;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 260;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 204.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20060427">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;239&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;239&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Class vote</MarginalNote><Label>239.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;239&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The holders of shares of a class or, subject to subsection (2), of a series are, unless the by-laws otherwise provide in the case of an amendment to the by-laws referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>), (<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>), entitled to vote separately as a class or series on a proposal to amend the by-laws to</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;239&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>increase or decrease any maximum number of authorized shares of that class, or increase any maximum number of authorized shares of a class having rights or privileges equal or superior to the shares of that class;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;239&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>effect an exchange, reclassification or cancellation of all or part of the shares of that class;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;239&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>add, change or remove the rights, privileges, restrictions or conditions attached to the shares of that class and, without limiting the generality of the foregoing,</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;239&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>remove or change prejudicially rights to accrued dividends or rights to cumulative dividends,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;239&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>add, remove or change prejudicially redemption rights,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;239&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>reduce or remove a dividend preference or a liquidation preference, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;239&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;iv&quot;"><Label>(iv)</Label><Text>add, remove or change prejudicially conversion privileges, options, voting, transfer or pre-emptive rights, or rights to acquire securities of the company, or sinking fund provisions;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;239&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>increase the rights or privileges of any class of shares having rights or privileges equal or superior to the shares of that class;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;239&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>create a new class of shares equal or superior to the shares of that class;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;239&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>make any class of shares having rights or privileges inferior to the shares of that class equal or superior to the shares of that class; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;239&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>effect an exchange or create a right of exchange of all or part of the shares of another class into the shares of that class.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;239&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;239&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Right limited</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The holders of a series of shares of a class are entitled to vote separately as a series under subsection (1) if that series is affected by an addition or amendment to the by-laws in a manner different from other shares of the same class.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;239&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;239&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Right to vote</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Subsections (1) and (2) apply whether or not the shares of a class otherwise carry the right to vote.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;240&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;240&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Participating policyholder vote</MarginalNote><Label>240.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;240&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Participating policyholders are entitled to vote separately on a proposal to amend the by-laws to add to, change or remove the rights of policyholders, other than participating policyholders, to vote at meetings of shareholders or policyholders.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;240&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;240&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Policyholder vote</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Policyholders who are entitled to vote, other than participating policyholders, are entitled to vote separately on a proposal to amend the by-laws to add to, change or remove the rights of policyholders, other than participating policyholders, to vote at meetings of shareholders or policyholders.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;240&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;240&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Right limited</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The holders of a class of non-participating policies who are entitled to vote are entitled to vote separately as a class if the right to vote attached to policies of that class is added to, changed or removed by an addition or amendment to the by-laws in a manner different from the right to vote attached to other non-participating policies.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;241&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;241&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Separate resolutions</MarginalNote><Label>241.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;241&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A proposed addition or amendment to the by-laws referred to in subsection 239(1) is adopted when the holders of the shares of each class or series entitled to vote separately thereon as a class or series and the policyholders have approved the addition or amendment by a special resolution.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;241&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;241&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Idem</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A proposed addition or amendment to the by-laws referred to in section 240 is adopted when the participating policyholders, the non-participating policyholders who are entitled to vote and the holders of each class of non-participating policies entitled to vote separately thereon as a class and the shareholders have approved the addition or amendment by a special resolution.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;242&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;242&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Revoking resolution</MarginalNote><Label>242.</Label><Text>Where a special resolution referred to in subsection 238(2) so states, the directors may, without further approval of the shareholders or policyholders, revoke the special resolution.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;243&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;243&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Proposal to amend</MarginalNote><Label>243.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;243&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection (2), a director or a shareholder or policyholder who is entitled to vote at an annual meeting of shareholders and policyholders of a company may, in accordance with sections 147 and 148, make a proposal to make an application referred to in section 224 or to make, amend or repeal the by-laws referred to in subsection 238(1) of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;243&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;243&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of amendment</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Notice of a meeting of shareholders or policyholders at which a proposal to amend the incorporating instrument or to make, amend or repeal the by-laws of a company to effect any of the changes referred to in subsection 238(1) is to be considered must set out the proposal.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 243;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 389.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;244&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;244&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Rights preserved</MarginalNote><Label>244.</Label><Text>No amendment to the incorporating instrument or by-laws of a company affects an existing cause of action or claim or liability to prosecution in favour of or against the company or its directors or officers, or any civil, criminal or administrative action or proceeding to which the company or any of its directors or officers are a party.</Text></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_III&quot;,gc=&quot;s_245&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_III&quot;,gc=&quot;s_245&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Amalgamation</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;245&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;245&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application to amalgamate</MarginalNote><Label>245.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;245&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>On the joint application of two or more bodies corporate, incorporated by or under an Act of Parliament, including companies and insurance holding companies, the Minister may issue letters patent amalgamating and continuing the applicants as one mutual company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;245&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;245&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application to amalgamate</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>On the joint application of two or more bodies corporate incorporated by or under an Act of Parliament, including companies — other than mutual companies — and insurance holding companies, the Minister may issue letters patent amalgamating and continuing the applicants as one company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;245&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;245&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application to amalgamate societies</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>On the joint application of two or more societies, the Minister may issue letters patent amalgamating and continuing the applicants as one society.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 245;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 218;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 390.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;246&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;246&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Amalgamation agreement</MarginalNote><Label>246.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;246&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Each applicant proposing to amalgamate shall enter into an amalgamation agreement.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;246&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;246&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Contents of agreement — company</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Every amalgamation agreement for an amalgamation to which subsection 245(1) or (2) applies shall set out the terms and means of effecting the amalgamation and, in particular,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;246&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the name of the amalgamated company and the province in which its head office is to be situated;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;246&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>whether the amalgamated company is to be a mutual company or a company with common shares;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;246&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the name and place of ordinary residence of each proposed director of the amalgamated company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;246&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the manner in which any shares of each applicant are to be converted into shares or other securities of the amalgamated company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;246&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if any shares of an applicant are not to be converted into shares or other securities of the amalgamated company, the amount of money or securities that the holders of those shares are to receive in addition to or in lieu of shares or other securities of the amalgamated company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;246&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the manner of payment of money in lieu of the issue of fractional shares of the amalgamated company or of any other body corporate that are to be issued in the amalgamation;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;246&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the proposed by-laws of the amalgamated company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;246&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;h&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">h</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>details of any other matter necessary to perfect the amalgamation and to provide for the subsequent management and operation of the amalgamated company; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;246&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">i</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the proposed effective date of the amalgamation.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;246&quot;,ss=&quot;2.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;246&quot;,ss=&quot;2.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Contents of agreement — society</MarginalNote><Label>(2.1)</Label><Text>Every amalgamation agreement for an amalgamation to which subsection 245(3) applies shall set out the terms and means of effecting the amalgamation and, in particular,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;246&quot;,ss=&quot;2.1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the name of the amalgamated society and the province in which its head office is to be situated;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;246&quot;,ss=&quot;2.1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the name and place of ordinary residence of each proposed director of the amalgamated society;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;246&quot;,ss=&quot;2.1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the proposed by-laws of the amalgamated society;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;246&quot;,ss=&quot;2.1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>details of any other matter necessary to perfect the amalgamation and to provide for the subsequent management and operation of the amalgamated society; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;246&quot;,ss=&quot;2.1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the proposed effective date of the amalgamation.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;246&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;246&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Cross ownership of shares</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>If shares of one of the applicants are held by or on behalf of another of the applicants, other than shares held in the capacity of a personal representative or by way of security, the amalgamation agreement must provide for the cancellation of those shares when the amalgamation becomes effective without any repayment of capital in respect thereof, and no provision shall be made in the agreement for the conversion of those shares into shares of the amalgamated company.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 246;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 219;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 261.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;247&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;247&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Approval of agreement by Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>247.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;247&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>An amalgamation agreement must be submitted to the Superintendent for approval and any approval of the agreement under subsection 248(5) by the shareholders, policyholders or members of an applicant is invalid unless, before the date of the approval, the Superintendent has approved the agreement in writing.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;247&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;247&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Report of independent actuary</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>An amalgamation agreement submitted to the Superintendent for approval must be accompanied by the report of an independent actuary on the agreement.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 247;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 220(E);</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 205.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;248&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;248&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Approval by shareholders, policyholders and members</MarginalNote><Label>248.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;248&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The directors of each applicant shall submit an amalgamation agreement for approval</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;248&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>to a meeting of the shareholders and policyholders entitled to vote of the applicant company of which they are directors and to the holders of each class or series of shares;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;248&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>to a meeting of the shareholders of the body corporate of which they are directors and to the holders of each class or series of shares; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;248&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>to a meeting of the members of the applicant society of which they are directors.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;248&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;248&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Right to vote</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Each share of an applicant carries the right to vote in respect of an amalgamation agreement whether or not it otherwise carries the right to vote.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;248&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;248&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Separate vote for class or series</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The holders of shares of a class or series of shares of each applicant are entitled to vote separately as a class or series in respect of an amalgamation agreement if the agreement contains a provision that, if it were contained in a proposed amendment to the by-laws or incorporating instrument of the applicant, would entitle those holders to vote separately as a class or series.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;248&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;248&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Policyholder vote</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Policyholders who are entitled to vote are entitled to vote separately from shareholders in respect of an amalgamation agreement.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;248&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;248&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Special resolution</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>Subject to subsections (3) and (4), an amalgamation agreement is approved when it has been approved by special resolution by</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;248&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the shareholders and the policyholders who are entitled to vote of each applicant company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;248&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the shareholders of each applicant body corporate; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;248&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the members of each applicant society.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;248&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;248&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Termination</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>An amalgamation agreement may provide that, at any time before the issue of letters patent of amalgamation, the agreement may be terminated by the directors of an applicant even though the agreement has been approved by the shareholders, policyholders or members of all or any of the applicant companies, bodies corporate or societies.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 248;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 221;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 262.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;249&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;249&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Vertical short-form amalgamation</MarginalNote><Label>249.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;249&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company that does not have any participating policyholders may, without complying with sections 246 to 248, amalgamate with one or more bodies corporate that</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;249&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>are incorporated by or under an Act of Parliament,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;249&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>are wholly-owned subsidiaries of the company, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;249&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>do not have any participating policyholders</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>if</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;249&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the amalgamation is approved by a resolution of the directors of the company and of each amalgamating subsidiary, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;249&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the resolutions provide that</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;249&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>the shares of each amalgamating subsidiary will be cancelled without any repayment of capital in respect thereof,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;249&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>the letters patent of amalgamation and the by-laws of the amalgamated company will be the same as the incorporating instrument and the by-laws of the amalgamating company that is the holding body corporate, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;249&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>no securities will be issued by the amalgamated company in connection with the amalgamation.</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;249&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;249&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Horizontal short-form amalgamation</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Two or more bodies corporate that</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;249&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>are incorporated by or under an Act of Parliament,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;249&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>are wholly-owned subsidiaries of the same holding body corporate, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;249&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>do not have any participating policyholders</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>may amalgamate and continue as one company without complying with sections 246 to 248 if</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;249&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>at least one of the applicants is a company,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;249&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the amalgamation is approved by a resolution of the directors of each of the applicants, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;249&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the resolutions provide that</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;249&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>the shares of all applicants, except those of one of the applicants that is a company, will be cancelled without any repayment of capital in respect thereof,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;249&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>the letters patent of amalgamation and the by-laws of the amalgamated company will be the same as the incorporating instrument and the by-laws of the amalgamating company whose shares are not cancelled, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;249&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>the stated capital of the amalgamating companies and bodies corporate whose shares are cancelled will be added to the stated capital of the amalgamating company whose shares are not cancelled.</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 249;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 263.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;250&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;250&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Joint application to Minister</MarginalNote><Label>250.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;250&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection (2), unless an amalgamation agreement is terminated in accordance with subsection 248(6), the applicants shall, within three months after the approval of the agreement in accordance with subsection 248(5) or the approval of the directors in accordance with subsection 249(1) or (2), jointly apply to the Minister for letters patent of amalgamation continuing the applicants as one company or society.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;250&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;250&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Conditions precedent to application</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>No application for the issue of letters patent under subsection (1) may be made unless</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;250&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>notice of intention to make such an application has been published at least once a week for a period of four consecutive weeks in the <XRefExternal reference-type="other" link="gazette">Canada Gazette</XRefExternal> and in a newspaper in general circulation at or near the place where the head office of each applicant is situated; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;250&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the application is supported by satisfactory evidence that the applicants have complied with the requirements of this Part relating to amalgamations.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;250&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;250&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application of sections 23 to 26</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>If two or more bodies corporate, none of which is a company or society, apply for letters patent under subsection (1), sections 23 to 26 apply in respect of the application with any modifications that the circumstances require.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;250&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;250&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Matters for consideration</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Before issuing letters patent of amalgamation continuing the applicants as one company or society, the Minister shall take into account all matters that the Minister considers relevant to the application, including</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;250&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the sources of continuing financial support for the amalgamated company or society;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;250&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the soundness and feasibility of the plans of the applicants for the future conduct and development of the business of the amalgamated company or society;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;250&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the business record and experience of the applicants;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;250&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the reputation of the applicants for being operated in a manner that is consistent with the standards of good character and integrity;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;250&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>whether the amalgamated company or society will be operated responsibly by persons with the competence and experience suitable for involvement in the operation of a financial institution;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;250&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the impact of any integration of the operations and businesses of the applicants on the conduct of those operations and businesses;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;250&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if one of the applicants is a converted company in respect of which the Minister has issued an order under subsection 407(8) or a converted company in respect of which subsection 407(11) applied at any time, or a body corporate that controls, within the meaning of paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), such a company, the opinion of the Superintendent regarding the extent to which the proposed corporate structure of the amalgamated company and its affiliates may affect the supervision and regulation of the amalgamated company, having regard to</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;250&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>the nature and extent of the proposed financial services activities to be carried out by the amalgamated company and its affiliates, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;250&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>the nature and degree of supervision and regulation applying to the proposed financial services activities to be carried out by the affiliates of the amalgamated company; and</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;250&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;h&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">h</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the best interests of the financial system in Canada.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;250&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;250&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>The Minister may not, before January 1, 2002, issue letters patent under section 251 amalgamating a converted company in respect of which subsection 407(4) or (11) applies, a company to which subsection 407(5) or (12) applies or an insurance holding company to which subsection 407(6) or (13) applies with any other body corporate.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;250&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;250&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>If one of the applicants for letters patent of amalgamation is a converted company in respect of which subsection 407(4) applies, or a company to which subsection 407(5) applies or an insurance holding company to which subsection 407(6) applies, the Minister may not issue the letters patent of amalgamation unless the amalgamated company is</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;250&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>widely held; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;250&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>controlled, within the meaning of paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), by a company to which subsection 407(5) applies, or by an insurance holding company to which subsection 407(6) applies, that controlled one of the applicants at the time the application was made.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;250&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;250&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Deeming</MarginalNote><Label>(7)</Label><Text>If one of the applicants for letters patent of amalgamation is a converted company in respect of which subsection 407(4) applies, a company to which subsection 407(5) applies or an insurance holding company to which subsection 407(6) applies and the letters patent of amalgamation are issued, the amalgamated company is deemed to be a converted company in respect of which subsection 407(4) applies or a company to which subsection 407(5) applies, as the case may be.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 250;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 222;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 391.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;251&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;251&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Issue of letters patent</MarginalNote><Label>251.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;251&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where an application has been made to the Minister in accordance with section 250, the Minister may issue letters patent of amalgamation continuing the applicants as one company or society.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;251&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;251&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Letters patent</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where letters patent are issued pursuant to this section, section 28 applies with such modifications as the circumstances require in respect of the issue of the letters patent.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;251&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;251&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Publication of notice</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The Superintendent shall cause to be published in the <XRefExternal reference-type="other" link="gazette">Canada Gazette</XRefExternal> notice of the issuance of letters patent pursuant to subsection (1).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 251;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 223.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;251.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;251.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Court enforcement</MarginalNote><Label>251.1</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;251.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If a company or society, or any director, officer, employee or agent of a company or society, is contravening or has failed to comply with any term or condition made in respect of the issuance of letters patent of amalgamation, the Minister may, in addition to any other action that may be taken under this Act, apply to a court for an order directing the company or society, or the director, officer, employee or agent, to comply with the term or condition, cease the contravention or do any thing that is required to be done, and on the application the court may so order and make any other order it thinks fit.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;251.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;251.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Appeal</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>An appeal from an order of a court under this section lies in the same manner as, and to the same court to which, an appeal may be taken from any other order of the court.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 392.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;252&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;252&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effect of letters patent</MarginalNote><Label>252.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;252&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>On the day provided for in the letters patent issued under section 251</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;252&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the amalgamation of the applicants and their continuance as one company or society becomes effective;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;252&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the property of each applicant continues to be the property of the amalgamated company or society;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;252&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the amalgamated company or society continues to be liable for the obligations of each applicant;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;252&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any existing cause of action, claim or liability to prosecution is unaffected;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;252&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any civil, criminal or administrative action or proceeding pending by or against an applicant may be continued to be prosecuted by or against the amalgamated company or society;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;252&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any conviction against, or ruling, order or judgment in favour of or against, an applicant may be enforced by or against the amalgamated company or society;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;252&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if any director or officer of an applicant continues as a director or officer of the amalgamated company, any disclosure by that director or officer of a material interest in any contract made to the applicant shall be deemed to be disclosure to the amalgamated company; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;252&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;h&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">h</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the letters patent of amalgamation are the incorporating instrument of the amalgamated company or society.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;252&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;252&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Minutes</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Any deemed disclosure under paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>) shall be recorded in the minutes of the first meeting of directors of the amalgamated company.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 252;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 224.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;253&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;253&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Transitional</MarginalNote><Label>253.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;253&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Notwithstanding any other provision of this Act or the regulations, the Minister may, by order, on the recommendation of the Superintendent, grant to a company or society in respect of which letters patent were issued under subsection 251(1) permission to</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;253&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>engage in a business activity specified in the order that the company or society would not otherwise be permitted by this Act to engage in and that one or more of the amalgamating bodies corporate was engaging in at the time application for the letters patent was made;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;253&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>continue to have issued and outstanding debt obligations the issue of which is not authorized by this Act if the debt obligations were outstanding at the time the application for the letters patent was made;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;253&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 1994, c. 47, s. 121]</Repealed></Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;253&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>hold assets that the company or society would not otherwise be permitted by this Act to hold, if the assets were held by one or more of the amalgamating bodies corporate at the time the application for the letters patent was made;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;253&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>acquire and hold assets that the company or society would not otherwise be permitted by this Act to acquire or hold, if one or more of the amalgamating bodies corporate were obliged, at the time the application for the letters patent was made, to acquire those assets; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;253&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>maintain outside Canada any records or registers required by this Act to be maintained in Canada.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;253&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;253&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Duration of exceptions</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The permission granted under subsection (1) shall be expressed to be granted for a period specified in the order not exceeding</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;253&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>with respect to any matter described in paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>), thirty days after the date of issue of the letters patent or, where the activity is conducted pursuant to an agreement existing on the date of issue of the letters patent, the expiration of the agreement;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;253&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>with respect to any matter described in paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>), ten years; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;253&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>with respect to any matter described in any of paragraphs (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>), two years.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;253&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;253&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Renewal</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection (4), the Minister, on the recommendation of the Superintendent, may by order renew a permission granted by order under subsection (1) with respect to any matter described in any of paragraphs (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>) for any further period or periods that the Minister considers necessary.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;253&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;253&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limitation</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>The Minister shall not grant to a company or society any permission</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;253&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>with respect to matters described in paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>), that purports to be effective more than ten years after the date of the approval for the company or society to commence and carry on business, unless the Minister is satisfied on the basis of evidence on oath provided by an officer of the company or society that the company or society will not be able at law to redeem at the end of the ten years the outstanding debt obligations to which the permission relates; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;253&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>with respect to matters described in paragraphs (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>) and (<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>), that purports to be effective more than ten years after the date of issue of the letters patent.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 253;</li><li> 1994, c. 47, s. 121;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 225;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 206.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_III&quot;,gc=&quot;s_254&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_III&quot;,gc=&quot;s_254&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Transfer of Business and Reinsurance</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;254&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;254&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restricted transactions</MarginalNote><Label>254.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;254&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Except in accordance with this section or an order made under subsection 678.5(1), a company or society shall not</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;254&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>cause itself to be reinsured, on an assumption basis, against all or any portion of the risks undertaken under its policies; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;254&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>sell all or substantially all of its assets.</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;254&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 2007, c. 6, s. 207]</Repealed></Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;254&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;254&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Approval of the Minister</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A company or society may, with the approval of the Minister,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;254&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>cause itself to be reinsured, on an assumption basis, against all or substantially all of the risks undertaken under its policies, by one or more of the following entities:</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;254&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>a company or society,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;254&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>a foreign company that, in Canada, reinsures those risks,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;254&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>a body corporate incorporated or formed by or under the laws of a province, if the Superintendent has entered into satisfactory arrangements concerning the reinsurance with either or both of the body corporate and the appropriate official or public body responsible for the supervision of the body corporate, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;254&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;iv&quot;"><Label>(iv)</Label><Text>an entity that is authorized to reinsure those risks, if the risks were undertaken outside Canada by the company or society; or</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;254&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>sell all or substantially all of its assets.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;254&quot;,ss=&quot;2.01&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;254&quot;,ss=&quot;2.01&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Approval of the Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>(2.01)</Label><Text>A company or society may, with the approval of the Superintendent, cause itself to be reinsured, on an assumption basis, against less than substantially all of the risks undertaken under its policies, by one or more of the following entities:</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;254&quot;,ss=&quot;2.01&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a company or society;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;254&quot;,ss=&quot;2.01&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a foreign company that, in Canada, reinsures those risks;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;254&quot;,ss=&quot;2.01&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a body corporate incorporated or formed by or under the laws of a province, if the Superintendent has entered into satisfactory arrangements concerning the reinsurance with either or both of the body corporate and the appropriate official or public body responsible for the supervision of the body corporate; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;254&quot;,ss=&quot;2.01&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an entity that is authorized to reinsure those risks, if the risks were undertaken outside Canada by the company or society.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;254&quot;,ss=&quot;2.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;254&quot;,ss=&quot;2.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Prescribed transactions</MarginalNote><Label>(2.1)</Label><Text>The approval of the Minister or Superintendent is not required for a prescribed transaction or a transaction in a prescribed class of transactions.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;254&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;254&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Procedure</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The company or society must, at least 30 days before it applies for the Minister’s or Superintendent’s approval, publish a notice in the <XRefExternal reference-type="other" link="gazette">Canada Gazette</XRefExternal> and in a newspaper in general circulation at or near the place where the head office of the company or society is situated stating the day on or after which it will apply.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;254&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;254&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Information</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Where a company or society publishes a notice referred to in subsection (3), the Superintendent may direct the company or society to provide its shareholders, policyholders and members with such information as the Superintendent may require.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;254&quot;,ss=&quot;4.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;254&quot;,ss=&quot;4.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Report of independent actuary</MarginalNote><Label>(4.1)</Label><Text>An application for approval under paragraph (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) must, if the Superintendent so requires, be accompanied by the report of an independent actuary on the proposed reinsurance agreement.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;254&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;254&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Inspection</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>If a company or society publishes a notice referred to in subsection (3), it must make the agreement for the transaction that the Minister or Superintendent is asked to approve available at its head office for the inspection of its shareholders, policyholders and members for at least 30 days after the publication of the notice and must provide a copy of the agreement to any shareholder, policyholder or member who requests one by writing to the head office of the company or society.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;254&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;254&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Superintendent may shorten periods</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>If the Superintendent is of the opinion that it is in the best interests of a group of policyholders affected by the transaction that the Minister or the Superintendent is asked to approve, the Superintendent may shorten the periods of 30 days referred to in subsections (3) and (5).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 254;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 226;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 393;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 207.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;255&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;255&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Taking of effect of approval</MarginalNote><Label>255.</Label><Text>A transaction referred to in subsection 254(2) or (2.01) has no effect until it has been approved by the Minister or the Superintendent, as the case may be.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 255;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 227;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 208.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;256&quot;"><Label>256.</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 2007, c. 6, s. 208]</Repealed></Text><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;257&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;257&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shareholder and policyholder approval</MarginalNote><Label>257.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;257&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company or society proposing to transfer all or substantially all of its policies, to cause itself to be reinsured, on an assumption basis, against all or substantially all of the risks undertaken under its policies, or to sell all or substantially all of its assets shall submit the proposal for approval to a meeting of the shareholders and policyholders who are entitled to vote, or to a meeting of members, and, subject to subsection (3), to the holders of each class or series of shares.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;257&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;257&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice to Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>(1.1)</Label><Text>A company or society proposing to transfer all or substantially all of its policies must give notice of the proposal to the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;257&quot;,ss=&quot;1.2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;257&quot;,ss=&quot;1.2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Information</MarginalNote><Label>(1.2)</Label><Text>After receiving the notice, the Superintendent may direct the company or society to provide its shareholders, policyholders and members with any information that the Superintendent may require.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;257&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;257&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Right to vote</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Each share of the company carries the right to vote in respect of the proposal whether or not the share otherwise carries the right to vote.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;257&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;257&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Class vote</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The holders of shares of a class or series of shares of the company are entitled to vote separately as a class or series in respect of the proposal if the shares of the class or series are affected by the proposed transaction in a manner different from the shares of another class or series.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;257&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;257&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Policyholder vote</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Policyholders who are entitled to vote are entitled to vote separately from shareholders in respect of the proposal.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;257&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;257&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Special resolution</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>For the purpose of subsection (1), and subject to subsections (3) and (4), the proposal is not approved by the shareholders and the policyholders who are entitled to vote or the members unless they approve it by special resolution.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;257&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;257&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Abandoning transfer or reinsurance</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>Where a special resolution under subsection (5) approving a proposed transaction so states, the directors of a company or society may, subject to the rights of third parties, abandon the transaction without further approval of the shareholders, policyholders or members.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;257&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;257&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application to Minister</MarginalNote><Label>(7)</Label><Text>Except in the case of a transaction to transfer all or substantially all of a company’s or society’s policies, the company or society shall, within three months after the approval of the transaction in accordance with subsection (5), apply to the Minister for approval of the transaction, unless the transaction is abandoned in accordance with subsection (6).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;257&quot;,ss=&quot;8&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;257&quot;,ss=&quot;8&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">When section does not apply</MarginalNote><Label>(8)</Label><Text>This section does not apply if the transfer or reinsurance is made under an order made under subsection 678.5(1).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 257;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 227;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 394;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 209.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;258&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;258&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations</MarginalNote><Label>258.</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may, for the purposes of section 254 or 257, make regulations respecting the circumstances in which companies or societies are deemed to be causing themselves to be reinsured, on an assumption basis, against risks undertaken under their policies.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 258;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 227;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 210.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;259&quot;"><Label>259.</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 1997, c. 15, s. 227]</Repealed></Text></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_IV&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><Label>Division IV</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_IV&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Head Office and Corporate Records</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;260&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;260&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Head office</MarginalNote><Label>260.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;260&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company shall at all times have a head office in the province specified in its incorporating instrument or by-laws.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;260&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;260&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Change of head office</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The directors of a company may change the address of the head office within the province specified in the incorporating instrument or by-laws.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;260&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;260&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of change of address</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A company shall send to the Superintendent, within fifteen days after any change of address of its head office, a notice of the change of address.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 260;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 264.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;261&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;261&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Company records</MarginalNote><Label>261.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;261&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company shall prepare and maintain records containing</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;261&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>its incorporating instrument and the by-laws of the company and all amendments thereto;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;261&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>minutes of meetings and resolutions of shareholders or policyholders;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;261&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the information referred to in paragraphs 668(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>), (<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>) and (<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">h</Emphasis>) contained in all returns provided to the Superintendent pursuant to section 668;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;261&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>particulars of any authorizations, conditions and limitations established by the Superintendent under subsection 58(1) or (2) or 59(1) that are from time to time applicable to the company; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;261&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>particulars of exceptions granted under section 38 or 253 that are from time to time applicable to the company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;261&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;261&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Additional records</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>In addition to the records described in subsection (1), a company shall prepare and maintain adequate</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;261&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>corporate accounting records;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;261&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>records containing minutes of meetings and resolutions of the directors and any committee thereof; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;261&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>records showing, for each customer of, or claimant under a policy issued by, the company, the amount owing to the company and the nature of the liabilities of the company to the customer or claimant.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;261&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;261&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Former-Act and continued companies</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>For the purposes of paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) and subsection (2),</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;261&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of a body corporate continued as a company under this Act, “records” includes similar records required by law to be maintained by the body corporate before it was so continued;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;261&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of a body corporate amalgamated and continued as a company under this Act, “records” includes similar records required by law to be maintained by the body corporate before it was so amalgamated; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;261&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of a former-Act company, “records” includes similar records required by law to be maintained by the company before the coming into force of this section.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 261;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 228(E);</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 211(E).</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;262&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;262&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Place of records</MarginalNote><Label>262.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;262&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The records described in section 261 shall be kept at the head office of the company or at such other place in Canada as the directors think fit.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;262&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;262&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of place of records</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where any of the records described in section 261 are not kept at the head office of a company, the company shall notify the Superintendent of the place where the records are kept.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;262&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;262&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Subsection (1) does not apply in respect of records of an office of the company outside Canada or in respect of customers of such an office.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;262&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;262&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Inspection</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>The records described in section 261, other than those described in paragraph 261(2)(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>), shall at all reasonable times be open to inspection by the directors.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;262&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;262&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Access to company records</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>A company’s shareholders, policyholders entitled to vote and creditors and their personal representatives may examine the records referred to in subsection 261(1) during the usual business hours of the company and may take extracts from them free of charge or have copies of them made on payment of a reasonable fee. If the company is a distributing company, any other person may on payment of a reasonable fee examine those records during the usual business hours of the company and take extracts from them or have copies of them made.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;262&quot;,ss=&quot;5.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;262&quot;,ss=&quot;5.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Electronic access</MarginalNote><Label>(5.1)</Label><Text>A company may make the information contained in records referred to in subsection 261(1) available to persons by any system of mechanical or electronic data processing or any other information storage device that is capable of reproducing the records in intelligible written form within a reasonable time.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;262&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;262&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Copies of by-laws for shareholders</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>Every shareholder of a company is entitled, on request made not more often than once in each calendar year, to receive free of charge one copy of the by-laws of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;262&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;262&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Copies of by-laws for policyholders</MarginalNote><Label>(7)</Label><Text>Every policyholder of a company who is entitled to vote at a meeting of policyholders or shareholders and policyholders of the company is entitled, on request made not more often than once in each calendar year, to receive free of charge one copy of the by-laws of the company.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 262;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 229;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 395;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 265.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;263&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;263&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shareholder lists</MarginalNote><Label>263.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;263&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A person who is entitled to a basic list of shareholders of a company (in this section referred to as the “applicant”) may request the company to furnish the applicant with a basic list within ten days after receipt by the company of the affidavit referred to in subsection (2) and, on payment of a reasonable fee by the applicant, the company shall comply with the request.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;263&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;263&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Affidavit and contents</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A request under subsection (1) must be accompanied by an affidavit containing</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;263&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the name and address of the applicant,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;263&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the name and address for service of the entity, if the applicant is an entity, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;263&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an undertaking that the basic list and any supplemental lists obtained pursuant to subsections (5) and (6) will not be used except as permitted under section 265,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>and, if the applicant is an entity, the affidavit shall be made by a director or an officer of the entity, or any person acting in a similar capacity.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;263&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;263&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Entitlement to list</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A company’s shareholders, policyholders entitled to vote and creditors and their personal representatives are — or if the company is a distributing company, any person is — entitled to a basic list of shareholders of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;263&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;263&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Basic list of shareholders</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>A basic list of shareholders of a company consists of a list of shareholders that is made up to a date not more than ten days before the receipt of the affidavit referred to in subsection (2) and that sets out</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;263&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the names of the shareholders of the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;263&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the number of shares owned by each shareholder; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;263&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the address of each shareholder as shown in the records of the company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;263&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;263&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Supplemental lists</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>A person requiring a company to supply a basic list of shareholders may, if the person states in the accompanying affidavit that supplemental lists are required, request the company or its agent, on payment of a reasonable fee, to provide supplemental lists of shareholders setting out any changes from the basic list in the names and addresses of the shareholders and the number of shares owned by each shareholder for each business day following the date to which the basic list is made up.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;263&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;263&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">When supplemental lists to be furnished</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>A company or its agent shall provide a supplemental list of shareholders required under subsection (5)</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;263&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>within ten days following the date the basic list is provided, where the information relates to changes that took place prior to that date; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;263&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>within ten days following the day to which the supplemental list relates, where the information relates to changes that took place on or after the date the basic list was provided.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 263;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 266.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;264&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;264&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Option holders</MarginalNote><Label>264.</Label><Text>A person requiring a company to supply a basic list or a supplemental list of shareholders may also require the company to include in that list the name and address of any known holder of an option or right to acquire shares of the company.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;265&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;265&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Use of shareholder list</MarginalNote><Label>265.</Label><Text>A list of shareholders obtained under section 263 shall not be used by any person except in connection with</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;265&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an effort to influence the voting of shareholders of the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;265&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an offer to acquire shares of the company; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;265&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any other matter relating to the affairs of the company.</Text></Paragraph></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;266&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;266&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Form of records</MarginalNote><Label>266.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;266&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A register or other record required or authorized by this Act to be prepared and maintained by a company</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;266&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>may be in a bound or loose-leaf form or in a photographic film form; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;266&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>may be entered or recorded by any system of mechanical or electronic data processing or any other information storage device that is capable of reproducing any required information in intelligible written form within a reasonable time.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;266&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;266&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Conversion of records</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Registers and records maintained in one form may be converted to any other form.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;266&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;266&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Destruction of converted records</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Notwithstanding section 269, a company may destroy any register or other record referred to in subsection (1) at any time after the register or other record has been converted to another form.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;267&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;267&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Protection of records</MarginalNote><Label>267.</Label><Text>A company and its agents shall take reasonable precautions to</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;267&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>prevent loss or destruction of,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;267&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>prevent falsification of entries in,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;267&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>facilitate detection and correction of inaccuracies in, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;267&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>ensure that unauthorized persons do not have access to or use of information in,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>the registers and records required or authorized by this Act to be prepared and maintained.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;268&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;268&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Requirement to maintain copies and process information in Canada</MarginalNote><Label>268.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;268&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If the Superintendent is of the opinion that it is incompatible with the fulfilment of the Superintendent’s responsibilities under this Act for a company to maintain, in another country, copies of records referred to in section 261 or of its central securities register or for a company to process, in another country, information or data relating to the preparation and maintenance of those records or of its central securities register — or if the Superintendent is advised by the Minister that, in the opinion of the Minister, it is not in the national interest for a company to do any of those activities in another country — the Superintendent shall direct the company to not maintain those copies, or to not process the information or data, as the case may be, in that other country or to maintain those copies or to process the information or data only in Canada.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;268&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;268&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Company to comply</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A company shall without delay comply with any direction issued under subsection (1).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 268;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 396;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 267;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 212.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20060427">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;269&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;269&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Retention of records</MarginalNote><Label>269.</Label><Text>A company shall retain</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;269&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the records of the company referred to in subsection 261(1);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;269&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any record of the company referred to in paragraph 261(2)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>); and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;269&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the central securities register referred to in subsection 271(1).</Text></Paragraph></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;270&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;270&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations</MarginalNote><Label>270.</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations respecting the records, papers and documents to be retained by a company and the length of time those records, papers and documents are to be retained.</Text></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_V&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><Label>Division V</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_V&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Securities Registers</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;271&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;271&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Central securities register</MarginalNote><Label>271.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;271&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company shall maintain a central securities register in which it shall record the securities, within the meaning of section 85, issued by it in registered form, showing in respect of each class or series of securities</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;271&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the names, alphabetically arranged, and latest known addresses of the persons who are security holders, and the names and latest known addresses of the persons who have been security holders;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;271&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the number of securities held by each security holder; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;271&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the date and particulars of the issue and transfer of each security.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;271&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;271&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Former-Act and continued companies</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>For the purposes of subsection (1), “central securities register” includes similar registers required by law to be maintained by a former-Act company or by a body corporate continued, or amalgamated and continued, as a company under this Act before the continuance, amalgamation or coming into force of this section, as the case may be.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;271&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;271&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Access to central securities register</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A company’s shareholders, policyholders entitled to vote and creditors and their personal representatives may examine the central securities register during the usual business hours of the company and may take extracts from it free of charge or have copies of it made on payment of a reasonable fee. If the company is a distributing company, any other person may on payment of a reasonable fee examine the central securities register during the usual business hours of the company and take extracts from it or have copies of it made.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;271&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;271&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Electronic access</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>The company may make the information contained in the central securities register available by any mechanical or electronic data processing system or other information storage device that is capable of reproducing it in intelligible written form within a reasonable time.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;271&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;271&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Affidavit and undertaking</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>A person who wishes to examine the central securities register, take extracts from it or have copies of it made shall provide the company with an affidavit containing their name and address — or if they are an entity, the name and address for service of the entity — and with an undertaking that the information contained in the register will not be used except in the same way as a list of shareholders may be used under section 265. In the case of an entity, the affidavit is to be sworn by a director or officer of the entity or a person acting in a similar capacity.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;271&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;271&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Supplementary information</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>A person who wishes to examine a central securities register, take extracts from it or have copies of it made may on payment of a reasonable fee, if they state in the accompanying affidavit that supplementary information is required, request the company or its agent to provide supplementary information setting out any changes made to the register.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;271&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;271&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">When supplementary information to be provided</MarginalNote><Label>(7)</Label><Text>A company or its agent shall provide the supplementary information within</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;271&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>10 days after the day on which the central securities register is examined if the changes take place before that day; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;271&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>10 days after the day to which the supplementary information relates if the changes take place on or after the day on which the central securities register is examined.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 271;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 397;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 268.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;272&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;272&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Branch registers</MarginalNote><Label>272.</Label><Text>A company may establish as many branch securities registers as it considers necessary.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;273&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;273&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Agents</MarginalNote><Label>273.</Label><Text>A company may appoint an agent to maintain its central securities register and each of its branch securities registers.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;274&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;274&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Location of central securities register</MarginalNote><Label>274.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;274&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The central securities register of a company shall be maintained by the company at its head office or at any other place in Canada designated by the directors of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;274&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;274&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Location of branch securities register</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A branch securities register of a company may be kept at any place in or outside Canada designated by the directors of the company.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;275&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;275&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effect of registration</MarginalNote><Label>275.</Label><Text>Registration of the issue or transfer of a security in the central securities register or in a branch securities register is complete and valid registration for all purposes.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;276&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;276&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Particulars in branch register</MarginalNote><Label>276.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;276&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A branch securities register shall only contain particulars of the securities issued or transferred at the branch for which that register is established.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;276&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;276&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Particulars in central securities register</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Particulars of each issue or transfer of a security registered in a branch securities register of a company shall also be kept in the central securities register of the company.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;277&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;277&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Destruction of certificates</MarginalNote><Label>277.</Label><Text>A company, its agent or a trustee within the meaning of section 317 is not required to produce</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;277&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a cancelled security certificate in registered form or an instrument referred to in subsection 73(1) that is cancelled or a like cancelled instrument in registered form after six years from the date of its cancellation;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;277&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a cancelled security certificate in bearer form or an instrument referred to in subsection 73(1) that is cancelled or a like cancelled instrument in bearer form after the date of its cancellation; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;277&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an instrument referred to in subsection 73(1) or a like instrument, irrespective of its form, after the date of its expiration.</Text></Paragraph></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_VI&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><Label>Division VI</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_VI&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Corporate Name and Seal</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;278&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;278&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Publication of name</MarginalNote><Label>278.</Label><Text>A company shall set out its name in legible characters in all contracts, premium notices, applications for policies, policies, negotiable instruments and other documents evidencing rights or obligations with respect to other parties that are issued or made by or on behalf of the company.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;279&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;279&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Corporate seal</MarginalNote><Label>279.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;279&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company may adopt a corporate seal and change one that it adopted.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;279&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;279&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Validity of unsealed documents</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A document executed on behalf of a company is not invalid merely because a corporate seal is not affixed to it.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 279;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 269.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_VII&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><Label>Division VII</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_VII&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;" /></Heading><Repealed>[Repealed, 1997, c. 15, s. 230]</Repealed><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_VIII&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><Label>Division VIII</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_VIII&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Insiders</TitleText></Heading><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_VIII&quot;,gc=&quot;s_288&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_VIII&quot;,gc=&quot;s_288&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Interpretation</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;288&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;288&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Definitions</MarginalNote><Label>288.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;288&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>In this Division,</Text><Definition Code="se=&quot;288&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{affiliate}{groupe}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;288&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{affiliate}{groupe}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>affiliate</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;288&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{affiliate}{groupe}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>groupe</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>affiliate</DefinedTermEn> means a body corporate that is affiliated with another body corporate within the meaning of subsection 6(2);</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;288&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{business combination}{regroupement d’entreprises}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;288&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{business combination}{regroupement d’entreprises}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>business combination</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;288&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{business combination}{regroupement d’entreprises}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>regroupement d’entreprises</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>business combination</DefinedTermEn> means an acquisition of all or substantially all of the assets of one body corporate by another, an amalgamation of two or more bodies corporate or any similar reorganization between two or more bodies corporate;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;288&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{call}{option d’achat}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;288&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{call}{option d’achat}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>call</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;288&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{call}{option d’achat}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>option d’achat</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>call</DefinedTermEn> means an option, transferable by delivery, to demand delivery of a specified number or amount of shares at a fixed price within a specified time but does not include an option or right to acquire shares of the body corporate that granted the option or right to acquire;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;288&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{}{}&quot;"><Text><DefinedTermEn>distributing company</DefinedTermEn><Repealed>[Repealed, 2005, c. 54, s. 270]</Repealed></Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;288&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{}{}&quot;"><Text><DefinedTermEn>insider</DefinedTermEn><Repealed>[Repealed, 2005, c. 54, s. 270]</Repealed></Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;288&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{officer}{dirigeant d’une société}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;288&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{officer}{dirigeant d’une société}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>officer</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;288&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{officer}{dirigeant d’une société}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>dirigeant d’une société</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>officer</DefinedTermEn>, in relation to a company, means</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;288&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{officer}{dirigeant d’une société}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an officer as defined in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) of the definition “officer” in section 2, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;288&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{officer}{dirigeant d’une société}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any natural person who performs functions for the company similar to those performed by a person referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) of the definition “officer” in section 2;</Text></Paragraph></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;288&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{put}{option de vente}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;288&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{put}{option de vente}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>put</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;288&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{put}{option de vente}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>option de vente</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>put</DefinedTermEn> means an option, transferable by delivery, to deliver a specified number or amount of shares at a fixed price within a specified time;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;288&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{share}{action}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;288&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{share}{action}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>share</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;288&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{share}{action}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>action</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>share</DefinedTermEn> means a voting share and includes</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;288&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{share}{action}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a security currently convertible into a voting share, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;288&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{share}{action}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a currently exercisable option or a right to acquire a voting share or a security referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>).</Text></Paragraph></Definition></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;288&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;288&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Control</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>For the purposes of this Division, a person controls a body corporate where the person controls the body corporate within the meaning of section 3, determined without regard to paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;288&quot;,ss=&quot;3)&quot;"><Label>(3) and (4)</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 2005, c. 54, s. 270]</Repealed></Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 288;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 270.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_VIII&quot;,gc=&quot;s_289&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_VIII&quot;,gc=&quot;s_289&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Insider Reporting</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;289&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;289&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Insider report</MarginalNote><Label>289.</Label><Text>An insider shall submit an insider report in accordance with the regulations.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 289;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 231;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 271.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;290&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;290&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exemption by Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>290.</Label><Text>On application by an insider, the Superintendent may in writing and on any terms that the Superintendent thinks fit exempt the insider from any of the requirements of section 289. The exemption may be given retroactive effect and the Superintendent shall publish the particulars of the exemption and the reasons for it in a periodical available to the public.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 290;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 271.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;290.1&quot;"><Label>290.1</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 2005, c. 54, s. 271]</Repealed></Text><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;291&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;291&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations</MarginalNote><Label>291.</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations for carrying out the purposes of sections 289 and 290, including</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;291&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>defining “insider” for the purposes of sections 289 and 290;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;291&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the form and content of an insider report; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;291&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the submission or publication of an insider report.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 291;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 271.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;292&quot;"><Label>292.</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 2005, c. 54, s. 271]</Repealed></Text><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_VIII&quot;,gc=&quot;s_293&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_VIII&quot;,gc=&quot;s_293&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Insider Trading</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;293&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;293&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Meaning of <DefinedTermEn>insider</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><Label>293.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;293&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>In this section, <DefinedTermEn>insider</DefinedTermEn> means with respect to a distributing company</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;293&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a director or officer of the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;293&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a director or officer of a subsidiary of the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;293&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a director or officer of a body corporate that enters into a business combination with the company; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;293&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a person employed or retained by the company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;293&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;293&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Prohibition — short sale</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>No insider may knowingly sell, directly or indirectly, a security of a distributing company or of any of the distributing company’s affiliates if the insider does not own or has not fully paid for the security.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;293&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;293&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Despite subsection (2), an insider may sell a security that they do not own if they own another security that is convertible into the security that was sold or they own an option or right to acquire the security that was sold, and if within 10 days after the sale they</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;293&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>exercise the conversion privilege, option or right and deliver the security so acquired to the purchaser; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;293&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>transfer the convertible security, option or right to the purchaser.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;293&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;293&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Prohibition — calls and puts</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>No insider may knowingly, directly or indirectly, buy or sell a call or put in respect of a security of a company or of any of the company’s affiliates.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 293;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 272.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_VIII&quot;,gc=&quot;s_294&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_VIII&quot;,gc=&quot;s_294&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Civil remedies</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;294&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;294&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Extended meaning of <DefinedTermEn>insider</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><Label>294.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;294&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>In this section and sections 294.1 and 295, <DefinedTermEn>insider</DefinedTermEn> with respect to a company means</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;294&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;294&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an affiliate of the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;294&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a director or officer of the company or of any person described in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>), (<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;294&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a person who beneficially owns directly or indirectly, or who exercises control or direction over or has a combination of ownership, control and direction in respect of, shares of the company carrying more than the prescribed percentage of the voting rights attached to all of the company’s outstanding shares not including shares held by the person as underwriter while those shares are in the course of a distribution to the public;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;294&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a person, other than a person described in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>), who is employed or retained by the company or by a person described in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;294&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a person who engages in or proposes to engage in any business or professional activity with or on behalf of the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;294&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a person who received material confidential information concerning the company while they were a person described in any of paragraphs (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;294&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;h&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">h</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a person who receives material confidential information from a person who is and who they know or ought reasonably to have known is a person described in this subsection, including in this paragraph, or subsection (3) or (4); or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;294&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">i</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a prescribed person.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;294&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;294&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Extended meaning of <DefinedTermEn>security</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>For the purposes of this section, each of the following is deemed to be a security of a company:</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;294&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a put, call, option or other right or obligation to purchase or sell a security of the company; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;294&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a security of another entity, the market price of which varies materially with the market price of the securities of the company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;294&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;294&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Deemed insider — take-over bid or business combination</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>For the purposes of this section and subsection 294.1(1), a person who proposes to make a take-over bid as defined in the regulations for securities of a company or to enter into a business combination with a company is an insider of the company with respect to material confidential information obtained from the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;294&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;294&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Deemed insider — affiliate or associate</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>An insider of a person referred to in subsection (3), or the person’s affiliate or associate, is an insider of the company referred to in that subsection. Paragraphs (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">i</Emphasis>) apply in making this determination except that references to “company” are to be read as references to “person described in subsection (3)”.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;294&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;294&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Meaning of <DefinedTermEn>associate</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>In subsection (4), <DefinedTermEn>associate</DefinedTermEn> means with respect to a person</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;294&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a body corporate that the person directly or indirectly controls, determined without regard to paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), or of which they beneficially own shares or securities currently convertible into shares carrying more than 10% of the voting rights under all circumstances or by reason of the occurrence of an event that has occurred and is continuing or a currently exercisable option or right to purchase the shares or convertible securities;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;294&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a partner of the person acting on behalf of the partnership of which they are partners;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;294&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a trust or estate in which the person has a substantial beneficial interest or in respect of which they serve as a trustee or a liquidator of the succession or in a similar capacity;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;294&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a spouse or common-law partner of the person;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;294&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a child of the person or of their spouse or common-law partner; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;294&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if that relative has the same residence as the person, a relative of the person or of their spouse or common-law partner.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;294&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;294&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Insider trading — compensation to sellers and purchasers</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>An insider of a company who purchases or sells a security of the company with knowledge of confidential information that if it were generally known might reasonably be expected to materially affect the value of any of the securities of the company is liable to compensate the seller or purchaser of the security, as the case may be, for any loss suffered by them as a result of the purchase or sale unless the insider establishes that</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;294&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the insider reasonably believed that the information had been generally disclosed;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;294&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the information was known or ought reasonably to have been known by the seller or purchaser; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;294&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the purchase or sale of the security took place in the prescribed circumstances.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;294&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;294&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Insider trading — compensation to company</MarginalNote><Label>(7)</Label><Text>The insider is accountable to the company for any benefit or advantage received or receivable by the insider as a result of a purchase or sale described in subsection (5), unless they establish the circumstances described in paragraph (6)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 294;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 272.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;294.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;294.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Tipping — compensation to sellers and purchasers</MarginalNote><Label>294.1</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;294.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>An insider of a company who discloses confidential information with respect to the company that has not been generally disclosed and that if it were generally known might reasonably be expected to materially affect the value of any of the securities of the company is liable to compensate any person who subsequently sells securities of the company to or purchases them from any person who received the information unless the insider establishes that</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;294.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the insider reasonably believed that the information had been generally disclosed;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;294.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the information was known or ought reasonably to have been known by the person who alleges that they suffered the loss;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;294.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if the insider is not a person described in subsection 294(3) or (4), the disclosure of the information was necessary in the course of their business; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;294.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if the insider is a person described in subsection 294(3) or (4), the disclosure of the information was necessary to effect the take-over bid or business combination.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;294.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;294.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Tipping — compensation to company</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The insider is accountable to the company for any benefit or advantage received or receivable by them as a result of a disclosure of information as described in subsection (1) unless they establish the circumstances described in paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>), (<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2005, c. 54, s. 272.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;295&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;295&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Measure of damages</MarginalNote><Label>295.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;295&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The court may assess damages under subsection 294(6) or 294.1(1) in accord­ance with any measure of damages that it considers relevant in the circumstances. However, in assessing damages in respect of a security of a distributing company, the court shall consider the following:</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;295&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if the plaintiff is a purchaser, the price that they paid for the security less the average market price of the security over the 20 trading days immediately following general disclosure of the information; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;295&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if the plaintiff is a seller, the average market price of the security over the 20 trading days immediately following general disclosure of the information, less the price that they received for the security.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;295&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;295&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Liability — more than one insider</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If more than one insider is liable under subsection 294(6) or 294.1(1) with respect to the same transaction or series of transactions, their liability is joint and several, or solidary.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;295&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;295&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limitation</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>An action to enforce a right created by subsection 294(6) or (7) or section 294.1 may be commenced only within two years after discovery of the facts that gave rise to the cause of action.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 295;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 272.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_IX&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><Label>Division IX</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_IX&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Prospectus</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;296&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;296&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Distribution</MarginalNote><Label>296.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;296&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>No person including a company shall distribute securities of a company except in accordance with the regulations made under subsection (2).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;296&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;296&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations respecting the distribution of securities of a company, including</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;296&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the information that is to be disclosed by a company before the distribution of any of its securities, including the information that is to be included in a prospectus;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;296&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the manner of disclosure and the form of the information that is to be disclosed; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;296&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>exempting any class of distribution of securities from the application of subsection (1).</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 296;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 272.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;297&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;297&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Order of exemption</MarginalNote><Label>297.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;297&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>On application by a company or any person proposing to make a distribution, the Superintendent may, by order, exempt that distribution from the application of any regulations made under subsection 296(2) if the Superintendent is satisfied that the company has disclosed or is about to disclose, in compliance with the laws of the relevant jurisdiction, information relating to the distribution that in form and content substantially complies with the requirements of those regulations.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;297&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;297&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Conditions</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>An order under subsection (1) may contain any conditions or limitations that the Superintendent deems appropriate.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 297;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 272.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_IX.1&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><Label>Division IX.1</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_IX.1&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Going-private Transactions and Squeeze-out Transactions</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;298&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;298&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Going-private transactions</MarginalNote><Label>298.</Label><Text>A company may carry out a going-private transaction if it complies with any applicable provincial securities laws.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 298;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 272.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;299&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;299&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Squeeze-out transactions</MarginalNote><Label>299.</Label><Text>No company may carry out a squeeze-out transaction unless, in addition to any approval by holders of shares required by or under this Act or the company’s by-laws, the transaction is approved by ordinary resolution of the holders of each class of shares affected by the transaction, voting separately, whether or not the shares otherwise carry the right to vote. However, the following do not have the right to vote on the resolution:</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;299&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>affiliates of the company; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;299&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>holders of shares that following the squeeze-out transaction would be entitled to consideration of greater value or to superior rights or privileges than those available to other holders of shares of the same class.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 299;</li><li> 1994, c. 26, s. 39(F);</li><li> 1999, c. 31, s. 140;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 272.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;300&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Right to dissent</MarginalNote><Label>300.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A holder of shares of a company may dissent if the company resolves to carry out a going-private transaction or squeeze-out transaction that affects those shares.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Payment for shares</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>In addition to any other right that the shareholder may have, but subject to subsection (25), a shareholder who complies with this section is, when the action approved by the resolution from which the shareholder dissents becomes effective, entitled to be paid by the company the fair value of the shares in respect of which the shareholder dissents, determined as of the close of business on the day before the resolution was adopted by the policyholders entitled to vote and the shareholders.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">No partial dissent</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A dissenting shareholder may claim under this section only with respect to all of the shares of a class held on behalf of any one beneficial owner and registered in the name of the dissenting shareholder.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Objection</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>A dissenting shareholder shall send to the company, at or before any meeting of shareholders and policyholders at which a resolution referred to in subsection (2) is to be voted on by the policyholders entitled to vote and the shareholders, a written objection to the resolution unless the company did not give notice to the shareholder of the purpose of the meeting and their right to dissent.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice that resolution was adopted</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>The company shall within 10 days after the day on which the policyholders entitled to vote and the shareholders adopt the resolution send to each shareholder who sent an objection under subsection (4) notice that the resolution was adopted. If it is necessary for the Minister or Superintendent to approve the transaction within the meaning of subsection 1016(1) before it becomes effective, the company shall send notice within 10 days after the approval. Notice is not required to be sent to a shareholder who voted for the resolution or one who has withdrawn their objection.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Demand for payment</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>A dissenting shareholder shall within 20 days after receiving the notice referred to in subsection (5) — or, if they do not receive it, within 20 days after learning that the resolution was adopted by the policyholders entitled to vote and the shareholders — send to the company a written notice containing</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>their name and address;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the number and class of shares in respect of which they dissent; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a demand for payment of the fair value of those shares.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Share certificates</MarginalNote><Label>(7)</Label><Text>A dissenting shareholder shall within 30 days after sending a notice under subsection (6) send the certificates representing the shares in respect of which they dissent to the company or its transfer agent.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;8&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;8&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Forfeiture</MarginalNote><Label>(8)</Label><Text>A dissenting shareholder who fails to comply with subsection (7) has no right to make a claim under this section.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;9&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;9&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Endorsing certificate</MarginalNote><Label>(9)</Label><Text>A company or its transfer agent shall endorse on any share certificate received in accordance with subsection (7) a notice that the holder is a dissenting shareholder under this section and shall without delay return the share certificates to the dissenting shareholder.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;10&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;10&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Suspension of rights</MarginalNote><Label>(10)</Label><Text>On sending a notice under subsection (6), a dissenting shareholder ceases to have any rights as a shareholder other than to be paid the fair value of their shares as determined under this section. However, the shareholder’s rights are reinstated as of the date the notice was sent if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;10&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the shareholder withdraws the notice before the company makes an offer under subsection (11);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;10&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the company fails to make an offer in accordance with subsection (11) and the shareholder withdraws the notice; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;10&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the directors revoke under section 242 the special resolution that was made in respect of the going-private transaction or squeeze-out transaction.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;11&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;11&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Offer to pay</MarginalNote><Label>(11)</Label><Text>A company shall, no later than seven days after the later of the day on which the action approved by the resolution from which the shareholder dissents becomes effective and the day on which the company received the notice referred to in subsection (6), send to each dissenting shareholder who sent a notice</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;11&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a written offer to pay for their shares in an amount considered by the directors of the company to be the fair value, accompanied by a statement showing how the fair value was determined; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;11&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if subsection (25) applies, a notice that it is unable to lawfully pay dissenting shareholders for their shares.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;12&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;12&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Same terms</MarginalNote><Label>(12)</Label><Text>Every offer made under subsection (11) for shares of the same class or series is to be on the same terms.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;13&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;13&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Payment</MarginalNote><Label>(13)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection (25), a company shall pay for the shares of a dissenting shareholder within 10 days after the day on which an offer made under subsection (11) is accepted, but the offer lapses if the company does not receive an acceptance within 30 days after the day on which the offer is made.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;14&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;14&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Court may fix fair value</MarginalNote><Label>(14)</Label><Text>If a company fails to make an offer under subsection (11) or if a dissenting shareholder fails to accept an offer, the company may, within 50 days after the day on which the action approved by the resolution from which the shareholder dissents becomes effective or within any further period that a court may allow, apply to the court to fix a fair value for the shares of any dissenting shareholder.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;15&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;15&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shareholder application</MarginalNote><Label>(15)</Label><Text>If a company fails to apply to a court under subsection (14), a dissenting shareholder may apply to a court for the same purpose within a further period of 20 days or within any further period that the court may allow.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;16&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;16&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Venue</MarginalNote><Label>(16)</Label><Text>An application under subsection (14) or (15) is to be made to a court having jurisdiction where the company’s head office is situated or, if the company carries on business in the province in which the dissenting shareholder resides, in that province.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;17&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;17&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">No security for costs</MarginalNote><Label>(17)</Label><Text>A dissenting shareholder is not required to give security for costs in an application made under subsection (14) or (15).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;18&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;18&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Parties</MarginalNote><Label>(18)</Label><Text>On an application to a court under subsection (14) or (15),</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;18&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>all dissenting shareholders whose shares have not been purchased by the company are to be joined as parties and are bound by the decision of the court;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;18&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the company shall notify each of them of the date, place and consequences of the application and their right to appear and be heard in person or by counsel; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;18&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the company shall notify the Superintendent of the date and place of the application and the Superintend­ent may appear and be heard in person or by counsel.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;19&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;19&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Powers of court</MarginalNote><Label>(19)</Label><Text>On an application to a court under subsection (14) or (15), the court may determine whether any other person is a dissenting shareholder and is to be joined as a party and the court shall then fix a fair value for the shares of all dissenting shareholders.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;20&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;20&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Appraisers</MarginalNote><Label>(20)</Label><Text>The court may appoint one or more appraisers to assist the court to fix a fair value for the shares of the dissenting shareholders.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;21&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;21&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Final order</MarginalNote><Label>(21)</Label><Text>The final order of the court is to be rendered against the company in favour of each dissenting shareholder for the value of the shares as fixed by the court.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;22&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;22&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Interest</MarginalNote><Label>(22)</Label><Text>The court may allow a reasonable rate of interest on the amount payable to each dissenting shareholder from the date the action approved by the resolution from which the shareholder dissents becomes effective until the date of payment.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;23&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;23&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice that s. (25) applies</MarginalNote><Label>(23)</Label><Text>If subsection (25) applies, the company shall within 10 days after an order is made under subsection (21) notify each dissenting shareholder that it is unable to lawfully pay dissenting shareholders for their shares.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;24&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;24&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effect of s. (25)</MarginalNote><Label>(24)</Label><Text>If subsection (25) applies, a dissenting shareholder may by written notice delivered to the company within 30 days after receiving notice under subsection (23)</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;24&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>withdraw their notice of dissent, in which case the company is deemed to consent to the withdrawal and the shareholder is reinstated to their full rights as a shareholder; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;24&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>retain their status as a claimant against the company, to be paid as soon as the company is able to lawfully pay them or, in a liquidation, to be ranked subordinate to the rights of the company’s creditors but in priority to its shareholders.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;25&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;300&quot;,ss=&quot;25&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limitation</MarginalNote><Label>(25)</Label><Text>A company may not make a payment to a dissenting shareholder under this section if there are reasonable grounds for believing that the company is or the payment would cause the company to be in contravention of a regulation referred to in subsection 515(1) or (2) or 516(1) or (2) or of an order made under subsection 515(3) or 516(4).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 300;</li><li> 1999, c. 31, s. 141;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 272.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;301&quot;"><Label>301.</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 2005, c. 54, s. 272]</Repealed></Text><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;302&quot;"><Label>302.</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 2005, c. 54, s. 272]</Repealed></Text><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;303&quot;"><Label>303.</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 2005, c. 54, s. 272]</Repealed></Text><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;304&quot;"><Label>304.</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 2005, c. 54, s. 272]</Repealed></Text><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;305&quot;"><Label>305.</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 2005, c. 54, s. 272]</Repealed></Text><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;306&quot;"><Label>306.</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 2005, c. 54, s. 272]</Repealed></Text><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_X&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><Label>Division X</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_X&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Compulsory Acquisitions</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;307&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Definitions</MarginalNote><Label>307.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>In this Division,</Text><Definition Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{affiliate}{groupe}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{affiliate}{groupe}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>affiliate</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{affiliate}{groupe}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>groupe</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>affiliate</DefinedTermEn> means a body corporate that is affiliated with another body corporate within the meaning of subsection 6(2);</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{associate of the offeror}{associé du pollicitant}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{associate of the offeror}{associé du pollicitant}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>associate of the offeror</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{associate of the offeror}{associé du pollicitant}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>associé du pollicitant</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>associate of the offeror</DefinedTermEn> means</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{associate of the offeror}{associé du pollicitant}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a body corporate that an offeror, directly or indirectly, controls, determined without regard to paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), or of which an offeror beneficially owns shares or securities currently convertible into shares carrying more than 10 per cent of the voting rights under all circumstances or by reason of the occurrence of an event that has occurred and is continuing, or a currently exercisable option or right to purchase the shares or the convertible securities,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{associate of the offeror}{associé du pollicitant}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a partner of the offeror acting on behalf of the partnership of which they are partners,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{associate of the offeror}{associé du pollicitant}&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a trust or estate in which the offeror has a substantial beneficial interest or in respect of which they serve as a trustee or a liquidator of the succession or in a similar capacity,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{associate of the offeror}{associé du pollicitant}&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a spouse or common-law partner of the offeror,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{associate of the offeror}{associé du pollicitant}&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a child of the offeror or of the offeror’s spouse or common-law partner, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{associate of the offeror}{associé du pollicitant}&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a relative of the offeror or of the offeror’s spouse or common-law partner, if that relative has the same residence as the offeror;</Text></Paragraph></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{dissenting offeree}{pollicité opposant}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{dissenting offeree}{pollicité opposant}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>dissenting offeree</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{dissenting offeree}{pollicité opposant}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>pollicité opposant</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>dissenting offeree</DefinedTermEn>             means a holder of a share who does not accept a take-over bid or a subsequent holder of the share who acquires it from the first-mentioned holder; </Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{}{}&quot;"><Text><DefinedTermEn>exempt offer</DefinedTermEn><Repealed>[Repealed, 2005, c. 54, s. 273]</Repealed></Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{offeree}{pollicité}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{offeree}{pollicité}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>offeree</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{offeree}{pollicité}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>pollicité</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>offeree</DefinedTermEn> means a person to whom a take-over bid is made;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{offeree company}{société pollicitée}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{offeree company}{société pollicitée}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>offeree company</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{offeree company}{société pollicitée}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>société pollicitée</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>offeree company</DefinedTermEn> means a company the shares of which are the object of a take-over bid;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{offeror}{pollicitant}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{offeror}{pollicitant}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>offeror</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{offeror}{pollicitant}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>pollicitant</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>offeror</DefinedTermEn> means a person, other than an agent, who makes a take-over bid, and includes two or more persons who, directly or indirectly,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{offeror}{pollicitant}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>make take-over bids jointly or in concert, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{offeror}{pollicitant}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>intend to exercise jointly or in concert voting rights attached to shares for which a take-over bid is made;</Text></Paragraph></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{share}{action}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{share}{action}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>share</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{share}{action}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>action</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>share</DefinedTermEn> means a share with or without voting rights and includes </Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{share}{action}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a security that is currently convertible into a share, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{share}{action}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a currently exercisable option or right to acquire a share or a security referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>);</Text></Paragraph></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{take-over bid}{offre d’achat visant à la mainmise}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{take-over bid}{offre d’achat visant à la mainmise}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>take-over bid</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{take-over bid}{offre d’achat visant à la mainmise}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>offre d’achat visant à la mainmise</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>take-over bid</DefinedTermEn> means an offer made by an offeror at approximately the same time to all of the shareholders of a distributing company to acquire all of the shares of a class of issued shares, and includes an offer by a distributing company to repurchase all of the shares of a class.</Text></Definition></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Control</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>For the purposes of this Division, a person controls a body corporate when the person controls the body corporate within the meaning of section 3, determined without regard to paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;307&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Date of bid</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A take-over bid is deemed to be dated as of the date on which it is sent.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 307;</li><li> 2000, c. 12, s. 154;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 273.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;308&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;308&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Right to acquire shares</MarginalNote><Label>308.</Label><Text>If, within one hundred and twenty days after the date of a take-over bid, the bid is accepted by the holders of not less than 90 per cent of the shares of any class of shares to which the take-over bid relates, other than shares held at the date of the take-over bid by or on behalf of the offeror or an affiliate or associate of the offeror, the offeror is entitled, on complying with this Division, to acquire the shares held by the dissenting offerees.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 308;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 274(F).</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;309&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;309&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Offeror’s notice to dissenters</MarginalNote><Label>309.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;309&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>An offeror may acquire shares held by a dissenting offeree by sending by registered mail within sixty days after the date of termination of the take-over bid and in any event within one hundred and eighty days after the date of the take-over bid, an offeror’s notice to each dissenting offeree and to the Superintendent stating that</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;309&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>offerees holding not less than 90 per cent of the shares of any class of shares to which the take-over bid relates, other than shares held at the date of the take-over bid by or on behalf of the offeror or an affiliate or associate of the offeror, have accepted the take-over bid;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;309&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the offeror is bound to take up and pay for or has taken up and paid for the shares of the offerees who accepted the take-over bid;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;309&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a dissenting offeree is required to elect</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;309&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>to transfer the dissenting offeree’s shares to the offeror on the same terms on which the offeror acquired the shares from the offerees who accepted the take-over bid, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;309&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>to demand payment of the fair value of the dissenting offeree’s shares in accordance with sections 313 to 316 by notifying the offeror within twenty days after receipt of the offeror’s notice;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;309&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a dissenting offeree who does not notify the offeror in accordance with paragraph 310(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) is deemed to have elected to transfer the shares to the offeror on the same terms on which the offeror acquired the shares from the offerees who accepted the take-over bid; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;309&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a dissenting offeree must send the dissenting offeree’s shares to which the take-over bid relates to the offeree company within twenty days after the dissenting offeree receives the offeror’s notice.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;309&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;309&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of adverse claim</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Concurrently with sending the offeror’s notice under subsection (1), the offeror shall send to the offeree company a notice of adverse claim in accordance with subsection 133(1) with respect to each share held by a dissenting offeree.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 309;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 275.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;310&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;310&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Share certificates and election</MarginalNote><Label>310.</Label><Text>A dissenting offeree to whom a notice is sent under subsection 309(1) shall within 20 days after receiving the notice</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;310&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>send to the offeree company the share certificates representing the shares to which the take-over bid relates; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;310&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>elect to transfer the shares to the offeror on the same terms as those on which the offeror acquired shares from the offerees who accepted the take-over bid or to demand payment of the fair value of the shares in accordance with sections 313 to 316 by notifying the offeror.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 310;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 276.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;310.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;310.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Deemed election</MarginalNote><Label>310.1</Label><Text>A dissenting offeree who does not notify the offeror in accordance with paragraph 310(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) is deemed to have elected to transfer the shares to the offeror on the same terms as those on which the offeror acquired shares from the offerees who accepted the take-over bid.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2005, c. 54, s. 276.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;311&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;311&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Payment to offeree company</MarginalNote><Label>311.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;311&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Within 20 days after the offeror sends a notice under subsection 309(1), the offeror shall pay the money, or transfer the other consideration, to the offeree company that the offeror would have had to pay or transfer to a dissenting offeree if the dissenting offeree had elected to transfer their shares in accordance with paragraph 310(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;311&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;311&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Consideration in trust</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>An offeree company is deemed to hold in a fiduciary capacity for the dissenting offerees the money or other consideration it receives under subsection (1).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;311&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;311&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Deposit or custody</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>An offeree company shall deposit the money received under subsection (1) in a separate account in a deposit-taking financial institution in Canada and the offeree company shall place any other consideration in the custody of a deposit-taking financial institution in Canada.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 311;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 277.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;311.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;311.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Fiduciary capacity of company</MarginalNote><Label>311.1</Label><Text>A company that is making a take-over bid to repurchase all of the shares of a class is deemed to hold in a fiduciary capacity for the dissenting shareholders the money that it would have had to pay, and the other consideration that it would have had to transfer, to a dissenting offeree if the dissenting offeree had elected to transfer their shares in accordance with paragraph 310(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>). The company shall within 20 days after a notice is sent under subsection 309(1) deposit the money in a separate account in a deposit-taking financial institution in Canada and place any other consideration in the custody of a deposit-taking financial institution in Canada.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2005, c. 54, s. 278.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;312&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;312&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Duty of offeree company</MarginalNote><Label>312.</Label><Text>Within thirty days after an offeror sends an offeror’s notice under subsection 309(1), the offeree company shall</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;312&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if the payment or transfer required by subsection 311(1) is made, issue to the offeror a share certificate in respect of the shares that were held by the dissenting offerees;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;312&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>give to each dissenting offeree who elects to transfer shares under paragraph 310(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) and who sends the share certificates as required under paragraph 310(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) the money or other consideration to which they are entitled, disregarding fractional shares, which may be paid for in money; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;312&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if the payment or transfer required by subsection 311(1) is made and the money or other consideration is deposited as required by subsections 311(2) and (3) or by section 311.1, send to each dissenting offeree who has not sent share certificates as required under paragraph 310(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) a notice stating that</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;312&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>their shares have been cancelled,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;312&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>the offeree company or its designated person holds in a fiduciary capacity for that offeree the money or other consideration to which they are entitled as payment for or in exchange for the shares, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;312&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>the offeree company will, subject to sections 313 to 316, send that money or other consideration to that offeree without delay after receiving the share certificates.</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 312;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 279.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;313&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;313&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Court may fix fair value</MarginalNote><Label>313.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;313&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If a dissenting offeree has elected to demand payment of the fair value of their shares under paragraph 310(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>), the offeror may, within 20 days after it has paid the money or transferred the other consideration under subsection 311(1), apply to a court to fix the fair value of the shares of that dissenting offeree.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;313&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;313&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Idem</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If an offeror fails to apply to a court under subsection (1), a dissenting offeree may apply to a court for the same purpose within a further period of twenty days.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;313&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;313&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Venue</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>An application under subsection (1) or (2) shall be made to a court having jurisdiction in the place at which the head office of the company is situated or in the province in which the dissenting offeree resides if the company carries on business in that province.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;313&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;313&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">No security for costs</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>A dissenting offeree is not required to give security for costs in an application made under subsection (1) or (2).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 313;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 280.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;314&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;314&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Parties and notice</MarginalNote><Label>314.</Label><Text>On an application under subsection 313(1) or (2),</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;314&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>all dissenting offerees who have made elections to demand payment under paragraph 310(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) and whose shares have not been acquired by the offeror shall be joined as parties and are bound by the decision of the court; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;314&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the offeror shall notify each affected dissenting offeree of the date, place and consequences of the application and of the dissenting offeree’s right to appear and be heard in person or by counsel at the hearing of the application.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 314;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 281.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;315&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;315&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Powers of court</MarginalNote><Label>315.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;315&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>On an application to a court under subsection 313(1) or (2), the court may determine whether any other person is a dissenting offeree who should be joined as a party, and the court shall then fix a fair value for the shares of all dissenting offerees.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;315&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;315&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Appraisers</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A court may in its discretion appoint one or more appraisers to assist the court in fixing a fair value for the shares of a dissenting offeree.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;315&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;315&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Final order</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The final order of a court shall be made against the offeror in favour of each dissenting offeree and for the amount for each dissenting offeree’s shares as fixed by the court.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;315&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;315&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Additional powers of court</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>In connection with proceedings under subsection 313(1) or (2), a court may make any order it thinks fit and, without limiting the generality of the foregoing, may</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;315&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>fix the amount of money or other consideration that is deemed to be held in a fiduciary capacity under subsection 311(2) or section 311.1;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;315&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>order that the money or other consideration is to be held in trust by a person other than the offeree company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;315&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>allow a reasonable rate of interest on the amount payable to each dissenting offeree from the date the dissenting offeree sends the share certificates required under section 310 until the date of payment; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;315&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>order that any money payable to a shareholder who cannot be found be paid to the Receiver General.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;315&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;315&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Recovery</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>If at any time a person establishes an entitlement to any moneys paid to the Receiver General under this section, the Receiver General shall pay an equivalent amount to that person out of the Consolidated Revenue Fund.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 315;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 282.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;316&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;316&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Status of dissenter</MarginalNote><Label>316.</Label><Text>Where no application is made to a court under subsection 313(2) within the period set out in that subsection, a dissenting offeree is deemed to have elected to transfer the dissenting offeree’s shares to the offeror on the same terms on which the offeror acquired the shares from the offerees who accepted the take-over bid.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;316.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;316.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Obligation to acquire shares</MarginalNote><Label>316.1</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;316.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If a shareholder who holds shares of an offeree company does not receive the notice referred to in subsection 309(1), the shareholder may require the offeror to acquire the shares</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;316.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>within 90 days after the date of termination of the take-over bid; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;316.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if the shareholder did not receive an offer under the take-over bid, within 90 days after the later of</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;316.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>the date of termination of the take-over bid, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;316.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>the day on which the shareholder learned of the take-over bid.</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;316.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;316.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Acquisition on same terms</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If the shareholder requires the offeror to acquire shares, the offeror shall acquire them on the same terms as those on which the offeror acquires shares from offerees who accept the take-over bid.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2005, c. 54, s. 283.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XI&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><Label>Division XI</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XI&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Trust Indentures</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;317&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;317&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Definitions</MarginalNote><Label>317.</Label><Text>In this Division,</Text><Definition Code="se=&quot;317&quot;,df=&quot;{event of default}{cas de défaut}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;317&quot;,df=&quot;{event of default}{cas de défaut}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>event of default</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;317&quot;,df=&quot;{event of default}{cas de défaut}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>cas de défaut</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>event of default</DefinedTermEn> means, in relation to a trust indenture, an event specified in the trust indenture on the occurrence of which the principal, interest and other moneys payable thereunder become or may be declared to be payable before maturity, but the event is not an event of default until all the conditions set out in the trust indenture in connection with the giving of notice of the event have been satisfied or the period of time for giving the notice has elapsed;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;317&quot;,df=&quot;{issuer}{émetteur}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;317&quot;,df=&quot;{issuer}{émetteur}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>issuer</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;317&quot;,df=&quot;{issuer}{émetteur}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>émetteur</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>issuer</DefinedTermEn> means a company that has issued, is about to issue or is in the process of issuing subordinated indebtedness;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;317&quot;,df=&quot;{trustee}{fiduciaire}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;317&quot;,df=&quot;{trustee}{fiduciaire}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>trustee</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;317&quot;,df=&quot;{trustee}{fiduciaire}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>fiduciaire</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>trustee</DefinedTermEn> means any person appointed as trustee under the terms of a trust indenture to which a company is a party, and includes any successor trustee;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;317&quot;,df=&quot;{trust indenture}{acte de fiducie}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;317&quot;,df=&quot;{trust indenture}{acte de fiducie}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>trust indenture</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;317&quot;,df=&quot;{trust indenture}{acte de fiducie}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>acte de fiducie</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>trust indenture</DefinedTermEn> means any deed, indenture or other instrument, including any supplement or amendment thereto, made by a company under which the company issues subordinated indebtedness and in which a person is appointed as trustee for the holders of the subordinated indebtedness issued thereunder.</Text></Definition></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;318&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;318&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application</MarginalNote><Label>318.</Label><Text>This Division applies in respect of a trust indenture if the subordinated indebtedness issued or to be issued under the trust indenture is part of a distribution to the public.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;319&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;319&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exemption</MarginalNote><Label>319.</Label><Text>The Superintendent may, in writing, exempt a trust indenture from the application of this Division if, in the Superintendent’s opinion, the trust indenture and the subordinated indebtedness are subject to a law of a province or other jurisdiction, other than Canada, that is substantially equivalent to the provisions of this Act relating to trust indentures.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;320&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;320&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Conflict of interest</MarginalNote><Label>320.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;320&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>No person shall be appointed as trustee if at the time of the appointment there is a material conflict of interest between the person’s role as trustee and any other role of the person.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;320&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;320&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Eliminating conflict of interest</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A trustee shall, within ninety days after the trustee becomes aware that a material conflict of interest exists,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;320&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>eliminate the conflict of interest; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;320&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>resign from office.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;321&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;321&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Validity despite conflict</MarginalNote><Label>321.</Label><Text>A trust indenture and any subordinated indebtedness issued thereunder are valid notwithstanding a material conflict of interest of the trustee.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;322&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;322&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Removal of trustee</MarginalNote><Label>322.</Label><Text>If a trustee is appointed in contravention of subsection 320(1) or if a trustee contravenes subsection 320(2), any interested person may apply to a court for an order that the trustee be replaced, and the court may make an order on such terms as it thinks fit.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;323&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;323&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Trustee qualifications</MarginalNote><Label>323.</Label><Text>A trustee, or at least one of the trustees if more than one is appointed, must be</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;323&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a trust company pursuant to subsection 57(2) of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="T-19.8">Trust and Loan Companies Act</XRefExternal>; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;323&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a body corporate that is incorporated by or under an Act of the legislature of a province and authorized to carry on business as a trustee.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, ss. 323, 758;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 213.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;324&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;324&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">List of security holders</MarginalNote><Label>324.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;324&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A holder of subordinated indebtedness issued under a trust indenture may, on payment to the trustee of a reasonable fee and on delivery of a statutory declaration to the trustee, require the trustee to provide, within fifteen days after the delivery to the trustee of the statutory declaration, a list setting out</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;324&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the names and addresses of the registered holders of the outstanding subordinated indebtedness,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;324&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the principal amount of outstanding subordinated indebtedness owned by each such holder, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;324&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the aggregate principal amount of subordinated indebtedness outstanding</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>as shown on the records maintained by the trustee on the day the statutory declaration is delivered to that trustee.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;324&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;324&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Duty of issuer</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>On the demand of a trustee, the issuer of subordinated indebtedness shall provide the trustee with the information required to enable the trustee to comply with subsection (1).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;324&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;324&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Where applicant is entity</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Where the person requiring the trustee to provide a list under subsection (1) is an entity, the statutory declaration required under that subsection shall be made by a director or an officer of the entity or a person acting in a similar capacity.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;324&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;324&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Contents of statutory declaration</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>The statutory declaration required under subsection (1) must state</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;324&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the name and address of the person requiring the trustee to provide the list and, if the person is an entity, the address for service thereof; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;324&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>that the list will not be used except as permitted by subsection (5).</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;324&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;324&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Use of list</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>No person shall use a list obtained under this section except in connection with</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;324&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an effort to influence the voting of the holders of subordinated indebtedness;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;324&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an offer to acquire subordinated indebtedness; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;324&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any other matter relating to the subordinated indebtedness or the affairs of the issuer or guarantor thereof.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;325&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;325&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Compliance with trust indentures</MarginalNote><Label>325.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;325&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>An issuer or a guarantor of subordinated indebtedness issued or to be issued under a trust indenture shall, before undertaking</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;325&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the issue, certification and delivery of subordinated indebtedness under the trust indenture, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;325&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the satisfaction and discharge of the trust indenture,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>provide the trustee with evidence of compliance with the conditions in the trust indenture in respect thereof.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;325&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;325&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Compliance by issuer or guarantor</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>On the demand of a trustee, the issuer or guarantor of subordinated indebtedness issued or to be issued under a trust indenture shall provide the trustee with evidence of compliance with the conditions in the trust indenture by the issuer or guarantor in respect of any act to be done by the trustee at the request of the issuer or guarantor.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;325&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;325&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Evidence of compliance</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The following documents constitute evidence of compliance for the purposes of subsections (1) and (2):</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;325&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a statutory declaration or certificate made by a director or an officer of the issuer or guarantor stating that the conditions referred to in subsections (1) and (2) have been complied with;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;325&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an opinion of legal counsel that the conditions of the trust indenture requiring review by legal counsel have been complied with, if the trust indenture requires compliance with conditions that are subject to review by legal counsel; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;325&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an opinion or report of the auditors of the issuer or guarantor, or such other accountant as the trustee selects, that the conditions of the trust indenture have been complied with, if the trust indenture requires compliance with conditions that are subject to review by auditors.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;325&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;325&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Further evidence of compliance</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>The evidence of compliance referred to in subsection (3) shall include a statement by the person giving the evidence</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;325&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>declaring that the person has read and understands the conditions of the trust indenture referred to in subsections (1) and (2);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;325&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>describing the nature and scope of the examination or investigation on which the person based the certificate, statement or opinion; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;325&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>declaring that the person has made such examination or investigation as the person believes necessary to enable the statements to be made or the opinions contained or expressed therein to be given.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;326&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;326&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Trustee may require evidence</MarginalNote><Label>326.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;326&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>On the request of a trustee, the issuer or guarantor of subordinated indebtedness issued under a trust indenture shall provide the trustee with evidence in such form as the trustee requires of compliance with any condition thereof relating to any action required or permitted to be taken by the issuer or guarantor under the trust indenture.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;326&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;326&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Certificate of compliance</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>At least once in each twelve month period beginning on the date of the trust indenture and at any other time on the demand of a trustee, the issuer or guarantor of subordinated indebtedness issued under a trust indenture shall provide the trustee with a certificate stating that the issuer or guarantor has complied with all requirements contained in the trust indenture that, if not complied with, would, with the giving of notice, lapse of time or otherwise, constitute an event of default, or, if there has been failure to so comply, giving particulars thereof.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;327&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;327&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of default</MarginalNote><Label>327.</Label><Text>A trustee shall, within thirty days after the trustee becomes aware of the occurrence thereof, give to the holders of subordinated indebtedness issued under a trust indenture notice of every event of default arising under the trust indenture and continuing at the time the notice is given, unless the trustee believes on reasonable grounds that it is in the best interests of the holders of the subordinated indebtedness to withhold the notice and so informs the issuer and guarantor in writing.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;328&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;328&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Duty of care</MarginalNote><Label>328.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;328&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>In exercising a trustee’s powers and discharging a trustee’s duties, the trustee shall</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;328&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>act honestly and in good faith with a view to the best interests of the holders of the subordinated indebtedness issued under the trust indenture; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;328&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>exercise the care, diligence and skill of a reasonably prudent trustee.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;328&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;328&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Reliance on statements</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Notwithstanding subsection (1), a trustee is not liable if the trustee relies in good faith on statements contained in a statutory declaration, certificate, opinion or report that complies with this Act or the trust indenture.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;329&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;329&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">No exculpation</MarginalNote><Label>329.</Label><Text>No term of a trust indenture or of any agreement between a trustee and the holders of subordinated indebtedness issued thereunder or between the trustee and the issuer or guarantor operates to relieve a trustee from the duties imposed on the trustee by sections 320, 324 and 327 and subsection 328(1).</Text></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XII&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><Label>Division XII</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XII&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Financial Statements</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;330&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;330&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Financial year</MarginalNote><Label>330.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;330&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The financial year of a company ends, at the election of the company in its by-laws, on the expiration of the thirty-first day of October or the thirty-first day of December in each year.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;330&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;330&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">First financial year</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where a company has, after the first day of July in any year, obtained an order approving the commencement and carrying on of business, the first financial year of the company ends, at the election of the company in its by-laws, on the expiration of the thirty-first day of October or the thirty-first day of December in the next calendar year.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;331&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;331&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Annual financial statement</MarginalNote><Label>331.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;331&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The directors of a company shall place before the shareholders and policyholders at every annual meeting</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;331&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a comparative annual financial statement relating separately to</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;331&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>the financial year immediately preceding the meeting, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;331&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>the financial year, if any, immediately preceding the financial year referred to in subparagraph (i);</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;331&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a.1&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a.1</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of a company that has participating policyholders, the information prescribed in respect of the policies established under paragraphs 165(2)(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>) and (<Emphasis style="italic">e.1</Emphasis>) and the other prescribed information;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;331&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the report of the auditor of the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;331&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the report of the actuary of the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;331&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a description of the roles of the actuary of the company and the auditor of the company in the preparation and audit of the annual statement; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;331&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any further information respecting the financial position of the company and the results of its operations required by the by-laws of the company to be placed before the shareholders and policyholders at the annual meeting.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;331&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;331&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Annual statement — contents</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>With respect to each of the financial years to which it relates, the annual statement of a company must contain the prescribed statements and any information that is in the opinion of the directors necessary to present fairly, in accordance with the accounting principles referred to in subsection (4), the financial position of the company as at the end of the financial year to which it relates and the results of the operations and changes in the financial position of the company for that financial year.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;331&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;331&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Additional information</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A company shall include with its annual statement</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;331&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of a company that has participating policyholders, a summary of the policies established under paragraphs 165(2)(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>) and (<Emphasis style="italic">e.1</Emphasis>);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;331&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a list of the subsidiaries of the company, other than subsidiaries that are not required to be listed by the regulations and subsidiaries acquired pursuant to section 499 or pursuant to a realization of security in accordance with section 500 and which the company would not otherwise be permitted to hold, showing, with respect to each subsidiary,</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;331&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>its name and the address of its head or principal office,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;331&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>the book value of the aggregate of any shares of the subsidiary beneficially owned by the company and by other subsidiaries of the company, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;331&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>the percentage of the voting rights attached to all the outstanding voting shares of the subsidiary that is carried by the aggregate of any voting shares of the subsidiary beneficially owned by the company and by other subsidiaries of the company; and</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;331&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>such other information as may be prescribed in such form as may be prescribed.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;331&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;331&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Accounting principles</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>The financial statements referred to in subsection (1), paragraph (3)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) and subsection 333(1) shall, except as otherwise specified by the Superintendent, be prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, the primary source of which is the Handbook of the Canadian Institute of Chartered Accountants. A reference in any provision of this Act to the accounting principles referred to in this subsection shall be construed as a reference to those generally accepted accounting principles with any specifications so made.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;331&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><Label>(5)</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 2005, c. 54, s. 284]</Repealed></Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;331&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;331&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations respecting subsidiaries that are not required to be listed for the purposes of paragraph (3)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 331;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 233;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 398;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 284.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;332&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;332&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Annual statement — approval</MarginalNote><Label>332.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;332&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The directors of a company shall approve the annual statement and their approval shall be evidenced by the signature or a printed or otherwise mechanically reproduced facsimile of the signature of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;332&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the chief executive officer or, in the event of that officer’s absence or inability to act, any other officer of the company authorized by the directors to sign in the stead of the chief executive officer; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;332&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>one director, if the signature required by paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) is that of a director, or two directors if the signature required by that paragraph is that of an officer who is not a director.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;332&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;332&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Condition precedent to publication</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A company shall not publish copies of an annual statement unless it is approved and signed in accordance with subsection (1).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 332;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 285.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;333&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;333&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Statements — subsidiaries</MarginalNote><Label>333.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;333&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company shall keep at its head office a copy of the current financial statements of each subsidiary of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;333&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;333&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Examination</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Subject to this section, the shareholders of a company, the policyholders of a company who are entitled to vote and their personal representatives may, on request therefor, examine the statements referred to in subsection (1) during the usual business hours of the company and may take extracts therefrom free of charge.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;333&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;333&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Barring examination</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A company may refuse to permit an examination under subsection (2) by any person.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;333&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;333&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application for order</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Within fifteen days after a refusal under subsection (3), the company shall apply to a court for an order barring the right of the person concerned to make an examination under subsection (2) and the court shall either order the company to permit the examination or, if it is satisfied that the examination would be detrimental to the company or to any other body corporate the financial statements of which would be subject to examination, bar the right and make any further order it thinks fit.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;333&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;333&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice to Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>A company shall give the Superintendent and the person seeking to examine the statements referred to in subsection (1) notice of an application to a court under subsection (4), and the Superintendent and the person may appear and be heard in person or by counsel at the hearing of the application.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;334&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;334&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Annual statement — distribution</MarginalNote><Label>334.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;334&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company shall, no later than 21 days before the date of each annual meeting or before the signing of a resolution under paragraph 158(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) in lieu of the annual meeting and unless that time period is waived by the shareholder or policyholder, send</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;334&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>to each shareholder a copy of the documents referred to in paragraphs 331(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) and (<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>) and subsection 331(3) and, on request, the document referred to in paragraph 331(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a.1</Emphasis>); and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;334&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>to each policyholder who is entitled under paragraph 143(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) to receive notice of the meeting a copy of the documents referred to in subsections 331(1) and (3).</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;334&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;334&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A company is not required to comply with subsection (1) with respect to shareholders or policyholders who have informed the company, in writing, that they do not wish to receive the annual statement.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;334&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;334&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effect of default</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Where a company is required to comply with subsection (1) and the company does not comply with that subsection, the annual meeting at which the annual statement is to be considered shall be adjourned until that subsection has been complied with.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 334;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 234;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 286.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;335&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;335&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Copy to Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>335.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;335&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection (2), a company shall send to the Superintendent a copy of the documents referred to in subsections 331(1) and (3) not later than twenty-one days before the date of each annual meeting of shareholders and policyholders of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;335&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;335&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Later filing</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If a company’s shareholders and policyholders sign a resolution under paragraph 158(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) in lieu of an annual meeting, the company shall send a copy of the documents referred to in subsections 331(1) and (3) to the Superintendent not later than thirty days after the signing of the resolution.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 335;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 235;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 399.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><Label>Division XIII</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Auditors</TitleText></Heading><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gc=&quot;s_336&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gc=&quot;s_336&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Interpretation</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;336&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;336&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Definitions</MarginalNote><Label>336.</Label><Text>In this Division,</Text><Definition Code="se=&quot;336&quot;,df=&quot;{firm of accountants}{cabinet de comptables}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;336&quot;,df=&quot;{firm of accountants}{cabinet de comptables}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>firm of accountants</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;336&quot;,df=&quot;{firm of accountants}{cabinet de comptables}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>cabinet de comptables</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>firm of accountants</DefinedTermEn> means a partnership, the members of which are accountants engaged in the practice of accounting, or a body corporate that is incorporated by or under an Act of the legislature of a province and engaged in the practice of accounting;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;336&quot;,df=&quot;{member}{membre}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;336&quot;,df=&quot;{member}{membre}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>member</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;336&quot;,df=&quot;{member}{membre}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>membre</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>member</DefinedTermEn>, in relation to a firm of accountants, means</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;336&quot;,df=&quot;{member}{membre}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an accountant who is a partner in a partnership, the members of which are accountants engaged in the practice of accounting, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;336&quot;,df=&quot;{member}{membre}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an accountant who is an employee of a firm of accountants.</Text></Paragraph></Definition></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gc=&quot;s_337&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gc=&quot;s_337&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Appointment</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;337&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;337&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Appointment of auditor</MarginalNote><Label>337.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;337&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The shareholders and policyholders of a company shall, by ordinary resolution at the first meeting of shareholders and policyholders and at each succeeding annual meeting, appoint an auditor to hold office until the close of the next annual meeting.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;337&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;337&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Remuneration of auditor</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The remuneration of an auditor may be fixed by ordinary resolution of the shareholders and policyholders but, if not so fixed, shall be fixed by the directors.</Text></Subsection></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gc=&quot;s_338&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gc=&quot;s_338&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Qualifications</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;338&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;338&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Qualification of auditor</MarginalNote><Label>338.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;338&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A natural person or firm of accountants is qualified to be an auditor of a company if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;338&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of a natural person, the person is an accountant who</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;338&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>is a member in good standing of an institute or association of accountants incorporated by or under an Act of the legislature of a province,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;338&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>has at least five years experience at a senior level in performing audits of a financial institution,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;338&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>is ordinarily resident in Canada, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;338&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;iv&quot;"><Label>(iv)</Label><Text>is independent of the company; and</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;338&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of a firm of accountants, the member of the firm jointly designated by the firm and the company to conduct the audit of the company on behalf of the firm is qualified in accordance with paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>).</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;338&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;338&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Independence</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>For the purposes of subsection (1),</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;338&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>independence is a question of fact; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;338&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a person is deemed not to be independent of a company if that person, a business partner of that person or a firm of accountants of which that person is a member</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;338&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>is a business partner, director, officer or employee of the company or of any affiliate of the company or is a business partner of any director, officer or employee of the company or of any affiliate of the company,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;338&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>beneficially owns or controls, directly or indirectly, a material interest in the shares of the company or of any affiliate of the company, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;338&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>has been a liquidator, trustee in bankruptcy, receiver or receiver and manager of any affiliate of the company within the two years immediately preceding the person’s proposed appointment as auditor of the company, other than an affiliate that is a subsidiary of the company acquired pursuant to section 499 or through a realization of security pursuant to section 500.</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;338&quot;,ss=&quot;2.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;338&quot;,ss=&quot;2.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Business partners</MarginalNote><Label>(2.1)</Label><Text>For the purposes of subsection (2),</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;338&quot;,ss=&quot;2.1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of the appointment of a natural person as the auditor of a company, a business partner of the person includes a shareholder of the business partner; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;338&quot;,ss=&quot;2.1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of the appointment of a firm of accountants as the auditor of a company, a business partner of a member of the firm includes another member of the firm and a shareholder of the firm or of a business partner of the member.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;338&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;338&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of designation</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Within fifteen days after the appointment of a firm of accountants as auditor of a company, the company and the firm of accountants shall jointly designate a member of the firm who meets the qualifications described in subsection (1) to conduct the audit of the company on behalf of the firm and the company shall forthwith notify the Superintendent in writing of the designation.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;338&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;338&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">New designation</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Where for any reason a member of a firm of accountants designated pursuant to subsection (3) ceases to conduct the audit of the company, the company and the firm of accountants may jointly designate another member of the same firm of accountants who meets the qualifications described in subsection (1) to conduct the audit of the company and the company shall forthwith notify the Superintendent in writing of the designation.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;338&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;338&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Deemed vacancy</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>In any case where subsection (4) applies and a designation is not made pursuant to that subsection within thirty days after the designated member ceases to conduct the audit of the company, there shall be deemed to be a vacancy in the office of auditor of the company.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 338;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 400;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 287.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;339&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;339&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Duty to resign</MarginalNote><Label>339.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;339&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>An auditor who ceases to be qualified under section 338 shall resign forthwith after the auditor, where the auditor is a natural person, or any member of the firm of accountants, where the auditor is a firm of accountants, becomes aware that the auditor or the firm has ceased to be so qualified.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;339&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;339&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Disqualification order</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Any interested person may apply to a court for an order declaring that an auditor of a company has ceased to be qualified under section 338 and declaring the office of auditor to be vacant.</Text></Subsection></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gc=&quot;s_340&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gc=&quot;s_340&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Vacancies</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;340&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;340&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Revocation of appointment</MarginalNote><Label>340.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;340&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The shareholders and policyholders of a company may, by ordinary resolution at a special meeting, revoke the appointment of an auditor.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;340&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;340&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Idem</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The Superintendent may at any time revoke the appointment of an auditor made under subsection (3) or 337(1) or section 342 by notice in writing signed by the Superintendent and sent by registered mail to the auditor and to the company addressed to the usual place of business of the auditor and the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;340&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;340&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Filling vacancy</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A vacancy created by the revocation of the appointment of an auditor under subsection (1) may be filled at the meeting at which the appointment was revoked and, if not so filled, shall be filled by the directors under section 342.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;341&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;341&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Ceasing to hold office</MarginalNote><Label>341.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;341&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>An auditor of a company ceases to hold office when</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;341&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the auditor resigns;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;341&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the auditor, where the auditor is a natural person, dies; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;341&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the appointment of the auditor is revoked by the shareholders and policyholders or the Superintendent.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;341&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;341&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effective date of resignation</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The resignation of an auditor becomes effective at the time a written resignation is sent to the company or at the time specified in the resignation, whichever is later.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;342&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;342&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Filling vacancy</MarginalNote><Label>342.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;342&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection 340(3), where a vacancy occurs in the office of auditor of a company, the directors shall forthwith fill the vacancy, and the auditor so appointed holds office for the unexpired term of office of the predecessor of that auditor.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;342&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;342&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Where Superintendent may fill vacancy</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where the directors fail to fill a vacancy in accordance with subsection (1), the Superintendent may fill the vacancy and the auditor so appointed holds office for the unexpired term of office of the predecessor of that auditor.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;342&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;342&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Designation of member of firm</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Where the Superintendent has, pursuant to subsection (2), appointed a firm of accountants to fill a vacancy, the Superintendent shall designate the member of the firm who is to conduct the audit of the company on behalf of the firm.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;343&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;343&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Right to attend meetings</MarginalNote><Label>343.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;343&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The auditor of a company is entitled to receive notice of every meeting of shareholders or policyholders and, at the expense of the company, to attend and be heard at those meetings on matters relating to the duties of the auditor.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;343&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;343&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Duty to attend meeting</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If a director, a shareholder of a company, whether or not the shareholder is entitled to vote at the meeting, or a policyholder who is entitled to vote at the meeting gives written notice, not less than ten days before a meeting of shareholders or policyholders, to an auditor or former auditor of the company that the director, shareholder or policyholder wishes the auditor’s attendance at the meeting, the auditor or former auditor shall attend the meeting at the expense of the company and answer questions relating to the auditor’s or former auditor’s duties as auditor.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;343&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;343&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice to company</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A director, shareholder or policyholder who gives notice under subsection (2) shall send concurrently a copy of the notice to the company and the company shall forthwith send a copy thereof to the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;343&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;343&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Superintendent may attend</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>The Superintendent may attend and be heard at any meeting referred to in subsection (2).</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;344&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;344&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Statement of auditor</MarginalNote><Label>344.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;344&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>An auditor of a company who</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;344&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>resigns,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;344&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>receives a notice or otherwise learns of a meeting of shareholders and policyholders called for the purpose of revoking the appointment of the auditor, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;344&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>receives a notice or otherwise learns of a meeting of directors or shareholders and policyholders at which another person is to be appointed in the auditor’s stead, whether because of the auditor’s resignation or revocation of appointment or because the auditor’s term of office has expired or is about to expire,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>shall submit to the company and the Superintendent a written statement giving the reasons for the resignation or the reasons why the auditor opposes any proposed action.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;344&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;344&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Other statements</MarginalNote><Label>(1.1)</Label><Text>In the case of a proposed replacement of an auditor whether because of removal or the expiry of their term, the company shall make a statement of the reasons for the proposed replacement and the proposed replacement auditor may make a statement in which they comment on those reasons.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;344&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;344&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Statements to be sent</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The company shall send a copy of the statements referred to in subsections (1) and (1.1) without delay to every shareholder entitled to vote at the annual meeting of shareholders and policyholders, to every policyholder entitled under paragraph 143(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) to receive notice of an annual meeting of shareholders and policyholders and to the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 344;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 288.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;345&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;345&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Duty of replacement auditor</MarginalNote><Label>345.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;345&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where an auditor of a company has resigned or the appointment of an auditor has been revoked, no person or firm shall accept an appointment or consent to be appointed as auditor of the company until the person or firm has requested and received from the other auditor a written statement of the circumstances and reasons why the other auditor resigned or why, in the other auditor’s opinion, the other auditor’s appointment was revoked.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;345&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;345&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Notwithstanding subsection (1), a person or firm may accept an appointment or consent to be appointed as auditor of a company if, within fifteen days after a request under that subsection is made, no reply from the other auditor is received.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;345&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;345&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effect of non-compliance</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Unless subsection (2) applies, an appointment as auditor of a company is void if subsection (1) has not been complied with.</Text></Subsection></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gc=&quot;s_346&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gc=&quot;s_346&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Examinations and Reports</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;346&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;346&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Auditor’s examination</MarginalNote><Label>346.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;346&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The auditor of a company shall make such examination as the auditor considers necessary to enable the auditor to report on the annual statement and on other financial statements required by this Act to be placed before the shareholders and policyholders, except such annual statements or parts thereof as relate to the period referred to in subparagraph 331(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)(ii).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;346&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;346&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Auditing standards</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The auditor’s examination referred to in subsection (1) shall, except as otherwise specified by the Superintendent, be conducted in accordance with generally accepted auditing standards, the primary source of which is the Handbook of the Canadian Institute of Chartered Accountants.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;346&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;346&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Reliance on actuary</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>An auditor of a company may, in conducting the examination referred to in subsection (1), use the valuation by the actuary of the company, or by any other actuary, of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;346&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the actuarial and other policy liabilities of the company as at the end of a financial year; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;346&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the increase in the actuarial liabilities of the company for a financial year.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;346&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;346&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Actuarial practices</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>A valuation by an actuary other than the actuary of the company may be used only if it was done in accordance with generally accepted actuarial practice and with any changes that may have been determined by the Superintendent and by following any additional directions that may have been made by the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 346;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 214.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;347&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;347&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Right to information</MarginalNote><Label>347.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;347&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>On the request of the auditor of a company, the present or former directors, officers, employees or representatives of the company shall, to the extent that they are reasonably able to do so,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;347&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>permit access to such records, assets and security held by the company or any entity in which the company has a substantial investment, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;347&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>provide such information and explanations</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>as are, in the opinion of the auditor, necessary to enable the auditor to perform the duties of auditor of the company.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;347&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;347&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Directors to provide information</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>On the request of the auditor of a company, the directors of the company shall, to the extent that they are reasonably able to do so,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;347&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>obtain from the present or former directors, officers, employees and representatives of any entity in which the company has a substantial investment the information and explanations that such persons are reasonably able to provide and that are, in the opinion of the auditor, necessary to enable the auditor to perform the duties of auditor of the company; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;347&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>provide the auditor with the information and explanations so obtained.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;347&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;347&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">No civil liability</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A person who in good faith makes an oral or written communication under subsection (1) or (2) shall not be liable in any civil action arising from having made the communication.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;348&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;348&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Auditor’s report and extended examination</MarginalNote><Label>348.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;348&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The Superintendent may, in writing, require that the auditor of a company report to the Superintendent on the extent of the auditor’s procedures in the examination of the annual statement and may, in writing, require that the auditor enlarge or extend the scope of that examination or direct that any other particular procedure be performed in any particular case, and the auditor shall comply with any such requirement of the Superintendent and report to the Superintendent thereon.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;348&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;348&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Special examination</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The Superintendent may, in writing, require that the auditor of a company make a particular examination relating to the adequacy of the procedures adopted by the company for the safety of its creditors, shareholders and policyholders, or any other examination as, in the Superintendent’s opinion, the public interest may require, and report to the Superintendent thereon.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;348&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;348&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Idem</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The Superintendent may direct that a special audit of a company be made if, in the opinion of the Superintendent, it is so required and may appoint for that purpose an accountant or a firm of accountants qualified pursuant to subsection 338(1) to be an auditor of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;348&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;348&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Expenses payable by company</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>The expenses entailed by any examination or audit referred to in any of subsections (1) to (3) are payable by the company on being approved in writing by the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 348;</li><li> 1999, c. 31, s. 142(F).</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;349&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;349&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Auditor’s report</MarginalNote><Label>349.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;349&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The auditor shall, not less than twenty-one days before the date of the annual meeting of the shareholders and policyholders of the company, make a report in writing to them on the annual statement.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;349&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;349&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Audit for shareholders and policyholders</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>In each report required under subsection (1), the auditor shall state whether, in the auditor’s opinion, the annual statement presents fairly, in accordance with the accounting principles referred to in subsection 331(4), the financial position of the company as at the end of the financial year to which it relates and the results of the operations and changes in the financial position of the company for that financial year.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;349&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;349&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Auditor’s remarks</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>In each report referred to in subsection (2), the auditor shall include such remarks as the auditor considers necessary when</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;349&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the examination has not been made in accordance with the auditing standards referred to in subsection 346(2);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;349&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the annual statement has not been prepared on a basis consistent with that of the preceding financial year; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;349&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the annual statement does not present fairly, in accordance with the accounting principles referred to in subsection 331(4), the financial position of the company as at the end of the financial year to which it relates or the results of the operations or changes in the financial position of the company for that financial year.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;350&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;350&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Report on directors’ statement</MarginalNote><Label>350.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;350&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The auditor of a company shall, if required by the shareholders and policyholders, audit and report to them on any financial statement submitted to them by the directors, and the report shall state whether, in the auditor’s opinion, the financial statement presents fairly the information required by the shareholders and policyholders.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;350&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;350&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Making of report</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A report of the auditor made under subsection (1) shall be attached to the financial statement to which it relates and a copy of the statement and report shall be sent by the directors to every shareholder, to every policyholder who is entitled pursuant to paragraph 143(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) to receive notice of an annual meeting of shareholders and policyholders and to the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;351&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;351&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Report to officers</MarginalNote><Label>351.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;351&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>It is the duty of the auditor of a company to report in writing to the chief executive officer and chief financial officer of the company any transactions or conditions that have come to the auditor’s attention affecting the well-being of the company that in the auditor’s opinion are not satisfactory and require rectification and, without restricting the generality of the foregoing, the auditor shall, as occasion requires, make a report to those officers in respect of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;351&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>transactions of the company that have come to the auditor’s attention and that in the auditor’s opinion have not been within the powers of the company, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;351&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of a life company, loans owing to the company by any person the aggregate amount of which exceeds 0.5 per cent of the regulatory capital of the company and in respect of which, in the auditor’s opinion, loss to the company is likely to occur,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>but when a report required under paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) has been made in respect of loans to any person, it is not necessary to report again in respect of loans to that person unless, in the opinion of the auditor, the amount of the loss likely to occur has increased.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;351&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;351&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Transmission of report</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where the auditor of a company makes a report under subsection (1),</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;351&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the auditor shall transmit the report, in writing, to the chief executive officer, chief financial officer and the actuary of the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;351&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the report shall be presented to the first meeting of the directors following its receipt;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;351&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the report shall be incorporated in the minutes of that meeting; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;351&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the auditor shall, at the time of transmitting the report to the chief executive officer and chief financial officer, provide the audit committee of the company and the Superintendent with a copy.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 351;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 289.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;352&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;352&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Auditor of subsidiaries</MarginalNote><Label>352.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;352&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company shall take all necessary steps to ensure that its auditor is duly appointed as the auditor of each of its subsidiaries.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;352&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;352&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Subsidiary outside Canada</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Subsection (1) applies in the case of a subsidiary that carries on its operations in a country other than Canada unless the laws of that country do not permit the appointment of the auditor of the company as the auditor of that subsidiary.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;352&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;352&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Subsection (1) does not apply in respect of any particular subsidiary where the company, after having consulted its auditor, is of the opinion that the total assets of the subsidiary are not a material part of the total assets of the company.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;353&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;353&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Auditor’s attendance</MarginalNote><Label>353.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;353&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The auditor of a company is entitled to receive notice of every meeting of the audit committee and the conduct review committee of the company and, at the expense of the company, to attend and be heard at that meeting.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;353&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;353&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Attendance</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If so requested by a member of the audit committee, the auditor shall attend every meeting of the audit committee held during the member’s term of office.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 353;</li><li> 1994, c. 26, s. 40(F).</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;354&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;354&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Calling meeting</MarginalNote><Label>354.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;354&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The auditor of a company or a member of the audit committee may call a meeting of the audit committee.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;354&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;354&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Right to interview</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The chief internal auditor of a company or any officer or employee of the company acting in a similar capacity shall, at the request of the auditor of the company and on receipt of reasonable notice, meet with the auditor.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;355&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;355&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of errors</MarginalNote><Label>355.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;355&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A director or an officer of a company shall forthwith notify the audit committee and the auditor of the company of any error or misstatement of which the director or officer becomes aware in an annual statement or other financial statement on which the auditor or any former auditor has reported.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;355&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;355&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Error noted by auditor</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If the auditor or a former auditor of a company is notified or becomes aware of an error or misstatement in an annual statement or other financial statement on which the auditor reported and in the auditor’s opinion the error or misstatement is material, the auditor or former auditor shall inform each director of the company accordingly.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;355&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;355&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Duty of directors</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Where under subsection (2) the auditor or a former auditor of a company informs the directors of an error or misstatement in an annual statement or other financial statement, the directors shall</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;355&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>prepare and issue a revised annual statement or financial statement; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;355&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>otherwise inform the shareholders and policyholders referred to in subsection 334(1) and the Superintendent of the error or misstatement.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gc=&quot;s_356&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gc=&quot;s_356&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Qualified Privilege</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;356&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;356&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Qualified privilege for statements</MarginalNote><Label>356.</Label><Text>Any oral or written statement or report made under this Act by the auditor or a former auditor of a company has qualified privilege.</Text></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XIV&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><Label>Division XIV</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XIV&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Actuaries</TitleText></Heading><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XIV&quot;,gc=&quot;s_357&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XIV&quot;,gc=&quot;s_357&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Appointment</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;357&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;357&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of appointment</MarginalNote><Label>357.</Label><Text>A company shall, forthwith after the appointment of the actuary of the company, notify the Superintendent in writing of the appointment.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;358&quot;"><Label>358. and 359.</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 1997, c. 15, s. 236]</Repealed></Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;359.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;359.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Officer precluded</MarginalNote><Label>359.1</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;359.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The chief executive officer or chief operating officer or a person performing like functions may not be appointed or hold the position of actuary of a company unless authorized in writing by the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;359.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;359.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Duration of authorization</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>An authorization under subsection (1) ceases to be in effect on the day specified therein but not later than the day that is six months after it is issued, and a person appointed or holding the position of actuary pursuant to the authorization shall not hold that position after that day.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1996, c. 6, s. 76.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;359.2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;359.2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Chief financial officer</MarginalNote><Label>359.2</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;359.2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The chief financial officer or a person performing like functions may not be appointed as or hold the position of actuary of a company unless</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;359.2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the audit committee of the company has provided the Superintendent with a written statement indicating that it is satisfied that the duties of both positions in the company will be adequately performed and that the actuarial duties will be performed in an independent manner; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;359.2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the appointment or holding of the position is authorized by the Superintendent.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;359.2&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;359.2&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Authorization</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>An authorization under paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) may contain limitations and conditions, including a limitation on the time during which the person referred to in the authorization may hold the position of actuary of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;359.2&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;359.2&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Termination of holding of position</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A person holding the position of actuary pursuant to an authorization under paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) shall not hold that position after the time limit referred to in subsection (2).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1996, c. 6, s. 76.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XIV&quot;,gc=&quot;s_360&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XIV&quot;,gc=&quot;s_360&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Vacancies</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;360&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;360&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Revocation of appointment</MarginalNote><Label>360.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;360&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The directors of a company may revoke the appointment of the actuary of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;360&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;360&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of revocation</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A company shall, forthwith after the revocation of the appointment of the actuary of the company, notify the Superintendent in writing of the revocation.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;361&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;361&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Ceasing to hold office</MarginalNote><Label>361.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;361&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A person ceases to hold office as the actuary of a company when</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;361&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the person resigns as actuary of the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;361&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the person ceases to be an actuary;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;361&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the person dies; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;361&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the appointment of the person as actuary of the company is revoked by the directors of the company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;361&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;361&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effective date of resignation</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The resignation of an actuary becomes effective at the time a written resignation is sent to the company or at the time specified in the resignation, whichever is later.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 361;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 237.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;362&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;362&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Filling vacancy</MarginalNote><Label>362.</Label><Text>Where a vacancy occurs in the office of actuary of a company, the directors shall forthwith notify the Superintendent of and fill the vacancy.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;363&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;363&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Statement of actuary</MarginalNote><Label>363.</Label><Text>An actuary of a company who resigns or whose appointment is revoked shall submit to the directors of the company and the Superintendent a written statement of the circumstances and reasons why the actuary resigned or why, in the actuary’s opinion, the actuary’s appointment was revoked.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;364&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;364&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Duty of replacement actuary</MarginalNote><Label>364.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;364&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where an actuary of a company resigns or the appointment of an actuary of a company is revoked, no person shall accept an appointment or consent to be appointed as actuary of the company before requesting and receiving from the other actuary the written statement referred to in section 363.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;364&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;364&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A person may accept an appointment or consent to be appointed as actuary of a company if no reply is received from the other actuary within fifteen days after a request under subsection (1) is made.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;364&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;364&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effect of non-compliance</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Unless subsection (2) applies, an appointment as actuary of a company is void if subsection (1) is not complied with.</Text></Subsection></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XIV&quot;,gc=&quot;s_365&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XIV&quot;,gc=&quot;s_365&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Valuations and Reports</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;365&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;365&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Actuary’s valuation</MarginalNote><Label>365.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;365&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The actuary of a company shall value</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;365&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the actuarial and other policy liabilities of the company as at the end of a financial year; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;365&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any other matter specified in any direction that may be made by the Superintendent.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;365&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;365&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Actuarial practices</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The actuary’s valuation shall be in accordance with generally accepted actuarial practice with such changes as may be determined by the Superintendent and any additional directions that may be made by the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;365.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;365.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Superintendent may appoint actuary</MarginalNote><Label>365.1</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;365.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The Superintendent may appoint an actuary to value the matters referred to in paragraph 365(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) in relation to a company if the Superintendent is of the opinion that the appointment is necessary. That actuary may not be an actuary of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;365.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;365.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Expenses payable by company</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The expenses incurred in carrying out a valuation under subsection (1) are payable by the company on being approved in writing by the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1996, c. 6, s. 77;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 238.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;366&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;366&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Right to information</MarginalNote><Label>366.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;366&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>On the request of the actuary of a company, the present or former directors, officers, employees or representatives of the company shall, to the extent that they are reasonably able to do so,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;366&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>permit access to such records held by the company, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;366&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>provide such information and explanations</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>as are, in the opinion of the actuary, necessary to enable the actuary to perform the duties of actuary of the company.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;366&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;366&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">No civil liability</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A person who in good faith makes an oral or written communication under subsection (1) shall not be liable in any civil action arising from having made the communication.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;367&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;367&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Actuary’s report</MarginalNote><Label>367.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;367&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The actuary of a company shall, not less than twenty-one days before the date of the annual meeting of the shareholders and policyholders of the company, make a report in the prescribed form to them on the valuation made under section 365 and on any other matter that is prescribed.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;367&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;367&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Idem</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>In each report required under subsection (1), the actuary shall state whether, in the actuary’s opinion, the annual statement presents fairly the results of the valuation made under section 365.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;368&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;368&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Report to directors</MarginalNote><Label>368.</Label><Text>The actuary of a company shall meet either with the directors of the company or, where the directors so choose, with the audit committee of the company at least once during each financial year in order to report, in accordance with generally accepted actuarial practice and any direction that may be made by the Superintendent, on the financial position of the company and, where so specified in such a direction, the expected future financial condition of the company.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;369&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;369&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Report to officers</MarginalNote><Label>369.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;369&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The actuary of a company shall report in writing to the chief executive officer and chief financial officer of the company any matters that have come to the actuary’s attention in the course of carrying out the actuary’s duties and that in the actuary’s opinion have material adverse effects on the financial condition of the company and require rectification.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;369&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;369&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Transmission of report</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>An actuary of a company who makes a report under subsection (1) shall forthwith provide a copy of it to the directors of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;369&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;369&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Failure to take action</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Where, in the opinion of the actuary of the company, suitable action is not being taken to rectify the matters referred to in subsection (1), the actuary shall forthwith send a copy of the report to the Superintendent and advise the directors that the actuary has done so.</Text></Subsection></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XIV&quot;,gc=&quot;s_370&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XIV&quot;,gc=&quot;s_370&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Qualified Privilege</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;370&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;370&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Qualified privilege for statements</MarginalNote><Label>370.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;370&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Any oral or written statement or report made under this Act by the actuary or former actuary of a company has qualified privilege.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;370&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;370&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">No civil liability</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The actuary or former actuary of a company who in good faith makes an oral or written statement or report under section 363 or 369 shall not be liable in any civil action seeking indemnification for damages attributable to the actuary or former actuary having made the statement or report.</Text></Subsection></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XV&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><Label>Division XV</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XV&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Remedial Actions</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;371&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;371&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Derivative action</MarginalNote><Label>371.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;371&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection (2), a complainant or the Superintendent may apply to a court for leave to bring an action under this Act in the name and on behalf of a company or any of its subsidiaries, or to intervene in an action under this Act to which the company or a subsidiary of the company is a party, for the purpose of prosecuting, defending or discontinuing the action on behalf of the company or the subsidiary.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;371&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;371&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Conditions precedent</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>No action may be brought and no intervention in an action may be made under subsection (1) by a complainant unless the court is satisfied that</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;371&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the complainant has, not less than 14 days before bringing the application or as otherwise ordered by the court, given notice to the directors of the company or the company’s subsidiary of the complainant’s intention to apply to the court under subsection (1) if the directors of the company or the company’s subsidiary do not bring, diligently prosecute or defend or discontinue the action;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;371&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the complainant is acting in good faith; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;371&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>it appears to be in the interests of the company or the subsidiary that the action be brought, prosecuted, defended or discontinued.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;371&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;371&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice to Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A complainant under subsection (1) shall give the Superintendent notice of the application and the Superintendent may appear and be heard in person or by counsel at the hearing of the application.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 371;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 290.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;372&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;372&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Powers of court</MarginalNote><Label>372.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;372&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>In connection with an action brought or intervened in under subsection 371(1), the court may at any time make any order it thinks fit including, without limiting the generality of the foregoing,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;372&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order authorizing the Superintendent, the complainant or any other person to control the conduct of the action;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;372&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order giving directions for the conduct of the action;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;372&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order directing that any amount adjudged payable by a defendant in the action be paid, in whole or in part, directly to former and present security holders or policyholders of the company who are entitled to participate in its profits or of the subsidiary instead of to the company or to the subsidiary; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;372&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order requiring the company or the subsidiary to pay reasonable legal fees incurred by the Superintendent or the complainant in connection with the action.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;372&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;372&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Jurisdiction</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Notwithstanding subsection (1), the court may not make any order in relation to any matter that would, under this Act, require the approval of the Minister or the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;373&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;373&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Status of shareholder approval</MarginalNote><Label>373.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;373&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>An application made or an action brought or intervened in under this Division need not be stayed or dismissed by reason only that it is shown that an alleged breach of a right or duty owed to the company or its subsidiary has been or might be approved by the shareholders or policyholders of the company or subsidiary or both, but evidence of approval by the shareholders or policyholders may be taken into account by the court in making an order under section 372.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;373&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;373&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Court approval to discontinue</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>An application made or an action brought or intervened in under this Division shall not be stayed, discontinued, settled or dismissed for want of prosecution without the approval of the court given on such terms as the court thinks fit and, if the court determines that the interests of any complainant might be substantially affected by any stay, discontinuance, settlement or dismissal, the court may order any party to the application or action to give notice to the complainant.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;374&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;374&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">No security for costs</MarginalNote><Label>374.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;374&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A complainant is not required to give security for costs in any application made or any action brought or intervened in under subsection 371(1) or section 375.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;374&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;374&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Interim costs</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>In an application made or an action brought or intervened in under this Division, the court may at any time order the company or its subsidiary to pay to the complainant interim costs, including legal fees and disbursements, but the complainant may be held accountable by the court for those interim costs on final disposition of the application or action.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 374;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 291(F).</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;375&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;375&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application to rectify records</MarginalNote><Label>375.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;375&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If the name of a person is alleged to be or to have been wrongly entered or retained in, or wrongly deleted or omitted from, the securities register or any other record of a company, the company, a security holder of the company or any aggrieved person may apply to a court for an order that the securities register or record be rectified.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;375&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;375&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice to Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>An applicant under this section shall give the Superintendent notice of the application and the Superintendent may appear and be heard in person or by counsel at the hearing of the application.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;375&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;375&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Powers of court</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>In connection with an application under this section, the court may make any order it thinks fit including, without limiting the generality of the foregoing,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;375&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order requiring the securities register or other record of the company to be rectified;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;375&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order restraining a company from calling or holding a meeting of shareholders or policyholders or paying a dividend to shareholders before the rectification;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;375&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order determining the right of a party to the proceedings to have the party’s name entered or retained in, or deleted or omitted from, the securities register or records of the company, whether the issue arises between two or more security holders or alleged security holders, or between the company and any security holder or alleged security holder; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;375&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order compensating a party who has incurred a loss.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XVI&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><Label>Division XVI</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XVI&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Liquidation and Dissolution</TitleText></Heading><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XVI&quot;,gc=&quot;s_376&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XVI&quot;,gc=&quot;s_376&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Interpretation</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;376&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;376&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Definition of <DefinedTermEn>court</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><Label>376.</Label><Text>In this Division, <DefinedTermEn>court</DefinedTermEn> means a court having jurisdiction in the place where the company has its head office.</Text></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XVI&quot;,gc=&quot;s_377&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XVI&quot;,gc=&quot;s_377&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Application</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;377&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;377&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application of Division</MarginalNote><Label>377.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;377&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>This Division does not apply to a company that is insolvent within the meaning of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="W-11">Winding-up and Restructuring Act</XRefExternal>.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;377&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;377&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Staying proceedings on insolvency</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Any proceedings taken under this Division to dissolve or to liquidate and dissolve a company shall be stayed if the company is at any time found to be insolvent within the meaning of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="W-11">Winding-up and Restructuring Act</XRefExternal>.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 377;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 167.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;378&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;378&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Mutual companies, etc.</MarginalNote><Label>378.</Label><Text>This Division does not apply to companies that</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;378&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>are mutual companies; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;378&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>have participating policyholders or policyholders who are entitled to vote at annual meetings of shareholders and policyholders.</Text></Paragraph></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;379&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;379&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Returns to Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>379.</Label><Text>A liquidator appointed under this Part to wind up the business of a company shall provide the Superintendent with such information relating to the business and affairs of the company in such form as the Superintendent requires.</Text></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XVI&quot;,gc=&quot;s_380&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XVI&quot;,gc=&quot;s_380&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Simple Liquidation</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;380&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;380&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">No property and no liabilities</MarginalNote><Label>380.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;380&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company that has no property and no liabilities may, if authorized by a special resolution of the shareholders or, if there are no shareholders, by a resolution of all the directors, apply to the Minister for letters patent dissolving the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;380&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;380&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Dissolution by letters patent</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where the Minister has received an application under subsection (1) and is satisfied that all the circumstances so warrant, the Minister may issue letters patent dissolving the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;380&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;380&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effect of letters patent</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A company in respect of which letters patent are issued under subsection (2) ceases to exist on the day stated in the letters patent.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;381&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;381&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Proposing liquidation</MarginalNote><Label>381.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;381&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The voluntary liquidation and dissolution of a company, other than a company referred to in subsection 380(1),</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;381&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>may be proposed by its directors; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;381&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>may be initiated by way of a proposal made by a shareholder who is entitled to vote at an annual meeting of shareholders in accordance with sections 147 and 148.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;381&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;381&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Terms must be set out</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A notice of any meeting of shareholders at which the voluntary liquidation and dissolution of a company is to be proposed shall set out the terms of the proposal.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;382&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;382&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shareholders’ resolution</MarginalNote><Label>382.</Label><Text>Where the voluntary liquidation and dissolution of a company is proposed, the company may apply to the Minister for letters patent dissolving the company if authorized by a special resolution of the shareholders or, where the company has issued more than one class of shares, by special resolution of each class of shareholders whether or not those shareholders are otherwise entitled to vote.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;383&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;383&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Approval of Minister required</MarginalNote><Label>383.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;383&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>No action directed toward the voluntary liquidation and dissolution of a company shall be taken by a company, other than as provided in sections 381 and 382, until an application made by the company pursuant to section 382 has been approved by the Minister.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;383&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;383&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Conditional approval</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where the Minister is satisfied on the basis of an application made under section 382 that the circumstances warrant the voluntary liquidation and dissolution of a company, the Minister may approve the application.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;383&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;383&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effect of approval</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Where the Minister has approved an application made pursuant to section 382 with respect to a company, the company shall not carry on business except to the extent necessary to complete its voluntary liquidation.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;383&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;383&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Liquidation process</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Where the Minister has approved an application made pursuant to section 382 with respect to a company, the company shall</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;383&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>cause notice of the approval to be sent to each known claimant, except policyholders, against and creditor of the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;383&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>publish notice of the approval once a week for four consecutive weeks in the <XRefExternal reference-type="other" link="gazette">Canada Gazette</XRefExternal> and once a week for two consecutive weeks in one or more newspapers in general circulation in each province in which the company transacted any business within the preceding twelve months;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;383&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>proceed to collect its property, dispose of property that is not to be distributed in kind to its shareholders, discharge or provide for all its obligations and do all other acts required to liquidate its business; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;383&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 1997, c. 15, s. 239]</Repealed></Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;383&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>after giving the notice required under paragraphs (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) and (<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) and adequately providing for the payment or discharge of all its obligations, distribute its remaining property, either in money or in kind, among its shareholders according to their respective rights.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 383;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 239.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;384&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;384&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Dissolution instrument</MarginalNote><Label>384.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;384&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Unless a court has made an order in accordance with subsection 385(1), the Minister may, if satisfied that the company has complied with subsection 383(4) and that all the circumstances so warrant, issue letters patent dissolving the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;384&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;384&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Company dissolved</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A company in respect of which letters patent are issued under subsection (1) is dissolved and ceases to exist on the day stated in the letters patent.</Text></Subsection></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XVI&quot;,gc=&quot;s_385&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XVI&quot;,gc=&quot;s_385&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Court-supervised Liquidation</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;385&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;385&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application for court supervision</MarginalNote><Label>385.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;385&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The Superintendent or any interested person may, at any time during the liquidation of a company, apply to a court for an order for the continuance of the voluntary liquidation under the supervision of the court in accordance with this section and sections 386 to 398 and on such application the court may so order and make any further order it thinks fit.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;385&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;385&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Idem</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>An application under subsection (1) to a court to supervise a voluntary liquidation shall state the reasons, verified by an affidavit of the applicant, why the court should supervise the liquidation.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;385&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;385&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice to Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Where a person, other than the Superintendent, makes an application under subsection (1), the person shall give the Superintendent notice of the application and the Superintendent may appear and be heard in person or by counsel at the hearing of the application.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;386&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;386&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Court supervision thereafter</MarginalNote><Label>386.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;386&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>When a court makes an order under subsection 385(1), the liquidation of the company shall continue under the supervision of the court.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;386&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;386&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Commencement of liquidation</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The supervision of the liquidation of a company by the court pursuant to an order made under subsection 385(1) commences on the day the order is made.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;387&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;387&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Powers of court</MarginalNote><Label>387.</Label><Text>In connection with the liquidation and dissolution of a company, the court may, where it is satisfied that the company is able to pay or adequately provide for the discharge of all its obligations and to make satisfactory arrangements for the protection of its policyholders, make any order it thinks fit including, without limiting the generality of the foregoing,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;387&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order to liquidate;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;387&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order appointing a liquidator, with or without security, fixing a liquidator’s remuneration and replacing a liquidator;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;387&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order appointing inspectors or referees, specifying their powers, fixing their remuneration and replacing inspectors or referees;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;387&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order determining the notice to be given to any interested person, or dispensing with notice to any person;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;387&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order determining the validity of any claims made against the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;387&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order, at any stage of the proceedings, restraining the directors and officers of the company from</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;387&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>exercising any of their powers, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;387&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>collecting or receiving any debt or other property of the company, and from paying out or transferring any property of the company, except as permitted by the court;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;387&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order determining and enforcing the duty or liability of any present or former director, officer, shareholder or policyholder</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;387&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>to the company, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;387&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>for an obligation of the company;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;387&quot;,p1=&quot;h&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">h</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order approving the payment, satisfaction or compromise of claims against the company and the retention of assets for that purpose, and determining the adequacy of provisions for the payment, discharge or transfer of any obligation of the company, whether liquidated, unliquidated, future or contingent;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;387&quot;,p1=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">i</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>with the concurrence of the Superintendent, an order providing for the disposal or destruction of the documents, records or registers of the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;387&quot;,p1=&quot;j&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">j</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>on the application of a creditor, an inspector or the liquidator, an order giving directions on any matter arising in the liquidation;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;387&quot;,p1=&quot;k&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">k</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>after notice has been given to all interested parties, an order relieving the liquidator from any omission or default on such terms as the court thinks fit and confirming any act of the liquidator;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;387&quot;,p1=&quot;l&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">l</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>subject to sections 394 to 396, an order approving any proposed, interim or final distribution to shareholders, if any, or incorporators, in money or in property;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;387&quot;,p1=&quot;m&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">m</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order disposing of any property belonging to creditors, shareholders, policyholders, and incorporators who cannot be found;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;387&quot;,p1=&quot;n&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">n</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>on the application of any director, officer, shareholder, policyholder, incorporator, creditor or the liquidator;</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;387&quot;,p1=&quot;n&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>an order staying the liquidation proceedings on such terms and conditions as the court thinks fit,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;387&quot;,p1=&quot;n&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>an order continuing or discontinuing the liquidation proceedings, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;387&quot;,p1=&quot;n&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>an order to the liquidator to restore to the company all of its remaining property; and</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;387&quot;,p1=&quot;o&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">o</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>after the liquidator has rendered the liquidator’s final account to the court, an order directing the company to apply to the Minister for letters patent dissolving the company.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 387;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 292(F).</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;388&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;388&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Cessation of business and powers</MarginalNote><Label>388.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;388&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where a court makes an order for the liquidation of a company,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;388&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the company continues in existence but shall cease to carry on business, except the business that is, in the opinion of the liquidator, required for an orderly liquidation; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;388&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the powers of the directors and shareholders, if any, are vested in the liquidator and cease to be vested in the directors or shareholders, except as specifically authorized by the court.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;388&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;388&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Delegation by liquidator</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A liquidator may delegate any of the powers vested by paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) to the directors or shareholders, if any.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;389&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;389&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Appointment of liquidator</MarginalNote><Label>389.</Label><Text>When making an order for the liquidation of a company or at any time thereafter, the court may appoint any person, including a director, an officer or a shareholder of the company or any other company, as liquidator of the company.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;390&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;390&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Vacancy in liquidator’s office</MarginalNote><Label>390.</Label><Text>Where an order for the liquidation of a company has been made and the office of liquidator is or becomes vacant, the property of the company is under the control of the court until the office of liquidator is filled.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;391&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;391&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Duties of liquidator</MarginalNote><Label>391.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;391&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A liquidator shall</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;391&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>forthwith after appointment give notice thereof to the Superintendent and to each claimant and creditor of the company known to the liquidator;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;391&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>forthwith after appointment publish notice thereof once a week for four consecutive weeks in the <XRefExternal reference-type="other" link="gazette">Canada Gazette</XRefExternal> and once a week for two consecutive weeks in one or more newspapers in general circulation in each province in which the company has transacted any business within the preceding twelve months, requiring</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;391&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>any person indebted to the company to render an account and pay to the liquidator at the time and place specified in the notice any amount owing,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;391&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>any person possessing property of the company to deliver it to the liquidator at the time and place specified in the notice, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;391&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>any person having a claim against the company, whether liquidated, unliquidated, future or contingent, other than a policyholder having an unliquidated claim, to present particulars thereof in writing to the liquidator not later than sixty days after the first publication of the notice;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;391&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>take into custody and control the property of the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;391&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 1997, c. 15, s. 240]</Repealed></Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;391&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>open and maintain a trust account for the moneys received by the liquidator in the course of the liquidation of the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;391&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>keep accounts of the moneys received and paid out by the liquidator in the course of the liquidation of the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;391&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>maintain separate lists of each class of creditors, shareholders, policyholders and other persons having claims against the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;391&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;h&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">h</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if at any time the liquidator determines that the company is unable to pay or adequately provide for the discharge of its obligations, apply to the court for directions;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;391&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">i</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>deliver to the court and to the Superintendent, at least once in every twelve month period after the liquidator’s appointment or more often as the court requires, the annual statement of the company prepared in accordance with subsection 331(1) or prepared in such manner as the liquidator thinks proper or as the court requires; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;391&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;j&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">j</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>after the final accounts are approved by the court, distribute any remaining property of the company among the shareholders, if any, or incorporators, according to their respective rights.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;391&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;391&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Powers of liquidator</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A liquidator may</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;391&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>retain actuaries, lawyers, notaries, accountants, appraisers and other professional advisers;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;391&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>bring, defend or take part in any civil, criminal or administrative action or proceeding in the name and on behalf of the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;391&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>carry on the business of the company as required for an orderly liquidation;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;391&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>sell by public auction or private sale any property of the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;391&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>do all acts and execute documents in the name and on behalf of the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;391&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>borrow money on the security of the property of the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;391&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>settle or compromise any claims by or against the company; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;391&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;h&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">h</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>do all other things necessary for the liquidation of the company and distribution of its property.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 391;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 240.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;392&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;392&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Due diligence</MarginalNote><Label>392.</Label><Text>A liquidator is not liable if they exercised the care, diligence and skill that a reasonably prudent person would have exercised in comparable circumstances, including reliance in good faith on</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;392&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>financial statements of the company represented to the liquidator by an officer of the company or in a written report of the auditor of the company fairly to reflect the financial condition of the company; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;392&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a report of a person whose profession lends credibility to a statement made by them.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 392;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 293.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;393&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;393&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Examination of others</MarginalNote><Label>393.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;393&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where a liquidator has reason to believe that any property of the company is in the possession or under the control of a person or that a person has concealed, withheld or misappropriated any such property, the liquidator may apply to the court for an order requiring that person to appear before the court at the time and place designated in the order and to be examined.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;393&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;393&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restoration and compensation</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where an examination conducted pursuant to subsection (1) discloses that a person has concealed, withheld or misappropriated any property of the company, the court may order that person to restore the property or pay compensation to the liquidator.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;394&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;394&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Costs of liquidation</MarginalNote><Label>394.</Label><Text>A liquidator shall pay the costs of liquidation out of the property of the company and shall pay or make adequate provision for all claims against the company.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;395&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;395&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Final accounts</MarginalNote><Label>395.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;395&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Within one year after the appointment of a liquidator and after paying or making adequate provision for all claims against the company, the liquidator shall apply to the court</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;395&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>for approval of the final accounts of the liquidator and for an order permitting the distribution, in money or in kind, of the remaining property of the company to its shareholders, if any, or to the incorporators, according to their respective rights; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;395&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>for an extension of time, setting out the reasons therefor.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;395&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;395&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shareholder application</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If a liquidator fails to make the application required by subsection (1), a shareholder of the company or, if there are no shareholders of the company, an incorporator may apply to the court for an order for the liquidator to show cause why a final accounting and distribution should not be made.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;395&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;395&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notification of final accounts</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A liquidator shall give notice of the liquidator’s intention to make an application under subsection (1) to the Superintendent, to each inspector appointed under section 387, to each shareholder of the company or, if there are no shareholders, to each incorporator and to any person who provided a security or fidelity bond for the liquidation.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;395&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;395&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Publication</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>The liquidator shall publish the notice required under subsection (3) in the <XRefExternal reference-type="other" link="gazette">Canada Gazette</XRefExternal> and once a week for two consecutive weeks in one or more newspapers in general circulation in each province in which the company has transacted any business within the preceding twelve months or as otherwise directed by the court.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;396&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;396&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Final order</MarginalNote><Label>396.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;396&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If the court approves the final accounts rendered by a liquidator, the court shall make an order</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;396&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>directing the company to apply to the Minister for letters patent dissolving the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;396&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>directing the custody or disposal of the documents, records and registers of the company; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;396&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>discharging the liquidator except in respect of the duty of a liquidator under subsection (2).</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;396&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;396&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Delivery of order</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The liquidator shall forthwith send a certified copy of the order referred to in subsection (1) to the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;397&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;397&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Right to distribution of money</MarginalNote><Label>397.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;397&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If in the course of the liquidation of a company the shareholders resolve to, or the liquidator proposes to,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;397&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>exchange all or substantially all of the remaining property of the company for securities of another entity that are to be distributed to the shareholders or to the incorporators, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;397&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>distribute all or part of the remaining property of the company to the shareholders or to the incorporators in kind,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>a shareholder or incorporator may apply to the court for an order requiring the distribution of the remaining property of the company to be in money.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;397&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;397&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Powers of court</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>On an application under subsection (1), the court may order</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;397&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>all of the remaining property of the company to be converted into and distributed in money; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;397&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the claim of any shareholder or incorporator applying under this section to be satisfied by a distribution in money.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;397&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;397&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Order by court</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Where an order is made by a court under paragraph (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>), the court</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;397&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>shall fix a fair value on the share of the property of the company attributable to the shareholder or incorporator;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;397&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>may in its discretion appoint one or more appraisers to assist the court in fixing a fair value in accordance with paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>); and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;397&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>shall render a final order against the company in favour of the shareholder or incorporator for the amount of the share of the property of the company attributable to the shareholder or incorporator.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;398&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;398&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Dissolution by letters patent</MarginalNote><Label>398.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;398&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>On an application made pursuant to an order under paragraph 396(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>), the Minister may issue letters patent dissolving the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;398&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;398&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Company dissolved</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A company in respect of which letters patent are issued under subsection (1) is dissolved and ceases to exist on the date of the issuance of the letters patent.</Text></Subsection></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XVI&quot;,gc=&quot;s_399&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VI&quot;,gb=&quot;l_XVI&quot;,gc=&quot;s_399&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">General</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;399&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;399&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Definition of <DefinedTermEn>shareholder</DefinedTermEn> and <DefinedTermEn>incorporator</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><Label>399.</Label><Text>In sections 401 and 402, <DefinedTermEn>shareholder</DefinedTermEn> and <DefinedTermEn>incorporator</DefinedTermEn> include the heirs and personal representatives of a shareholder or incorporator.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;400&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;400&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Continuation of actions</MarginalNote><Label>400.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;400&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Notwithstanding the dissolution of a company under this Part,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;400&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a civil, criminal or administrative action or proceeding commenced by or against the company before its dissolution may be continued as if the company had not been dissolved;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;400&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a civil, criminal or administrative action or proceeding may be brought against the company within two years after its dissolution as if the company had not been dissolved; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;400&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any property that would have been available to satisfy any judgment or order if the company had not been dissolved remains available for that purpose.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;400&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;400&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Service on company</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Service of a document on a company after its dissolution may be effected by serving the document on a person shown as a director in the incorporating instrument of the company or, if applicable, in the latest return sent to the Superintendent under section 668.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;401&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;401&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limitations on liability</MarginalNote><Label>401.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;401&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Notwithstanding the dissolution of a company, a shareholder or incorporator to whom any of its property has been distributed is liable to any person claiming under subsection 400(1) to the extent of the amount received by that shareholder or incorporator on the distribution.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;401&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;401&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limitation</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>An action to enforce liability under subsection (1) may not be commenced except within two years after the date of the dissolution of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;401&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;401&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Action against class</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A court may order an action referred to in subsections (1) and (2) to be brought against the persons who were shareholders or incorporators as a class, subject to such conditions as the court thinks fit.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;401&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;401&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Reference</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>If the plaintiff establishes a claim in an action under subsection (3), the court may refer the proceedings to a referee or other officer of the court who may</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;401&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>add as a party to the proceedings each person found by the plaintiff to have been a shareholder or incorporator;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;401&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>determine, subject to subsection (1), the amount that each person who was a shareholder or incorporator must contribute towards satisfaction of the plaintiff’s claim; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;401&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>direct payment of the amounts so determined.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;402&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;402&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Where creditor cannot be found</MarginalNote><Label>402.</Label><Text>Where a creditor, shareholder or incorporator to whom property is to be distributed on the dissolution of a company cannot be found, the portion of the property to be distributed to that creditor, shareholder or incorporator shall be converted into money and paid in accordance with section 404.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;403&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;403&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Vesting in Crown</MarginalNote><Label>403.</Label><Text>Subject to subsection 400(1) and sections 404 and 405, property of a company that has not been disposed of at the date of the dissolution of the company vests in Her Majesty in right of Canada.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;404&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;404&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Unclaimed money on winding-up</MarginalNote><Label>404.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;404&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where the business of a company is being wound up under this Division, the liquidator or the company shall pay to the Minister on demand and in any event before the final winding-up of that business any amount that is payable by the liquidator or the company to a creditor, shareholder or incorporator of the company to whom payment thereof has not, for any reason, been made.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;404&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;404&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Records</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where a liquidator or a company makes a payment to the Minister under subsection (1) with respect to a creditor, shareholder or incorporator, the liquidator or company shall concurrently forward to the Minister all documents, records and registers in the possession of the liquidator or company that relate to the entitlement of the creditor, shareholder or incorporator.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;404&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;404&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Payment to Receiver General</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The Minister shall pay to the Receiver General all amounts paid to the Minister under subsection (1).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;404&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;404&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Liquidator and company discharged</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Payment by a liquidator or a company to the Minister under subsection (1) discharges the liquidator and the company in respect of which the payment is made from all liability for the amount so paid, and payment by the Minister to the Receiver General under subsection (3) discharges the Minister from all liability for the amount so paid.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;405&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;405&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Recovery</MarginalNote><Label>405.</Label><Text>If at any time a person establishes an entitlement to any moneys paid to the Receiver General under this Division, the Receiver General shall pay an equivalent amount to that person out of the Consolidated Revenue Fund.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;406&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;406&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Custody of records after dissolution</MarginalNote><Label>406.</Label><Text>A person who has been granted custody of the documents, records and registers of a dissolved company shall keep them available for production for six years following the date of the dissolution of the company or until the expiration of such shorter period as may be ordered by the court when it orders the dissolution.</Text></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VII&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="1"><Label>PART VII</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VII&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">OWNERSHIP</TitleText></Heading><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_I&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><Label>Division I</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_I&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Interpretation</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;406.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;406.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Definition of “agent”</MarginalNote><Label>406.1</Label><Text>In this Part, <DefinedTermEn>agent</DefinedTermEn> means</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;406.1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in relation to Her Majesty in right of Canada or of a province, any agent of Her Majesty in either of those rights, and includes a municipal or public body empowered to perform a function of government in Canada or any entity empowered to perform a function or duty on behalf of Her Majesty in either of those rights but does not include</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;406.1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>an official or entity performing a function or duty in connection with the administration or management of the estate or property of a natural person,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;406.1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>an official or entity performing a function or duty in connection with the administration, management or investment of a fund established to provide compensation, hospitalization, medical care, annuities, pensions or similar benefits to natural persons, or moneys derived from such a fund, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;406.1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>the trustee of any trust for the administration of a fund to which Her Majesty in either of those rights contributes and of which an official or entity that is an agent of Her Majesty in either of those rights is a trustee; and</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;406.1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in relation to the government of a foreign country or any political subdivision thereof, a person empowered to perform a function or duty on behalf of the government of the foreign country or political subdivision, other than a function or duty in connection with the administration or management of the estate or property of a natural person.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1994, c. 47, s. 122.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_II&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><Label>Division II</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_II&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Constraints on Ownership</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;407&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Constraining acquisition</MarginalNote><Label>407.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>No person, or entity controlled by a person, shall, without the approval of the Minister, purchase or otherwise acquire any share of a company or purchase or otherwise acquire control of any entity that holds any share of a company if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the acquisition would cause the person to have a significant interest in any class of shares of the company; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>where the person has a significant interest in a class of shares of the company, the acquisition would increase the significant interest of the person in that class of shares.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Amalgamation, etc., constitutes acquisition</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If the entity that would result from an amalgamation, a merger or a reorganization would have a significant interest in a class of shares of a company, the entity is deemed to be acquiring a significant interest in that class of shares of the company through an acquisition for which the approval of the Minister is required under subsection (1).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exemption</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>On application by a company, other than a converted company in respect of which subsection (4) or (11) applies or a company to which subsection (5) or (12) applies, the Superintendent may exempt from the application of subsection (1) and section 408 any class of non-voting shares of the company if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the aggregate book value of the shares of the class is not more than 30 per cent of the aggregate book value of all the outstanding shares of the company; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of a mutual company, the aggregate book value of the shares of the class is not more than 30 per cent of the aggregate book value of all the outstanding shares of the company and the surplus of the company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limitations on share holdings</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Despite subsection (1), no person may be a major shareholder of a converted company having an aggregate of surplus and minority interests of five billion dollars or more according to its last annual statement dated before the effective date of the letters patent of conversion of the converted company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>Subsection (4) does not apply to a widely held company that controls, within the meaning of paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), a converted company if it</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>controlled the converted company on the day on which the letters patent of conversion that gave effect to the conversion of the converted company became effective and it has continued to control, within the meaning of that paragraph, the converted company since that day; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>acquired control, within the meaning of that paragraph, of the converted company under section 28.1 or 28.2 and it has continued to control, within the meaning of that paragraph, the converted company since the day it acquired control.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception — widely held insurance holding company</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>Subsection (4) does not apply to a widely held insurance holding company that controls, within the meaning of paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), the converted company if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the insurance holding company acquired control, within the meaning of that paragraph, of the converted company or of the company to which subsection (5) applies, as the case may be, under section 714 or 715 and the insurance holding company has continued to control, within the meaning of that paragraph, the converted company since the day the insurance holding company acquired control; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the converted company was a subsidiary of the company to which subsection (5) applies that was continued under section 721 as the insurance holding company and the insurance holding company has continued to control, within the meaning of paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), the converted company since the day it came into existence as an insurance holding company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception — other entities</MarginalNote><Label>(7)</Label><Text>Subsection (4) does not apply to an entity that controls, within the meaning of paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), the converted company if the entity is controlled, within the meaning of paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), by a company to which subsection (5) applies, or by an insurance holding company to which subsection (6) applies, that is permitted under that subsection to be a major shareholder of the converted company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;8&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;8&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(8)</Label><Text>The Minister may, at any time after the day that is two years after December 31, 1999, by order, determine that subsection (4) no longer applies in respect of any particular company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;9&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;9&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limitation on share holdings</MarginalNote><Label>(9)</Label><Text>Despite subsection (1), no person may be a major shareholder of a company to which subsection (5) applies.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;10&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;10&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(10)</Label><Text>Subsection (9) does not apply to a widely held insurance holding company that controls, within the meaning of paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), a company to which subsection (5) applies if the insurance holding company acquired control, within the meaning of that paragraph, of the company under section 714 or 715 and the insurance holding company has continued to control, within the meaning of that paragraph, the company since the day the insurance holding company acquired control.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;11&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;11&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limitations on share holdings</MarginalNote><Label>(11)</Label><Text>Despite subsection (1), until a day that is two years after December 31, 1999, no person may have a significant interest in any class of shares of a converted company having an aggregate of surplus and minority interests in an amount that is one billion dollars or more but less than five billion dollars, according to its last annual statement dated before the effective date of the letters patent of conversion of the converted company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;12&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;12&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(12)</Label><Text>Subsection (11) does not apply to a company if no person has a significant interest in any class of shares of the company and the company controls, within the meaning of paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), the converted company if it</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;12&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>controlled the converted company on the day on which the letters patent of conversion that gave effect to the conversion of the converted company became effective and it has continued to control, within the meaning of that paragraph, the converted company since that day; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;12&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>acquired control, within the meaning of that paragraph, of the converted company under section 28.1 or 28.2 and it has continued to control, within the meaning of that paragraph, the converted company since the day it acquired control.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;13&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;13&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception — insurance holding company</MarginalNote><Label>(13)</Label><Text>Subsection (11) does not apply to an insurance holding company if no person has a significant interest in any class of shares of the insurance holding company and the insurance holding company controls, within the meaning of paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), the converted company if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;13&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the insurance holding company acquired control, within the meaning of that paragraph, of the converted company or of the company to which subsection (12) applies, as the case may be, under section 714 or 715 and the insurance holding company has continued to control, within the meaning of that paragraph, the converted company since the day the insurance holding company acquired control; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;13&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the converted company was a subsidiary of the company to which subsection (12) applies that was continued under section 721 as the insurance holding company and the insurance holding company has continued to control, within the meaning of that paragraph, the converted company since the day it came into existence as an insurance holding company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;14&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;14&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception — other entities</MarginalNote><Label>(14)</Label><Text>Subsection (11) does not apply to an entity that controls, within the meaning of paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), the converted company if the entity is controlled, within the meaning of that paragraph, by a company to which subsection (12) applies, or by an insurance holding company to which subsection (13) applies, that is permitted under that subsection to have a significant interest in any class of shares of the converted company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;15&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;15&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limitation on share holdings</MarginalNote><Label>(15)</Label><Text>Despite subsection (1), no person may have a significant interest in any class of shares of a company to which subsection (12) applies.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;16&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;16&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(16)</Label><Text>Subsection (15) does not apply to an insurance holding company that controls, within the meaning of paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), a company to which subsection (12) applies if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;16&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>no person has a significant interest in any class of shares of the insurance holding company; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;16&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the insurance holding company acquired control, within the meaning of that paragraph, under section 714 or 715 of the company to which subsection (12) applies and the insurance holding company has continued to control, within the meaning of that paragraph, the company since the day the insurance holding company acquired control.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;17&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;17&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Deeming</MarginalNote><Label>(17)</Label><Text>For the purposes of this Act, if the Minister makes an order under subsection (8) to the effect that subsection (4) no longer applies in respect of a particular company,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;17&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the particular company is deemed, as of the effective date of the order, to no longer be a company in respect of which subsection (4) applies;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;17&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a widely held company that controls, within the meaning of paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), the particular company in the circumstances referred to in subsection (5) is deemed, as of the effective date of the order, to no longer be a company to which subsection (5) applies; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;17&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a widely held insurance holding company that controls, within the meaning of paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), the particular company in the circumstances referred to in subsection (6) is deemed, as of the effective date of the order, to no longer be an insurance holding company to which subsection (6) applies.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;18&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;18&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Deeming</MarginalNote><Label>(18)</Label><Text>For the purposes of this Act, after the day that is two years after December 31, 1999,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;18&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a converted company having an aggregate of surplus and minority interests in an amount that is one billion dollars or more but less than five billion dollars, according to its last annual statement dated before the effective date of the letters patent of conversion of the converted company is deemed to no longer be a company in respect of which subsection (11) applies;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;18&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a company that controls, within the meaning of paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), a converted company referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) in the circumstances referred to in subsection (12) is deemed to no longer be a company to which subsection (12) applies; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;407&quot;,ss=&quot;18&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an insurance holding company that controls, within the meaning of paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), a converted company referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) in the circumstances referred to in subsection (13) is deemed to no longer be an insurance holding company to which subsection (13) applies.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 407;</li><li> 1993, c. 34, s. 79;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 241;</li><li> 1999, c. 1, s. 7;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 401;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 215.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;407.01&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407.01&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Life companies — major shareholder</MarginalNote><Label>407.01</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407.01&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If a converted company in respect of which subsection 407(4) applies or a company to which subsection 407(5) applies controls a life company and a person becomes a major shareholder of the life company or of any entity that also controls the life company, the converted company or company, as the case may be, must do all things necessary to ensure that, on the day that is one year after the person became a major shareholder of the life company or entity that controls the life company,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;407.01&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the converted company or the company no longer controls the life company; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;407.01&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the life company or the entity that controls the life company does not have any major shareholder other than the converted company or the company, as the case may be, or any entity that the converted company or the company controls.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407.01&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407.01&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exemption</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Subsection (1) does not apply in respect of a life company with equity of less than two hundred and fifty million dollars, or any other amount that may be prescribed.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407.01&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407.01&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Extension</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>If general market conditions so warrant and the Minister is satisfied that the converted company or the company has used its best efforts to be in compliance with subsection (1) on the required day, the Minister may specify a later day as the day from and after which it must comply with that subsection.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 402.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;407.011&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407.011&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Life companies — major shareholder</MarginalNote><Label>407.011</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407.011&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Despite subsection 407.01(1), if a converted company in respect of which subsection 407(4) applies or a company to which subsection 407(5) applies controls a life company in respect of which subsection 407.01(1) does not apply by reason of subsection 407.01(2) and the equity of the life company reaches two hundred and fifty million dollars or more or any other amount that is prescribed and on the day the equity of the life company reaches two hundred and fifty million dollars or more, or the prescribed amount, as the case may be, a person is a major shareholder of the life company or of any entity that also controls the life company, the converted company or company must do all things necessary to ensure that, on the day that is three years after that day,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;407.011&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the converted company or company no longer controls the life company; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;407.011&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the life company or the entity that controls the life company does not have any major shareholder other than the converted company or the company or any entity that the converted company or company controls.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407.011&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407.011&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Extension</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If general market conditions so warrant and the Minister is satisfied that the converted company or the company has used its best efforts to be in compliance with subsection (1) on the required day, the Minister may specify a later day as the day from and after which it must comply with that subsection.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 402.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;407.02&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407.02&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Life companies — significant interest</MarginalNote><Label>407.02</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407.02&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If a converted company in respect of which subsection 407(11) applies or a company to which subsection 407(12) applies controls a life company and a person acquires a significant interest in any class of shares of the life company or of any entity that also controls the life company, the converted company or company, as the case may be, must do all things necessary to ensure that, on the day that is one year after the person acquired the significant interest in the class of shares of the life company or entity that controls the life company,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;407.02&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the converted company or the company no longer controls the life company; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;407.02&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>no person has a significant interest in any class of shares of the life company or the entity that controls the life company, other than the converted company or the company, as the case may be, or any entity that the converted company or the company controls.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407.02&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407.02&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exemption</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Subsection (1) does not apply in respect of a life company with equity of less than two hundred and fifty million dollars, or any other amount that may be prescribed.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407.02&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407.02&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Extension</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>If general market conditions so warrant and the Minister is satisfied that the converted company or the company has used its best efforts to be in compliance with subsection (1) on the required day, the Minister may specify a later day as the day from and after which it must comply with that subsection.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 402.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;407.03&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407.03&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Prohibition against significant interest</MarginalNote><Label>407.03</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407.03&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>No person who has a significant interest in any class of shares of a widely held converted company in respect of which subsection 407(4) applies or of a widely held company to which subsection 407(5) applies may have a significant interest in any class of shares of a subsidiary of the converted company or company, as the case may be, that is a life company or an insurance holding company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407.03&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407.03&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Prohibition against significant interest</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>No person who has a significant interest in any class of shares of a life company may have a significant interest in any class of shares of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;407.03&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a widely held converted company in respect of which subsection 407(4) applies that controls the life company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;407.03&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a widely held company to which subsection 407(5) applies that controls the life company; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;407.03&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a widely held insurance holding company to which subsection 407(6) applies that controls the life company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 402.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;407.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">No acquisition of control without approval</MarginalNote><Label>407.1</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>No person shall acquire control, within the meaning of paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), of a company without the approval of the Minister.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Amalgamation, etc., constitutes acquisition</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If the entity that would result from an amalgamation, a merger or a reorganization would control, within the meaning of paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), a company, the entity is deemed to be acquiring control, within the meaning of that paragraph, of the company through an acquisition for which the approval of the Minister is required under subsection (1).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 242;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 216.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;407.2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407.2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Prohibition against control</MarginalNote><Label>407.2</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407.2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Despite section 407.1, no person shall control, within the meaning of paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), a converted company in respect of which subsection 407(4) or (11) applies or a company to which subsection 407(5) or (12) applies.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407.2&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407.2&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Subsection (1) does not apply to a company to which subsection 407(5) or (12) applies or to an insurance holding company to which subsection 407(6) or (13) applies that is permitted to control, within the meaning of paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), under those subsections, the converted company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407.2&quot;,ss=&quot;2.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407.2&quot;,ss=&quot;2.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(2.1)</Label><Text>Subsection (1) does not apply to an insurance holding company to which subsection 407(10) or (16) applies that is permitted to control, within the meaning of paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), under those subsections, the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407.2&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407.2&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception — other entities</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Subsection (1) does not apply to an entity that controls, within the meaning of paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), the converted company or company, as the case may be, if the entity is controlled, within the meaning of that paragraph, by a company to which subsection 407(5) or (12) applies, or an insurance holding company to which subsection 407(6) or (13) applies, that is permitted to be a major shareholder of the converted company or company, as the case may be, or to have a significant interest in any class of shares of the converted company or company, as the case may be.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407.2&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407.2&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Loss of control</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Despite subsections (1) and 407(4), if the converted company referred to in subsection (1) is a converted company in respect of which subsection 407(4) applies, a company to which subsection 407(5) applies or an insurance holding company to which subsection 407(6) applies may be a major shareholder of the converted company and cease to control, within the meaning of paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), the converted company if the company or the insurance holding company, as the case may be, has entered into an agreement with the Minister to do all things necessary to ensure that it is not a major shareholder of the converted company on the expiration of the day specified in the agreement.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407.2&quot;,ss=&quot;4.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407.2&quot;,ss=&quot;4.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(4.1)</Label><Text>Despite subsections (1) and 407(9), if the company referred to in subsection (1) is a company to which subsection 407(5) applies, an insurance holding company to which subsection 407(6) applies may be a major shareholder of the company and cease to control, within the meaning of paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), the company if the insurance holding company has entered into an agreement with the Minister to do all things necessary to ensure that it is not a major shareholder of the company on the expiration of the day specified in the agreement.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407.2&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407.2&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Extension</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>If general market conditions so warrant and the Minister is satisfied that the company or the insurance holding company, as the case may be, has used its best efforts to be in compliance with subsection (4) or (4.1) on the required day, the Minister may specify a later day as the day from and after which it must comply with that subsection.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407.2&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407.2&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Loss of control</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>Despite subsections (1) and 407(11), if the converted company referred to in subsection (1) is a converted company in respect of which subsection 407(11) applies, a company to which subsection 407(12) applies or an insurance holding company to which subsection 407(13) applies may have a significant interest in a class of shares of the converted company and cease to control, within the meaning of paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), the converted company if the company or the insurance holding company, as the case may be, has entered into an agreement with the Minister to do all things necessary to ensure that it does not have a significant interest in any class of shares of the converted company on the expiration of the day specified in the agreement.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407.2&quot;,ss=&quot;6.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407.2&quot;,ss=&quot;6.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(6.1)</Label><Text>Despite subsections (1) and 407(15), if the company referred to in subsection (1) is a company to which subsection 407(12) applies, an insurance holding company to which subsection 407(13) applies may have a significant interest in a class of shares of the company and cease to control, within the meaning of paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), the company if the insurance holding company has entered into an agreement with the Minister to do all things necessary to ensure that it does not have a significant interest in any class of shares of the company on the expiration of the day specified in the agreement.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;407.2&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;407.2&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Extension</MarginalNote><Label>(7)</Label><Text>If general market conditions so warrant and the Minister is satisfied that the company or the insurance holding company, as the case may be, has used its best efforts to be in compliance with subsection (6) or (6.1) on the required day, the Minister may specify a later day as the day from and after which it must comply with that subsection.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 403.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;408&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;408&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Constraining registration</MarginalNote><Label>408.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;408&quot;,ss=&quot;&quot;"><Label></Label><Text>No company shall, unless the acquisition of the share has been approved by the Minister, record in its securities register a transfer or issue of any share of the company to any person or to any entity controlled by a person if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;408&quot;,ss=&quot;&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the transfer or issue of the share would cause the person to have a significant interest in any class of shares of the company; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;408&quot;,ss=&quot;&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>where the person has a significant interest in a class of shares of the company, the transfer or issue of the share would increase the significant interest of the person in that class of shares of the company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;408&quot;,ss=&quot;2)&quot;"><Label>(2) and (3)</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 1997, c. 15, s. 243]</Repealed></Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 408;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 243.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;408.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;408.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception for small holdings</MarginalNote><Label>408.1</Label><Text>Notwithstanding section 408, where, as a result of a transfer or issue of shares of a class of shares of a company to a person, the total number of shares of that class registered in the securities register of the company in the name of that person</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;408.1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>would not exceed five thousand, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;408.1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>would not exceed 0.1 per cent of the outstanding shares of that class,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>the company is entitled to assume that no person is acquiring or increasing a significant interest in that class of shares of the company as a result of that issue or transfer of shares.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1994, c. 47, s. 123.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;409&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;409&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Where approval not required</MarginalNote><Label>409.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;409&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Despite subsections 407(1) and (2) and section 408, the approval of the Minister is not required in respect of a company, other than a converted company in respect of which subsection 407(4) applies or a company to which subsection 407(5) applies, if a person with a significant interest in a class of shares of the company or an entity controlled by a person with a significant interest in a class of shares of the company purchases or otherwise acquires shares of that class, or acquires control of any entity that holds any share of that class, and the number of shares of that class purchased or otherwise acquired, or the acquisition of control of the entity, as the case may be, would not increase the significant interest of the person in that class of shares of the company to a percentage that is greater than the percentage referred to in subsection (2) or (3), whichever is applicable.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;409&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;409&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Percentage</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection (3), for the purposes of subsection (1), the percentage is 5 percentage points in excess of the significant interest of the person in that class of shares of the company on the later of June 1, 1992 and the day of the most recent purchase or acquisition by the person or any entity controlled by the person, other than the entity referred to in subsection (1), of shares of that class of shares of the company, or of control of an entity that held shares of that class of shares of the company, for which approval was given by the Minister.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;409&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;409&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">When approval not required</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>If a person has a significant interest in a class of shares of a company and the person’s percentage of that class has decreased after the date of the most recent purchase or other acquisition by the person or any entity controlled by the person, other than the entity referred to in subsection (1), of shares of that class of shares of the company, or of control of an entity that held shares of that class of shares of the company, for which approval was given by the Minister, the percentage for the purposes of subsection (1) is the percentage that is the lesser of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;409&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>5 percentage points in excess of the significant interest of the person in that class of shares of the company on the later of June 1, 1992 and the day of the most recent purchase or other acquisition by the person or any entity controlled by the person, other than the entity referred to in subsection (1), of shares of that class of shares of the company, or of control of an entity that held shares of that class of shares of the company, for which approval was given by the Minister, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;409&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>10 percentage points in excess of the lowest significant interest of the person in that class of shares of the company at any time after the later of June 1, 1992 and the day of the most recent purchase or other acquisition by the person or any entity controlled by the person, other than the entity referred to in subsection (1), of shares of that class of shares of the company, or of control of an entity that held shares of that class of shares of the company, for which approval was given by the Minister.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;409&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;409&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Subsection (1) does not apply if the purchase or other acquisition of shares or the acquisition of control referred to in that subsection would</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;409&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>result in the acquisition of control of the company by the person referred to in that subsection;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;409&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>where the person controls the company but the voting rights attached to the aggregate of any voting shares of the company beneficially owned by the person and by entities controlled by the person do not exceed 50 per cent of the voting rights attached to all of the outstanding voting shares of the company, cause the voting rights attached to that aggregate to exceed 50 per cent of the voting rights attached to all of the outstanding voting shares of the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;409&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>result in the acquisition of a significant interest in a class of shares of the company by an entity controlled by the person and the acquisition of that investment is not exempted by the regulations; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;409&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>result in an increase in a significant interest in a class of shares of the company by an entity controlled by the person by a percentage that is greater than the percentage referred to in subsection (2) or (3), whichever is applicable, and the increase is not exempted by the regulations.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;409&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;409&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;409&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>exempting from the application of paragraph (4)(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>) the acquisition of a significant interest in a class of shares of the company by an entity controlled by the person; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;409&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>exempting from the application of paragraph (4)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>) an increase in a significant interest in a class of shares of the company by an entity controlled by the person by a percentage that is greater than the percentage referred to in subsection (2) or (3), whichever applies.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 409;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 244;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 404.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;410&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;410&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">When approval not required</MarginalNote><Label>410.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;410&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Despite subsections 407(1) and (2) and section 408, the approval of the Minister is not required if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;410&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the Superintendent has, by order, directed the company to increase its capital and shares of the company are issued and acquired in accordance with the terms and conditions, if any, that may be specified in the order; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;410&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a person who controls, within the meaning of paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>), the company acquires additional shares of the company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;410&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;410&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(1.1)</Label><Text>Paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) does not apply in respect of a converted company in respect of which subsection 407(4) or (11) applies or a company to which subsection 407(5) or (12) applies.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;410&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;410&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Pre-approval</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>For the purposes of subsections 407(1) and (2) and section 408, the Minister may approve</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;410&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the purchase or other acquisition of such number or percentage of shares of a company as may be required in a particular transaction or series of transactions; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;410&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the purchase or other acquisition of up to a specified number or percentage of shares of a company within a specified period.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 410;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 405.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;411&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;411&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Public holding requirement</MarginalNote><Label>411.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;411&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Every company shall, from and after the day determined under this section in respect of that company, have, and continue to have, voting shares that carry at least 35 per cent of the voting rights attached to all of the outstanding voting shares of the company and that are</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;411&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>shares of one or more classes of shares that are listed and posted for trading on a recognized stock exchange in Canada; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;411&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>shares none of which is beneficially owned by a person who is a major shareholder of the company in respect of the voting shares of the company or by any entity that is controlled by a person who is a major shareholder of the company in respect of such shares.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;411&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;411&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Determination of day</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If the company has equity of two billion dollars or more on the day it comes into existence, the day referred to in subsection (1) is the day that is three years after that day and, in the case of any other company, the day referred to in subsection (1) is the day that is three years after the day of the first annual meeting of the shareholders and policyholders of the company held after the equity of the company first reaches two billion dollars.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;411&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;411&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Extension</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>If general market conditions so warrant and the Minister is satisfied that a company has used its best efforts to be in compliance with this section on the day determined under subsection (2), the Minister may specify a later day as the day from and after which the company must comply with subsection (1).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 411;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 406;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 335.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;412&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;412&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limit on assets</MarginalNote><Label>412.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;412&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Unless an exemption order with respect to the company is granted under section 414, if a company fails to comply with section 411 in any month, the Minister may, by order, require the company not to have, until it complies with that section, average total assets in any three month period ending on the last day of a subsequent month exceeding the company’s average total assets in the three month period ending on the last day of the month immediately before the month specified in the order.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;412&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;412&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Average total assets</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>For the purposes of subsection (1), the average total assets of a company in a three month period shall be computed by adding the total assets of the company as calculated for the month end of each of the three months in the period and by dividing the sum by three.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 412;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 407.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;413&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;413&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Increase of capital</MarginalNote><Label>413.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;413&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where the Superintendent has, by order, directed a company to increase its capital and shares of the company are issued and acquired in accordance with such terms and conditions as may be specified in the order, section 411 shall not apply in respect of the company until such time as the Superintendent may, by order, specify.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;413&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><Label>(2)</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 1997, c. 15, s. 245]</Repealed></Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 413;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 245.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;414&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;414&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exemption by Minister</MarginalNote><Label>414.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;414&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>On application by a company and subject to any terms and conditions that the Minister considers appropriate, the Minister may by order exempt the company from the requirements of section 411 if the Minister considers it appropriate to do so.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;414&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;414&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Compliance with section 411</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The company shall comply with section 411 as of the day on which the exemption order expires.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;414&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;414&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limit on assets</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>If a company fails to comply with section 411 on the day referred to in subsection (2), it shall not, until it complies with that section, have average total assets in any three month period ending on the last day of a subsequent month exceeding its average total assets in the three month period ending on the last day of the month immediately preceding the day referred to in subsection (2) or on any later day that the Minister may specify by order.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;414&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;414&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application of s. 412(2)</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Subsection 412(2) applies for the purposes of subsection (3).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, ss. 414, 758;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 408;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 294.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;414.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;414.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Continuation of exemption</MarginalNote><Label>414.1</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;414.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Despite subsection 414(2), if an exemption order that was granted in respect of a company under subsection 414(3) as it read before the day on which this section comes into force provides that it expires if the holding body corporate ceases to comply with section 411, the company is not required to comply with that section until six months after the day on which the holding body corporate ceased to comply with that section if the failure to comply is as a result of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;414.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a distribution to the public of voting shares of the holding body corporate;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;414.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a redemption or purchase of voting shares of the holding body corporate;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;414.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the exercise of any option to acquire voting shares of the holding body corporate; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;414.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the conversion of any convertible securities into voting shares of the holding body corporate.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;414.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;414.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shares acquiring voting rights</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Despite subsection 414(2), if as a result of an event that has occurred and is continuing shares of a holding body corporate referred to in subsection (1) acquire voting rights in such number as to cause the holding body corporate to no longer be in compliance with section 411, the company is not required to comply with that section until six months after the day on which the holding body corporate ceased to comply with that section or any later day that the Minister may by order specify.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2005, c. 54, s. 294.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;415&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;415&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>415.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;415&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where a company fails to comply with section 411 as the result of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;415&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a distribution to the public of voting shares of the company,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;415&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a redemption or purchase of voting shares of the company,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;415&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the exercise of any option to acquire voting shares of the company, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;415&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the conversion of any convertible securities into voting shares of the company,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>section 412 shall not apply in respect of that company until the expiration of six months after the day the company failed to comply with section 411.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;415&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;415&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shares acquiring voting rights</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where, as the result of an event that has occurred and is continuing, shares of a company acquire voting rights in such number as to cause the company to no longer be in compliance with section 411, section 412 shall not apply in respect of that company until the expiration of six months after the day the company ceased to be in compliance with section 411 or such later day as the Minister may, by order, specify.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;415&quot;,ss=&quot;3)&quot;"><Label>(3) and (4)</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 2005, c. 54, s. 295]</Repealed></Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;415&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;415&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Mutualization</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>Where the Minister approves a proposal to convert a company into a mutual company under section 226, section 412 does not apply in respect of the company until the expiration of the period that the Minister may fix.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 415;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 295.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;416&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;416&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Acquisition of control permitted</MarginalNote><Label>416.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;416&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection (2) and sections 408 and 417, section 411 does not apply in respect of a company if a person acquires control of a company with equity of two billion dollars or more through the purchase or other acquisition of all or any number of the shares of the company by the person or by any entity controlled by the person.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;416&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;416&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Undertaking required</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Subsection (1) applies only if the person provides the Minister with an undertaking satisfactory to the Minister to do all things necessary so that, within three years after the acquisition, or any other period that the Minister may specify, the company has voting shares that carry at least 35 per cent of the voting rights attached to all of the outstanding voting shares of the company and that are</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;416&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>shares of one or more classes of shares that are listed and posted for trading on a recognized stock exchange in Canada; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;416&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>shares none of which is beneficially owned by a person who is a major shareholder of the company in respect of the voting shares of the company or by any entity that is controlled by a person who is a major shareholder of the company in respect of such shares.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 416;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 409;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 335.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;417&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;417&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application of section 411</MarginalNote><Label>417.</Label><Text>At the expiration of the period for compliance with an undertaking referred to in subsection 416(2), section 411 shall apply in respect of the company.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;418&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;418&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction on voting rights</MarginalNote><Label>418.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;418&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If, with respect to any company, a particular person contravenes subsection 407(1), (4), (9), (11) or (15) or section 407.03, 407.1 or 407.2 or fails to comply with an undertaking referred to in subsection 416(2) or with any term or condition imposed under section 421, no person, and no entity controlled by the particular person, shall, in person or by proxy, exercise any voting rights</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;418&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>that are attached to shares of the company beneficially owned by the particular person or any entity controlled by the particular person; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;418&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>that are subject to an agreement entered into by the particular person, or any entity controlled by the particular person, pertaining to the exercise of the voting rights.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;418&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;418&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Subsection (1) ceases to apply</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Subsection (1) ceases to apply in respect of a person when, as the case may be,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;418&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the shares to which the contravention relates have been disposed of;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;418&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the person ceases to control the company within the meaning of paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;418&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if the person failed to comply with an undertaking referred to in subsection 416(2), the company complies with section 411; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;418&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if the person failed to comply with a term or condition imposed under section 421, the person complies with the term or condition.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;418&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;418&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Saving</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Despite subsection (1), if a person contravenes subsection 407(4) by reason only that, as a result of an event that has occurred and is continuing and is not within the control of the person, shares of the converted company beneficially owned by the person or by any entity controlled by the person acquire voting rights in such number so as to cause the person to be a major shareholder of the converted company, the Minister may, after consideration of the circumstances, permit the person and any entity controlled by the person to exercise voting rights, in person or by proxy, in respect of any class of voting shares of the converted company beneficially owned by them that do not in aggregate exceed 20 per cent of the voting rights attached to that class of voting shares.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;418&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;418&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Saving</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Despite subsection (1), if a person contravenes subsection 407(9) by reason only that, as a result of an event that has occurred and is continuing and is not within the control of the person, shares of the company beneficially owned by the person or by any entity controlled by the person acquire voting rights in such number so as to cause the person to be a major shareholder of the company, the Minister may, after consideration of the circumstances, permit the person and any entity controlled by the person to exercise voting rights, in person or by proxy, in respect of any class of voting shares of the company beneficially owned by them that do not in aggregate exceed 20 per cent of the voting rights attached to that class of voting shares.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 418;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 246;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 410.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_II&quot;,gc=&quot;s_419&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_II&quot;,gc=&quot;s_419&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Approval Process</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;419&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;419&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application for approval</MarginalNote><Label>419.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;419&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>An application for an approval of the Minister required under this Part must be filed with the Superintendent and contain the information, material and evidence that the Superintendent may require.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;419&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;419&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Applicant</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If, with respect to any particular transaction, this Part applies to more than one person, any one of those persons may make the application to the Minister for approval on behalf of all of those persons.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 419;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 411.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;420&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;420&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Matters for consideration</MarginalNote><Label>420.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;420&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection (1.1), if an application for an approval under section 407 is made, the Minister, in determining whether or not to approve the transaction, shall take into account all matters that the Minister considers relevant to the application, including</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;420&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the nature and sufficiency of the financial resources of the applicant or applicants as a source of continuing financial support for the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;420&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the soundness and feasibility of the plans of the applicant or applicants for the future conduct and development of the business of the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;420&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the business record and experience of the applicant or applicants;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;420&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the character and integrity of the applicant or applicants or, if the applicant or any of the applicants is a body corporate, its reputation for being operated in a manner that is consistent with the standards of good character and integrity;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;420&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>whether the company will be operated responsibly by persons with the competence and experience suitable for involvement in the operation of a financial institution;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;420&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if the company is a converted company in respect of which the Minister has issued an order under subsection 407(8) or a converted company in respect of which subsection 407(11) applied at any time, or a company that controls, within the meaning of paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), such a converted company, the opinion of the Superintendent regarding the extent to which the corporate structure of the applicant or applicants and their affiliates may affect the supervision and regulation of the company, having regard to</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;420&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>the nature and extent of the proposed financial services activities to be carried out by the company and its affiliates, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;420&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>the nature and degree of supervision and regulation applying to the proposed financial services activities to be carried out by the affiliates of the company;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;420&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the impact of any integration of the businesses and operations of the applicant or applicants with those of the company on the conduct of those businesses and operations; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;420&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;h&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">h</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the best interests of the financial system in Canada.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;420&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;420&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(1.1)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection 407.2(1), the Minister shall take into account only paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>) if the application is in respect of a transaction that would result in the applicant or applicants holding</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;420&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>more than 10 per cent but no more than 20 per cent of any class of the outstanding voting shares of a converted company in respect of which subsection 407(4) applies or of a company to which subsection 407(5) applies; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;420&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>more than 10 per cent but no more than 30 per cent of any class of the outstanding non-voting shares of such a converted company or company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;420&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;420&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">National treatment</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where a transaction in respect of which subsection 407(1) or (2) applies would cause a company to become a subsidiary of a foreign institution that is engaged in the insurance business, that does not have any other company as its subsidiary and that is a non-WTO Member foreign institution, the Minister shall not approve the transaction unless the Minister is satisfied that treatment as favourable for companies to which this Act applies exists or will be provided in the jurisdiction in which the foreign institution principally carries on business, either directly or through a subsidiary.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;420&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;420&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Part XII of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="B-1.01">Bank Act</XRefExternal></MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Nothing in subsection (1) or (2) affects the operation of Part XII of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="B-1.01">Bank Act</XRefExternal>.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 420;</li><li> 1999, c. 28, s. 121;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 412.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;421&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;421&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Terms and conditions</MarginalNote><Label>421.</Label><Text>The Minister may impose any terms and conditions in respect of an approval given under this Part that the Minister considers necessary to ensure compliance with any provision of this Act.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 421;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 413.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;422&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;422&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Certifying receipt of application</MarginalNote><Label>422.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;422&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If, in the opinion of the Superintendent, an application filed under this Part contains all the required information, the Superintendent shall without delay refer the application to the Minister and send a receipt to the applicant certifying the date on which the completed application was received by the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;422&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;422&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Incomplete application</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If, in the opinion of the Superintendent, an application filed under this Part is incomplete, the Superintendent shall send a notice to the applicant specifying the information required by the Superintendent to complete the application.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 422;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 414.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;423&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;423&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of decision to applicant</MarginalNote><Label>423.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;423&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to subsections (2) and (3) and 424(1), the Minister shall, within a period of thirty days after the certified date referred to in subsection 422(1), send to the applicant</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;423&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a notice approving the transaction to which the application relates; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;423&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>where the Minister is not satisfied that the transaction to which the application relates should be approved, a notice to that effect, advising the applicant of the right to make representations to the Minister in respect of the matter.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;423&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;423&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Idem</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Subject to subsections (4) and 424(2), where an application filed under subsection 419(1) involves the acquisition of control of a company, the Minister shall, within a period of forty-five days after the certified date referred to in subsection 422(1), send to the applicant</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;423&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a notice approving the transaction to which the application relates; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;423&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>where the Minister is not satisfied that the transaction to which the application relates should be approved, a notice to that effect, advising the applicant of the right to make representations to the Minister in respect of the matter.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;423&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;423&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Extension of period for notice</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Where the Minister is unable to complete the consideration of an application within the period referred to in subsection (1), the Minister shall,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;423&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>within that period, send a notice to that effect to the applicant; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;423&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>within a further period of thirty days after the date of the sending of the notice referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) or within such other further period as may be agreed on by the applicant and the Minister, send a notice referred to in paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) to the applicant.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;423&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;423&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Idem</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Where the Minister considers it appropriate to do so, the Minister may extend the period referred to in subsection (2) for one or more periods of forty-five days.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;424&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;424&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Reasonable opportunity to make representations</MarginalNote><Label>424.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;424&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where, after receipt of the notice referred to in paragraph 423(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>), the applicant advises the Minister that the applicant wishes to make representations, the Minister shall provide the applicant with a reasonable opportunity within a period of thirty days after the date of the notice, or within such further period as may be agreed on by the applicant and the Minister, to make representations in respect of the matter.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;424&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;424&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Idem</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where, after receipt of the notice referred to in paragraph 423(2)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>), the applicant advises the Minister that the applicant wishes to make representations, the Minister shall provide the applicant with a reasonable opportunity within a period of forty-five days after the date of the notice, or within such further period as may be agreed on by the applicant and the Minister, to make representations in respect of the matter.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;425&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;425&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of decision</MarginalNote><Label>425.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;425&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Within a period of thirty days after the expiration of the period for making representations referred to in subsection 424(1), the Minister shall, in the light of any such representations and having regard to the matters to be taken into account, send a notice to the applicant indicating whether or not the Minister approves the share transaction to which the application relates.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;425&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;425&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Idem</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Within a period of forty-five days after the expiration of the period for making representations referred to in subsection 424(2), the Minister shall, in the light of any such representations and having regard to the matters to be taken into account, send a notice to the applicant indicating whether or not the Minister approves the share transaction to which the application relates.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;426&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;426&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Deemed approval</MarginalNote><Label>426.</Label><Text>Where the Minister does not send a notice under subsection 423(1) or (3) or 425(1) within the period provided for in those subsections, the Minister is deemed to have approved the share transaction to which the application relates.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;426.1&quot;"><Label>426.1</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 1994, c. 47, s. 124]</Repealed></Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;427&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;427&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Mutual company constraints</MarginalNote><Label>427.</Label><Text>Subject to such regulations as the Governor in Council may make for the purpose, a mutual company may by by-law impose, change or remove restrictions on the issue, transfer or ownership of shares of any class issued under section 63, in order to prevent a person from having a significant interest in that class.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 427;</li><li> 1994, c. 47, s. 124;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 77.1.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;428&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;428&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Constraining registration — Crown and foreign governments</MarginalNote><Label>428.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;428&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>No company shall record in its securities register a transfer or issue of any share of the company to</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;428&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>Her Majesty in right of Canada or of a province or any agent or agency of Her Majesty in either of those rights; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;428&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the government of a foreign country or any political subdivision thereof, or any agent or agency thereof.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;428&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;428&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Notwithstanding subsection (1), a company that is a subsidiary of a foreign institution that is controlled by the government of a foreign country or any political subdivision thereof, or any agency thereof, may register a transfer or issue of a share or shares of the company to the foreign institution or to any subsidiary of the foreign institution.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;429&quot;"><Label>429.</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 1994, c. 47, s. 125]</Repealed></Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;430&quot;"><Label>430.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;430&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 1994, c. 47, s. 126]</Repealed></Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;430&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;430&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Suspension of voting rights held by governments</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Notwithstanding section 152, where any voting shares of a company are beneficially owned by</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;430&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>Her Majesty in right of Canada or of a province or any agency of Her Majesty in either of those rights, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;430&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the government of a foreign country or any political subdivision thereof, or any agency thereof,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>no person shall, in person or by proxy, exercise the voting rights attached to those shares.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;430&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;430&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Transitional</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Subsection (2) does not apply in respect of a government or agency referred to in that subsection that, on September 27, 1990, beneficially owned shares of a former-Act company where the exercise of the voting rights attached to those shares was not prohibited under subsection 36(2) of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act">Canadian and British Insurance Companies Act</XRefExternal>, as that subsection read immediately prior to June 1, 1992.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;430&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;430&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Transitional</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Subsection (3) ceases to apply where a government or agency referred to in that subsection acquires beneficial ownership of any additional voting shares of the former-Act company in such number that the percentage of the voting rights attached to all of the voting shares of the former-Act company beneficially owned by the government or agency is greater than the percentage of the voting rights attached to all of the voting shares of the former-Act company that were beneficially owned by the government or agency on September 27, 1990.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 430;</li><li> 1994, c. 47, s. 126.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;431&quot;"><Label>431. and 431.1</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 1994, c. 47, s. 127]</Repealed></Text></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_III&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><Label>Division III</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_III&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Directions</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;432&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;432&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Disposition of shareholdings</MarginalNote><Label>432.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;432&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If, with respect to any company, a person contravenes subsection 407(1), (4), (9), (11) or (15) or section 407.03, 407.1 or 407.2 or fails to comply with an undertaking referred to in subsection 416(2) or with any term or condition imposed under section 421, the Minister may, if the Minister considers it in the public interest to do so, by order, direct that person and any person controlled by that person to dispose of any number of shares of the bank beneficially owned by any of those persons that the Minister specifies in the order, within the time specified in the order and in the proportion, if any, as between the person and the persons controlled by that person that is specified in the order.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;432&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;432&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Representations</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>No direction shall be made under subsection (1) unless the Minister has provided each person to whom the direction relates and the company concerned with a reasonable opportunity to make representations in respect of the subject-matter of the direction.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;432&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;432&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Appeal</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Any person with respect to whom a direction has been made under subsection (1) may, within thirty days after the date of the direction, appeal the matter in accordance with section 1020.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;432&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><Label>(4)</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 2001, c. 9, s. 415]</Repealed></Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 432;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 78;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 415.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;433&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;433&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application to court</MarginalNote><Label>433.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;433&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where a person fails to comply with a direction made under subsection 432(1), an application on behalf of the Minister may be made to a court for an order to enforce the direction.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;433&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;433&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Court order</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A court may, on an application under subsection (1), make such order as the circumstances require to give effect to the terms of the direction and may, without limiting the generality of the foregoing, require the company concerned to sell the shares that are the subject-matter of the direction.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;433&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;433&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Appeal</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>An appeal from an order of a court under this section lies in the same manner as, and to the same court to which, an appeal may be taken from any other order of the court.</Text></Subsection></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_III&quot;,gc=&quot;s_434&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_III&quot;,gc=&quot;s_434&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">General Provisions</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;434&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;434&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Interest of securities underwriter</MarginalNote><Label>434.</Label><Text>This Part does not apply to a securities underwriter in respect of shares of a body corporate or ownership interests in an unincorporated entity that are acquired by the underwriter in the course of a distribution to the public of those shares or ownership interests and that are held by the underwriter for a period of not more than six months.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;435&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;435&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Arrangements to effect compliance</MarginalNote><Label>435.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;435&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The directors of a company may make such arrangements as they deem necessary to carry out the intent of this Part and, in particular, but without limiting the generality of the foregoing, may</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;435&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>require any person in whose name a share of the company is held to submit a declaration setting out</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;435&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>the beneficial ownership of the share, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;435&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>such other information as the directors deem relevant for the purposes of this Part;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;435&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>require any person who wishes to have a transfer of a share registered in the name of, or to have a share issued to, that person to submit a declaration referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) as though the person were the holder of that share; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;435&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>determine the circumstances in which a declaration referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) is to be required, the form of the declaration and the times at which it is to be submitted.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;435&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;435&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Order of Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The Superintendent may, by order, direct a company to obtain from any person in whose name a share of the company is held a declaration setting out the name of every entity controlled by that person and containing information concerning</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;435&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the ownership or beneficial ownership of the share; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;435&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>such other related matters as are specified by the Superintendent.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;435&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;435&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Compliance required</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>As soon as possible after receipt by a company of a direction under subsection (2),</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;435&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the company shall comply with the direction; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;435&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>every person who is requested by the company to provide a declaration containing information referred to in subsection (1) or (2) shall comply with the request.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;435&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;435&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Outstanding declaration: effect</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Where, pursuant to this section, a declaration is required to be submitted by a shareholder or other person in respect of the issue or transfer of any share, a company may refuse to issue the share or register the transfer unless the required declaration is submitted.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;436&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;436&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Reliance on information</MarginalNote><Label>436.</Label><Text>A company and any person who is a director or an officer, employee or agent of the company may rely on any information contained in a declaration required by the directors pursuant to section 435 or on any information otherwise acquired in respect of any matter that might be the subject of such a declaration, and no action lies against the company or any such person for anything done or omitted to be done in good faith in reliance on any such information.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;437&quot;"><Label>437.</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 1994, c. 47, s. 128]</Repealed></Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;438&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;438&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exemption regulations</MarginalNote><Label>438.</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may, by regulation, exempt from any of the provisions of this Part any share transaction or any class of share transactions involving the transfer of shares on the death of the beneficial owner thereof, or any arrangement made in contemplation of the death of the beneficial owner, to one or more members of the beneficial owner’s family, or to one or more trustees on their behalf.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;439&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;439&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="C-34">Competition Act</XRefExternal></MarginalNote><Label>439.</Label><Text>Nothing in, or done under the authority of, this Act affects the operation of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="C-34">Competition Act</XRefExternal>.</Text></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VIII&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="1"><Label>PART VIII</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VIII&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">BUSINESS AND POWERS</TitleText></Heading><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_440&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_440&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">General</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;440&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;440&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Main business</MarginalNote><Label>440.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;440&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to this Act, a company shall not engage in or carry on any business other than such business generally as appertains to the business of providing financial services.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;440&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;440&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Idem</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>For greater certainty, a company may</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;440&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>act as a financial agent, receiver, liquidator or sequestrator;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;440&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>provide investment counselling services and portfolio management services; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;440&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>issue payment, credit or charge cards and, in cooperation with others including other financial institutions, operate a payment, credit or charge card plan.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 440;</li><li> 2009, c. 2, s. 282(F).</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;441&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Additional activities</MarginalNote><Label>441.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>In addition, a company may</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>act as an agent for vendors, purchasers, mortgagors, mortgagees, lessors or lessees of real property and provide consulting or appraisal services in respect of real property;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>hold, manage and otherwise deal with real property;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>provide information processing services in Canada that the company has developed for its own use and that are an integral part of the company’s operations to entities in which the company has a substantial investment that do not provide information processing services to other entities;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>outside Canada, or with the prior written approval of the Minister, in Canada, engage in any of the following activities, namely,</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>collecting, manipulating and transmitting</Text><Clause Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;,c1=&quot;A&quot;"><Label>(A)</Label><Text>information that is primarily financial or economic in nature,</Text></Clause><Clause Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;,c1=&quot;B&quot;"><Label>(B)</Label><Text>information that relates to the business of a permitted entity, as defined in subsection 490(1), or</Text></Clause><Clause Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;,c1=&quot;C&quot;"><Label>(C)</Label><Text>any other information that the Minister may, by order, specify,</Text></Clause></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>providing advisory or other services in the design, development or implementation of information management systems,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>designing, developing or marketing computer software, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;,p2=&quot;iv&quot;"><Label>(iv)</Label><Text>designing, developing, manufacturing or selling, as an ancillary activity to any activity referred to in any of subparagraphs (i) to (iii) that the company is engaging in, computer equipment integral to the provision of information services related to the business of financial institutions or to the provision of financial services;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d.1&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d.1</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>with the prior written approval of the Minister, develop, design, hold, manage, manufacture, sell or otherwise deal with data transmission systems, information sites, communication devices or information platforms or portals that are used</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d.1&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>to provide information that is primarily financial or economic in nature,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d.1&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>to provide information that relates to the business of a permitted entity, as defined in subsection 490(1), or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d.1&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>for a prescribed purpose or in prescribed circumstances;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>promote merchandise and services to the holders of any payment, credit or charge card issued by the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>engage in the sale of</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>tickets, including lottery tickets, on a non-profit public service basis in connection with special, temporary and infrequent non-commercial celebrations or projects that are of local, municipal, provincial or national interest,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>urban transit tickets, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>tickets in respect of a lottery sponsored by the federal government or a provincial or municipal government or an agency of any such government or governments;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>act as a custodian of property; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;h&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">h</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>with the consent of the Minister</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;h&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>provide safety and risk prevention services and services respecting risk management and claims adjustment, where the provision of those services is reasonably ancillary to the business of insurance carried on by the company,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;h&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>operate rehabilitation and training and development centres, where the operation of those centres is reasonably ancillary to the business of insurance carried on by the company,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;h&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>provide computer systems to independent insurance brokers and agents, where the provision of those systems is reasonably ancillary to the business of insurance carried on by the company,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;h&quot;,p2=&quot;iv&quot;"><Label>(iv)</Label><Text>provide support to independent insurance brokers and agents, where the provision of that support is reasonably ancillary to the business of insurance carried on by the company,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;h&quot;,p2=&quot;v&quot;"><Label>(v)</Label><Text>operate repair and appraisal centres, where the operation of those centres is reasonably ancillary to the business of insurance carried on by the company, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;h&quot;,p2=&quot;vi&quot;"><Label>(vi)</Label><Text>carry on any other activities that are reasonably ancillary to the business of insurance carried on by the company.</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Additional activities — life companies</MarginalNote><Label>(1.1)</Label><Text>A life company may engage, under prescribed terms and conditions, if any are prescribed, in specialized business management or advisory services.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Terms and conditions</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A consent given under paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">h</Emphasis>) is subject to the terms and conditions imposed by the Minister.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Except as authorized by or under this Act, a company shall not deal in goods, wares or merchandise or engage in any trade or other business.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting what a company may or may not do with respect to the carrying on of the activities referred to in any of paragraphs (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>) and (<Emphasis style="italic">d.1</Emphasis>) and subsection (1.1);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>imposing terms and conditions in respect of</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>the provision of services referred to in paragraphs (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) and 440(2)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>), and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>the carrying on of the activities referred to in any of paragraphs (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>) and (<Emphasis style="italic">d.1</Emphasis>) and subsection (1.1); and</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;441&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the circumstances in which companies may be exempted from the requirement to obtain the approval of the Minister before carrying on a particular activity referred to in paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">d.1</Emphasis>).</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 441;</li><li> 1993, c. 34, s. 80(F);</li><li> 1994, c. 26, s. 41(F);</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 247;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 416;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 217(E).</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;442&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;442&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Networking</MarginalNote><Label>442.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;442&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company may</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;442&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>act as agent for any person in respect of the provision of any service that is provided by a financial institution, a permitted entity as defined in subsection 490(1) or a prescribed entity;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;442&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>enter into an arrangement with any person in respect of the provision of that service; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;442&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>refer any person to any such financial institution or entity.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;442&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;442&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations respecting the disclosure of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;442&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the name of the principal for whom a company is acting as agent pursuant to subsection (1); and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;442&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>whether any commission is being earned by a company when acting as agent pursuant to subsection (1).</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 442;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 417.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_443&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_443&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Classes of Insurance</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;443&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;443&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction to specified classes of insurance</MarginalNote><Label>443.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;443&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company shall not insure a risk unless the risk falls within a class of insurance that is specified in the order of the Superintendent approving the commencement and carrying on of business by the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;443&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;443&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Continuation of certificate limitations</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A class of insurance specified in a certificate of registry, issued under Part III of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act">Canadian and British Insurance Companies Act</XRefExternal>, or in any other authorization, that had not expired or been withdrawn before the coming into force of this Part is deemed to be specified in an order of the Superintendent approving the commencement and carrying on of business by the company.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;444&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;444&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction to reinsurance</MarginalNote><Label>444.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;444&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company may reinsure, but shall not otherwise insure, a risk falling within a class of insurance specified in the order of the Superintendent approving the commencement and carrying on of business by the company if the order limits the company to the reinsurance of those risks.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;444&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;444&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Continuation of certificate conditions</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A condition that limits a company to the reinsurance of risks falling within a class of insurance and that is contained in a certificate of registry issued under Part III of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act">Canadian and British Insurance Companies Act</XRefExternal>, or in any other authorization, that had not expired or been withdrawn before the coming into force of this Part is deemed to be a limitation in an order of the Superintendent approving the commencement and carrying on of business by the company.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;445&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;445&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">No new composite companies</MarginalNote><Label>445.</Label><Text>The Superintendent may not make or vary an order approving the commencement and carrying on of business by a company if the company would as a result be permitted to insure both risks falling within the class of life insurance and risks falling within any other class of insurance other than accident and sickness insurance, credit protection insurance and other approved products insurance.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 445;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 248;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 218.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;446&quot;"><Label>446.</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 2007, c. 6, s. 218]</Repealed></Text><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;447&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;447&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Separate accounts</MarginalNote><Label>447.</Label><Text>A company that is authorized to insure risks falling within the class of life insurance and risks falling within one or more other classes of insurance shall maintain separate accounts in respect of each class of insurance within which it is authorized to insure risks.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 447;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 249.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;448&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;448&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Annuities and endowment insurance restricted to life companies</MarginalNote><Label>448.</Label><Text>Property and casualty companies and marine companies shall not issue annuities or policies of endowment insurance.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 448;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 219.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;449&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;449&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Compensation association</MarginalNote><Label>449.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;449&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Every company that is insuring risks that fall within a class of insurance shall become and remain a member of any compensation association designated by order of the Minister for that class of insurance.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;449&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;449&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Designation limitation</MarginalNote><Label>(1.1)</Label><Text>A compensation association shall not be designated under subsection (1) unless, in the opinion of the Minister, it has the authority to levy an assessment on each of its members.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;449&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;449&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exceptions</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Subsection (1) does not apply</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;449&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>to a company that may reinsure but may not otherwise insure risks;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;449&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in respect of a class of insurance that, in the opinion of the Minister, is adequately covered by some other compensation plan;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;449&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in respect of the insurance against the loss of, or damage to, property caused by fire, by lightning, by an explosion due to ignition, by smoke or by breakage of or leakage from a sprinkler, from other fire protection equipment or from another fire protection system by a company that is a member of the Fire Mutuals Guarantee Fund; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;449&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in respect of a class of insurance for which the Minister has not designated a compensation association.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 449;</li><li> 1994, c. 26, s. 42(E);</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 79;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 220.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_450&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_450&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Segregated Funds</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;450&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;450&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Segregated funds restricted to life companies</MarginalNote><Label>450.</Label><Text>A property and casualty company, or a marine company, shall not issue policies — or accept or retain, on the direction of a policyholder or beneficiary, policy dividends or bonuses, or policy proceeds that are payable on the surrender or maturity of the policy or on the death of the person whose life is insured — if the liabilities of the company in respect of the policies or the amounts accepted or retained vary in amount depending on the market value of a fund consisting of a specified group of assets.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 450;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 221.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;451&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;451&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Where segregated funds required</MarginalNote><Label>451.</Label><Text>A life company that issues policies described in section 450 or accepts or retains amounts so described shall, in respect of those policies or amounts,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;451&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>maintain separate accounts; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;451&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>establish and maintain one or more funds consisting of assets that are segregated from the other assets of the company and that are specified as the assets on the market value of which the liabilities of the company in respect of those policies or amounts depend.</Text></Paragraph></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;452&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;452&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Establishment and maintenance of segregated funds</MarginalNote><Label>452.</Label><Text>For the purpose of establishing or maintaining a segregated fund required to be established and maintained by section 451, a company may, subject to the regulations and, in the case of a transfer from a participating account maintained pursuant to section 456, to section 463, transfer an amount to the separate account maintained in respect of the segregated fund.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 452;</li><li> 1994, c. 26, s. 43.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;453&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;453&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Transfers from segregated funds</MarginalNote><Label>453.</Label><Text>A company may return the current value of an amount transferred under section 452 to the account from which the amount was transferred.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 453;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 222.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;454&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;454&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Claims against segregated funds</MarginalNote><Label>454.</Label><Text>A claim against a segregated fund maintained as required by section 451 under a policy or for an amount in respect of which the fund is maintained has priority over any other claim against the assets of that fund, including the claims referred to in section 161 of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="W-11">Winding-up and Restructuring Act</XRefExternal>, except to the extent that the payment of that other claim is secured by a security interest in or on a specific, identifiable asset of the segregated fund.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 454;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 167;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 250.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;455&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;455&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction of claims</MarginalNote><Label>455.</Label><Text>The liability of a company under a policy or for an amount in respect of which a segregated fund is maintained pursuant to section 451</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;455&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>does not, except to the extent that the assets of the fund are insufficient to satisfy a claim for any minimum amount that the company agrees to pay under the policy or in respect of the amount, give rise to a claim against any assets of the company, other than the assets of that fund,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>but</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;455&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>to the extent that the assets of the fund are insufficient to satisfy such a claim, gives rise to a claim against the assets of the company, other than the assets of that fund, that has the priority referred to in subsection 161(2) of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="W-11">Winding-up and Restructuring Act</XRefExternal>.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 455;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 167.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_456&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_456&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Participating Policies</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;456&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;456&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Participating account</MarginalNote><Label>456.</Label><Text>A company shall maintain accounts, in the form and manner determined by the Superintendent, in respect of participating policies, separately from those maintained in respect of other policies.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;457&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;457&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Allocation of income</MarginalNote><Label>457.</Label><Text>There shall be credited to, or debited from, a participating account maintained pursuant to section 456 that portion of the investment income or losses of the company for a financial year, including accrued capital gains or losses, whether or not realized, that is determined in accordance with a method that is</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;457&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the written opinion of the actuary of the company, fair and equitable to the participating policyholders;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;457&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>approved by resolution of the directors, after considering the written opinion of the actuary of the company; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;457&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>not disallowed by the Superintendent, on the ground that it is not fair and equitable to the participating policyholders, within sixty days after receiving the resolution.</Text></Paragraph></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;458&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;458&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Allocation of expenses</MarginalNote><Label>458.</Label><Text>There shall be debited from a participating account maintained pursuant to section 456 that portion of the expenses, including taxes, of the company for a financial year that is determined in accordance with a method that is</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;458&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the written opinion of the actuary of the company, fair and equitable to the participating policyholders;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;458&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>approved by resolution of the directors, after considering the written opinion of the actuary of the company; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;458&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>not disallowed by the Superintendent, on the ground that it is not fair and equitable to the participating policyholders, within sixty days after receiving the resolution.</Text></Paragraph></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;459&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;459&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Filing of allocation method</MarginalNote><Label>459.</Label><Text>A company the directors of which by resolution approve a method of allocating its investment income and losses and expenses to a participating account maintained pursuant to section 456 shall, within thirty days after making the resolution, file a copy of it with the Superintendent, together with a copy of the written opinion of the actuary of the company and any other information relevant to the allocation method that the Superintendent requests.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;460&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;460&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Review of allocation method</MarginalNote><Label>460.</Label><Text>The actuary of a company shall annually report in writing to the directors on the fairness and equitableness of the method used by the company for allocating its investment income and losses and expenses to a participating account maintained pursuant to section 456.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;461&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;461&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Payments to shareholders from participating account</MarginalNote><Label>461.</Label><Text>A company that has share capital may, from a participating account maintained pursuant to section 456, in a financial year and at any time within six months after the end of that financial year, make a payment to its shareholders, or transfer an amount to an account (other than a participating shareholder account as defined in section 83.01) from which a payment can be made to its shareholders, if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;461&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the aggregate of the amounts so paid or transferred in that financial year does not exceed the percentage of the portion of the profits of the participating account that is determined by the directors as the portion to be distributed for that financial year to the shareholders and participating policyholders, which percentage shall not exceed the number, expressed as a percentage, that is the aggregate of</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;461&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>10 multiplied by the lesser of</Text><Clause Code="se=&quot;461&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;,c1=&quot;A&quot;"><Label>(A)</Label><Text>the sum of the opening balances for that financial year of all participating accounts of the company, and</Text></Clause><Clause Code="se=&quot;461&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;,c1=&quot;B&quot;"><Label>(B)</Label><Text>two hundred and fifty million dollars,</Text></Clause></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;461&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>7.5 multiplied by the amount, if any, by which the lesser of</Text><Clause Code="se=&quot;461&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;,c1=&quot;A&quot;"><Label>(A)</Label><Text>the sum of the opening balances for that financial year of all participating accounts of the company, and</Text></Clause><Clause Code="se=&quot;461&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;,c1=&quot;B&quot;"><Label>(B)</Label><Text>five hundred million dollars</Text></Clause><ContinuedSubparagraph><Text>exceeds two hundred and fifty million dollars,</Text></ContinuedSubparagraph></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;461&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>5 multiplied by the amount, if any, by which the lesser of</Text><Clause Code="se=&quot;461&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;,c1=&quot;A&quot;"><Label>(A)</Label><Text>the sum of the opening balances for that financial year of all participating accounts of the company, and</Text></Clause><Clause Code="se=&quot;461&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;,c1=&quot;B&quot;"><Label>(B)</Label><Text>one billion dollars</Text></Clause><ContinuedSubparagraph><Text>exceeds five hundred million dollars, and</Text></ContinuedSubparagraph></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;461&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;iv&quot;"><Label>(iv)</Label><Text>2.5 multiplied by the amount, if any, by which the sum of the opening balances for that financial year of all participating accounts of the company exceeds one billion dollars,</Text></Subparagraph><ContinuedParagraph><Text>divided by the sum of the opening balances for that financial year of all the participating accounts;</Text></ContinuedParagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;461&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the company pays dividends or bonuses to its participating policyholders out of the profits of the participating account for that financial year in accordance with its dividend or bonus policy established pursuant to paragraph 165(2)(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>); and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;461&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the payment to the shareholders, or the transfer to the account from which a payment can be made to the shareholders, would not, in the opinion of the actuary of the company, materially affect the company’s ability to continue to comply with its dividend or bonus policy or to maintain the levels or rates of dividends or bonuses paid to the company’s participating policyholders.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 461;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 251;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 223.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;462&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;462&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Transfers from participating account</MarginalNote><Label>462.</Label><Text>The only transfers that may be made from a participating account maintained pursuant to section 456 are</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;462&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>transfers made pursuant to sections 461 and 463;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;462&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>transfers made in respect of transfers or reinsurance of all or any portion of the participating policies in respect of which the participating account is maintained;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;462&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>transfers, with the approval of the Superintendent, of amounts that can be reasonably attributed to sources not related to the participating policies in respect of which the account is or has been maintained, if the transfer would not, in the opinion of the actuary of the company, materially affect the company’s ability to continue to comply with its dividend or bonus policy, maintain the levels or rates of dividends or bonuses paid to the company’s participating policyholders or meet the company’s obligations under its participating policies; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;462&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>transfers made in respect of the conversion of a mutual company into a company with common shares.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 462;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 252;</li><li> 1999, c. 1, s. 8;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 224.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;463&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;463&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Transfers to segregated funds from participating account</MarginalNote><Label>463.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;463&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company may transfer from a participating account maintained pursuant to section 456 to a segregated fund maintained pursuant to section 451 an amount not exceeding the amount determined in accordance with the formula</Text><FormulaGroup><Formula><FormulaText>A - (B - C)</FormulaText></Formula><FormulaConnector>where</FormulaConnector><FormulaDefinition><FormulaTerm>A</FormulaTerm><Text>is 25 per cent of the unappropriated earned surplus of that account;</Text></FormulaDefinition><FormulaDefinition><FormulaTerm>B</FormulaTerm><Text>is the aggregate amount of all previous transfers from that account to the segregated funds; and</Text></FormulaDefinition><FormulaDefinition><FormulaTerm>C</FormulaTerm><Text>is the aggregate amount returned to the participating account from the segregated funds.</Text></FormulaDefinition></FormulaGroup></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;463&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;463&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Ceiling</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The aggregate amount of all transfers from participating accounts maintained pursuant to section 456 to the segregated funds maintained pursuant to section 451 may not exceed the amount determined in accordance with the formula</Text><FormulaGroup><Formula><FormulaText>A - (B - C)</FormulaText></Formula><FormulaConnector>where</FormulaConnector><FormulaDefinition><FormulaTerm>A</FormulaTerm><Text>is 10 per cent of the aggregate unappropriated earned surplus of the participating accounts;</Text></FormulaDefinition><FormulaDefinition><FormulaTerm>B</FormulaTerm><Text>is the aggregate amount of all previous transfers from those accounts to those funds; and</Text></FormulaDefinition><FormulaDefinition><FormulaTerm>C</FormulaTerm><Text>is the aggregate amount returned to those accounts from those funds.</Text></FormulaDefinition></FormulaGroup></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;464&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;464&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Declaration of policy dividend or bonus</MarginalNote><Label>464.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;464&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to this section, the directors of a company that issues participating policies may declare, and the company may pay or otherwise satisfy, a dividend, bonus or other benefit on those policies in accordance with its dividend or bonus policy established pursuant to paragraph 165(2)(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;464&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;464&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Report of actuary</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The company’s actuary shall, in writing, report to the directors on the fairness to participating policyholders of a proposed dividend, bonus or other benefit and whether it is in accordance with the policy. The directors shall consider the actuary’s report before declaring the dividend, bonus or other benefit.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;464&quot;,ss=&quot;2.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;464&quot;,ss=&quot;2.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Generally accepted actuarial practice</MarginalNote><Label>(2.1)</Label><Text>The report of the actuary referred to in subsection (2) shall be prepared in accordance with generally accepted actuarial practice with such changes as may be determined by the Superintendent and any additional directions that may be made by the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;464&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;464&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">When dividend not to be declared</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The directors of a company shall not declare a dividend, bonus or other benefit to participating policyholders if there are reasonable grounds for believing that the company is, or the payment or other satisfaction would cause the company to be, in contravention of subsection 515(1), any regulation made under subsection 515(2) or any order made under subsection 515(3).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 464;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 296;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 225.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20070420">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_464.1&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_464.1&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Adjustable Policies</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;464.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;464.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Report of actuary</MarginalNote><Label>464.1</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;464.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The actuary of a company that has adjustable policyholders shall, annually and in writing, report to the directors on whether the changes that the company made in respect of its adjustable policies during the preceding 12 months are in accordance with the criteria established under paragraph 165(2)(<Emphasis style="italic">e.2</Emphasis>) and are fair to the adjustable policyholders.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;464.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;464.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Generally accepted actuarial practice</MarginalNote><Label>(1.1)</Label><Text>The report of the actuary referred to in subsection (1) shall be prepared in accordance with generally accepted actuarial practice with such changes as may be determined by the Superintendent and any additional directions that may be made by the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;464.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;464.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Information to policyholder</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A company that made changes in respect of its adjustable policies during the preceding 12 months shall within the prescribed period send the prescribed information to the policyholder.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;464.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;464.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Information to policyholder — renewal</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>In the case of the renewal of an adjustable policy, the company shall within the prescribed period send the prescribed information to the policyholder.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2005, c. 54, s. 297.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_465&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_465&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Reinsurance</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;465&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;465&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations</MarginalNote><Label>465.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;465&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations limiting the extent to which a company may cause itself to be reinsured against risks undertaken under its policies.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;465&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;465&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulation may provide for discretion</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A regulation made pursuant to subsection (1) may provide that the Superintendent may, by order, determine the matters or exercise the discretion that the regulation may specify.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 465;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 226.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_466&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_466&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Restrictions</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;466&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;466&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction on fiduciary activities</MarginalNote><Label>466.</Label><Text>No company shall act in Canada as</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;466&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an executor, administrator or official guardian or a guardian, tutor, curator, judicial adviser or committee of a mentally incompetent person; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;466&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a trustee for a trust.</Text></Paragraph></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;467&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;467&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction on deposit taking</MarginalNote><Label>467.</Label><Text>Except as otherwise permitted by this Act, a company shall not accept deposits.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 467;</li><li> 1999, c. 31, s. 143(F).</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;468&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;468&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction on securities activities</MarginalNote><Label>468.</Label><Text>A company shall not deal in Canada in securities to the extent prohibited or restricted by such regulations as the Governor in Council may make for the purposes of this section.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;469&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;469&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction on residential mortgages</MarginalNote><Label>469.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;469&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company shall not make a loan in Canada on the security of residential property in Canada for the purpose of purchasing, renovating or improving that property, or refinance such a loan, if the amount of the loan, together with the amount then outstanding of any mortgage having an equal or prior claim against the property, would exceed 80 per cent of the value of the property at the time of the loan.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;469&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;469&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Subsection (1) does not apply in respect of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;469&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a loan made or guaranteed under the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="N-11">National Housing Act</XRefExternal> or any other Act of Parliament by or pursuant to which a different limit on the value of property on the security of which the company may make a loan is established;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;469&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a loan if repayment of the amount of the loan that exceeds the maximum amount set out in subsection (1) is guaranteed or insured by a government agency or a private insurer approved by the Superintendent;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;469&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the acquisition by the company from an entity of securities issued or guaranteed by the entity that are secured on any residential property, whether in favour of a trustee or otherwise, or the making of a loan by the company to the entity against the issue of such securities; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;469&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a loan secured by a mortgage where</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;469&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>the mortgage is taken back by the company on a property disposed of by the company, including where the disposition is by way of a realization of a security interest, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;469&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>the mortgage secures payment of an amount payable to the company for the property.</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 469;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 253;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 227.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;469.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;469.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction on charges to borrowers</MarginalNote><Label>469.1</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;469.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to any regulations made under subsection (2), a company that has obtained insurance or a guarantee against default on a loan made in Canada on the security of residential property shall not charge a borrower an amount for the insurance or guarantee that exceeds the actual cost to the company of the insurance or guarantee.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;469.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;469.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;469.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the determination of the actual cost to a company for the purposes of subsection (1);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;469.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the circumstances in which a company is exempt from the application of subsection (1);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;469.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting, in relation to insurance or a guarantee against default on a loan made by a company in Canada on the security of residential property,</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;469.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>the arrangements into which the company, its representatives and its employees may or may not enter, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;469.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>the payments or benefits that the company, its representatives and its employees may or may not accept from an insurer or the insurer’s affiliates; and</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;469.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting any other matters necessary to carry out the purposes of subsection (1).</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;469.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;469.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations — disclosure</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations respecting the disclosure by a company of information relating to insurance or a guarantee against default on a loan made by the company in Canada on the security of residential property, including regulations respecting</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;469.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the information that must be disclosed, including information relating to</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;469.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>the person who benefits from the insurance or guarantee,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;469.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>the arrangements between the company, its representatives or its employees and the insurer or the insurer’s affiliates, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;469.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>the payments and benefits that the company, its representatives and its employees accept from an insurer or the insurer’s affiliates;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;469.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the time, place and manner in which and the persons to whom information is to be disclosed; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;469.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the circumstances under which a company is not required to disclose information.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2009, c. 2, s. 283.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;470&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;470&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Policies re security interests</MarginalNote><Label>470.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;470&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The directors of a company shall establish and the company shall adhere to policies regarding the creation of security interests in property of the company to secure obligations of the company and the acquisition by the company of beneficial interests in property that is subject to security interests.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;470&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;470&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Order to amend policies</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The Superintendent may, by order, direct a company to amend its policies as specified in the order.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;470&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;470&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Compliance</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A company shall comply with an order made under subsection (2) within the time specified in the order.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 470;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 418.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;470.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;470.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations and guidelines</MarginalNote><Label>470.1</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations and the Superintendent may make guidelines respecting the creation by a company of security interests in its property to secure obligations of the company and the acquisition by the company of beneficial interests in property that is subject to security interests.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 418.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;470.2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;470.2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>470.2</Label><Text>Sections 470 and 470.1 do not apply in respect of a security interest created by a company to secure an obligation of the company to the Bank of Canada.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 418.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;471&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;471&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction on receivers</MarginalNote><Label>471.</Label><Text>A company shall not grant to a person the right to appoint a receiver or a receiver and manager of the property or business of the company.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;472&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;472&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction on partnerships</MarginalNote><Label>472.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;472&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Except with the approval of the Superintendent, a company may not be a general partner in a limited partnership or a partner in a general partnership.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;472&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;472&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Meaning of <DefinedTermEn>general partnership</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>For the purposes of subsection (1), <DefinedTermEn>general partnership</DefinedTermEn> means any partnership other than a limited partnership.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 472;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 419.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_473&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_473&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Restrictions Specific to Life Companies</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;473&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;473&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">General restriction</MarginalNote><Label>473.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;473&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A life company shall not, and shall not permit its prescribed subsidiaries to, enter into any debt obligation, within the meaning assigned to that expression by the regulations, or issue any share, other than a common share, if as a result the aggregate of the total debt obligations of the company, determined in the prescribed manner, and the stated capital of the company would exceed the prescribed percentage of the total assets of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;473&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;473&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A life company need not include in the aggregate amount calculated for the purposes of subsection (1) the value of any debt obligation or the stated capital of any shares if the value of the debt obligation or the stated capital of the shares is included as part of the regulatory capital of the company.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;474&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;474&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction on guarantees</MarginalNote><Label>474.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;474&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A life company shall not guarantee on behalf of any person the payment or repayment of any sum of money unless</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;474&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the sum of money is a fixed sum of money with or without interest thereon; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;474&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the person on whose behalf the company has undertaken to guarantee the payment or repayment has an unqualified obligation to reimburse the company for the full amount of the payment or repayment to be guaranteed.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;474&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;474&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) does not apply where the person on whose behalf the company has undertaken to guarantee a payment or repayment is a subsidiary of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;474&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><Label>(3)</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 1997, c. 15, s. 254]</Repealed></Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;474&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;474&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations imposing terms and conditions in respect of guarantees permitted by this section.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 474;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 254;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 420.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;475&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;475&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction on leasing</MarginalNote><Label>475.</Label><Text>A life company shall not engage in Canada in any personal property leasing activity in which a financial leasing entity, within the meaning of subsection 490(1), is not permitted to engage.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 475;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 421.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_476&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_476&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Restrictions Specific to Property and Casualty Companies and Marine Companies</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;476&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;476&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">General restriction</MarginalNote><Label>476.</Label><Text>A property and casualty company, or a marine company, shall not, and shall not permit its prescribed subsidiaries to, enter into any debt obligation, within the meaning assigned to that expression by the regulations, or issue any share, other than a common share, if as a result the aggregate of the total debt obligations of the company, determined in the prescribed manner, and the stated capital of the company would exceed the prescribed percentage of the total assets of the company.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 476;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 228.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;477&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;477&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction on guarantees</MarginalNote><Label>477.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;477&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A property and casualty company, or a marine company, shall not guarantee on behalf of any person the payment or repayment of any sum of money unless the person on whose behalf the company has undertaken to guarantee the payment or repayment is a subsidiary of the company and has an unqualified obligation to reimburse the company for the full amount of the payment or repayment to be guaranteed.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;477&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;477&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Saving</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Subsection (1) does not prevent a property and casualty company, or a marine company, from insuring a risk falling within a class of insurance that is specified in the order of the Superintendent approving the commencement and carrying on of business by the company.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 477;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 255;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 422;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 228.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;478&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;478&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction on leasing</MarginalNote><Label>478.</Label><Text>A property and casualty company, or a marine company, shall not engage in Canada in any financial leasing of personal property.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 478;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 228.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_479&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_479&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Borrowing Costs</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;479&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;479&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Definition of <DefinedTermEn>cost of borrowing</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><Label>479.</Label><Text>For the purposes of this section and sections 479.1 to 487, <DefinedTermEn>cost of borrowing</DefinedTermEn> means, in respect of a loan or an advance on the security or against the cash surrender value of a policy made by a company,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;479&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the interest or discount applicable to the loan or advance;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;479&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any amount charged in connection with the loan or advance that is payable by the borrower to the company; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;479&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any charge prescribed to be included in the cost of borrowing.</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>For those purposes, however, <DefinedTermEn>cost of borrowing</DefinedTermEn> does not include any charge prescribed to be excluded from the cost of borrowing.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 479;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 256;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 423.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;479.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;479.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Rebate of borrowing costs</MarginalNote><Label>479.1</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;479.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where a company makes a loan in respect of which the disclosure requirements of section 480 apply and the loan is not secured by a mortgage on real property and is required to be repaid either on a fixed future date or by instalments, the company shall, if there is a prepayment of the loan, rebate to the borrower a portion of the charges included in the cost of borrowing in respect of the loan.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;479.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;479.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The charges to be rebated do not include the interest or discount applicable to the loan.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;479.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;479.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations governing the rebate of charges under subsection (1). The rebate shall be made in accordance with those regulations.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 256.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;480&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;480&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Disclosing borrowing costs — loans</MarginalNote><Label>480.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;480&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company shall not make a loan to a natural person that is repayable in Canada unless the cost of borrowing, as calculated and expressed in accordance with section 481, and other prescribed information have, in the prescribed manner and at the prescribed time, been disclosed by the company to the borrower.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;480&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;480&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Non-application</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Subsection (1) does not apply in respect of a loan that is of a prescribed class of loans.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 480;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 256.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;481&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;481&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Calculating borrowing costs</MarginalNote><Label>481.</Label><Text>The cost of borrowing shall be calculated, in the prescribed manner, on the basis that all obligations of the borrower are duly fulfilled and shall be expressed as a rate per annum and, in prescribed circumstances, as an amount in dollars and cents.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;482&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;482&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Additional disclosure</MarginalNote><Label>482.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;482&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where a company makes a loan in respect of which the disclosure requirements of section 480 are applicable and the loan is required to be repaid either on a fixed future date or by instalments, the company shall disclose to the borrower, in accordance with the regulations,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;482&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>whether the borrower has the right to repay the amount borrowed before the maturity of the loan and, if applicable,</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;482&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>any terms and conditions relating to that right, including the particulars of the circumstances in which the borrower may exercise that right, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;482&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>whether, in the event that the borrower exercises the right, any portion of the cost of borrowing is to be rebated, the manner in which any such rebate is to be calculated or, if a charge or penalty will be imposed on the borrower, the manner in which the charge or penalty is to be calculated;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;482&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the event that an amount borrowed is not repaid at maturity or, if applicable, an instalment is not paid on the day the instalment is due to be paid, particulars of the charges or penalties to be paid by the borrower because of the failure to repay or pay in accordance with the contract governing the loan;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;482&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>at such time and in such manner as may be prescribed, any changes respecting the cost of borrowing or the loan agreement as may be prescribed;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;482&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>particulars of any other rights and obligations of the borrower; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;482&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any other prescribed information, at such time and in such form and manner as may be prescribed.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;482&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;482&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Disclosure in credit card applications</MarginalNote><Label>(1.1)</Label><Text>A company shall, in accordance with the regulations, at such time and in such manner as may be prescribed, provide prescribed information in any application forms or related documents that it prepares for the issuance of credit, payment or charge cards and provide prescribed information to any person applying to it for a credit, payment or charge card.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;482&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;482&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Disclosure re credit cards</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where a company issues or has issued a credit, payment or charge card to a natural person, the company shall, in addition to disclosing the costs of borrowing in respect of any loan obtained through the use of the card, disclose to the person, in accordance with the regulations,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;482&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any charges or penalties described in paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;482&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>particulars of the person’s rights and obligations;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;482&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any charges for which the person becomes responsible by accepting or using the card;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;482&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>at such time and in such manner as may be prescribed, such changes respecting the cost of borrowing or the loan agreement as may be prescribed; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;482&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any other prescribed information, at such time and in such form and manner as may be prescribed.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;482&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;482&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Additional disclosure re other loans</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Where a company enters into or has entered into an arrangement, including a line of credit, for the making of a loan in respect of which the disclosure requirements of section 480 apply and the loan is not a loan in respect of which subsection (1) or (2) applies, the company shall, in addition to disclosing the costs of borrowing, disclose to the person to whom the loan is made, in accordance with the regulations,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;482&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any charges or penalties described in paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;482&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>particulars of the person’s rights and obligations;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;482&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any charges for which the person is responsible under the arrangement;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;482&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>at such time and in such manner as may be prescribed, such changes respecting the cost of borrowing under the arrangement as may be prescribed; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;482&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any other prescribed information, at such time and in such form and manner as may be prescribed.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 482;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 257.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;482.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;482.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Renewal statement</MarginalNote><Label>482.1</Label><Text>Where a company makes a loan in respect of which the disclosure requirements of section 480 apply and the loan is secured by a mortgage on real property, the company shall disclose to the borrower, at such time and in such manner as may be prescribed, such information as may be prescribed respecting the renewal of the loan.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 258.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;483&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;483&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Disclosure in advertising</MarginalNote><Label>483.</Label><Text>No person shall authorize the publication, issue or appearance of any advertisement in Canada relating to arrangements referred to in subsection 482(3), loans, credit cards, payment cards or charge cards, offered to natural persons by a company, and purporting to disclose prescribed information about the cost of borrowing or about any other matter unless the advertisement contains such information as may be required by the regulations, in such form and manner as may be prescribed.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 483;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 258.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;484&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;484&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Disclosing borrowing costs — advances</MarginalNote><Label>484.</Label><Text>If regulations have been made respecting the manner in which the cost of borrowing is to be disclosed in respect of an advance on the security or against the cash surrender value of a policy, a company shall not make such an advance unless the cost of borrowing, as calculated and expressed in accordance with the regulations, has, in the prescribed manner, been disclosed by the company or otherwise as prescribed to the policyholder at or before the time when the advance is made.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 484;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 229(E).</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;485&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;485&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations re borrowing costs</MarginalNote><Label>485.</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;485&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the manner in which, and the time at which, a company is to disclose to a borrower</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;485&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>the cost of borrowing,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;485&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>any rebate of the cost of borrowing, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;485&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>any other information relating to a loan, arrangement, credit card, payment card or charge card referred to in section 482;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;485&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the contents of any statement disclosing the cost of borrowing and other information required to be disclosed by a company to a borrower;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;485&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the manner of calculating the cost of borrowing;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;485&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the circumstances under which the cost of borrowing is to be expressed as an amount in dollars and cents;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;485&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>specifying any class of loans that are not to be subject to section 479.1 or subsection 480(1) or 482(1) or (3) or section 482.1 or 483 or the regulations or any specified provisions of the regulations;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;485&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>specifying any class of advances that are not to be subject to section 484 or the regulations or any specified provisions of the regulations;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;485&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the manner in which and the time at which any rights, obligations, charges or penalties referred to in sections 479.1 to 484 are to be disclosed;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;485&quot;,p1=&quot;h&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">h</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>prohibiting the imposition of any charge or penalty referred to in section 482 or providing that the charge or penalty, if imposed, will not exceed a prescribed amount;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;485&quot;,p1=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">i</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the nature or amount of any charge or penalty referred to in paragraph 482(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>), (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) or (3)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) and the costs of the company that may be included or excluded in the determination of the charge or penalty;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;485&quot;,p1=&quot;j&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">j</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the method of calculating the amount of rebate of the cost of borrowing, or the portion of the cost of borrowing referred to in subparagraph 482(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)(ii);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;485&quot;,p1=&quot;k&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">k</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting advertisements made by a company regarding arrangements referred to in subsection 482(3), loans, credit cards, payment cards or charge cards;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;485&quot;,p1=&quot;l&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">l</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the renewal of loans; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;485&quot;,p1=&quot;m&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">m</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting such other matters or things as are necessary to carry out the purposes of sections 479.1 to 484.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 485;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 259.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_486&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_486&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Complaints</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;486&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;486&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Procedures for dealing with complaints</MarginalNote><Label>486.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;486&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company shall</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;486&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>establish procedures for dealing with complaints made by persons having requested or received products or services in Canada from the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;486&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>designate an officer or employee of the company to be responsible for implementing those procedures; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;486&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>designate one or more officers or employees of the company to receive and deal with those complaints.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;486&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;486&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Procedures to be filed with Commissioner</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A company shall file with the Commissioner a copy of its procedures established under paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;486&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;486&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">How procedures to be made available</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A company shall make its procedures established under paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) available</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;486&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>on its websites through which products or services are offered in Canada; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;486&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in written format to be sent to any person who requests them.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;486&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;486&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Information on contacting Agency</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>A company shall also make prescribed information on how to contact the Agency available whenever it makes its procedures established under paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) available under subsection (3).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 486;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 260;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 424;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 230.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;486.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;486.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Obligation to be member of complaints body</MarginalNote><Label>486.1</Label><Text>In any province, if there is no law of the province that makes a company subject to the jurisdiction of an organization that deals with complaints made by persons having requested or received products or services in the province from a company, the company shall be a member of an organization that is not controlled by it and that deals with those complaints that have not been resolved to the satisfaction of the persons under procedures established by companies under paragraph 486(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>).</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 424.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;487&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;487&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Information on contacting Agency</MarginalNote><Label>487.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;487&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company shall, in the prescribed manner, provide a person requesting or receiving a product or service from it with prescribed information on how to contact the Agency if the person has a complaint about an arrangement referred to in subsection 482(3), a payment, credit or charge card, the disclosure of or manner of calculating the cost of borrowing in respect of a loan or an advance on the security or against the cash surrender value of a policy, or about any other obligation of the company under a consumer provision.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;487&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;487&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Report</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The Commissioner shall prepare a report, to be included in the report referred to in section 34 of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="F-11.1">Financial Consumer Agency of Canada Act</XRefExternal>, respecting</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;487&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>procedures for dealing with complaints established by companies pursuant to paragraph 486(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>); and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;487&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the number and nature of complaints that have been brought to the attention of the Agency by persons who have requested or received a product or service from a company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 487;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 261;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 424.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_VIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_488&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_VIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_488&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Miscellaneous</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;488&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;488&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Prepayment protected</MarginalNote><Label>488.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;488&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company shall not make a loan to a natural person that is repayable in Canada, the terms of which prohibit prepayment of the money advanced or any instalment thereon before its due date.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;488&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;488&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Non-application of subsection (1)</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Subsection (1) does not apply in respect of a loan</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;488&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>that is secured by a mortgage on real property; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;488&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>that is made for business purposes and the principal amount of which is more than $100,000 or such other amount as may be prescribed.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 488;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 262.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;488.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;488.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations — activities</MarginalNote><Label>488.1</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations respecting any matters involving a company’s dealings, or its employees’ or representatives’ dealings, with customers or the public, including</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;488.1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>what a company may or may not do in carrying out any of the activities in which it is permitted to engage, or in providing any of the services that it may provide, under section 440 and any ancillary, related or incidental activities or services; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;488.1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the time, place and manner in which any of those activities are to be carried out or any of those services are to be provided.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2009, c. 2, s. 284.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;489&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;489&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations re customer information</MarginalNote><Label>489.</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;489&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>requiring a company or society to establish procedures regarding the collection, retention, use and disclosure of any information about its customers or members or any class of customers or members;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;489&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>requiring a company or society to establish procedures for dealing with complaints made by a customer or member about the collection, retention, use or disclosure of information about the customer or member;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;489&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the disclosure by a company or society of information relating to the procedures referred to in paragraphs (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) and (<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;489&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>requiring a company or society to designate its officers and employees who are responsible for</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;489&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>implementing the procedures referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>), and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;489&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>receiving and dealing with complaints made by a customer or member of the company or society about the collection, retention, use or disclosure of information about the customer or member;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;489&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>requiring a company or society to report information relating to</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;489&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>complaints made by customers or members of the company or society about the collection, retention, use or disclosure of information, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;489&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>the actions taken by the company or society to deal with the complaints; and</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;489&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>defining “information”, “collection” and “retention” for the purposes of paragraphs (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>) and the regulations made under those paragraphs.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 489;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 80;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 263.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;489.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;489.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Public accountability statements</MarginalNote><Label>489.1</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;489.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company with equity of $1 billion or more shall, in accordance with regulations made under subsection (4), annually publish a statement describing the contribution of the company and its prescribed affiliates to the Canadian economy and society.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;489.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;489.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Filing</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A company shall, in the manner and at the time prescribed, file a copy of the statement with the Commissioner.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;489.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;489.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Provision of statement to public</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A company shall, in the manner and at the time prescribed, disclose the statement to its customers and to the public.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;489.1&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;489.1&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations prescribing</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;489.1&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the name, contents and form of a statement referred to in subsection (1) and the time in which it must be prepared;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;489.1&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>affiliates of a company referred to in subsection (1);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;489.1&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the manner and time in which a statement must be filed under subsection (2); and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;489.1&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the manner and time in which a statement mentioned in subsection (3) is to be disclosed, respectively, to a company’s customers and to the public.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 425.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;489.2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;489.2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations re disclosure</MarginalNote><Label>489.2</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may, subject to any other provisions of this Act relating to the disclosure of information, make regulations respecting the disclosure of information by companies or any prescribed class of companies, including regulations respecting</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;489.2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the information that must be disclosed, including information relating to</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;489.2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>any product or service or prescribed class of products or services offered by them,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;489.2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>any of their policies, procedures or practices relating to the offer by them of any product or service or prescribed class of products or services,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;489.2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>anything they are required to do or to refrain from doing under a consumer provision, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;489.2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;iv&quot;"><Label>(iv)</Label><Text>any other matter that may affect their dealings, or their employees’ or representatives’ dealings, with customers or the public;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;489.2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the manner, place and time in which, and the persons to whom information is to be disclosed; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;489.2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the content and form of any advertisement by companies or any prescribed class of companies relating to any matter referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>).</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 425;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 231.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;489.3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;489.3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Provisions that do not apply</MarginalNote><Label>489.3</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;489.3&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Paragraphs 165(2)(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>) and (<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>) and sections 479 to 489.2 do not apply in respect of a company if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;489.3&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the order approving the commencement and carrying on of business by the company restricts it to the reinsurance of risks within a class of insurance specified in the order;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;489.3&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>it has provided the Commissioner with a declaration stating that it is not dealing with a prescribed group of consumers or carrying on any prescribed activity; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;489.3&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>after providing the declaration, it continues to not deal with that prescribed group.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;489.3&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;489.3&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice if action taken that causes provisions to apply</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The company must give notice to the Commissioner if it subsequently deals with the prescribed group referred to in the declaration.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2007, c. 6, s. 232.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_IX&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="1"><Label>PART IX</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_IX&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">INVESTMENTS</TitleText></Heading><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_IX&quot;,gb=&quot;s_490&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_IX&quot;,gb=&quot;s_490&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Definitions and Application</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;490&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Definitions</MarginalNote><Label>490.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The definitions in this subsection apply in this Part.</Text><Definition Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{closed-end fund}{fonds d’investissement à capital fixe}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{closed-end fund}{fonds d’investissement à capital fixe}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>closed-end fund</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{closed-end fund}{fonds d’investissement à capital fixe}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>fonds d’investissement à capital fixe</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>closed-end fund</DefinedTermEn> means an entity whose activities are limited to investing the funds of the entity so as to provide investment diversification and professional investment management to the holders of its securities, and whose securities are </Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{closed-end fund}{fonds d’investissement à capital fixe}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>fixed in number and distributed to the public in an offering under a preliminary prospectus, prospectus, short-form prospectus or similar document in accordance with the laws of a province or a foreign jurisdiction;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{closed-end fund}{fonds d’investissement à capital fixe}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>traded on an exchange or an over-the-counter market; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{closed-end fund}{fonds d’investissement à capital fixe}&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>liquidated on a fixed future termination date, the proceeds of which are allocated to the holders of the securities on a proportional basis.</Text></Paragraph></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>commercial loan</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>prêt commercial</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>commercial loan</DefinedTermEn> means</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any loan made or acquired by a company, other than</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>a loan to a natural person in an amount of two hundred and fifty thousand dollars or less,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>a loan to the Government of Canada, the government of a province, a municipality, or to any agency thereof, or to the government of a foreign country or any political subdivision thereof, or any agency thereof, or to a prescribed international agency,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>a loan that is guaranteed by, or fully secured by securities issued by, a government, a municipality or an agency referred to in subparagraph (ii),</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;iv&quot;"><Label>(iv)</Label><Text>a loan that is secured by a mortgage on real property, if</Text><Clause Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;iv&quot;,c1=&quot;A&quot;"><Label>(A)</Label><Text>the mortgage is on residential property and the amount of the loan, together with the amount then outstanding of any mortgage having an equal or prior claim against the property, does not exceed 80% of the value of the property at the time the loan is made or acquired, or</Text></Clause><Clause Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;iv&quot;,c1=&quot;B&quot;"><Label>(B)</Label><Text>the mortgage is on real property other than residential property and</Text><Subclause Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;iv&quot;,c1=&quot;B&quot;,cs=&quot;I&quot;"><Label>(I)</Label><Text>the amount of the loan, together with the amount then outstanding of any mortgage having an equal or prior claim against the property, does not exceed 80% of the value of the property at the time the loan is made or acquired, and</Text></Subclause><Subclause Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;iv&quot;,c1=&quot;B&quot;,cs=&quot;II&quot;"><Label>(II)</Label><Text>at the time the loan is made or acquired, the property provides an annual income sufficient to pay all annual expenses related to the property, including the payments owing under the mortgage and the mortgages having an equal or prior claim against the property,</Text></Subclause></Clause></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;v&quot;"><Label>(v)</Label><Text>a loan that is secured by a mortgage on real property, if</Text><Clause Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;v&quot;,c1=&quot;A&quot;"><Label>(A)</Label><Text>the mortgage is on residential property and</Text><Subclause Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;v&quot;,c1=&quot;A&quot;,cs=&quot;I&quot;"><Label>(I)</Label><Text>the amount of the loan, together with the amount then outstanding of any mortgage having an equal or prior claim against the property, exceeds 80% of the value of the property at the time the loan is made or acquired, and</Text></Subclause><Subclause Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;v&quot;,c1=&quot;A&quot;,cs=&quot;II&quot;"><Label>(II)</Label><Text>repayment of the amount of the loan that exceeds 80% of the value of the property is guaranteed or insured by a government agency or private insurer approved by the Superintendent,</Text></Subclause></Clause><Clause Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;v&quot;,c1=&quot;B&quot;"><Label>(B)</Label><Text>the mortgage is on real property other than residential property and</Text><Subclause Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;v&quot;,c1=&quot;B&quot;,cs=&quot;I&quot;"><Label>(I)</Label><Text>the amount of the loan, together with the amount then outstanding of any mortgage having an equal or prior claim against the property, exceeds 80% of the value of the property at the time the loan is made or acquired,</Text></Subclause><Subclause Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;v&quot;,c1=&quot;B&quot;,cs=&quot;II&quot;"><Label>(II)</Label><Text>repayment of the amount of the loan that exceeds 80% of the value of the property is guaranteed or insured by a government agency or private insurer approved by the Superintendent, and</Text></Subclause><Subclause Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;v&quot;,c1=&quot;B&quot;,cs=&quot;III&quot;"><Label>(III)</Label><Text>at the time the loan is made or acquired, the property provides an annual income sufficient to pay all annual expenses related to the property, including the payments owing under the mortgage and the mortgages having an equal or prior claim against the property, or</Text></Subclause></Clause><Clause Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;v&quot;,c1=&quot;C&quot;"><Label>(C)</Label><Text>the loan is one referred to in paragraph 469(2)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>),</Text></Clause></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;vi&quot;"><Label>(vi)</Label><Text>a loan that</Text><Clause Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;vi&quot;,c1=&quot;A&quot;"><Label>(A)</Label><Text>consists of a deposit made by the company with another financial institution,</Text></Clause><Clause Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;vi&quot;,c1=&quot;B&quot;"><Label>(B)</Label><Text>is fully secured by a deposit with any financial institution, including the company,</Text></Clause><Clause Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;vi&quot;,c1=&quot;C&quot;"><Label>(C)</Label><Text>is fully secured by debt obligations guaranteed by any financial institution other than the company, or</Text></Clause><Clause Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;vi&quot;,c1=&quot;D&quot;"><Label>(D)</Label><Text>is fully secured by a guarantee of a financial institution other than the company,</Text></Clause></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;vii&quot;"><Label>(vii)</Label><Text>an advance on the security of or against the cash surrender value of a policy, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;viii&quot;"><Label>(viii)</Label><Text>a loan to an entity controlled by the company;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an investment in debt obligations, other than</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>debt obligations that are</Text><Clause Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;,c1=&quot;A&quot;"><Label>(A)</Label><Text>guaranteed by any financial institution other than the company,</Text></Clause><Clause Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;,c1=&quot;B&quot;"><Label>(B)</Label><Text>fully secured by deposits with any financial institution, or</Text></Clause><Clause Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;,c1=&quot;C&quot;"><Label>(C)</Label><Text>fully secured by debt obligations that are guaranteed by any financial institution other than the company,</Text></Clause></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>debt obligations issued by the Government of Canada, the government of a province, a municipality, or by any agency thereof, or by the government of a foreign country or any political subdivision thereof, or by any agency thereof, or by a prescribed international agency,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>debt obligations that are guaranteed by, or fully secured by securities issued by, a government, a municipality or an agency referred to in subparagraph (ii),</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;iv&quot;"><Label>(iv)</Label><Text>debt obligations that are widely distributed, as that expression is defined by the regulations, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;v&quot;"><Label>(v)</Label><Text>debt obligations of an entity controlled by the company; and</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an investment in shares of a body corporate or ownership interests in an unincorporated entity, other than</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>shares or ownership interests that are widely distributed, as that expression is defined by the regulations,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>shares or ownership interests of an entity controlled by the company, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{commercial loan}{prêt commercial}&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>participating shares.</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{factoring entity}{entité s’occupant d’affacturage}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{factoring entity}{entité s’occupant d’affacturage}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>factoring entity</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{factoring entity}{entité s’occupant d’affacturage}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>entité s’occupant d’affacturage</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>factoring entity</DefinedTermEn> means a factoring entity as defined in the regulations.</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{finance entity}{entité s’occupant de financement}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{finance entity}{entité s’occupant de financement}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>finance entity</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{finance entity}{entité s’occupant de financement}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>entité s’occupant de financement</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>finance entity</DefinedTermEn> means a finance entity as defined in the regulations.</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{financial leasing entity}{entité s’occupant de crédit-bail}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{financial leasing entity}{entité s’occupant de crédit-bail}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>financial leasing entity</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{financial leasing entity}{entité s’occupant de crédit-bail}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>entité s’occupant de crédit-bail</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>financial leasing entity</DefinedTermEn> means an entity</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{financial leasing entity}{entité s’occupant de crédit-bail}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the activities of which are limited to the financial leasing of personal property and such related activities as are prescribed and whose activities conform to such restrictions and limitations thereon as are prescribed; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{financial leasing entity}{entité s’occupant de crédit-bail}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>that, in conducting the activities referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) in Canada, does not</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{financial leasing entity}{entité s’occupant de crédit-bail}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>direct its customers or potential customers to particular dealers in the leased property or the property to be leased,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{financial leasing entity}{entité s’occupant de crédit-bail}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>enter into lease agreements with persons in respect of any motor vehicle having a gross vehicle weight, as that expression is defined by the regulations, of less than twenty-one tonnes, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{financial leasing entity}{entité s’occupant de crédit-bail}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>enter into lease agreements with natural persons in respect of personal household property, as that expression is defined by the regulations.</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{loan}{prêt}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{loan}{prêt}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>loan</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{loan}{prêt}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>prêt</DefinedTermFr> ou <DefinedTermFr>emprunt</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>loan</DefinedTermEn> includes an acceptance, advance on the security of or against the cash surrender value of a policy, endorsement or other guarantee, a deposit, a financial lease, a conditional sales contract, a repurchase agreement and any other similar arrangement for obtaining funds or credit but does not include investments in securities.</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{motor vehicle}{véhicule à moteur}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{motor vehicle}{véhicule à moteur}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>motor vehicle</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{motor vehicle}{véhicule à moteur}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>véhicule à moteur</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>motor vehicle</DefinedTermEn> means a motorized vehicle designed to be used primarily on a public highway for the transportation of persons or things, but does not include</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{motor vehicle}{véhicule à moteur}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a fire-engine, bus, ambulance or utility truck; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{motor vehicle}{véhicule à moteur}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any other special purpose motorized vehicle that contains significant special features that make it suitable for a specific purpose.</Text></Paragraph></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{mutual fund distribution entity}{courtier de fonds mutuels}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{mutual fund distribution entity}{courtier de fonds mutuels}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>mutual fund distribution entity</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{mutual fund distribution entity}{courtier de fonds mutuels}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>courtier de fonds mutuels</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>mutual fund distribution entity</DefinedTermEn> means an entity whose principal activity is acting as a selling agent of units, shares or other interests in a mutual fund and acting as a collecting agent in the collection of payments for any such interests if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{mutual fund distribution entity}{courtier de fonds mutuels}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the proceeds of the sales of any such interests, less any sales commissions and service fees, are paid to the mutual fund; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{mutual fund distribution entity}{courtier de fonds mutuels}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the existence of a sales commission and service fee in respect of the sale of any such interest is disclosed to the purchaser of the interest before the purchase of the interest.</Text></Paragraph></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{mutual fund entity}{entité s’occupant de fonds mutuels}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{mutual fund entity}{entité s’occupant de fonds mutuels}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>mutual fund entity</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{mutual fund entity}{entité s’occupant de fonds mutuels}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>entité s’occupant de fonds mutuels</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>mutual fund entity</DefinedTermEn> means an entity</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{mutual fund entity}{entité s’occupant de fonds mutuels}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>whose activities are limited to the investing of the funds of the entity so as to provide investment diversification and professional investment management to the holders of its securities; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{mutual fund entity}{entité s’occupant de fonds mutuels}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>whose securities entitle their holders to receive, on demand, or within a specified period after demand, an amount computed by reference to the value of a proportionate interest in the whole or in a part of its net assets, including a separate fund or trust account of the entity.</Text></Paragraph></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{participating share}{action participante}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{participating share}{action participante}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>participating share</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{participating share}{action participante}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>action participante</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>participating share</DefinedTermEn> means a share of a body corporate that carries the right to participate in the earnings of the body corporate to an unlimited degree and to participate in a distribution of the remaining property of the body corporate on dissolution.</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{permitted entity}{entité admissible}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{permitted entity}{entité admissible}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>permitted entity</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{permitted entity}{entité admissible}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>entité admissible</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>permitted entity</DefinedTermEn> means an entity in which a company is permitted to acquire a substantial investment under section 495.</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{prescribed subsidiary}{filiale réglementaire}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{prescribed subsidiary}{filiale réglementaire}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>prescribed subsidiary</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{prescribed subsidiary}{filiale réglementaire}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>filiale réglementaire</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>prescribed subsidiary</DefinedTermEn> means a subsidiary that is one of a prescribed class of subsidiaries.</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{specialized financing entity}{entité s’occupant de financement spécial}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{specialized financing entity}{entité s’occupant de financement spécial}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>specialized financing entity</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{specialized financing entity}{entité s’occupant de financement spécial}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>entité s’occupant de financement spécial</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>specialized financing entity</DefinedTermEn> means a specialized financing entity as defined in the regulations.</Text></Definition></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Members of a company’s group</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>For the purpose of this Part, a member of a company’s group is any of the following:</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an entity referred to in any of paragraphs 495(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>) that controls the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a subsidiary of the company or of an entity referred to in any of paragraphs 495(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>) that controls the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an entity in which the company, or an entity referred to in any of paragraphs 495(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>) that controls the company, has a substantial investment; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a prescribed entity in relation to the company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exclusion of assets and liabilities of segregated funds</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A reference in this Part to the assets or liabilities of a company does not include</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>assets of a segregated fund maintained pursuant to section 451; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;490&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>liabilities of the company under the policies and for the amounts in respect of which such a fund is maintained.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, ss. 490, 760;</li><li> 1993, c. 34, s. 81(F);</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 264;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 426;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 233;</li><li> 2008, c. 28, s. 154.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20070420">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;491&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;491&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Non-application of Part</MarginalNote><Label>491.</Label><Text>This Part does not apply in respect of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;491&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>assets of a segregated fund maintained pursuant to section 451;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;491&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the holding of a security interest in real property, unless the security interest is prescribed under paragraph 509(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to be an interest in real property; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;491&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the holding of a security interest in securities of an entity.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 491;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 426.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_IX&quot;,gb=&quot;s_492&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_IX&quot;,gb=&quot;s_492&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">General Constraints on Investments</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;492&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;492&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Investment standards</MarginalNote><Label>492.</Label><Text>The directors of a company shall establish and the company shall adhere to investment and lending policies, standards and procedures that a reasonable and prudent person would apply in respect of a portfolio of investments and loans to avoid undue risk of loss and obtain a reasonable return.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 492;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 426.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;493&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;493&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction on control and substantial investments</MarginalNote><Label>493.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;493&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to subsections (2) to (4), no company shall acquire control of, or hold, acquire or increase a substantial investment in, any entity other than a permitted entity.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;493&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;493&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception: indirect investments</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A company may, subject to Part XI, acquire control of, or acquire or increase a substantial investment in, an entity other than a permitted entity by way of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;493&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an acquisition of control of an entity referred to in any of paragraphs 495(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">j</Emphasis>), or of a prescribed entity, that controls or has a substantial investment in the entity; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;493&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an acquisition of shares or ownership interests in the entity by</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;493&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>an entity referred to in any of paragraphs 495(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">j</Emphasis>), or a prescribed entity, that is controlled by the company, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;493&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>an entity controlled by an entity referred to in any of paragraphs 495(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">j</Emphasis>), or a prescribed entity, that is controlled by the company.</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;493&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;493&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception: temporary investments, realizations and loan workouts</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A company may, subject to Part XI, acquire control of, or acquire or increase a substantial investment in, an entity by way of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;493&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a temporary investment permitted by section 498;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;493&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an acquisition of shares of a body corporate or of ownership interests in an unincorporated entity permitted by section 499; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;493&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a realization of security permitted by section 500.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;493&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;493&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception: specialized financing regulations</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>A life company may, subject to Part XI, acquire control of, or hold, acquire or increase a substantial investment in, an entity other than a permitted entity if it does so in accordance with regulations made under paragraph 494(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>) concerning specialized financing.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;493&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;493&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception: uncontrolled event</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>A company is deemed not to contravene subsection (1) if the company acquires control of, or acquires or increases a substantial investment in, an entity solely as the result of an event not within the control of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;493&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;493&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application of other provision</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>Despite having acquired control of, or a substantial investment in, an entity under a particular provision of this Part, a company may continue to control the entity or hold the substantial investment in the entity as though it had made the acquisition under another provision of this Part so long as the conditions of that other provision are met.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;493&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;493&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Timing of deemed acquisition</MarginalNote><Label>(7)</Label><Text>If a company decides to exercise its right under subsection (6), the company is deemed to be acquiring the control or the substantial investment under the other provision.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 493;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 265;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 426;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 234.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;494&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;494&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations</MarginalNote><Label>494.</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;494&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the determination of the amount or value of loans, investments and interests for the purposes of this Part;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;494&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the loans and investments, and the maximum aggregate amount of all loans and investments, that may be made or acquired by a company and its prescribed subsidiaries to or in a person and any persons connected with that person;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;494&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>specifying the classes of persons who are connected with any person for the purposes of paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>); and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;494&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>concerning specialized financing for the purposes of subsection 493(4).</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 494;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 426.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_IX&quot;,gb=&quot;s_495&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_IX&quot;,gb=&quot;s_495&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Subsidiaries and Equity Investments</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;495&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Permitted investments</MarginalNote><Label>495.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to subsections (6) to (8) and Part XI, a company may acquire control of, or acquire or increase a substantial investment in</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a company or a society;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an insurance holding company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a bank;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a bank holding company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a body corporate to which the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="T-19.8">Trust and Loan Companies Act</XRefExternal> applies;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an association to which the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="C-41.01">Cooperative Credit Associations Act</XRefExternal> applies;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a trust, loan or insurance corporation incorporated or formed by or under an Act of the legislature of a province;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;h&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">h</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a cooperative credit society incorporated or formed, and regulated, by or under an Act of the legislature of a province;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">i</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an entity that is incorporated or formed by or under an Act of Parliament or of the legislature of a province and that is primarily engaged in dealing in securities; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;j&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">j</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an entity that is incorporated or formed, and regulated, otherwise than by or under an Act of Parliament or of the legislature of a province and that is primarily engaged outside Canada in a business that, if carried on in Canada, would be the business of banking, the business of a cooperative credit society, the business of insurance, the business of providing fiduciary services or the business of dealing in securities.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Permitted investments — life companies</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Subject to subsections (3) and (6) to (8) and Part XI, a life company may acquire control of, or acquire or increase a substantial investment in, an entity, other than an entity referred to in any of paragraphs (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">j</Emphasis>), whose business is limited to one or more of the following:</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>engaging in any financial service activity or in any other activity that a life company is permitted to engage in under subsection 440(2) or section 441 or 442, other than paragraph 441(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">h</Emphasis>);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>acquiring or holding shares of, or ownership interests in, entities in which a company is permitted under this Part to hold or acquire;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>engaging in the provision of any services exclusively to any or all of the following, so long as the entity is providing those services to the company or any member of the company’s group:</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>the company,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>any member of the company’s group,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>any entity that is primarily engaged in the business of providing financial services,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;iv&quot;"><Label>(iv)</Label><Text>any permitted entity in which an entity referred to in subparagraph (iii) has a substantial investment, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;v&quot;"><Label>(v)</Label><Text>any prescribed person, if it is doing so under prescribed terms and conditions, if any are prescribed;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>engaging in any activity that a life company is permitted to engage in, other than an activity referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>), that relates to</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>the promotion, sale, delivery or distribution of a financial product or financial service that is provided by the life company or any member of the life company’s group, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>if a significant portion of the business of the entity involves an activity referred to in subparagraph (i), the promotion, sale, delivery or distribution of a financial product or financial service that is provided by any other entity that is primarily engaged in the business of providing financial services;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>engaging in the activities referred to in the definition <DefinedTermEn>closed-end fund</DefinedTermEn>, <DefinedTermEn>mutual fund distribution entity</DefinedTermEn> or <DefinedTermEn>mutual fund entity</DefinedTermEn> in subsection 490(1); and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>engaging in prescribed activities, under prescribed terms and conditions, if any are prescribed.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction — life company</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A life company may not acquire control of, or acquire or increase a substantial investment in, an entity whose business includes any activity referred to in any of paragraphs (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>) if the entity engages in the business of accepting deposit liabilities or if the activities of the entity include</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>activities that a company is not permitted to engage in under any of sections 466, 469 and 475;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>dealing in securities, except as may be permitted under paragraph (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>) or as may be permitted to a company under paragraph 440(2)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>activities that a company is not permitted to engage in under any regulation made under section 489 if the entity engages in the activities of a finance entity or of any other entity as may be prescribed;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>acquiring control of or acquiring or holding a substantial investment in another entity unless</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>in the case of an entity that is controlled by the company, the company itself would be permitted under this Part to acquire a substantial investment in the other entity, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>in the case of an entity that is not controlled by the company, the company itself would be permitted to acquire a substantial investment in the other entity under subsection (1) or (2) or 493(2), paragraph 493(3)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>) or subsection 493(4); or</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any prescribed activity.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;3.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;3.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(3.1)</Label><Text>Despite paragraph (3)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>), a life company may acquire control of, or acquire or increase a substantial investment in, any entity that acts as a trustee of a trust if the entity has been authorized under the laws of a province to act as a trustee of a trust and the entity is</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;3.1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a closed-end fund;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;3.1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a mutual fund entity; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;3.1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an entity whose business is limited to engaging in one or more of the following:</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;3.1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>the activities of a mutual fund distribution entity,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;3.1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>any activity that a company is permitted to engage in under subsection 441(1.1), and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;3.1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>the provision of investment counselling services and portfolio management services.</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Permitted investments — property and casualty companies and marine companies</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Subject to subsections (5) to (8) and Part XI, a property and casualty company, or a marine company, may acquire control of, or acquire or increase a substantial investment in, an entity, other than an entity referred to in any of paragraphs (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">j</Emphasis>), whose business is limited to one or more of the following:</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>engaging in any financial service activity or in any other activity that a property and casualty company, or a marine company, is permitted to engage in under subsection 440(2) or section 441 or 442, other than paragraph 441(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">h</Emphasis>);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>acquiring or holding shares of, or ownership interests in, entities in which a property and casualty company, or a marine company, is permitted under this Part to hold or acquire;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>engaging in the provision of any services exclusively to any or all of the following, so long as the entity is providing those services to the company or any member of the company’s group:</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>the company,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>any member of the company’s group,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>any entity that is primarily engaged in the business of providing financial services,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;iv&quot;"><Label>(iv)</Label><Text>any permitted entity in which an entity referred to in subparagraph (iii) has a substantial investment, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;v&quot;"><Label>(v)</Label><Text>any prescribed person, if it is doing so under prescribed terms and conditions, if any are prescribed;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>engaging in any activity that a property and casualty company, or a marine company, is permitted to engage in, other than an activity referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>), that relates to</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>the promotion, sale, delivery or distribution of a financial product or financial service that is provided by the company or any member of the company’s group, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>if a significant portion of the business of the entity involves an activity referred to in subparagraph (i), the promotion, sale, delivery or distribution of a financial product or financial service that is provided by any other entity that is primarily engaged in the business of providing financial services;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>engaging in the activities referred to in the definition <DefinedTermEn>closed-end fund</DefinedTermEn>, <DefinedTermEn>mutual fund distribution entity</DefinedTermEn> or <DefinedTermEn>mutual fund entity</DefinedTermEn> in subsection 490(1); and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>engaging in prescribed activities, under prescribed terms and conditions, if any are prescribed.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction — property and casualty companies and marine companies</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>A property and casualty company, or a marine company, may not acquire control of, or acquire or increase a substantial investment in, an entity whose business includes any activity referred to in any of paragraphs (4)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>) if the entity engages in the business of accepting deposit liabilities or if the activities of the entity include</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>activities that a company is not permitted to engage in under any of sections 466, 469 and 478;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>dealing in securities, except as may be permitted under paragraph (4)(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>) or as may be permitted to a company under paragraph 440(2)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any financial intermediary activity that exposes the entity to material market or credit risk, including the activities of a finance entity, a factoring entity and a financial leasing entity;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;c.1&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c.1</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the activities of a specialized financing entity;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>acquiring control of or acquiring or holding a substantial investment in another entity unless</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>in the case of an entity that is controlled by the company, the company itself would be permitted under this Part to acquire a substantial investment in the other entity, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>in the case of an entity that is not controlled by the company, the company itself would be permitted to acquire a substantial investment in the other entity under subsection (1) or (4) or 493(2) or paragraph 493(3)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>); or</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any prescribed activity.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;5.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;5.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(5.1)</Label><Text>Despite paragraph (5)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>), a property and casualty company, or a marine company, may acquire control of, or acquire or increase a substantial investment in, any entity that acts as a trustee of a trust if the entity has been authorized under the laws of a province to act as a trustee of a trust and the entity is</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;5.1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a closed-end fund;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;5.1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a mutual fund entity; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;5.1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an entity whose business is limited to engaging in one or more of the following:</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;5.1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>the activities of a mutual fund distribution entity, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;5.1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>the provision of investment counselling services and portfolio management services.</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Control</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection (10) and the regulations, a company may not acquire control of, or acquire or increase a substantial investment in,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an entity referred to in any of paragraphs (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">j</Emphasis>), unless</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>the company controls, within the meaning of paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), the entity, or would thereby acquire control, within the meaning of that paragraph, of the entity, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>the company is permitted by regulations made under paragraph 501(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to acquire or increase the substantial investment;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an entity whose business includes one or more of the activities referred to in paragraph (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) and that engages, as part of its business, in any financial intermediary activity that exposes the entity to material market or credit risk, including a finance entity, a factoring entity and a financial leasing entity, unless</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>the company controls, within the meaning of paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), the entity, or would thereby acquire control, within the meaning of that paragraph, of the entity, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>the company is permitted by regulations made under paragraph 501(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to acquire or increase the substantial investment; or</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an entity whose business includes an activity referred to in paragraph (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) or (4)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>), including a specialized financing entity, unless</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>the company controls, within the meaning of paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), the entity, or would thereby acquire control, within the meaning of that paragraph, of the entity,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>the company is permitted by regulations made under paragraph 501(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to acquire or increase the substantial investment, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>subject to prescribed terms and conditions, if any are prescribed, the activities of the entity do not include the acquisition or holding of control of, or the acquisition or holding of shares or other ownership interests in, an entity referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) or an entity that is not a permitted entity.</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Minister’s approval</MarginalNote><Label>(7)</Label><Text>Subject to the regulations, a company may not, without the prior written approval of the Minister,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>acquire control of an entity referred to in paragraphs (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">i</Emphasis>) from a person who is not a member of the company’s group;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>acquire control of an entity referred to in paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">j</Emphasis>) or (6)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>), other than an entity whose activities are limited to the activities of one or more of the following entities, if the control is acquired from an entity referred to in any of paragraphs (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>) that is not a member of the company’s group:</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>a factoring entity, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>a financial leasing entity;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>acquire control of, or acquire or increase a substantial investment in, an entity whose business includes one or more of the activities referred to in paragraph (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>) or (4)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>acquire control of, or acquire or increase a substantial investment in, an entity that engages in Canada in an activity described in paragraph 441(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,p1=&quot;d.1&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d.1</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>acquire control of, or acquire or increase a substantial investment in, an entity that engages in an activity described in paragraph 441(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d.1</Emphasis>); or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>acquire control of, or acquire or increase a substantial investment in, an entity engaging in an activity prescribed for the purposes of paragraph (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>) or (4)(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>).</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;8&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;8&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Superintendent’s approval</MarginalNote><Label>(8)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection (9) and the regulations, a company may not acquire control of, or acquire or increase a substantial investment in, an entity referred to in any of paragraphs (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">j</Emphasis>) and (6)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) and (<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>) unless the company obtains the approval of the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;9&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;9&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(9)</Label><Text>Subsection (8) does not apply in respect of a particular transaction if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;9&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the company is acquiring control of an entity, other than a specialized financing entity, and the only reason for which the company would, but for this subsection, require approval for the acquisition is that the entity carries on activities referred to in paragraph (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) or (4)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;9&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the company is acquiring control of an entity whose activities are limited to the activities of a factoring entity or a financial leasing entity; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;9&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the Minister has approved the transaction under subsection (7) or is deemed to have approved it under subsection 496(1).</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;10&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;10&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Control not required</MarginalNote><Label>(10)</Label><Text>A company need not control an entity referred to in paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">j</Emphasis>), or an entity that is incorporated or formed otherwise than by or under an Act of Parliament or of the legislature of a province, if the laws or customary business practices of the country under the laws of which the entity was incorporated or formed do not permit the company to control the entity.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;11&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;11&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Prohibition on giving up control in fact</MarginalNote><Label>(11)</Label><Text>A company that, under subsection (6), controls an entity may not, without the prior written approval of the Minister, give up control, within the meaning of paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), of the entity while it continues to control the entity.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;12&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;12&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Giving up control</MarginalNote><Label>(12)</Label><Text>A company that, under subsection (6), controls an entity may, with the prior written approval of the Superintendent, give up control of the entity while keeping a substantial investment in the entity if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;12&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the company is permitted to do so by regulations made under paragraph 501(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>); or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;12&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the entity meets the conditions referred to in subparagraph (6)(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)(iii).</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;13&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;495&quot;,ss=&quot;13&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Subsections do not apply</MarginalNote><Label>(13)</Label><Text>If a company controls, within the meaning of paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>), (<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>), an entity, subsections (7) and (8) do not apply in respect of any subsequent increases by the company of its substantial investment in the entity so long as the company continues to control the entity.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 495;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 266;</li><li> 1999, c. 28, s. 122;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 426;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, ss. 235, 336(F).</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;496&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;496&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Approval for indirect investments</MarginalNote><Label>496.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;496&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If a company obtains the approval of the Minister under subsection 495(7) to acquire control of, or to acquire or increase a substantial investment in, an entity and, through that acquisition or increase, the company indirectly acquires control of, or acquires or increases a substantial investment in, another entity that would require the approval of the Minister under subsection 495(7) or the Superintendent under subsection 495(8) and that indirect acquisition or increase is disclosed to the Minister in writing before the approval is obtained, the company is deemed to have obtained the approval of the Minister or the Superintendent for that indirect acquisition or increase.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;496&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;496&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Approval for indirect investments</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If a company obtains the approval of the Superintendent under subsection 495(8) to acquire control of, or to acquire or increase a substantial investment in, an entity and, through that acquisition or increase the company indirectly acquires control of, or acquires or increases a substantial investment in, another entity that would require the approval of the Superintendent under that subsection and that indirect acquisition or increase is disclosed to the Superintendent in writing before the approval is obtained, the company is deemed to have obtained the approval of the Superintendent for that indirect acquisition or increase.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 496;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 426.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;497&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;497&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Undertakings</MarginalNote><Label>497.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;497&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If a company controls a permitted entity, other than an entity referred to in any of paragraphs 495(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>), the company shall provide the Superintendent with any undertakings that the Superintendent may require regarding</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;497&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the activities of the entity; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;497&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>access to information about the entity.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;497&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;497&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Undertakings</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If a company acquires control of an entity referred to in any of paragraphs 495(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">j</Emphasis>), the company shall provide the Superintendent with any undertakings concerning the entity that the Superintendent may require.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;497&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;497&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Agreements with other jurisdictions</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The Superintendent may enter into an agreement with the appropriate official or public body responsible for the supervision of any entity referred to in any of paragraphs 495(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">j</Emphasis>) in each province or in any other jurisdiction concerning any matters referred to in paragraphs (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) and (<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) or any other matter the Superintendent considers appropriate.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;497&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;497&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Access to records</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Despite any other provision of this Part, a company shall not control a permitted entity, other than an entity referred to in any of paragraphs 495(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>), unless, in the course of the acquisition of control or within a reasonable time after the control is acquired, the company obtains from the permitted entity an undertaking to provide the Superintendent with reasonable access to the records of the permitted entity.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 497;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 426.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_IX&quot;,gb=&quot;s_498&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_IX&quot;,gb=&quot;s_498&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Exceptions and Exclusions</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;498&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;498&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Temporary investments in entity</MarginalNote><Label>498.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;498&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection (4), a company may, by way of a temporary investment, acquire control of, or acquire or increase a substantial investment in, an entity but, within two years, or any other period that may be specified or approved by the Superintendent, after acquiring control or after acquiring or increasing the substantial investment, as the case may be, it shall do all things necessary to ensure that it no longer controls the entity or has a substantial investment in the entity.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;498&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;498&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Transitional</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Despite subsection (1), if a company that was in existence immediately before June 1, 1992 had an investment in an entity on September 27, 1990 that is a substantial investment within the meaning of section 10 and the company subsequently increases that substantial investment by way of a temporary investment, the company shall, within two years, or any other period that is specified or approved by the Superintendent, after increasing the substantial investment, do all things necessary to ensure that its substantial investment in the entity is no greater than it was on September 27, 1990.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;498&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;498&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Extension</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The Superintendent may, in the case of any particular company that makes an application under this subsection, extend the period of two years, or the other period specified or approved by the Superintendent, that is referred to in subsection (1) or (2) for any further period or periods, and on any terms and conditions, that the Superintendent considers necessary.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;498&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;498&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Temporary investment</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>If a company, by way of temporary investment, acquires control of, or acquires or increases a substantial investment in, an entity for which the approval of the Minister would have been required under subsection 495(7) if the company had acquired the control, or acquired or increased the substantial investment, under section 495, the company must, within 90 days after acquiring control or after acquiring or increasing the substantial investment,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;498&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>apply to the Minister for approval to retain control of the entity or to continue to hold the substantial investment in the entity for a period specified by the Minister or for an indeterminate period on any terms and conditions that the Minister considers appropriate; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;498&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>do all things necessary to ensure that, on the expiry of the 90 days, it no longer controls the entity or does not have a substantial investment in the entity.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;498&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;498&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Indeterminate extension</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>If a company, by way of temporary investment, acquires control of, or acquires or increases a substantial investment in, an entity for which the approval of the Superintendent would have been required under subsection 495(8) if the company had acquired the control, or acquired or increased the substantial investment, under section 495, the Superintendent may, on application, permit the company to retain control of the entity or to continue to hold the substantial investment in the entity for an indeterminate period, on any terms and conditions that the Superintendent considers appropriate.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 498;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 426;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 236.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;499&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;499&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Loan workouts</MarginalNote><Label>499.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;499&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Despite anything in this Part, if a company or any of its subsidiaries has made a loan to an entity and, under the terms of the agreement between the company, or any of its subsidiaries, and the entity with respect to the loan and any other documents governing the terms of the loan, a default has occurred, the company may acquire</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;499&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if the entity is a body corporate, all or any of the shares of the body corporate;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;499&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if the entity is an unincorporated entity, all or any of the ownership interests in the entity;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;499&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>all or any of the shares or all or any of the ownership interests in any entity that is an affiliate of the entity;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;499&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>all or any of the shares of a body corporate that is primarily engaged in holding shares of, ownership interests in or assets acquired from the entity or any of its affiliates; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;499&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>all or any of the ownership interests in any entity that is primarily engaged in holding shares of, ownership interests in or assets acquired from the entity or any of its affiliates.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;499&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;499&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Obligation of company</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If a company acquires shares or ownership interests in an entity under subsection (1), the company shall, within five years after acquiring them, do all things necessary to ensure that the company does not control the entity or have a substantial investment in the entity.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;499&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;499&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Transitional</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Despite subsection (1), if a company that was in existence immediately before June 1, 1992 had an investment in an entity on September 27, 1990 that is a substantial investment within the meaning of section 10 and the company later increases that substantial investment by way of an investment made under subsection (1), the company shall, within five years after increasing the substantial investment, do all things necessary to ensure that its substantial investment in the entity is no greater than it was on September 27, 1990.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;499&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;499&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Extension</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>The Superintendent may, in the case of any particular company that makes an application under this subsection, extend the period of five years referred to in subsection (2) or (3) for any further period or periods, and on any terms and conditions, that the Superintendent considers necessary.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;499&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;499&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception — entities controlled by foreign governments</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>Despite anything in this Part, if a company has made a loan to, or holds a debt obligation of, the government of a foreign country or an entity controlled by the government of a foreign country and, under the terms of the agreement between the company and that government or the entity, as the case may be, and any other documents governing the terms of the loan or debt obligation, a default has occurred, the company may acquire all or any of the shares of, or ownership interests in, that entity or in any other entity designated by that government, if the acquisition is part of a debt restructuring program of that government.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;499&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;499&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Time for holding shares</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>If a company acquires any shares or ownership interests under subsection (5), the company may, on any terms and conditions that the Superintendent considers appropriate, hold those shares or ownership interests for an indeterminate period or for any other period that the Superintendent may specify.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;499&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;499&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(7)</Label><Text>If, under subsection (1), a company acquires control of, or acquires or increases a substantial investment in, an entity that it would otherwise be permitted to acquire or increase under section 495, the company may retain control of the entity or continue to hold the substantial investment for an indeterminate period if the approval in writing of the Minister is obtained before the end of the period referred to in subsection (2) or (3), including any extension of it granted under subsection (4).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 499;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 267;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 426;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 237.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;500&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;500&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Realizations</MarginalNote><Label>500.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;500&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Despite anything in this Act, a company may acquire</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;500&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an investment in a body corporate,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;500&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an interest in an unincorporated entity, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;500&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an interest in real property,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>if the investment or interest is acquired through the realization of a security interest held by the company or any of its subsidiaries.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;500&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;500&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Disposition</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection 77(2), if a company acquires control of, or acquires a substantial investment in, an entity by way of the realization of a security interest held by the company or any of its subsidiaries, the company shall, within five years after the day on which control or the substantial investment is acquired, do all things necessary, or cause its subsidiary to do all things necessary, as the case may be, to ensure that the company no longer controls the entity or has a substantial investment in the entity.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;500&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;500&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Transitional</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Despite subsection (2), if a company that was in existence immediately before June 1, 1992 had an investment in an entity on September 27, 1990 that is a substantial investment within the meaning of section 10 and the company later increases that substantial investment by way of a realization of a security interest under subsection (1), the company shall, within five years after increasing the substantial investment, do all things necessary to ensure that its substantial investment in the entity is no greater than it was on September 27, 1990.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;500&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;500&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Extension</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>The Superintendent may, in the case of any particular company that makes an application under this subsection, extend the period of five years referred to in subsection (2) or (3) for any further period or periods, and on any terms and conditions, that the Superintendent considers necessary.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;500&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;500&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>If, under subsection (1), a company acquires control of, or acquires or increases a substantial investment in, an entity that it would otherwise be permitted to acquire or increase under section 495, the company may retain control of the entity or continue to hold the substantial investment for an indeterminate period if the approval in writing of the Minister is obtained before the end of the period referred to in subsection (2) or (3), including any extension of it granted under subsection (4).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 500;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 268;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 426.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;501&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;501&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations restricting ownership</MarginalNote><Label>501.</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;501&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>for the purposes of subsection 495(6), permitting the acquisition of control or the acquisition or increase of substantial investments, or prescribing the circumstances under which that subsection does not apply or the companies or other entities in respect of which that subsection does not apply, including prescribing companies or other entities on the basis of the activities they engage in;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;501&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>for the purposes of subsection 495(7) or (8), permitting the acquisition of control or the acquisition or increase of substantial investments, or prescribing the circumstances under which either of those subsections does not apply or the companies or other entities in respect of which either of those subsections does not apply, including prescribing companies or other entities on the basis of the activities they engage in;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;501&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>for the purposes of subsection 495(12), permitting a company to give up control of an entity; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;501&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>restricting the ownership by a company of shares of a body corporate or of ownership interests in an unincorporated entity under sections 495 to 500 and imposing terms and conditions applicable to companies that own such shares or interests.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 501;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 269;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 426.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_IX&quot;,gb=&quot;s_502&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_IX&quot;,gb=&quot;s_502&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Portfolio Limits</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;502&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;502&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exclusion from portfolio limits</MarginalNote><Label>502.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;502&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection (3), the value of all loans, investments and interests acquired by a company and any of its prescribed subsidiaries under section 499 or as a result of a realization of a security interest is not to be included in calculating the value of loans, investments and interests of the company and its prescribed subsidiaries under sections 503 to 508</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;502&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>for a period of twelve years following the day on which the interest was acquired, in the case of an interest in real property; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;502&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>for a period of five years after the day on which the loan, investment or interest was acquired, in the case of a loan, investment or interest, other than an interest in real property.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;502&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;502&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Extension</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The Superintendent may, in the case of any particular company, extend any period referred to in subsection (1) for any further period or periods, and on any terms and conditions, that the Superintendent considers necessary.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;502&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;502&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Subsection (1) does not apply to an investment or interest described in that subsection if the investment or interest is defined by a regulation made under section 509 to be an interest in real property and</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;502&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the company or the subsidiary acquired the investment or interest as a result of the realization of a security interest securing a loan that was defined by a regulation made under section 509 to be an interest in real property; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;502&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the company or the subsidiary acquired the investment or interest under section 499 as a result of a default referred to in that section in respect of a loan that was defined by a regulation made under section 509 to be an interest in real property.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 502;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 270;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 426.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_IX&quot;,gb=&quot;s_503&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_IX&quot;,gb=&quot;s_503&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Commercial Lending by Life Companies</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;503&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;503&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Lending limit: companies with regulatory capital of $25 million or less</MarginalNote><Label>503.</Label><Text>Subject to section 504, a life company that has twenty-five million dollars or less of regulatory capital shall not, and shall not permit its prescribed subsidiaries to, make or acquire a commercial loan or acquire control of a permitted entity that holds commercial loans if the aggregate value of all commercial loans held by the company and its prescribed subsidiaries exceeds, or the making or acquisition of the commercial loan or acquisition of control of the entity would cause the aggregate value of all commercial loans held by the company and its prescribed subsidiaries to exceed, 5 per cent of the total assets of the company.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 503;</li><li> 1999, c. 28, s. 123;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 426.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;504&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;504&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Lending limit: regulatory capital over $25 million</MarginalNote><Label>504.</Label><Text>A life company that has twenty-five million dollars or less of regulatory capital that is controlled by a financial institution that has the equivalent of more than twenty-five million dollars of regulatory capital or a life company that has more than twenty-five million dollars of regulatory capital may make or acquire commercial loans or acquire control of a permitted entity that holds commercial loans if the aggregate value of all commercial loans held by the company and its prescribed subsidiaries would thereby exceed the limit set out in section 503 only with the prior approval in writing of the Superintendent and in accordance with any terms and conditions that the Superintendent may specify.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 504;</li><li> 1999, c. 28, s. 124;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 426.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_IX&quot;,gb=&quot;s_505&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_IX&quot;,gb=&quot;s_505&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Consumer and Commercial Lending by Property and Casualty Companies and Marine Companies</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;505&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;505&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Lending limit — property and casualty companies and marine companies</MarginalNote><Label>505.</Label><Text>A property and casualty company, or a marine company, shall not, and shall not permit its prescribed subsidiaries to, make or acquire a commercial loan or a loan to a natural person, or acquire control of a permitted entity that holds commercial loans or loans to natural persons, if the aggregate value of all such loans held by the company and its prescribed subsidiaries exceeds, or the making or acquisition of the loan or the acquisition of control of the permitted entity would cause the aggregate value of all such loans held by the company and its prescribed subsidiaries to exceed, the prescribed percentage of the total assets of the company.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 505;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 426;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 238.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_IX&quot;,gb=&quot;s_506&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_IX&quot;,gb=&quot;s_506&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Real Property</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;506&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;506&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limit on total property interest</MarginalNote><Label>506.</Label><Text>A company shall not, and shall not permit its prescribed subsidiaries to, purchase or otherwise acquire an interest in real property or make an improvement to any real property in which the company or any of its prescribed subsidiaries has an interest if the aggregate value of all interests of the company in real property exceeds, or the acquisition of the interest or the making of the improvement would cause that aggregate value to exceed, an amount determined in accordance with the regulations.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 506;</li><li> 1993, c. 34, s. 82;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 426.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_IX&quot;,gb=&quot;s_507&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_IX&quot;,gb=&quot;s_507&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Equities</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;507&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;507&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limits on equity acquisitions</MarginalNote><Label>507.</Label><Text>A company shall not, and shall not permit its prescribed subsidiaries to,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;507&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>purchase or otherwise acquire any participating shares of any body corporate or any ownership interests in any unincorporated entity, other than those of a permitted entity in which the company has, or by virtue of the acquisition would have, a substantial investment, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;507&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>acquire control of an entity that holds shares or ownership interests referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>),</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>if the aggregate value of</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;507&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>all participating shares, excluding participating shares of permitted entities in which the company has a substantial investment, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;507&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>all ownership interests in unincorporated entities, other than ownership interests in permitted entities in which the company has a substantial investment,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>beneficially owned by the company and its prescribed subsidiaries exceeds, or the purchase or acquisition would cause that aggregate value to exceed, an amount determined in accordance with the regulations.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 507;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 426.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_IX&quot;,gb=&quot;s_508&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_IX&quot;,gb=&quot;s_508&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Aggregate Limit</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;508&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;508&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Aggregate limit</MarginalNote><Label>508.</Label><Text>A company shall not, and shall not permit its prescribed subsidiaries to,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;508&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>purchase or otherwise acquire</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;508&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>participating shares of a body corporate, other than those of a permitted entity in which the company has, or by virtue of the acquisition would have, a substantial investment,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;508&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>ownership interests in an unincorporated entity, other than ownership interests in a permitted entity in which the company has, or by virtue of the acquisition would have, a substantial investment, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;508&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>interests in real property, or</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;508&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>make an improvement to real property in which the company or any of its prescribed subsidiaries has an interest</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>if the aggregate value of</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;508&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>all participating shares and ownership interests referred to in subparagraphs (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)(i) and (ii) that are beneficially owned by the company and its prescribed subsidiaries, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;508&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>all interests of the company in real property referred to in subparagraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)(iii)</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>exceeds, or the acquisition or the making of the improvement would cause that aggregate value to exceed, an amount determined in accordance with the regulations.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 508;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 271;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 426.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_IX&quot;,gb=&quot;s_509&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_IX&quot;,gb=&quot;s_509&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Miscellaneous</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;509&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;509&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations</MarginalNote><Label>509.</Label><Text>For the purposes of this Part, the Governor in Council may make regulations</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;509&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>defining the interests of a company in real property;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;509&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>determining the method of valuing those interests;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;509&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>exempting classes of companies from the application of sections 502 to 508; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;509&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the determination of an amount for the purpose of each of sections 506, 507 and 508.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 509;</li><li> 1993, c. 34, s. 83;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 272;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 426.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;510&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;510&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Divestment order</MarginalNote><Label>510.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;510&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The Superintendent may, by order, direct a company to dispose of, within any period that the Superintendent considers reasonable, any loan, investment or interest made or acquired in contravention of this Part.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;510&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;510&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Divestment order</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If, in the opinion of the Superintendent,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;510&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an investment by a company or any entity it controls in shares of a body corporate or in ownership interests in an unincorporated entity enables the company to control the body corporate or the unincorporated entity, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;510&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the company or any entity it controls has entered into an arrangement whereby it or its nominee may veto any proposal put before</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;510&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>the board of directors of a body corporate, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;510&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>a similar group or committee of an unincorporated entity,</Text></Subparagraph><ContinuedParagraph><Text>or whereby no proposal may be approved except with the consent of the company, the entity it controls or the nominee,</Text></ContinuedParagraph></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>the Superintendent may, by order, require the company, within any period that the Superintendent considers reasonable, to do all things necessary to ensure that the company no longer controls the body corporate or unincorporated entity or has the ability to veto or otherwise defeat any proposal referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>).</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;510&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;510&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Divestment order</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>If</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;510&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a company</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;510&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>fails to provide or obtain within a reasonable time the undertakings referred to in subsection 497(1), (2) or (4), or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;510&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>is in default of an undertaking referred to in subsection 497(1) or (2) and the default is not remedied within ninety days after the day of receipt by the company of a notice from the Superintendent of the default, or</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;510&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a permitted entity referred to in subsection 497(4) is in default of an undertaking referred to in subsection 497(4) and the default is not remedied within ninety days after the day of receipt by the company of a notice from the Superintendent of the default,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>the Superintendent may, by order, require the company, within any period that the Superintendent considers reasonable, to do all things necessary to ensure that the company no longer has a substantial investment in the entity to which the undertaking relates.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;510&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;510&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Subsection (2) does not apply in respect of an entity in which a company has a substantial investment permitted by this Part.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 510;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 426.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;511&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;511&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Deemed temporary investment</MarginalNote><Label>511.</Label><Text>If a company controls or has a substantial investment in an entity as permitted by this Part and the company becomes aware of a change in the business or affairs of the entity that, if the change had taken place before the acquisition of control or of the substantial investment, would have caused the entity not to be a permitted entity or would have been such that approval for the acquisition would have been required under subsection 495(7) or (8), the company is deemed to have acquired, on the day the company becomes aware of the change, a temporary investment in respect of which section 498 applies.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 511;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 273;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 426.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;512&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;512&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Asset transactions</MarginalNote><Label>512.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;512&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company shall not, and shall not permit its subsidiaries to, without the approval of the Superintendent, acquire assets from a person or transfer assets to a person if</Text><FormulaGroup><Formula><FormulaText>A + B &gt; C</FormulaText></Formula><FormulaConnector>where</FormulaConnector><FormulaDefinition><FormulaTerm>A</FormulaTerm><Text>is the value of the assets;</Text></FormulaDefinition><FormulaDefinition><FormulaTerm>B</FormulaTerm><Text>is the total value of all assets that the company and its subsidiaries acquired from or transferred to that person in the twelve months ending immediately before the acquisition or transfer; and</Text></FormulaDefinition><FormulaDefinition><FormulaTerm>C</FormulaTerm><Text>is ten per cent of the total value of the assets of the company, as shown in the last annual statement of the company prepared before the acquisition or transfer.</Text></FormulaDefinition></FormulaGroup></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;512&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;512&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Approval of series of transactions</MarginalNote><Label>(1.1)</Label><Text>The Superintendent may, for the purposes of subsection (1), approve a transaction or series of transactions relating to the acquisition or transfer of assets that may be entered into with a person, or with persons of any class of persons, regardless of whether those persons are known at the time of the granting of the approval or not.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;512&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;512&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Subsection (1) does not apply in respect of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;512&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an asset that is a debt obligation referred to in subparagraphs (<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)(i) to (v) of the definition <DefinedTermEn>commercial loan</DefinedTermEn> in subsection 490(1);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;512&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>assets that are acquired or transferred under a transaction or series of transactions by a company with another financial institution as a result of the company’s participation in one or more syndicated loans with that financial institution;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;512&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>assets that are acquired or transferred under a transaction that is approved by the Minister or the Superintendent under subsection 254(2) or (2.01);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;512&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>shares of, or ownership interests in, an entity for which the approval of the Minister under Part VII or subsection 495(7) is required or the approval of the Superintendent under subsection 495(8) is required;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;512&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>assets that are acquired or transferred under a transaction approved by the Minister under subsection 715(1) of this Act or subsection 678(1) of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="B-1.01">Bank Act</XRefExternal>;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;512&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>assets, other than real property, acquired or disposed of under an arrangement that has been approved by the Superintendent under subsection 527(3); or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;512&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>assets acquired or disposed of with the approval of the Superintendent under subsection 527(4).</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;512&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><Label>(3)</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 2007, c. 6, s. 239]</Repealed></Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;512&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;512&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Value of assets</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>For the purposes of “A” in subsection (1), the value of the assets is</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;512&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of assets that are acquired, the purchase price of the assets or, if the assets are shares of, or ownership interests in, an entity the assets of which will be included in the annual statement of the company after the acquisition, the fair market value of the assets; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;512&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of assets that are transferred, the value of the assets as reported in the last annual statement of the company prepared before the transfer or, if the value of the assets is not reported in that annual statement, the value of the assets as it would be reported in the annual statement of the company if the annual statement had been prepared, in accordance with the accounting principles referred to in subsection 331(4), immediately before the transfer.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;512&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;512&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Total value of all assets</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>For the purposes of subsection (1), the total value of all assets that the company or any of its subsidiaries has acquired during the period of twelve months referred to in subsection (1) is the purchase price of the assets or, if the assets are shares of, or ownership interests in, an entity the assets of which immediately after the acquisition were included in the annual statement of the company, the fair market value of the assets of the entity at the date of the acquisition.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;512&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;512&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Total value of all assets</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>For the purposes of subsection (1), the total value of all assets that the company or any of its subsidiaries has transferred during the 12-month period referred to in subsection (1) is the total of the value of each of those assets as reported in the last annual statement of the company prepared before the transfer of the asset or, if the value of any of those assets is not reported in that annual statement, as it would be reported in the annual statement of the company if the annual statement had been prepared, in accordance with the accounting principles referred to in subsection 331(4), immediately before the transfer of the asset.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 512;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 274;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 426;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 239.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;513&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;513&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Transitional</MarginalNote><Label>513.</Label><Text>Nothing in this Part requires</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;513&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the termination of a loan made before February 7, 2001;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;513&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the termination of a loan made after that date as a result of a commitment made before that date;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;513&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the disposal of an investment made before that date; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;513&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the disposal of an investment made after that date as a result of a commitment made before that date.</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>But if the loan or investment would be precluded or limited by this Part, the amount of the loan or investment may not, except as provided in subsections 498(2), 499(3) and 500(3), be increased after that date.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 513;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 426.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;514&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;514&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Deeming</MarginalNote><Label>514.</Label><Text>A loan or investment referred to in section 513 is deemed not to be prohibited by the provisions of this Part.</Text></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_X&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="1"><Label>PART X</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_X&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">ADEQUACY OF CAPITAL AND LIQUIDITY AND ASSETS</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;515&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;515&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Adequacy of capital and liquidity — companies and societies</MarginalNote><Label>515.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;515&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company and society shall, in relation to its operations, maintain adequate capital and adequate and appropriate forms of liquidity and shall comply with any regulations in relation to adequate capital and adequate and appropriate forms of liquidity.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;515&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;515&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations and guidelines</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations and the Superintendent may make guidelines respecting the maintenance by companies and societies of adequate capital and adequate and appropriate forms of liquidity.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;515&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;515&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Directives</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Notwithstanding that a company or society is complying with regulations or guidelines made under subsection (2), the Superintendent may, by order, direct the company or society to increase its capital or to provide additional liquidity in any forms and amounts that the Superintendent may require.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;515&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;515&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Compliance</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>A company and society shall comply with an order made under subsection (3) within the time that the Superintendent specifies in the order.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 515;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 81;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 427.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;516&quot;"><Label>516.</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 2007, c. 6, s. 240]</Repealed></Text><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;517&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;517&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of value</MarginalNote><Label>517.</Label><Text>Where an appraisal of any asset held by a company or any of its subsidiaries has been made by the Superintendent and the value determined by the Superintendent to be the appropriate value of the asset varies materially from the value placed by the company or subsidiary on the asset, the Superintendent shall send to the company, the auditor of the company, the actuary of the company and the audit committee of the company a written notice of the appropriate value of the asset as determined by the Superintendent.</Text></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XI&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="1"><Label>PART XI</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XI&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">SELF-DEALING</TitleText></Heading><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XI&quot;,gb=&quot;s_517.1&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XI&quot;,gb=&quot;s_517.1&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Interpretation and Application</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;517.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;517.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Definition of <DefinedTermEn>senior officer</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><Label>517.1</Label><Text>For the purposes of this Part, a <DefinedTermEn>senior officer</DefinedTermEn> of a body corporate is a person who is</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;517.1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a director of the body corporate who is a full-time employee of the body corporate;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;517.1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the chief executive officer, chief operating officer, president, secretary, treasurer, controller, chief financial officer, chief accountant, chief auditor or chief actuary of the body corporate;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;517.1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a natural person who performs functions for the body corporate similar to those performed by a person referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;517.1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the head of the strategic planning unit of the body corporate;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;517.1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the head of the unit of the body corporate that provides legal services or human resources services to the body corporate; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;517.1&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any other officer reporting directly to the body corporate’s board of directors, chief executive officer or chief operating officer.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 276.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;518&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;518&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Related party of company</MarginalNote><Label>518.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;518&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>For the purposes of this Part, a person is a related party of a company where the person</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;518&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>is a person who has a significant interest in a class of shares of the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;518&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>is a director or senior officer of the company or of a body corporate that controls the company or is acting in a similar capacity in respect of an unincorporated entity that controls the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;518&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>is the spouse or common-law partner, or a child who is less than eighteen years of age, of a person described in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;518&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>is an entity that is controlled by a person referred to in any of paragraphs (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;518&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>is an entity in which a person who controls the company has a substantial investment;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;518&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>is an entity in which the spouse or common-law partner, or a child who is less than eighteen years of age, of a person who controls the company has a substantial investment; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;518&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>is a person, or a member of a class of persons, designated under subsection (4) or (5) as, or deemed under subsection (6) to be, a related party of the company.</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;518&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;h&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">h</Emphasis>)</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 1997, c. 15, s. 277]</Repealed></Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;518&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;518&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception — subsidiaries and substantial investments of companies</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If an entity in which a company has a substantial investment would, but for this subsection, be a related party of the company only because a person who controls the company controls the entity or has a substantial investment in the entity, and the person does not control the entity or have a substantial investment in the entity otherwise than through the person’s controlling interest in the company, the entity is not a related party of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;518&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;518&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Deeming</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The holding body corporate of a company is deemed not to be a person referred to in paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) if the holding body corporate is a foreign company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;518&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;518&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Designated related party</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>For the purposes of this Part, the Superintendent may, with respect to a particular company, designate as a related party of the company</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;518&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any person or class of persons whose direct or indirect interest in or relationship with the company or a related party of the company might reasonably be expected to affect the exercise of the best judgment of the company in respect of a transaction; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;518&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any person who is a party to any agreement, commitment or understanding referred to in section 9 if the company referred to in that section is the particular company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;518&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;518&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Idem</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>Where a person is designated as a related party of a company pursuant to subsection (4), the Superintendent may also designate any entity in which the person has a substantial investment and any entity controlled by such an entity to be a related party of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;518&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;518&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Deemed related party</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>Where, in contemplation of a person becoming a related party of a company, the company enters into a transaction with the person, the person is deemed for the purposes of this Part to be a related party of the company in respect of that transaction.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;518&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;518&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Holders of exempted shares</MarginalNote><Label>(7)</Label><Text>The Superintendent may, by order, designate a class of non-voting shares of a company for the purpose of this subsection. If a class of non-voting shares of a company is so designated, a person is deemed, notwithstanding paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>), not to be a related party of the company if the person would otherwise be a related party of the company only because the person has a significant interest in that class.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;518&quot;,ss=&quot;8&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;518&quot;,ss=&quot;8&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Determination of substantial investment</MarginalNote><Label>(8)</Label><Text>For the purpose of determining whether an entity or a person has a substantial investment for the purposes of paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>), the references to “control” and “controlled” in section 10 shall be construed as references to “control, within the meaning of section 3, determined without regard to paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)” and “controlled, within the meaning of section 3, determined without regard to paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)”, respectively.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;518&quot;,ss=&quot;9&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;518&quot;,ss=&quot;9&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Determination of control</MarginalNote><Label>(9)</Label><Text>For the purposes of paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), “controlled” means “controlled, within the meaning of section 3, determined without regard to paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)”.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 518;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 277;</li><li> 2000, c. 12, s. 158.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;519&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;519&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Non-application of Part</MarginalNote><Label>519.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;519&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>This Part does not apply in respect of any transaction entered into prior to the coming into force of this Part but, after the coming into force of this Part, any modification of, addition to, or renewal or extension of a prior transaction is subject to this Part.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;519&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;519&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Idem</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>This Part does not apply in respect of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;519&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>assets of a segregated fund maintained pursuant to section 451 if</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;519&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>all the policies in respect of which the fund is maintained are held by one person or all the amounts in respect of which it is maintained are retained on the direction of one person, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;519&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>the assets of the fund reflect the securities upon which a generally recognized market index is based and the weighting of those securities in that index;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;519&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the issue by the company of shares of any class when fully paid for in money or when issued</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;519&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>in accordance with any provisions for the conversion of other issued and outstanding securities of the company into shares of that class,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;519&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>as a share dividend,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;519&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>in exchange for shares of a body corporate that has been continued as a company under Part III,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;519&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;iv&quot;"><Label>(iv)</Label><Text>in accordance with the terms of an amalgamation under Part VI,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;519&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;v&quot;"><Label>(v)</Label><Text>by way of consideration in accordance with the terms of a sale agreement under Part VI, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;519&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;vi&quot;"><Label>(vi)</Label><Text>with the approval in writing of the Superintendent, in exchange for shares of another body corporate;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;519&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the payment of dividends or policy dividends or bonuses by a company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;519&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>transactions that consist of the payment or provision by a company to persons who are related parties of the company of salaries, fees, stock options, policy premiums, pension benefits, incentive benefits or other benefits or remuneration in their capacity as directors, officers or employees of the company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;519&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>transactions approved by the Minister under subsection 715(1) of this Act or subsection 678(1) of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="B-1.01">Bank Act</XRefExternal>; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;519&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if a company is controlled by a widely held insurance holding company or a widely held bank holding company, transactions approved by the Superintendent that are entered as part of, or in the course of, a restructuring of the holding company or of any entity controlled by it.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;519&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;519&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Nothing in paragraph (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>) exempts from the application of this Part the payment by a company of fees or other remuneration to a person for</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;519&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the provision of services referred to in paragraph 528(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>); or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;519&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>duties outside the ordinary course of business of the company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;519&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;519&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception for holding body corporate</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>A holding body corporate of a company is not a related party of the company if the holding body corporate is a Canadian financial institution that is referred to in any of paragraphs (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>) of the definition “financial institution” in subsection 2(1).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;519&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;519&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Substantial investment — related party exception</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>Where a holding body corporate of a company is, because of subsection (4), not a related party of the company, any entity in which the holding body corporate has a substantial investment is not a related party of the company if no related party of the company has a substantial investment in the entity otherwise than through the control of the holding body corporate.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 519, c. 48, s. 495;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 278;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 428;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 241.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;520&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;520&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Meaning of <DefinedTermEn>transaction</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><Label>520.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;520&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>For the purposes of this Part, entering into a transaction with a related party of a company includes</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;520&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>making a guarantee on behalf of the related party;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;520&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>making an investment in any securities of the related party;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;520&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>taking an assignment of or otherwise acquiring a loan made by a third party to the related party;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;520&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>taking a security interest in the securities of the related party; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;520&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>causing the company to be reinsured by the related party against any risk undertaken by the company under its policies.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;520&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;520&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Interpretation</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>For the purposes of this Part, the fulfilment of an obligation under the terms of any transaction, including the payment of interest on a loan or deposit and the making of a payment or an advance under a policy, is part of the transaction, and not a separate transaction.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;520&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;520&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Meaning of <DefinedTermEn>loan</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>For the purposes of this Part, <DefinedTermEn>loan</DefinedTermEn> includes a deposit, a financial lease, a conditional sales contract, a repurchase agreement and any other similar arrangement for obtaining funds or credit, but does not include investments in securities or the making of an acceptance, endorsement or other guarantee.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;520&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;520&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Security of a related party</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>For the purposes of this Part, <DefinedTermEn>security</DefinedTermEn> of a related party includes an option, transferable by delivery, to demand delivery of a specified number or amount of shares of the related party at a fixed price within a specified time.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 520;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 242.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XI&quot;,gb=&quot;s_521&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XI&quot;,gb=&quot;s_521&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Prohibited Related Party Transactions</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;521&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;521&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Prohibited transactions</MarginalNote><Label>521.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;521&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Except as provided in this Part, a company shall not, directly or indirectly, enter into any transaction with a related party of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;521&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;521&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Transaction of entity</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Without limiting the generality of subsection (1), a company is deemed to have indirectly entered into a transaction in respect of which this Part applies where the transaction is entered into by an entity that is controlled by the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;521&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;521&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Subsection (2) does not apply where an entity that is controlled by a company is a financial institution incorporated or formed under the laws of a province and is subject to regulation and supervision, satisfactory to the Minister, regarding transactions with related parties of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;521&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;521&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Idem</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Subsection (2) does not apply in respect of transactions entered into by an entity that is controlled by a company if the transaction is a prescribed transaction or is one of a class of prescribed transactions.</Text></Subsection></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XI&quot;,gb=&quot;s_522&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XI&quot;,gb=&quot;s_522&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Permitted Related Party Transactions</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;522&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;522&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Nominal value transactions</MarginalNote><Label>522.</Label><Text>Notwithstanding anything in this Part, a company may enter into a transaction with a related party of the company if the value of the transaction is nominal or immaterial to the company when measured by criteria that have been established by the conduct review committee of the company and approved in writing by the Superintendent.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;523&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;523&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Reinsurance</MarginalNote><Label>523.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;523&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company may, subject to subsection (2) and to Division III of Part VI, cause itself to be reinsured by a related party of the company against any risk undertaken by the company under its policies.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;523&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;523&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction re related parties</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Except with the approval of the Superintendent, a company may cause itself to be reinsured in respect of risks undertaken under its policies by a related party of the company only if the related party is</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;523&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a company; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;523&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a foreign company that, in Canada, reinsures those risks.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;523&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;523&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The approval of the Superintendent under subsection (2) is not required if the reinsurance transaction was approved by the Minister or the Superintendent under subsection 254(2) or (2.01).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 523;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 243.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;524&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;524&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Risks of related party</MarginalNote><Label>524.</Label><Text>A company may, subject to Division III of Part VI, reinsure any risks undertaken by a related party of the company.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 524;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 244(F).</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;525&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;525&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Secured loans</MarginalNote><Label>525.</Label><Text>A company may make a loan to or a guarantee on behalf of a related party of the company or take an assignment of or otherwise acquire a loan to a related party of the company if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;525&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the loan or guarantee is fully secured by securities of or guaranteed by the Government of Canada or the government of a province; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;525&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the loan is a loan permitted by section 469 made to a related party who is a natural person on the security of a mortgage of the principal residence of that related party.</Text></Paragraph></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;526&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;526&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Borrowing, etc., from related party</MarginalNote><Label>526.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;526&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company may borrow money from or issue debt obligations to a related party of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;526&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;526&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Segregated funds</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A company may issue policies to a related party of the company or accept or retain on the direction of a policyholder or beneficiary who is a related party amounts that are payable as</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;526&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>policy dividends or bonuses, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;526&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>policy proceeds on the surrender or maturity of the policy or on the death of the person whose life is insured</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>where the liabilities of the company in respect of the policies or the amounts accepted or retained vary in amount depending on the market value of a specified group of assets.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;527&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;527&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Acquisition of assets</MarginalNote><Label>527.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;527&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company may purchase or otherwise acquire from a related party of the company</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;527&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>securities of or guaranteed by the Government of Canada or the government of a province;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;527&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>assets fully secured by securities of or guaranteed by the Government of Canada or the government of a province; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;527&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>goods for use in the ordinary course of business.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;527&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;527&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Sale of assets</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Subject to section 512, a company may sell any assets of the company to a related party of the company if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;527&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the consideration for the assets is fully paid in money; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;527&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>there is an active market for those assets.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;527&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;527&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Asset transactions with financial institutions</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Notwithstanding any of the provisions of subsections (1) and (2), a company may, in the normal course of business and pursuant to arrangements that have been approved by the Superintendent in writing, acquire or dispose of any assets, other than real property, from or to a related party of the company that is a financial institution.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;527&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;527&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Asset transactions in restructuring</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Notwithstanding any of the provisions of subsections (1) and (2), a company may acquire any assets from, or dispose of any assets to, a related party of the company as part of, or in the course of, a restructuring, if the acquisition or disposition has been approved in writing by the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;527&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;527&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Idem</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>A company may lease assets</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;527&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>from a related party of the company for use in the ordinary course of business of the company, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;527&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>to a related party of the company,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>if the lease payments are made in money.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;527&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;527&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Approval under subsection 254(2) or (2.01)</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>A company or society may acquire any assets from, or dispose of any assets to, a related party of the company under a transaction that is approved by the Minister or the Superintendent under subsection 254(2) or (2.01).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 527;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 245.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;528&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;528&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Services</MarginalNote><Label>528.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;528&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company may enter into a transaction with a related party of the company if the transaction</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;528&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>subject to subsection (2), consists of a written contract for the purchase by the company of services used in the ordinary course of business;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;528&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>subject to subsection (4), involves the provision of services normally offered to the public by the company in the ordinary course of business;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;528&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>consists of a written contract with a financial institution or an entity in which the company is permitted to have a substantial investment pursuant to section 495 that is a related party of the company</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;528&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>for the networking of any services provided by the company or the financial institution or entity, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;528&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>for the referral of any person by the company to the financial institution or entity, or for the referral of any person by the financial institution or entity to the company;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;528&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>consists of a written contract for such pension or benefit plans or their management or administration as are incidental to directorships or to the employment of officers or employees of the company or its subsidiaries; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;528&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>involves the provision by the company of management, advisory, accounting, information processing or other services in relation to any business of the related party.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;528&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;528&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where a company has entered into a contract pursuant to paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) and the contract, when taken together with all other such contracts entered into by the company, results in all or substantially all of the management functions of the company being exercised by persons who are not employees of the company, the Superintendent may, by order, if the Superintendent considers that result to be inappropriate, require the company, within such time as may be specified in the order, to take all steps necessary to ensure that management functions that are integral to the carrying on of business by the company are exercised by employees of the company to the extent specified in the order.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;528&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;528&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Despite subsection 521(2), a company is deemed not to have indirectly entered into a transaction in respect of which this Part applies if the transaction is entered into by an entity that is controlled by the company and the business of which is limited to the activity referred to in paragraph 495(2)(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>) and the transaction is on terms and conditions at least as favourable to the company as market terms and conditions, as defined in subsection 534(2).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;528&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;528&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Services</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>The provision of services, for the purposes of paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>), does not include the making of loans or guarantees.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 528;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 279;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 246.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;528.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;528.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Transactions with holding companies</MarginalNote><Label>528.1</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;528.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection (2) and sections 528.2 and 528.3, if a widely held insurance holding company or a widely held bank holding company has a significant interest in any class of shares of a company, the company may enter into any transaction with the holding company or with any other related party of the company that is an entity in which the holding company has a substantial investment.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;528.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;528.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Policies and procedures</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The company shall adhere to policies and procedures established under subsection 204(3) when entering into the transaction.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 429.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;528.2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;528.2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction</MarginalNote><Label>528.2</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;528.2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If a company enters into a transaction with a related party of the company with whom the company may enter into transactions under subsection 528.1(1) and that is not a federal financial institution, the company shall not directly or indirectly make, take an assignment of or otherwise acquire a loan to the related party, make an acceptance, endorsement or other guarantee on behalf of the related party or make an investment in the securities of the related party if, immediately following the transaction, the aggregate financial exposure, as that expression is defined by the regulations, of the company would exceed</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;528.2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in respect of all transactions of the company with the related party, the prescribed percentage of the company’s regulatory capital or, if no percentage is prescribed, five per cent of the company’s regulatory capital; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;528.2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in respect of all transactions of the company with such related parties of the company, the prescribed percentage of the company’s regulatory capital or, if no percentage is prescribed, ten per cent of the company’s regulatory capital.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;528.2&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;528.2&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Order</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If the Superintendent is of the opinion that it is necessary for the protection of the interests of the policyholders and creditors of a company, the Superintendent may, by order,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;528.2&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>reduce the limit in paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) that would otherwise apply to the company; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;528.2&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>impose limits on transactions by the company with related parties with whom the company may enter into transactions under subsection 528.1(1) that are federal financial institutions.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;528.2&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;528.2&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Order</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The Superintendent may, by order, increase the limit in paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) that would otherwise apply to a company on transactions by the company with related parties that are financial institutions that are regulated in a manner acceptable to the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 429.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;528.3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;528.3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Assets transactions</MarginalNote><Label>528.3</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;528.3&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Despite subsection 527(3), a company shall not, without the approval of the Superintendent and its conduct review committee, directly or indirectly acquire assets from a related party of the company with whom the company may enter into transactions under subsection 528.1(1) that is not a federal financial institution, or directly or indirectly transfer assets to such a related party if</Text><FormulaGroup><Formula><FormulaText>A + B &gt; C</FormulaText></Formula><FormulaConnector>where</FormulaConnector><FormulaDefinition><FormulaTerm>A</FormulaTerm><Text>is the value of the assets;</Text></FormulaDefinition><FormulaDefinition><FormulaTerm>B</FormulaTerm><Text>is the total value of all assets that the company directly or indirectly acquired from, or directly or indirectly transferred to, that related party in the 12 months ending immediately before the acquisition or transfer, other than assets acquired by or transferred to the company under transactions permitted by section 522; and</Text></FormulaDefinition><FormulaDefinition><FormulaTerm>C</FormulaTerm><Text>is five per cent, or the percentage that may be prescribed, of the total value of the assets of the company, as shown in the last annual statement of the company prepared before the acquisition or transfer.</Text></FormulaDefinition></FormulaGroup></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;528.3&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;528.3&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The prohibition in subsection (1) does not apply in respect of assets purchased or otherwise acquired under subsection 527(1), assets sold under subsection 527(2) or any other assets that may be prescribed.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;528.3&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;528.3&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The approval of the Superintendent under this section is not required if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;528.3&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the company acquires or transfers assets under a transaction that is approved by the Minister or the Superintendent under subsection 254(2) or (2.01);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;528.3&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the company or its subsidiary acquires shares of, or ownership interests in, an entity for which the approval of the Minister under Part VII or subsection 495(7) is required or the approval of the Superintendent under subsection 495(8) is required.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;528.3&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;528.3&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Value of assets</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>For the purposes of “A” in subsection (1), the value of the assets is</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;528.3&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of assets that are acquired, the purchase price of the assets or, if the assets are shares of, or ownership interests in, an entity the assets of which will be included in the annual statement of the company after the acquisition, the fair market value of the assets; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;528.3&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of assets that are transferred, the book value of the assets as stated in the last annual statement of the company prepared before the transfer or, if the assets are shares of, or ownership interests in, an entity the assets of which were included in the last annual statement of the company before the transfer, the value of the assets as stated in the annual statement.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;528.3&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;528.3&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Total value of all assets</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>For the purposes of subsection (1), the total value of all assets that the company or any of its subsidiaries has acquired during the period of twelve months referred to in subsection (1) is the purchase price of the assets or, if the assets are shares of, or ownership interests in, an entity the assets of which immediately after the acquisition were included in the annual statement of the company, the fair market value of the assets of the entity at the date of the acquisition.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;528.3&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;528.3&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Total value of all assets</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>For the purposes of subsection (1), the total value of all assets that the company or any of its subsidiaries has transferred during the period of twelve months referred to in subsection (1) is the book value of the assets as stated in the last annual statement of the company prepared before the transfer or, if the assets are shares of, or ownership interests in, an entity the assets of which were included in the last annual statement of the company before the transfer, the value of the assets of the entity as stated in the annual statement.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 429;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 247.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;529&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;529&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Directors and officers and their interests</MarginalNote><Label>529.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;529&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection (2) and sections 530 and 531, a company may enter into any transaction with a related party of the company if the related party is</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;529&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a natural person who is a related party of the company only because the person is</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;529&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>a director or senior officer of the company or of an entity that controls the company, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;529&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>the spouse or common-law partner, or a child who is less than eighteen years of age, of a director or senior officer of the company or of an entity that controls the company; or</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;529&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an entity that is a related party of the company only because the entity is controlled by</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;529&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>a director or senior officer of the company or of an entity that controls the company, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;529&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>the spouse or common-law partner, or a child who is less than eighteen years of age, of a director or senior officer referred to in subparagraph (i).</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;529&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;529&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Loans to full-time officers</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A company may, with respect to a related party of the company referred to in subsection (1) who is a full-time senior officer of the company, make, take an assignment of or otherwise acquire a loan to the related party only if the aggregate principal amount of all outstanding loans to the related party that are held by the company and its subsidiaries, together with the principal amount of the proposed loan, does not exceed the greater of twice the annual salary of the related party and $100,000.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;529&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;529&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Subsection (2) does not apply in respect of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;529&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>loans referred to in paragraph 525(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>), and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;529&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>margin loans referred to in section 531,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>and the amount of any such loans to a related party of a company shall not be included in determining, for the purposes of subsection (2), the aggregate principal amount of all outstanding loans made by the company to the related party.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;529&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;529&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Preferred terms — loan to senior officer</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Notwithstanding section 534, a company may make a loan, other than a margin loan, to a senior officer of the company on terms and conditions more favourable to the officer than market terms and conditions, as defined in subsection 534(2), if the terms and conditions of the loan have been approved by the conduct review committee of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;529&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;529&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Preferred terms — loan to spouse or common-law partner</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>Notwithstanding section 534, a company may make a loan referred to in paragraph 525(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) to the spouse or common-law partner of a senior officer of the company on terms and conditions more favourable than market terms and conditions, as defined in subsection 534(2), if the terms and conditions of the loan have been approved by the conduct review committee of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;529&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;529&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Preferred terms — other financial services</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>Notwithstanding section 534, a company may offer financial services, other than loans or guarantees, to a senior officer of the company, or to the spouse or common-law partner, or a child who is less than eighteen years of age, of a senior officer of the company, on terms and conditions more favourable than market terms and conditions, as defined in subsection 534(2), if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;529&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the financial services are offered by the company to employees of the company on those favourable terms and conditions; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;529&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the conduct review committee of the company has approved the practice of making those financial services available on those favourable terms and conditions to senior officers of the company or to the spouses or common-law partners, or the children under eighteen years of age, of senior officers of the company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 529;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 280;</li><li> 2000, c. 12, ss. 155, 158.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;530&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;530&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Board approval required</MarginalNote><Label>530.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;530&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Except with the concurrence of at least two thirds of the directors present at a meeting of the board of directors of the company, a company shall not, with respect to a related party of the company referred to in subsection 529(1),</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;530&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>make, take an assignment of or otherwise acquire a loan to the related party, including a margin loan referred to in section 531,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;530&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>make a guarantee on behalf of the related party, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;530&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>make an investment in the securities of the related party</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>if, immediately following the transaction, the aggregate of</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;530&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the principal amount of all outstanding loans to the related party that are held by the company and its subsidiaries, other than</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;530&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>loans referred to in paragraph 525(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>), and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;530&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>if the related party is a full-time senior officer of the company, loans to the related party that are permitted by subsection 529(2),</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;530&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the sum of all outstanding amounts guaranteed by the company and its subsidiaries on behalf of the related party, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;530&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>where the related party is an entity, the book value of all investments by the company and its subsidiaries in the securities of the entity</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>would exceed 2 per cent of the regulatory capital of the company.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;530&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;530&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limit on transactions with directors, officers and their interests</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A company shall not, with respect to a related party of the company referred to in subsection 529(1),</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;530&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>make, take an assignment of or otherwise acquire a loan to the related party, including a margin loan referred to in section 531,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;530&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>make a guarantee on behalf of the related party, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;530&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>make an investment in the securities of the related party</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>if, immediately following the transaction, the aggregate of</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;530&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the principal amount of all outstanding loans to all related parties of the company referred to in subsection 529(1) that are held by the company and its subsidiaries, other than</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;530&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>loans referred to in section 525, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;530&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>loans permitted by subsection 529(2),</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;530&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the sum of all outstanding amounts guaranteed by the company and its subsidiaries on behalf of all related parties of the company referred to in subsection 529(1), and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;530&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the book value of all investments by the company and its subsidiaries in the securities of all entities that are related parties of the company referred to in subsection 529(1)</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>would exceed 50 per cent of the regulatory capital of the company.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;530&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;530&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exclusion of <Language xml:lang="la">de minimis</Language> transactions</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Loans, guarantees and investments that are referred to in section 522 shall not be included in calculating the aggregate of loans, guarantees and investments referred to in subsections (1) and (2).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 530;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 281.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;531&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;531&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Margin loans</MarginalNote><Label>531.</Label><Text>The Superintendent may establish terms and conditions with respect to the making by a company of margin loans to a director or senior officer of the company.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 531;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 282.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;532&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;532&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exemption by order</MarginalNote><Label>532.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;532&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company may enter into a transaction with a related party of the company if the Superintendent, by order, has exempted the transaction from the provisions of section 521.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;532&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;532&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Conditions for order</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The Superintendent shall not make an order referred to in subsection (1) unless the Superintendent is satisfied that the decision of the company to enter into the transaction has not been and is not likely to be influenced in any significant way by a related party of the company and does not involve in any significant way the interests of a related party of the company.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 532;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 83.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;533&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;533&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Prescribed transactions</MarginalNote><Label>533.</Label><Text>A company may enter into a transaction with a related party of the company if the transaction is a prescribed transaction or one of a class of prescribed transactions.</Text></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XI&quot;,gb=&quot;s_534&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XI&quot;,gb=&quot;s_534&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Restrictions on Permitted Transactions</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;534&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;534&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Market terms and conditions</MarginalNote><Label>534.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;534&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Except as provided in subsections 529(4) to (6), any transaction entered into with a related party of the company shall be on terms and conditions that are at least as favourable to the company as market terms and conditions.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;534&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;534&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Meaning of “market terms and conditions”</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>For the purposes of subsection (1), <DefinedTermEn>market terms and conditions</DefinedTermEn> means</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;534&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in respect of a service or a loan facility offered to the public by the company in the ordinary course of business, terms and conditions that are no more or less favourable than those offered to the public by the company in the ordinary course of business; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;534&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in respect of any other transaction,</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;534&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>terms and conditions, including those relating to price, rent or interest rate, that might reasonably be expected to apply in a similar transaction in an open market under conditions requisite to a fair transaction between parties who are at arm’s length and who are acting prudently, knowledgeably and willingly, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;534&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>if the transaction is one that would not reasonably be expected to occur in an open market between parties who are at arm’s length, terms and conditions, including those relating to price, rent or interest rate, that would reasonably be expected to provide the company with fair value, having regard to all the circumstances of the transaction, and that would be consistent with the parties to the transaction acting prudently, knowledgeably and willingly.</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 534;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 430.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;535&quot;"><Label>535. and 536.</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 1997, c. 15, s. 283]</Repealed></Text></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XI&quot;,gb=&quot;s_537&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XI&quot;,gb=&quot;s_537&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Disclosure</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;537&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;537&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Company obligation</MarginalNote><Label>537.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;537&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where, in respect of any proposed transaction permitted by this Part, other than those referred to in section 522, a company has reason to believe that the other party to the transaction is a related party of the company, the company shall take all reasonable steps to obtain from the other party full disclosure, in writing, of any interest or relationship, direct or indirect, that would make the other party a related party of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;537&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;537&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Reliance on information</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A company and any person who is a director or an officer, employee or agent of the company may rely on any information contained in any disclosure received by the company pursuant to subsection (1) or any information otherwise acquired in respect of any matter that might be the subject of such a disclosure and no action lies against the company or any such person for anything done or omitted in good faith in reliance on any such information.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;538&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;538&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice to Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>538.</Label><Text>If a company has entered into a transaction that the company is prohibited by this Part from entering into, or a company has entered into a transaction for which approval is required under subsection 530(1) without having obtained the approval, the company shall, on becoming aware of that fact, notify the Superintendent without delay.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 538;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 284.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XI&quot;,gb=&quot;s_539&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XI&quot;,gb=&quot;s_539&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Remedial Actions</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;539&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;539&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Order to void contract or to grant other remedy</MarginalNote><Label>539.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;539&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If a company enters into a transaction that it is prohibited from entering into by this Part, the company or the Superintendent may apply to a court for an order setting aside the transaction or for any other appropriate remedy, including an order directing that the related party of the company involved in the transaction account to the company for any profit or gain realized or that any director or senior officer of the company who authorized the transaction compensate the company for any loss or damage incurred by the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;539&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;539&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Time limit</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>An application under subsection (1) in respect of a particular transaction may only be made within the period of three months following the day the notice referred to in section 538 in respect of the transaction is given to the Superintendent or, if no such notice is given, the day the Superintendent becomes aware of the transaction.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;539&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;539&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Certificate</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>For the purposes of subsection (2), a document purporting to have been issued by the Superintendent, certifying the day on which the Superintendent became aware of the transaction, shall, in the absence of evidence to the contrary, be received in evidence as conclusive proof of that fact without proof of the signature or of the official character of the person appearing to have signed the document and without further proof.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 539;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 431.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="1"><Label>PART XII</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">FRATERNAL BENEFIT SOCIETIES</TitleText></Heading><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_540&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_540&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Interpretation</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;540&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;540&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Definitions</MarginalNote><Label>540.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;540&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>In this Part,</Text><Definition Code="se=&quot;540&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{by-law}{règlement administratif}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;540&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{by-law}{règlement administratif}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>by-law</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;540&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{by-law}{règlement administratif}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>règlement administratif</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>by-law</DefinedTermEn> includes the incorporating instrument of a society;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;540&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{permitted entity}{entité admissible}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;540&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{permitted entity}{entité admissible}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>permitted entity</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;540&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{permitted entity}{entité admissible}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>entité admissible</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>permitted entity</DefinedTermEn> means an entity in which a society is permitted to acquire a substantial investment under section 554;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;540&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{subordinate branch}{succursale secondaire}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;540&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{subordinate branch}{succursale secondaire}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>subordinate branch</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;540&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{subordinate branch}{succursale secondaire}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>succursale secondaire</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>subordinate branch</DefinedTermEn> means a division of a society as described in the by-laws of the society;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;540&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{supreme governing body}{conseil supérieur de direction}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;540&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{supreme governing body}{conseil supérieur de direction}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>supreme governing body</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;540&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{supreme governing body}{conseil supérieur de direction}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>conseil supérieur de direction</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>supreme governing body</DefinedTermEn> means a board of directors or any other group within a society having ultimate authority for managing the business and affairs of the society.</Text></Definition></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;540&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;540&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Members of a society’s group</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>For the purpose of section 554, a member of a society’s group is any of the following:</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;540&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a subsidiary of the society;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;540&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an entity in which the society has a substantial investment; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;540&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a prescribed entity in relation to the society.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;540&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;540&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Words of Part IX</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Words and expressions that are defined for the purposes of Part IX and referred to in this Part, other than “permitted entity”, have, for the purposes of this Part, the meanings assigned to them by that Part with any modifications that the circumstances require.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 540;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 432.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_541&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_541&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Powers</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;541&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;541&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Granting of sickness benefits by subordinate branch</MarginalNote><Label>541.</Label><Text>No by-law of a society shall empower or purport to empower any subordinate branch of the society to grant sickness benefits to any member of the branch unless the by-law makes adequate provision to secure on an actuarial basis the solvency of the sick benefit fund of the branch.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;542&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;542&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Society’s business</MarginalNote><Label>542.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;542&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Except as otherwise permitted by this Act, a society shall not carry on a business that does not relate to the business of the insuring of risks in respect of its members or the spouses, common-law partners or children of its members.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;542&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;542&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Additional activities</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A society may</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;542&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>with the consent of the Minister, engage in activities that are reasonably ancillary to the society’s insurance business;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;542&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>engage in fraternal, benevolent or religious activities;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;542&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>hold, manage and otherwise deal with real property;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;542&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>act as an agent for a person, or enter into any other arrangement with a person, in respect of the provision of a service by</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;542&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>a financial institution that is primarily engaged in an insurance business, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;542&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>a body corporate in which a society is permitted by section 554 to have a substantial investment; and</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;542&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>refer persons to a financial institution or body corporate described in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>).</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;542&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;542&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">By-law required</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A society shall not carry on the business of insuring risks unless it is authorized to do so by a by-law of the society passed on the recommendation of the society’s actuary and approved by the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;542&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;542&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Classes of insurance</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>A society shall not insure a risk that is not within a class of insurance that is specified in the order of the Superintendent approving the commencement and carrying on of business by the society. The classes that may be specified in that order are the class of life insurance, the class of accident and sickness insurance or both of those classes.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;542&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;542&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction on leasing</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>A society shall not engage in Canada in any financial leasing of personal property.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 542;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 167;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 285;</li><li> 2000, c. 12, s. 156.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;542.01&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;542.01&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Separate accounts</MarginalNote><Label>542.01</Label><Text>A society shall maintain a separate account in respect of each class of insurance in which it is authorized to insure risks.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 285.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;542.02&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;542.02&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Actuary’s certificate</MarginalNote><Label>542.02</Label><Text>A society’s actuary shall certify whether the society’s rates of benefit are reasonable, and whether the amounts of insurance to be issued by the society are reasonable, having regard to</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;542.02&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the conditions and circumstances for the issuance of policies by the society;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;542.02&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the sufficiency of the rates of contribution to provide for those benefits and those amounts of insurance; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;542.02&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the reasonableness of the loan values, cash values and other equities that may be provided under the policies.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 285.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;542.03&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;542.03&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Segregated fund restriction</MarginalNote><Label>542.03</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;542.03&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Only a society that is authorized to insure risks within the class of life insurance may</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;542.03&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>issue policies where the liabilities of the society in respect of the policies vary in amount depending on the market value of a fund consisting of a specified group of assets; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;542.03&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>accept or retain, on the direction of a policyholder or beneficiary, policy dividends or bonuses or policy proceeds that are payable on the surrender or maturity of the policy or on the death of the person whose life is insured, where the liabilities of the society in respect of the amounts accepted or retained vary in amount depending on the market value of a fund consisting of a specified group of assets.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;542.03&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;542.03&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Segregated funds required</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A society that issues policies described in paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) or accepts or retains amounts described in paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) shall</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;542.03&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>maintain separate accounts in respect of those policies or amounts; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;542.03&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>establish and maintain one or more funds consisting of assets that are segregated from the other assets of the society and that are specified as the assets on the market value of which the liabilities of the society in respect of those policies or amounts depend.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;542.03&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;542.03&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Creation and maintenance of segregated funds</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>For the purpose of establishing or maintaining a segregated fund required by subsection (2), a society may, subject to the regulations, transfer an amount to the separate account maintained in respect of the segregated fund.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;542.03&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;542.03&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Transfers from segregated funds</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>A society may return the current value of an amount transferred under subsection (3) to the account from which the amount was transferred.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;542.03&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;542.03&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Claims against segregated funds</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>A claim against a segregated fund maintained under subsection (2) under a policy, or for an amount in respect of which the fund is maintained, has priority over any other claim against the assets of that fund, including the claims referred to in section 161 of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="W-11">Winding-up and Restructuring Act</XRefExternal>, except to the extent that the payment of that other claim is secured by a security interest in or on a specific, identifiable asset of the segregated fund.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;542.03&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;542.03&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Where fund can satisfy claim</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>The liability of a society under a policy or for an amount in respect of which a segregated fund is maintained under subsection (2) does not, except to the extent that the assets of the fund are insufficient to satisfy a claim for any minimum amount that the society agrees to pay under the policy or in respect of the amount, give rise to a claim against any assets of the society, other than the assets of that fund.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;542.03&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;542.03&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Where fund cannot satisfy claim</MarginalNote><Label>(7)</Label><Text>To the extent that the assets of the fund are insufficient to satisfy the liability of a society under a policy or for an amount in respect of which a segregated fund is maintained under subsection (2), that liability gives rise to a claim against the assets of the society, other than the assets of that fund, and that claim has the priority referred to in subsection 161(2) of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="W-11">Winding-up and Restructuring Act</XRefExternal>.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 285;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 248.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;542.04&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;542.04&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations</MarginalNote><Label>542.04</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;542.04&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations limiting the extent to which a society may cause itself to be reinsured against risks undertaken under its policies.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;542.04&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;542.04&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulation may delegate to Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A regulation made under subsection (1) may provide that the Superintendent may, by order, determine the matters or exercise the discretion that the regulation specifies.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 285;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 249.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;542.05&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;542.05&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction on issuance of annuities and endowment insurance</MarginalNote><Label>542.05</Label><Text>A society may issue annuities or policies of endowment insurance only if it is authorized to insure risks within the class of life insurance.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 285;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 250.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;542.06&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;542.06&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Residential mortgages restriction</MarginalNote><Label>542.06</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;542.06&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A society shall not make a loan in Canada on the security of residential property in Canada for the purpose of purchasing, renovating or improving the property, if the amount of the loan, together with the amount then outstanding of any mortgage having an equal or prior claim against the property, would exceed 80 per cent of the value of the property at the time of the loan.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;542.06&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;542.06&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Subsection (1) does not apply in respect of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;542.06&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a loan made or guaranteed under the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="N-11">National Housing Act</XRefExternal> or any other Act of Parliament by or under which a different limit on the value of property on the security of which the society may make a loan is established;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;542.06&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a loan if repayment of the amount of the loan that exceeds the maximum amount set out in subsection (1) is guaranteed or insured by a government agency or private insurer approved by the Superintendent;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;542.06&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the acquisition by the society from an entity of securities issued or guaranteed by the entity that are secured on any residential property, whether in favour of a trustee or otherwise, or the making of a loan by the society to the entity against the issue of those securities; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;542.06&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a loan secured by a mortgage where</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;542.06&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>the mortgage is taken back by the society on a property disposed of by the society, including where the disposition is by way of the realization of a security interest, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;542.06&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>the mortgage secures payment of an amount payable to the society for the property.</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 285;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 251.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;542.061&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;542.061&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction on charges to borrowers</MarginalNote><Label>542.061</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;542.061&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to any regulations made under subsection (2), a society that has obtained insurance or a guarantee against default on a loan made in Canada on the security of residential property shall not charge a borrower an amount for the insurance or guarantee that exceeds the actual cost to the society of the insurance or guarantee.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;542.061&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;542.061&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;542.061&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the determination of the actual cost to a society for the purposes of subsection (1);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;542.061&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the circumstances in which a society is exempt from the application of subsection (1);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;542.061&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting, in relation to insurance or a guarantee against default on a loan made by a society in Canada on the security of residential property,</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;542.061&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>the arrangements into which the society, its representatives and its employees may or may not enter, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;542.061&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>the payments or benefits that the society, its representatives and its employees may or may not accept from an insurer or the insurer’s affiliates; and</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;542.061&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting any other matters necessary to carry out the purposes of subsection (1).</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;542.061&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;542.061&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations — disclosure</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations respecting the disclosure by a society of information relating to insurance or a guarantee against default on a loan made by the society in Canada on the security of residential property, including regulations respecting</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;542.061&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the information that must be disclosed, including information relating to</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;542.061&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>the person who benefits from the insurance or guarantee,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;542.061&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>the arrangements between the society, its representatives or its employees and the insurer or the insurer’s affiliates, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;542.061&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>the payments and benefits that the society, its representatives and its employees accept from an insurer or the insurer’s affiliates;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;542.061&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the time, place and manner in which and the persons to whom information is to be disclosed; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;542.061&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the circumstances under which a society is not required to disclose information.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2009, c. 2, s. 285.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;542.07&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;542.07&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Policies re security interests</MarginalNote><Label>542.07</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;542.07&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The directors of a society shall establish and the society shall adhere to policies regarding the creation of security interests in property of the society to secure obligations of the society and the acquisition by the society of beneficial interests in property that is subject to security interests.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;542.07&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;542.07&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Order to amend policies</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The Superintendent may, by order, direct a society to amend its policies as specified in the order.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;542.07&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;542.07&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Compliance</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A society shall comply with an order made under subsection (2) within the time specified in the order.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 285;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 433.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;542.071&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;542.071&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations and guidelines</MarginalNote><Label>542.071</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations and the Superintendent may make guidelines respecting the creation by a society of security interests in its property to secure obligations of the society and the acquisition by the society of beneficial interests in property that is subject to security interests.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 433.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;542.08&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;542.08&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction on receivers</MarginalNote><Label>542.08</Label><Text>A society shall not grant to a person the right to appoint a receiver or a receiver and manager of the property or business of the society.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 285.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;542.09&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;542.09&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction on partnerships</MarginalNote><Label>542.09</Label><Text>Except with the approval of the Superintendent, a society may not be a general partner in a limited partnership or a partner in any partnership other than a limited partnership.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 285;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 434.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;542.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;542.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">General restriction</MarginalNote><Label>542.1</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;542.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A society shall not, and shall not permit its prescribed subsidiaries to, enter into any debt obligation, within the meaning assigned to that expression by the regulations, or permit its prescribed subsidiaries to issue any share, other than a common share, if as a result the aggregate of the total debt obligations of the society, determined in the prescribed manner, and the stated capital of the society would exceed the prescribed percentage of the total assets of the society.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;542.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;542.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A society need not include in the aggregate amount calculated for the purpose of subsection (1) the value of any debt obligation or the stated capital of any shares if the value of the debt obligation or the stated capital of the shares is included as part of the regulatory capital of the society.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 285.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;542.11&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;542.11&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction on guarantees</MarginalNote><Label>542.11</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;542.11&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A society shall not guarantee on behalf of any person the payment or repayment of any sum of money unless</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;542.11&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the sum of money is a fixed sum of money with or without interest on it; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;542.11&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the person on whose behalf the society has undertaken to guarantee the payment or repayment has an unqualified obligation to reimburse the society for the full amount of the payment or repayment to be guaranteed.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;542.11&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;542.11&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) does not apply where the person on whose behalf the society has undertaken to guarantee a payment or repayment is a subsidiary of the society.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;542.11&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;542.11&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations imposing terms and conditions in respect of guarantees permitted by this section.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 285;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 435.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;542.12&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;542.12&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Prepayment protected</MarginalNote><Label>542.12</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;542.12&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A society shall not make a loan to a natural person if the loan would be repayable in Canada and the terms would prohibit prepayment of the money advanced or any instalment of that money before its due date.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;542.12&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;542.12&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Non-application of subsection (1)</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Subsection (1) does not apply in respect of a loan</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;542.12&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>that is secured by a mortgage on real property; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;542.12&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>that is made for business purposes and the principal amount of which is more than $100,000 or such other amount as may be prescribed.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 285.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_543&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_543&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Corporate Governance</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;543&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;543&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Majority to reside in Canada</MarginalNote><Label>543.</Label><Text>A majority of the members of the supreme governing body of every society shall at the time of their election or appointment be individuals who are resident in Canada.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;544&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;544&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Head office</MarginalNote><Label>544.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;544&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A society shall at all times have a head office in the province specified in its incorporating instrument or by-laws.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;544&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;544&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Change of head office — different province</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Despite anything contained in its incorporating instrument, any society may, by by-law passed and approved by the votes of at least two thirds of the members entitled to vote by the by-laws of the society who are present or represented at a special meeting duly called for considering the by-law, change the head office of the society from one province to another.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;544&quot;,ss=&quot;2.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;544&quot;,ss=&quot;2.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Change of head office — within a province</MarginalNote><Label>(2.1)</Label><Text>The supreme governing body of a society may, by resolution passed and approved by at least two thirds of the votes cast at a meeting, change the address of the head office within the province specified in the society’s by-laws.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;544&quot;,ss=&quot;2.2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;544&quot;,ss=&quot;2.2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of change of address</MarginalNote><Label>(2.2)</Label><Text>If there is a change of address of the head office of a society, the society shall send a notice of the change to the Superintendent within fifteen days after the change.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;544&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;544&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Maximum period</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A society shall establish by by-law the maximum period of time within which meetings of the society shall be held.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 544;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 286;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 298.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;544.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;544.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Change of name</MarginalNote><Label>544.1</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;544.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Despite anything contained in its incorporating instrument, a society may, by by-law passed and approved by the votes of at least two thirds of the members entitled to vote by the by-laws of the society who are present or represented at a special meeting duly called for considering the by-law, change the name of the society.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;544.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;544.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effective date</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A by-law referred to in subsection (1) is not effective until the Superintendent approves it.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 436.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;545&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;545&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Appointing proxyholder</MarginalNote><Label>545.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;545&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A member who is entitled to vote by by-law of a society may, if the by-laws of the society so provide, by executing an instrument of proxy, appoint a proxyholder or one or more alternate proxyholders, who are not required to be members of the society, to attend and act at the meeting in the manner and to the extent authorized by the proxy and with the authority conferred by the proxy.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;545&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;545&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Validity of proxies</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>An instrument of proxy is not valid at a meeting of a society unless it is filed with the secretary of the society at least ten days before the date of the meeting and it may be revoked at any time.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;545&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;545&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Societies to inform members of rights</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A society for which an order approving the commencement and carrying on of business of life insurance has been made under this Act that has members who are entitled to vote at meetings of the society shall advise each of those members at least once a year by means of a statement printed in prominent type on a premium notice, premium receipt or dividend notice or otherwise, of the rights of the member to attend and to vote in person or by proxy at those meetings and to obtain a blank instrument of proxy on request therefor in writing to the secretary of the society, but in the case of a member who is not in receipt of a regular annual premium notice from the society, notice of the rights of the member to attend and to vote at meetings of the society may be given only at least once every five years.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;546&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;546&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Valuation balance sheet to be sent to members</MarginalNote><Label>546.</Label><Text>Every society for which an order approving the commencement and carrying on of business has been made under this Act shall, not later than June 1 in each year, mail to each member of the society a copy of the valuation balance sheet in the prescribed form and an explanation of the facts concerning the condition of the society or, in lieu thereof, shall publish in its official paper that balance sheet and explanation and mail a copy of the issue of the paper containing the balance sheet and explanation to each of the society’s members.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;547&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;547&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Auditors and actuaries</MarginalNote><Label>547.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;547&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Divisions XIII and XIV of Part VI apply to societies with such modifications as the circumstances require.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;547&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;547&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Appointment of actuary</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The directors of a former-Act society shall, forthwith after the coming into force of this Part, appoint the actuary of the society.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;548&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;548&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">By-laws</MarginalNote><Label>548.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;548&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Unless this Act otherwise provides, the supreme governing body of a society may by resolution make, amend or repeal any by-law that regulates the business or affairs of the society.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;548&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;548&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Deemed by-laws</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Any matter provided for in the incorporating instrument of a former-Act society on the coming into force of this Part that, under this Act, would be provided for in the by-laws of a society is deemed to be provided for in the by-laws of the society.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;548&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;548&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Copies to Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Within thirty days after a by-law of a society comes into effect or is amended, the society shall send a copy of the by-law or the amendment to the Superintendent. A society shall send to the Superintendent, within six months after the coming into force of this subsection, its by-laws that are in effect on the coming into force of this subsection.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 548;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 287.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;549&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;549&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Return</MarginalNote><Label>549.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;549&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Every society shall, each year before June 30 of that year, provide the Superintendent with a return showing</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;549&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the name, residence and citizenship of each director of the society;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;549&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the mailing address of each director;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;549&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the bodies corporate of which each director referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) is an officer or director and the firms of which each director is a member;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;549&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the names of the directors referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) who are officers or employees of the society, and the positions they occupy;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;549&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the date of expiration of the term of each director referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>); and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;549&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the name, address and date of appointment of the auditor of the society.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;549&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;549&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Information</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;549&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any information relating to a director or auditor of a society shown in the latest return made to the Superintendent under subsection (1), other than information referred to in paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>), becomes inaccurate or incomplete,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;549&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a vacancy in the position of auditor of the society occurs or is filled by another person, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;549&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a vacancy on the supreme governing body of the society occurs or is filled,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>the society shall forthwith provide the Superintendent with such information as is required to maintain the return in a complete and accurate form.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 549;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 288.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_550&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_550&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Investments</TitleText></Heading><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_550&quot;,gc=&quot;s_550&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_550&quot;,gc=&quot;s_550&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Application</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;550&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;550&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Non-application of sections 551 to 570</MarginalNote><Label>550.</Label><Text>Sections 551 to 570 do not apply in respect of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;550&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any interest in real property arising through the holding of a security interest in real property;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;550&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any interest in an entity arising through the holding of a security interest in securities of that entity; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;550&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>assets of a segregated fund maintained as required by subsection 542.03(2).</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 550;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 289.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_550&quot;,gc=&quot;s_551&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_550&quot;,gc=&quot;s_551&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">General Constraints on Investments</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;551&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;551&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Investment standards</MarginalNote><Label>551.</Label><Text>The directors of a society shall establish and the society shall adhere to investment and lending policies, standards and procedures that a reasonable and prudent person would apply in respect of a portfolio of investments and loans to avoid undue risk of loss and obtain a reasonable return.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;552&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;552&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction on control and substantial investments</MarginalNote><Label>552.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;552&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to subsections (2) and (3), no society shall acquire control of, or hold, acquire or increase a substantial investment in, any entity other than a permitted entity.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;552&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;552&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception: indirect investments</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A society may acquire control of, or acquire or increase a substantial investment in, an entity other than a permitted entity by way of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;552&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an acquisition of control of an entity referred to in any of paragraphs 554(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>), or of a prescribed entity, that controls or has a substantial investment in the entity; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;552&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an acquisition of shares or ownership interests in the entity by</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;552&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>an entity referred to in any of paragraphs 554(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>), or a prescribed entity, that is controlled by the society, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;552&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>an entity controlled by an entity referred to in any of paragraphs 554(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>), or a prescribed entity, that is controlled by the society.</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;552&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;552&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception: temporary investments, realizations and loan workouts</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A society may acquire control of, or acquire or increase a substantial investment in, an entity by way of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;552&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a temporary investment permitted by section 557;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;552&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an acquisition of shares of a body corporate or of ownership interests in an unincorporated entity permitted by section 558; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;552&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a realization of security permitted by section 559.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;552&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;552&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception: uncontrolled event</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>A society is deemed not to contravene subsection (1) if the society acquires control of, or acquires or increases a substantial investment in, an entity solely as the result of an event not within the control of the society.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;552&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;552&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application of other provision</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>Despite having acquired control of, or a substantial investment in, an entity under a particular provision of this Part, a society may continue to control the entity or hold the substantial investment in the entity as though it had made the acquisition under another provision of this Part so long as the conditions of that other provision are met.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;552&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;552&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Timing of deemed acquisition</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>If a society decides to exercise its right under subsection (5), the society is deemed to be acquiring the control or the substantial investment under the other provision.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 552;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 290;</li><li> 1999, c. 31, s. 144;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 437;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 252.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;553&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;553&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations re limits</MarginalNote><Label>553.</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;553&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the determination of the amount or value of loans, investments and interests for the purposes of sections 550 to 570;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;553&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the loans and investments, and the maximum aggregate amount of all loans and investments, that may be made or acquired by a society and its prescribed subsidiaries to or in a person and any persons connected with that person; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;553&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>specifying the classes of persons who are connected with any person for the purposes of paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>).</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 553;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 437.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_550&quot;,gc=&quot;s_554&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_550&quot;,gc=&quot;s_554&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Subsidiaries and Equity Investments</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;554&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Permitted investments</MarginalNote><Label>554.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to subsections (4) and (5), a society may acquire control of, or acquire or increase a substantial investment in,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a company or a society;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an insurance corporation incorporated or formed by or under an Act of the legislature of a province; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an entity that is incorporated or formed, and regulated, otherwise than by or under an Act of Parliament or of the legislature of a province and that is primarily engaged outside Canada in a business that, if carried on in Canada, would be the business of insurance.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Permitted investments</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Subject to subsections (3) to (5), a society may acquire control of, or acquire or increase a substantial investment in, an entity, other than an entity referred to in any of paragraphs (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>), whose business is limited to one or more of the following:</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>engaging in any financial service activity or in any other activity that a property and casualty company is permitted to engage in under subsection 440(2) or section 441 or 442, other than paragraph 441(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">h</Emphasis>);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>acquiring or holding shares of, or ownership interests in, entities in which a society is permitted under this Part to hold or acquire;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>engaging in the provision of any services exclusively to any or all of the following, so long as the entity is providing those services to the society or any member of the society’s group:</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>the society,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>any member of the society’s group,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>any entity that is primarily engaged in the business of providing financial services,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;iv&quot;"><Label>(iv)</Label><Text>any permitted entity in which an entity referred to in subparagraph (iii) has a substantial investment, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;v&quot;"><Label>(v)</Label><Text>any prescribed person, if it is doing so under prescribed terms and conditions, if any are prescribed;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>engaging in any activity that a society is permitted to engage in, other than an activity referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>), that relates to</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>the promotion, sale, delivery or distribution of a financial product or financial service that is provided by the society or any member of the society’s group, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>if a significant portion of the business of the entity involves an activity referred to in subparagraph (i), the promotion, sale, delivery or distribution of a financial product or financial service that is provided by any other entity that is primarily engaged in the business of providing financial services;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>engaging in the activities referred to in the definition <DefinedTermEn>closed-end fund</DefinedTermEn>, <DefinedTermEn>mutual fund distribution entity</DefinedTermEn> or <DefinedTermEn>mutual fund entity</DefinedTermEn> in subsection 490(1); and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>engaging in prescribed activities, under prescribed terms and conditions, if any are prescribed.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A society may not acquire control of, or acquire or increase a substantial investment in, an entity whose business includes any activity referred to in any of paragraphs (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>) if the entity engages in the business of accepting deposit liabilities or if the activities of the entity include</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>activities that a property and casualty company is not permitted to engage in under any of sections 466, 469 and 478;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any financial intermediary activity that exposes the entity to material market or credit risk, including the activities of a finance entity, a factoring entity and a financial leasing entity;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b.1&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b.1</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the activities of a specialized financing entity;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>dealing in securities, except as may be permitted under paragraph (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>) or as may be permitted to a company under paragraph 440(2)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>acquiring control of or acquiring or holding a substantial investment in another entity unless</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>in the case of an entity that is controlled by the society, the society itself would be permitted under this Part to acquire a substantial investment in the other entity, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>in the case of an entity that is not controlled by the society, the society itself would be permitted to acquire a substantial investment in the other entity under subsection (1) or (2) or 552(2) or paragraph 552(3)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>); or</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any prescribed activity.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;3.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;3.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(3.1)</Label><Text>Despite paragraph (3)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>), a society may acquire control of, or acquire or increase a substantial investment in, any entity that acts as a trustee of a trust if the entity has been authorized under the laws of a province to act as a trustee of a trust and the entity is</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;3.1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a closed-end fund;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;3.1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a mutual fund entity; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;3.1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an entity whose business is limited to engaging in one or more of the following:</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;3.1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>the activities of a mutual fund distribution entity,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;3.1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>any activity that a company is permitted to engage in under subsection 441(1.1), and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;3.1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>the provision of investment counselling services and portfolio management services.</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Control</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection (6) and the regulations, a society may not acquire control of, or acquire or increase a substantial investment in,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an entity referred to in any of paragraphs (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>), unless the society controls, within the meaning of paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), the entity, or would thereby acquire control, within the meaning of that paragraph, of the entity; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an entity whose business includes an activity referred to in paragraph (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>), unless</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>the society controls, within the meaning of paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), the entity, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>subject to prescribed terms and conditions, if any are prescribed, the activities of the entity do not include the acquisition or holding of control of, or the acquisition or holding of shares or other ownership interests in, an entity referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) or an entity that is not a permitted entity.</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Minister’s approval</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>Subject to the regulations, a society may not, without the prior written approval of the Minister, acquire control of, or acquire or increase a substantial investment in, a permitted entity.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Control not required</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>A society need not control an entity referred to in paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>), or an entity that is incorporated or formed otherwise than by or under an Act of Parliament or of the legislature of a province, if the laws or customary business practices of the country under the laws of which the entity was incorporated or formed do not permit the society to control the entity.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Prohibition on giving up control in fact</MarginalNote><Label>(7)</Label><Text>A society that, under subsection (4), controls an entity may not, without the prior written approval of the Minister, give up control, within the meaning of paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), of the entity while it continues to control the entity.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;8&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;8&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Subsections do not apply</MarginalNote><Label>(8)</Label><Text>If a society controls, within the meaning of paragraph 3(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>), (<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>), an entity, subsection (5) does not apply in respect of any subsequent increases by the society to its substantial investment in the entity so long as the society continues to control the entity.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;9&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;9&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations</MarginalNote><Label>(9)</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;9&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>for the purposes of subsection (4), permitting the acquisition of control or the acquisition or increase of substantial investments, or prescribing the circumstances under which that subsection does not apply or the societies or other entities in respect of which that subsection does not apply, including prescribing societies or other entities on the basis of the activities they engage in; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;554&quot;,ss=&quot;9&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>for the purposes of subsection (5), permitting the acquisition of control or the acquisition or increase of substantial investments, or prescribing the circumstances under which that subsection does not apply or the societies or other entities in respect of which that subsection does not apply, including prescribing societies or other entities on the basis of the activities they engage in.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 554;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 291;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 437;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, ss. 253, 336(F).</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;555&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;555&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Approval for indirect investments</MarginalNote><Label>555.</Label><Text>If a society obtains the approval of the Minister under subsection 554(5) to acquire control of, or to acquire or increase a substantial investment in, an entity and, through that acquisition or increase, the society indirectly acquires control of, or acquires or increases a substantial investment in, another entity that would require the approval of the Minister under subsection 554(5) and that indirect acquisition or increase is disclosed to the Minister in writing before the approval is obtained, the society is deemed to have obtained the approval of the Minister for that indirect acquisition or increase.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 555;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 437.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;556&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;556&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Undertakings</MarginalNote><Label>556.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;556&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If a society controls a permitted entity, other than an entity referred to in any of paragraphs 554(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>), the society shall provide the Superintendent with any undertakings that the Superintendent may require regarding</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;556&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the activities of the entity; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;556&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>access to information about the entity.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;556&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;556&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Undertakings</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If a society acquires control of an entity referred to in paragraph 554(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>), the society shall provide the Superintendent with any undertakings concerning the entity that the Superintendent may require.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;556&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;556&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Agreements with other jurisdictions</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The Superintendent may enter into an agreement with the appropriate official or public body responsible for the supervision of any entity referred to in paragraph 554(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>) in each province or in any other jurisdiction concerning any matters referred to in paragraphs (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) and (<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) or any other matter the Superintendent considers appropriate.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;556&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;556&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Access to records</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Despite any other provision of this Part, a society shall not control a permitted entity, other than an entity referred to in paragraph 554(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>), unless, in the course of the acquisition of control or within a reasonable time after the control is acquired, the society obtains from the permitted entity an undertaking to provide the Superintendent with reasonable access to the records of the permitted entity.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 556;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 437.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_550&quot;,gc=&quot;s_557&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_550&quot;,gc=&quot;s_557&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Exceptions and Exclusions</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;557&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;557&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Temporary investments in entity</MarginalNote><Label>557.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;557&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection (4), a society may, by way of a temporary investment, acquire control of, or acquire or increase a substantial investment in, an entity but, within two years, or any other period that may be specified or approved by the Superintendent, after acquiring control or after acquiring or increasing the substantial investment, as the case may be, it shall do all things necessary to ensure that it no longer controls the entity or has a substantial investment in the entity.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;557&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;557&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Transitional</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Despite subsection (1), if a society that was in existence immediately before June 1, 1992 had an investment in an entity on September 27, 1990 that is a substantial investment within the meaning of section 10 and the society subsequently increases that substantial investment by way of a temporary investment, the society shall, within two years, or any other period that is specified or approved by the Superintendent, after increasing the substantial investment, do all things necessary to ensure that its substantial investment in the entity is no greater than it was on September 27, 1990.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;557&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;557&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Extension</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The Superintendent may, in the case of any particular society that makes an application under this subsection, extend the period of two years, or the other period specified or approved by the Superintendent, that is referred to in subsection (1) or (2) for any further period or periods, and on any terms and conditions, that the Superintendent considers necessary.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;557&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;557&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Temporary investment</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>If a society, by way of temporary investment, acquires control of, or acquires or increases a substantial investment in, an entity for which the approval of the Minister would have been required under subsection 554(5) if the society had acquired the control, or acquired or increased the substantial investment, under section 554, the society must, within 90 days after acquiring control or after acquiring or increasing the substantial investment,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;557&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>apply to the Minister for approval to retain control of the entity or to continue to hold the substantial investment in the entity for a period specified by the Minister or for an indeterminate period on any terms and conditions that the Minister considers appropriate; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;557&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>do all things necessary to ensure that, on the expiry of the 90 days, it no longer controls the entity or does not have a substantial investment in the entity.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 557;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 437;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 254.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;558&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;558&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Loan workouts</MarginalNote><Label>558.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;558&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Despite anything in this Part, if a society or any of its subsidiaries has made a loan to an entity and, under the terms of the agreement between the society, or any of its subsidiaries, and the entity with respect to the loan and any other documents governing the terms of the loan, a default has occurred, the society may acquire</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;558&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if the entity is a body corporate, all or any of the shares of the body corporate;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;558&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if the entity is an unincorporated entity, all or any of the ownership interests in the entity;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;558&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>all or any of the shares or all or any of the ownership interests in any entity that is an affiliate of the entity; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;558&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>all or any of the shares of a body corporate that is primarily engaged in holding shares of, ownership interests in or assets acquired from the entity or any of its affiliates.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;558&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;558&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Obligation</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If a society acquires shares or ownership interests in an entity under subsection (1), the society shall, within five years after acquiring them, do all things necessary to ensure that the society does not control the entity or have a substantial investment in the entity.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;558&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;558&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Transitional</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Despite subsection (1), if a society that was in existence immediately before June 1, 1992 had an investment in an entity on September 27, 1990 that is a substantial investment within the meaning of section 10 and the society later increases that substantial investment by way of an investment made under subsection (1), the society shall, within five years after increasing the substantial investment, do all things necessary to ensure that its substantial investment in the entity is no greater than it was on September 27, 1990.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;558&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;558&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Extension</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>The Superintendent may, in the case of any particular society that makes an application under this subsection, extend the period of five years referred to in subsection (2) or (3) for any further period or periods, and on any terms and conditions, that the Superintendent considers necessary.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;558&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;558&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception — entities controlled by foreign governments</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>Despite anything in this Part, if a society has made a loan to, or holds a debt obligation of, the government of a foreign country or an entity controlled by the government of a foreign country and, under the terms of the agreement between the society and that government or the entity, as the case may be, and any other documents governing the terms of the loan or debt obligation, a default has occurred, the society may acquire all or any of the shares of, or ownership interests in, that entity or in any other entity designated by that government, if the acquisition is part of a debt restructuring program of that government.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;558&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;558&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Time for holding shares</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>If a society acquires any shares or ownership interests under subsection (5), the society may, on any terms and conditions that the Superintendent considers appropriate, hold those shares or ownership interests for an indeterminate period or for any other period that the Superintendent may specify.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;558&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;558&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(7)</Label><Text>If, under subsection (1), a society acquires control of, or acquires or increases a substantial investment in, an entity that it would otherwise be permitted to acquire or increase under section 554, the society may retain control of the entity or continue to hold the substantial investment for an indeterminate period, if the approval in writing of the Minister is obtained before the end of the period referred to in subsection (2) or (3), including any extension of it granted under subsection (4).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 558;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 292;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 437.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;559&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;559&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Realizations</MarginalNote><Label>559.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;559&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Despite anything in this Act, a society may acquire</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;559&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an investment in a body corporate,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;559&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an interest in an unincorporated entity, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;559&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an interest in real property,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>if the investment or interest is acquired through the realization of a security interest held by the society or any of its subsidiaries.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;559&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;559&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Disposition</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If a society acquires control of, or acquires a substantial investment in, an entity by way of the realization of a security interest held by the society or any of its subsidiaries, the society shall, within five years after the day on which control or the substantial investment is acquired, do all things necessary, or cause its subsidiary to do all things necessary, as the case may be, to ensure that the society no longer controls the entity or has a substantial investment in the entity.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;559&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;559&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Transitional</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Despite subsection (2), if a society that was in existence immediately before June 1, 1992 had an investment in an entity on September 27, 1990 that is a substantial investment within the meaning of section 10 and the society later increases that substantial investment by way of a realization of a security interest under subsection (1), the society shall, within five years after increasing the substantial investment, do all things necessary to ensure that its substantial investment in the entity is no greater than it was on September 27, 1990.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;559&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;559&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Extension</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>The Superintendent may, in the case of any particular society that makes an application under this subsection, extend the period of five years referred to in subsection (2) or (3) for any further period or periods, and on any terms and conditions, that the Superintendent considers necessary.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;559&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;559&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>If, under subsection (1), a society acquires control of, or acquires or increases a substantial investment in, an entity that it would otherwise be permitted to acquire or increase under section 554, the society may retain control of the entity or continue to hold the substantial investment for an indeterminate period if the approval in writing of the Minister is obtained before the end of the period referred to in subsection (2) or (3), including any extension of it granted under subsection (4).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 559;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 293;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 437.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;560&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;560&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations restricting ownership</MarginalNote><Label>560.</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations restricting the ownership under sections 554 to 559 by a society of shares of a body corporate or of ownership interest in an unincorporated entity and imposing terms and conditions applicable to societies that own such shares or interests.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 560;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 437.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_550&quot;,gc=&quot;s_561&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_550&quot;,gc=&quot;s_561&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Portfolio Limits</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;561&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;561&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exclusion from portfolio limits</MarginalNote><Label>561.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;561&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The value of all loans, investments and interests acquired by a society and any of its prescribed subsidiaries as a result of a realization of a security interest or pursuant to section 558 shall not be included in calculating the value of loans, investments and interests of the society and its prescribed subsidiaries under sections 562 to 566</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;561&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>for a period of twelve years following the day on which the interest was acquired, in the case of an interest in real property; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;561&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>for a period of five years after the day on which the loan, investment or interest was acquired, in the case of a loan, investment or interest, other than an interest in real property.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;561&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;561&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Extension</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The Superintendent may, in the case of any particular society, extend any period referred to in subsection (1) for such further period or periods, and on such terms and conditions, as the Superintendent considers necessary.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 561;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 294.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_550&quot;,gc=&quot;s_562&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_550&quot;,gc=&quot;s_562&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Consumer and Commercial Lending by Societies</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;562&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;562&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Lending limit</MarginalNote><Label>562.</Label><Text>A society shall not, and shall not permit its prescribed subsidiaries to,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;562&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>make or acquire a commercial loan or a loan to a natural person, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;562&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>acquire control of a permitted entity that holds commercial loans or loans to natural persons</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>where the aggregate value of all such loans held by the society and its prescribed subsidiaries exceeds, or the acquisition or making of the loan or the acquisition of control of the body corporate would cause the aggregate value of all such loans held by the society and its prescribed subsidiaries to exceed, the prescribed percentage of the total assets of the society.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 562;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 438.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_550&quot;,gc=&quot;s_563&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_550&quot;,gc=&quot;s_563&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Real Property</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;563&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;563&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limit on total property interest</MarginalNote><Label>563.</Label><Text>A society shall not, and shall not permit its prescribed subsidiaries to,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;563&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>purchase or otherwise acquire an interest in real property, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;563&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>make an improvement to any real property in which the society or any of its prescribed subsidiaries has an interest</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>if the aggregate value of all interests of the society in real property exceeds, or the acquisition of the interest or the making of the improvement would cause that aggregate value to exceed, an amount determined in accordance with the regulations.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 563;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 439.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;564&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;564&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations</MarginalNote><Label>564.</Label><Text>For the purposes of this Part, the Governor in Council may make regulations</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;564&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>defining the interests of a society in real property;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;564&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>determining the method of valuing those interests; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;564&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the determination of an amount for the purpose of each of sections 563, 565 and 566.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 564;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 439.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_550&quot;,gc=&quot;s_565&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_550&quot;,gc=&quot;s_565&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Equities</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;565&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;565&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limits on equity acquisitions</MarginalNote><Label>565.</Label><Text>A society shall not, and shall not permit its prescribed subsidiaries to,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;565&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>purchase or otherwise acquire any participating shares of any body corporate or any ownership interests in any unincorporated entity, other than those of a permitted entity in which the society has, or by virtue of the acquisition would have, a substantial investment, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;565&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>acquire control of an entity that holds shares or ownership interests referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>),</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>if the aggregate value of</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;565&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>all participating shares, excluding participating shares of permitted entities in which the society has a substantial investment, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;565&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>all ownership interests in unincorporated entities, other than ownership interests in permitted entities in which the society has a substantial investment,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>beneficially owned by the society and its prescribed subsidiaries exceeds, or the purchase or acquisition would cause that aggregate value to exceed, an amount determined in accordance with the regulations.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 565;</li><li> 1993, c. 34, s. 84(F);</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 295;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 439.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_550&quot;,gc=&quot;s_566&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_550&quot;,gc=&quot;s_566&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Aggregate Limit</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;566&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;566&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Aggregate limit</MarginalNote><Label>566.</Label><Text>A society shall not, and shall not permit its prescribed subsidiaries to,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;566&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>purchase or otherwise acquire</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;566&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>participating shares of a body corporate, other than those of a permitted entity in which the society has, or by virtue of the acquisition would have, a substantial investment,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;566&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>ownership interests in an unincorporated entity, other than ownership interests in a permitted entity in which the society has, or by virtue of the acquisition would have, a substantial investment, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;566&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>interests in real property, or</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;566&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>make an improvement to real property in which the society or any of its prescribed subsidiaries has an interest</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>if the aggregate value of</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;566&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>all participating shares and ownership interests referred to in subparagraphs (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)(i) and (ii) that are beneficially owned by the society and its prescribed subsidiaries, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;566&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>all interests of the society in real property referred to in subparagraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)(iii)</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>exceeds, or the acquisition or the making of the improvement would cause that aggregate value to exceed, an amount determined in accordance with the regulations.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 566;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 296;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 439.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_550&quot;,gc=&quot;s_567&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_550&quot;,gc=&quot;s_567&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Miscellaneous</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;567&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;567&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Divestment order</MarginalNote><Label>567.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;567&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The Superintendent may, by order, direct a society to dispose of, within such period as the Superintendent considers reasonable, any loan, investment or interest made or acquired in contravention of this Part.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;567&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;567&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Idem</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;567&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a society</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;567&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>fails to provide or obtain within a reasonable time the undertakings referred to in section 556, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;567&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>is in default of an undertaking referred to in section 556 and the default is not remedied within ninety days after the day of receipt by the society of a notice from the Superintendent of the default, or</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;567&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a body corporate referred to in section 556 is in default of an undertaking referred to in section 556 and the default is not remedied within ninety days after the day of receipt by the society of a notice from the Superintendent of the default,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>the Superintendent may, by order, require the society, within such period as the Superintendent considers reasonable, to do all things necessary to ensure that the society no longer has a substantial investment in the body corporate to which the undertaking relates.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;568&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;568&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Deemed temporary investment</MarginalNote><Label>568.</Label><Text>If a society controls or has a substantial investment in an entity as permitted by this Part and the society becomes aware of a change in the business or affairs of the entity that, if the change had taken place before the acquisition of control or of the substantial investment, would have caused the entity not to be a permitted entity or would have been such that approval for the acquisition would have been required under subsection 554(5), the society is deemed to have acquired, on the day the society becomes aware of the change, a temporary investment in respect of which section 557 applies.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 568;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 297;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 440.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;569&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;569&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Asset transactions</MarginalNote><Label>569.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;569&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A society shall not, and shall not permit its subsidiaries to, without the approval of the Superintendent, acquire assets from a person or transfer assets to a person if</Text><FormulaGroup><Formula><FormulaText>A + B &gt; C</FormulaText></Formula><FormulaConnector>where</FormulaConnector><FormulaDefinition><FormulaTerm>A</FormulaTerm><Text>is the value of the assets;</Text></FormulaDefinition><FormulaDefinition><FormulaTerm>B</FormulaTerm><Text>is the total value of all assets that the society and its subsidiaries acquired from or transferred to that person in the twelve months ending immediately before the acquisition or transfer; and</Text></FormulaDefinition><FormulaDefinition><FormulaTerm>C</FormulaTerm><Text>is ten per cent of the total value of the assets of the society, as shown in the last annual statement of the society prepared before the acquisition or transfer.</Text></FormulaDefinition></FormulaGroup></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;569&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;569&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Approval of series of transactions</MarginalNote><Label>(1.1)</Label><Text>The Superintendent may, for the purposes of subsection (1), approve a transaction or series of transactions relating to the acquisition or transfer of assets that may be entered into with a person, or with persons of any class of persons, regardless of whether those persons are known at the time of the granting of the approval or not.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;569&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;569&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Subsection (1) does not apply in respect of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;569&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an asset that is a debt obligation referred to in subparagraphs (<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)(i) to (v) of the definition “commercial loan” in subsection 490(1); or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;569&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a transaction or series of transactions by a society with another financial institution as a result of the society’s participation in one or more syndicated loans with that financial institution.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;569&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;569&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The approval of the Superintendent under this section is not required if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;569&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the society sells or transfers assets under a transaction that is approved by the Minister or the Superintendent under subsection 254(2) or (2.01);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;569&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the society or its subsidiary acquires shares of, or ownership interests in, an entity for which the approval of the Minister under Part VII or subsection 554(5) is required.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;569&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;569&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Value of assets</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>For the purposes of “A” in subsection (1), the value of the assets is</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;569&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of assets that are acquired, the purchase price of the assets or, if the assets are shares of, or ownership interests in, an entity the assets of which will be included in the annual statement of the society after the acquisition, the fair market value of the assets; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;569&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of assets that are transferred, the value of the assets as reported in the last annual statement of the society prepared before the transfer or, if the value of the assets is not reported in that annual statement, the value of the assets as it would be reported in the annual statement of the society if the annual statement had been prepared, in accordance with the accounting principles referred to in subsection 331(4), immediately before the transfer.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;569&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;569&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Total value of all assets</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>For the purposes of subsection (1), the total value of all assets that the society or any of its subsidiaries has acquired during the period of twelve months referred to in subsection (1) is the purchase price of the assets or, if the assets are shares of, or ownership interests in, an entity the assets of which immediately after the acquisition were included in the annual statement of the society, the fair market value of the assets of the entity at the date of the acquisition.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;569&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;569&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Total value of all assets</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>For the purposes of subsection (1), the total value of all assets that the society or any of its subsidiaries has transferred during the 12-month period referred to in subsection (1) is the total of the value of each of those assets as reported in the last annual statement of the society prepared before the transfer of the asset or, if the value of any of those assets is not reported in that annual statement, as it would be reported in the annual statement of the society if the annual statement had been prepared, in accordance with the accounting principles referred to in subsection 331(4), immediately before the transfer of the asset.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 569;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 440;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 255.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_550&quot;,gc=&quot;s_570&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_550&quot;,gc=&quot;s_570&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Saving</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;570&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Saving</MarginalNote><Label>570.</Label><Text>Nothing in this Part requires</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the termination of a loan or a commitment to make a loan or investment or to increase a loan or investment, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the disposal of an investment</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>made before the coming into force of this Part but, if the loan or investment would be precluded or limited by this Part, the amount of the loan or investment shall not, except as provided in sections 557, 558 and 559, or pursuant to a commitment referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>), be increased after the coming into force of this Part.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;570.001&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.001&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Saving</MarginalNote><Label>570.001</Label><Text>A loan or investment referred to in section 570 is deemed not to be prohibited by the provisions of this Part.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 441.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_570.01&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_570.01&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Liquidation and Dissolution of a Society</TitleText></Heading><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_570.01&quot;,gc=&quot;s_570.01&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_570.01&quot;,gc=&quot;s_570.01&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Interpretation</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;570.01&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.01&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Definition of <DefinedTermEn>court</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><Label>570.01</Label><Text>In sections 570.02 to 570.3, <DefinedTermEn>court</DefinedTermEn> means a court having jurisdiction in the place where the society has its head office.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 298.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_570.01&quot;,gc=&quot;s_570.02&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_570.01&quot;,gc=&quot;s_570.02&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Application</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;570.02&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.02&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application of sections 570.03 to 570.3</MarginalNote><Label>570.02</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.02&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Sections 570.03 to 570.3 do not apply to a society that is insolvent within the meaning of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="W-11">Winding-up and Restructuring Act</XRefExternal>.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.02&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.02&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Staying proceedings on insolvency</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Any proceedings taken under sections 570.04 to 570.3 to dissolve or to liquidate and dissolve a society shall be stayed if the society is at any time found to be insolvent within the meaning of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="W-11">Winding-up and Restructuring Act</XRefExternal>.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 298.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_570.01&quot;,gc=&quot;s_570.03&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_570.01&quot;,gc=&quot;s_570.03&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Duty to Provide Information</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;570.03&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.03&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Returns to Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>570.03</Label><Text>A liquidator appointed under this Part to wind up the business of a society shall provide the Superintendent with such information relating to the business and affairs of the society as the Superintendent requires, in such form as the Superintendent requires.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 298.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_570.01&quot;,gc=&quot;s_570.04&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_570.01&quot;,gc=&quot;s_570.04&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Simple Liquidation</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;570.04&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.04&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">No property and no liabilities</MarginalNote><Label>570.04</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.04&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A society that has no property and no liabilities may, if authorized by a special resolution or, if there are no members, by a resolution of the society’s supreme governing body, apply to the Minister for letters patent dissolving the society.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.04&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.04&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Dissolution by letters patent</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where the Minister has received an application under subsection (1) and is satisfied that all the circumstances so warrant, the Minister may issue letters patent dissolving the society.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.04&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.04&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effect of letters patent</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A society in respect of which letters patent are issued under subsection (2) is dissolved and ceases to exist on the day stated in the letters patent.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 298.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;570.05&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.05&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Proposing liquidation</MarginalNote><Label>570.05</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.05&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The voluntary liquidation and dissolution of a society, other than a society referred to in subsection 570.04(1),</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.05&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>may be proposed by its supreme governing body; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.05&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>may be initiated by way of a proposal made in accordance with the society’s by-laws by a member who is entitled to vote at a meeting of the society’s members at which the proposal may be voted on.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.05&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.05&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Terms must be set out</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A notice of any meeting of members at which the voluntary liquidation and dissolution of a society is to be proposed shall set out the terms of the proposal.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 298.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;570.06&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.06&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Members’ resolution</MarginalNote><Label>570.06</Label><Text>Where the voluntary liquidation and dissolution of a society is proposed, the society may apply to the Minister for letters patent dissolving the society if authorized by a special resolution.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 298.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;570.07&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.07&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Approval of Minister required</MarginalNote><Label>570.07</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.07&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>No action directed toward the voluntary liquidation and dissolution of a society shall be taken by a society, other than as provided in sections 570.05 and 570.06, until an application made by the society under section 570.06 has been approved by the Minister.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.07&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.07&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Conditional approval</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If the Minister is satisfied, on the basis of an application made under section 570.06, that the circumstances warrant the voluntary liquidation and dissolution of a society, the Minister may approve the application.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.07&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.07&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effect of approval</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>If the Minister approves an application made under section 570.06 with respect to a society, the society shall not carry on business except to the extent necessary to complete its voluntary liquidation.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.07&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.07&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Liquidation process</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>If the Minister approves an application made under section 570.06 with respect to a society, the society shall</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.07&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>cause notice of the approval to be sent to each known claimant, except members, against the society and to each known creditor of the society;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.07&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>publish notice of the approval once a week for four consecutive weeks in the <XRefExternal reference-type="other" link="gazette">Canada Gazette</XRefExternal> and once a week for two consecutive weeks in one or more newspapers in general circulation in each province in which the company transacted any business within the preceding twelve months;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.07&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>proceed to collect its property, dispose of property that is not to be distributed in kind to its members, discharge or provide for all its obligations and do all other acts required to liquidate its business; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.07&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>after giving the notice required under paragraphs (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) and (<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) and adequately providing for the payment or discharge of all its obligations, distribute its remaining property, either in money or in kind, among its members according to their respective rights.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 298.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;570.08&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.08&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Dissolution instrument</MarginalNote><Label>570.08</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.08&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Unless a court has made an order in accordance with subsection 570.09(1), the Minister may, if satisfied that the society has complied with subsection 570.07(4) and that all the circumstances so warrant, issue letters patent dissolving the society.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.08&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.08&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Society dissolved</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A society in respect of which letters patent are issued under subsection (1) is dissolved and ceases to exist on the day stated in the letters patent.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 298.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_570.01&quot;,gc=&quot;s_570.09&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_570.01&quot;,gc=&quot;s_570.09&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Court-supervised Liquidation</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;570.09&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.09&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application for court supervision</MarginalNote><Label>570.09</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.09&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The Superintendent or any interested person may, at any time during the liquidation of a society, apply to a court for an order for the continuance of the voluntary liquidation under the supervision of the court in accordance with this section and sections 570.1 to 570.21. On that application, the court may so order and make any further order it thinks fit.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.09&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.09&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application to state reasons</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>An application under subsection (1) to a court to supervise a voluntary liquidation shall state the reasons, verified by an affidavit of the applicant, why the court should supervise the liquidation.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.09&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.09&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice to Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Where a person, other than the Superintendent, makes an application under subsection (1), the person shall give the Superintendent notice of the application and the Superintendent may appear and be heard in person or by counsel at the hearing of the application.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 298.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;570.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Court supervision</MarginalNote><Label>570.1</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If a court makes an order under subsection 570.09(1), the liquidation of the society shall continue under the supervision of the court.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Beginning of liquidation</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The supervision of the liquidation of a society by the court under an order made under subsection 570.09(1) begins on the day the order is made.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 298.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;570.11&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.11&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Powers of court</MarginalNote><Label>570.11</Label><Text>In connection with the liquidation and dissolution of a society, if the court is satisfied that the society is able to pay or adequately provide for the discharge of all its obligations and to make satisfactory arrangements for the protection of its policyholders, the court may make any order it thinks fit, including</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.11&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order to liquidate;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.11&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order appointing a liquidator, with or without security, fixing a liquidator’s remuneration and replacing a liquidator;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.11&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order appointing inspectors or referees, specifying their powers, fixing their remuneration and replacing inspectors or referees;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.11&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order determining the notice to be given to any interested person, or dispensing with notice to any person;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.11&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order determining the validity of any claims made against the society;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.11&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order, at any stage of the proceedings, restraining the directors and officers of the society from</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;570.11&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>exercising any of their powers, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;570.11&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>collecting or receiving any debt or other property of the society, and from paying out or transferring any property of the society, except as permitted by the court;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.11&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order determining and enforcing the duty or liability of any present or former director, officer or member</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;570.11&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>to the society, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;570.11&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>for an obligation of the society;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.11&quot;,p1=&quot;h&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">h</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order approving the payment, satisfaction or compromise of claims against the society and the retention of assets for that purpose, and determining the adequacy of provisions for the payment, discharge or transfer of any obligation of the society, whether liquidated, unliquidated, future or contingent;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.11&quot;,p1=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">i</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>with the concurrence of the Superintendent, an order providing for the disposal or destruction of the documents, records or registers of the society;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.11&quot;,p1=&quot;j&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">j</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>on the application of a creditor, an inspector or the liquidator, an order giving directions on any matter arising in the liquidation;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.11&quot;,p1=&quot;k&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">k</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>after notice has been given to all interested parties, an order relieving the liquidator from any omission or default on such terms as the court thinks fit and confirming any act of the liquidator;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.11&quot;,p1=&quot;l&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">l</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>subject to sections 570.18 to 570.2, an order approving any proposed, interim or final distribution to members, if any, or to incorporators, in money or in kind;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.11&quot;,p1=&quot;m&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">m</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order disposing of any property belonging to creditors, members and incorporators who cannot be found;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.11&quot;,p1=&quot;n&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">n</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>on the application of any director, officer, member, incorporator or creditor or the liquidator,</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;570.11&quot;,p1=&quot;n&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>an order staying the liquidation proceedings on such terms and conditions as the court thinks fit,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;570.11&quot;,p1=&quot;n&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>an order continuing or discontinuing the liquidation proceedings, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;570.11&quot;,p1=&quot;n&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>an order to the liquidator to restore to the society all of its remaining property; and</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.11&quot;,p1=&quot;o&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">o</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>after the liquidator has rendered the liquidator’s final account to the court, an order directing the society to apply to the Minister for letters patent dissolving the society.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 298.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;570.12&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.12&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Cessation of business and powers</MarginalNote><Label>570.12</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.12&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where a court makes an order for the liquidation of a society,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.12&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the society continues in existence but shall cease to carry on business, except the business that is, in the opinion of the liquidator, required for an orderly liquidation; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.12&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the powers of the directors and members, if any, are vested in the liquidator and cease to be vested in the directors or members, except as specifically authorized by the court.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.12&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.12&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Delegation by liquidator</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A liquidator may delegate any of the powers vested by paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) to the directors or members, if any.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 298.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;570.13&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.13&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Appointment of liquidator</MarginalNote><Label>570.13</Label><Text>When making an order for the liquidation of a society or at any later time, the court may appoint any person, including a director, an officer or a member of the society or any other society, as liquidator of the society.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 298.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;570.14&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.14&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Vacancy in liquidator’s office</MarginalNote><Label>570.14</Label><Text>Where an order for the liquidation of a society has been made and the office of liquidator is or becomes vacant, the property of the society is under the control of the court until the office of liquidator is filled.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 298.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;570.15&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.15&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Duties of liquidator</MarginalNote><Label>570.15</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.15&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A liquidator shall</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.15&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>without delay after appointment, give notice of the appointment to the Superintendent and to each claimant and creditor of the society known to the liquidator;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.15&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>without delay after appointment, publish notice of the appointment once a week for four consecutive weeks in the <XRefExternal reference-type="other" link="gazette">Canada Gazette</XRefExternal> and once a week for two consecutive weeks in one or more newspapers in general circulation in each province in which the society has transacted any business within the preceding twelve months, requiring</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;570.15&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>any person indebted to the society to render an account and pay to the liquidator at the time and place specified in the notice any amount owing,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;570.15&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>any person possessing property of the society to deliver it to the liquidator at the time and place specified in the notice, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;570.15&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>any person having a claim against the society, whether liquidated, unliquidated, future or contingent, other than a policyholder having an unliquidated claim, to present particulars of the claim in writing to the liquidator not later than sixty days after the first publication of the notice;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.15&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>take into custody and control the property of the society;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.15&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>open and maintain a trust account for the money received by the liquidator in the course of the liquidation of the society;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.15&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>keep accounts of the money received and paid out by the liquidator in the course of the liquidation of the society;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.15&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>maintain separate lists of each class of creditors, members and other persons having claims against the society;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.15&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if at any time the liquidator determines that the society is unable to pay or adequately provide for the discharge of its obligations, apply to the court for directions;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.15&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;h&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">h</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>deliver to the court and to the Superintendent, at least once in every twelve-month period after the liquidator’s appointment or more often as the court requires, the society’s financial statements prepared in such manner as the liquidator thinks proper or as the court requires; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.15&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">i</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>after the final accounts are approved by the court, distribute any remaining property of the society among the members, if any, or incorporators, according to their respective rights.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.15&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.15&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Powers of liquidator</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A liquidator may</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.15&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>retain actuaries, lawyers, notaries, accountants, appraisers and other professional advisers;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.15&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>bring, defend or take part in any civil, criminal or administrative action or proceeding in the name of, and on behalf of, the society;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.15&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>carry on the business of the society as required for an orderly liquidation;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.15&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>sell by public auction or private sale any property of the society;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.15&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>do all acts and execute documents in the name of, and on behalf of, the society;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.15&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>borrow money on the security of the property of the society;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.15&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>settle or compromise any claims by or against the society; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.15&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;h&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">h</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>do all other things necessary for the liquidation of the society and distribution of its property.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 298.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;570.16&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.16&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Reliance on statements</MarginalNote><Label>570.16</Label><Text>A liquidator is not liable if the liquidator relies in good faith on</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.16&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>financial statements of the society represented to the liquidator by an officer of the society, or on a written report of the auditor of the society, to reflect fairly the financial condition of the society; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.16&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an opinion, report or statement of an actuary, lawyer, notary, accountant, appraiser or other professional adviser retained by the liquidator.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 298.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;570.17&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.17&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Examination of others</MarginalNote><Label>570.17</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.17&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If a liquidator has reason to believe that any property of the society is in the possession or under the control of a person or that a person has concealed, withheld or misappropriated the property, the liquidator may apply to the court for an order requiring that person to appear before the court at the time and place designated in the order and to be examined.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.17&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.17&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restoration and compensation</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If an examination conducted under subsection (1) discloses that a person has concealed, withheld or misappropriated any property of the society, the court may order that person to restore the property or pay compensation to the liquidator.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 298.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;570.18&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.18&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Costs of liquidation</MarginalNote><Label>570.18</Label><Text>A liquidator shall pay the costs of liquidation out of the property of the society and shall pay or make adequate provision for all claims against the society.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 298.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;570.19&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.19&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Final accounts</MarginalNote><Label>570.19</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.19&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Within one year after the appointment of a liquidator and after paying or making adequate provision for all claims against the society, the liquidator shall apply to the court</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.19&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>for approval of the final accounts of the liquidator and for an order permitting the distribution, in money or in kind, of the remaining property of the society to its members, if any, or to the incorporators, according to their respective rights; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.19&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>for an extension of time, setting out the reasons for the extension.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.19&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.19&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Member application</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If a liquidator fails to make the application required by subsection (1), a member of the society or, if there are no members of the society, an incorporator may apply to the court for an order for the liquidator to show cause why a final accounting and distribution should not be made.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.19&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.19&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notification of final accounts</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A liquidator who intends to make an application under subsection (1) shall give notice of that intention to the Superintendent, to each inspector appointed under section 570.11, to each member of the society or, if there are no members, to each incorporator and to any person who provided a security or fidelity bond for the liquidation.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.19&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.19&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Publication</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>The liquidator shall publish the notice required under subsection (3) in the <XRefExternal reference-type="other" link="gazette">Canada Gazette</XRefExternal>, and once a week for two consecutive weeks in one or more newspapers in general circulation in each province in which the society has transacted any business within the preceding twelve months, or as otherwise directed by the court.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 298.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;570.2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Final order</MarginalNote><Label>570.2</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If the court approves the final accounts rendered by a liquidator, the court shall make an order</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>directing the society to apply to the Minister for letters patent dissolving the society;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>directing the custody or disposal of the documents, records and registers of the society; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>discharging the liquidator except in respect of the duty of a liquidator under subsection (2).</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.2&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.2&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Delivery of order</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The liquidator shall without delay send a certified copy of the order referred to in subsection (1) to the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 298.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;570.21&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.21&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Right to distribution of money</MarginalNote><Label>570.21</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.21&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A member or incorporator may apply to the court for an order requiring the distribution of the remaining property of a society to be in money if, in the course of the liquidation of the society, the members resolve to, or the liquidator proposes to,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.21&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>exchange all or substantially all of the remaining property of the society for securities of another entity that are to be distributed to the members or to the incorporators; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.21&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>distribute all or part of the remaining property of the society to the members or to the incorporators in kind.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.21&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.21&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Powers of court</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>On an application under subsection (1), the court may order</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.21&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>all of the remaining property of the society to be converted into and distributed in money; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.21&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the claim of any member or incorporator applying under this section to be satisfied by a distribution in money.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.21&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.21&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Order by court</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Where an order is made by a court under paragraph (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>), the court</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.21&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>shall fix a fair value on the share of the property of the society attributable to the member or incorporator;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.21&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>may in its discretion appoint one or more appraisers to assist the court in fixing a fair value in accordance with paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>); and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.21&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>shall render a final order against the society in favour of the member or incorporator for the amount of the share of the property of the society attributable to the member or incorporator.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 298.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;570.22&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.22&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Dissolution by letters patent</MarginalNote><Label>570.22</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.22&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>On an application made under an order under paragraph 570.2(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>), the Minister may issue letters patent dissolving the society.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.22&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.22&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Society dissolved</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A society in respect of which letters patent are issued under subsection (1) is dissolved and ceases to exist on the date of the issuance of the letters patent.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 298.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_570.01&quot;,gc=&quot;s_570.23&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_570.01&quot;,gc=&quot;s_570.23&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">General</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;570.23&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.23&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Definitions</MarginalNote><Label>570.23</Label><Text>In sections 570.25 and 570.26, <DefinedTermEn>member</DefinedTermEn> and <DefinedTermEn>incorporator</DefinedTermEn> include the heirs and personal representatives of a member or incorporator.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 298.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;570.24&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.24&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Continuation of actions</MarginalNote><Label>570.24</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.24&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Even if a society has been dissolved under this Part,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.24&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a civil, criminal or administrative action or proceeding brought by or against the society before its dissolution may be continued as if the society had not been dissolved;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.24&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a civil, criminal or administrative action or proceeding may be brought against the society within two years after its dissolution as if the society had not been dissolved; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.24&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any property that would have been available to satisfy any judgment or order if the society had not been dissolved remains available for that purpose.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.24&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.24&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Service on society</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Service of a document on a society after its dissolution may be effected by serving the document on a person shown as a director in the incorporating instrument of the society or, if applicable, in the latest return sent to the Superintendent under subsection 549(1).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 298.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;570.25&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.25&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limitations on liability</MarginalNote><Label>570.25</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.25&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Even if a society has been dissolved, a member or incorporator to whom any of its property has been distributed is liable to any person claiming under subsection 570.24(1), to the extent of the amount received by that member or incorporator on the distribution.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.25&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.25&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limitation</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>An action to enforce liability under subsection (1) may not be commenced more than two years after the date of the dissolution of the society.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.25&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.25&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Action against class</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A court may order an action referred to in subsections (1) and (2) to be brought against the persons who were members or incorporators as a class, subject to such conditions as the court thinks fit.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.25&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.25&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Reference</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>If the plaintiff establishes a claim in an action under subsection (3), the court may refer the proceedings to a referee or other officer of the court who may</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.25&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>add as a party to the proceedings each person found by the plaintiff to have been a member or incorporator;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.25&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>determine, subject to subsection (1), the amount that each person who was a member or incorporator must contribute towards satisfaction of the plaintiff’s claim; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;570.25&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>direct payment of the amounts so determined.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 298.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;570.26&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.26&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Where creditor cannot be found</MarginalNote><Label>570.26</Label><Text>If a creditor, member or incorporator to whom property is to be distributed on the dissolution of a society cannot be found, the portion of the property to be distributed to that creditor, member or incorporator shall be converted into money and paid in accordance with section 570.28.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 298.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;570.27&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.27&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Vesting in Crown</MarginalNote><Label>570.27</Label><Text>Subject to subsection 570.24(1) and sections 570.28 and 570.29, property of a society that has not been disposed of at the date of the dissolution of the society vests in Her Majesty in right of Canada.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 298.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;570.28&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.28&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Unclaimed money on winding-up</MarginalNote><Label>570.28</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.28&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where the business of a society is being wound up under this Part, the liquidator or the society shall pay to the Minister on demand, and in any event before the final winding-up of that business, any amount that is payable by the liquidator or the society to a creditor, member or incorporator of the society and that has not, for any reason, been paid.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.28&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.28&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Records</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If a liquidator or a society makes a payment to the Minister under subsection (1) with respect to a creditor, member or incorporator, the liquidator or society shall at the same time forward to the Minister all documents, records and registers in the possession of the liquidator or society that relate to the entitlement of the creditor, member or incorporator.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.28&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.28&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Payment to Receiver General</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The Minister shall pay to the Receiver General all amounts paid to the Minister under subsection (1).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;570.28&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.28&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Liquidator and company discharged</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Payment by a liquidator or a society to the Minister under subsection (1) discharges the liquidator and the society in respect of which the payment is made from all liability for the amount so paid, and payment by the Minister to the Receiver General under subsection (3) discharges the Minister from all liability for the amount so paid.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 298.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;570.29&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.29&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Recovery</MarginalNote><Label>570.29</Label><Text>If at any time a person establishes an entitlement to any money paid to the Receiver General under this Part, the Receiver General shall pay an equivalent amount to that person out of the Consolidated Revenue Fund.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 298.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;570.3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;570.3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Custody of records after dissolution</MarginalNote><Label>570.3</Label><Text>A person who has been granted custody of the documents, records and registers of a dissolved society shall keep them available for production for six years after the date of the dissolution of the society or until the end of such shorter period as may be ordered by the court when it orders the dissolution.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 298.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="1"><Label>PART XIII</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">FOREIGN COMPANIES</TitleText></Heading><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_571&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_571&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Interpretation</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;571&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;571&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Definitions</MarginalNote><Label>571.</Label><Text>In this Part,</Text><Definition Code="se=&quot;571&quot;,df=&quot;{association}{association}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;571&quot;,df=&quot;{association}{association}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>association</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;571&quot;,df=&quot;{association}{association}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>association</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>association</DefinedTermEn> means an association of persons formed in a foreign country on the plan known as Lloyd’s, whereby each member of the association participating in a policy becomes liable for a stated, limited or proportionate part of the whole amount payable under the policy;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;571&quot;,df=&quot;{chief agency}{agence principale}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;571&quot;,df=&quot;{chief agency}{agence principale}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>chief agency</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;571&quot;,df=&quot;{chief agency}{agence principale}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>agence principale</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>chief agency</DefinedTermEn> means the principal office of a foreign company in Canada;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;571&quot;,df=&quot;{chief agent}{agent principal}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;571&quot;,df=&quot;{chief agent}{agent principal}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>chief agent</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;571&quot;,df=&quot;{chief agent}{agent principal}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>agent principal</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>chief agent</DefinedTermEn>, in respect of a foreign company, means the natural person appointed pursuant to subsection 579(3) and named as such in the power of attorney referred to in paragraph 579(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>);</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;571&quot;,df=&quot;{exchange}{groupe d’échange}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;571&quot;,df=&quot;{exchange}{groupe d’échange}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>exchange</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;571&quot;,df=&quot;{exchange}{groupe d’échange}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>groupe d’échange</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>exchange</DefinedTermEn> means a group of persons formed in a foreign country for the purpose of exchanging reciprocal contracts of indemnity or inter-insurance with each other through the same attorney, where the principal office of the exchange is in a foreign country;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;571&quot;,df=&quot;{foreign entity}{entité étrangère}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;571&quot;,df=&quot;{foreign entity}{entité étrangère}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>foreign entity</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;571&quot;,df=&quot;{foreign entity}{entité étrangère}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>entité étrangère</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>foreign entity</DefinedTermEn> means an entity incorporated or formed by or under the laws of a country other than Canada, and includes an association and an exchange;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;571&quot;,df=&quot;{foreign fraternal benefit society}{société de secours étrangère}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;571&quot;,df=&quot;{foreign fraternal benefit society}{société de secours étrangère}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>foreign fraternal benefit society</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;571&quot;,df=&quot;{foreign fraternal benefit society}{société de secours étrangère}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>société de secours étrangère</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>foreign fraternal benefit society</DefinedTermEn> means a fraternal benefit society incorporated outside Canada;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;571&quot;,df=&quot;{foreign life company}{société d’assurance-vie étrangère}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;571&quot;,df=&quot;{foreign life company}{société d’assurance-vie étrangère}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>foreign life company</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;571&quot;,df=&quot;{foreign life company}{société d’assurance-vie étrangère}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>société d’assurance-vie étrangère</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>foreign life company</DefinedTermEn> means a foreign company that is authorized to insure risks that fall within the class of life insurance;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;571&quot;,df=&quot;{foreign marine company}{société d’assurance maritime étrangère}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;571&quot;,df=&quot;{foreign marine company}{société d’assurance maritime étrangère}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>foreign marine company</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;571&quot;,df=&quot;{foreign marine company}{société d’assurance maritime étrangère}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>société d’assurance maritime étrangère</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>foreign marine company</DefinedTermEn> means a foreign company that is authorized to solely insure risks within the class of marine insurance;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;571&quot;,df=&quot;{foreign property and casualty company}{société d’assurances multirisques étrangère}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;571&quot;,df=&quot;{foreign property and casualty company}{société d’assurances multirisques étrangère}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>foreign property and casualty company</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;571&quot;,df=&quot;{foreign property and casualty company}{société d’assurances multirisques étrangère}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>société d’assurances multirisques étrangère</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>foreign property and casualty company</DefinedTermEn> means a foreign company other than a foreign life company or a foreign marine company;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;571&quot;,df=&quot;{}{}&quot;"><Text><DefinedTermEn>fraternal benefit society</DefinedTermEn><Repealed>[Repealed, 1997, c. 15, s. 299]</Repealed></Text></Definition><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 571;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 83.1;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 299;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 256.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_572&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_572&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Application</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;572&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;572&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application — insurance business in Canada</MarginalNote><Label>572.</Label><Text>This Part applies only in respect of the insurance business in Canada of a foreign entity.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 572;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 257.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;572.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;572.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>572.1</Label><Text>Despite section 572, this Part does not apply in respect of the insurance against injury to persons or loss of or damage to property, or liability for such injury, loss or damage, caused by nuclear energy, including ionizing radiation and contamination by radioactive substances, to the extent that, in the opinion of the Superintendent, that insurance is not available within Canada.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2007, c. 6, s. 257.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_573&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_573&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Insurance of Risks</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;573&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;573&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction on insuring of risks unless authorized</MarginalNote><Label>573.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;573&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A foreign entity shall not insure in Canada a risk unless it is authorized by order made under subsection 574(1).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;573&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;573&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction to specified classes of insurance</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A foreign company shall not insure in Canada a risk unless the risk falls within a class of insurance that is specified in the order made under subsection 574(1) in respect of the foreign company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;573&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;573&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction on issuance of annuities or endowment insurance</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Unless authorized to insure in Canada risks falling within the class of life insurance, a foreign company shall not issue annuities or policies of endowment insurance in Canada.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;573&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;573&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Transitional</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>A certificate of registry issued to a foreign entity under the <XRefExternal reference-type="act">Foreign Insurance Companies Act</XRefExternal> or Part VIII of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act">Canadian and British Insurance Companies Act</XRefExternal>, or any other authorization, that had not expired or been withdrawn before June 1, 1992 is deemed to be an order made under subsection 574(1) and the foreign entity remains subject to any and all other conditions and limitations contained in the certificate or other authorization.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;573&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;573&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Continuance of certificate limitations</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>A class of insurance specified in a certificate of registry or other authorization referred to in subsection (4) is deemed to be specified in an order of the Superintendent approving the insuring in Canada of risks by the foreign company.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 573;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 300(F);</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 259.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;574&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;574&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application for order</MarginalNote><Label>574.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;574&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>On application by a foreign entity, the Superintendent may, with the approval of the Minister but subject to the other provisions of this Part, make an order approving the insuring in Canada of risks by the foreign entity.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;574&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;574&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Reciprocal treatment</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If the application is made by a foreign entity that is not controlled by a WTO Member resident, the Minister shall not approve the making of an order under subsection (1) unless the Minister is satisfied that treatment as favourable for companies to which this Act applies exists or will be provided in the jurisdiction in which the foreign entity principally carries on business, either directly or through a subsidiary.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 574;</li><li> 1999, c. 28, s. 125;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 260.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;575&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;575&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Prohibited names</MarginalNote><Label>575.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;575&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>An order made under subsection 574(1) may not provide for the use of a name that</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;575&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>is prohibited by an Act of Parliament;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;575&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>is, in the opinion of the Superintendent, deceptively misdescriptive;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;575&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>is the same as or, in the opinion of the Superintendent, substantially the same as or confusingly similar to, any existing trade-mark, trade name or corporate name of a body corporate, except where</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;575&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>the trade-mark or trade name is being changed or the body corporate is being dissolved or is changing its corporate name, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;575&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>consent to the use of the trade-mark, trade name or corporate name is signified to the Superintendent in any manner that the Superintendent may require;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;575&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>is the same as or, in the opinion of the Superintendent, substantially the same as or confusingly similar to, the known name under or by which any entity carries on business or is identified; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;575&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>is reserved under section 45 for a company or society or proposed company or society.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;575&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;575&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Affiliated entity</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Despite subsection (1), an order made under subsection 574(1) may provide for the use of a name that is the same or substantially the same as that of an entity with which the foreign entity is affiliated, within the meaning of subsection 6(2), if that other entity consents to the use of the name.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;575&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;575&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Representations to Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>If the Superintendent does not make an order for one of the reasons specified in subsection (1), he or she must, by a notice in writing to that effect, give the foreign entity and any other interested party an opportunity to make representations.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 575;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 84;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 301;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 260.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;576&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;576&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Change of name</MarginalNote><Label>576.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;576&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>On the application of a foreign company, the Superintendent may, subject to subsection 575(1), by further order, change the name under which a foreign company insures risks.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;576&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><Label>(2)</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 2007, c. 6, s. 261]</Repealed></Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 576;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 84;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 261.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;577&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;577&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Direction to change of name</MarginalNote><Label>577.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;577&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If through inadvertence or otherwise a foreign company is permitted by an order made under subsection 574(1) to insure risks under a name that is prohibited by section 575, the Superintendent may direct the foreign company to change the name without delay.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;577&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;577&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Revoking name</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where a foreign company has been directed under subsection (1) to change the name under which it insures risks and has not, within sixty days after the service of the direction, changed that name to a name that is not prohibited by this Part, the Superintendent may revoke the name under which the foreign company insures risks and assign to it a name and, until changed in accordance with subsection 576(1), the name under which the foreign company is to insure risks is thereafter the name so assigned.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 577;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 84;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 262.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;578&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;578&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">French, English or foreign form of name</MarginalNote><Label>578.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;578&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The name under which a foreign company is authorized to insure risks, as set out in the order made under subsection 574(1), may be in an English form, a French form, an English form and a French form, a combined English and French form or a form combining words in a language other than English or French with one of the forms specified in this subsection.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;578&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;578&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Other name</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Subject to subsections (3) and (4), a foreign company may carry on its insurance business in Canada under a name other than the name set out in the order made under subsection 574(1) in respect of the foreign company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;578&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;578&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Direction to change name</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>If a foreign company carries on its insurance business in Canada under a name other than a name set out in the order made under subsection 574(1) in respect of the foreign company, the Superintendent may direct the foreign company not to use that other name if the Superintendent is of the opinion that the other name is a name referred to in any of paragraphs 575(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;578&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;578&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Publication of name</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>A foreign company shall set out, or cause to be set out, its name and, if different, the name under which it is authorized to insure risks, in legible characters in all contracts, premium notices, applications for policies, policies, negotiable instruments and other documents evidencing rights and obligations with respect to other parties that are issued or made by or on behalf of the foreign company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;578&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;578&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Publication of statement</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>A foreign company shall set out or cause to be set out in legible characters in all premium notices, applications for policies and policies that are issued or made by or on behalf of the foreign company a statement that the document was issued or made in the course of its insurance business in Canada.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;578&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;578&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Continuation of registered names</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>The name of a foreign company, as set out in a certificate of registry referred to in subsection 573(4), or in any other authorization, is deemed to be set out in an order of the Superintendent made under subsection 574(1) in respect of the foreign company.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 578;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 263.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;579&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;579&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application</MarginalNote><Label>579.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;579&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>An application for an order under subsection 574(1) must be filed with the Superintendent, together with the information, material and evidence that the Superintendent may require, including</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;579&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>documents relating to the constitution of the foreign entity;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;579&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a power of attorney to the chief agent appointed under subsection (3), in the form that the Superintendent may require;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;579&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a statement, in the form that the Superintendent may require, of the financial condition of the foreign entity and of the business of insurance undertaken by the foreign entity, and any additional statements or information that the Superintendent may require as to its solvency and its ability to meet all of its obligations;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;579&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>evidence satisfactory to the Superintendent that the foreign entity is authorized under the laws of the country where it is incorporated or formed to insure risks within each class of insurance in Canada that that foreign entity has applied to insure;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;579&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of a foreign fraternal benefit society,</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;579&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>a report of an actuary appointed by the foreign fraternal benefit society, in the form that the Superintendent may require, on the results of an actuarial valuation made by the actuary, as of the preceding December 31 or as of any later date specified by the Superintendent, of each of the benefit funds maintained by the foreign fraternal benefit society, having regard to the prospective liabilities of and contributions to each fund, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;579&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>the opinion of the actuary that the assets of the foreign fraternal benefit society applicable to each fund, taken at the value accepted by the Superintendent, together with the premiums, dues and other contributions to be received after the date of the valuation from the members according to the scale in force at the date of the valuation, are sufficient to provide for the payment at maturity of all of the obligations of the fund without deduction or abatement; and</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;579&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a copy of the resolution respecting the investment and lending policies, standards and procedures that the foreign entity is to establish and adhere to in accordance with subsection 615(1).</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;579&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;579&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Contents of power of attorney</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A power of attorney referred to in paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) must expressly authorize the chief agent to receive all notices under the laws of Canada from the Minister or the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;579&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;579&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Appointment of chief agent</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A foreign company shall appoint a natural person who is ordinarily resident in Canada to be its chief agent for the purposes of this Part.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 579;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 302;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 264.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;580&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;580&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Publishing notice of intention</MarginalNote><Label>580.</Label><Text>Before filing an application referred to in subsection 579(1), a foreign entity must, at least once a week for four consecutive weeks, publish, in a form satisfactory to the Superintendent, a notice of intention to make the application in the <XRefExternal reference-type="other" link="gazette">Canada Gazette</XRefExternal> and in a newspaper in general circulation at or near the place where its chief agency is to be situated if it is granted an order under subsection 574(1).</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 580;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 265.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;581&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;581&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Conditions for order</MarginalNote><Label>581.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;581&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The Superintendent shall not make an order under subsection 574(1) in respect of a foreign entity until it has been shown to the satisfaction of the Superintendent that all relevant requirements of this Act have been complied with and that the foreign entity has</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;581&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>vested in trust assets having a prescribed value;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;581&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>appointed an actuary under section 623 and an auditor under section 633; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;581&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>established its chief agency.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;581&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;581&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Conditions of order</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The order may contain any conditions or limitations that are consistent with this Act and that the Superintendent considers appropriate.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 581;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 299;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 265.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20060427">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;582&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;582&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Permissible securities</MarginalNote><Label>582.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;582&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The assets of a foreign entity to be vested in trust are to consist of unencumbered securities of or guaranteed by Canada or a province.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;582&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;582&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Other permissible securities</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The assets of a foreign entity to be vested in trust may also consist of other securities at the accepted value and on the conditions established by the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 582;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 266(E).</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;583&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;583&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Contents of order</MarginalNote><Label>583.</Label><Text>An order made under subsection 574(1) in respect of a foreign company must set out</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;583&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the name of the foreign company and, if different, the name under which it is authorized to insure risks;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;583&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the day on which the order becomes effective;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;583&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the classes of insurance risks that the foreign company is authorized to insure; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;583&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the conditions or limitations that are consistent with this Act that are considered appropriate by the Superintendent.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 583;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 267.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;584&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;584&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Public notice</MarginalNote><Label>584.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;584&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>On the making of an order under subsection 574(1) in respect of a foreign company, the foreign company must publish a notice of the making of the order in a newspaper in general circulation at or near the place where its chief agency is located.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;584&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;584&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice in <XRefExternal reference-type="other" link="gazette">Canada Gazette</XRefExternal></MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The Superintendent shall cause to be published in the <XRefExternal reference-type="other" link="gazette">Canada Gazette</XRefExternal> a notice of the making of the order referred to in subsection (1).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 584;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 268.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;585&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;585&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Publication of list</MarginalNote><Label>585.</Label><Text>Unless the regulations provide otherwise, the Superintendent shall cause to be published quarterly in the <XRefExternal reference-type="other" link="gazette">Canada Gazette</XRefExternal> a list of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;585&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>foreign companies;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;585&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the classes of insurance specified in the orders of the Superintendent approving the insurance of risks by them;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;585&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>their chief agents; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;585&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the province in which their chief agencies are situated.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 585;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 300;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 269.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20060427">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;586&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;586&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Variations</MarginalNote><Label>586.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;586&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>In respect of an order made under subsection 574(1) in respect of a foreign company, the Superintendent may at any time, by further order,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;586&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>specify additional classes of insurance risks that the foreign company is authorized to insure;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;586&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>make the order subject to conditions or limitations that are consistent with this Act and that are considered appropriate by the Superintendent; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;586&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>amend or revoke any authorization contained in the order or any condition or limitation to which the order is subject.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;586&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;586&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Representations</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Before making any such further order, the Superintendent must give the foreign company an opportunity to make representations regarding that further order.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;586&quot;,ss=&quot;3)&quot;"><Label>(3) to (6)</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 1996, c. 6, s. 85]</Repealed></Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 586;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 85;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 270.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;587&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;587&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Change of chief agent</MarginalNote><Label>587.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;587&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A foreign company that changes its chief agent shall, without delay after doing so, file with the Superintendent a further power of attorney appointing the new chief agent.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;587&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;587&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Change of address</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A foreign company that changes the address of its chief agency shall, within 15 days after doing so, send a notice of the change of address to the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 587;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 271.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;587.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;587.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restricted transactions</MarginalNote><Label>587.1</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;587.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Except in accordance with this section or an order made under subsection 678.6(1), a foreign company shall not cause itself to be reinsured, on an assumption basis, against all or any portion of the risks undertaken under its policies.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;587.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;587.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Approval of the Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A foreign company may, with the approval of the Superintendent, cause itself to be reinsured, on an assumption basis, against all or any portion of the risks undertaken under its policies, by one or more of the following entities:</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;587.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a company or society;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;587.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>another foreign company that, in Canada, reinsures those risks; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;587.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a body corporate incorporated or formed by or under the laws of a province, if the Superintendent has entered into satisfactory arrangements concerning the reinsurance with either or both of the body corporate and the appropriate official or public body responsible for the supervision of the body corporate.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;587.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;587.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Prescribed transactions</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The approval of the Superintendent is not required for a prescribed transaction or a transaction in a prescribed class of transactions.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;587.1&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;587.1&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Procedure</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>The foreign company must, at least 30 days before it applies for the Superintendent’s approval, publish a notice in the <XRefExternal reference-type="other" link="gazette">Canada Gazette</XRefExternal> and in a newspaper in general circulation at or near the place where its chief agency is situated stating the day on or after which it will apply.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;587.1&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;587.1&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Information</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>If a foreign company publishes a notice referred to in subsection (4), the Superintendent may direct the foreign company to provide its policyholders with any information that the Superintendent may require.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;587.1&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;587.1&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Report of independent actuary</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>An application for approval must, if the Superintendent so requires, be accompanied by the report of an independent actuary on the proposed reinsurance agreement.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;587.1&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;587.1&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Inspection</MarginalNote><Label>(7)</Label><Text>If a foreign company publishes a notice referred to in subsection (4), it must make the agreement for the transaction that the Superintendent is asked to approve available at its chief agency for the inspection of its policyholders for at least 30 days after the publication of the notice and must provide a copy of the agreement to any policyholder who requests one by writing to the chief agency.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;587.1&quot;,ss=&quot;8&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;587.1&quot;,ss=&quot;8&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Superintendent may shorten periods</MarginalNote><Label>(8)</Label><Text>If the Superintendent is of the opinion that it is in the best interests of a group of policyholders affected by the transaction that the Superintendent is asked to approve, the Superintendent may shorten the periods of 30 days referred to in subsections (4) and (7).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;587.1&quot;,ss=&quot;9&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;587.1&quot;,ss=&quot;9&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations</MarginalNote><Label>(9)</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations respecting the circumstances in which foreign companies are deemed to be causing themselves to be reinsured, on an assumption basis, against risks undertaken under their policies.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 303;</li><li> 1999, c. 1, s. 9;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 442;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 301;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 271.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20060427">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;587.2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;587.2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Approval by Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>587.2</Label><Text>A transaction referred to in subsection 587.1(2) has no effect until it has been approved by the Superintendent.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2007, c. 6, s. 271.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;587.3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;587.3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice to Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>587.3</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;587.3&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A foreign company proposing to transfer all or substantially all of its policies must give notice of the proposal to the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;587.3&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;587.3&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Information</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>After receiving the notice, the Superintendent may direct the foreign company to provide its policyholders with any information that the Superintendent may require.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2007, c. 6, s. 271.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_588&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_588&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Classes of Insurance</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;588&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;588&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction to reinsurance</MarginalNote><Label>588.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;588&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A foreign company may reinsure, but shall not otherwise insure, a risk falling within a class of insurance specified in the order made under subsection 574(1) in respect of the foreign company if the order limits the foreign company to the reinsurance of those risks.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;588&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;588&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Continuation of certificate conditions</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A condition that limits a foreign company to the reinsurance of risks falling within a class of insurance and that is contained in a certificate of registry issued under the <XRefExternal reference-type="act">Foreign Insurance Companies Act</XRefExternal> or under Part VIII of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act">Canadian and British Insurance Companies Act</XRefExternal>, or in any other authorization, that had not expired or been withdrawn before June 1, 1992 is deemed to be a condition in an order made under subsection 574(1) in respect of the foreign company.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 588;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 272.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;589&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;589&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">No new foreign composite companies</MarginalNote><Label>589.</Label><Text>The Superintendent may not make or vary an order made under subsection 574(1) in respect of a foreign company if the foreign company would as a result be permitted to insure both risks falling within the class of life insurance and risks falling within any other class of insurance other than accident and sickness insurance, credit protection insurance and other approved products insurance.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 589;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 304;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 272.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;590&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;590&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Saving for existing foreign composite companies</MarginalNote><Label>590.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;590&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Despite section 589, subsections 573(4) and 588(2) permit a foreign company to which was issued under the <XRefExternal reference-type="act">Foreign Insurance Companies Act</XRefExternal> or Part VIII of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act">Canadian and British Insurance Companies Act</XRefExternal> a certificate of registry or other authorization specifying both risks falling within the class of life insurance and risks falling within some other class of insurance, other than accident and sickness insurance, accident insurance, personal accident insurance and sickness insurance, to insure those risks.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;590&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;590&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Separate accounts for life insurance</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A foreign company referred to in subsection (1) shall maintain an account and funds in respect of the insurance of risks falling within the classes of life insurance and accident and sickness insurance, accident insurance, personal accident insurance and sickness insurance separately from those maintained in respect of the insurance of risks falling within any other class of insurance.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 590;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 273.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;591&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;591&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Compensation association</MarginalNote><Label>591.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;591&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Every foreign company that is insuring risks that fall within a class of insurance shall become and remain a member of any compensation association designated by order of the Minister for that class of insurance.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;591&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;591&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Designation limitation</MarginalNote><Label>(1.1)</Label><Text>A compensation association shall not be designated under subsection (1) unless, in the opinion of the Minister, it has the authority to levy an assessment on each of its members of not less than eighty-five one hundredths of one per cent of the member’s average annual premium income from policies that are eligible for compensation from the association.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;591&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;591&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exceptions</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Subsection (1) does not apply</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;591&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>to a foreign company that may reinsure but may not otherwise insure risks;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;591&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in respect of a class of insurance that, in the opinion of the Minister, is adequately covered by some other compensation plan for that class of insurance;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;591&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in respect of the insuring in Canada of risks against the loss of, or damage to, property caused by fire, by lightning, by an explosion due to ignition, by smoke or by breakage of or leakage from a sprinkler, from other fire protection equipment or from another fire protection system by a foreign company that is a member of the Fire Mutuals Guarantee Fund; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;591&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>to a foreign company that is a foreign fraternal benefit society or an exchange.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 591;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 86;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 305;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 274.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_592&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_592&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Segregated Funds</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;592&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;592&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Segregated funds restricted to foreign life companies</MarginalNote><Label>592.</Label><Text>Unless authorized to insure risks that fall within the class of life insurance, a foreign company shall not</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;592&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>insure risks under policies, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;592&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>accept or retain on the direction of a policyholder or beneficiary policy dividends or bonuses, or policy proceeds that are payable on the surrender or maturity of the policy or on the death of the person whose life is insured,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>where the liabilities of the foreign company in respect of the policies or the amounts accepted or retained vary in amount depending on the market value of a fund consisting of a specified group of assets.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 592;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 275.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;593&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;593&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Where segregated funds required</MarginalNote><Label>593.</Label><Text>A foreign company that issues policies described in section 592 or accepts or retains amounts so described shall, in respect of those policies or amounts,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;593&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>maintain separate accounts; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;593&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>establish and maintain one or more funds consisting of assets in Canada that are segregated from the other assets in Canada of the foreign company and that are specified as the assets on the market value of which the liabilities of the foreign company in respect of those policies or amounts depend.</Text></Paragraph></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;594&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;594&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Claims against segregated funds</MarginalNote><Label>594.</Label><Text>A claim against a segregated fund maintained as required by section 593 under a policy or for an amount in respect of which the fund is maintained has priority over any other claim against the assets of that fund, including the claims referred to in section 161 of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="W-11">Winding-up and Restructuring Act</XRefExternal>, except to the extent that the payment of that other claim is secured by a security interest in or on a specific, identifiable asset of the segregated fund.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 594;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 167;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 306;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 276.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;595&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;595&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction of claims</MarginalNote><Label>595.</Label><Text>The liability of a foreign company under a policy or for an amount in respect of which a segregated fund is maintained pursuant to section 593</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;595&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>does not, except to the extent that the assets of the fund are insufficient to satisfy a claim for any minimum amount that the foreign company agrees to pay under the policy or in respect of the amount, give rise to a claim against any assets in Canada of the foreign company, other than the assets of that fund,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>but</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;595&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>to the extent that the assets of the fund are insufficient to satisfy such a claim, gives rise to a claim against the assets in Canada of the foreign company, other than the assets of that fund, that has the priority referred to in subsection 161(2) of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="W-11">Winding-up and Restructuring Act</XRefExternal>.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 595;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 167;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 276.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_596&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_596&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Reinsurance</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;596&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;596&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations</MarginalNote><Label>596.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;596&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations limiting the extent to which foreign companies may cause themselves to be reinsured against risks undertaken under their policies.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;596&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;596&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulation may provide for discretion</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A regulation made pursuant to subsection (1) may provide that the Superintendent may, by order, determine the matters or exercise the discretion that the regulation may specify.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 596;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 277.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;597&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;597&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction re related parties</MarginalNote><Label>597.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;597&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Except with the approval of the Superintendent, a foreign company may cause itself to be reinsured, in respect of risks undertaken under its policies, by a related party of the foreign company only if the related party is</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;597&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a company; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;597&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a foreign company that, in Canada, reinsures those risks.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;597&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;597&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Meaning of <DefinedTermEn>related party</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>For the purposes of this section, <DefinedTermEn>related party</DefinedTermEn>, in relation to a foreign company, means a <DefinedTermEn>related party</DefinedTermEn> within the meaning of Part XI, with such modifications as the circumstances require.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 597;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 278.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_598&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_598&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Borrowing Costs</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;598&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;598&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Definition of <DefinedTermEn>cost of borrowing</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><Label>598.</Label><Text>For the purposes of this section and sections 598.1 to 605, <DefinedTermEn>cost of borrowing</DefinedTermEn> means, in respect of a loan or an advance on the security or against the cash surrender value of a policy made by a foreign company,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;598&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the interest or discount applicable to the loan or advance;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;598&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any amount charged in connection with the loan or advance that is payable by the borrower to the foreign company; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;598&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any charge prescribed to be included in the cost of borrowing.</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>For those purposes, however, “cost of borrowing” does not include any charge prescribed to be excluded from the cost of borrowing.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 598;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 307;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 443.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;598.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;598.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Rebate of borrowing costs</MarginalNote><Label>598.1</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;598.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where a foreign company makes a loan in respect of which the disclosure requirements of section 599 apply, and the loan is not secured by a mortgage on real property and is required to be repaid either on a fixed future date or by instalments, the foreign company shall, if there is a prepayment of the loan, rebate to the borrower a portion of the charges included in the cost of borrowing in respect of the loan.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;598.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;598.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The charges to be rebated do not include the interest or discount applicable to the loan.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;598.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;598.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations governing the rebate of charges under subsection (1). The rebate shall be made in accordance with those regulations.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 307.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;599&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;599&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Disclosing borrowing costs</MarginalNote><Label>599.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;599&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A foreign company shall not include in its assets in Canada any loan to a natural person that is repayable in Canada unless the cost of borrowing, as calculated and expressed in accordance with section 600, and other prescribed information have, in the prescribed manner and at the prescribed time, been disclosed by the foreign company to the borrower.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;599&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;599&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Non-application</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Subsection (1) does not apply in respect of a loan that is of a prescribed class of loans.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 599;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 307.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;600&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;600&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Calculating borrowing costs</MarginalNote><Label>600.</Label><Text>The cost of borrowing shall be calculated, in the prescribed manner, on the basis that all obligations of the borrower are duly fulfilled and shall be expressed as a rate per annum and, in prescribed circumstances, as an amount in dollars and cents.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;601&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;601&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Additional disclosure</MarginalNote><Label>601.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;601&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where a foreign company makes a loan in respect of which the disclosure requirements of section 599 are applicable and the loan is required to be repaid either on a fixed future date or by instalments, the foreign company shall disclose to the borrower, in accordance with the regulations,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;601&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>whether the borrower has the right to repay the amount borrowed before the maturity of the loan and, if applicable,</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;601&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>any terms and conditions relating to that right, including the particulars of the circumstances in which the borrower may exercise that right, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;601&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>whether, in the event that the borrower exercises the right, any portion of the cost of borrowing is to be rebated, the manner in which any such rebate is to be calculated or, if a charge or penalty will be imposed on the borrower, the manner in which the charge or penalty is to be calculated;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;601&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the event that an amount borrowed is not repaid at maturity or, if applicable, an instalment is not paid on the day the instalment is due to be paid, particulars of the charges or penalties to be paid by the borrower because of the failure to repay or pay in accordance with the contract governing the loan;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;601&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>at such time and in such manner as may be prescribed, any changes respecting the cost of borrowing or the loan agreement as may be prescribed;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;601&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>particulars of any other rights and obligations of the borrower; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;601&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any other prescribed information, at such time and in such form and manner as may be prescribed.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;601&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;601&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Disclosure in credit card applications</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A foreign company shall, in accordance with the regulations, at such time and in such manner as may be prescribed, provide prescribed information in any application forms or related documents that it prepares for the issuance of credit, payment or charge cards in Canada and provide prescribed information to any person applying to it in Canada for a credit, payment or charge card.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;601&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;601&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Disclosure re credit cards</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Where a foreign company issues in Canada or has issued in Canada a credit, payment or charge card to a natural person, the foreign company shall, in addition to disclosing the costs of borrowing in respect of any loan that is obtained through the use of the card and that is repayable in Canada, disclose to the person, in accordance with the regulations,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;601&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any charges or penalties described in paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;601&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>particulars of the person’s rights and obligations;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;601&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any charges for which the person becomes responsible by accepting or using the card;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;601&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>at such time and in such manner as may be prescribed, such changes respecting the cost of borrowing or the loan agreement as may be prescribed; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;601&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any other prescribed information, at such time and in such form and manner as may be prescribed.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;601&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;601&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Additional disclosure re other loans</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Where a foreign company enters into or has entered into an arrangement, including a line of credit, for the making of a loan in respect of which the disclosure requirements of section 599 apply and the loan is not one in respect of which subsection (1) or (3) applies, the foreign company shall, in addition to disclosing the costs of borrowing, disclose to the person, in accordance with the regulations,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;601&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any charges or penalties described in paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;601&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>particulars of the person’s rights and obligations;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;601&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any charges for which the person is responsible under the arrangement;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;601&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>at such time and in such manner as may be prescribed, such changes respecting the cost of borrowing under the arrangement as may be prescribed; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;601&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any other prescribed information, at such time and in such form and manner as may be prescribed.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 601;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 308.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;601.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;601.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Renewal statement</MarginalNote><Label>601.1</Label><Text>If a foreign company makes a loan in respect of which the disclosure requirements of section 599 apply and the loan is secured by a mortgage on real property, the foreign company shall disclose to the borrower at such time and in such manner as may be prescribed, such information as may be prescribed respecting the renewal of the loan.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 309.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;601.2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;601.2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Disclosure in advertising</MarginalNote><Label>601.2</Label><Text>No person shall authorize the publication, issue or appearance of any advertisement in Canada relating to arrangements referred to in subsection 601(4), loans, credit cards, payment cards or charge cards, offered to natural persons by a foreign company, and purporting to disclose prescribed information about the cost of borrowing or about any other matter unless the advertisement contains such information as may be required by the regulations, in such form and manner as may be prescribed.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1997, c. 15, s. 309.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;602&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;602&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Disclosing borrowing costs — advances</MarginalNote><Label>602.</Label><Text>If regulations have been made respecting the manner in which the cost of borrowing is to be disclosed in respect of an advance on the security or against the cash surrender value of a policy, a foreign company shall not make such an advance unless the cost of borrowing, as calculated and expressed in accordance with the regulations, has, in the prescribed manner, been disclosed by the foreign company or otherwise as prescribed to the policyholder at or before the time when the advance is made.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 602;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 279.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;603&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;603&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations re borrowing costs</MarginalNote><Label>603.</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;603&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the manner in which, and the time at which, a foreign company is to disclose to a borrower</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;603&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>the cost of borrowing,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;603&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>any rebate of the cost of borrowing, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;603&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>any other information relating to a loan, arrangement, credit card, payment card or charge card referred to in section 601;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;603&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the contents of any statement disclosing the cost of borrowing and other information required to be disclosed by a foreign company to a borrower;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;603&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the manner of calculating the cost of borrowing;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;603&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the circumstances under which the cost of borrowing is to be expressed as an amount in dollars and cents;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;603&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>specifying any class of loans that are not to be subject to section 598.1, subsection 599(1) or 601(1) or (4) or section 601.1 or 601.2 or the regulations or any specified provisions of the regulations;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;603&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>specifying any class of advances that are not to be subject to section 602 or the regulations or any specified provisions of the regulations;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;603&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the manner in which and the time at which any rights, obligations, charges or penalties referred to in sections 598.1 to 602 are to be disclosed;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;603&quot;,p1=&quot;h&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">h</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>prohibiting the imposition of any charge or penalty referred to in section 601 or providing that the charge or penalty, if imposed, will not exceed a prescribed amount;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;603&quot;,p1=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">i</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the nature or amount of any charge or penalty referred to in paragraph 601(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>), (3)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) or (4)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) and the costs of the foreign company that may be included or excluded in the determination of the charge or penalty;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;603&quot;,p1=&quot;j&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">j</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the method of calculating the amount of rebate of the cost of borrowing, or the portion of the cost of borrowing referred to in subparagraph 601(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)(ii);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;603&quot;,p1=&quot;k&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">k</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting advertisements made by a foreign company regarding arrangements referred to in subsection 601(4), loans, credit cards, payment cards or charge cards;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;603&quot;,p1=&quot;l&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">l</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the renewal of loans; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;603&quot;,p1=&quot;m&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">m</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting such other matters or things as are necessary to carry out the purposes of sections 598.1 to 602.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 603;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 310.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_604&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_604&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Complaints</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;604&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;604&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Procedures for dealing with complaints</MarginalNote><Label>604.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;604&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A foreign company shall</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;604&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>establish procedures for dealing with complaints made by persons having requested or received products or services in Canada from the foreign company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;604&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>designate one of its officers or employees in Canada, or an agent in Canada, to be responsible for implementing those procedures; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;604&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>designate one or more of its officers or employees in Canada, or agents in Canada, to receive and deal with those complaints.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;604&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;604&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Procedures to be filed with Commissioner</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A foreign company shall file with the Commissioner a copy of its procedures established under paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;604&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;604&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">How procedures to be made available</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A foreign company shall make its procedures established under paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) available</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;604&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>on its websites through which products or services are offered in Canada; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;604&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in written format to be sent to any person who requests them.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;604&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;604&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Information on contacting Agency</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>A foreign company shall also make prescribed information on how to contact the Agency available whenever it makes its procedures established under paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) available under subsection (3).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 604;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 311;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 444;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 280.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;604.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;604.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Obligation to be member of complaints body</MarginalNote><Label>604.1</Label><Text>In any province, if there is no law of the province that makes a foreign company subject to the jurisdiction of an organization that deals with complaints made by persons having requested or received products or services in the province from a foreign company, the foreign company shall be a member of an organization in Canada that is not controlled by it and that deals with those complaints that have not been resolved to the satisfaction of the persons under procedures established under paragraph 604(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>).</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 444;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 281.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;605&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;605&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Information on contacting Agency</MarginalNote><Label>605.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;605&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A foreign company shall, in the prescribed manner, provide a person in Canada requesting or receiving a product or service in Canada from it with prescribed information on how to contact the Agency if the person has a complaint about an arrangement referred to in subsection 601(3), a payment, credit or charge card referred to in subsection 601(2), the disclosure of or manner of calculating the cost of borrowing in respect of a loan repayable in Canada or an advance on the security or against the cash surrender value of a policy, or about any other obligation of the foreign company under a consumer provision.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;605&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;605&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Report</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The Commissioner shall prepare a report, to be included in the report referred to in section 34 of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="F-11.1">Financial Consumer Agency of Canada Act</XRefExternal>, respecting</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;605&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>procedures for dealing with complaints established by foreign companies pursuant to paragraph 604(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>); and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;605&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the number and nature of complaints that have been brought to the attention of the Agency by persons who have requested or received a product or service from a foreign company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 605;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 312;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 444;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 282.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_606&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_606&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Miscellaneous</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;606&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;606&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Prepayment protected</MarginalNote><Label>606.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;606&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A foreign company shall not include in its assets in Canada any loan to a natural person that is repayable in Canada, the terms of which prohibit prepayment of the money advanced or any instalment thereon before its due date.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;606&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;606&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Non-application of subsection (1)</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Subsection (1) does not apply in respect of a loan</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;606&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>that is secured by a mortgage on real property; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;606&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>that is made for business purposes and the principal amount of which is more than $100,000 or such other amount as may be prescribed.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 606;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 313.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;606.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;606.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations — activities</MarginalNote><Label>606.1</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations respecting any matters involving a foreign company’s dealings, or its employees’ or representatives’ dealings, with customers or the public, including</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;606.1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>what a foreign company may or may not do in carrying out any of the activities in which it is permitted to engage, or in providing any of the services that it may provide, under this Act and any ancillary, related or incidental activities or services; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;606.1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the time, place and manner in which any of those activities are to be carried out or any of those services are to be provided.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2009, c. 2, s. 286.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;607&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;607&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations re customer information</MarginalNote><Label>607.</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;607&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>requiring a foreign company to establish procedures regarding the collection, retention, use and disclosure of any information about its customers in Canada or any class of customers in Canada;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;607&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>requiring a foreign company to establish procedures for dealing with complaints made by a customer in Canada about the collection, retention, use or disclosure of information about the customer;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;607&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the disclosure by a foreign company of information relating to the procedures referred to in paragraphs (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) and (<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;607&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>requiring a foreign company to designate the officers and employees of the company who are responsible for</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;607&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>implementing the procedures referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>), and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;607&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>receiving and dealing with complaints made by a customer, in Canada, of the foreign company about the collection, retention, use or disclosure of information about the customer;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;607&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>requiring a foreign company to report information relating to</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;607&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>complaints made by its customers in Canada about the collection, retention, use or disclosure of information, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;607&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>its actions taken to deal with the complaints; and</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;607&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>defining “information”, “collection” and “retention” for the purposes of paragraphs (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>) and the regulations made under those paragraphs.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 607;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 314.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;607.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;607.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations re disclosure</MarginalNote><Label>607.1</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may, subject to any other provisions of this Act relating to the disclosure of information, make regulations respecting the disclosure of information by foreign companies or any prescribed class of foreign companies, including regulations respecting</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;607.1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the information that must be disclosed, including information relating to</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;607.1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>any product or service or prescribed class of products or services offered by them,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;607.1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>any of their policies, procedures or practices relating to the offer by them of any product or service or prescribed class of products or services,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;607.1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>anything they are required to do or to refrain from doing under a consumer provision, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;607.1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;iv&quot;"><Label>(iv)</Label><Text>any other matter that may affect their dealings, or their employees’ or representatives’ dealings, with customers or the public;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;607.1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the manner, place and time in which, and the persons to whom, information is to be disclosed; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;607.1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the content and form of any advertisement by foreign companies or any prescribed class of foreign companies relating to any matter referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>).</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 445;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 283.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;607.2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;607.2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Provisions that do not apply</MarginalNote><Label>607.2</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;607.2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Sections 598 to 607.1 do not apply in respect of a foreign company if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;607.2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the order made under subsection 574(1) in respect of the foreign company restricts it to the reinsurance of risks within a class of insurance specified in the order;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;607.2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the foreign company has provided the Commissioner with a declaration stating that it is not dealing with a prescribed group of consumers; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;607.2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>after providing the declaration, the foreign company continues to not deal with that prescribed group.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;607.2&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;607.2&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice if action taken that causes provisions to apply</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The foreign company must give notice to the Commissioner if it subsequently deals with the prescribed group referred to in the declaration.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2007, c. 6, s. 284.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_608&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_608&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Adequacy of Assets</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;608&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;608&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Adequacy of assets and appropriate forms of liquidity</MarginalNote><Label>608.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;608&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A foreign company shall maintain in Canada an adequate margin of assets over liabilities in respect of its insurance business in Canada as shown in the records it is required to maintain under section 647, and adequate and appropriate forms of liquidity, and shall comply with any regulations in relation to an adequate margin of assets over liabilities and adequate and appropriate forms of liquidity.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;608&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;608&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Liabilities</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>For the purposes of subsection (1), the liabilities in Canada of a foreign company include the reserve included in the annual return required under subsection 665(2).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;608&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;608&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Guidelines</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The Superintendent may make guidelines in respect of any matter referred to in paragraph 610(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;608&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;608&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Directives</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Even though a foreign company is complying with regulations made under paragraph 610(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) or guidelines made under subsection (3), the Superintendent may, by order, direct the foreign company to increase the margin of its assets over its liabilities that it is required to maintain in Canada or to provide additional liquidity in the forms and the amounts that the Superintendent requires.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;608&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;608&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Compliance</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>A foreign company shall comply with an order made under subsection (4) within the time that the Superintendent specifies in the order.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 608;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 87;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 446;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 286.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;609&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;609&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Adequacy of assets</MarginalNote><Label>609.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;609&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A foreign company shall, in relation to each class of insurance risks that it is permitted to insure, maintain in Canada, in accordance with the regulations, assets the total value of which shall be determined in accordance with the regulations.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;609&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;609&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Guidelines</MarginalNote><Label>(1.1)</Label><Text>The Superintendent may make guidelines in respect of any matter referred to in paragraph 610(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;609&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;609&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Directives</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Even though a foreign company is complying with regulations made under paragraph 610(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) or guidelines made under subsection (1.1), the Superintendent may, by order, direct the foreign company to increase the assets that it is required to maintain in Canada.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;609&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;609&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Compliance</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A foreign company shall comply with an order made under subsection (2) within such time as the Superintendent specifies therein.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 609;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 88;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 287.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;610&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;610&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations</MarginalNote><Label>610.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;610&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;610&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the maintenance by foreign companies of an adequate margin of assets in Canada over liabilities in Canada and adequate and appropriate forms of liquidity;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;610&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the maintenance by foreign companies of assets in Canada of a particular value, which regulations may make special provision for associations and exchanges;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;610&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>prescribing rules for determining the value, location and protection of the assets of foreign companies;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;610&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>governing the determination of the reserves to be included in the liabilities of foreign companies;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;610&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>determining the method of calculating the value of interests of foreign companies in real property for the purposes of section 618; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;610&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>prescribing anything that is required or authorized by this Part to be prescribed.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;610&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;610&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulation may provide for discretion</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A regulation made pursuant to paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) may provide that the Superintendent may, by order, determine the matters or exercise the discretion that the regulations may specify.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 610;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 447(E).</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;611&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;611&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Vesting in trust</MarginalNote><Label>611.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;611&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The assets that a foreign company is required to maintain in Canada under sections 608 and 609 and the regulations made under section 610 must be vested in trust in a Canadian financial institution chosen by the foreign company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;611&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;611&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Conflict of interest</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>No Canadian financial institution may be appointed as trustee if at the time of the appointment there is a material conflict of interest between the Canadian financial institution’s role as trustee and any other of its roles.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;611&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;611&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Trust deed</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A trust deed must be approved by the Superintendent before it is entered into.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;611&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;611&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Determination of value of assets in Canada</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>The Superintendent shall determine the value at which assets shall be accepted for the purposes of this Part.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;611&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;611&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Maintenance of value of assets in Canada</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>The trustee of a foreign company may deal with the assets in Canada in any manner provided for in the trust deed, but in such a way that the value for the purposes of this Part of the assets in Canada does not fall below that required by this Part.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 611;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 448.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;612&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;612&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Inadmissible assets</MarginalNote><Label>612.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;612&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A foreign company may not vest in trust</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;612&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>securities issued by or debt obligations of the foreign company or one of its affiliates;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;612&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>real property, or ground rents or mortgages on real property, situated outside Canada;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;612&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>shares or ownership interests, however designated, in any entity in such number as would constitute a substantial investment in that entity without regard to any shares or ownership interests held by any other entity; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;612&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a loan made in Canada on the security of residential property in Canada for the purpose of purchasing, renovating or improving that property, if the amount of the loan, together with the amount then outstanding of any mortgage having an equal or prior claim against the property, would exceed 80 per cent of the value of the property at the time of the loan.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;612&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;612&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Despite paragraphs (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) and (<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>), a foreign company may vest in trust a substantial investment in an entity that is primarily engaged in</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;612&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>holding, managing or otherwise dealing with real property; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;612&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>holding shares or ownership interests in entities that are primarily engaged in any of the activities referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>).</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;612&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;612&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Idem</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Notwithstanding paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), a foreign company may vest in trust</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;612&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a loan made or guaranteed under the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="N-11">National Housing Act</XRefExternal> or any other Act of Parliament by or pursuant to which a different limit on the value of property on the security of which the foreign company may make a loan is established;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;612&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a loan if repayment of the amount of the loan that exceeds the maximum amount set out in subsection (1) is guaranteed or insured by a government agency or a private insurer approved by the Superintendent; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;612&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>securities issued or guaranteed by an entity that are secured on any residential property, whether in favour of a trustee or otherwise, or a loan made by the foreign company to the entity against the issue of such securities.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 612;</li><li> 1993, c. 34, s. 85(E);</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 315;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 290.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_613&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_613&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Investments</TitleText></Heading><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_613&quot;,gc=&quot;s_613&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_613&quot;,gc=&quot;s_613&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Definitions and Application</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;613&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;613&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Definition of <DefinedTermEn>commercial loan</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><Label>613.</Label><Text>In sections 615 to 620, <DefinedTermEn>commercial loan</DefinedTermEn> has the same meaning as in Part IX.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;614&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;614&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Non-application</MarginalNote><Label>614.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;614&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Sections 612 and 615 to 620 do not apply in respect of assets of a foreign company held in relation to a segregated fund maintained pursuant to section 593.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;614&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;614&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exclusion of liabilities of segregated funds</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A reference in sections 615 to 619 and in regulations made under section 620 to the assets in Canada or the liabilities in Canada of a foreign company does not include liabilities of the foreign company for the policies and amounts in respect of which a segregated fund is maintained pursuant to section 593.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 614;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 291.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_613&quot;,gc=&quot;s_615&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_613&quot;,gc=&quot;s_615&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">General Constraints on Investments</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;615&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;615&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Investment standards</MarginalNote><Label>615.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;615&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A foreign company shall, in respect of its assets in Canada, establish and adhere to investment and lending policies, standards and procedures that a reasonable and prudent person would apply in respect of a portfolio of investments and loans to avoid undue risk of loss and obtain a reasonable return.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;615&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;615&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Resolution of board of directors</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A foreign company to which subsection 573(4) applies shall, during the period of ninety days following the coming into force of this Part, file with the Superintendent a certified copy of a resolution of its board of directors establishing the investment and lending policies, standards and procedures referred to in subsection (1).</Text></Subsection></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_613&quot;,gc=&quot;s_616&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_613&quot;,gc=&quot;s_616&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Commercial Lending by Foreign Life Companies</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;616&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;616&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Lending limit — foreign life companies</MarginalNote><Label>616.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;616&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The total accepted value of commercial loans vested in trust by a foreign life company for the classes of life insurance, accident and sickness insurance, credit protection insurance and other approved products insurance shall not at any time exceed the prescribed percentage of the value of its assets in Canada for those classes.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;616&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;616&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Lending limit — foreign composite companies</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The total accepted value of the commercial loans and loans to natural persons vested in trust by a foreign life company for the classes of insurance other than life insurance, accident and sickness insurance, credit protection insurance and other approved products insurance, shall not at any time exceed the prescribed percentage of the value of its assets in Canada for those classes.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 616;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 292.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_613&quot;,gc=&quot;s_617&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_613&quot;,gc=&quot;s_617&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Consumer and Commercial Lending by Foreign Property and Casualty Companies and Foreign Marine Companies</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;617&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;617&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Lending limit — foreign property and casualty companies and foreign marine companies</MarginalNote><Label>617.</Label><Text>The total accepted value of the commercial loans and loans to natural persons vested in trust by a foreign property and casualty company, or a foreign marine company, shall not at any time exceed the prescribed percentage of the value of its assets in Canada.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 617;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 292.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_613&quot;,gc=&quot;s_618&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_613&quot;,gc=&quot;s_618&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Real Property</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;618&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;618&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limit on total property interest — foreign life companies</MarginalNote><Label>618.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;618&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The total accepted value of interests in real property vested in trust by a foreign life company for the classes of life insurance, accident and sickness insurance, credit protection insurance and other approved products insurance shall not at any time exceed the prescribed percentage of the value of its assets in Canada for those classes.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;618&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;618&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limit on total property interest — foreign composite companies</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The total accepted value of interests in real property vested in trust by a foreign life company for the classes of insurance other than life insurance, accident and sickness insurance, credit protection insurance and other approved products insurance, shall not at any time exceed the prescribed percentage of the value of its assets in Canada for those classes.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;618&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;618&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limit on total property interest — foreign property and casualty companies and foreign marine companies</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The total accepted value of interests in real property vested in trust by a foreign property and casualty company, or a foreign marine company, shall not at any time exceed the prescribed percentage of the value of its assets in Canada.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 618;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 292.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_613&quot;,gc=&quot;s_619&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_613&quot;,gc=&quot;s_619&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Equities</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;619&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;619&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limit on equity acquisitions — foreign life companies</MarginalNote><Label>619.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;619&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The total accepted value of the participating shares, within the meaning of Part IX, of any body corporate and any ownership interests, howsoever designated, in any unincorporated entities vested in trust by a foreign life company for the classes of life insurance, accident and sickness insurance, credit protection insurance and other approved products insurance shall not at any time exceed the prescribed percentage of the value of its assets in Canada for those classes.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;619&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;619&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limit on equity acquisitions — foreign composite companies</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The total accepted value of the participating shares, within the meaning of Part IX, of any body corporate and any ownership interests, howsoever designated, in any unincorporated entities vested in trust by a foreign life company for the classes of insurance, other than life insurance, accident and sickness insurance, credit protection insurance and other approved products insurance, shall not at any time exceed the prescribed percentage of the value of its assets in Canada for those classes.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;619&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;619&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limit on equity acquisitions — foreign property and casualty companies and foreign marine companies</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The total accepted value of the participating shares, within the meaning of Part IX, of any body corporate and any ownership interests, howsoever designated, in any unincorporated entities vested in trust by a foreign property and casualty company, or a foreign marine company, shall not at any time exceed the prescribed percentage of the value of its assets in Canada.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 619;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 292.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_613&quot;,gc=&quot;s_620&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_613&quot;,gc=&quot;s_620&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Aggregate Limit</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;620&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;620&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limit on aggregate value</MarginalNote><Label>620.</Label><Text>The aggregate value of each of the following total accepted values, namely,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;620&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the total accepted values referred to in subsections 618(1) and 619(1),</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;620&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the total accepted values referred to in subsections 618(2) and 619(2), and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;620&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the total accepted values referred to in subsections 618(3) and 619(3),</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>shall not at any time exceed the respective prescribed percentage of the value of the assets in Canada.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_621&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_621&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Self-dealing</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;621&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;621&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Prohibited transactions</MarginalNote><Label>621.</Label><Text>A foreign company shall not vest in trust any asset in accordance with this Part if the asset was acquired through a transaction that at the time of acquisition would be prohibited for a company pursuant to section 521.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;622&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;622&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>622.</Label><Text>A foreign company may vest in trust an asset if the asset was acquired through a transaction described in any of sections 524 to 533 and</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;622&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the transaction was entered into on terms and conditions that are at least as favourable to the foreign company as market terms and conditions, as defined in subsection 534(2); and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;622&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the foreign company files a notice of the vesting with the Superintendent on vesting the asset in trust.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 622;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 316;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 293.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_623&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_623&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Actuaries</TitleText></Heading><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_623&quot;,gc=&quot;s_623&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_623&quot;,gc=&quot;s_623&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Appointment</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;623&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;623&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Appointment of actuary</MarginalNote><Label>623.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;623&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A foreign company that is required by this Act to provide the Superintendent with the report of an actuary shall without delay appoint a person to be the actuary of the foreign company for its insurance business in Canada.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;623&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;623&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of appointment</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A foreign company shall, forthwith after the appointment of an actuary of the foreign company, notify the Superintendent in writing of the appointment.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 623;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 317.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;624&quot;"><Label>624.</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 1997, c. 15, s. 318]</Repealed></Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;624.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;624.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Chief agent</MarginalNote><Label>624.1</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;624.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The chief agent of a foreign company may not be appointed as or hold the position of actuary of the foreign company unless authorized in writing by the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;624.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;624.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Duration of authorization</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>An authorization under subsection (1) ceases to be in effect on the day specified therein but not later than the day that is six months after it is issued, and a person appointed or holding the position of actuary pursuant to the authorization shall not hold that position after that day.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1996, c. 6, s. 88.1.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_623&quot;,gc=&quot;s_625&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_623&quot;,gc=&quot;s_625&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Vacancies</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;625&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;625&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Revocation of appointment</MarginalNote><Label>625.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;625&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A foreign company may revoke the appointment of the actuary of the foreign company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;625&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;625&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of revocation</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A foreign company shall, forthwith after the revocation of the appointment of the actuary of the foreign company, notify the Superintendent in writing of the revocation.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;626&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;626&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Ceasing to hold office</MarginalNote><Label>626.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;626&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A person ceases to hold office as the actuary of a foreign company when</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;626&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the person resigns as actuary of the foreign company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;626&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the person ceases to be an actuary;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;626&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the person dies; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;626&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the appointment of the person as actuary of the foreign company is revoked by the foreign company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;626&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;626&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effective date of resignation</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The resignation of an actuary of a foreign company becomes effective at the time a written resignation is sent to the foreign company or at the time specified in the resignation, whichever is later.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;626&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;626&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Filling vacancy</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Where a vacancy occurs in the office of actuary of a foreign company, the foreign company shall forthwith notify the Superintendent in writing of the vacancy and fill the vacancy.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 626;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 319.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;627&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;627&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Statement of actuary</MarginalNote><Label>627.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;627&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>An actuary of a foreign company who resigns or whose appointment is revoked shall submit to the chief agent of the foreign company and the Superintendent a written statement of the circumstances and reasons why the actuary resigned or why, in the actuary’s opinion, the actuary’s appointment was revoked.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;627&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;627&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Duty of replacement actuary</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where an actuary of a foreign company resigns or the appointment of an actuary of a foreign company is revoked, no person shall accept an appointment or consent to be appointed as actuary of the foreign company before requesting and receiving from the other actuary the written statement referred to in subsection (1).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;627&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;627&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A person may accept an appointment or consent to be appointed as actuary of a company if no reply is received from the other actuary within fifteen days after a request under subsection (2) is made.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;627&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;627&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effect of non-compliance</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Unless subsection (3) applies, an appointment as actuary of a company is void if subsection (2) is not complied with.</Text></Subsection></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_623&quot;,gc=&quot;s_628&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_623&quot;,gc=&quot;s_628&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Valuations and Reports</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;628&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;628&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Right to information</MarginalNote><Label>628.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;628&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>On the request of the actuary of a foreign company, the present or former directors, chief agents, officers, employees or representatives of the foreign company shall, to the extent that they are reasonably able to do so,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;628&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>permit access to such records held by the foreign company, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;628&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>provide such information and explanations</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>as are, in the opinion of the actuary, necessary to enable the actuary to perform the duties of actuary of the foreign company.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;628&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;628&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">No civil liability</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A person who in good faith makes an oral or written communication under subsection (1) shall not be liable in any civil action arising from having made the communication.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;629&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;629&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Actuary’s valuation</MarginalNote><Label>629.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;629&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The actuary of a foreign company shall value</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;629&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the actuarial and other policy liabilities of the foreign company with respect to its insurance business in Canada as at the end of a financial year; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;629&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any other matters specified in any direction that may be made by the Superintendent.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;629&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;629&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Actuarial practices</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>An actuary’s valuation shall be in accordance with generally accepted actuarial practice with such changes as may be determined by the Superintendent and any additional directions that may be made by the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;629.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;629.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Superintendent may appoint actuary</MarginalNote><Label>629.1</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;629.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The Superintendent may appoint an actuary to value the matters referred to in paragraph 629(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) in relation to a foreign company if the Superintendent is of the opinion that the appointment is necessary. That actuary may not be an actuary of the foreign company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;629.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;629.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Expenses payable by foreign company</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The expenses incurred in carrying out a valuation under subsection (1) are payable by the foreign company on being approved in writing by the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1996, c. 6, s. 89;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 320.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;630&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;630&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Report to chief agent</MarginalNote><Label>630.</Label><Text>The actuary of a foreign company shall meet with the chief agent of the foreign company at least once during each financial year in order to report, in accordance with generally accepted actuarial practice, on the financial position of the insurance business in Canada of the foreign company, and, where a direction that may be made by the Superintendent so specifies, the expected future financial condition of the foreign company as it affects its insurance business in Canada.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 630;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 321.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;631&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;631&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Report to chief agent</MarginalNote><Label>631.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;631&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The actuary of a foreign company shall report in writing to the chief agent of the foreign company any matters that have come to the actuary’s attention in the course of carrying out the duties of the actuary and that in the actuary’s opinion have material adverse effects on the financial condition of the foreign company with respect to its insurance business in Canada and require rectification.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;631&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;631&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Transmission of report</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>An actuary of a foreign company who makes a report under subsection (1) shall forthwith provide a copy of it to the directors of the foreign company and to any person designated by them as responsible for the insurance business in Canada of the foreign company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;631&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;631&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Failure to take action</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Where, in the opinion of the actuary of the foreign company, suitable action is not taken to rectify the matters referred to in subsection (1), the actuary shall forthwith provide a copy of the report to the Superintendent and advise the chief agent of the foreign company that the actuary has done so.</Text></Subsection></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_623&quot;,gc=&quot;s_632&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_623&quot;,gc=&quot;s_632&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Qualified Privilege</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;632&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;632&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Qualified privilege for statements</MarginalNote><Label>632.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;632&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Any oral or written statement or report made under this Act by the actuary or former actuary of a foreign company has qualified privilege.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;632&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;632&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">No civil liability</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The actuary or a former actuary of a foreign company who in good faith makes an oral or written statement under subsection 627(1) or section 631 shall not be liable in any civil action seeking indemnification for damages attributable to the actuary or former actuary having made the statement or report.</Text></Subsection></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_632.1&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_632.1&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Auditors</TitleText></Heading><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_632.1&quot;,gc=&quot;s_632.1&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_632.1&quot;,gc=&quot;s_632.1&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Interpretation</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;632.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;632.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Definitions</MarginalNote><Label>632.1</Label><Text>In sections 634 to 643, the expressions <DefinedTermEn>firm of accountants</DefinedTermEn> and <DefinedTermEn>member</DefinedTermEn> have the meanings assigned to those expressions by section 336.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2007, c. 6, s. 294.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_632.1&quot;,gc=&quot;s_633&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_632.1&quot;,gc=&quot;s_633&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Appointment</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;633&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;633&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Appointment of auditor</MarginalNote><Label>633.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;633&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A foreign company shall appoint an auditor for its insurance business in Canada.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;633&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;633&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of appointment</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A foreign company shall, forthwith after the appointment of the auditor of the foreign company, notify the Superintendent in writing of the appointment.</Text></Subsection></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_632.1&quot;,gc=&quot;s_634&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_632.1&quot;,gc=&quot;s_634&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Qualifications</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;634&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;634&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Qualification of auditor</MarginalNote><Label>634.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;634&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A natural person or firm of accountants is qualified to be an auditor of a foreign company if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;634&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of a natural person, the person is an accountant who</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;634&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>is a member in good standing of an institute or association of accountants incorporated by or under an Act of the legislature of a province,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;634&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>has at least five years experience at a senior level in performing audits of a financial institution,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;634&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>is ordinarily resident in Canada, and</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;634&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;iv&quot;"><Label>(iv)</Label><Text>is independent of the foreign company and its chief agent; and</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;634&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of a firm of accountants, the member of the firm jointly designated by the firm and the foreign company to conduct the audit of the foreign company on behalf of the firm is qualified in accordance with paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>).</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;634&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;634&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Independence</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>For the purposes of subsection (1),</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;634&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>independence is a question of fact; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;634&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a person is deemed not to be independent of a foreign company if that person, a business partner of that person or a firm of accountants of which that person is a member</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;634&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>is a business partner, director, officer or employee of the foreign company or of any affiliate of the foreign company or is a business partner of any director, officer or employee of the foreign company or of any affiliate of the foreign company,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;634&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>beneficially owns or controls, directly or indirectly, a material interest in the shares of the foreign company or of any affiliate of the foreign company, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;634&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>has been a liquidator, trustee in bankruptcy, receiver or receiver and manager of any affiliate of the foreign company within the two years immediately preceding the person’s proposed appointment as auditor of the foreign company.</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;634&quot;,ss=&quot;2.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;634&quot;,ss=&quot;2.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Business partners</MarginalNote><Label>(2.1)</Label><Text>For the purposes of subsection (2),</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;634&quot;,ss=&quot;2.1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of the appointment of a natural person as the auditor of a foreign company, a business partner of the person includes a shareholder of the business partner; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;634&quot;,ss=&quot;2.1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of the appointment of a firm of accountants as the auditor of a foreign company, a business partner of a member of the firm includes another member of the firm and a shareholder of the firm or of a business partner of the member.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;634&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;634&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of designation</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Within 15 days after the appointment of a firm of accountants as auditor of a foreign company, the foreign company and the firm of accountants shall jointly designate a member of the firm who meets the qualifications described in subsection (1) to conduct the audit of the foreign company on behalf of the firm and the foreign company shall without delay notify the Superintendent in writing of the designation.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;634&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;634&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">New designation</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Where for any reason a member of a firm of accountants designated pursuant to subsection (3) ceases to conduct the audit of the foreign company, the foreign company and the firm of accountants may jointly designate another member of the same firm of accountants who meets the qualifications described in subsection (1) to conduct the audit of the foreign company and the foreign company shall forthwith notify the Superintendent in writing of the designation.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;634&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;634&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Deemed vacancy</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>In any case where subsection (4) applies and a designation is not made pursuant to that subsection within thirty days after the designated member ceases to conduct the audit of the foreign company, there shall be deemed to be a vacancy in the office of auditor of the foreign company.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 634;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 302;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 295(E).</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20061128">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;635&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;635&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Duty to resign</MarginalNote><Label>635.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;635&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>An auditor who ceases to be qualified under section 634 shall resign forthwith after the auditor, where the auditor is a natural person, or any member of the firm of accountants, where the auditor is a firm of accountants, becomes aware that the auditor or the firm has ceased to be so qualified.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;635&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;635&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Disqualification order</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Any interested person may apply to a court for an order declaring that an auditor of a foreign company has ceased to be qualified under section 634 and declaring the office of auditor to be vacant.</Text></Subsection></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_632.1&quot;,gc=&quot;s_636&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_632.1&quot;,gc=&quot;s_636&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Vacancies</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;636&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;636&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Revocation of appointment</MarginalNote><Label>636.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;636&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A foreign company may revoke the appointment of an auditor of the foreign company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;636&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;636&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Idem</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The Superintendent may at any time revoke the appointment of an auditor made under subsection (3) or section 633 or 638 by notice in writing signed by the Superintendent and sent by registered mail to the auditor and to the chief agent of the foreign company addressed to the usual place of business of the auditor and the chief agent.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;636&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;636&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Filling vacancy</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A vacancy created by the revocation of the appointment of an auditor under subsection (1) shall be filled by the foreign company under section 638.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;637&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;637&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Ceasing to hold office</MarginalNote><Label>637.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;637&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>An auditor of a foreign company ceases to hold office when</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;637&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the auditor resigns;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;637&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the auditor, where the auditor is a natural person, dies; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;637&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the appointment of the auditor is revoked by the foreign company or the Superintendent.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;637&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;637&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effective date of resignation</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The resignation of an auditor becomes effective at the time a written resignation is sent to the foreign company or at the time specified in the resignation, whichever is later.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;638&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;638&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Filling vacancy</MarginalNote><Label>638.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;638&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where a vacancy occurs in the office of auditor of a foreign company, the foreign company shall forthwith fill the vacancy.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;638&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;638&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Where Superintendent may fill vacancy</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where the foreign company fails to fill a vacancy in accordance with subsection (1), the Superintendent may fill the vacancy.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;638&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;638&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Designation of member of firm</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Where the Superintendent has, pursuant to subsection (2), appointed a firm of accountants to fill a vacancy, the Superintendent shall designate the member of the firm who is to conduct the audit on behalf of the firm.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;639&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;639&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Statement of auditor</MarginalNote><Label>639.</Label><Text>An auditor of a foreign company who</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;639&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>resigns, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;639&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>receives a notice or otherwise learns that another person is to be appointed in the auditor’s stead, whether because of the auditor’s resignation or revocation of appointment,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>shall submit to the chief agent of the foreign company and the Superintendent a written statement giving the reasons for the resignation or the reasons why the auditor opposes any proposed action.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;640&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;640&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Duty of replacement auditor</MarginalNote><Label>640.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;640&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where an auditor of a foreign company has resigned or the appointment of an auditor has been revoked, no person or firm shall accept an appointment or consent to be appointed as auditor of the foreign company until the person or firm has requested and received from the other auditor a written statement of the circumstances and reasons why the other auditor resigned or why, in the other auditor’s opinion, the other auditor’s appointment was revoked.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;640&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;640&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Notwithstanding subsection (1), a person or firm may accept an appointment or consent to be appointed as auditor of a foreign company if, within fifteen days after a request under that subsection is made, no reply from the other auditor is received.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;640&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;640&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effect of non-compliance</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Unless subsection (2) applies, an appointment as auditor of a foreign company is void if subsection (1) has not been complied with.</Text></Subsection></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_632.1&quot;,gc=&quot;s_641&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_632.1&quot;,gc=&quot;s_641&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Examinations and Reports</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;641&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;641&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Auditor’s examination</MarginalNote><Label>641.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;641&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The auditor of a foreign company shall make such examination as the auditor considers necessary to enable the auditor to report on the annual return required by subsection 665(2) and on other financial statements required by this Act to be filed with the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;641&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;641&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Auditing standards</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The auditor’s examination referred to in subsection (1) shall, except as otherwise specified by the Superintendent, be conducted in accordance with generally accepted auditing standards, the primary source of which is the Handbook of the Canadian Institute of Chartered Accountants.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;641&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;641&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Reliance on actuary</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>An auditor of a foreign company may, in conducting the examination referred to in subsection (1), use the valuation by the actuary of the foreign company of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;641&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the actuarial and other policy liabilities of the foreign company as at the end of a financial year; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;641&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the increase in the actuarial liabilities of the foreign company for a financial year.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;642&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;642&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Right to information</MarginalNote><Label>642.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;642&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>On the request of the auditor of a foreign company, the present or former chief agents, directors, officers, employees or representatives of the foreign company shall, to the extent that they are reasonably able to do so,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;642&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>permit access to such records, assets and security held by the foreign company, or any entity in which the foreign company has a substantial investment, in respect of the insurance business in Canada of the foreign company, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;642&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>provide such information and explanations</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>as are, in the opinion of the auditor, necessary to enable the auditor to perform the duties of auditor of the foreign company.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;642&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;642&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">No civil liability</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A person who in good faith makes an oral or written communication under subsection (1) shall not be liable in any civil action arising from having made the communication.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;643&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;643&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Auditor’s report and extended examination</MarginalNote><Label>643.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;643&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The Superintendent may, in writing, require that the auditor of a foreign company report to the Superintendent on the extent of the auditor’s procedures in the examination of the annual return and may, in writing, require that the auditor enlarge or extend the scope of that examination or direct that any other particular procedure be performed in any particular case, and the auditor shall comply with any such requirement of the Superintendent and report to the Superintendent thereon.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;643&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;643&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Special examination</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>In respect of the insurance business in Canada of a foreign company, the Superintendent may, in writing, require that the auditor of the foreign company make a particular examination relating to the adequacy of the procedures adopted by the foreign company for the safety of its creditors and policyholders, or any other examination that, in the Superintendent’s opinion, the public interest may require, and report to the Superintendent on the examination.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;643&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;643&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Idem</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>In respect of the insurance business in Canada of a foreign company, the Superintendent may direct that a special audit of the foreign company be made if, in the opinion of the Superintendent, it is so required and may appoint for that purpose an accountant or a firm of accountants qualified pursuant to subsection 634(1) to be an auditor of the foreign company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;643&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;643&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Expenses payable by foreign company</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>The expenses entailed by any examination or audit referred to in any of subsections (1) to (3) are payable by the foreign company on being approved in writing by the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 643;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 296.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;644&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;644&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Auditor’s report</MarginalNote><Label>644.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;644&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The auditor of a foreign company shall, not later than the earlier of May 31 in each year and the day in each year on which the auditor is required to make a report under the laws under which the foreign company is incorporated, make a report to the chief agent in writing on the annual return required by subsection 665(2).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;644&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;644&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Auditor’s opinion</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>In each report required under subsection (1), the auditor shall state whether, in the auditor’s opinion, the annual return presents fairly, in accordance with the accounting principles referred to in subsection 331(4), the financial position of the insurance business in Canada of the foreign company as at the end of the financial year to which it relates and the results of the operations and changes in the financial position of the insurance business in Canada of the foreign company for that financial year.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;644&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;644&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Auditor’s remarks</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>In each report referred to in subsection (2), the auditor shall include such remarks as the auditor considers necessary when</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;644&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the examination has not been made in accordance with the auditing standards referred to in subsection 641(2);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;644&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the annual return has not been prepared on a basis consistent with that of the preceding financial year; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;644&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the annual return does not present fairly, in accordance with the accounting principles referred to in subsection 331(4), the financial position of the insurance business in Canada of the foreign company as at the end of the financial year to which it relates or the results of the operations or changes in the financial position of the foreign company for that financial year.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 644;</li><li> 1994, c. 26, s. 44(F).</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;645&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;645&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Report to chief agent</MarginalNote><Label>645.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;645&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>It is the duty of the auditor of a foreign company to report in writing to the chief agent of the foreign company any transactions or conditions in respect of the insurance business in Canada of the foreign company that have come to the auditor’s attention affecting the well-being of the foreign company that in the auditor’s opinion are not satisfactory and require rectification and, without restricting the generality of the foregoing, the auditor shall, as occasion requires, make a report to the chief agent in respect of transactions in respect of the insurance business in Canada of the foreign company that have come to the auditor’s attention and that in the auditor’s opinion have not been within the powers of the foreign company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;645&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;645&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Transmission of report</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where the auditor of a foreign company makes a report under subsection (1), the auditor shall, at the time of transmitting the report to the chief agent provide the Superintendent with a copy of the report.</Text></Subsection></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_632.1&quot;,gc=&quot;s_646&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_632.1&quot;,gc=&quot;s_646&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Qualified Privilege</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;646&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;646&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Qualified privilege for statements</MarginalNote><Label>646.</Label><Text>Any oral or written statement or report made under this Act by the auditor or a former auditor of a foreign company has qualified privilege.</Text></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_647&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_647&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Records</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;647&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;647&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Records</MarginalNote><Label>647.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;647&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A foreign company shall prepare and maintain</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;647&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>copies of all orders of the Superintendent in relation to the foreign company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;647&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>accounting records respecting its insurance business in Canada; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;647&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>with respect to its insurance business in Canada, records showing, for each customer of, or claimant under a policy issued by, the foreign company, the amount owing to the foreign company and the nature of the liabilities of the foreign company to the customer or claimant.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;647&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;647&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Standards for record keeping</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The records described in paragraphs (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) and (<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>) shall be kept in a manner that enables the chief agent of the foreign company to provide the Superintendent with the information required by section 664 and with the annual return required by subsection 665(2).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;647&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;647&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Place of records</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The records described in subsection (1) shall be kept at the chief agency of the foreign company.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 647;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 449;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 297.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;648&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;648&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Examination of books</MarginalNote><Label>648.</Label><Text>The Superintendent may examine the books, vouchers, receipts and other documents of a foreign company relating to its insurance business in Canada for the purpose of verifying information provided to the Superintendent pursuant to section 664 or 665.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;649&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;649&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Sections 266 to 270 apply</MarginalNote><Label>649.</Label><Text>Section 266 to 270 apply, with such modifications as the circumstances require, to foreign companies.</Text></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_650&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XIII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_650&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Release of Assets</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;650&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;650&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application for release of assets in Canada</MarginalNote><Label>650.</Label><Text>A foreign company that proposes to cease to insure in Canada risks may apply to the Superintendent for the release of its assets in Canada.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 650;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 298.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;651&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;651&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Conditions of release</MarginalNote><Label>651.</Label><Text>Except as otherwise provided in this Act, the Superintendent may, by order, authorize the release of the assets in Canada of a foreign company if the foreign company</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;651&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>has, in respect of its policies,</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;651&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>obtained their surrender,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;651&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>transferred them,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;651&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>caused itself to be reinsured, on an assumption basis, against the risks undertaken under them, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;651&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;iv&quot;"><Label>(iv)</Label><Text>otherwise discharged its liabilities under them, or provided for their discharge in a manner satisfactory to the Superintendent;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;651&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>has discharged all of its obligations, other than liabilities under its policies, or provided for them in a manner satisfactory to the Superintendent; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;651&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>has provided the Superintendent with proof of the publication, for four consecutive weeks, in the <XRefExternal reference-type="other" link="gazette">Canada Gazette</XRefExternal> and in at least one newspaper of general circulation at or near the place where the chief agency of the foreign company is situated, of a notice that it will apply to the Superintendent for the release of its assets in Canada on a day specified in the notice, which must be at least six weeks after the date of the notice, and calling on its creditors and policyholders opposing that release to file their opposition with the Superintendent on or before the day.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 651;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 90;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 298.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;652&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;652&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Release of assets to liquidator</MarginalNote><Label>652.</Label><Text>Despite sections 650 and 651, the assets in Canada of a foreign company that is in liquidation may, on the order of any court having jurisdiction under the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="W-11">Winding-up and Restructuring Act</XRefExternal>, be released to the liquidator.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 652;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 298.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;653&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;653&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Revocation of order</MarginalNote><Label>653.</Label><Text>The Superintendent may revoke the order made under subsection 574(1) in respect of a foreign company if in the opinion of the Superintendent the foreign company is not insuring in Canada risks, or if the foreign company does not</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;653&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>provide information to the Superintendent as required by section 664;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;653&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>provide the annual return to the Superintendent as required by section 665;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;653&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>permit the examination authorized by section 648 or 674; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;653&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>provide any information in its possession or control that is requested for the purpose of any such examination.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 653;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 298.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;654&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;654&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Deemed revocation</MarginalNote><Label>654.</Label><Text>An order made under subsection 574(1) in respect of a foreign company is deemed to be revoked when an order is made under section 651 or 652 authorizing the release of its assets in Canada.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 654;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 167;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 298.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;655&quot;"><Label>655.</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 2007, c. 6, s. 298]</Repealed></Text><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XIV&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="1"><Label>PART XIV</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XIV&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">PROVINCIAL COMPANIES</TitleText></Heading><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XIV&quot;,gb=&quot;s_656&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XIV&quot;,gb=&quot;s_656&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Application</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;656&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;656&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application of other provisions</MarginalNote><Label>656.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;656&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Divisions XII to XIV of Part VI, other than subsection 330(2), Parts VIII to XI and Part XX apply to provincial companies.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;656&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;656&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Idem</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Subsections 15(1) and (2) and sections 254 to 256 and 268 apply, with such modifications as the circumstances require, to every provincial company for which an order for the commencement and carrying on of business under this Part has been made to the same extent that they are applicable to, or in respect of, a company, but to the extent to which any provision referred to in this section would effect an enlargement, in any respect, of the corporate powers or rights of any provincial company under its incorporating instrument, that provision does not apply to the provincial company.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 656;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 303.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XIV&quot;,gb=&quot;s_657&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XIV&quot;,gb=&quot;s_657&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Order to Commence and Carry on Business</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;657&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;657&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Making of order</MarginalNote><Label>657.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;657&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Forthwith on the coming into force of this Part, the Superintendent shall make an order approving the commencement and carrying on of business by every provincial company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;657&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;657&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Order to specify classes of insurance</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>An order approving the commencement and carrying on of business by a provincial company under subsection (1) shall specify the classes of insurance risks that the provincial company is permitted to insure pursuant to section 443, as applied by subsection 656(1).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;657&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;657&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Conditions of order</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>An order approving the commencement and carrying on of business by a provincial company may contain such conditions or limitations that are consistent with this Act and relate to the business of the provincial company as the Superintendent deems expedient and necessary.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;657&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;657&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Variations</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>In respect of the order approving the commencement and carrying on of business by a provincial company, the Superintendent may at any time, by further order,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;657&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>specify additional classes of insurance risks that the provincial company is permitted to insure pursuant to section 443, as applied by subsection 656(1),</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;657&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>make the order subject to such conditions or limitations that are consistent with this Act and that relate to the business of the provincial company as the Superintendent deems expedient and necessary, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;657&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>amend or revoke any authorization contained in the order or any condition or limitation to which the order is subject,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>but before making any such further order the Superintendent shall provide the provincial company with an opportunity to make representations regarding that further order.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;657&quot;,ss=&quot;5)&quot;"><Label>(5) and (6)</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 1996, c. 6, s. 91]</Repealed></Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 657;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 91.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;658&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;658&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Undertaking</MarginalNote><Label>658.</Label><Text>Every provincial company for which an order has been made under section 657 shall provide the Superintendent with an undertaking in such form as may be required by the Superintendent that it will, so long as the order is not rescinded, submit to and comply with all of the provisions of this Act applicable to it in respect of the classes of insurance specified in the order and any conditions or limitations set out in the order.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;659&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;659&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Transitional</MarginalNote><Label>659.</Label><Text>A provincial company that deposited securities with the Receiver General pursuant to section 76 or 82 of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act">Canadian and British Insurance Companies Act</XRefExternal> shall apply for the return of those securities within such period following the coming into force of this section as may be fixed by order of the Governor in Council.</Text></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XIV&quot;,gb=&quot;s_660&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XIV&quot;,gb=&quot;s_660&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Duties of Directors</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;660&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;660&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Appointment of actuary, auditor and conduct review committee</MarginalNote><Label>660.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;660&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The directors of a provincial company shall</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;660&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>appoint the actuary of the provincial company forthwith after the Superintendent makes an order for the provincial company under section 657;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;660&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>appoint the auditor of the provincial company for the purposes of this Act forthwith after the Superintendent makes an order for the provincial company under section 657; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;660&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>establish a conduct review committee consisting of at least three directors who are not affiliated with the company, determined in accordance with regulations made under section 170.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;660&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;660&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Duties of conduct review committee</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The conduct review committee of a provincial company shall</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;660&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>require the management of the provincial company to establish procedures for complying with Part XI;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;660&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>review those procedures and their effectiveness in ensuring that the provincial company is complying with Part XI;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;660&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b.1&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b.1</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if an insurance holding company or a bank holding company that is widely held has a significant interest in any class of shares of the provincial company, establish policies for entering into transactions referred to in section 528.1; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;660&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>review the practices of the provincial company to ensure that any transactions with related parties of the provincial company that may have a material effect on the stability or solvency of the provincial company are identified.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;660&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;660&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Provincial company report to Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A provincial company shall report to the Superintendent on the mandate and responsibilities of the conduct review committee and the procedures established by the committee under paragraph (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;660&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;660&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Committee report to directors</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>After each meeting of the conduct review committee of a provincial company, the committee shall report to the directors of the provincial company on all transactions and other matters reviewed by the committee.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;660&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;660&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Directors’ report to Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>Within ninety days after the end of each financial year, the directors of a provincial company shall report to the Superintendent on the proceedings of the conduct review committee and on all transactions and other matters reviewed by the committee during the year.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 660;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 450.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XIV&quot;,gb=&quot;s_661&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XIV&quot;,gb=&quot;s_661&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Corporate Records</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;661&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;661&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Provincial company to provide information</MarginalNote><Label>661.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;661&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A provincial company shall provide the Superintendent with such information, material and evidence, at such times and in such form, as the Superintendent may require, and, without limiting the generality of the foregoing, the information, material and evidence shall include</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;661&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>copies of its incorporating instrument and the by-laws of the provincial company; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;661&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>copies of any of the records referred to in section 662.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;661&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;661&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Names of directors and auditors</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A provincial company shall, within thirty days after each annual meeting of the provincial company, provide the Superintendent with a return showing</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;661&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the name, residence and citizenship of each director holding office immediately following the meeting;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;661&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the mailing address of each director holding office immediately following the meeting;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;661&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the bodies corporate of which each director referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) is an officer or director and the firms of which each director is a member;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;661&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the affiliation, within the meaning of section 170, with the provincial company of each director referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;661&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the names of the directors referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) who are officers or employees of the provincial company or any affiliate of the provincial company, and the positions they occupy;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;661&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the name of each committee of the provincial company on which each director referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) serves;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;661&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the date of expiration of the term of each director referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>); and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;661&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;h&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">h</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the name, address and date of appointment of the auditor of the provincial company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;661&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;661&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Changes</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Where</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;661&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any information relating to a director or auditor of a provincial company shown in the latest return made to the Superintendent under subsection (2), other than information referred to in paragraph (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), becomes inaccurate or incomplete,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;661&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a vacancy in the position of auditor of the provincial company occurs or is filled by another person, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;661&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a vacancy on the board of directors of the provincial company occurs or is filled,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>the provincial company shall forthwith provide the Superintendent with such information as is required to maintain the return in a complete and accurate form.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;662&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;662&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Records</MarginalNote><Label>662.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;662&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A provincial company shall prepare and maintain adequate</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;662&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>corporate accounting records; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;662&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>records showing, for each customer of, or claimant under a policy issued by, the provincial company, the amount owing to the provincial company and the nature of the liabilities of the provincial company to the customer or claimant.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;662&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;662&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Definition of <DefinedTermEn>records</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>For the purposes of subsection (1), <DefinedTermEn>records</DefinedTermEn> includes similar records required by law to be maintained by the provincial company before the coming into force of this section.</Text></Subsection></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XV&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="1"><Label>PART XV</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XV&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">REGULATION OF COMPANIES, SOCIETIES, FOREIGN COMPANIES AND PROVINCIAL COMPANIES — SUPERINTENDENT</TitleText></Heading><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XV&quot;,gb=&quot;s_663&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XV&quot;,gb=&quot;s_663&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Interpretation</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;663&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;663&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Definition of <DefinedTermEn>société</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><Label>663.</Label><Text>In the French version of this Part, <DefinedTermEn>société</DefinedTermEn> means a <DefinedTermEn>société</DefinedTermEn>, “société de secours”, “société étrangère” or “société provinciale” within the meaning of section 2.</Text></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XV&quot;,gb=&quot;s_664&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XV&quot;,gb=&quot;s_664&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Supervision</TitleText></Heading><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XV&quot;,gb=&quot;s_664&quot;,gc=&quot;s_664&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XV&quot;,gb=&quot;s_664&quot;,gc=&quot;s_664&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Returns</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;664&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;664&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Required information</MarginalNote><Label>664.</Label><Text>A company, society, foreign company or provincial company shall provide the Superintendent with such information, at such times and in such form as the Superintendent may require.</Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;665&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;665&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Annual return — companies, societies and provincial companies</MarginalNote><Label>665.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;665&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company, society or provincial company shall prepare annually a return of the condition and affairs of the company, society or provincial company as at the end of each financial year, showing its assets and liabilities and its income and expenditures during that financial year together with such other information as the Superintendent may deem necessary.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;665&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;665&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Annual return: foreign companies</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A foreign company, in respect of its insurance business in Canada, shall prepare annually a return of the condition and affairs of the foreign company as at the end of each financial year, showing its assets and liabilities and its income and expenditures during that financial year together with such other information as the Superintendent may deem necessary.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;665&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><Label>(3)</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 2007, c. 6, s. 299]</Repealed></Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;665&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;665&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Accounting principles</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>The annual return shall be prepared in accordance with the accounting principles referred to in subsection 331(4).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 665;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 322;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 299.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;666&quot;"><Label>666.</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 1997, c. 15, s. 323]</Repealed></Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;667&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;667&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Valuation of actuarial and other policy liabilities</MarginalNote><Label>667.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;667&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The liabilities of a company, society, foreign company or provincial company shown in its annual return must include as a reserve the value of the actuarial and other policy liabilities and other matters determined under section 365 or section 629.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;667&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;667&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Report of actuary</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The actuary of a company, society, foreign company or provincial company shall make, and the company, society, foreign company or provincial company shall file with its annual return, a report in a form determined by the Superintendent on the reserve referred to in subsection (1).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;667&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;667&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Auditor’s remarks</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The auditor of a company, society or provincial company shall attach to the annual return a report stating whether, in the auditor’s opinion, the annual return presents fairly, in accordance with accounting principles referred to in subsection 331(4), the financial position of the company, society or provincial company as at the end of the financial year to which it relates and the results of the operations and changes in the financial position of the company, society or provincial company for that financial year.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;667&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;667&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Idem</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>In each report referred to in subsection (3), the auditor shall include such remarks as the auditor considers necessary when</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;667&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the examination has not been made in accordance with the auditing standards referred to in subsection 346(2);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;667&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the annual return has not been prepared on a basis consistent with that of the preceding financial year; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;667&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the annual return does not present fairly, in accordance with the accounting principles referred to in subsection 331(4), the financial position of the company, society or provincial company as at the end of the financial year to which it relates or the results of the operations or changes in the financial position of the company, society or provincial company for that financial year.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;668&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;668&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Names of directors and auditors</MarginalNote><Label>668.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;668&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company shall, within thirty days after each annual meeting of the company, provide the Superintendent with a return showing</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;668&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the name, residence and citizenship of each director holding office immediately following the meeting;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;668&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the mailing address of each director holding office immediately following the meeting;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;668&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the bodies corporate of which each director referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) is an officer or director and the firms of which each director is a member;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;668&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the affiliation, within the meaning of section 170, with the company of each director referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;668&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the names of the directors referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) who are officers or employees of the company or any affiliate of the company, and the positions they occupy;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;668&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the name of each committee of the company on which each director referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) serves;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;668&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the date of expiration of the term of each director referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>); and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;668&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;h&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">h</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the name, address and date of appointment of the auditor of the company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;668&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;668&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Changes</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;668&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any information relating to a director or auditor of a company shown in the latest return made to the Superintendent under subsection (1), other than information referred to in paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), becomes inaccurate or incomplete,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;668&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a vacancy in the position of auditor of the company occurs or is filled by another person, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;668&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a vacancy on the board of directors of the company occurs or is filled,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>the company shall forthwith provide the Superintendent with such information as is required to maintain the return in a complete and accurate form.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;669&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;669&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Copy of by-laws</MarginalNote><Label>669.</Label><Text>A company shall send to the Superintendent, within thirty days after the coming into effect of a by-law or an amendment to a by-law, a copy of the by-law or amendment.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 669;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 452.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;670&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;670&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Registers</MarginalNote><Label>670.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;670&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The Superintendent shall cause a register to be maintained in respect of each company or society for which an order has been made approving the commencement and carrying on of business.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;670&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;670&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Register for company</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The register in respect of a company shall contain a copy of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;670&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the incorporating instrument of the company; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;670&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the information referred to in paragraphs 668(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>), (<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>) and (<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">h</Emphasis>) contained in the latest return provided to the Superintendent by the company as required by section 668.</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;670&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 2001, c. 9, s. 453]</Repealed></Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;670&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;670&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Register for society</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The register in respect of a society shall contain a copy of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;670&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the incorporating instrument of the society; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;670&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the information referred to in paragraphs 549(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) and (<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>) contained in the latest return provided to the Superintendent by the society as required by subsection 549(1).</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;670&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 2001, c. 9, s. 453]</Repealed></Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;670&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;670&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Form</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>The register may be maintained in</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;670&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a bound or loose-leaf form or a photographic film form; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;670&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a system of mechanical or electronic data processing or any other information storage device that is capable of reproducing any required information in intelligible written form within a reasonable time.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;670&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;670&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Access</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>Persons are entitled to reasonable access to the register and may make copies of or take extracts from the information in it.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;670&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;670&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Evidence</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>A statement containing information in the register and purporting to be certified by the Superintendent is admissible in evidence in all courts as proof, in the absence of evidence to the contrary, of the facts stated in the statement without proof of the appointment or signature of the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 670;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 324;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 453.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;671&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;671&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Production of information and documents</MarginalNote><Label>671.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;671&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The Superintendent may, by order, direct a person who controls a company or any entity that is affiliated with a company to provide the Superintendent with such information or documents as may be specified in the order where the Superintendent believes that the production of the information or documents is necessary in order to be satisfied that the provisions of this Act are being duly observed and that the company is in a sound financial condition.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;671&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;671&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Time</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Any person to whom a direction has been issued under subsection (1) shall provide the information or documents specified in the order within the time specified in the order and, where the order does not specify a time, the person shall provide the information or documents within a reasonable time.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;671&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;671&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exemption</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Subsection (1) does not apply in respect of an entity that controls a company or is affiliated with a company where that entity is a financial institution regulated</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;671&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>by or under an Act of Parliament; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;671&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>by or under an Act of the legislature of a province where the Superintendent has entered into an agreement with the appropriate official or public body responsible for the supervision of financial institutions in that province concerning the sharing of information on such financial institutions.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;672&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;672&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Confidential information</MarginalNote><Label>672.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;672&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to section 673, all information regarding the business or affairs of a company, society, foreign company or provincial company, or regarding a person dealing with any of them, that is obtained by the Superintendent, or by any person acting under the direction of the Superintendent, as a result of the administration or enforcement of any Act of Parliament, and all information prepared from that information, is confidential and shall be treated accordingly.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;672&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;672&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Disclosure permitted</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Nothing in subsection (1) prevents the Superintendent from disclosing any information</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;672&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>to any government agency or body that regulates or supervises financial institutions, for purposes related to that regulation or supervision,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;672&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a.01&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a.01</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>to any other agency or body that regulates or supervises financial institutions, for purposes related to that regulation or supervision,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;672&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a.1&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a.1</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>to any compensation association designated by order of the Minister pursuant to subsection 449(1) or 591(1), for purposes related to its operation, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;672&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>to the Deputy Minister of Finance or any officer of the Department of Finance authorized in writing by the Deputy Minister of Finance or to the Governor of the Bank of Canada or any officer of the Bank of Canada authorized in writing by the Governor of the Bank of Canada, for the purposes of policy analysis related to the regulation of financial institutions,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>if the Superintendent is satisfied that the information will be treated as confidential by the agency, body or person to whom it is disclosed.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 672;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 92;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 325;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 454.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;672.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;672.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations</MarginalNote><Label>672.1</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations prohibiting, limiting or restricting the disclosure by companies, societies, foreign companies or provincial companies of prescribed supervisory information.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1999, c. 28, s. 126.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;673&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;673&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Disclosure by Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>673.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;673&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The Superintendent shall disclose, at such times and in such manner as the Minister may determine, such information obtained by the Superintendent under this Act as the Minister considers ought to be disclosed for the purposes of the analysis of the financial condition of a company, society, foreign company or provincial company and that</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;673&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>is contained in returns filed pursuant to the Superintendent’s financial regulatory reporting requirements in respect of companies, societies, foreign companies or provincial companies; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;673&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>has been obtained as a result of an industry-wide or sectoral survey conducted by the Superintendent in relation to an issue or circumstances that could have an impact on the financial condition of companies, societies, foreign companies or provincial companies.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;673&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;673&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Prior consultation required</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The Minister shall consult with the Superintendent before making any determination under subsection (1).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 673;</li><li> 1994, c. 26, s. 45;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 93.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;673.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;673.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Disclosure by a company, etc.</MarginalNote><Label>673.1</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;673.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A company, society, foreign company or provincial company shall make available to the public such information concerning</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;673.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the compensation of its executives, as that expression is defined by the regulations, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;673.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>its business and affairs for the purposes of the analysis of its financial condition,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>in such form and manner and at such times as may be required by or pursuant to such regulations as the Governor in Council may make for the purpose.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;673.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;673.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exemption by regulation</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) does not apply to a company, society, foreign company or provincial company that is within such class or classes of companies, societies, foreign companies or provincial companies as may be prescribed.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1996, c. 6, s. 93.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;673.2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;673.2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exceptions to disclosure</MarginalNote><Label>673.2</Label><Text>Subject to any regulations made under section 489 or 607, no information obtained by a company, society, foreign company or provincial company regarding any of its customers shall be disclosed or made available under subsection 673(1) or section 673.1.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1996, c. 6, s. 93.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;673.3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;673.3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Report respecting disclosure</MarginalNote><Label>673.3</Label><Text>The Superintendent shall prepare a report, to be included in the report referred to in section 40 of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="O-2.7">Office of the Superintendent of Financial Institutions Act</XRefExternal>, respecting the disclosure of information by companies, societies, foreign companies or provincial companies and describing the state of progress made in enhancing the disclosure of information in the financial services industry.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1996, c. 6, s. 93;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 455.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XV&quot;,gb=&quot;s_664&quot;,gc=&quot;s_674&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XV&quot;,gb=&quot;s_664&quot;,gc=&quot;s_674&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Inspection of Companies, Societies, Foreign Companies and Provincial Companies</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;674&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;674&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Examination of companies, etc.</MarginalNote><Label>674.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;674&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The Superintendent, from time to time, but at least once in each calendar year, shall make or cause to be made any examination and inquiry into the business and affairs of each company, society, foreign company and provincial company that the Superintendent considers to be necessary or expedient to determine whether the company, society, foreign company or provincial company is complying with the provisions of this Act and whether the company, society or provincial company or the insurance business in Canada of the foreign company is in a sound financial condition and, after the conclusion of each examination and inquiry, shall report on it to the Minister.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;674&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;674&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Examination need not be made annually</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If, in the opinion of the Superintendent, the circumstances so warrant in the case of a company, a provincial company or a foreign company that is not a fraternal benefit society, the examination and inquiry may be made less frequently than annually but not less frequently than triennially.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;674&quot;,ss=&quot;2.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;674&quot;,ss=&quot;2.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Examination need not be made annually</MarginalNote><Label>(2.1)</Label><Text>If, in the opinion of the Superintendent, the circumstances so warrant in the case of a society or a foreign company that is a fraternal benefit society, the examination and inquiry may be made less frequently than annually.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;674&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;674&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Access to records of company</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The Superintendent or a person acting under the Superintendent’s direction</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;674&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>has a right of access to any records, cash, assets and security held by or on behalf of a company, society or provincial company or held by or on behalf of a foreign company in respect of its insurance business in Canada; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;674&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>may require the directors, officers, auditor and actuary of a company, society or provincial company or the chief agent, actuary and auditor of a foreign company to provide information and explanations, to the extent that they are reasonably able to do so, in respect of the condition and affairs of the company, society, foreign company or provincial company or any entity in which it has a substantial investment.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 674;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 456.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;675&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;675&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Power of Superintendent on inquiry</MarginalNote><Label>675.</Label><Text>The Superintendent has all the powers of a person appointed as a commissioner under Part II of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="I-11">Inquiries Act</XRefExternal> for the purpose of obtaining evidence under oath, and may delegate those powers to any person acting under the Superintendent’s direction.</Text></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XV&quot;,gb=&quot;s_675.1&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XV&quot;,gb=&quot;s_675.1&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Remedial Powers</TitleText></Heading><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XV&quot;,gb=&quot;s_675.1&quot;,gc=&quot;s_675.1&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XV&quot;,gb=&quot;s_675.1&quot;,gc=&quot;s_675.1&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Prudential Agreements</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;675.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;675.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Prudential agreement</MarginalNote><Label>675.1</Label><Text>The Superintendent may enter into an agreement, called a “prudential agreement”, with a company, society or provincial company for the purposes of implementing any measure designed to maintain or improve its safety and soundness or with a foreign company for the purposes of implementing any measure designed to protect the interests of its policyholders and creditors in respect of its insurance business in Canada.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 457.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XV&quot;,gb=&quot;s_675.1&quot;,gc=&quot;s_676&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XV&quot;,gb=&quot;s_675.1&quot;,gc=&quot;s_676&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Directions of Compliance</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;676&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;676&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Superintendent’s directions to companies, etc.</MarginalNote><Label>676.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;676&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where, in the opinion of the Superintendent, a company, society, foreign company or provincial company, or a person with respect to a company, society, foreign company or provincial company,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;676&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>is committing, or is about to commit, an act that is an unsafe or unsound practice in conducting the business of the company, society, foreign company or provincial company, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;676&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>is pursuing or is about to pursue any course of conduct that is an unsafe or unsound practice in conducting the business of the company, society, foreign company or provincial company,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>the Superintendent may direct the company, society, foreign company, provincial company or person to</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;676&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>cease or refrain from committing the act or pursuing the course of conduct, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;676&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>perform such acts as in the opinion of the Superintendent are necessary to remedy the situation.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;676&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;676&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Opportunity for representations</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection (3), no direction shall be issued to a company, society, foreign company, provincial company or person under subsection (1) unless the company, society, foreign company, provincial company or person is provided with a reasonable opportunity to make representations in respect of the matter.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;676&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;676&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Temporary direction</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Where, in the opinion of the Superintendent, the length of time required for representations to be made under subsection (2) might be prejudicial to the public interest, the Superintendent may make a temporary direction with respect to the matters referred to in paragraphs (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) and (<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) having effect for a period of not more than fifteen days.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;676&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;676&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Idem</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Subject to section 677, a temporary direction under subsection (3) continues to have effect after the expiration of the fifteen day period referred to in that subsection if no representations are made to the Superintendent within that period or, if representations have been made, the Superintendent notifies the company, society, foreign company, provincial company or person that the Superintendent is not satisfied that there are sufficient grounds for revoking the direction.</Text></Subsection></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;677&quot;"><Label>677.</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 1996, c. 6, s. 94]</Repealed></Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;678&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Court enforcement</MarginalNote><Label>678.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where a company, society, foreign company, provincial company or person</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;678&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>is contravening or has failed to comply with a prudential agreement entered into under section 675.1 or a direction of the Superintendent issued to the company, society, foreign company, provincial company or person pursuant to subsection 676(1) or (3),</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;678&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>is contravening this Act, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;678&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>has omitted to do any thing under this Act that is required to be done by or on the part of the company, society, foreign company, provincial company or person,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>the Superintendent may, in addition to any other action that may be taken under this Act, apply to a court for an order requiring the company, society, foreign company, provincial company or person to comply with the prudential agreement or direction, cease the contravention or do any thing that is required to be done, and on such application the court may so order and make any other order it thinks fit.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Appeal</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>An appeal from a decision of a court under subsection (1) lies in the same manner, and to the same court, as an appeal from any other order of the court.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 678;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 458.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XV&quot;,gb=&quot;s_675.1&quot;,gc=&quot;s_678.01&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XV&quot;,gb=&quot;s_675.1&quot;,gc=&quot;s_678.01&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Disqualification and Removal</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;678.01&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678.01&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Meaning of “senior officer”</MarginalNote><Label>678.01</Label><Text>In sections 678.1 and 678.2, <DefinedTermEn>senior officer</DefinedTermEn> means the chief executive officer, secretary, treasurer, controller or actuary of a company, society or provincial company, or any other officer reporting directly to its board of directors or chief executive officer.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 459.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;678.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application</MarginalNote><Label>678.1</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>This section applies only in respect of a company, society or provincial company</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;678.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>that has been notified by the Superintendent that this section applies to it where the company, society or provincial company is subject to measures designed to maintain or improve its safety and soundness, which measures</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;678.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>have been specified by the Superintendent by way of conditions or limitations in respect of the order approving the commencement and carrying on of its business, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;678.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>are contained in a prudential agreement entered into under section 675.1 or an undertaking given by the company, society or provincial company to the Superintendent; or</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;678.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>that is the subject of a direction made under section 676 or an order made under subsection 515(3).</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Information to be provided</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A company, society or provincial company shall provide the Superintendent with the name of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;678.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>each person who has been nominated for election or appointment as a member of its board of directors,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;678.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>each person who has been selected by the company, society or provincial company for appointment as a senior officer, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;678.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>each person who is newly elected as a director of the company, society or provincial company at a meeting of shareholders and policyholders and who was not proposed for election by anyone involved in the management of the company, society or provincial company,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>together with such other information about the background, business record and experience of the person as the Superintendent may require.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">When information to be provided</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The information required by subsection (2) shall be provided to the Superintendent</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;678.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>at least thirty days prior to the date or proposed date of the election or appointment or within such shorter period as the Superintendent may allow; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;678.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of a person referred to in paragraph (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>), within fifteen days after the date of the election of the person.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678.1&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678.1&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Disqualification or removal</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>If the Superintendent is of the opinion that, on the basis of the competence, business record, experience, conduct or character of a person, he or she is not suitable to hold that position, the Superintendent may, by order</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;678.1&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of a person referred to in paragraph (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>), disqualify the person from being elected or appointed as a director of the company, society or provincial company or from being appointed as a senior officer; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;678.1&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of a person referred to in paragraph (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>), remove the person from office as a director of the company, society or provincial company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678.1&quot;,ss=&quot;4.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678.1&quot;,ss=&quot;4.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Risk of prejudice</MarginalNote><Label>(4.1)</Label><Text>In forming an opinion under subsection (4), the Superintendent must consider whether the interests of the policyholders and creditors of the company, society or provincial company would likely be prejudiced if the person were to take office or continue to hold office, as the case may be.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678.1&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678.1&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Representations may be made</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>The Superintendent must in writing notify the person concerned and the company, society or provincial company of any action that the Superintendent proposes to take under subsection (4) and must afford them an opportunity within 15 days after the date of the notice, or within any longer period that the Superintendent allows, to make representations to the Superintendent in relation to the matter.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678.1&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678.1&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Prohibition</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>Where an order has been made under subsection (4)</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;678.1&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>disqualifying a person from being elected or appointed to a position, the person shall not be, and the company, society or provincial company shall not permit the person to be, elected or appointed to the position; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;678.1&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>removing a director from office, the person shall not continue to hold, and the company, society or provincial company shall not permit the person to continue to hold, office as a director.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1996, c. 6, s. 95;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 460;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 300.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;678.2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678.2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Removal of directors or senior officers</MarginalNote><Label>678.2</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678.2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The Superintendent may, by order, remove a person from office as a director or senior officer of a company, society or provincial company if the Superintendent is of the opinion that the person is not suitable to hold that office</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;678.2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>on the basis of the competence, business record, experience, conduct or character of the person; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;678.2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>because the person has contravened or, by action or negligence, has contributed to the contravention of</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;678.2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>this Act or the regulations made under it,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;678.2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>a direction made under section 676,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;678.2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>an order made under subsection 515(3),</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;678.2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;iv&quot;"><Label>(iv)</Label><Text>a condition or limitation in respect of the order approving the commencement and carrying on of business by the company, society or provincial company, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;678.2&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;v&quot;"><Label>(v)</Label><Text>a prudential agreement entered into under section 675.1 or an undertaking given by the company, society or provincial company to the Superintendent.</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678.2&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678.2&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Risk of prejudice</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>In forming an opinion under subsection (1), the Superintendent must consider whether the interests of the policyholders and creditors of the company, society or provincial company have been or are likely to be prejudiced by the person’s holding office as a director or senior officer.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678.2&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678.2&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Representations may be made</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The Superintendent must in writing notify the person concerned and the company, society or provincial company of any removal order that the Superintendent proposes to make under subsection (1) and must afford them an opportunity within 15 days after the date of the notice, or within any longer period that the Superintendent allows, to make representations to the Superintendent in relation to the matter.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678.2&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678.2&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Suspension</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>If the Superintendent is of the opinion that the public interest may be prejudiced by the director or senior officer continuing to exercise the powers or carry out the duties and functions of that office during the period for making representations, the Superintendent may make an order suspending the director or senior officer. The suspension may not extend beyond 10 days after the expiration of that period.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678.2&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678.2&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of order</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>The Superintendent shall, without delay, notify the director or senior officer, as the case may be, and the company, society or provincial company of a removal order or suspension order.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678.2&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678.2&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Consequences of removal order</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>The director or senior officer, as the case may be, ceases to hold that office as of the date the removal order is made or any later date specified in the order.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678.2&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678.2&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Appeal</MarginalNote><Label>(7)</Label><Text>The director or senior officer, as the case may be, or the company, society or provincial company, as the case may be, may, within 30 days after the date of receipt of notice of the removal order under subsection (5), or within any longer period that the Court allows, appeal the matter to the Federal Court.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678.2&quot;,ss=&quot;8&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678.2&quot;,ss=&quot;8&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Powers of Federal Court</MarginalNote><Label>(8)</Label><Text>The Federal Court, in the case of an appeal, may dismiss the appeal or set aside the removal order.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678.2&quot;,ss=&quot;9&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678.2&quot;,ss=&quot;9&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Order not stayed by appeal</MarginalNote><Label>(9)</Label><Text>A removal order is not stayed by an appeal.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 461;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 301.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;678.3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678.3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application</MarginalNote><Label>678.3</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678.3&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>This section applies only in respect of a foreign company</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;678.3&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>that has been notified by the Superintendent that this section applies to it where the foreign company is subject to measures designed to protect the interests of its policyholders and creditors in respect of its insurance business in Canada, which measures</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;678.3&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>have been specified by the Superintendent by way of conditions or limitations in respect of the order made under subsection 574(1) in respect of the foreign company, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;678.3&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>are contained in a prudential agreement entered into under section 675.1 or an undertaking given by the foreign company to the Superintendent; or</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;678.3&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>that is the subject of a direction made under section 676 or an order made under subsection 608(4) or 609(2).</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678.3&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678.3&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Information to be provided</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A foreign company shall provide the Superintendent with the name of any person who has been selected by the foreign company for appointment as chief agent together with such other information about the background, business record and experience of the person as the Superintendent may require.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678.3&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678.3&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">When information to be provided</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The information required by subsection (2) shall be provided to the Superintendent at least 30 days prior to the date of the appointment or within any shorter period that the Superintendent may allow.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678.3&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678.3&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Disqualification</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>If the Superintendent is of the opinion that, on the basis of the competence, business record, experience, conduct or character of a person, he or she is not suitable to hold the position of chief agent, the Superintendent may, by order, disqualify the person from being appointed to that office.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678.3&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678.3&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Risk of prejudice</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>In forming an opinion under subsection (4), the Superintendent must consider whether the interests of the policyholders and creditors of the foreign company in respect of its insurance business in Canada would likely be prejudiced if the person were to take office.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678.3&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678.3&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Representations may be made</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>The Superintendent must in writing notify the person concerned and the foreign company of an order that the Superintendent proposes to make under subsection (4) and must afford them an opportunity within 15 days after the date of the notice, or within any longer period that the Superintendent allows, to make representations to the Superintendent in relation to the matter.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678.3&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678.3&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Prohibition</MarginalNote><Label>(7)</Label><Text>If an order is made under subsection (4) disqualifying a person from being appointed as chief agent, the person shall not be, and the foreign company shall not permit the person to be, appointed to that position.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 461;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 302.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;678.4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678.4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Removal</MarginalNote><Label>678.4</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678.4&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The Superintendent may, by order, remove a person from office as the chief agent of a foreign company if the Superintendent is of the opinion that the person is not suitable to hold that office</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;678.4&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>on the basis of the competence, business record, experience, conduct or character of the person; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;678.4&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>because the person has contravened or, by action or negligence, has contributed to the contravention of</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;678.4&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>this Act or the regulations made under it,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;678.4&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>a direction made under section 676,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;678.4&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>an order made under subsection 608(4) or 609(2),</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;678.4&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;iv&quot;"><Label>(iv)</Label><Text>a condition or limitation in respect of the order made under subsection 574(1) in respect of the foreign company, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;678.4&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;v&quot;"><Label>(v)</Label><Text>a prudential agreement entered into under section 675.1 or an undertaking given by the foreign company to the Superintendent.</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678.4&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678.4&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Risk of prejudice</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>In forming an opinion under subsection (1), the Superintendent must consider whether the interests of the policyholders and creditors of the foreign company in respect of its insurance business in Canada have been or are likely to be prejudiced by the person’s holding office as chief agent.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678.4&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678.4&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Representations may be made</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The Superintendent must in writing notify the chief agent and the foreign company of any removal order that the Superintendent proposes to make under subsection (1) and must afford them an opportunity within 15 days after the date of the notice, or within any longer period that the Superintendent allows, to make representations to the Superintendent in relation to the matter.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678.4&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678.4&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Suspension</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>If the Superintendent is of the opinion that the public interest is likely to be prejudiced by the chief agent continuing to exercise the powers or carry out the duties and functions of that office during the period for making representations, the Superintendent may make an order suspending the chief agent. The suspension may not extend beyond 10 days after the expiration of that period.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678.4&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678.4&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of order</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>The Superintendent shall, without delay, notify the chief agent and the foreign company of a removal order or suspension order.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678.4&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678.4&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Consequences of removal order</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>The chief agent ceases to hold that office as of the date the removal order is made or any later date specified in the order.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678.4&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678.4&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Appeal</MarginalNote><Label>(7)</Label><Text>The chief agent or the foreign company may, within 30 days after the date of receipt of notice of the removal order under subsection (5), or within any longer period that the Court allows, appeal the matter to the Federal Court.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678.4&quot;,ss=&quot;8&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678.4&quot;,ss=&quot;8&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Powers of Federal Court</MarginalNote><Label>(8)</Label><Text>The Federal Court, in the case of an appeal, may dismiss the appeal or set aside the removal order.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678.4&quot;,ss=&quot;9&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678.4&quot;,ss=&quot;9&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Order not stayed by appeal</MarginalNote><Label>(9)</Label><Text>A removal order is not stayed by an appeal.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 461;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 303.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XV&quot;,gb=&quot;s_675.1&quot;,gc=&quot;s_678.5&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XV&quot;,gb=&quot;s_675.1&quot;,gc=&quot;s_678.5&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Supervisory Intervention</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;678.5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678.5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Direction to transfer policies or to reinsure risks — society</MarginalNote><Label>678.5</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678.5&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If the circumstances described in any of paragraphs 679(1.1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>) exist in respect of a society, the Superintendent may, by order, subject to any terms and conditions the Superintendent may specify, direct it to transfer all or any portion of its policies to, or cause itself to be reinsured, against all or any portion of the risks undertaken under its policies, by any company, society, foreign company or body corporate incorporated or formed by or under the laws of a province that is authorized to transact the classes of insurance to be so transferred or reinsured.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678.5&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678.5&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Compliance</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The society shall comply with the order within the time that the Superintendent specifies in the order or within any further period specified by the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678.5&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678.5&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Opportunity for representations</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>No order shall be issued to a society under subsection (1) unless the society is provided with a reasonable opportunity to make representations in respect of the matter.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 462;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 304.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;678.6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678.6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Direction to transfer policies or to reinsure risks — foreign fraternal benefit society</MarginalNote><Label>678.6</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678.6&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If the circumstances described in any of paragraphs 679(1.2)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>) exist in respect of a foreign fraternal benefit society, the Superintendent may, by order, subject to any terms and conditions the Superintendent may specify, direct it to transfer all or any portion of its policies in respect of its insurance business in Canada to, or cause itself to be reinsured, against all or any portion of the risks undertaken under those policies, by any company, society, foreign company or body corporate incorporated or formed by or under the laws of a province that is authorized to transact the classes of insurance to be so transferred or reinsured.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678.6&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678.6&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Compliance</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The foreign company shall comply with the order within the time that the Superintendent specifies in the order or within any further period specified by the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;678.6&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;678.6&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Opportunity for representations</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>No order shall be issued to a foreign company under subsection (1) unless the foreign company is provided with a reasonable opportunity to make representations in respect of the matter.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 462;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 305.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;679&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;679&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Superintendent may take control</MarginalNote><Label>679.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;679&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to this Act, where any of the circumstances described in subsection (1.1) exist in respect of a company, society or provincial company or any of the circumstances described in subsection (1.2) exist in respect of a foreign company, the Superintendent may</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;679&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>take control, for a period not exceeding sixteen days, of the assets of the company, society or provincial company and the assets under its administration or, in the case of a foreign company, of its assets in Canada together with its other assets held in Canada under control of its chief agent, including all amounts received or receivable in respect of its insurance business in Canada; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;679&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>unless the Minister advises the Superintendent that the Minister is of the opinion that it is not in the public interest to do so,</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;679&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>take control, for a period exceeding sixteen days, of the assets of the company, society or provincial company and the assets under its administration or, in the case of a foreign company, of its assets in Canada together with its other assets held in Canada under the control of its chief agent, including all amounts received or receivable in respect of its insurance business in Canada,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;679&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>where control of assets has been taken under paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>), continue the control beyond the sixteen days referred to in that paragraph, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;679&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>take control of the company, society or provincial company.</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;679&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;679&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Circumstances re other than foreign company</MarginalNote><Label>(1.1)</Label><Text>Control by the Superintendent under subsection (1) may be taken in respect of a company, society or provincial company, other than a foreign company, where</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;679&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the company, society or provincial company has failed to pay its liabilities or, in the opinion of the Superintendent, will not be able to pay its liabilities as they become due and payable;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;679&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 2001, c. 9, s. 463]</Repealed></Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;679&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the assets of the company, society or provincial company are not, in the opinion of the Superintendent, sufficient to give adequate protection to its policyholders and creditors;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;679&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any asset appearing on the books or records of the company, society or provincial company or held under its administration is not, in the opinion of the Superintendent, satisfactorily accounted for;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;679&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the regulatory capital of the company, society or provincial company has, in the opinion of the Superintendent, reached a level or is eroding in a manner that may detrimentally affect its policyholders or creditors;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;679&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the company, society or provincial company has failed to comply with an order of the Superintendent made under subsection 515(3) to increase its capital or with an order of the Superintendent made under subsection 678.5(1); or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;679&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the opinion of the Superintendent, any other state of affairs exists in respect of the company, society or provincial company that may be materially prejudicial to the interests of the company’s, society’s or provincial company’s policyholders or creditors or the owners of any assets under the company’s, society’s or provincial company’s administration, including where proceedings under a law relating to bankruptcy or insolvency have been commenced in Canada or elsewhere in respect of the holding body corporate of the company or provincial company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;679&quot;,ss=&quot;1.2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;679&quot;,ss=&quot;1.2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Circumstances re foreign company</MarginalNote><Label>(1.2)</Label><Text>Control by the Superintendent under subsection (1) may be taken in respect of a foreign company where</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;679&quot;,ss=&quot;1.2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in respect of its insurance business in Canada, it has failed to pay its liabilities or, in the opinion of the Superintendent, will not be able to pay its liabilities as they become due and payable;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;679&quot;,ss=&quot;1.2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 2001, c. 9, s. 463]</Repealed></Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;679&quot;,ss=&quot;1.2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>its assets in Canada are not, in the opinion of the Superintendent, sufficient to give adequate protection to its policyholders and creditors in respect of its insurance business in Canada;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;679&quot;,ss=&quot;1.2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any asset relating to its insurance business in Canada appearing on the books or records of the foreign company is not, in the opinion of the Superintendent, satisfactorily accounted for;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;679&quot;,ss=&quot;1.2&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>it has failed to comply with an order of the Superintendent made under subsection 608(4) to increase the margin of its assets in Canada over its liabilities in Canada or with an order of the Superintendent made under subsection 609(2) or 678.6(1); or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;679&quot;,ss=&quot;1.2&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the opinion of the Superintendent, any other state of affairs exists in respect of the foreign company that may be materially prejudicial to the interests of the foreign company’s policyholders or creditors in respect of its insurance business in Canada, or to the interests of the owners of any assets under the foreign company’s administration in Canada, including where proceedings under a law relating to bankruptcy or insolvency have been commenced in Canada or elsewhere in respect of the foreign company or its holding body corporate.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;679&quot;,ss=&quot;1.3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;679&quot;,ss=&quot;1.3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of proposed action</MarginalNote><Label>(1.3)</Label><Text>The Superintendent must notify a company, society, provincial company or foreign company of any action proposed to be taken in respect of it under paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) and of its right to make written representations to the Superintendent within the time specified in the notice, not exceeding ten days after it receives the notice.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;679&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;679&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Objectives of Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If the Superintendent has, under subsection (1), control of the assets of a company, society, provincial company or foreign company referred to in that subsection, the Superintendent may do all things necessary or expedient to protect the rights and interests of the policyholders and creditors of the company, society or provincial company or the policyholders and creditors in respect of the foreign company’s insurance business in Canada.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;679&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;679&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Powers of Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Where the Superintendent has, pursuant to subsection (1), control of the assets of a company, society, provincial company or foreign company referred to in that subsection,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;679&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the company, society, provincial company or foreign company shall not make, acquire or transfer any loan or make any purchase, sale or exchange of securities or any disbursement or transfer of cash of any kind without the prior approval of the Superintendent or a representative designated by the Superintendent; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;679&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>no director, officer or employee of the company, society, provincial company or foreign company nor the chief agent of the foreign company shall have access to any cash or securities held by the company, society, provincial company or foreign company unless</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;679&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>a representative of the Superintendent accompanies the director, officer or employee or the chief agent, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;679&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>the access is previously authorized by the Superintendent or the Superintendent’s representative.</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 679;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 96;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 326;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 463;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 306.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;680&quot;"><Label>680. to 682.</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 1996, c. 6, s. 96]</Repealed></Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;683&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;683&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Powers of directors and officers suspended</MarginalNote><Label>683.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;683&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where the Superintendent takes control of a company, society or provincial company pursuant to subparagraph 679(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)(iii), the powers, duties, functions, rights and privileges of the directors of the company, society or provincial company and of the officers of the company, society or provincial company responsible for its management are suspended.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;683&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;683&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Superintendent to manage company</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where the Superintendent takes control of a company, society or provincial company pursuant to subparagraph 679(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)(iii), the Superintendent shall manage the business and affairs of the company, society or provincial company and in so doing the Superintendent</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;683&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>may perform any of the duties and functions that the persons referred to in subsection (1) were performing prior to the taking of control; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;683&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>has and may exercise any power, right or privilege that any such person had or could have exercised prior to the taking of control.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;683&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;683&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Persons to assist</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Where the Superintendent takes control of a company, society or provincial company pursuant to subparagraph 679(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)(iii), or of the assets of a foreign company pursuant to subparagraph 679(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)(i) or (ii), the Superintendent may appoint one or more persons to assist in the management of the company, society or provincial company or of the insurance business in Canada of the foreign company.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 683;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 97.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;684&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;684&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Expiration of control</MarginalNote><Label>684.</Label><Text>Control by the Superintendent under subsection 679(1) of a company, society or provincial company or of the assets of a company, society or provincial company or of the assets in Canada of a foreign company together with its other assets held in Canada under the control of its chief agent including all amounts received or receivable in respect of its insurance business in Canada expires on the day on which a notice by the Superintendent is sent to</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;684&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the directors and officers who conducted the business and affairs of the company, society or provincial company, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;684&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the chief agent in Canada of the foreign company,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>stating that the Superintendent is of the opinion that the circumstances leading to the taking of control by the Superintendent have been substantially rectified and that the company, society or provincial company or the foreign company, as the case may be, can resume control of its business and affairs, assets or its insurance business in Canada, as the case may be.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 684;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 97.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;684.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;684.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Superintendent may request winding-up</MarginalNote><Label>684.1</Label><Text>The Superintendent may, at any time before the receipt of a request under section 685 to relinquish control of a company, society or provincial company or of the assets of a company, society or provincial company or of the assets in Canada of a foreign company together with its other assets held in Canada under the control of its chief agent including all amounts received or receivable in respect of its insurance business in Canada, request the Attorney General of Canada to apply for a winding-up order under section 10.1 of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="W-11">Winding-up and Restructuring Act</XRefExternal> in respect of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;684.1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the company, society or provincial company, where the assets of the company, society or provincial company are under the control of the Superintendent pursuant to subparagraph 679(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)(i) or (ii);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;684.1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the insurance business in Canada of the foreign company, where the assets in Canada of the foreign company together with its other assets referred to in subparagraph 679(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)(i) or (ii) are under the control of the Superintendent pursuant to that subparagraph; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;684.1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the company, society or provincial company, where it is under the control of the Superintendent pursuant to subparagraph 679(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)(iii).</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1996, c. 6, s. 97.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;685&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;685&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Requirement to relinquish control</MarginalNote><Label>685.</Label><Text>Where no action has been taken by the Superintendent under section 684.1 and, after thirty days following the taking of control by the Superintendent under subsection 679(1) of a company, society or provincial company or of the assets of a company, society or provincial company or of the assets in Canada of a foreign company together with its other assets held in Canada under the control of its chief agent including all amounts received or receivable in respect of its insurance business in Canada, the Superintendent receives from the board of directors of the company, society or provincial company or, in case of a foreign company, its chief agent, a notice in writing requesting the Superintendent to relinquish control, the Superintendent must, not later than twelve days after receipt of the notice,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;685&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>comply with the request; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;685&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>request the Attorney General of Canada to apply for a winding-up order under section 10.1 of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="W-11">Winding-up and Restructuring Act</XRefExternal> in respect of the company, society or provincial company or the insurance business in Canada of the foreign company.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 685;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 97.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XV&quot;,gb=&quot;s_675.1&quot;,gc=&quot;s_686&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XV&quot;,gb=&quot;s_675.1&quot;,gc=&quot;s_686&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Special Assessments of Companies, Societies, Foreign Companies and Provincial Companies</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;686&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;686&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Superintendent to ascertain amounts</MarginalNote><Label>686.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;686&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The Superintendent shall, before December 31 in each year,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;686&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>ascertain the total amount of expenses incurred during the immediately preceding fiscal year in</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;686&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>exercising control of a company, society or provincial company,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;686&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>exercising control of the assets of a foreign company pursuant to subparagraph 679(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)(i) or (ii),</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;686&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>carrying out as liquidator the winding-up of a company, society or provincial company or of the insurance business in Canada of a foreign company,</Text></Subparagraph><ContinuedParagraph><Text>including amounts paid as interest charges on money borrowed by or on behalf of the company, society or provincial company to meet its requirements for liquid funds or as the cost of terminating leases or employment contracts or other similar expenses; and</Text></ContinuedParagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;686&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>ascertain the portion of the expenses described in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) that were incurred by the company, society, foreign company or provincial company in respect of its policies of accident and sickness insurance, its policies of life insurance and annuity and its other policies by multiplying those expenses by</Text><FormulaGroup><Formula><FormulaText>A/D, B/D and C/D, respectively,</FormulaText></Formula><FormulaConnector>where</FormulaConnector><FormulaDefinition><FormulaTerm>A, B and C</FormulaTerm><Text>represent the total of the gross premium income of the company, society, foreign company or provincial company, as determined by the Superintendent, in respect of</Text><FormulaParagraph><Label>(i)</Label><Text>its policies of accident and sickness insurance,</Text></FormulaParagraph><FormulaParagraph><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>its policies of life insurance and annuities, and</Text></FormulaParagraph><FormulaParagraph><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>its other policies,</Text></FormulaParagraph><ContinuedFormulaParagraph><Text>respectively, during the period referred to in the description of D, and</Text></ContinuedFormulaParagraph></FormulaDefinition><FormulaDefinition><FormulaTerm>D</FormulaTerm><Text>represents the total of the gross premium income of the company, society, foreign company or provincial company, as determined by the Superintendent, during the period of five calendar years preceding the first to occur of the calendar year in which the Superintendent took control of the company, society or provincial company, or in the case of a foreign company, the assets, and that in which a winding-up order was issued in respect of the company, society, foreign company or provincial company.</Text></FormulaDefinition></FormulaGroup></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;686&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;686&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Amounts conclusive</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The amounts ascertained by the Superintendent pursuant to subsection (1) are final and conclusive for the purposes of this section and sections 687 and 688.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 686;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 98;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 307.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;687&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;687&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Assessment</MarginalNote><Label>687.</Label><Text>As soon as possible after ascertaining the portions described in paragraph 686(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>), the Superintendent shall, subject to this section and to the extent and in the manner that the Governor in Council may prescribe, assess those portions against each company, society, foreign company and provincial company, other than the company, society, foreign company or provincial company in respect of which the expenses were incurred, in the following proportion:</Text><FormulaGroup><Formula><FormulaText>A/B</FormulaText></Formula><FormulaConnector>where</FormulaConnector><FormulaDefinition><FormulaTerm>A</FormulaTerm><Text>represents the net premiums during the immediately preceding calendar year of the company, society, foreign company or provincial company from</Text><FormulaParagraph><Label>(i)</Label><Text>policies of accident and sickness insurance,</Text></FormulaParagraph><FormulaParagraph><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>policies of life insurance and annuities, or</Text></FormulaParagraph><FormulaParagraph><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>other policies; and</Text></FormulaParagraph></FormulaDefinition><FormulaDefinition><FormulaTerm>B</FormulaTerm><Text>represents the total net premiums during the immediately preceding calendar year of all companies, societies, foreign companies and provincial companies, other than the company, society, foreign company or provincial company in respect of which the expenses were incurred, from</Text><FormulaParagraph><Label>(i)</Label><Text>policies of accident and sickness insurance,</Text></FormulaParagraph><FormulaParagraph><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>policies of life insurance and annuities, or</Text></FormulaParagraph><FormulaParagraph><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>other policies.</Text></FormulaParagraph></FormulaDefinition></FormulaGroup><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 687;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 308.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;688&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;688&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application of certain provisions of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="O-2.7">Office of the Superintendent of Financial Institutions Act</XRefExternal></MarginalNote><Label>688.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;688&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subsection 23(4) and section 23.2 of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="O-2.7">Office of the Superintendent of Financial Institutions Act</XRefExternal> apply, with such modifications as the circumstances require, in respect of an assessment under section 687.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;688&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;688&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Definitions</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>In this section and sections 686 and 687,</Text><Definition Code="se=&quot;688&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,df=&quot;{gross premium income}{produit brut}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;688&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,df=&quot;{gross premium income}{produit brut}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>gross premium income</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;688&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,df=&quot;{gross premium income}{produit brut}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>produit brut</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>gross premium income</DefinedTermEn> of a company, society, foreign company or provincial company means its premium income from its insurance business in Canada calculated without reduction in respect of reinsurance premiums paid or payable;</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;688&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,df=&quot;{net premiums}{primes nettes}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;688&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,df=&quot;{net premiums}{primes nettes}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>net premiums</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;688&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,df=&quot;{net premiums}{primes nettes}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>primes nettes</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>net premiums</DefinedTermEn> of a company, society, foreign company or provincial company means its gross premium income less</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;688&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,df=&quot;{net premiums}{primes nettes}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>premiums paid or payable in respect of the reinsurance of risks undertaken under its policies in respect of its insurance business in Canada, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;688&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,df=&quot;{net premiums}{primes nettes}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>dividends paid or allowed by it to its policyholders in respect of its insurance business in Canada.</Text></Paragraph></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;688&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,df=&quot;{}{}&quot;"><Text><DefinedTermEn>special insurance</DefinedTermEn><Repealed>[Repealed, 2007, c. 6, s. 309]</Repealed></Text></Definition></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 688;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 327;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 309.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20070420">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;689&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;689&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Advisory committee</MarginalNote><Label>689.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;689&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The Superintendent may, from among the companies, societies, foreign companies and provincial companies that are subject to an assessment under section 687 on account of the control of a company, society or provincial company or control of the assets of a foreign company, appoint a committee of not more than six members to advise the Superintendent in respect of assets, management and all other matters pertinent to the duties and responsibilities of the Superintendent in exercising that control.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;689&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><Label>(2)</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 1996, c. 6, s. 99]</Repealed></Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 689;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 99.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;690&quot;"><Label>690.</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 1996, c. 6, s. 100]</Repealed></Text></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;691&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;691&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Expenses payable by company, etc.</MarginalNote><Label>691.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;691&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where the Superintendent has taken control of a company, society or provincial company pursuant to subparagraph 679(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)(iii) and the control expires or is relinquished pursuant to section 684 or paragraph 685(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>), the Superintendent may direct that the company, society or provincial company be liable for repayment of all or part of the expenses resulting from the taking of control of the company, society or provincial company and assessed against and paid by other companies, societies, provincial companies and foreign companies pursuant to section 687, together with such interest in respect thereof at such rate as is specified by the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;691&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;691&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Expenses payable by foreign company</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where the Superintendent has taken control of the assets of a foreign company pursuant to subparagraph 679(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)(i) or (ii) and the control expires or is relinquished pursuant to section 684 or paragraph 685(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>), the Superintendent may direct that the foreign company be liable for repayment of all or part of the expenses resulting from the taking of control of the assets of the foreign company and assessed against and paid by other companies, societies, foreign companies and provincial companies pursuant to section 687, together with such interest in respect thereof at such rate as is specified by the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 691;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 101.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;692&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;692&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Reduction of assessments</MarginalNote><Label>692.</Label><Text>Any amount paid to or recovered by Her Majesty under section 691 of this Act or paragraph 161(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>) or (6)(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>) or subparagraph 161(8)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)(iv) of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="W-11">Winding-up and Restructuring Act</XRefExternal> in respect of a company, society, foreign company or provincial company shall be applied to the extent and the manner that may be prescribed.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 692;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 167;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 328;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 464(F).</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XVI&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="1"><Label>PART XVI</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XVI&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">REGULATION OF COMPANIES AND FOREIGN COMPANIES — COMMISSIONER</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;693&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;693&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Definition of <DefinedTermEn>société</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><Label>693.</Label><Text>In the French version of this Part, <DefinedTermEn>société</DefinedTermEn> means a <DefinedTermEn>société</DefinedTermEn> or <DefinedTermEn>société étrangère</DefinedTermEn> within the meaning of section 2.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 693;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;694&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;694&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Required information</MarginalNote><Label>694.</Label><Text>A company or foreign company shall provide the Commissioner with the information at the times and in the form that the Commissioner may require for the purposes of the administration of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="F-11.1">Financial Consumer Agency of Canada Act</XRefExternal> and the consumer provisions.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 694;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;695&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;695&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Confidential information</MarginalNote><Label>695.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;695&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection (2), information regarding the business or affairs of a company or foreign company or regarding persons dealing with any of them that is obtained by the Commissioner or by any person acting under the direction of the Commissioner, in the course of the exercise or performance of powers, duties and functions referred to in subsection 5(1) of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="F-11.1">Financial Consumer Agency of Canada Act</XRefExternal>, and any information prepared from that information, is confidential and shall be treated accordingly.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;695&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;695&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Disclosure permitted</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If the Commissioner is satisfied that the information will be treated as confidential by the agency, body or person to whom it is disclosed, subsection (1) does not prevent the Commissioner from disclosing it</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;695&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>to any government agency or body that regulates or supervises financial institutions, for purposes related to that regulation or supervision;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;695&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>to any other agency or body that regulates or supervises financial institutions, for purposes related to that regulation or supervision;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;695&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>to any compensation association designated by order of the Minister under subsection 449(1) or 591(1), for purposes related to its operation; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;695&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>to the Deputy Minister of Finance or any officer of the Department of Finance authorized in writing by the Deputy Minister of Finance or to the Governor of the Bank of Canada or any officer of the Bank of Canada authorized in writing by the Governor of the Bank of Canada, for the purposes of policy analysis related to the regulation of financial institutions.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 695;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;696&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;696&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Examination</MarginalNote><Label>696.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;696&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The Commissioner, from time to time, but at least once in each calendar year, shall make or cause to be made any examination and inquiry that the Commissioner considers necessary for the purposes of satisfying the Commissioner that the applicable consumer provisions are being complied with and, after the conclusion of each examination and inquiry, shall report on it to the Minister.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;696&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;696&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Access to records</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The Commissioner or a person acting under the Commissioner’s direction in carrying out his or her duties under subsection (1)</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;696&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>has a right of access to any records, including electronic records, of a company or foreign company; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;696&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>may require the directors or officers of a company or foreign company to provide information and explanations, to the extent that they are reasonably able to do so, in respect of any matter subject to examination or inquiry under subsection (1).</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 696;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;697&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;697&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Power of Commissioner on inquiry</MarginalNote><Label>697.</Label><Text>The Commissioner, in carrying out his or her duties in relation to consumer provisions, has all the powers of a person appointed as a commissioner under Part II of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="I-11">Inquiries Act</XRefExternal> for the purpose of obtaining evidence under oath, and may delegate those powers to any person acting under the Commissioner’s direction.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 697;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;698&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;698&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Compliance agreement</MarginalNote><Label>698.</Label><Text>The Commissioner may enter into an agreement, called a “compliance agreement”, with a company or foreign company for the purposes of implementing any measure designed to further compliance by it with the consumer provisions.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 698;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="1"><Label>PART XVII</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">INSURANCE HOLDING COMPANIES</TitleText></Heading><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_699&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;s_699&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Purpose</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;699&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;699&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Purpose</MarginalNote><Label>699.</Label><Text>The purpose of this Part is to provide for the incorporation, formation and regulation of insurance holding companies that are holding bodies corporate of life companies.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 699;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;699.1&quot;"><Label>699.1</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 2001, c. 9, s. 465]</Repealed></Text></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_1&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><Label>Division 1</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_1&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Interpretation</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;700&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;700&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Definitions</MarginalNote><Label>700.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;700&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The following definitions apply in this Part.</Text><Definition Code="se=&quot;700&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{affairs}{affaires internes}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;700&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{affairs}{affaires internes}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>affairs</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;700&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{affairs}{affaires internes}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>affaires internes</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>affairs</DefinedTermEn>, with respect to an insurance holding company, means the relationships among the insurance holding company and its affiliates and the shareholders, directors and officers of the insurance holding company and its affiliates, but does not include the business of the insurance holding company or any of its affiliates.</Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;700&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{complainant}{plaignant}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;700&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{complainant}{plaignant}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>complainant</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;700&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{complainant}{plaignant}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>plaignant</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>complainant</DefinedTermEn>, in relation to an insurance holding company or any matter concerning an insurance holding company, means</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;700&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{complainant}{plaignant}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a registered holder or beneficial owner, and a former registered holder or beneficial owner, of a security of the insurance holding company or any of its affiliates;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;700&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{complainant}{plaignant}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a director or an officer, or a former director or officer, of the insurance holding company or any of its affiliates; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;700&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{complainant}{plaignant}&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>any other person who, in the discretion of a court, is a proper person to make an application under section 912, 916 or 1031.</Text></Paragraph></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;700&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{subordinated indebtedness}{titre secondaire}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;700&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{subordinated indebtedness}{titre secondaire}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>subordinated indebtedness</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;700&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,df=&quot;{subordinated indebtedness}{titre secondaire}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>titre secondaire</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>subordinated indebtedness</DefinedTermEn> means an instrument evidencing an indebtedness of an insurance holding company that by its terms provides that the indebtedness will, in the event of the insolvency or winding-up of the insurance holding company, be subordinate in right of payment to all liabilities of the insurance holding company except those liabilities that, by their terms, rank equally with or are subordinate to such indebtedness.</Text></Definition></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;700&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;700&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Provisions in other Parts</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A reference in a provision in this Part to a provision in any other Part is deemed to be a reference to that provision as it has been made applicable by this Part in respect of insurance holding companies.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;700&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;700&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">References in other Parts</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A reference in a provision of another Part to a provision that has been made applicable in respect of insurance holding companies by this Part is to be read as including a reference to that provision as it has been made applicable in respect of insurance holding companies.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 700;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_2&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><Label>Division 2</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_2&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Status and Powers</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;701&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;701&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Corporate powers</MarginalNote><Label>701.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;701&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>An insurance holding company has the capacity of a natural person and, subject to this Act, the rights, powers and privileges of a natural person.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;701&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;701&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Powers restricted</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>An insurance holding company shall not carry on any business or exercise any power that it is restricted by this Act from carrying on or exercising, or exercise any of its powers in a manner contrary to this Act.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;701&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;701&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Business in Canada</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>An insurance holding company may carry on business throughout Canada.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;701&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;701&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Powers outside Canada</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Subject to this Act, an insurance holding company has the capacity to carry on its business, conduct its affairs and exercise its powers in any jurisdiction outside Canada to the extent and in the manner that the laws of that jurisdiction permit.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 701;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;702&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;702&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">No invalidity</MarginalNote><Label>702.</Label><Text>No act of an insurance holding company, including any transfer of property to or by an insurance holding company, is invalid by reason only that the act or transfer is contrary to the insurance holding company’s incorporating instrument or this Act.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 702;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 102;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;703&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;703&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">By-law not necessary</MarginalNote><Label>703.</Label><Text>It is not necessary for an insurance holding company to pass a by-law in order to confer any particular power on the insurance holding company or its directors.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 703;</li><li> 1996, c. 6, s. 103;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 330;</li><li> 1999, c. 31, s. 145(F);</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;704&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;704&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">No personal liability</MarginalNote><Label>704.</Label><Text>The shareholders of an insurance holding company are not, as shareholders, liable for any liability, act or default of the insurance holding company except as otherwise provided by this Act.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 704;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;705&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;705&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">No constructive notice</MarginalNote><Label>705.</Label><Text>No person is affected by or is deemed to have notice or knowledge of the contents of a document concerning an insurance holding company by reason only that the document has been filed with the Superintendent or the Minister or is available for inspection at an office of the insurance holding company.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 705;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;706&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;706&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Authority of directors, officers and representatives</MarginalNote><Label>706.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;706&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>No insurance holding company and no guarantor of an obligation of an insurance holding company may assert against a person dealing with the insurance holding company or against a person who has acquired rights from the insurance holding company that</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;706&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the insurance holding company’s incorporating instrument or any by-laws of the insurance holding company have not been complied with;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;706&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the persons named as directors of the insurance holding company in the most recent return sent to the Superintendent under section 994 are not the directors of the insurance holding company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;706&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the place named in the incorporating instrument or by-laws of the insurance holding company is not the place where the head office of the insurance holding company is situated;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;706&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a person held out by the insurance holding company as a director, officer or representative of the insurance holding company has not been duly appointed or has no authority to exercise the powers and perform the duties that are customary in the business of the insurance holding company or usual for a director, officer or representative; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;706&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a document issued by any director, officer or representative of the insurance holding company with actual or usual authority to issue the document is not valid or not genuine.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;706&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;706&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception — knowledge</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Subsection (1) does not apply in respect of a person who has or ought to have knowledge of a situation described in that subsection by virtue of their relationship to the insurance holding company.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 706;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 331;</li><li> 2000, c. 12, s. 157;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 304.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;707&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;707&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Sunset provision</MarginalNote><Label>707.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;707&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to subsections (2) and (4), insurance holding companies shall not carry on business after the day that is the fifth anniversary of the day on which this section comes into force.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;707&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;707&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Extension</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may, by order, extend by up to six months the time during which insurance holding companies may continue to carry on business. No more than one order may be made under this subsection.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;707&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;707&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Order not a regulation</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The order is not a regulation for the purposes of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="S-22">Statutory Instruments Act</XRefExternal>. However, it shall be published in Part II of the <XRefExternal reference-type="other" link="gazette">Canada Gazette</XRefExternal>.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;707&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;707&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>If Parliament dissolves on the fifth anniversary of the day on which this section comes into force, on any day within the six-month period before that anniversary or on any day within an extension under subsection (2), insurance holding companies may continue to carry on business until the end of 180 days after the first day of the first session of the next Parliament.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 707;</li><li> 1997, c. 15, s. 332;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465;</li><li> 2006, c. 4, s. 201.1;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 310;</li><li> 2012, c. 5, s. 154.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20070420">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_3&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><Label>Division 3</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_3&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Incorporation, Continuance and Discontinuance</TitleText></Heading><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_3&quot;,gc=&quot;s_708&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_3&quot;,gc=&quot;s_708&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Formalities of Incorporation</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;708&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;708&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Incorporation of insurance holding company</MarginalNote><Label>708.</Label><Text>On the application of one or more persons made in accordance with this Part, the Minister may, subject to this Division, issue letters patent incorporating an insurance holding company.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 708;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;709&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;709&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restrictions on incorporation</MarginalNote><Label>709.</Label><Text>Letters patent incorporating an insurance holding company may not be issued if the application therefor is made by or on behalf of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;709&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>Her Majesty in right of Canada or in right of a province, an agency of Her Majesty in either of those rights, or an entity controlled by Her Majesty in either of those rights;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;709&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the government of a foreign country or any political subdivision thereof;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;709&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an agency of the government of a foreign country or any political subdivision thereof; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;709&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an entity, other than a foreign institution or any subsidiary of a foreign institution, that is controlled by the government of a foreign country or any political subdivision thereof.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 709;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;710&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;710&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">National treatment</MarginalNote><Label>710.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;710&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If a proposed insurance holding company would be a subsidiary of a foreign institution that is engaged in the insurance business, letters patent to incorporate the insurance holding company may not be issued unless the Minister is satisfied that, if the application is made by a non-WTO Member foreign institution, treatment as favourable for insurance holding companies to which this Act applies exists or will be provided in the jurisdiction in which the foreign institution principally carries on business, either directly or through a subsidiary.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;710&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;710&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Part XII of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="B-1.01">Bank Act</XRefExternal></MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Nothing in subsection (1) affects the operation of Part XII of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="B-1.01">Bank Act</XRefExternal>.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 710;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;711&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;711&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application for incorporation</MarginalNote><Label>711.</Label><Text>An application for letters patent to incorporate an insurance holding company setting out the names of the first directors of the insurance holding company shall be filed with the Superintendent, together with such other information, material and evidence as the Superintendent may require.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 711;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;712&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;712&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Matters for consideration</MarginalNote><Label>712.</Label><Text>Before issuing letters patent to incorporate an insurance holding company, the Minister shall take into account all matters that the Minister considers relevant to the application, including</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;712&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the nature and sufficiency of the financial resources of the applicant or applicants as a source of continuing financial support for the company that is proposed to be its subsidiary;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;712&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the soundness and feasibility of the plans of the applicant or applicants for the future conduct and development of the business of the company that is proposed to be its subsidiary;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;712&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the business record and experience of the applicant or applicants;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;712&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the character and integrity of the applicant or applicants or, if the applicant or any of the applicants is a body corporate, its reputation for being operated in a manner that is consistent with the standards of good character and integrity;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;712&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>whether the insurance holding company will be operated responsibly by persons with the competence and experience suitable for involvement in the operation of a financial institution;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;712&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the impact of any integration of the businesses and operations of the applicant or applicants with those of the insurance holding company and its affiliates on the conduct of those businesses and operations; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;712&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the best interests of the financial system in Canada.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 712;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;713&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;713&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Contents of letters patent</MarginalNote><Label>713.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;713&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>There shall be set out in the letters patent incorporating an insurance holding company</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;713&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the name of the insurance holding company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;713&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the province in which the head office of the insurance holding company is to be situated; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;713&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the date that the insurance holding company came, or is to come, into existence.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;713&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;713&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Provisions in letters patent</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The Minister may set out in the letters patent incorporating an insurance holding company any provision not contrary to this Act that the Minister considers advisable in order to take into account the particular circumstances of the proposed insurance holding company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;713&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;713&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Terms and conditions</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The Minister may impose such terms and conditions in respect of the issuance of letters patent incorporating an insurance holding company as the Minister considers necessary or appropriate.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 713;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 305.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;714&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;714&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Letters patent of incorporation on application of life company</MarginalNote><Label>714.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;714&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If the Minister, under section 708, issues letters patent incorporating an insurance holding company on the application of a life company, including a converted company, there may, on the request of the company, and with the approval of the Minister, be included in the letters patent of incorporation of the insurance holding company a provision deeming shares of the insurance holding company to be issued, on a share for share basis, to all shareholders of the company in exchange for all the issued and outstanding shares of the company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;714&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;714&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effect of provision</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Shares of an insurance holding company deemed to be issued under subsection (1) are subject to the same designation, rights, privileges and restrictions or conditions and, subject to any agreement to the contrary, to the same charges, encumbrances and other restrictions as the shares of the company for which they are exchanged and the shares of the company, on the issuance of the letters patent, become the property of the insurance holding company free and clear of any charge, encumbrance or other restriction.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;714&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;714&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effect of provision</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>An exchange of shares of a company referred to in subsection (1) under a provision included in the letters patent incorporating an insurance holding company does not deprive a person who was a holder of shares of the company immediately before the exchange of any right or privilege with respect to the shares or relieve the person of any liability in respect of the shares, but that right or privilege must be exercised in accordance with this Act.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;714&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;714&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Transfer and voting of company shares</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Despite subsection (3), no share of an insurance holding company that is deemed to be issued under a provision included in the letters patent incorporating an insurance holding company may subsequently be transferred or voted contrary to this Act.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;714&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;714&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shareholder and policyholder approval</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>No provision described in subsection (1) may be included in letters patent issued under section 708 unless the application for the letters patent is accompanied by evidence that the request for the provision was approved by a special resolution of the shareholders and the policyholders of the company who are entitled to vote at a meeting of shareholders and policyholders called to consider the application.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;714&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;714&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exchange of share certificates</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>If, under a provision included in the letters patent incorporating an insurance holding company, a share exchange is deemed to have taken place, the insurance holding company shall, within ninety days after the issuance of the letters patent, make provision for the issue of share certificates representing shares of the insurance holding company and for the exchange of those certificates for share certificates representing the shares of the company that were outstanding on the effective date of the letters patent.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 714;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;715&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;715&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Proposal involving fundamental change</MarginalNote><Label>715.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;715&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>On application, made in accordance with the regulations, by a life company, including a converted company, to give effect to a proposal to incorporate an insurance holding company as the holding body corporate of the company, to continue a body corporate as an insurance holding company of the company or to amalgamate two or more bodies corporate and continue those bodies corporate as an insurance holding company of the company — and to make any other fundamental change to the company, including an exchange of any or all of the shares of the company for shares of the insurance holding company —, the Minister may, to give effect to the proposal,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;715&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>include in the letters patent of the insurance holding company issued under section 708, 721 or 863 any provision the Minister considers necessary; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;715&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>despite any provision of the Act specified in regulations made under paragraph (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>), give any approval that the Minister considers necessary.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;715&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;715&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;715&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting applications referred to in subsection (1), including their form and the information to be contained in them, and authorizing the Superintendent to require additional information in respect of such applications;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;715&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting proposals to which subsection (1) applies, including the information to be contained in the proposals and the times within which the transactions involved in them must occur;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;715&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the procedures to be followed by the company that makes an application under subsection (1);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;715&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>respecting the approval, confirmation or authorization, if any, of all or any portion of proposals to which subsection (1) applies, and including the approval of shareholders and policyholders and including the terms and conditions of those approvals, confirmations or authorizations and their effect; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;715&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>specifying provisions of the Act for the purpose of paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>).</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 715;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;716&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;716&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of issue of letters patent</MarginalNote><Label>716.</Label><Text>The Superintendent shall cause to be published in the <XRefExternal reference-type="other" link="gazette">Canada Gazette</XRefExternal> a notice of the issuance of letters patent incorporating an insurance holding company.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 716;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;717&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;717&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">First directors</MarginalNote><Label>717.</Label><Text>The first directors of an insurance holding company are the directors named in the application for letters patent to incorporate the insurance holding company.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 717;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;718&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;718&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effect of letters patent</MarginalNote><Label>718.</Label><Text>An insurance holding company comes into existence on the date provided therefor in its letters patent.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 718;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_3&quot;,gc=&quot;s_719&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_3&quot;,gc=&quot;s_719&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Continuance</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;719&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;719&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Federal corporations</MarginalNote><Label>719.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;719&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A body corporate incorporated under the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="C-44">Canada Business Corporations Act</XRefExternal> or any other Act of Parliament, including a company, may apply to the Minister for letters patent continuing the body corporate as an insurance holding company under this Part.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;719&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;719&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Other corporations</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A body corporate incorporated otherwise than by or under an Act of Parliament may, if so authorized by the laws of the jurisdiction where it is incorporated, apply to the Minister for letters patent continuing the body corporate as an insurance holding company under this Part.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 719;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;720&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;720&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application for continuance</MarginalNote><Label>720.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;720&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where a body corporate applies for letters patent under subsection 719(1) or (2), sections 709 to 712 apply in respect of the application, with such modifications as the circumstances require.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;720&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;720&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Special resolution approval</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where a body corporate applies for letters patent under subsection 719(1) or (2), the application must be duly authorized by a special resolution.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;720&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;720&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Copy of special resolution</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A copy of the special resolution referred to in subsection (2) shall be filed with the application.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 720;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;721&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;721&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Power to issue letters patent</MarginalNote><Label>721.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;721&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>On the application of a body corporate under subsection 719(1) or (2), the Minister may, subject to this Division, issue letters patent continuing the body corporate as an insurance holding company under this Part.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;721&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;721&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Issue of letters patent</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Section 713 applies in respect of the issue of letters patent under subsection (1), with such modifications as the circumstances require.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 721;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;722&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;722&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effect of letters patent</MarginalNote><Label>722.</Label><Text>On the day set out in the letters patent continuing a body corporate as an insurance holding company under subsection 721(1),</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;722&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the body corporate becomes an insurance holding company as if it had been incorporated under this Part; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;722&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the letters patent are deemed to be the incorporating instrument of the continued insurance holding company.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 722;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;723&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;723&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Copy of letters patent</MarginalNote><Label>723.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;723&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where a body corporate is continued as an insurance holding company under this Part, the Superintendent shall without delay send a copy of the letters patent to the appropriate official or public body in the jurisdiction in which the body corporate was authorized to apply to be continued under this Part.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;723&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;723&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of issuance of letters patent</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The Superintendent shall publish in the <XRefExternal reference-type="other" link="gazette">Canada Gazette</XRefExternal> a notice of the issuance of letters patent continuing a body corporate as an insurance holding company under this Part.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 723;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;724&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;724&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effects of continuance</MarginalNote><Label>724.</Label><Text>Where a body corporate is continued as an insurance holding company under this Part,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;724&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the property of the body corporate continues to be the property of the insurance holding company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;724&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the insurance holding company continues to be liable for the obligations of the body corporate;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;724&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an existing cause of action or claim by or against the body corporate or any liability of the body corporate to prosecution is unaffected;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;724&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a civil, criminal or administrative action or proceeding pending by or against the body corporate may continue to be prosecuted by or against the insurance holding company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;724&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a conviction against, or any ruling, order or judgment in favour of or against, the body corporate may be enforced by or against the insurance holding company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;724&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a person who, on the day the body corporate becomes an insurance holding company, is the holder of a security issued by the body corporate is not deprived of any right or privilege available to the person at that time in respect of the security or relieved of any liability in respect of it, but any such right or privilege may be exercised only in accordance with this Act; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;724&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the by-laws of the body corporate, except those that are in conflict with this Act, continue as the by-laws of the insurance holding company.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 724;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;725&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;725&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Transitional</MarginalNote><Label>725.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;725&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Despite any other provision of this Act or the regulations, the Minister may, on the recommendation of the Superintendent, by order, grant to an insurance holding company in respect of which letters patent were issued under subsection 721(1) permission to</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;725&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>engage in a business activity specified in the order that the insurance holding company would not otherwise be permitted by this Act to engage in and that the body corporate continued as the insurance holding company was engaging in at the time the application for the letters patent was made;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;725&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>continue to have issued and outstanding debt obligations the issue of which is not authorized by this Act if the debt obligations were outstanding at the time the application for the letters patent was made;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;725&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>hold assets that the insurance holding company would not otherwise be permitted by this Act to hold, if the assets were held by the body corporate continued as the insurance holding company at the time the application for the letters patent was made;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;725&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>acquire and hold assets that the insurance holding company would not otherwise be permitted by this Act to acquire or hold, if the body corporate continued as the insurance holding company was obliged, at the time the application for the letters patent was made, to acquire those assets; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;725&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>maintain outside Canada any records or registers required by this Act to be maintained in Canada.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;725&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;725&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Duration</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The permission granted under subsection (1) shall be expressed to be granted for a period specified in the order not exceeding</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;725&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>with respect to any activity described in paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>), thirty days after the effective date of the letters patent or, where the activity is conducted pursuant to an agreement existing on the effective date of the letters patent, the expiration of the agreement;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;725&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>with respect to any matter described in paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>), ten years; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;725&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>with respect to any matter described in any of paragraphs (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>), two years.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;725&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;725&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Renewal</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection (4), the Minister may, on the recommendation of the Superintendent, by order, renew a permission granted by order under subsection (1) with respect to any matter described in paragraphs (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>) for such further period or periods as the Minister considers necessary.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;725&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;725&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limitation</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>The Minister shall not grant to an insurance holding company any permission</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;725&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>with respect to matters described in paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>), that purports to be effective more than ten years after the effective date of the letters patent of continuance issued to continue the insurance holding company under this Part, unless the Minister is satisfied on the basis of evidence on oath provided by an officer of the insurance holding company that the insurance holding company will not be able at law to redeem at the end of the ten years the outstanding debt obligations to which the permission relates; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;725&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>with respect to matters described in paragraphs (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>) and (<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), that purports to be effective more than ten years after the effective date of the letters patent of continuance issued to continue the insurance holding company under this Part.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 725;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 311.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_3&quot;,gc=&quot;s_726&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_3&quot;,gc=&quot;s_726&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Discontinuance</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;726&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;726&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Transferring to other Acts</MarginalNote><Label>726.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;726&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>An insurance holding company may apply to be continued only as a body corporate under any other Act of Parliament or any Act of the legislature of a province, and it may do so only with the approval in writing of the Minister.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;726&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;726&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Conditions for approval</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>No approval referred to in subsection (1) may be given to an insurance holding company unless the Minister is satisfied that the application of the insurance holding company has been authorized by a special resolution.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 726;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 312.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;727&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;727&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Meaning of <DefinedTermEn>insurance holding company without a life company subsidiary</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><Label>727.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;727&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>For the purpose of this section, <DefinedTermEn>insurance holding company without a life company subsidiary</DefinedTermEn> means an insurance holding company that does not, at any time within one year after it came into existence, have a subsidiary that is a life company or that does not, for a period of one year, have a subsidiary that is a life company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;727&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;727&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Obligation to apply</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>An insurance holding company without a life company subsidiary must, within thirty days after becoming an insurance holding company without a life company subsidiary, apply to be continued under subsection 726(1).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;727&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;727&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Cessation of existence</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Except for the sole purpose of winding up its affairs, an insurance holding company without a life company subsidiary that has no other subsidiary that fails to make an application under subsection (2) within the time provided for in that subsection ceases to exist on the expiration of that period.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 727;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;728&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;728&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Act ceases to apply</MarginalNote><Label>728.</Label><Text>On the day specified by the Minister, this Act ceases to apply to the body corporate continued under the other Act of Parliament or under the Act of the legislature of a province.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 728;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;729&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;729&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Withdrawing application</MarginalNote><Label>729.</Label><Text>Where a special resolution authorizing the application under subsection 726(1) so states, the directors of an insurance holding company may, without further approval of the shareholders, withdraw the application before it is acted on.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 729;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_3&quot;,gc=&quot;s_730&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_3&quot;,gc=&quot;s_730&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Corporate Name</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;730&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;730&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Prohibited names</MarginalNote><Label>730.</Label><Text>An insurance holding company may not be incorporated under this Part with a name</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;730&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>that is prohibited by an Act of Parliament;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;730&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>that is, in the opinion of the Superintendent, deceptively misdescriptive;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;730&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>that is the same as or, in the opinion of the Superintendent, substantially the same as or confusingly similar to any existing</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;730&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>trade-mark or trade name, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;730&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>corporate name of a body corporate,</Text></Subparagraph><ContinuedParagraph><Text>except where the trade-mark or trade name is being changed or the body corporate is being dissolved or is changing its corporate name and consent to the use of the trade-mark, trade name or corporate name is signified to the Superintendent in such manner as the Superintendent may require;</Text></ContinuedParagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;730&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>that is the same as or, in the opinion of the Superintendent, substantially the same as or confusingly similar to the known name under or by which any entity carries on business or is identified; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;730&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>that is reserved under section 45 for a company or society or a proposed company or society or under section 734 for another insurance holding company or a proposed insurance holding company.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 730;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;731&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;731&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Affiliated insurance holding company</MarginalNote><Label>731.</Label><Text>Despite section 730 and subject to section 732, an insurance holding company that is affiliated with another entity may, with the consent of that entity,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;731&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>be incorporated with, or change its name to, substantially the same name as that of the affiliated entity; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;731&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>subject to any terms and conditions that may be prescribed, carry on business under or identify itself by a name, other than its corporate name, that is substantially the same as the corporate name of the affiliated entity or that is another name under which or with which the affiliated entity carries on business or otherwise identifies itself.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 731;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 313.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;732&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;732&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction</MarginalNote><Label>732.</Label><Text>An insurance holding company may not be incorporated or continued with, or change its name to or carry on business or identify itself by, a name that is substantially the same as that of a company unless the name contains words that, in the opinion of the Superintendent, indicate to the public that the insurance holding company is distinct from any company that is a subsidiary of the insurance holding company.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 732;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;733&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;733&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">French or English form of name</MarginalNote><Label>733.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;733&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The name of an insurance holding company may be set out in its letters patent in an English form, a French form, an English form and a French form or in a combined English and French form, and the insurance holding company may use and be legally designated by any such form.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;733&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;733&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Mandatory abbreviation</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Despite any other provision of this Act and subject to the regulations, every insurance holding company shall have as part of its name, the abbreviations “ihc” or “spa”.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;733&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;733&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Alternate name</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>An insurance holding company may identify itself outside Canada by its name in any language and the insurance holding company may use and be legally designated by any such form of its name outside Canada.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;733&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;733&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Other name</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection (5) and section 880, an insurance holding company may carry on business under or identify itself by a name other than its corporate name.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;733&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;733&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Directions</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>If an insurance holding company is carrying on business under or identifying itself by a name other than its corporate name, the Superintendent may, by order, direct the insurance holding company not to use that other name if the Superintendent is of the opinion that that other name is a name referred to in any of paragraphs 730(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;733&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;733&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations respecting the use of the abbreviations “ihc” or “spa” in the name of insurance holding companies.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 733;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;734&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;734&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Reserved name</MarginalNote><Label>734.</Label><Text>The Superintendent may, on request, reserve for ninety days a name for a proposed insurance holding company or for an insurance holding company that intends to change its name.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 734;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;735&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;735&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Directing change of name</MarginalNote><Label>735.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;735&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If through inadvertence or otherwise an insurance holding company</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;735&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>comes into existence or is continued with a name, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;735&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>on an application to change its name, is granted a name</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>that is prohibited by section 730 or 732, the Superintendent may, by order, direct the insurance holding company to change its name and the insurance holding company shall comply with that direction.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;735&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;735&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Revoking name</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where an insurance holding company has been directed under subsection (1) to change its name and has not, within sixty days after the service of the direction, changed its name to a name that is not prohibited by this Part, the Superintendent may revoke the name of the insurance holding company and assign to it a name and, until changed in accordance with section 849 or 851, the name of the insurance holding company is thereafter the name so assigned.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 735;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;736&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;736&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Subsidiaries</MarginalNote><Label>736.</Label><Text>Despite subsection 47(1), a subsidiary of an insurance holding company may, with the approval in writing of the Superintendent, use the word “assurance”, “assurances”, “insurance” or “lifeco” or any word or words of import equivalent to any of those words in its name.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 736;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;737&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;737&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Definition of <DefinedTermEn>reserved name</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><Label>737.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;737&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>In this section, <DefinedTermEn>reserved name</DefinedTermEn> means a name that includes as part thereof the word “assurance”, “assurances”, “insurance”, “lifeco”, “fiduciaire”, “fiduciary”, “fiducie”, “trust”, “trustco”, “loan”, “loanco” or “prêt” or any word or words of import equivalent to any of those words.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;737&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;737&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Termination of control required in certain cases</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>No person, other than a financial institution, who</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;737&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>is carrying on business in Canada under a reserved name, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;737&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>has control or acquires control of an insurance holding company,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>shall control the insurance holding company one year after the date of acquisition of the control.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;737&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;737&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Prohibition</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>No person, other than a financial institution, who</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;737&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>controls an entity that is not a financial institution that carries on business in Canada under a reserved name, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;737&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>has control or acquires control of an insurance holding company,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>shall control the insurance holding company one year after the date of the acquisition of the control.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;737&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;737&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Continuing control prohibited</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Despite subsection (3), where a financial institution controls an entity that</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;737&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>is not a financial institution,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;737&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>carries on business in Canada under a reserved name, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;737&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>acquires control of an insurance holding company,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>the entity shall not control the insurance holding company one year after the date on which the entity acquires control of the insurance holding company.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;737&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;737&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exceptions</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>Subsections (2) to (4) do not apply with respect to a person or entity that was carrying on business in Canada under a reserved name on June 25, 1999.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 737;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_3&quot;,gc=&quot;s_738&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_3&quot;,gc=&quot;s_738&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Publication of Information</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;738&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;738&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Publication of information</MarginalNote><Label>738.</Label><Text>The Superintendent shall, within sixty days after the end of each year, cause a notice to be published in the <XRefExternal reference-type="other" link="gazette">Canada Gazette</XRefExternal>, showing</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;738&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the name of every insurance holding company; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;738&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the province in which the head office of the insurance holding company is situated.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 738;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 306.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_4&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><Label>Division 4</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_4&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Organization and Commencement</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;739&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;739&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">First directors’ meeting</MarginalNote><Label>739.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;739&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>After letters patent incorporating an insurance holding company are issued, a meeting of the directors of the insurance holding company shall be held at which the directors may, subject to this Division,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;739&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>make by-laws;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;739&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>adopt forms of share certificates and corporate records;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;739&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>authorize the issue of shares of the insurance holding company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;739&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>appoint officers;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;739&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>appoint an auditor to hold office until the meeting called under subsection 740(1);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;739&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>make banking arrangements; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;739&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>deal with any other matters necessary to organize the insurance holding company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;739&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;739&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Calling directors’ meeting</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>An incorporator or a director named in the application for letters patent may call the meeting referred to in subsection (1) by giving, subject to subsection 817(2), no fewer than five days notice of the purpose, time and place of the meeting to each director of the insurance holding company.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 739;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;740&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;740&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Calling shareholders’ meeting</MarginalNote><Label>740.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;740&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>After the meeting referred to in subsection 739(1) is held, the directors of the insurance holding company shall without delay call a meeting of the shareholders of the insurance holding company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;740&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;740&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Meeting of shareholders or incorporators</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The shareholders of an insurance holding company shall, by resolution at the meeting of shareholders called under subsection (1),</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;740&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>approve, amend or reject any by-law made by the directors of the insurance holding company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;740&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>subject to section 803, elect directors to hold office for a term expiring not later than the close of the third annual meeting of shareholders following the election; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;740&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>appoint an auditor to hold office until the close of the first annual meeting of shareholders.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 740;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;741&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;741&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Term of first directors</MarginalNote><Label>741.</Label><Text>A director named in the application for letters patent to incorporate an insurance holding company holds office until the election of directors at the meeting of shareholders called under subsection 740(1).</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 741;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_5&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><Label>Division 5</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_5&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Capital Structure</TitleText></Heading><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_5&quot;,gc=&quot;s_742&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_5&quot;,gc=&quot;s_742&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Share Capital</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;742&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;742&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Power to issue shares</MarginalNote><Label>742.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;742&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to this Part and the by-laws of the insurance holding company, shares of an insurance holding company may be issued at such times and to such persons and for such consideration as the directors of the insurance holding company may determine.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;742&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;742&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shares</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Shares of an insurance holding company shall be in registered form and shall be without nominal or par value.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;742&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;742&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shares of continued insurance holding company</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>If a body corporate is continued as an insurance holding company under this Part, shares with nominal or par value issued by the body corporate before it was so continued are deemed to be shares without nominal or par value.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;742&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;742&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Deemed share conditions</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>If any right of a holder of a share with nominal or par value of a body corporate continued as an insurance holding company under this Part, other than a voting right, was stated or expressed in terms of the nominal or par value of the share immediately before the continuance under this Part that right is thereafter deemed to be the same right stated or expressed without reference to the nominal or par value of the share.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 742;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;743&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;743&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Common shares</MarginalNote><Label>743.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;743&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>An insurance holding company shall have one class of shares, to be designated as “common shares”, which are non-redeemable and in which the rights of the holders thereof are equal in all respects, and those rights include</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;743&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the right to vote at all meetings of shareholders except where only holders of a specified class of shares are entitled to vote;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;743&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the right to receive dividends declared on those shares; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;743&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the right to receive the remaining property of the insurance holding company on dissolution.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;743&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;743&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Designations of shares</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>No insurance holding company shall designate more than one class of its shares as “common shares” or any variation of that term.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;743&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;743&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Continued insurance holding company</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A body corporate continued as an insurance holding company under this Part that is not in compliance with subsection (2) on the date letters patent continuing it as an insurance holding company are issued shall, within twelve months after that date, redesignate its shares to comply with that subsection.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 743;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;744&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;744&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Classes of shares</MarginalNote><Label>744.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;744&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The by-laws of an insurance holding company may provide for more than one class of shares and, if they so provide, shall set out</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;744&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the rights, privileges, restrictions and conditions attaching to the shares of each class; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;744&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the maximum number, if any, of shares of any class that the insurance holding company is authorized to issue.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;744&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;744&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shareholder approval</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where a by-law referred to in subsection (1) is made, the directors of the insurance holding company shall submit the by-law to the shareholders at the next meeting of shareholders.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;744&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;744&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effective date</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A by-law referred to in subsection (1) is not effective until it is confirmed or confirmed with amendments by special resolution of the shareholders at the meeting referred to in subsection (2).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 744;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;745&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;745&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shares issued in series</MarginalNote><Label>745.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;745&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The by-laws of an insurance holding company may, subject to any limitations set out in them, authorize the issue of any class of shares in one or more series and may</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;745&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>fix the maximum number of shares in each series and determine the designation, rights, privileges, restrictions and conditions attaching to them; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;745&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>authorize the directors to do anything referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>).</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;745&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;745&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Series participation</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If any cumulative dividend or amounts payable on return of capital in respect of a series of shares are not paid in full, the shares of all series of the same class participate rateably in respect of accumulated dividends and return of capital.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;745&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;745&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Voting rights</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Where voting rights are attached to any series of a class of shares, the shares of every other series of that class shall have the same voting rights.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;745&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;745&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction on series</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>No rights, privileges, restrictions or conditions attached to a series of shares authorized under this section confer on the series a priority in respect of dividends or return of capital over any other series of shares of the same class that are then outstanding.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;745&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;745&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Material to Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>If the directors exercise their authority under paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>), the directors shall, before the issue of shares of the series, send to the Superintendent particulars of the series of shares and a copy of the by-law that granted the authority to the directors.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 745;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 307;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 314(E).</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20060427">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;746&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;746&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">One share, one vote</MarginalNote><Label>746.</Label><Text>Where voting rights are attached to a share of an insurance holding company, the voting rights may confer only one vote in respect of that share.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 746;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;747&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;747&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shares non-assessable</MarginalNote><Label>747.</Label><Text>Shares issued by an insurance holding company are non-assessable and the shareholders are not liable to the insurance holding company or to its creditors in respect thereof.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 747;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;748&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;748&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Consideration for share</MarginalNote><Label>748.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;748&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>No share of any class of shares of an insurance holding company shall be issued until it is fully paid for in money or, with the approval of the Superintendent, in property.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;748&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;748&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Other currencies</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>When issuing shares, an insurance holding company may provide that any aspect of the shares relating to money or involving the payment of or the liability to pay money be in a currency other than the currency of Canada.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 748;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;749&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;749&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Stated capital account</MarginalNote><Label>749.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;749&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>An insurance holding company shall maintain a separate stated capital account for each class and series of shares it issues.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;749&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;749&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Addition to stated capital account</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>An insurance holding company shall record in the appropriate stated capital account the full amount of any consideration it receives for any shares it issues.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;749&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;749&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Despite subsection (2), an insurance holding company may, subject to subsection (4), record in the stated capital account maintained for the shares of a class or series any part of the consideration it receives in an exchange if it issues shares</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;749&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in exchange for</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;749&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>property of a person who immediately before the exchange did not deal with the insurance holding company at arm’s length within the meaning of that expression in the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="I-3.3">Income Tax Act</XRefExternal>,</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;749&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>shares of or another interest in a body corporate that immediately before the exchange or because of it did not deal with the insurance holding company at arm’s length within the meaning of that expression in the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="I-3.3">Income Tax Act</XRefExternal>, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;749&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;iii&quot;"><Label>(iii)</Label><Text>property of a person who immediately before the exchange dealt with the insurance holding company at arm’s length within the meaning of that expression in the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="I-3.3">Income Tax Act</XRefExternal> if the person, the insurance holding company and all of the holders of shares in the class or series of shares so issued consent to the exchange;</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;749&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>under an agreement referred to in subsection 858(1); or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;749&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>to shareholders of an amalgamating body corporate who receive the shares in addition to or instead of securities of the amalgamated insurance holding company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;749&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;749&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limit on addition to a stated capital account</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>On the issuance of a share, an insurance holding company shall not add to the stated capital account in respect of the share an amount greater than the amount of the consideration it receives for the share.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;749&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;749&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Constraint on addition to a stated capital account</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>Where an insurance holding company that has issued any outstanding shares of more than one class or series proposes to add to a stated capital account that it maintains in respect of a class or series of shares an amount that was not received by the insurance holding company as consideration for the issue of shares, the addition must be approved by special resolution unless all the issued and outstanding shares are of not more than two classes of convertible shares referred to in subsection 759(4).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 749;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 308.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;750&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;750&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Stated capital of continued insurance holding company</MarginalNote><Label>750.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;750&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where a body corporate is continued as an insurance holding company under this Part, the insurance holding company shall record in the stated capital account maintained for each class and series of shares then outstanding an amount that is equal to the aggregate of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;750&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the aggregate amount paid up on the shares of each class and series of shares immediately before the body corporate was so continued, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;750&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the amount of the contributed surplus of the insurance holding company that is attributable to those shares.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;750&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;750&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Contributed surplus entry</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The amount of any contributed surplus recorded in the stated capital account pursuant to paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) shall be deducted from the contributed surplus account of the insurance holding company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;750&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;750&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shares issued before continuance</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Any amount unpaid in respect of a share issued by a body corporate before it was continued as an insurance holding company under this Part and paid after it was so continued shall be recorded in the stated capital account maintained by the insurance holding company for the shares of that class or series.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 750;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;751&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;751&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Pre-emptive right</MarginalNote><Label>751.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;751&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where the by-laws of an insurance holding company so provide, no shares of any class shall be issued unless the shares have first been offered to the shareholders holding shares of that class, and those shareholders have a pre-emptive right to acquire the offered shares in proportion to their holdings of the shares of that class, at such price and on such terms as those shares are to be offered to others.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;751&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;751&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Despite the existence of a pre-emptive right, a shareholder of an insurance holding company has no pre-emptive right in respect of shares of a class to be issued</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;751&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>for a consideration other than money;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;751&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>as a share dividend; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;751&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>pursuant to the exercise of conversion privileges, options or rights previously granted by the insurance holding company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;751&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;751&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Despite the existence of a pre-emptive right, a shareholder of an insurance holding company has no pre-emptive right in respect of shares to be issued</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;751&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>where the issue of shares to the shareholder is prohibited by this Part; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;751&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>where, to the knowledge of the directors of the insurance holding company, the offer of shares to a shareholder whose recorded address is in a country other than Canada ought not to be made unless the appropriate authority in that country is provided with information in addition to that submitted to the shareholders at the last annual meeting.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 751;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;752&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;752&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Conversion privileges</MarginalNote><Label>752.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;752&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>An insurance holding company may issue conversion privileges, options or rights to acquire securities of the insurance holding company, and shall set out the conditions thereof</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;752&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the documents that evidence the conversion privileges, options or rights; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;752&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the securities to which the conversion privileges, options or rights are attached.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;752&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;752&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Transferable rights</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Conversion privileges, options and rights to acquire securities of an insurance holding company may be made transferable or non-transferable, and options and rights to acquire such securities may be made separable or inseparable from any securities to which they are attached.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;752&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;752&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Reserved shares</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Where an insurance holding company has granted privileges to convert any securities issued by the insurance holding company into shares, or into shares of another class or series, or has issued or granted options or rights to acquire shares, if the by-laws limit the number of authorized shares, the insurance holding company shall reserve and continue to reserve sufficient authorized shares to meet the exercise of such conversion privileges, options and rights.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 752;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;753&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;753&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Holding of own shares</MarginalNote><Label>753.</Label><Text>Except as provided in sections 754 to 756, or unless permitted by the regulations, an insurance holding company shall not</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;753&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>hold shares of the insurance holding company or of any body corporate that controls the insurance holding company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;753&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>hold any ownership interests of any unincorporated entity that controls the insurance holding company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;753&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>permit any of its subsidiaries to hold any shares of the insurance holding company or of any body corporate that controls the insurance holding company; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;753&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>permit any of its subsidiaries to hold any ownership interests of any unincorporated entity that controls the insurance holding company.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 753;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;754&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;754&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Purchase and redemption of shares</MarginalNote><Label>754.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;754&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection (2) and to its by-laws, an insurance holding company may, with the consent of the Superintendent, purchase, for the purpose of cancellation, any shares issued by it, or redeem any redeemable shares issued by it at prices not exceeding the redemption price thereof calculated according to a formula stated in its by-laws or the conditions attaching to the shares.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;754&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;754&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restrictions on purchase and redemption</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>An insurance holding company shall not make any payment to purchase or redeem any shares issued by it if there are reasonable grounds for believing that it is, or the payment would cause it to be, in contravention of subsection 992(1), any regulation made under subsection 992(2) or any order made under subsection 992(3).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;754&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;754&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Donated shares</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>An insurance holding company may accept from any shareholder a share of the insurance holding company surrendered to it as a gift, but may not extinguish or reduce a liability in respect of an amount unpaid on any such share except in accordance with section 757.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 754;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 315.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;755&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;755&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Holding as personal representative</MarginalNote><Label>755.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;755&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>An insurance holding company may permit its subsidiaries to hold, in the capacity of a personal representative, shares of the insurance holding company or of any body corporate that controls the insurance holding company or ownership interests in any unincorporated entity that controls the insurance holding company, but only if the subsidiary does not have a beneficial interest in the shares or ownership interests.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;755&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;755&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Security interest</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>An insurance holding company may permit its subsidiaries to hold, by way of a security interest, shares of the insurance holding company or of any body corporate that controls the insurance holding company or any ownership interests of any entity that controls the insurance holding company if the security interest is nominal or immaterial when measured by criteria established by the insurance holding company that have been approved in writing by the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 755;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 309(F).</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;755.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;755.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception — conditions before acquisition</MarginalNote><Label>755.1</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;755.1&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>An insurance holding company may permit any of its subsidiaries to acquire shares of the insurance holding company through the issuance of those shares by the insurance holding company to the subsidiary if the conditions prescribed for the purposes of this subsection are met before the subsidiary acquires the shares.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;755.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;755.1&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Conditions after acquisition</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>After a subsidiary has acquired shares under the purported authority of subsection (1), the conditions prescribed for the purposes of this subsection must be met.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;755.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;755.1&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Non-compliance with conditions</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>If an insurance holding company permits any of its subsidiaries to acquire shares of the insurance holding company under the purported authority of subsection (1) and one or more of the conditions prescribed for the purposes of subsections (1) and (2) were not met, are not met or cease to be met, as the case may be, then, despite section 702 and subsection 749(2), the insurance holding company must comply with the prescribed requirements.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2007, c. 6, s. 316.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;756&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;756&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Cancellation of shares</MarginalNote><Label>756.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;756&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection (2), where an insurance holding company purchases shares of the insurance holding company or fractions thereof or redeems or otherwise acquires shares of the insurance holding company, the insurance holding company shall cancel those shares.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;756&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;756&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Requirement to sell</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If a subsidiary of an insurance holding company, through the realization of security, acquires any shares of the insurance holding company or of any body corporate that controls the insurance holding company or any ownership interests in an unincorporated entity that controls the insurance holding company, the insurance holding company shall cause its subsidiary to, within six months after the day of the realization, sell or otherwise dispose of the shares or ownership interests.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 756;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;757&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;757&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Reduction of capital</MarginalNote><Label>757.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;757&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The stated capital of an insurance holding company may be reduced by special resolution.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;757&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;757&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limitation</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>An insurance holding company shall not reduce its stated capital by special resolution if there are reasonable grounds for believing that the insurance holding company is, or the reduction would cause the insurance holding company to be, in contravention of subsection 992(1), any regulation made under subsection 992(2) or any order made under subsection 992(3).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;757&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;757&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Contents of special resolution</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A special resolution to reduce the stated capital of an insurance holding company shall specify the stated capital account or accounts from which the reduction of stated capital effected by the special resolution will be deducted.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;757&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;757&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Approval by Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>A special resolution to reduce the stated capital of an insurance holding company has no effect until it is approved in writing by the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;757&quot;,ss=&quot;4.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;757&quot;,ss=&quot;4.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(4.1)</Label><Text>Subsection (4) does not apply if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;757&quot;,ss=&quot;4.1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the reduction in the stated capital is made solely as a result of changes made to the accounting principles referred to in subsection 331(4); and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;757&quot;,ss=&quot;4.1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>there is to be no return of capital to shareholders as a result of the reduction.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;757&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;757&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Conditions for approval</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>No approval to reduce the stated capital of an insurance holding company may be given by the Superintendent unless application therefor is made within three months after the time of the passing of the special resolution and a copy of the special resolution, together with a notice of intention to apply for approval, has been published in the <XRefExternal reference-type="other" link="gazette">Canada Gazette</XRefExternal>.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;757&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;757&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Statements to be submitted</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>In addition to evidence of the passing of a special resolution to reduce the stated capital of an insurance holding company and of the publication thereof, statements showing</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;757&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the number of the insurance holding company’s shares issued and outstanding,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;757&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the results of the voting by class of shares of the insurance holding company,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;757&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the insurance holding company’s assets and liabilities, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;757&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the reason why the insurance holding company seeks the reduction of capital</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>shall be submitted to the Superintendent at the time of the application for approval of the special resolution.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 757;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 317.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;758&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;758&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Recovery by action</MarginalNote><Label>758.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;758&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where any money or property was paid or distributed to a shareholder or other person as a consequence of a reduction of capital made contrary to section 757, a creditor of the insurance holding company may apply to a court for an order compelling the shareholder or other person to pay the money or deliver the property to the insurance holding company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;758&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;758&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shares held by personal representative</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>No person holding shares in the capacity of a personal representative and registered on the records of the insurance holding company as a shareholder and therein described as the personal representative of a named person is personally liable under subsection (1), but the named person is subject to all the liabilities imposed by that subsection.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;758&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;758&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limitation</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>An action to enforce a liability imposed by subsection (1) may not be commenced more than two years after the date of the act complained of.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;758&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;758&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Remedy preserved</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>This section does not affect any liability that arises under section 841.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 758;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;759&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;759&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Adjustment of stated capital account</MarginalNote><Label>759.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;759&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>On a purchase, redemption or other acquisition by an insurance holding company of shares or fractions thereof issued by it, the insurance holding company shall deduct from the stated capital account maintained for the class or series of shares so purchased, redeemed or otherwise acquired an amount equal to the result obtained by multiplying the stated capital in respect of the shares of that class or series by the number of shares of that class or series so purchased, redeemed or otherwise acquired and dividing by the number of shares of that class or series outstanding immediately before the purchase, redemption or other acquisition.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;759&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;759&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Adjustment of stated capital account</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>An insurance holding company shall adjust its stated capital account or accounts in accordance with any special resolution referred to in section 757.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;759&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;759&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shares converted to another class</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>On a conversion of outstanding shares of an insurance holding company into shares of another class or series, or on a change of outstanding shares of the insurance holding company into shares of another class or series, the insurance holding company shall</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;759&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>deduct from the stated capital account maintained for the class or series of shares converted or changed an amount equal to the result obtained by multiplying the stated capital of the shares of that class or series by the number of shares of that class or series converted or changed, and dividing by the number of outstanding shares of that class or series immediately before the conversion or change; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;759&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>record the result obtained under paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) and any additional consideration received pursuant to the conversion or change in the stated capital account maintained or to be maintained for the class or series of shares into which the shares have been converted or changed.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;759&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;759&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Stated capital of convertible shares</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>For the purposes of subsection (3) and subject to the insurance holding company’s by-laws, where an insurance holding company issues two classes of shares and there is attached to each class a right to convert a share of one class into a share of the other class and a share is so converted, the amount of stated capital attributable to a share in either class is the aggregate of the stated capital of both classes divided by the number of outstanding shares of both classes immediately before the conversion.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;759&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;759&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Conversion or change of shares</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>Shares issued by an insurance holding company and converted into shares of another class or series, or changed under subsection 851(1) into shares of another class or series, become issued shares of the class or series of shares into which the shares have been converted or changed.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 759;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;760&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;760&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Addition to stated capital account</MarginalNote><Label>760.</Label><Text>On a conversion of any debt obligation of an insurance holding company into shares of a class or series of shares, the insurance holding company shall</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;760&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>deduct from the liabilities of the insurance holding company the nominal value of the debt obligation being converted; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;760&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>record the result obtained under paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) and any additional consideration received for the conversion in the stated capital account maintained or to be maintained for the class or series of shares into which the debt obligation has been converted.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 760;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;761&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;761&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Declaration of dividend</MarginalNote><Label>761.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;761&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The directors of an insurance holding company may declare and an insurance holding company may pay a dividend by issuing fully paid shares of the insurance holding company or options or rights to acquire fully paid shares of the insurance holding company and, subject to subsection (4), the directors of an insurance holding company may declare and an insurance holding company may pay a dividend in money or property, and, where a dividend is to be paid in money, the dividend may be paid in a currency other than the currency of Canada.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;761&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;761&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice to Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The directors of an insurance holding company shall notify the Superintendent of the declaration of a dividend at least 15 days before the day fixed for its payment.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;761&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;761&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Share dividend</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>If shares of an insurance holding company are issued in payment of a dividend, the insurance holding company shall record in the stated capital account maintained or to be maintained for the shares of the class or series issued in payment of the dividend the declared amount of the dividend stated as an amount of money.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;761&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;761&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">When dividend not to be declared</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>The directors of an insurance holding company shall not declare and an insurance holding company shall not pay a dividend if there are reasonable grounds for believing that the insurance holding company is, or the payment would cause the insurance holding company to be, in contravention of subsection 992(1), any regulation made under subsection 992(2) or any order made under subsection 992(3).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 761;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 318.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_5&quot;,gc=&quot;s_762&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_5&quot;,gc=&quot;s_762&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Subordinated Indebtedness</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;762&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;762&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction on subordinated indebtedness</MarginalNote><Label>762.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;762&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>An insurance holding company shall not issue subordinated indebtedness unless the subordinated indebtedness is fully paid for in money or, with the approval of the Superintendent, in property.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;762&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;762&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">References to subordinated indebtedness</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A person shall not in any prospectus, advertisement, correspondence or literature relating to any subordinated indebtedness issued or to be issued by an insurance holding company refer to the subordinated indebtedness otherwise than as subordinated indebtedness.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;762&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;762&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Other currencies</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>When issuing subordinated indebtedness, an insurance holding company may provide that any aspect of the subordinated indebtedness relating to money or involving the payment of or the liability to pay money in relation thereto be in a currency other than that of Canada including, without restricting the generality of the foregoing, the payment of any interest thereon.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 762;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_5&quot;,gc=&quot;s_763&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_5&quot;,gc=&quot;s_763&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Security Certificates and Transfers</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;763&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;763&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Sections 85 to 139 apply</MarginalNote><Label>763.</Label><Text>Sections 85 to 139 apply in respect of insurance holding companies, subject to the following:</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;763&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>references to “company” in those sections are to be read as references to “insurance holding company”;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;763&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>references to “this Act” in those sections are to be read as references to “this Part”;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;763&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>references to “Part VII” in those sections are to be read as references to “Division 7 of Part XVII”;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;763&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>references to “this Part” in those sections are to be read as references to “this Division”;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;763&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>paragraph 92(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) is to be read without reference to the words “other than section 427”;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;763&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the reference to “sections 142 to 145 and section 149” in subsection 97(1) is to be read as a reference to “sections 766 to 769 and 772”; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;763&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the reference to “section 75 or 81” in subsection 101(3) is to be read as a reference to “section 754 or 759”.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>1991, c. 47, s. 763;</li><li> 2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="2"><Label>Division 6</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Corporate Governance</TitleText></Heading><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_1&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><Label>Subdivision 1</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_1&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Shareholders</TitleText></Heading><Heading group-style="left-regular" Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_1&quot;,gd=&quot;s_764&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="4"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_1&quot;,gd=&quot;s_764&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Place of Meetings</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;764&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;764&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Place of meetings</MarginalNote><Label>764.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;764&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Meetings of shareholders of an insurance holding company shall be held at the place within Canada provided for in the by-laws of the insurance holding company or, in the absence of any such provision, at the place within Canada that the directors determine.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;764&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;764&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Participation by electronic means</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Unless the by-laws provide otherwise, any person who is entitled to attend a meeting of shareholders may participate in the meeting by means of a telephonic, electronic or other communication facility that permits all participants to communicate adequately with each other during the meeting if the insurance holding company makes one available. A person who is participating in a meeting by one of those means is deemed for the purposes of this Part to be present at the meeting.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;764&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;764&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations respecting the manner of and conditions for participating in a meeting by means of a telephonic, electronic or other communication facility that permits all participants to communicate adequately with each other during the meeting.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 311.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading group-style="left-regular" Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_1&quot;,gd=&quot;s_765&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="4"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_1&quot;,gd=&quot;s_765&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Calling Meetings</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;765&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;765&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Calling meetings</MarginalNote><Label>765.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;765&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The directors of an insurance holding company</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;765&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>shall, after the meeting called under subsection 740(1), call the first annual meeting of shareholders of the insurance holding company, which meeting must be held not later than six months after the end of the first financial year of the insurance holding company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;765&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>shall subsequently call an annual meeting of shareholders, which meeting must be held not later than six months after the end of each financial year; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;765&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>may at any time call a special meeting of shareholders.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;765&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;765&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Order to delay calling annual meeting</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Despite subsection (1), the insurance holding company may apply to the court for an order extending the time for calling an annual meeting.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;765&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;765&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Obligation to notify Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The insurance holding company shall give notice of the application to the Superintendent before any hearing concerning the application and shall provide the Superintendent with a copy of any order that is issued.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;765&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;765&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Superintendent’s right to appear</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>The Superintendent is entitled to appear and be heard in person or by counsel at any hearing concerning the application.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 312.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading group-style="left-regular" Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_1&quot;,gd=&quot;s_766&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="4"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_1&quot;,gd=&quot;s_766&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Record Dates</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;766&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;766&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Authority to fix record date</MarginalNote><Label>766.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;766&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The directors may in advance fix a record date, that is within the prescribed period, for the determination of shareholders for any purpose, including for a determination of which shareholders are entitled to</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;766&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>receive payment of a dividend;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;766&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>participate in a liquidation distribution;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;766&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>receive notice of a meeting of shareholders; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;766&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>vote at a meeting of shareholders.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;766&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;766&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Determination of record date</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If no record date is fixed,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;766&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the record date for the determination of shareholders who are entitled to receive notice of a meeting of shareholders is</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;766&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>at the close of business on the day immediately preceding the day on which the notice is given, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;766&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>if no notice is given, the day on which the meeting is held; and</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;766&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the record date for the determination of shareholders for any other purpose, other than to establish a shareholder’s right to vote, is at the close of business on the day on which the directors pass a resolution in respect of that purpose.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;766&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;766&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of record date</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>If a record date is fixed and unless notice of the record date is waived in writing by every holder of a share of the class or series affected whose name is set out in the securities register at the close of business on the day on which the directors fix the record date, notice of the record date shall be given within the prescribed period by</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;766&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>advertisement in a newspaper in general circulation in the place where the insurance holding company’s head office is situated and in each place in Canada where the insurance holding company has a transfer agent or where a transfer of its shares may be recorded; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;766&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>written notice to each stock exchange in Canada on which the insurance holding company’s shares are listed for trading.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 313.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading group-style="left-regular" Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_1&quot;,gd=&quot;s_767&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="4"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_1&quot;,gd=&quot;s_767&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Notices of Meetings</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;767&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;767&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of meeting</MarginalNote><Label>767.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;767&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Notice of the time and place of a meeting of shareholders of an insurance holding company shall be sent within the prescribed period to</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;767&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>each shareholder entitled to vote at the meeting;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;767&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>each director;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;767&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the auditor of the insurance holding company; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;767&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the Superintendent.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;767&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;767&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(1.1)</Label><Text>In the case of an insurance holding company that is not a distributing insurance holding company, notice may be sent within any shorter period specified in its by-laws.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;767&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;767&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Number of eligible votes</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>An insurance holding company in respect of which subsection 927(4) applies shall set out in the notice of a meeting the number of eligible votes, as defined under subsection 793(1), that may be cast at the meeting as of the record date for determining the shareholders entitled to receive the notice of meeting, or, if there are to be separate votes of shareholders at the meeting, the number of eligible votes, as defined in that subsection, in respect of each separate vote to be held at the meeting.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;767&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;767&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Waiver of notice</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>An insurance holding company is not required under subsection (1) to send to a person notice of a meeting if the person waives notice of the meeting. That waiver may be in any manner.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;767&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;767&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Attendance constitutes waiver</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>A person who attends a meeting of shareholders is deemed to have waived notice of the meeting, except where the person attends the meeting for the express purpose of objecting to the transaction of any business on the grounds that the meeting is not lawfully called.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;767&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;767&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Publication in newspaper</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>In addition to the notice required under subsection (1), where any class of shares of an insurance holding company is publicly traded on a recognized stock exchange in Canada, notice of the time and place of the meeting of shareholders shall be published once a week for at least four consecutive weeks before the date of the meeting in a newspaper in the place where the head office of the insurance holding company is situated and in each place in Canada where the insurance holding company has a transfer agent or where a transfer of the insurance holding company’s shares may be recorded.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;767&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;767&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice not required</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>Notice of a meeting of shareholders is not required to be sent to shareholders who are not registered on the records of the insurance holding company or the insurance holding company’s transfer agent on the record date fixed under paragraph 766(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>) or determined under paragraph 766(2)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;767&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;767&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effect of default</MarginalNote><Label>(7)</Label><Text>Failure to receive a notice of a meeting of shareholders does not deprive a shareholder of the right to vote at the meeting.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 314.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;768&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;768&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of adjourned meeting</MarginalNote><Label>768.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;768&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If a meeting of shareholders is adjourned for less than thirty days, it is not necessary, unless the by-laws otherwise provide, to give notice of the adjourned meeting, other than by announcement at the earliest meeting that is adjourned.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;768&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;768&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice after longer adjournment</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If a meeting of shareholders is adjourned by one or more adjournments for a total of thirty days or more, notice of the continuation of the meeting shall be given as for an original meeting but, unless the meeting is adjourned by one or more adjournments for a total of more than ninety days, subsection 788(1) does not apply.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;769&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;769&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Special business</MarginalNote><Label>769.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;769&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>All matters dealt with at a special meeting of shareholders or at an annual meeting of shareholders are deemed to be special business, except that special business does not include consideration of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;769&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the financial statements;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;769&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the auditor’s report;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;769&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the election of directors; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;769&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the remuneration of directors and reappointment of the incumbent auditor.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;769&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;769&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of special business</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Notice of a meeting of shareholders at which special business is to be transacted must</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;769&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>state the nature of the special business in sufficient detail to permit a shareholder to form a reasoned judgment thereon; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;769&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>contain the text of any special resolution to be submitted to the meeting.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading group-style="left-regular" Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_1&quot;,gd=&quot;s_770&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="4"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_1&quot;,gd=&quot;s_770&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Shareholder Proposals</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;770&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;770&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Proposals</MarginalNote><Label>770.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;770&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to subsections (1.1) and (1.2), a registered holder or a beneficial owner of shares that may be voted at an annual meeting of shareholders may</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;770&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>submit to the insurance holding company notice of any matter that they propose to raise at the meeting (in this section and section 771 referred to as a “proposal”); and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;770&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>discuss at the meeting any matter in respect of which they would have been entitled to submit a proposal.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;770&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;770&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Eligibility to submit proposal</MarginalNote><Label>(1.1)</Label><Text>To be eligible to submit a proposal a person shall</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;770&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>for at least the prescribed period be the registered holder or beneficial owner of at least the prescribed number of the insurance holding company’s outstanding shares; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;770&quot;,ss=&quot;1.1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>have the support of persons who, in the aggregate and including or not including the person who submits the proposal, have for at least the prescribed period been the registered holders or beneficial owners of at least the prescribed number of the insurance holding company’s outstanding shares.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;770&quot;,ss=&quot;1.2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;770&quot;,ss=&quot;1.2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Information to be provided</MarginalNote><Label>(1.2)</Label><Text>A proposal is to be accompanied by the following information:</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;770&quot;,ss=&quot;1.2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the name and address of the person submitting the proposal and the names and addresses of their supporters, if any; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;770&quot;,ss=&quot;1.2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the number of shares held or owned by the person and their supporters and the date that the shares were acquired.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;770&quot;,ss=&quot;1.3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;770&quot;,ss=&quot;1.3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Information not part of proposal</MarginalNote><Label>(1.3)</Label><Text>The information provided under subsection (1.2) does not form part of a proposal or of the supporting statement referred to in subsection (3) and is not to be included for the purposes of the prescribed maximum number of words referred to in subsection (3).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;770&quot;,ss=&quot;1.4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;770&quot;,ss=&quot;1.4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Proof may be required</MarginalNote><Label>(1.4)</Label><Text>If the insurance holding company requests within the prescribed period that a person provide proof that they are eligible to submit a proposal, the person shall within the prescribed period provide proof that they meet the requirements of subsection (1.1).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;770&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;770&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Circulation of proposal</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>An insurance holding company shall attach any proposal of a shareholder submitted for consideration at a meeting of shareholders to the notice of the meeting.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;770&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;770&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Supporting statement</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>At the request of the person who submits a proposal, the insurance holding company shall attach to the notice of the meeting the person’s statement in support of the proposal and their name and address. The statement and proposal together are not to exceed the prescribed maximum number of words.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;770&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;770&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Nomination of directors</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>A proposal may include nominations for the election of directors if it is signed by one or more registered holders or beneficial owners of shares representing in the aggregate not less than 5% of the shares of the insurance holding company or 5% of the shares of a class of its shares entitled to vote at the meeting at which the proposal is to be presented.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;770&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;770&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exemption</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>An insurance holding company is not required to comply with subsections (2) and (3) if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;770&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the proposal is not submitted to the insurance holding company at least the prescribed number of days before the anniversary date of the notice of meeting that was sent to shareholders in respect of the previous annual meeting of shareholders;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;770&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>it clearly appears that the primary purpose of the proposal is to enforce a personal claim or redress a personal griev­ance against the insurance holding company or its directors, officers or security holders;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;770&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;b.1&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b.1</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>it clearly appears that the proposal does not relate in a significant way to the business or affairs of the insurance holding company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;770&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the person submitting the proposal failed within the prescribed period before the insurance holding company receives their proposal to present, in person or by proxy, at a meeting of shareholders a proposal that at their request had been attached to the notice of the meeting;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;770&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>substantially the same proposal was set out in or attached to a dissident’s proxy circular or a notice of a meeting relating to, and presented to shareholders at, a meeting of shareholders held within the prescribed period before the receipt of the proposal and did not receive the prescribed minimum amount of support at the meeting; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;770&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the rights conferred by subsections (1) to (4) are being abused to secure publicity.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;770&quot;,ss=&quot;5.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;770&quot;,ss=&quot;5.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Insurance holding company may refuse to include proposal</MarginalNote><Label>(5.1)</Label><Text>If a person who submits a proposal fails to continue to hold or own shares in accordance with paragraph (1.1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) or, as the case may be, does not continue to have the support of persons who are in the aggregate the registered holders or beneficial owners of the prescribed number of shares in accordance with paragraph (1.1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) until the end of the meeting, the insurance holding company is not required to attach any proposal submitted by that person to a notice of a meeting for any meeting held within the prescribed period after the day of the meeting.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;770&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;770&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Immunity for proposal and statement</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>No insurance holding company or person acting on behalf of an insurance holding company incurs any liability by reason only of circulating a proposal or statement in compliance with subsections (2) and (3).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 315.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;771&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;771&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of refusal</MarginalNote><Label>771.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;771&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If an insurance holding company refuses to attach a proposal to a notice of a meeting, it shall in writing notify the person submitting the proposal of its intention not to attach the proposal and of the reasons for the refusal. It shall notify the person within the prescribed period after either the day on which it receives the proposal or, if it has requested proof under subsection 770(1.4), the day on which it receives the proof.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;771&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;771&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Application to court</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>On the application of a person submitting a proposal who claims to be aggrieved by an insurance holding company’s refusal under subsection (1), a court may restrain the holding of the meeting at which the proposal is sought to be presented and make any further order that it thinks fit.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;771&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;771&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Appeal to court</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>An insurance holding company or any person claiming to be aggrieved by a proposal may apply to a court for an order permitting the insurance holding company not to attach the proposal to the notice of the meeting, and the court, if it is satisfied that subsection 770(5) applies, may make such order as it thinks fit.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;771&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;771&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice to Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>An applicant under subsection (2) or (3) shall give the Superintendent written notice of the application and the Superintendent may appear and be heard at the hearing of the application in person or by counsel.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 316.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading group-style="left-regular" Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_1&quot;,gd=&quot;s_772&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="4"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_1&quot;,gd=&quot;s_772&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Shareholder List</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;772&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;772&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">List of shareholders entitled to notice</MarginalNote><Label>772.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;772&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>An insurance holding company shall prepare an alphabetical list of shareholders entitled to receive notice of a meeting, showing the number of shares held by each shareholder</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;772&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if a record date is fixed under paragraph 766(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>), no later than 10 days after that date; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;772&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if no record date is fixed, on the record date determined under paragraph 766(2)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>).</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;772&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;772&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Voting list</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The insurance holding company shall prepare an alphabetical list of shareholders entitled to vote as of the record date showing the number of shares held by each shareholder</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;772&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if a record date is fixed under paragraph 766(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), no later than 10 days after that date; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;772&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if no record date is fixed under paragraph 766(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>), no later than 10 days after a record date is fixed under paragraph 766(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>) or no later than the record date determined under paragraph 766(2)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>), as the case may be.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;772&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;772&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Entitlement to vote</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Subject to section 793, a shareholder whose name appears on a list prepared under subsection (2) is entitled to vote the shares shown opposite their name.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;772&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;772&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Examination of list</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>A shareholder may examine the list of shareholders</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;772&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>during usual business hours at the head office of the insurance holding company or at the place where its central securities register is maintained; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;772&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>at the meeting of shareholders for which the list was prepared.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 317.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading group-style="left-regular" Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_1&quot;,gd=&quot;s_773&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="4"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_1&quot;,gd=&quot;s_773&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Quorum</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;773&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;773&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shareholders</MarginalNote><Label>773.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;773&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Unless the by-laws otherwise provide, a quorum of shareholders is present at a meeting of shareholders if the holders of a majority of the shares who are entitled to vote at the meeting are present in person or represented by proxyholders.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;773&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;773&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Quorum at opening</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If a quorum is present at the opening of a meeting of shareholders, the shareholders present may, unless the by-laws otherwise provide, proceed with the business of the meeting, notwithstanding that a quorum is not present throughout the meeting.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;773&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;773&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">No quorum at opening</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>If a quorum is not present at the opening of a meeting of shareholders, the shareholders present may adjourn the meeting to a fixed time and place but may not transact any other business.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;774&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;774&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">One shareholder meeting</MarginalNote><Label>774.</Label><Text>If an insurance holding company has only one shareholder, or only one holder of any class or series of shares, the shareholder present in person or represented by a proxyholder constitutes a meeting of shareholders or a meeting of shareholders of that class or series.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading group-style="left-regular" Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_1&quot;,gd=&quot;s_775&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="4"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_1&quot;,gd=&quot;s_775&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Voting</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;775&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;775&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">One share — one vote</MarginalNote><Label>775.</Label><Text>Subject to section 793, if a share of an insurance holding company entitles the holder of the share to vote at a meeting of shareholders, that share entitles the shareholder to one vote at the meeting.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;776&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;776&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Representative shareholder</MarginalNote><Label>776.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;776&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If an entity is a shareholder of an insurance holding company, the insurance holding company shall recognize any natural person authorized by a resolution of the directors or governing body or similar authority of the entity to represent it at meetings of shareholders of the insurance holding company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;776&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;776&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Powers of representative</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A natural person authorized under subsection (1) to represent an entity may exercise on behalf of the entity all the powers the entity could exercise if the entity were a natural person who was a shareholder.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;777&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;777&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Joint shareholders</MarginalNote><Label>777.</Label><Text>Unless the by-laws otherwise provide, if two or more persons hold shares jointly, one of those holders present at a meeting of shareholders may in the absence of the others vote the shares, but if two or more of those persons who are present in person or represented by proxyholder vote, they shall vote as one on the shares jointly held by them.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;778&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;778&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Voting by hands or ballot</MarginalNote><Label>778.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;778&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Unless the by-laws otherwise provide, voting at a meeting of shareholders shall take place by show of hands except when a ballot is demanded by a shareholder or proxyholder entitled to vote at the meeting.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;778&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;778&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Ballot</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A shareholder or proxyholder may demand a ballot either before or after any vote by show of hands.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;778&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;778&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Electronic voting</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Despite subsection (1) and unless the by-laws provide otherwise, any vote referred to in that subsection may be held entirely by means of a telephonic, electronic or other communication facility if the insurance holding company makes one available.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;778&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;778&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Voting while participating electronically</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Unless the by-laws provide otherwise, any person who is participating in a meeting of shareholders under subsection 764(2) and entitled to vote at that meeting may vote by means of the telephonic, electronic or other communication facility that the insurance holding company has made available for that purpose.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;778&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;778&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Regulations</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations respecting the manner of and conditions for voting at a meeting of shareholders by means of a telephonic, electronic or other communication facility.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 318.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading group-style="left-regular" Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_1&quot;,gd=&quot;s_779&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="4"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_1&quot;,gd=&quot;s_779&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Resolution in lieu of Meeting</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;779&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;779&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Resolution in lieu of meeting</MarginalNote><Label>779.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;779&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Except where a written statement is submitted by a director under section 809 or by an auditor under subsection 900(1),</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;779&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a resolution in writing signed by all the shareholders entitled to vote on that resolution at a meeting of shareholders is as valid as if it had been passed at a meeting of the shareholders; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;779&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a resolution in writing dealing with all matters required by this Part to be dealt with at a meeting of shareholders, and signed by all the shareholders entitled to vote at that meeting, satisfies all the requirements of this Part relating to meetings of shareholders.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;779&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;779&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Filing resolution</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A copy of every resolution referred to in subsection (1) shall be kept with the minutes of the meetings of shareholders.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;779&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;779&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Evidence</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Unless a ballot is demanded, an entry in the minutes of a meeting that the chairperson declared a resolution to be carried or defeated is in the absence of evidence to the contrary proof of that fact without proof of the number or proportion of votes recorded in favour of or against the resolution.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 319.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading group-style="left-regular" Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_1&quot;,gd=&quot;s_780&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="4"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_1&quot;,gd=&quot;s_780&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Requisitioned Meetings</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;780&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;780&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Requisitioned meeting</MarginalNote><Label>780.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;780&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Shareholders who together hold not less than 5 per cent of the issued and outstanding shares of an insurance holding company that carry the right to vote at a meeting sought to be held may requisition the directors to call a meeting of shareholders for the purposes stated in the requisition.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;780&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;780&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Form</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A requisition referred to in subsection (1)</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;780&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>must state the business to be transacted at the meeting and must be sent to each director and to the head office of the insurance holding company; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;780&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>may consist of several documents of like form, each signed by one or more shareholders.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;780&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;780&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Directors calling meeting</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>On receipt of a requisition referred to in subsection (1), the directors shall call a meeting of shareholders to transact the business stated in the requisition, unless</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;780&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a record date has been fixed under paragraph 766(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>) and notice of it has been given under subsection 766(3);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;780&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the directors have called a meeting of shareholders and have given notice thereof under section 767; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;780&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the business of the meeting as stated in the requisition includes matters described in paragraphs 770(5)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>).</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;780&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;780&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shareholders’ power</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>If the directors do not call a meeting within twenty-one days after receiving a requisition referred to in subsection (1), any shareholder who signed the requisition may call the meeting.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;780&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;780&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Procedure</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>A meeting called under this section shall be called as nearly as possible in the manner in which meetings are to be called pursuant to the by-laws and this Part.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;780&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;780&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Reimbursement</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>Unless the shareholders otherwise resolve at a meeting called under subsection (4), the insurance holding company shall reimburse the shareholders for any expenses reasonably incurred by them in requisitioning, calling and holding the meeting.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 320.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Heading group-style="left-regular" Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_1&quot;,gd=&quot;s_781&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="4"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_1&quot;,gd=&quot;s_781&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Powers of the Court</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;781&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;781&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Court may order meeting to be called</MarginalNote><Label>781.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;781&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A court may, on the application of a director, a shareholder who is entitled to vote at a meeting of shareholders or the Superintendent, order a meeting to be called, held or conducted in the manner that the court directs if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;781&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>it is impracticable to call the meeting within the time or in the manner in which it is to be called;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;781&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>it is impracticable to conduct the meeting in the manner required by this Part or the by-laws; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;781&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the court thinks that the meeting ought to be called, held or conducted within the time or in the manner that it directs for any other reason.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;781&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><Label>(2)</Label><Text><Repealed>[Repealed, 2005, c. 54, s. 321]</Repealed></Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;781&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;781&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Varying quorum</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Without restricting the generality of subsection (1), a court may order that the quorum required by the by-laws or this Part be varied or dispensed with at a meeting called, held and conducted pursuant to this section.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;781&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;781&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Valid meeting</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>A meeting called, held and conducted pursuant to this section is for all purposes a meeting of shareholders of the insurance holding company duly called, held and conducted.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 321.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;782&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;782&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Court review of election</MarginalNote><Label>782.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;782&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>An insurance holding company or a shareholder or director of an insurance holding company may apply to a court to resolve any dispute in respect of the election or appointment of a director or an auditor of the insurance holding company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;782&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;782&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Powers of court</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>On an application under subsection (1), a court may make any order it thinks fit including, without limiting the generality of the foregoing,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;782&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order restraining a director or auditor whose election or appointment is challenged from acting pending determination of the dispute;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;782&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order declaring the result of the disputed election or appointment;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;782&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order requiring a new election or appointment, and including in the order directions for the management of the business and affairs of the insurance holding company until a new election is held or the new appointment is made; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;782&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order determining the voting rights of shareholders and persons claiming to own shares.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;783&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;783&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice to Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>783.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;783&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A person who makes an application under subsection 781(1) or 782(1) shall give notice of the application to the Superintendent before the hearing and shall deliver a copy of the order of the court, if any, to the Superintendent.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;783&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;783&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Superintendent representation</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The Superintendent may appear and be heard in person or by counsel at the hearing of an application referred to in subsection (1).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading group-style="left-regular" Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_1&quot;,gd=&quot;s_784&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="4"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_1&quot;,gd=&quot;s_784&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Pooling Agreements</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;784&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;784&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Pooling agreement</MarginalNote><Label>784.</Label><Text>A written agreement between two or more shareholders may provide that in exercising voting rights the shares held by them will be voted as provided in the agreement.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_2&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><Label>Subdivision 2</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_2&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Proxies and Restrictions on Voting</TitleText></Heading><Heading group-style="left-regular" Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_2&quot;,gd=&quot;s_785&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="4"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_2&quot;,gd=&quot;s_785&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Proxies</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;785&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;785&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Definitions</MarginalNote><Label>785.</Label><Text>The following definitions apply in this Subdivision.</Text><Definition Code="se=&quot;785&quot;,df=&quot;{intermediary}{intermédiaire}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;785&quot;,df=&quot;{intermediary}{intermédiaire}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>intermediary</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;785&quot;,df=&quot;{intermediary}{intermédiaire}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>intermédiaire</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>intermediary</DefinedTermEn> means a person who holds a security on behalf of another person who is not the registered holder of the security, and includes </Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;785&quot;,df=&quot;{intermediary}{intermédiaire}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a securities broker or dealer required to be registered to trade or deal in securities under the laws of any jurisdiction;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;785&quot;,df=&quot;{intermediary}{intermédiaire}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a securities depositary;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;785&quot;,df=&quot;{intermediary}{intermédiaire}&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a financial institution;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;785&quot;,df=&quot;{intermediary}{intermédiaire}&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in respect of a clearing agency, a securities dealer, trust company, association within the meaning of section 2 of the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="C-41.01">Cooperative Credit Associations Act</XRefExternal>, bank or other person, including another clearing agency, on whose behalf the clearing agency or its nominee holds securities of an issuer;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;785&quot;,df=&quot;{intermediary}{intermédiaire}&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a trustee or administrator of a self-administered retirement savings plan, retirement income fund or education savings plan or another similar self-administered savings or investment plan that is registered under the <XRefExternal reference-type="act" link="I-3.3">Income Tax Act</XRefExternal>;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;785&quot;,df=&quot;{intermediary}{intermédiaire}&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a nominee of a person referred to in any of paragraphs (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>); and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;785&quot;,df=&quot;{intermediary}{intermédiaire}&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a person who performs functions similar to those performed by a person referred to in any of paragraphs (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>) and holds a security registered in their name, or in the name of their nominee, on behalf of another person who is not the registered holder of the security.</Text></Paragraph></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;785&quot;,df=&quot;{}{}&quot;"><Text><DefinedTermEn>registrant</DefinedTermEn><Repealed>[Repealed, 2005, c. 54, s. 322]</Repealed></Text></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;785&quot;,df=&quot;{solicit}{sollicitation}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;785&quot;,df=&quot;{solicit}{sollicitation}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>solicit</DefinedTermEn> or <DefinedTermEn>solicitation</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;785&quot;,df=&quot;{solicit}{sollicitation}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>sollicitation</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>solicit</DefinedTermEn> or <DefinedTermEn>solicitation</DefinedTermEn> includes</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;785&quot;,df=&quot;{solicit}{sollicitation}&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a request for a proxy, whether or not accompanied by or included in a form of proxy,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;785&quot;,df=&quot;{solicit}{sollicitation}&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a request to execute or not to execute a form of proxy or to revoke a proxy,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;785&quot;,df=&quot;{solicit}{sollicitation}&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the sending of a form of proxy or other communication to a shareholder under circumstances reasonably calculated to result in the procurement, withholding or revocation of a proxy, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;785&quot;,df=&quot;{solicit}{sollicitation}&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the sending of a form of proxy to a shareholder under section 788,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedDefinition><Text>but does not include</Text></ContinuedDefinition><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;785&quot;,df=&quot;{solicit}{sollicitation}&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the sending of a form of proxy in response to an unsolicited request made by or on behalf of a shareholder,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;785&quot;,df=&quot;{solicit}{sollicitation}&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the performance of administrative acts or professional services on behalf of a person soliciting a proxy,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;785&quot;,df=&quot;{solicit}{sollicitation}&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the sending by a registrant of the documents referred to in section 791, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;785&quot;,df=&quot;{solicit}{sollicitation}&quot;,p1=&quot;h&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">h</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a solicitation by a person in respect of shares of which that person is the beneficial owner.</Text></Paragraph></Definition><Definition Code="se=&quot;785&quot;,df=&quot;{solicitation by or on behalf of the management of an insurance holding company}{sollicitation effectuée par la direction d’une société de portefeuille d’assurances ou pour son compte}&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;785&quot;,df=&quot;{solicitation by or on behalf of the management of an insurance holding company}{sollicitation effectuée par la direction d’une société de portefeuille d’assurances ou pour son compte}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermEn>solicitation by or on behalf of the management of an insurance holding company</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;785&quot;,df=&quot;{solicitation by or on behalf of the management of an insurance holding company}{sollicitation effectuée par la direction d’une société de portefeuille d’assurances ou pour son compte}&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;"><DefinedTermFr>sollicitation effectuée par la direction d’une société de portefeuille d’assurances ou pour son compte</DefinedTermFr></MarginalNote><Text><DefinedTermEn>solicitation by or on behalf of the management of an insurance holding company</DefinedTermEn> means a solicitation by any person pursuant to a resolution or instruction of, or with the acquiescence of, the directors or a committee of the directors of the insurance holding company.</Text></Definition><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 322.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;786&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;786&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Appointing proxyholder</MarginalNote><Label>786.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;786&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A shareholder who is entitled to vote at a meeting of shareholders may, by executing a form of proxy, appoint a proxyholder or one or more alternate proxyholders, who are not required to be shareholders, to attend and act at the meeting in the manner and to the extent authorized by the proxy and with the authority conferred by the proxy.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;786&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;786&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Execution of proxy</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A form of proxy shall be executed by a shareholder or by a shareholder’s attorney authorized in writing to do so.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;786&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;786&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limit on authority</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>No appointment of a proxyholder provides authority for the proxyholder to act in respect of the appointment of an auditor or the election of a director unless a nominee proposed in good faith for the appointment or election is named in the form of proxy, a management proxy circular, a dissident’s proxy circular or a proposal under subsection 770(1).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;786&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;786&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Required information</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>A form of proxy must indicate, in bold-face type, that the shareholder by whom or on whose behalf it is executed may appoint a proxyholder, other than a person designated in the form of proxy, to attend and act on the shareholder’s behalf at a meeting to which the proxy relates, and must contain instructions as to the manner in which the shareholder may do so.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;786&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;786&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Validity of proxy</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>A proxy is valid only at the meeting in respect of which it is given or at a continuation of the meeting after an adjournment.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;786&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;786&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Revocation of proxy</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>A shareholder may revoke a proxy</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;786&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>by depositing an instrument in writing executed by the shareholder or by the shareholder’s attorney authorized in writing to do so</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;786&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>at the head office of the insurance holding company at any time up to and including the last business day before the day of a meeting, or a continuation of a meeting after an adjournment, at which the proxy is to be used, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;786&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>with the chairperson of the meeting on the day of the meeting or a continuation of the meeting after an adjournment; or</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;786&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in any other manner permitted by law.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;787&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;787&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Deposit of proxies</MarginalNote><Label>787.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;787&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The directors may specify, in a notice calling a meeting of shareholders or a continuation of a meeting of shareholders after an adjournment, a time before which executed forms of proxy to be used at the meeting or the continued meeting must be deposited with the insurance holding company or its transfer agent.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;787&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;787&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Time for deposit of proxies</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The time specified for the deposit of forms of proxy may not precede the meeting or the continued meeting by more than forty-eight hours, excluding Saturdays and holidays.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;788&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;788&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Mandatory solicitation</MarginalNote><Label>788.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;788&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection 768(2) and subsection (2), the management of an insurance holding company shall, at the same time as they send notice of a meeting of shareholders, send a form of proxy in prescribed form to each shareholder entitled to receive notice of the meeting under section 767.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;788&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;788&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The management of an insurance holding company is not required to send a form of proxy under subsection (1) if the insurance holding company</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;788&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>is not a distributing insurance holding company; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;788&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>has 50 or fewer shareholders who are entitled to vote at a meeting, two or more joint holders of a share being counted as one shareholder.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 323.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;789&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;789&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Soliciting proxies</MarginalNote><Label>789.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;789&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A person shall not solicit proxies unless</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;789&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of solicitation by or on behalf of the management of an insurance holding company, a management proxy circular in prescribed form, either as an appendix to or as a separate document accompanying the notice of the meeting, is sent to the auditor of the insurance holding company and to each shareholder whose proxy is solicited; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;789&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of any other solicitation, a dissident’s proxy circular in prescribed form stating the purposes of the solicitation is sent to the auditor of the insurance holding company, to each shareholder whose proxy is solicited and to the insurance holding company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;789&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;789&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Copy to Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A person who sends a management proxy circular or dissident’s proxy circular shall at the same time file with the Superintendent</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;789&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of a management proxy circular, a copy of it together with a copy of the notice of meeting, form of proxy and any other documents for use in connection with the meeting; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;789&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of a dissident’s proxy circular, a copy of it together with a copy of the form of proxy and any other documents for use in connection with the meeting.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;789&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;789&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exemption by Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>On the application of an interested person, the Superintendent may, on any terms that the Superintendent thinks fit, exempt the person from any of the requirements of subsection (1) and section 788, and the exemption may be given retroactive effect.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;789&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;789&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Reporting exemptions</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>The Superintendent shall set out in a periodical available to the public the particulars of each exemption granted under subsection (3) together with the reasons for the exemption.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;790&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;790&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Attendance at meeting</MarginalNote><Label>790.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;790&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A person who solicits a proxy and is appointed proxyholder shall attend in person or cause an alternate proxyholder to attend every meeting in respect of which the proxy is valid, and the proxyholder or alternate proxyholder shall comply with the directions of the shareholder who executed the form of proxy.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;790&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;790&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Rights of proxyholder</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A proxyholder or an alternate proxyholder has the same rights as the appointing shareholder to speak at a meeting of shareholders in respect of any matter, to vote by way of ballot at the meeting and, except where a proxyholder or an alternate proxyholder has conflicting instructions from more than one shareholder, to vote at the meeting in respect of any matter by way of a show of hands.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;790&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;790&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Vote by show of hands</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Despite subsections (1) and (2) and unless a shareholder or proxyholder demands a ballot, if the chairperson of a meeting of shareholders declares to the meeting that, if a ballot were conducted, the total number of votes attached to shares represented at the meeting by proxy required to be voted against what, to the knowledge of the chairperson, would be the decision of the meeting on a matter or group of matters is less than 5% of all the votes that might be cast by shareholders in person or by proxy,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;790&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the chairperson may conduct the vote in respect of that matter or group of matters by way of a show of hands; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;790&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a proxyholder or alternate proxyholder may vote in respect of that matter or group of matters by way of a show of hands.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 325.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;791&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;791&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Duty of intermediary</MarginalNote><Label>791.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;791&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Shares of an insurance holding company that are registered in the name of an intermediary or an intermediary’s nominee and not beneficially owned by the intermediary may not be voted unless the intermediary sends to the beneficial owner</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;791&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a copy of the notice of the meeting, annual statement, management proxy circular and dissident’s proxy circular and any other documents, other than the form of proxy, that were sent to shareholders by or on behalf of any person for use in connection with the meeting; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;791&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a written request for voting instructions except if the intermediary has already received written voting instructions from the beneficial owner.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;791&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;791&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">When documents to be sent</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The intermediary shall send the documents referred to in subsection (1) without delay after they receive the documents referred to in paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;791&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;791&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction on voting</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>An intermediary or a proxyholder appointed by them may not vote shares that the intermediary does not beneficially own and that are registered in the name of the intermediary or their nominee unless the intermediary or proxyholder, as the case may be, receives written voting instructions from the beneficial owner.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;791&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;791&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Copies</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>A person by or on behalf of whom a solicitation is made shall on request and without delay provide the intermediary, at the person’s expense, with the necessary number of copies of the documents referred to in paragraph (1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;791&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;791&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Instructions to intermediary</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>The intermediary shall vote or appoint a proxyholder to vote any shares referred to in subsection (1) in accordance with any written voting instructions received from the beneficial owner.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;791&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;791&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Beneficial owner as proxyholder</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>If a beneficial owner so requests and provides an intermediary with the appropriate documentation, the intermediary shall appoint the beneficial owner or a nominee of the beneficial owner as proxyholder.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;791&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;791&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Effect of intermediary’s failure to comply</MarginalNote><Label>(7)</Label><Text>The failure of an intermediary to comply with any of subsections (1) to (6) does not render void any meeting of shareholders or any action taken at the meeting.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;791&quot;,ss=&quot;8&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;791&quot;,ss=&quot;8&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Intermediary may not vote</MarginalNote><Label>(8)</Label><Text>Nothing in this Subdivision gives an intermediary the right to vote shares that they are otherwise prohibited from voting.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 326.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;791.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;791.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exemption</MarginalNote><Label>791.1</Label><Text>The Governor in Council may make regulations respecting the conditions under which an insurance holding company is exempt from any of the requirements of sections 786 to 791.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2005, c. 54, s. 326.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;792&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;792&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restraining order</MarginalNote><Label>792.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;792&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If a form of proxy, management proxy circular or dissident’s proxy circular contains an untrue statement of a material fact or omits to state a material fact that is required to be contained in it or that is necessary to make a statement contained in it not misleading in light of the circumstances in which the statement is made, an interested person or the Superintendent may apply to a court and the court may make any order it thinks fit including</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;792&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order restraining the solicitation or the holding of the meeting, or restraining any person from implementing or acting on a resolution passed at the meeting, to which the form of proxy, management proxy circular or dissident’s proxy circular relates;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;792&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order requiring correction of any form of proxy or proxy circular and a further solicitation; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;792&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>an order adjourning the meeting.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;792&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;792&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of application</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where a person other than the Superintendent is an applicant under subsection (1), the applicant shall give to the Superintendent notice of the application and the Superintendent is entitled to appear and to be heard in person or by counsel.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading group-style="left-regular" Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_2&quot;,gd=&quot;s_793&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="4"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_2&quot;,gd=&quot;s_793&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Restrictions on Voting</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;793&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;793&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Meaning of <DefinedTermEn>eligible votes</DefinedTermEn></MarginalNote><Label>793.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;793&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>In this section, <DefinedTermEn>eligible votes</DefinedTermEn> means the total number of votes that may be cast by or on behalf of shareholders on a vote of shareholders or a vote of holders of a class or series of shares, as the case may be, in respect of any particular matter, calculated without regard to subsection (2).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;793&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;793&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>At a meeting of shareholders of an insurance holding company in respect of which subsection 927(4) applies, no person and no entity controlled by any person may, in respect of any vote of shareholders or holders of any class or series of shares of the company, cast votes in respect of any shares beneficially owned by the person or the entity that are, in aggregate, more than 20 per cent of the eligible votes that may be cast in respect of that vote.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;793&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;793&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Proxyholders</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>No person who is a proxyholder for a person or for an entity controlled by a person may cast votes to which the proxy relates that the person or entity may not cast by reason of subsection (2).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;793&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;793&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Subsections (2) and (3) do not apply in respect of a vote held under section 852.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;793&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;793&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Validity of vote</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>A vote in respect of a particular matter is not invalid merely because a person voted contrary to subsection (2) or (3).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;793&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;793&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Disposition of shareholdings</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>If, with respect to any insurance holding company, a person contravenes subsection (2) or (3), the Minister may, by order, direct the shareholder of the shares to which the contravention relates or any person controlled by that shareholder to dispose of any number of shares of the insurance holding company beneficially owned by any of those persons that the Minister specifies in the order, within the time specified in the order and in the proportion, if any, as between the shareholder and the persons controlled by that shareholder that is specified in the order.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;793&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;793&quot;,ss=&quot;7&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Restriction on voting rights</MarginalNote><Label>(7)</Label><Text>If the Minister makes an order under subsection (6), the person to whom the order relates may not, in person or by proxy, exercise any voting rights that are attached to shares of the company beneficially owned by the person.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;793&quot;,ss=&quot;8&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;793&quot;,ss=&quot;8&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Subsection (7) ceases to apply</MarginalNote><Label>(8)</Label><Text>Subsection (7) shall cease to apply in respect of a person when the shares to which the order relates have been disposed of.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;793&quot;,ss=&quot;9&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;793&quot;,ss=&quot;9&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Reliance on number in notice</MarginalNote><Label>(9)</Label><Text>For the purpose of this section, a person is entitled to rely on the number of eligible votes set out in a notice of a meeting under subsection 767(2).</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;793&quot;,ss=&quot;10&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;793&quot;,ss=&quot;10&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Designation of persons</MarginalNote><Label>(10)</Label><Text>For the purpose of this section, the Minister may, with respect to a particular insurance holding company, designate two or more persons who are parties to an agreement, commitment or understanding referred to in section 9 to be a single person.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_3&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="3"><Label>Subdivision 3</Label><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_3&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Directors and Officers</TitleText></Heading><Heading group-style="left-regular" Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_3&quot;,gd=&quot;s_794&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="4"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_3&quot;,gd=&quot;s_794&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Duties</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;794&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;794&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Duty to manage</MarginalNote><Label>794.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;794&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to this Act, the directors of an insurance holding company shall manage or supervise the management of the business and affairs of the insurance holding company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;794&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;794&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Specific duties</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Without limiting the generality of subsection (1), the directors of an insurance holding company shall</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;794&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>establish an audit committee to perform the duties referred to in subsections 829(3) and (4);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;794&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>establish procedures to resolve conflicts of interest, including techniques for the identification of potential conflict situations and for restricting the use of confidential information;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;794&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>designate a committee of the board of directors to monitor the procedures referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>); and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;794&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>establish investment and lending policies, standards and procedures in accordance with section 968.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;794&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;794&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Paragraph (2)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) does not apply to the directors of an insurance holding company if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;794&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>all the voting shares of the insurance holding company are beneficially owned by a Canadian financial institution described by any of paragraphs (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>) of the definition “financial institution” in subsection 2(1); and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;794&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the audit committee of the Canadian financial institution referred to in paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) performs for and on behalf of the insurance holding company all the functions that would otherwise be required to be performed by the audit committee of the insurance holding company under this Part.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;795&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;795&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Duty of care</MarginalNote><Label>795.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;795&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Every director and officer of an insurance holding company in exercising any of the powers of a director or an officer and discharging any of the duties of a director or an officer shall</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;795&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>act honestly and in good faith with a view to the best interests of the insurance holding company; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;795&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>exercise the care, diligence and skill that a reasonably prudent person would exercise in comparable circumstances.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;795&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;795&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Duty to comply</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Every director, officer and employee of an insurance holding company shall comply with this Act, the regulations, the insurance holding company’s incorporating instrument and the by-laws of the insurance holding company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;795&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;795&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">No exculpation</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>No provision in any contract, in any resolution or in the by-laws of an insurance holding company relieves any director, officer or employee of the insurance holding company from the duty to act in accordance with this Act and the regulations or relieves a director, officer or employee from liability for a breach thereof.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading group-style="left-regular" Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_3&quot;,gd=&quot;s_796&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="4"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_3&quot;,gd=&quot;s_796&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Qualification and Number — Directors</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;796&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;796&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Minimum number of directors</MarginalNote><Label>796.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;796&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>An insurance holding company shall have at least seven directors.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;796&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;796&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Residency requirement</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>At least one half of the directors of an insurance holding company that is a subsidiary of a foreign institution and a majority of the directors of any other insurance holding company must be, at the time of each director’s election or appointment, resident Canadians.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465;</li><li> 2007, c. 6, s. 319.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;797&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;797&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Disqualified persons</MarginalNote><Label>797.</Label><Text>The following persons are disqualified from being directors of an insurance holding company:</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;797&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a person who is less than eighteen years of age;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;797&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a person who is of unsound mind and has been so found by a court in Canada or elsewhere;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;797&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a person who has the status of a bankrupt;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;797&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a person who is not a natural person;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;797&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a person who is prohibited by subsection 793(7) or section 945 or 955 from exercising voting rights attached to shares of the insurance holding company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;797&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a person who is an officer, director or full-time employee of an entity that is prohibited by subsection 793(7) or section 945 or 955 from exercising voting rights attached to shares of the insurance holding company;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;797&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a person who is an agent or employee of Her Majesty in right of Canada or in right of a province;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;797&quot;,p1=&quot;h&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">h</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a minister of Her Majesty in right of Canada or in right of a province; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;797&quot;,p1=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">i</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a person who is an agent or employee of the government of a foreign country or any political subdivision thereof.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;798&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;798&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">No requirement to hold shares</MarginalNote><Label>798.</Label><Text>A director of an insurance holding company is not required to hold shares of the insurance holding company.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;799&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;799&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limit on directors</MarginalNote><Label>799.</Label><Text>No more than 15 per cent of the directors of an insurance holding company may, at each director’s election or appointment, be employees of the insurance holding company or a subsidiary of the insurance holding company, except that up to four persons who are employees of the insurance holding company or a subsidiary of the insurance holding company may be directors of the insurance holding company if those directors constitute not more than one half of the directors of the insurance holding company.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading group-style="left-regular" Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_3&quot;,gd=&quot;s_800&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="4"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_3&quot;,gd=&quot;s_800&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Election and Tenure — Directors</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;800&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;800&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Number of directors</MarginalNote><Label>800.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;800&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to subsection 796(1) and sections 803 and 851, the directors of an insurance holding company shall, by by-law, determine the number of directors or the minimum and maximum number of directors, but no by-law that decreases the number of directors shortens the term of an incumbent director.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;800&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;800&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Election at annual meeting</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A by-law made pursuant to subsection (1) that provides for a minimum and maximum number of directors may provide that the number of directors to be elected at any annual meeting of the shareholders be such number as is fixed by the directors prior to the annual meeting.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;800.1&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;800.1&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Election or appointment as director</MarginalNote><Label>800.1</Label><Text>The election or appointment of a person as a director is subject to the following:</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;800.1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the person was present at the meeting when the election or appointment took place and did not refuse to hold office as a director; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;800.1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the person was not present at the meeting when the election or appointment took place but</Text><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;800.1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;i&quot;"><Label>(i)</Label><Text>consented in writing to hold office as a director before the election or appointment or within 10 days after it, or</Text></Subparagraph><Subparagraph Code="se=&quot;800.1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;,p2=&quot;ii&quot;"><Label>(ii)</Label><Text>acted as a director after the election or appointment.</Text></Subparagraph></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2005, c. 54, s. 327.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;801&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;801&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Term of directors</MarginalNote><Label>801.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;801&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Except where this Part or the by-laws of an insurance holding company provide for cumulative voting, the insurance holding company may, by by-law, provide that the directors be elected for terms of one, two or three years.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;801&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;801&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Term of one, two or three years</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A director elected for a term of one, two or three years holds office until the close of the first, second or third annual meeting of shareholders, as the case may be, following the election of the director.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;801&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;801&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">No stated term</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A director who is not elected for an expressly stated term of office ceases to hold office at the close of the next annual meeting of shareholders following the election of the director.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;801&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;801&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Tenure of office</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>It is not necessary that all directors elected at a meeting of shareholders hold office for the same term.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;801&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;801&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Tenure of office</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>If a by-law of an insurance holding company provides that the directors be elected for a term of two or three years, it may also provide that the term of office of each director be for the whole of that term, or that, as nearly as may be, one half of the directors retire each year if the term is two years, and that one third of the directors retire each year if the term is three years.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;801&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;801&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Composition requirements</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>Where a director of an insurance holding company is elected or appointed for a term of more than one year, the insurance holding company shall comply with subsection 796(2) and section 799 at each annual meeting of shareholders during the director’s term of office as if that director were elected or appointed on that date.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;802&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;802&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Determining election of directors</MarginalNote><Label>802.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;802&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Except where this Part or the by-laws of an insurance holding company provide for cumulative voting, the persons, to the number authorized to be elected, who receive the greatest number of votes at an election of directors of an insurance holding company shall be the directors thereof.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;802&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;802&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Equal number of votes</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If, at any election of directors referred to in subsection (1), two or more persons receive an equal number of votes and there are not sufficient vacancies remaining to enable all the persons receiving an equal number of votes to be elected, the directors who receive a greater number of votes or the majority of them shall, in order to complete the full number of directors, determine which of the persons so receiving an equal number of votes are to be elected.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;803&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;803&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Cumulative voting</MarginalNote><Label>803.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;803&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Where this Part or the by-laws provide for cumulative voting,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;803&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>there shall be a stated number determined by by-law, and not a minimum and maximum number, of directors;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;803&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>each shareholder entitled to vote at an election of directors to be elected by cumulative voting has the right to cast a number of votes equal to the number of votes attached to the shares held by the shareholder multiplied by the number of directors to be elected by cumulative voting, and the shareholder may cast all such votes in favour of one candidate or distribute them among the candidates in any manner;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;803&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a separate vote shall be taken with respect to each candidate nominated for a position that is to be filled by cumulative voting unless a resolution is passed unanimously permitting two or more persons to be elected by a single vote;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;803&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if a shareholder has voted for more than one candidate without specifying the distribution of the votes among the candidates, the shareholder is deemed to have distributed the votes equally among the candidates for whom the shareholder voted;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;803&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if the number of candidates nominated exceeds the number of positions to be filled, the candidates who receive the least number of votes shall be eliminated until the number of candidates remaining equals the number of positions to be filled;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;803&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;f&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>each director elected by cumulative voting ceases to hold office at the close of the next annual meeting of shareholders following the director’s election;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;803&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;g&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a director may be removed from office only if the number of votes cast in favour of a motion to remove the director is greater than the product of the number of directors required by the by-laws and the number of votes cast against the motion; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;803&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;h&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">h</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the number of directors required by the by-laws may be decreased only if the number of votes cast in favour of a motion to decrease the number of directors is greater than the product of the number of directors required by the by-laws and the number of votes cast against the motion.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;803&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;803&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Mandatory cumulative voting</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where the aggregate of the voting shares beneficially owned by a person and any entities controlled by the person carries more than 10 per cent of the voting rights attached to all the outstanding voting shares of an insurance holding company, the directors shall be elected by cumulative voting.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;803&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;803&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Subsection (2) does not apply if all the voting shares of the insurance holding company that are outstanding are beneficially owned by</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;803&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>one person;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;803&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>one person and one or more entities controlled by that person; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;803&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>one or more entities controlled by the same person.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;803&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;803&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Subsection (2) does not apply to an insurance holding company in respect of which subsection 927(4) applies.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;803&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;803&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Transitional election</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>Where this Part or the by-laws of an insurance holding company provide for cumulative voting, the shareholders of the insurance holding company shall</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;803&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>at the first annual meeting of shareholders held not earlier than ninety days following the date that cumulative voting is required under subsection (2) or provided for in the by-laws, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;803&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>at each succeeding annual meeting,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>elect the stated number of directors to hold office until the close of the next annual meeting of shareholders following their election.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;803&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;803&quot;,ss=&quot;6&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Class or series of shares</MarginalNote><Label>(6)</Label><Text>Nothing in this Part precludes the holders of any class or series of shares of an insurance holding company from having an exclusive right to elect one or more directors.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 328.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;804&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;804&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Re-election of directors</MarginalNote><Label>804.</Label><Text>A director who has completed a term of office is, if otherwise qualified, eligible for re-election.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading group-style="left-regular" Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_3&quot;,gd=&quot;s_805&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="4"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_3&quot;,gd=&quot;s_805&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Incomplete Elections and Director Vacancies</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;805&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;805&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Void election or appointment</MarginalNote><Label>805.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;805&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>If, immediately after the time of any purported election or appointment of directors, the board of directors would fail to comply with subsection 796(2) or section 799, the purported election or appointment of all persons purported to be elected or appointed at that time is void unless the directors, within forty-five days after the discovery of the non-compliance, develop a plan, approved by the Superintendent, to rectify the non-compliance.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;805&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;805&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Failure to elect minimum</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If, at the close of a meeting of shareholders of an insurance holding company, the shareholders have failed to elect the number or minimum number of directors required by this Part or the by-laws of an insurance holding company, the purported election of directors at the meeting</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;805&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>is valid if the directors purported to be elected and those incumbent directors, if any, whose terms did not expire at the close of the meeting, together constitute a quorum; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;805&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>is void if the directors purported to be elected and those incumbent directors, if any, whose terms did not expire at the close of the meeting, together do not constitute a quorum.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;806&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;806&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Directors where elections incomplete or void</MarginalNote><Label>806.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;806&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Despite subsections 801(2) and (3) and paragraphs 803(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>) and 807(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>), where subsection 805(1) or (2) applies at the close of any meeting of shareholders of an insurance holding company, the board of directors shall, until their successors are elected or appointed, consist solely of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;806&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>where paragraph 805(2)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) applies, the directors referred to in that paragraph; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;806&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>where subsection 805(1) or paragraph 805(2)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) applies, those persons who were the incumbent directors immediately before the meeting.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;806&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;806&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Where there is no approved rectification plan</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Despite subsections 801(2) and (3) and paragraphs 803(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">f</Emphasis>) and 807(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>), where a plan to rectify the non-compliance referred to in subsection 805(1) has not been approved by the Superintendent by the end of the forty-five day period referred to in that subsection, the board of directors shall, until their successors are elected or appointed, consist solely of the persons who were the incumbent directors immediately before the meeting at which the purported election or appointment referred to in that subsection occurred.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;806&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;806&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Directors to call meeting</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Where subsection (1) or (2) applies, the board of directors referred to in that subsection shall without delay call a special meeting of shareholders to fill the vacancies, where paragraph 805(2)(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) applies, or elect a new board of directors, where subsection 805(1) or paragraph 805(2)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) applies.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;806&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;806&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shareholder may call meeting</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>Where the directors fail to call a special meeting required by subsection (3), the meeting may be called by any shareholder.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;807&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;807&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Ceasing to hold office</MarginalNote><Label>807.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;807&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A director ceases to hold office</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;807&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>at the close of the annual meeting at which the director’s term of office expires;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;807&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>when the director dies or resigns;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;807&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>when the director becomes disqualified under section 797 or ineligible to hold office pursuant to subsection 837(2);</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;807&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;d&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">d</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>when the director is removed under section 808; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;807&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;e&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>when the director is removed from office under section 1006 or 1007.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;807&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;807&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Date of resignation</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The resignation of a director of an insurance holding company becomes effective at the time a written resignation is sent to the insurance holding company by the director or at the time specified in the resignation, whichever is later.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;808&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;808&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Removal of director</MarginalNote><Label>808.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;808&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to paragraph 803(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">g</Emphasis>) and this section, the shareholders of an insurance holding company may by resolution at a special meeting remove any director or all the directors from office.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;808&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;808&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Removal of director</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>If the holders of any class or series of shares of an insurance holding company have the exclusive right to elect one or more directors, a director so elected may be removed only by a resolution at a meeting of the shareholders of that class or series.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;808&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;808&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Vacancy by removal</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Subject to paragraphs 803(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) to (<Emphasis style="italic">e</Emphasis>), a vacancy created by the removal of a director may be filled at the meeting of the shareholders at which the director is removed or, if not so filled, may be filled under section 812 or 813.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;809&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;809&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Statement of director</MarginalNote><Label>809.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;809&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A director who</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;809&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>resigns,</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;809&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>receives a notice or otherwise learns of a meeting of shareholders called for the purpose of removing the director from office, or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;809&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>receives a notice or otherwise learns of a meeting of directors or shareholders at which another person is to be appointed or elected to fill the office of director, whether because of the director’s resignation or removal or because the director’s term of office has expired or is about to expire,</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>is entitled to submit to the insurance holding company a written statement giving the reasons for the resignation or the reasons why the director opposes any proposed action or resolution.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;809&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;809&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Statement to Superintendent</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Where a director resigns as a result of a disagreement with the other directors or the officers of an insurance holding company, the director shall submit to the insurance holding company and the Superintendent a written statement setting out the nature of the disagreement.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;810&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;810&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Circulation of statement</MarginalNote><Label>810.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;810&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>An insurance holding company shall forthwith on receipt of a director’s statement referred to in subsection 809(1) relating to a matter referred to in paragraph 809(1)(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) or (<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>), or a director’s statement referred to in subsection 809(2), send a copy thereof to each shareholder entitled to receive a notice of meetings and to the Superintendent, unless the statement is attached to a notice of a meeting.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;810&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;810&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Immunity for statement</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>No insurance holding company or person acting on its behalf incurs any liability by reason only of circulating a director’s statement in compliance with subsection (1).</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;811&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;811&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Shareholders filling vacancy</MarginalNote><Label>811.</Label><Text>The by-laws of an insurance holding company may provide that a vacancy among the directors is to be filled only by vote of</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;811&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the shareholders; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;811&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the holders of any class or series of shares having an exclusive right to elect one or more directors if the vacancy occurs among the directors elected by the holders of that class or series.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;812&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;812&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Directors filling vacancy</MarginalNote><Label>812.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;812&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Despite section 819 but subject to subsection (2) and sections 811 and 813, a quorum of directors may fill a vacancy among the directors except a vacancy resulting from a change in the by-laws by which the number or the minimum or maximum number of directors is increased or from a failure to elect the number or minimum number of directors provided for in the by-laws.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;812&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;812&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Where composition fails</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Despite sections 811 and 819, where by reason of a vacancy the number of directors or the composition of the board of directors fails to meet any of the requirements of section 796 or 799, the directors who, in the absence of any by-law, would be empowered to fill that vacancy shall do so forthwith.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 329.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;813&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;813&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Class vacancy</MarginalNote><Label>813.</Label><Text>Despite section 819 but subject to section 811, where the holders of any class or series of shares of an insurance holding company have an exclusive right to elect one or more directors and a vacancy occurs among those directors,</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;813&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the remaining directors elected by the holders of that class or series of shares may fill the vacancy except one resulting from an increase in the number or the minimum or maximum number of directors for that class or series or from a failure to elect the number or minimum number of directors provided for in the by-laws for that class or series;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;813&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if there are no such remaining directors and, by reason of the vacancy, the number of directors or the composition of the board of directors fails to meet any of the requirements of section 796 or 799, the other directors may fill that vacancy; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;813&quot;,p1=&quot;c&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">c</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>if there are no such remaining directors and paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>) does not apply, any holder of shares of that class or series may call a meeting of the holders thereof for the purpose of filling the vacancy.</Text></Paragraph><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 330.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;814&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;814&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Unexpired term</MarginalNote><Label>814.</Label><Text>Unless the by-laws otherwise provide, a director elected or appointed to fill a vacancy holds office for the unexpired term of the director’s predecessor in office.</Text><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;815&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;815&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Additional directors</MarginalNote><Label>815.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;815&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The directors may appoint one or more additional directors if the by-laws of the insurance holding company allow them to do so and the by-laws determine the minimum and maximum numbers of directors.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;815&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;815&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Term of office</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A director appointed under subsection (1) holds office for a term expiring not later than the close of the next annual meeting of shareholders of the insurance holding company.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;815&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;815&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Limit on number appointed</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The total number of directors appointed under subsection (1) may not exceed one third of the number of directors elected at the previous annual meeting of shareholders of the insurance holding company.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Heading group-style="left-regular" Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_3&quot;,gd=&quot;s_816&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;" level="4"><TitleText Code="ga=&quot;l_XVII&quot;,gb=&quot;l_6&quot;,gc=&quot;l_3&quot;,gd=&quot;s_816&quot;,h1=&quot;&quot;,t1=&quot;&quot;">Meetings of the Board</TitleText></Heading><Section Code="se=&quot;816&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;816&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Meetings required</MarginalNote><Label>816.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;816&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The directors shall meet at least four times during each financial year.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;816&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;816&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Place for meetings</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The directors may meet at any place unless the by-laws provide otherwise.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;816&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;816&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice for meetings</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>The notice for the meetings must be given as required by the by-laws.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;817&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;817&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Notice of meeting</MarginalNote><Label>817.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;817&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A notice of a meeting of directors shall specify each matter referred to in section 832 that is to be dealt with at the meeting but, unless the by-laws otherwise provide, need not otherwise specify the purpose of or the business to be transacted at the meeting.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;817&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;817&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Waiver of notice</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A director may in any manner waive notice of a meeting of directors and the attendance of a director at a meeting of directors is a waiver of notice of that meeting except where the director attends the meeting for the express purpose of objecting to the transaction of any business on the grounds that the meeting is not lawfully called.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;817&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;817&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Adjourned meeting</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>Notice of an adjourned meeting of directors is not required to be given if the time and place of the adjourned meeting was announced at the original meeting.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;818&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;818&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Quorum</MarginalNote><Label>818.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;818&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to section 819, the number of directors referred to in subsection (2) constitutes a quorum at any meeting of directors or a committee of directors and, notwithstanding any vacancy among the directors, a quorum of directors may exercise all the powers of the directors.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;818&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;818&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Quorum</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>The number of directors constituting a quorum at any meeting of directors or a committee of directors shall be</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;818&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a majority of the minimum number of directors required by this Part for the board of directors or a committee of directors; or</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;818&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>such greater number of directors than the number calculated pursuant to paragraph (<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>) as may be established by the by-laws of the insurance holding company.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;818&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;818&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Director continues to be present</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A director who is present at a meeting of directors or of a committee of directors but is not, in accordance with subsection 837(1), present at any particular time during the meeting is considered to be present for the purposes of this section.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 331.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;819&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;819&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Resident Canadian majority</MarginalNote><Label>819.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;819&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>The directors of an insurance holding company shall not transact business at a meeting of directors or of a committee of directors unless</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;819&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of an insurance holding company that is the subsidiary of a foreign institution, at least one half, and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;819&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>in the case of any other insurance holding company, a majority</Text></Paragraph><ContinuedSectionSubsection><Text>of the directors present are resident Canadians.</Text></ContinuedSectionSubsection></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;819&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;819&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Exception</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>Despite subsection (1), the directors of an insurance holding company may transact business at a meeting of directors or of a committee of directors without the required proportion of directors who are resident Canadians if</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;819&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>a director who is a resident Canadian unable to be present approves, in writing or by telephonic, electronic or other communications facilities, the business transacted at the meeting; and</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;819&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,p1=&quot;b&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">b</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>there would have been present the required proportion of directors who are resident Canadians had that director been present at the meeting.</Text></Paragraph></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;820&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;820&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Electronic meeting</MarginalNote><Label>820.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;820&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>Subject to the by-laws of an insurance holding company, a meeting of directors or of a committee of directors may be held by means of such telephonic, electronic or other communications facilities as permit all persons participating in the meeting to communicate adequately with each other during the meeting.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;820&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;820&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Deemed present</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A director participating in a meeting by any means referred to in subsection (1) is deemed for the purposes of this Part to be present at that meeting.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465.</li></ul></HistoricalNote></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;821&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;821&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Resolution outside board meeting</MarginalNote><Label>821.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;821&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A resolution in writing signed by all the directors entitled to vote on that resolution at a meeting of directors is as valid as if it had been passed at a meeting of directors.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;821&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;821&quot;,ss=&quot;2&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Filing directors’ resolution</MarginalNote><Label>(2)</Label><Text>A copy of the resolution referred to in subsection (1) shall be kept with the minutes of the proceedings of the directors.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;821&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;821&quot;,ss=&quot;3&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Resolution outside committee meeting</MarginalNote><Label>(3)</Label><Text>A resolution in writing signed by all the directors entitled to vote on that resolution at a meeting of a committee of directors, other than a resolution of the audit committee in carrying out its duties under subsection 829(3), is as valid as if it had been passed at a meeting of that committee.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;821&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;821&quot;,ss=&quot;4&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Filing committee resolution</MarginalNote><Label>(4)</Label><Text>A copy of the resolution referred to in subsection (3) shall be kept with the minutes of the proceedings of that committee.</Text></Subsection><Subsection Code="se=&quot;821&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;821&quot;,ss=&quot;5&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Evidence</MarginalNote><Label>(5)</Label><Text>Unless a ballot is demanded, an entry in the minutes of a meeting that the chairperson declared a resolution to be carried or defeated is in the absence of evidence to the contrary proof of that fact without proof of the number or proportion of votes recorded in favour of or against the resolution.</Text></Subsection><HistoricalNote><ul><li>2001, c. 9, s. 465;</li><li> 2005, c. 54, s. 332.</li></ul></HistoricalNote><a startdate="20030101">Previous Version</a></Section><Section Code="se=&quot;822&quot;"><MarginalNote Code="se=&quot;822&quot;,m1=&quot;&quot;">Dissent of director</MarginalNote><Label>822.</Label><Subsection Code="se=&quot;822&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;"><Label>(1)</Label><Text>A director of an insurance holding company who is present at a meeting of directors or a committee of directors is deemed to have consented to any resolution passed or action taken at that meeting unless</Text><Paragraph Code="se=&quot;822&quot;,ss=&quot;1&quot;,p1=&quot;a&quot;"><Label>(<Emphasis style="italic">a</Emphasis>)</Label><Text>the director requests that the director’s dissent be entered or the director’s dissent is entered in the minutes of the meeting;</Text></Paragraph><Paragraph Code="se=&q
